Вы находитесь на странице: 1из 1126

User's Guide

GEO5 version 17
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Content
Using help...................................................................................................................33
Using function Search...............................................................................................34
User defined environment..............................................................................................35
Window for application..............................................................................................35
Control menu...........................................................................................................36
Horizontal tool bars...................................................................................................37
Tool bar Files........................................................................................................37
Tool bar Scale and shift.........................................................................................38
Tool bar Plot setting..............................................................................................39
Tool bar Stage of construction................................................................................39
Tool bar 3D visualization........................................................................................40
Tool bar Selections................................................................................................40
Vertical tool bars......................................................................................................41
Visualization style settings.........................................................................................42
Style manager......................................................................................................43
Frames....................................................................................................................44
Tables.....................................................................................................................45
Dialog windows........................................................................................................47
Active dimensions and objects....................................................................................48
Unit metric / imperial................................................................................................49
Copy to clipboard.....................................................................................................49
GeoClipboard...........................................................................................................50
Copying and pasting 2D interfaces..........................................................................50
Options...................................................................................................................51
Options copy to clipboard....................................................................................52
Options print picture..........................................................................................53
Options - input.....................................................................................................54
Common input.............................................................................................................55
Inputting and editing soils.........................................................................................55
Classification of soils.............................................................................................56
Soil and rock symbols...........................................................................................58
Manual classification of soils...................................................................................60
Interfaces in 2D environment.....................................................................................60
Adding interface...................................................................................................61
Editing interface...................................................................................................62
-1-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Corrector of inputted interface................................................................................63
World coordinates.................................................................................................64
Assigning soils..........................................................................................................67
Design coefficients....................................................................................................68
Running more analyses / verifications.........................................................................69
Connecting programs................................................................................................70
Selecting and storing views........................................................................................71
Results visualization settings..................................................................................72
Setting color range...................................................................................................73
Scale color definition.............................................................................................74
Import - export DXF..................................................................................................75
Reading data into template....................................................................................76
Reading data into interface....................................................................................77
Inputting data using template................................................................................78
Modifying template during data input......................................................................79
Export DXF..........................................................................................................80
Import LandXML.......................................................................................................81
Import gINT.............................................................................................................82
Import of terrain points.........................................................................................83
Import of soils and profile......................................................................................84
Heredity - stage of construction..................................................................................85
Standards and analysis methods....................................................................................85
Settings Administrator...............................................................................................85
Export and import of settings.................................................................................86
Settings list.............................................................................................................87
Analysis settings.......................................................................................................88
Materials and standards.........................................................................................88
Wall analysis........................................................................................................89
Excavations..........................................................................................................90
Stability analysis..................................................................................................91
Settlement...........................................................................................................91
Spread Footing.....................................................................................................92
Piles....................................................................................................................93
Pile CPT...............................................................................................................94
Micropiles............................................................................................................95
Pile group............................................................................................................95
Adding new Setting...................................................................................................96
-2-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Import of older data..................................................................................................97
Basic changes in settings between version 15 and older versions................................97
Verification methodology...........................................................................................98
Analysis according to the factor of safety (ASD).......................................................98
Analysis according to the theory of limit states (LSD)................................................98
Verification according to EN 1997...........................................................................99
Partial factors...................................................................................................99
Design Approaches......................................................................................100
Design approach 1..................................................................................101
Design approach 2..................................................................................102
Design approach 3..................................................................................102
National Annex (NA)....................................................................................103
Partial factors on water....................................................................................103
Analysis of walls (support structures)................................................................105
Analysis of sheeting structures.........................................................................106
Analysis of foundations (spread footing, piles)....................................................106
Slope stability analysis....................................................................................107
Load combinations..........................................................................................108
Analysis according to LRFD..................................................................................109
LRFD 2003 - Analysis of walls (support structures)..............................................110
LRFD 2003 - Analysis of foundations.................................................................111
LRFD 2012 - Design situations..........................................................................111
LRFD 2012 - Analysis of walls (support structures)..............................................113
LRFD 2012 - Analysis of foundations.................................................................114
LRFD 2012 - Analysis of slope stability...............................................................115
Design situations....................................................................................................115
Input regimes and analysis..........................................................................................116
Program Earth Pressure...........................................................................................116
Project...............................................................................................................116
Settings.............................................................................................................117
Geometry..........................................................................................................117
Profile...............................................................................................................118
Soils..................................................................................................................119
Basic data......................................................................................................120
Assign...............................................................................................................121
Terrain...............................................................................................................122
Water................................................................................................................123
-3-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Surcharge..........................................................................................................124
Earthquake........................................................................................................125
Stage settings....................................................................................................126
Analysis.............................................................................................................126
Program Sheeting Design.........................................................................................127
Project...............................................................................................................127
Settings.............................................................................................................128
Profile...............................................................................................................129
Soils..................................................................................................................130
Basic data......................................................................................................131
Assign...............................................................................................................132
Geometry..........................................................................................................133
Anchors.............................................................................................................134
Props................................................................................................................135
Supports............................................................................................................136
Pressure determination........................................................................................137
Terrain...............................................................................................................138
Water................................................................................................................139
Surcharge..........................................................................................................140
Applied forces.....................................................................................................141
Earthquake........................................................................................................142
Stage settings....................................................................................................143
Analysis.............................................................................................................143
Stability.............................................................................................................145
Program Sheeting Check..........................................................................................147
Project...............................................................................................................147
Settings.............................................................................................................147
Profile...............................................................................................................148
Modulus of subsoil reaction..................................................................................149
Pressiometric tests..............................................................................................150
Soils..................................................................................................................152
Basic data......................................................................................................153
Geometry..........................................................................................................154
Adding and editing section...............................................................................155
User catalog...................................................................................................156
Assign...............................................................................................................157
Excavation.........................................................................................................158
-4-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Terrain...............................................................................................................159
Water................................................................................................................160
Surcharge..........................................................................................................161
Applied forces.....................................................................................................162
Anchors.............................................................................................................163
Props................................................................................................................164
Supports............................................................................................................165
Earthquake........................................................................................................166
Stage settings....................................................................................................167
Analysis.............................................................................................................167
Internal stability.................................................................................................170
External stability.................................................................................................171
Heave failure......................................................................................................172
Envelopes..........................................................................................................173
Program Slope Stability...........................................................................................174
Project...............................................................................................................174
Settings.............................................................................................................175
Interface............................................................................................................175
Embankment......................................................................................................176
Earth cut...........................................................................................................177
Soils..................................................................................................................178
Basic data......................................................................................................179
Rigid body..........................................................................................................180
Assign...............................................................................................................181
Anchors.............................................................................................................182
Reinforcements...................................................................................................183
Surcharge..........................................................................................................184
Water................................................................................................................185
Earthquake........................................................................................................186
Stage settings....................................................................................................187
Analysis.............................................................................................................188
Restrictions on the optimization procedure.........................................................190
Height multiplier.............................................................................................190
Program Cantilever Wall..........................................................................................191
Project...............................................................................................................191
Settings.............................................................................................................192
Geometry..........................................................................................................193
-5-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Material.............................................................................................................194
Profile...............................................................................................................194
Soils..................................................................................................................195
Basic data......................................................................................................196
Assign...............................................................................................................197
Terrain...............................................................................................................198
Water................................................................................................................199
Surcharge..........................................................................................................200
Front face resistance...........................................................................................201
Applied forces.....................................................................................................202
Earthquake........................................................................................................203
Base anchorage..................................................................................................204
Stage settings....................................................................................................205
Verification.........................................................................................................206
Bearing capacity.................................................................................................207
Dimensioning.....................................................................................................208
Stability.............................................................................................................209
Program Masonry wall.............................................................................................210
Project...............................................................................................................210
Settings.............................................................................................................211
Types of blocks...................................................................................................211
Geometry..........................................................................................................212
Material.............................................................................................................213
Profile...............................................................................................................214
Soils..................................................................................................................215
Basic data......................................................................................................216
Assign...............................................................................................................217
Terrain...............................................................................................................218
Water................................................................................................................219
Surcharge..........................................................................................................220
Front face resistance...........................................................................................221
Applied forces.....................................................................................................222
Earthquake........................................................................................................223
Base anchorage..................................................................................................224
Stage settings....................................................................................................225
Verification.........................................................................................................226
Bearing capacity.................................................................................................227
-6-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dimensioning.....................................................................................................228
Stability.............................................................................................................229
Program Gravity Wall...............................................................................................230
Project...............................................................................................................230
Settings.............................................................................................................230
Geometry..........................................................................................................231
Material.............................................................................................................232
Profile...............................................................................................................233
Soils..................................................................................................................234
Basic data......................................................................................................235
Assign...............................................................................................................236
Terrain...............................................................................................................237
Water................................................................................................................238
Surcharge..........................................................................................................239
Front face resistance...........................................................................................240
Applied forces.....................................................................................................241
Earthquake........................................................................................................242
Stage settings....................................................................................................243
Verification.........................................................................................................243
Bearing capacity.................................................................................................244
Dimensioning.....................................................................................................245
Stability.............................................................................................................246
Program Prefab Wall................................................................................................247
Project...............................................................................................................247
Settings.............................................................................................................248
Geometry..........................................................................................................248
Profile...............................................................................................................249
Soils..................................................................................................................250
Basic data......................................................................................................251
Assign...............................................................................................................252
Terrain...............................................................................................................253
Water................................................................................................................254
Surcharge..........................................................................................................255
Front face resistance...........................................................................................256
Applied forces.....................................................................................................257
Earthquake........................................................................................................258
Stage settings....................................................................................................259
-7-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Verification.........................................................................................................259
Bearing capacity.................................................................................................260
Dimensioning.....................................................................................................261
Internal sliding...................................................................................................262
Stability.............................................................................................................263
Program Gabion......................................................................................................264
Project...............................................................................................................264
Settings.............................................................................................................265
Material.............................................................................................................265
Geometry..........................................................................................................266
Profile...............................................................................................................267
Soils..................................................................................................................268
Basic data......................................................................................................269
Assign...............................................................................................................270
Terrain...............................................................................................................271
Water................................................................................................................272
Surcharge..........................................................................................................273
Front face resistance...........................................................................................274
Applied forces.....................................................................................................275
Earthquake........................................................................................................276
Stage settings....................................................................................................277
Verification.........................................................................................................277
Bearing capacity.................................................................................................278
Dimensioning.....................................................................................................279
Stability.............................................................................................................280
Program Spread Footing..........................................................................................281
Project...............................................................................................................281
Settings.............................................................................................................282
Profile...............................................................................................................282
Soils..................................................................................................................283
Basic data......................................................................................................284
Assign...............................................................................................................285
Foundation.........................................................................................................286
Load..................................................................................................................287
Import of loads...............................................................................................288
Geometry..........................................................................................................289
Sand-gravel cushion............................................................................................291
-8-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Material.............................................................................................................292
Surcharge..........................................................................................................293
Water, incompressible subsoil...............................................................................294
Stage settings....................................................................................................295
Bearing capacity.................................................................................................295
Settlement and rotation.......................................................................................296
Dimensioning.....................................................................................................297
Program Piles.........................................................................................................298
Project...............................................................................................................298
Settings.............................................................................................................299
Profile...............................................................................................................299
Modulus of subsoil reaction..................................................................................300
Soils..................................................................................................................301
Basic data......................................................................................................302
Assign...............................................................................................................303
Load..................................................................................................................304
Geometry..........................................................................................................305
Material.............................................................................................................306
Water, incompressible subsoil...............................................................................307
Negative skin friction...........................................................................................308
Stage settings....................................................................................................309
Vertical bearing capacity analytical solution.........................................................309
Vertical bearing capacity - Spring method..............................................................310
Settlement linear loading curve (Poulos).............................................................311
Settlement nonlinear loading curve (Masopust)....................................................312
Horizontal bearing capacity..................................................................................313
Program Settlement................................................................................................314
Project...............................................................................................................314
Settings.............................................................................................................315
Interface............................................................................................................315
Embankment......................................................................................................316
Earth cut...........................................................................................................317
Incompressible subsoil........................................................................................318
Soils..................................................................................................................319
Basic data......................................................................................................320
Assign...............................................................................................................321
Surcharge..........................................................................................................322
-9-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Water................................................................................................................323
Stage settings....................................................................................................324
Analysis.............................................................................................................325
Consolidation parameters.................................................................................326
Program Abutment..................................................................................................328
Project...............................................................................................................328
Settings.............................................................................................................329
Geometric section...............................................................................................330
Wings................................................................................................................331
Geometry plane view...........................................................................................332
Footing steps......................................................................................................333
Material.............................................................................................................334
Profile...............................................................................................................335
Soils..................................................................................................................336
Basic data......................................................................................................337
Load - LC...........................................................................................................338
Assign...............................................................................................................339
Terrain...............................................................................................................340
Water................................................................................................................341
Surcharge..........................................................................................................342
Front face resistance...........................................................................................343
Applied forces.....................................................................................................344
Earthquake........................................................................................................345
Stage settings....................................................................................................346
Verification.........................................................................................................347
Bearing capacity.................................................................................................348
Dimensioning.....................................................................................................349
Stability.............................................................................................................350
Program Nailed slopes.............................................................................................351
Project...............................................................................................................351
Settings.............................................................................................................352
Geometry..........................................................................................................352
Types of nails.....................................................................................................353
Geometry of nails...............................................................................................354
Material.............................................................................................................355
Profile...............................................................................................................356
Soils..................................................................................................................357
-10-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Basic data......................................................................................................358
Assign...............................................................................................................359
Terrain...............................................................................................................360
Water................................................................................................................361
Surcharge..........................................................................................................362
Earthquake........................................................................................................363
Stage settings....................................................................................................364
Internal stability.................................................................................................364
Verification.........................................................................................................365
Bearing capacity.................................................................................................366
Dimensioning.....................................................................................................367
External stability.................................................................................................368
Program Ground Loss..............................................................................................369
Project...............................................................................................................369
Settings.............................................................................................................370
Buildings............................................................................................................370
Profile...............................................................................................................371
Soils..................................................................................................................371
Assign...............................................................................................................372
Geometry..........................................................................................................373
Measurement.....................................................................................................374
Stage settings....................................................................................................375
Analysis.............................................................................................................376
Damages...........................................................................................................377
Program Rock Stability............................................................................................379
Project...............................................................................................................379
Settings.............................................................................................................379
Terrain...............................................................................................................380
Rock..................................................................................................................381
Slip surface plane.............................................................................................382
Slip surface - polygonal.......................................................................................383
Parameters polygonal slip surface......................................................................384
Water plane slip surface....................................................................................385
Surcharge plane and polygonal slip surface.........................................................386
Anchors plane and polygonal slip surface............................................................387
Earthquake........................................................................................................388
Stage settings....................................................................................................389
-11-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Analysis plane slip surface.................................................................................389
Analysis polygonal slip surface...........................................................................390
Geometry..........................................................................................................391
3D View.........................................................................................................392
Slip surface rock wedge....................................................................................393
Parameters rock wedge.....................................................................................394
Surcharge rock wedge......................................................................................395
Anchors rock wedge.........................................................................................396
Water rock wedge............................................................................................397
Analysis rock wedge.........................................................................................398
Program Terrain......................................................................................................399
Project...............................................................................................................399
Basic data..........................................................................................................400
Global coordinate system.................................................................................401
Soils..................................................................................................................401
Assign...............................................................................................................402
Points................................................................................................................403
Import of points..............................................................................................404
Automatic calculation of height.........................................................................405
Edges................................................................................................................407
Water................................................................................................................408
Bore holes.........................................................................................................409
Earth grading.....................................................................................................411
Generate...........................................................................................................413
Modeling terrain on edges................................................................................413
Point constructions..............................................................................................414
Line constructions...............................................................................................416
Launching..........................................................................................................417
Program Micropile...................................................................................................419
Project...............................................................................................................419
Settings.............................................................................................................419
Profile...............................................................................................................420
Soils..................................................................................................................421
Basic data......................................................................................................422
Geometry..........................................................................................................423
Material.............................................................................................................424
Assign...............................................................................................................425
-12-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Load..................................................................................................................426
Water................................................................................................................427
Standard penetration tests (SPT)..........................................................................428
Pressiometric tests..............................................................................................430
Verification of cross-section..................................................................................431
Root verification..................................................................................................432
Program FEM..........................................................................................................433
Topology............................................................................................................433
Coordinate systems.........................................................................................434
Project...........................................................................................................436
Settings.........................................................................................................436
Stability analysis.........................................................................................437
Plane strain analysis....................................................................................437
Axial symmetry...........................................................................................438
Tunnels......................................................................................................442
Advanced input...........................................................................................442
Ko procedure..............................................................................................444
Water flow.................................................................................................444
Flow analysis..........................................................................................445
Interface........................................................................................................446
Soils..............................................................................................................447
Materials models.........................................................................................448
Linear models.........................................................................................449
Elastic model......................................................................................450
Modified elastic model..........................................................................450
Nonlinear models....................................................................................451
Mohr-Coulomb (MC)............................................................................452
Mohr-Coulomb model with tension cut off...........................................453
Modified Mohr-Coulomb (MCM).............................................................453
Drucker-Prager...................................................................................454
Softening and hardening......................................................................454
Angle of dilation..................................................................................456
Influence of material model..................................................................456
Modified Cam-clay model (MCC)............................................................457
Generalized Cam clay model (GCC).......................................................460
Numerical implementation of MCC and GCC models.................................462
Hypoplastic clay..................................................................................464
-13-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Material models in flow analysis................................................................470
Coefficient of permeability........................................................................473
Basic data..................................................................................................475
Geostatic stress, uplift pressure....................................................................476
Rigid bodies...................................................................................................477
Assign...........................................................................................................478
Contact types.................................................................................................479
Contact elements........................................................................................481
Lining............................................................................................................482
Module Lining - FEM....................................................................................484
Free points.............................................................................................484
Free lines...............................................................................................485
Line refinement.......................................................................................486
Settings.................................................................................................487
Generator of shape of lining.........................................................................488
Generator of anchored regions......................................................................490
Stages of construction.................................................................................491
Free points.....................................................................................................492
Free lines.......................................................................................................494
Point refinement.............................................................................................495
Line refinement..............................................................................................497
Mesh generation.............................................................................................498
Mesh generator warning...............................................................................500
Adjusting original geometry..........................................................................502
Standard boundary conditions......................................................................502
Construction stages.............................................................................................503
Activity..........................................................................................................504
Activity of regions below GWT......................................................................506
Assign...........................................................................................................507
Lining............................................................................................................507
Beams.......................................................................................................508
Anchors.....................................................................................................509
Beam loads................................................................................................510
Generator of anchors on free line..................................................................511
Beams...........................................................................................................512
Types of cross-section.................................................................................514
Beam end-points connection.........................................................................515
-14-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Degradation and strengthening of beams.......................................................516
Catalog of profiles.......................................................................................517
Cross-section editor....................................................................................518
Catalog of materials....................................................................................518
Editor of materials.......................................................................................519
Contacts........................................................................................................520
Contacts and beams (water flow)......................................................................521
Point supports................................................................................................523
Point flow.......................................................................................................524
Line Supports.................................................................................................525
Line flow........................................................................................................526
Anchors.........................................................................................................527
Anchor end points.......................................................................................529
Anchors in the stability analysis....................................................................530
Props.............................................................................................................531
Reinforcements...............................................................................................533
Anchoring geo-reinforcements......................................................................535
Axial stiffness of geosynthetics.....................................................................537
Surcharge......................................................................................................538
Beam loads....................................................................................................540
Water............................................................................................................541
Analysis.........................................................................................................542
Transient flow analysis.................................................................................543
Recommended modeling procedure...............................................................548
Loss of convergence of nonlinear analysis......................................................549
Setting and analysis description....................................................................550
Solution method.....................................................................................551
Change of stiffness matrix........................................................................551
Initial solution step..................................................................................552
Maximum number of iterations.................................................................553
Convergence criterion..............................................................................553
Setting Newton-Raphson method..............................................................553
Setting Arc-length method.......................................................................554
Setting arc length...............................................................................555
Automatic arc length control.................................................................556
Line search method.................................................................................557
Plasticity................................................................................................558
-15-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Course of analysis.......................................................................................559
Results......................................................................................................560
Tool bar Results....................................................................................560
Results visualization settings....................................................................561
List of variables......................................................................................562
Monitors........................................................................................................564
Monitors settings........................................................................................565
Graphs..........................................................................................................566
Stability.........................................................................................................567
Setting basic parameters of slope stability analysis.........................................568
Setting driving parameters of relaxation of reduction factor..............................569
Program Pile CPT....................................................................................................570
Project...............................................................................................................570
Settings.............................................................................................................571
Profile...............................................................................................................571
Soils..................................................................................................................572
Basic data......................................................................................................573
Construction.......................................................................................................574
Group of piles.................................................................................................576
Geometry..........................................................................................................577
GWT + NSF........................................................................................................578
CPTs..................................................................................................................580
Import CPT....................................................................................................581
Assign...............................................................................................................582
Bearing capacity.................................................................................................583
Settlement.........................................................................................................584
Program Beam.......................................................................................................586
Project...............................................................................................................586
Settings.............................................................................................................586
Winkler-Pasternak parameters C1 a C2..............................................................587
Calculation of Winkler-Pasternak parameters C1 and C2 from geological profile......587
Calculation of Winkler-Pasternak constants from deformation parameters of soils. . .588
Geometry..........................................................................................................588
Subsoil..............................................................................................................589
Interface............................................................................................................590
Location.............................................................................................................591
Soils..................................................................................................................592
-16-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Basic data......................................................................................................593
Assign...............................................................................................................594
Water................................................................................................................595
Supports............................................................................................................596
Load cases.........................................................................................................597
Load case parameters......................................................................................598
Load..................................................................................................................600
Combination of ULS.............................................................................................601
Parameters of combinations of ULS...................................................................602
Generator of combinations...............................................................................603
Combinations SLS...............................................................................................606
Parameters of combinations of SLS...................................................................607
Generator of combinations...............................................................................608
Analysis.............................................................................................................608
Program Plate.........................................................................................................609
Project...............................................................................................................609
Settings.............................................................................................................610
Joints................................................................................................................610
Lines.................................................................................................................611
Macroelements...................................................................................................612
Openings...........................................................................................................614
Joint refinements................................................................................................615
Line refinements.................................................................................................616
Macroelement refinements...................................................................................618
Mesh generation.................................................................................................619
Mesh generator warning..................................................................................622
Joint supports.....................................................................................................623
Line supports.....................................................................................................624
Beams...............................................................................................................626
Catalog of materials........................................................................................627
Editor of materials..........................................................................................629
Types of cross-section.....................................................................................630
Catalog of profiles...........................................................................................631
Cross-section editor........................................................................................632
Internal hinges...................................................................................................633
Macroelement subsoils.........................................................................................635
Winkler-Pasternak parameters C1 a C2..............................................................636
-17-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Calculation of Winkler-Pasternak constants from deformation parameters of soils. . .637
Load cases.........................................................................................................637
Load case parameters......................................................................................639
Joint loads.........................................................................................................640
Line loads..........................................................................................................641
Temperature load............................................................................................643
Macroelement loads............................................................................................643
Free point loads..................................................................................................644
Free line loads....................................................................................................645
Free area loads...................................................................................................646
Combination ULS................................................................................................648
Parameters of combinations of ULS...................................................................649
Generator of combinations of ULS.....................................................................650
Combination SLS................................................................................................653
Parameters of combinations of SLS...................................................................654
Generator of combinations of SLS.....................................................................654
Dimensioning parameters....................................................................................655
Macroelement dimensionings................................................................................655
Analysis.............................................................................................................656
Procedure of analysis.......................................................................................657
Results..........................................................................................................658
Tool bar Results.......................................................................................659
Results visualization settings........................................................................660
List of variables..........................................................................................660
List of variables of dimensioning...................................................................661
Values...............................................................................................................662
Distributions.......................................................................................................663
Coordinate system (sign convention).....................................................................664
Program MSE Wall...................................................................................................666
Project...............................................................................................................666
Settings.............................................................................................................667
Geometry..........................................................................................................668
Material.............................................................................................................669
Types of reinforcements.......................................................................................670
Adding and editing type of reinforcement...........................................................671
User's catalogue.............................................................................................672
Reinforcement....................................................................................................673
-18-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Reinforcement....................................................................................................675
Profile...............................................................................................................676
Soils..................................................................................................................677
Basic data......................................................................................................678
Assign...............................................................................................................679
Terrain...............................................................................................................680
Water................................................................................................................681
Water................................................................................................................682
Surcharge..........................................................................................................683
Front face resistance...........................................................................................684
Applied forces.....................................................................................................685
Earthquake........................................................................................................686
Stage settings....................................................................................................687
Verification.........................................................................................................688
Dimensioning.....................................................................................................689
Bearing capacity.................................................................................................690
Slip on georeinforcement.....................................................................................691
Internal stability.................................................................................................692
Global stability....................................................................................................693
Stability.............................................................................................................694
Program Pile Group.................................................................................................695
Project...............................................................................................................695
Settings.............................................................................................................696
Structure...........................................................................................................697
Geometry..........................................................................................................697
Material.............................................................................................................698
Load..................................................................................................................699
Load acting on a pile group..............................................................................700
Profile...............................................................................................................702
Soils..................................................................................................................702
Basic data......................................................................................................703
Assign...............................................................................................................704
Water................................................................................................................705
Negative skin friction...........................................................................................706
Vertical springs...................................................................................................707
Horizontal modulus.............................................................................................708
Stage settings....................................................................................................709
-19-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Vertical bearing capacity analytical solution.........................................................709
Settlement cohesive soil...................................................................................710
Settlement cohesionless soil (loading curve)........................................................711
Analysis spring method.....................................................................................712
Dimensioning.....................................................................................................713
Outputs.....................................................................................................................714
Adding picture........................................................................................................714
List of pictures........................................................................................................715
Print and export document.......................................................................................716
Print and export picture...........................................................................................717
Control menu Print and export..................................................................................718
Tool bar Print and export.........................................................................................719
Setting header and footer........................................................................................720
Page properties......................................................................................................722
Page numbering.....................................................................................................722
About company......................................................................................................723
Theory......................................................................................................................724
Stress in a soil body................................................................................................725
Geostatic stress, uplift pressure............................................................................725
Effective/total stress in soil..................................................................................726
Increment of earth pressure due to surcharge........................................................727
Increment of earth pressure under footing.............................................................728
Earth pressure........................................................................................................729
Sign convention..................................................................................................730
Active earth pressure..........................................................................................730
Active earth pressure the Mazindrani theory....................................................731
Active earth pressure - the Coulomb theory.......................................................732
Active earth pressure - the Mller-Breslau theory................................................733
Active earth pressure - the Caquot theory..........................................................734
Active earth pressure - the Absi theory..............................................................735
Active earth pressure total stress...................................................................736
Passive earth pressure.........................................................................................737
Passive earth pressure - the Rankin and Mazindrani theory..................................737
Passive earth pressure - the Coulomb theory......................................................738
Passive earth pressure - the Caquot Krisel theory...........................................739
Coefficient of passive earth pressure Kp.........................................................739
Reduction coefficient of passive earth pressure...............................................742
-20-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Passive earth pressure - the Mller Breslau theory...........................................743
Passive earth pressure - the Absi theory............................................................744
Passive earth pressure - the Sokolovski theory...................................................744
Passive earth pressure total stress.................................................................747
Earth pressure at rest..........................................................................................747
Earth pressure at rest for inclined ground surface at the back of structure.............748
Alternate angle of internal friction of soil................................................................749
Distribution of earth pressures in case of broken terrain..........................................750
Influence of water...............................................................................................751
Without ground water, water is not considered....................................................751
Hydrostatic pressure, ground water behind structure...........................................752
Hydrostatic pressure, ground water behind and in front of structure......................753
Hydrodynamic pressure...................................................................................753
Special distribution of water pressure................................................................755
Uplift pressure in footing bottom.......................................................................756
Influence of tensile cracks................................................................................756
Minimum dimensioning pressure...........................................................................756
Earth - pressure wedge.......................................................................................757
Surcharge..........................................................................................................759
Surface surcharge...........................................................................................759
Strip surcharge...............................................................................................760
Trapezoidal surcharge......................................................................................761
Concentrated surcharge...................................................................................761
Line surcharge................................................................................................762
Surcharge in non-homogeneous soil..................................................................764
Surface surcharge...........................................................................................764
Strip surcharge...............................................................................................765
Trapezoidal surcharge......................................................................................766
Concentrated surcharge...................................................................................766
Surface surcharge...........................................................................................766
Influence of earthquake.......................................................................................767
MononobeOkabe theory.................................................................................769
Arrango theory...............................................................................................770
Influence of water...........................................................................................771
EN 1998-5 Seismic effects...............................................................................773
Forces from earth pressure at rest acting on the rigid structure............................774
Influence of friction between soil and back of structure............................................774
-21-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Table of ultimate friction factors for dissimilar materials.......................................775
Adhesion of soil..............................................................................................776
Parameters of rocks............................................................................................777
Nailed slopes..........................................................................................................778
Analysis of internal stability..................................................................................778
Analysis of nails bearing capacity......................................................................779
Estimated bond strength..............................................................................781
Total bearing capacity of nail............................................................................783
Verification factor of safety............................................................................783
Verification theory of limit states....................................................................784
Nail force.......................................................................................................784
Dimensioning of concrete cover............................................................................785
MSE Wall...............................................................................................................786
Internal stability.................................................................................................787
Verification factor of safety............................................................................788
Verification limit states..................................................................................789
Shapes of slip surfaces....................................................................................789
Extensible reinforcements - active earth pressure...............................................790
Inextensible reinforcements - combination of earth pressures...............................791
Wall analysis..........................................................................................................792
Evaluation of forces in the footing bottom..............................................................793
Verification limit states.....................................................................................793
Verification - safety factor....................................................................................794
Internal sliding...................................................................................................795
Reinforcements...................................................................................................796
Base anchorage..................................................................................................797
Accounting for wall jump......................................................................................799
Dimensioning of masonry wall according to AS 3700...............................................800
Dimensioning of masonry wall according to EN 1996-1-1.........................................801
Bearing capacity of foundation soil........................................................................802
Wall dimensioning...............................................................................................803
Internal stability of gabion...................................................................................804
Internal stability of gabion wall factor of safety................................................806
Internal stability of gabion wall limit states......................................................808
Calculating abutment forces.................................................................................809
Reduced passive earth pressure............................................................................810
Sheeting design......................................................................................................811
-22-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Analysis of sheet pile wall....................................................................................811
Analysis of anchored wall fixed in heel...................................................................811
Analysis of anchored wall simply supported at heel.................................................813
Sheeting check.......................................................................................................814
Method of dependent pressures............................................................................815
Modulus of subsoil reaction..................................................................................817
Modulus of subsoil reaction according to CUR 166...............................................817
Modulus of subsoil reaction according to Schmitt................................................818
Modulus of subsoil reaction according to Mnard.................................................819
Modulus of subsoil reaction according to Chadeisson...........................................819
Modulus of subsoil reaction derived from iterations.............................................820
Internal stability of anchors..................................................................................822
Braced sheeting..................................................................................................823
Nonlinear modulus of subsoil reaction....................................................................824
Failure by heave.................................................................................................825
Slope stability........................................................................................................827
Soil body...........................................................................................................827
Influence of water...............................................................................................827
Surcharge..........................................................................................................830
Anchors.............................................................................................................830
Reinforcements...................................................................................................831
End of reinforcements.....................................................................................832
Earthquake effect................................................................................................834
Verification according to EN 1997..........................................................................835
Analysis according to the theory of limit states / factor of safety...............................836
Polygonal slip surface..........................................................................................836
Sarma...........................................................................................................838
Spencer.........................................................................................................840
Janbu............................................................................................................843
Morgenstern-Price...........................................................................................846
Shahunyants..................................................................................................849
ITF Method (Imbalance Thrust Force Method).....................................................852
Optimization of polygonal slip surface................................................................855
Changing inclination of dividing planes..............................................................856
Circular slip surface.............................................................................................856
Fellenius / Petterson........................................................................................858
Bishop...........................................................................................................858
-23-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Spencer.........................................................................................................858
Janbu............................................................................................................859
Morgenstern-Price...........................................................................................859
Shahunyants..................................................................................................859
ITF Method (Imbalance Thrust Force Method).....................................................859
Optimization of circular slip surface...................................................................859
Foliation............................................................................................................860
Influence of tensile cracks....................................................................................860
Analysis of bearing capacity of foundation..................................................................860
Bearing capacity on drained subsoil.......................................................................861
Standard analysis...........................................................................................861
Bearing capacity on undrained subsoil...................................................................863
Standard analysis...........................................................................................864
Bearing capacity of foundation on bedrock.............................................................864
Standard analysis...........................................................................................864
Solution according to CSN 73 1001...................................................................865
Analysis according to EC 7-1 (EN 1997-1:2003)..................................................865
Parameters to compute foundation bearing capacity............................................866
Horizontal bearing capacity of foundation...............................................................869
Homogenization of layered subsoil........................................................................870
Effective area.....................................................................................................872
Determination of cross-sectional internal forces......................................................873
Analysis of uplift.................................................................................................874
Standard approach..........................................................................................874
Cone method..................................................................................................875
DL/T 5219 - 2005...........................................................................................877
Pile analysis...........................................................................................................878
Vertical bearing capacity......................................................................................878
Analytical solution...........................................................................................878
NAVFAC DM 7.2..........................................................................................879
Pile base resistance.................................................................................879
Pile shaft resistance.................................................................................879
Bearing capacity factor Nq.......................................................................880
Coefficient of lateral earth pressure K........................................................880
Friction angle on pile skin.........................................................................881
Adhesion coefficient.................................................................................882
Critical depth..........................................................................................882
-24-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Tomlinson..................................................................................................883
Adhesion coefficient.................................................................................884
Effective length.......................................................................................884
Effective stress method................................................................................885
Coefficients of pile bearing capacity...........................................................885
CSN 73 1002..............................................................................................886
Verification.................................................................................................887
Verification according to the theory of limit states.......................................887
Design coefficients..............................................................................888
Verification according to factors of safety...................................................888
Vertical bearing capacity - Spring method..........................................................889
Limit loading curve......................................................................................889
Shear strength of skin.................................................................................890
Coefficient of increase of limit skin friction......................................................891
Depth of deformation zone...........................................................................891
Incompressible subsoil.................................................................................893
Negative skin friction...................................................................................893
Influence of technology................................................................................894
Shear resistance on skin..............................................................................894
Stiffness of subsoil below the pile heel...........................................................896
Distributions of forces acting on pile..............................................................896
Dependence of shear on deformation.............................................................896
Pile settlement...................................................................................................896
Nonlinear theory (Masopust)............................................................................896
Approach according to Masopust...................................................................897
Regression coefficients.................................................................................899
Coefficients m1, m2....................................................................................900
Secant deformation modulus Es....................................................................900
Settlement coefficient Is..............................................................................901
Linear theory (Poulos).....................................................................................901
Piles resting on stiff subsoil..........................................................................902
Piles floating in compressible subsoil.............................................................903
Corrective factor for Poissons number Rv......................................................904
Corrective factor for stiffness soil layer Rb......................................................904
Tip load proportion for incompressible pile BETAo............................................905
Corrective coefficient for pile compressibility Ck..............................................906
Corrective coefficient for influence of Poissons number of soil Cv.....................907
-25-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Corrective coefficient for stiffness soil stratum Cb...........................................907
Pile stiffness factor K...................................................................................908
Basic settlement influence coefficient Io.............................................................909
Corrective factor for pile compressibility Rk........................................................909
Corrective factor for finite depth of layer on a rigid base Rh.................................910
Horizontal bearing capacity..................................................................................911
Constant distribution of modulus of subsoil reaction............................................911
Linear modulus of subsoil reaction....................................................................912
Modulus of subsoil reaction according to CSN 73 1004.........................................913
Modulus of subsoil reaction after Matlock and Rees.............................................913
Modulus of subsoil reaction after Vesic...............................................................914
Pile Group..............................................................................................................914
Analytical solution...............................................................................................914
Cohesionless soil (analysis for drained conditions)...............................................915
Efficiency of a pile group..............................................................................915
Cohesive soil (analysis for undrained conditions).................................................916
Analysis according to factor of safety.................................................................916
Analysis according to the theory of limit states...................................................917
Pile group settlement......................................................................................917
Spring method....................................................................................................919
Calculation of stiffnesses of vertical springs........................................................920
Settlement analysis.................................................................................................920
Stress in the footing bottom.................................................................................921
Overall settlement and rotation of foundation.........................................................922
Influence of foundation depth and incompressible subsoil........................................923
Influence of sand-gravel cushion...........................................................................924
Analysis using the oedometric modulus..................................................................925
Analysis using the compression constant...............................................................926
Analysis using the compression index....................................................................926
Analysis according to NEN (Buismann, Ladd)..........................................................926
Analysis using the Soft soil model.........................................................................928
Analysis according to the Janbu theory..................................................................929
Analysis for cohesionless soils after Janbu..........................................................929
Analysis for coarse-grained soils after Janbu.......................................................929
Analysis for sands and silts after Janbu..............................................................930
Analysis for overconsolidated sands and silts after Janbu.....................................930
Analysis for cohesive soils after Janbu...............................................................931
-26-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Analysis for overconsolidated cohesive soils after Janbu.......................................931
Settlement analysis using DMT (constrained modulus).............................................932
Theory of settlement...........................................................................................932
Primary settlement..........................................................................................934
Secondary settlement......................................................................................936
Consolidation analysis.....................................................................................937
Determination of the depth of influence zone..........................................................939
Theory of structural strength............................................................................939
Method of restriction of the magnitude of primary stress......................................940
Characteristics of settlement analyses...................................................................941
Compression index..........................................................................................941
Oedometric modulus.......................................................................................944
Compression constant.....................................................................................945
Compression constant 10.................................................................................946
Void ratio.......................................................................................................947
Recompression index.......................................................................................947
Janbu characteristics.......................................................................................948
Influence of loading history..............................................................................949
Coefficient m..................................................................................................950
Modified compression index..............................................................................950
Index of secondary compression.......................................................................951
Overconsolidation index of secondary compression..............................................952
Analyses in program Ground Loss.............................................................................953
Analysis of subsidence trough...............................................................................953
Volume loss....................................................................................................953
Recommended values of parameters for volume loss analysis...........................954
Classical theory..............................................................................................956
Analysis for layered subsoil..........................................................................957
Shape of subsidence trough.............................................................................959
Coefficient of calculation of inflection point.....................................................959
Subsidence trough with several excavations.......................................................960
Analysis of subsidence trough at a depth...........................................................960
Calculation of other variables............................................................................961
Analysis of failure of buildings..............................................................................961
Tensile cracks.................................................................................................962
Gradient damage............................................................................................962
Relative deflection...........................................................................................963
-27-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Failure of a section of building..........................................................................964
Rock slope.............................................................................................................964
Plane slip surface................................................................................................965
Stepped slip surface........................................................................................966
Tensile strength of rock................................................................................967
Undulating slip surface....................................................................................968
Anchorage of rock slope...................................................................................968
Surcharge of rock slope...................................................................................969
Influence of water acting on slip surface............................................................969
GWT above toe of slope...............................................................................970
GWT on tension crack..................................................................................971
GWT on tension crack, max..........................................................................972
Water acting on tension crack only................................................................974
Own water force acting on slip surface only....................................................974
Own water force behavior............................................................................975
Polygonal slip surface..........................................................................................975
Geometry of rock block....................................................................................976
Anchor forces, surcharge.................................................................................977
Influence of water...........................................................................................977
Solution procedure..........................................................................................978
Rock wedge........................................................................................................980
Geometry of rock wedge..................................................................................980
Stereographic projection..............................................................................981
Influence of ground water................................................................................981
Resolution of acting forces...............................................................................983
Verification.........................................................................................................984
Verification according to the factor of safety.......................................................984
Verification according to the theory of limit states...............................................984
Rock - shear resistance criteria.............................................................................985
Mohr - Coulomb..............................................................................................985
Parameters Mohr Coulomb.........................................................................985
Hoek - Brown.................................................................................................986
Parameters Hoek Brown............................................................................987
Calculation of Hoek-Brown parameters..........................................................990
Barton - Bandis..............................................................................................992
Barton Bandis parameters.........................................................................992
Bulk weight of rocks............................................................................................995
-28-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Influence of seismic effects..................................................................................996
Micropile................................................................................................................997
Verification based on factor of safety.....................................................................998
Verification based on limit states...........................................................................998
Verification of the micropile tube...........................................................................999
Coupled section bearing capacity.....................................................................1000
Micropile life time......................................................................................1000
Coefficient Fut.......................................................................................1000
Coefficient of influence of corrosion.........................................................1001
Bearing capacity of cross-section loaded by normal force...............................1001
Bearing capacity of cross-section loaded by combination of bending moment and
normal force.............................................................................................1002
Influence of buckling.................................................................................1003
Internal stability of section.............................................................................1004
Geometric method (Euler)..........................................................................1005
Salas theory.............................................................................................1007
Constant A reflecting the type of support in the micropile head...................1007
Coefficient f..........................................................................................1008
Vas-Souche theory..................................................................................1008
Modulus of horizontal reaction of subsoil..................................................1009
Calculation of the modulus of horizontal reaction of subsoil Er.................1009
Values of the modulus of subsoil reaction Ep.............................................1010
Bearing capacity of the micropile root section.......................................................1011
Lizzi theory...................................................................................................1012
Skin friction of the micropile root................................................................1012
Littlejohn theory...........................................................................................1014
Zweck theory................................................................................................1014
Bowles theory...............................................................................................1015
Vas theory..................................................................................................1015
Coefficients of type of application of micropile...............................................1017
Bearing capacity of the root in rock.................................................................1017
Skin friction and bearing capacity of the micropile root in rock........................1017
Bustamante (SPT, Pressiometer Mnard)..........................................................1018
Skin friction of the micropile root - graphs....................................................1018
Analyses in program Pile CPT..................................................................................1020
Bearing capacity...............................................................................................1021
EN 1997-2....................................................................................................1022
NEN 6743.....................................................................................................1022
-29-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
LCPC (Bustamante).......................................................................................1023
Determination of equivalent average cone tip resistance................................1023
Schmertmann...............................................................................................1024
Determination of average cone tip resistance................................................1025
Correlation coefficient K.............................................................................1026
Negative skin friction.....................................................................................1027
Shaft friction coefficient ALFA s.......................................................................1028
Influence of overconsolidation (OCR)...............................................................1030
Pile shape coefficient s...................................................................................1031
Expanded pile toe coefficient BETA..................................................................1031
Pile toe coefficient ALFA p...............................................................................1032
Pile group.....................................................................................................1033
Calculation of pile toe settlement l.......................................................................1034
Graphs to calculate settlement........................................................................1034
Calculation of limit load curve.........................................................................1035
Verification.......................................................................................................1036
Verification according to EN 1997-2.................................................................1036
Correlation coefficients for evaluating standard values of bearing capacity........1038
Verification according to factor of safety...........................................................1038
Verification according to limit states................................................................1039
Field testing.........................................................................................................1039
Cone penetration tests (CPT)..............................................................................1039
Standard penetration tests (SPT)........................................................................1040
Pressiometric tests............................................................................................1042
Dimensioning of concrete structures........................................................................1043
EN 1992-1-1 (EC2) or EN 1992-2........................................................................1043
Materials, coefficients, notation.......................................................................1044
Standard values of coefficients........................................................................1045
Verification of rectangular cross-section made from plain concrete......................1046
Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under M, V......................................1047
Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under N, M, V..................................1048
Verification of circular RC cross-section............................................................1049
Verification of spread footing for punching shear...............................................1050
Design of longitudinal reinforcement for plates..................................................1051
Design of shear reinforcement for plates..........................................................1052
CSN 73 1201 R.................................................................................................1053
Materials, coefficients, notation.......................................................................1053
-30-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Verification of rectangular cross-section made from plain concrete......................1054
Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under M, V......................................1055
Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under N, M, V..................................1056
Verification of circular RC cross-section............................................................1057
Verification of spread footing for punching shear...............................................1057
Design of longitudinal reinforcement for plates..................................................1058
Design of shear reinforcement for plates..........................................................1059
CSN 73 6206....................................................................................................1060
PN-B-03264:2002.............................................................................................1061
Materials, coefficients, notation.......................................................................1061
Verification of rectangular cross-section made from plain concrete......................1062
Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under M, V......................................1063
Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under N, M, V..................................1064
Verification of circular RC cross-section............................................................1065
Verification of spread footing for punching shear...............................................1066
Design of longitudinal reinforcement for plates..................................................1067
Design of shear reinforcement for plates..........................................................1068
BS 8110:1997..................................................................................................1068
Materials, coefficients, notation.......................................................................1069
Verification of rectangular cross-sections made from plain concrete.....................1069
Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under M, V......................................1069
Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under N, M, V..................................1071
Verification of circular RC cross-section............................................................1072
Verification of spread footing for punching shear...............................................1072
Design of longitudinal reinforcement for plates..................................................1074
Design of shear reinforcement for plates..........................................................1074
IS 456.............................................................................................................1075
Materials, coefficients, notation.......................................................................1075
Verification of rectangular cross-sections made from plain concrete.....................1076
Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under M, V......................................1077
Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under N, M, V..................................1078
Verification of circular RC cross-section............................................................1079
Verification of spread footing for punching shear...............................................1079
Design of longitudinal reinforcement for plates..................................................1081
Design of shear reinforcement for plates..........................................................1081
IS Road Bridges................................................................................................1082
ACI 318-11......................................................................................................1082
-31-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Materials, coefficients, notation.......................................................................1082
Verification of rectangular cross-section made from plain concrete......................1083
Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under M, V......................................1083
Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under N, M, V..................................1085
Verification of circular RC cross-section............................................................1085
Verification of spread footing for punching shear...............................................1086
Design of longitudinal reinforcement for plates..................................................1087
Design of shear reinforcement for plates..........................................................1088
AS 3600-2001..................................................................................................1088
Materials, coefficients, notation.......................................................................1089
Verification of rectangular cross-sections made from plain concrete ....................1089
Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under M, V......................................1090
Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under N, M, V..................................1091
Verification of circular RC cross-section............................................................1091
Verification of spread footing for punching shear...............................................1092
Design of longitudinal reinforcement for plates..................................................1093
Design of shear reinforcement for plates..........................................................1094
SNiP 52-101-2003.............................................................................................1095
Materials, coefficients, notation.......................................................................1095
Verification of rectangular cross-sections made from plain concrete ....................1096
Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under M, V......................................1096
Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under N, M, V..................................1097
Verification of circular RC cross-section............................................................1098
Verification of spread footing for punching shear...............................................1098
Design of longitudinal reinforcement for plates..................................................1099
Design of shear reinforcement for plates..........................................................1100
GB 50010-2010................................................................................................1100
Materials, coefficients, notation.......................................................................1101
Verification of rectangular cross-sections made from plain concrete.....................1101
Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under M, V......................................1102
Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under N, M, V..................................1103
Verification of circular RC cross-section............................................................1104
Verification of spread footing for punching shear...............................................1104
Design of longitudinal reinforcement for plates..................................................1105
Design of shear reinforcement for plates..........................................................1106
NZS 3101-2006................................................................................................1107
Materials, coefficients, notation.......................................................................1107
-32-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Verification of rectangular cross-sections made from plain concrete.....................1108
Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under M, V......................................1109
Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under N, M, V..................................1110
Verification of circular RC cross-section............................................................1111
Verification of spread footing for punching shear...............................................1112
Design of longitudinal reinforcement for plates..................................................1113
Design of shear reinforcement for plates..........................................................1114
-33-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Using help
The text hint of all our programs is displayed in standard Windows EXPLORER viewer. The help
dialog window can be launched either through the program menu (items "Help", "Content")
or using the Fn button "F1" anywhere in the program.
Some dialog windows (e.g., "Add soil") allow for opening the corresponding chapter of the
help by pressing the help button " ".
The dialog window contains:
- Bar with basic tool buttons. The "Hide (Show)" button hides (shows) tree with a list help
topics. The ("Back/Forward") buttons allow for listing pages, which have been already
displayed. The "Print" button opens the printing dialog window and the "Options" buttons
opens the menu to set the EXPLORER window properties.
- Bar containing the tab sheet "Contents" (shows tree with individual topics), tab sheets
"Inde" and "Search".
- "!ree" with a list hint topics individual items in the tree are opened/closed by clicking
the symbols "+"/"-" in front of the name.
- Window for displaying the help itself the window header contains currently shown items
and the "Back/Forward" buttons that function in the same way as the already described
buttons on the tool bar.
The text of each help may contain further cross references to other items. The text of these
references is colored in green.
Dialog window "Help" - tab sheet "Contents"
-34-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Using "unction Search
Function "Search" allows for finding an arbitrary text in the subject help. The searched text is
written into the field "Input searched tet" and button "#ist o" topics" launches the search.
The list of found topics containing the searched text is displayed in the column under the
buttons. Clicking on the topic title and then clicking on the "$ispla%" button displays the
corresponding topic in the right part of the window (the double-clicking option is also
available).
The searched text is highlighted in blue. Switching back to the "Contents" tab sheet shows
the topic location in the tree (help content).
Frame "Help" - tab sheet "Search"
User de"ined en&iron'ent
The programs are standard windows applications. Managing the application environment
(application window, dialog windows, control menu, tables, frames, tool bars, and copy to
clipboard) applies to standard properties of the Windows environment. The programs support
operating systems WIN 98, WIN 2000, WIN NT and WIN XP.
The minimum hardware and software configuration corresponding to class of PC PENTIUM III
with 128 MB of operating memory and minimum resolution of graphic adapter and monitor of
1024x768 pixels with 256 bit color range is required. Recommended configuration corresponds
to a class of PC computers of Pentium 4, 512 MB of operating memory.
-35-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
(indow "or application
The program is launched in standard dialog window containing all managing tools typical for
the Windows environment (minimizing, maximizing and closing the application window.). The
window header displays information on currently executed task (file name and location) see
figure:
Managing tools of window for application
The desktop constitutes the window of application. It includes the control menu, horizontal tool
bars, space for graphic visualization of the executed task and vertical tool bars to select
individual inputting modes to specify the task. The bottom part of the desktop displays frames
that allows the user to introduce various input parameters into the task. Location of the
individual elements on the desktop is evident from the following figure:
Managing tools of window for application
Control 'enu
Selecting an item from the menu is performed by clicking the le"t 'ouse )utton, or
alternatively using the keyboard by pressing A#! * underlined letter in the selected menu
item.
-36-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
As typical for the WINDOWS environment, some of the options in the menu can be replaced
with the buttons on individual tool bars, or with abbreviated commands entered through the
keyboard (providing it exists it is displayed next to the command in the menu e.g., Sa&e "ile
+ C!,#*S).
Some of the options in the program can be set only with the help of the menu e.g., program
"Options".
Control menu of program
Hori-ontal tool )ars
The program contains the following tool bars:
- Tool bar "Files"
- Tool bar "Scale and shift"
- Tool bar "Plot setting"
- Tool bar "Stage of construction"
- Tool bar "3D visualization"
- Tool bar "Selections"
-37-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
!ool )ar Files
The tool bar contains the following buttons:
Tool bar "Files"
Individual buttons function as follows:

.ew "ile - opens a new file if there is an existing task opened
in the same window, the program prompts the user
to save the unsaved data

Open "ile - opens an existing file - if there is an existing task
opened in the same window, the program prompts
the user to save the unsaved data

Sa&e data into "ile - saves data of currently opened task if no name is
assigned to the task, the program opens the "Sa&e
as" dialog window

Undo - returns the last performed step (the function is
available only in programs with 2D environment and
must be allowed in dialog window "Options")

,edo - restores one returned step (the function is available
only in programs with 2D environment and must be
allowed in dialog window "Options")

Print and export document - opens the dialog window to create, edit and print
output documents

Print and export picture - opens the dialog window to create, edit and print the
current drawing displayed on the desktop

Cop% - copies the current picture displayed on the desktop
or the inputted soil profile into clipboard

Insert - inserts the soil profile stored in the clipboard (this
option allows the user to copy the soil profile created
in a different program e.g., from program
"Pressures" to program "Gra&it% wall"
!ool )ar Scale and shi"t
The tool bar buttons serve to manage all plots displayed on the desktop (zoom in/out,
move.). The following figure shows locations of individual buttons:
Tool bar "Scale and shift"

Scale up - scales up desktop view while keeping location of the point
under the axis cross unchanged this action is repeated
using the left mouse button, the right button leaves the
zooming mode

Scale down - scales down the desktop view while keeping location of
the point under the axis cross unchanged this action is
-38-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
repeated using the left mouse button, the right mouse
button leaves the zooming mode

Shows 'arked region - shows and scales up the marked region - the region is
selected using the left mouse button

/o&e displa%ed region - moves the current view in an arbitrary direction to
proceed move mouse in the desired location while keeping
the left mouse button pressed

Scale up - scales up the displayed region while keeping the region
centered

Scale down - scales down the displayed region while keeping the region
centered

/odi"% scale - scales the view such that all objects are visible

Use pre&ious scale - modifies view scale - returns the original view scale prior
to the last applied scale action
!ool )ar Plot setting
The button on a tool bar serves to set the visualization style settings on the desktop (colors,
thickness and style of lines, background.).
Toll bar "Plot setting"

Plot setting - The button opens the "Visualization style settings" dialog
window that allows for setting all parameters of the picture
displayed on the desktop.

Selection o"
inter"aces in
act0 stage to
)e
displa%ed
- The button opens the "Selection o" inter"aces in act0 stage
to )e displa%ed" dialog window that allows for setting which
interfaces should be displayed on the desktop.
!ool )ar Stage o" construction
Tool bar buttons serve to work with stages of construction. The following picture shows the
location of individual buttons:
Tool bar "Stage of construction"

Adds construction stage - adds new stage of construction at the end of list

,e'o&es construction
stage
- removes the last stage of construction from the
list

Construction stage 112 000 - switches between individual stages of construction
selection is performed using the left mouse
-39-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
button
In all our programs this bar allows for defining stages of construction. Construction stages
serve to model gradual building of a construction (essential "or progra's Sheeting check1
Settle'ent1 F3/). This function can be also used for parametric studies and in each stage of
construction assume different soil assignment or different design coefficients. It is rather
advantageous to model earthquake effects on a structure in a separate stage of construction
as it is then possible to assume different factors of safety or different design coefficients.
For individual types of input (soil assignment, anchors, supports.) there always exists
relationship over construction stages (Heredity).
!ool )ar 4$ &isuali-ation
The following buttons are available in the tool bar:
Tool bar "3D isuali!ation"
Individual buttons have the following functions:

#ighting direction - Opens the dialog window, which allows us to set the
lighting direction

Aono'etric &iew - Sets the axonometric view of drawing

Perspecti&e &iew - Sets the perspective view of drawing

4$ &iew - Sets the predefined 3D view of drawing

5iew along the X 6ais - Sets the view in the direction of the X-axis

5iew in opposite direction
to X 6ais
- Sets the view in the direction opposite to the X-axis

5iew along the Y 6ais - Sets the view in the direction of the Y-axis

5iew in opposite direction
to Y 6ais
- Sets the view in the direction opposite to the Y-axis

5iew along the Z 6ais - Sets the view in the direction of the Z-axis

5iew in opposite direction
to Z 6ais
- Sets the view in the direction opposite to the Z-axis

/o&es the displa%ed cut - Moves the displayed cut in an arbitrary direction to
move the drawing slide the mouse while pressing the
left mouse button

,otates the scene - Rotates the displayed drawing in an arbitrary direction
to move the drawing slide the mouse while pressing the
left mouse button

Auto'atic scene rotation - Turns on an automatic rotation of drawing according to
the last used rotation (use the ",otate scene" button)
-40-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
!ool )ar Selections
The tool bar buttons allow for setting the way in which individual objects on the desktop are
selected when adjusting the drawing. The picture shows the positions of these buttons:
Tool bar "Selections"

Selection
indi&iduall%
- in a given mode each mouse click adds one object into the
selection set (point, edge)

Selection )%
crossing
- in a given mode each mouse click adds all objects crossed by the
line into the selection set (point, edge)

Selection using
rectangle
- in a given mode each mouse click adds all objects found inside the
rectangle into the selection set (point, edge)

Selection using
rho')oid
- in a given mode each mouse click adds all objects found inside the
rhomboid into the selection set (point, edge)

Add to the
selection set
- adds additional objects to the overall list according to the assumed
selection mode

,e'o&e "ro'
the selection set
- removes objects from the overall list according to the assumed
selection mode

In&ert selection - inverts all selected objects depending on the assumed selection
mode
5ertical tool )ars
The vertical tool bars serve to select the desired mode (regime) of inputting data (project,
geometry, profile..) including analysis type and verification. Selecting the mode from this bar
displays in the bottom part of the desktop the corresponding frame for data input.
Tool bar for switching between input data regimes
The standalone vertical tool bar serves to manage pictures.
The "Add picture" button opens the "New picture" dialog window. The next line in the bar
provides the number of stored pictures in a given regime of data input. The "!otal" line shows
-41-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
the total number of stored pictures. The "Picture list" button opens the list of pictures.
Tool bar for controlling iew manager editor
5isuali-ation st%le settings
The "5isuali-ation st%le settings" dialog window serves to set the plot style (line type and
color) for visualization on the desktop or for printout, respectively. It contains a group of tab
sheets that correspond to individual data input regimes. The tab sheets serve to set the style
for drawing objects, which are specified in the related input regime.
The "Glo)al" tab sheet defines the settings common to all input regimes (background color,
color of elements to be deleted or modification and style of drawing of inactive elements).
The program implicitly contains two standard settings of styles and colors, particularly for
black or white background. The setting can be modified in the combo list on the tool bar. User
settings can be defined, i.e. a user can specify a style of drawing and store that style with the
help of the button on the tool bar into the "Style manager".
Dialog window ""isuali!ation st#le settings" $ global setting
The following picture shows an example of a tab sheet for setting the plot in the regime
"(ater". Individual columns of the table contain (moving from the left):
Ite' - list of items plotted in a given input regime (here, e.g., water tables,
dimensions, gradient, water pressure..)
Acti&e - shows / hides a given item in the acti&e regi'e "(ater". In case the
option cannot be turned off (the field has a gray background in this case
items "!a)les" and "(ater pressure") the visualization on the desktop is
mandatory!
Inacti&e - shows / hides a given item in other input data regi'es. Visualization color
depends on the assumed setting in the tab sheet "Glo)al"
-42-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
$esktop - determines the item color displayed on the desktop
Pictures - determines the item color displayed in the "Picture list" or on printout ("Print
and export picture", "Print and export document")
#ine t%pe - determines the line style
!hickness - determines the line thickness
Dialog window ""isuali!ation st#le settings" $ setting for the input regime "%ater"
St%le 'anager
The red button on a tool bar of the "5isuali-ation st%le settings" dialog window opens the
".ew st%le" dialog window. The window allows for setting the style name and its description.
The "O7" button saves the selected style.
Saing the user profile of isuali!ation st#le
In such a way an arbitrary number of user profiles of visualization styles can be defined. The
list of such profiles can be accessed from a combo list already containing implicitly predefined
profiles (black and white background), or a view manager (can be opened by pressing the
button on a tool bar) that allows for editing the profile. The buttons "Up" and "$own" serve to
move within a list of the user defined profiles.
-43-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window "St#le manager"
Fra'es
The frame is a permanently opened window in the bottom part of the application window.
Frames are changed depending on the input data regime of a given task selected from the
vertical control bar. The frame may contain the following items: table, combo list, fields for
inputting data (h
1
, h
2
..) and command buttons.
The function key "!a)" together with cursor arrows for moving within the selected element
(e.g., combo list) and in case of command buttons the corresponding underlined letter ("Add"
"A") are employed when selecting the data using the keyboard.
Frame control elements
The frame can be minimized using the button in the left upper corner. In this case the frame
space is taken by the drawing space. In some cases it is more advantageous to exploit the
frame space for increasing the drawing space, which is possible owing to the fact that the
program uses the system of active dimensions and active objects so that the frame does not
-44-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
have to be displayed all the time.
Returning the frame to its original face is performed by pressing the button in the left bottom
corner of the desktop showing the frame name. Providing the frame is minimized, e.g. in the
regime "(ater" it remains hidden even when switching to other input data regime.
Frame control elements
!a)les
The table is a list of inputted data (for example a list of surcharges, soils, profile interfaces.).
The table header contains a list of items (surcharge, name, width, size.) and in the upper left
corner control elements to manage the table rows:

- selects all ta)le rows

- cancels selection

- in&erts selection
The assumed selection can be also changed by pressing the desired row number. Buttons with
numbers are "pressed".
The "Add" button opens the corresponding dialog window for inserting the table data. If the
list of data in the table is empty then all input fields in the dialog window are empty. If the
table contains some already inputted elements then the input fields are filled with values taken
from the current table row (an "arrow" is positioned next to the row number). Elements
(rows) are inserted in the table by pressing the "Add" button in the dialog window. New data
are placed at the end of the table.
Individual rows are edited with the help of the "3dit" button. Only the row marked with an
arrow (see figure) will be edited regardless of other selected rows in the table. Some of the
-45-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
dialog windows allows for editing a group of selected items using the "3dit selected" button.
It is therefore possible to modify values in more rows all at once. Always the selected rows are
edited.
The ",e'o&e" button deletes all selected ("pressed") rows. More than one row can be
removed at the same time. If no item is selected the program deletes the current row (marked
with an "arrow").
It there is among rows selected for deletion a row, which cannot be deleted (e.g. starting point
of a structure), the program stops the deletion process!
Table e&ample
Selection state of individual table rows corresponds to visualization state of objects on the
desktop. An object on the desktop that corresponds to the current row in the table (an
"arrow" is positioned next to the row number) is implicitly displayed etra )old. If the row is
selected ("pressed") the corresponding object is displayed in green. Pressing the ",e'o&e"
button colors all objects selected for deletion red.
-46-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
"isuali!ation of selected ob'ects
Marking objects using these colors is implicitly set. This setting, however, can be modified in
the "Visualization style Settings" - tab sheet "Glo)al".
Setting color for selecting ob'ects
$ialog windows
A dialog window is one of the elements that allows for inputting data into the program. In all
programs the dialog windows apply to conventional windows management typical for the
WINDOWS environment. A left mouse button is used when selecting objects in the window or
alternatively the function key "!a)" when using the keyboard. The cursor arrows, "3.!3,"
key or in case of command buttons the corresponding underlined letter ("Cancel" - "C", "O7"
-47-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
"O") are employed when moving within an object.
A dialog window can contain the following items: table, combo list, fields for inputting data
(number, text) and command buttons. The "O7" command button confirms the selection, while
the "Cancel" button leaves the input mode.
Providing the window contains a certain non-typical control element (or this element has some
other than typical effect) its function is described in the corresponding data input regime.
As an example consider the following picture showing the "3dit surcharge" dialog window
that contains the "O7* " and "O7* " buttons. These buttons allow the user to move within
the list of inputted surcharges and at the same time to confirm changes made in the window.
Pressing this button results in the same action as if closing the window with the "O7" button
and opening it again for the next element in the list.
Dialog window e&ample
Acti&e di'ensions and o)8ects
The system of active dimensions and objects allows for faster editing of the inputted data.
- Acti&e di'ension is a dimension that can be edited directly on the desktop. The value of
active dimension is labeled by frame (dashed line). Positioning the mouse cursor and the
frame changes its mask into a "hand". Clicking the value than changes the frame view (is
plotted in a solid line), the cursor starts to blink and the dimension can be edited. The
"3nter" button closes the editing mode. The change is immediately displayed on the
desktop.
- Acti&e o)8ect functions in a similar way. Changing the cursor mask into a "hand" and
-48-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
clicking the object (double click) than activates the editing mode. In this case, however,
the values are not edited directly on the desktop, but rather in the dialog window originally
used to create the object. The picture shows an example of an active object (trapezoidal
surcharge), when clicking on the desktop opens the "3dit surcharge" dialog window.
(&ample of using actie dimensions and actie ob'ects
Unit 'etric 9 i'perial
The program allows for choosing either metric or imperial units. Use combo list to select the
desired type of units. A prompt message appears requesting to confirm the selection.
By changing the unit system the program updates concrete and rein"orce'ent 'aterial
and concrete standard. By selecting imperial units you can use ACI standard to design
concrete constructions. After units change it is necessary to check selected materials in the
frame "/aterial".
Dialog window to confirm the change of units
Cop% to clip)oard
The program allows for using the Windows clipboard in two different ways:
-49-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- It is possible to copy the current desktop view. The picture can be then inserted into an
arbitrary editor (MS Word, Drawing, Adobe Photoshop, etc.) Individual parameters are set
in the "Options" dialog window, tab sheet "Copy to clipboard".
- It is possible to copy the program input data (soil parameters, profile and interfaces,
surcharges, water impact, terrain, etc.). The copied data can be then inserted into our
another program.
Copying to clipboard is available either from the control menu (items "/odi"ications", "Cop%
picture") or using the "Files" button on the tool bar.
GeoClip)oard
GeoClipboard is a special clipboard used in GEO5 programs. It allows to copy and paste data
between regimes and stages of the same or another program.
Basic characteristics of GeoClipboard are:
- GeoClipboard can simulteneously contain different data, e.g. pasting soils after interfaces
doesn't remove interface data
- data are saved after program exit and computer restart till they are replaced by other data
from same data category
- every computer user has its own GeoClipboard
- during pasting data form GeoClipboard the preview of changes is always shown and the
user can change pasting parameters
GeoClipboard controls are always placed into the relevant frame. It looks like this:
)eoClipboard
GeoClipboard is implemented for the following data:
- 2D interfaces, including copying the analysed GWT and topology of stages in FEM
Cop%ing and pasting 2$ inter"aces
GeoClipboard allows to copy and paste 2D interfaces between the following regimes:
- Interface
- Embankment and Earth cut
- Water
- Imcompressible Subsoil
-50-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
It also allows to copy data from FEM program:
- in "Anal%sis" regime it allows to copy analysed GWT, especially after water flow analysis
- in "Acti&it%" regime it allows to copy interfaces with respect to active and inactive areas
It's possible to copy the following items:
- focused interface
- selected interfaces
- terrain of current stage
Pasting interfaces from GeoClipboard is the same process as if the user enters interfaces step
by step. The pasting parameters can be entered in the following window:
Pasting from )eoClipboard
In this window it can be specified, which interfaces are pasted ("Paste" column), the order of
pasting (change by mouse click on or by keys Ctrl+Shift+up or down arrow) and locate it
to the desired place. In the same regimes there is a possibility to paste only standalone
interface, thereafter the "Paste" column acts like a radio button and the "Order" column is
hidden.
Program always shows preview of changes caused by pasting and the result of pasting is
described in ".ote" column. Data are changed when "Paste" button is pressed.
There is a possibility to repeatedly paste one interface with changed location to enter skew-
layered profile.
Options
The "Options" dialog window serves to set some of the special program functions (copy to
clipboard, print view, grid and step, etc.).
This dialog window is opened from a control menu (items "Setting", "Options").
The window contains individual tab sheets (number and content may vary depending on
individual programs) that allow for specifying corresponding settings.
-51-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window "*ptions"
Options + cop% to clip)oard
The "Cop% to clip)oard" tab sheet allows for setting the controlling parameters:
Picture si-e - The setting defines the picture size. Either the picture width or height
can be assigned manually. The other dimension is always set
automatically.
Picture "or'at - The setting defines the picture format (*.EMF, *.WMF, *.BMP), its
resolution and color. Recommended setting is displayed in the figure
(format: *.EMF, resolution: 600 dpi, color).
Options - The setting defines the picture frame and header. If both options are
checked, the picture contains both the frame and header.
The "$e"ault" button in the window sets original implicit values.
-52-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window "*ptions" $ tab sheet "Cop# to clipboard"
Options + print picture
This dialog window is opened from the control menu (items "Setting", "Options"). The "Print
picture" tab sheet allows for setting the picture parameters assumed for printout or export in
the "Print and export picture" dialog window.
Options - The setting defines the picture frame and header. If both options are
checked, the picture contains both the frame and header.
The "$e"ault" button in the window sets original implicit values.
-53-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window "*ptions" $ tab sheet "Print picture"
Options 6 input
The "Options" dialogue window, tab sheet "Input" allows for setting the "Grid" parameters
and parameters of functions "Undo" and ",edo".
This tab sheet is implemented onl% in 2$ progra's (Slope stability, Settlement, Beam, etc.).
Grid - sets the grid origin and step in the X and Z directions
Show grid - shows / hides grid on the desktop
Snap to grid - turns on / off the snap to grid option using the mouse (when
shifting the mouse the cursor jumps over the defined grid a
point off the grid can be specified by holding the "C!,#" key)
Hori-ontal rule - shows / hides horizontal rule with a scale of distances on the
desktop
5ertical rule - shows / hides vertical rule with a scale of distances on the desktop
Functions "Undo and
,edo"
- turns on / off the possibility of using these functions in the
program (on horizontal tool bar these buttons are ""ogg%"
-54-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window "*ptions" - tab sheet "+nput"
Co''on input
This chapter contains the hint sections that either provide details on the chapter "$ata input
and anal%sis regi'es" or are common to our several programs.
Inputting and editing soils
The "Add new soil" dialog window serves to input name soil parameters that should be
obtained from laboratory measurements or geological survey.
All inputting fields in the window must be filled. The only exception is the value of
sat
(bulk
weight of saturated soil) in the window section "Upli"t". Should this field remain empty the
program automatically adds the value of (bulk weight of soil).
Clicking the hint button " " provides information about the theory of analyses linked to
individual values being inputted.
The color and pattern category of a soil can be set in the combo lists in the right part of the
dialogues window.
If no geological survey or laboratory experiments are available, the soil can be specified with
the help of the soil database containing approximate values of basic characteristics. The
"Classi"%" button opens the "Classification of soils" dialog window with the values offered for
inserting into the window. The "$elete" button allows for removing information about
classified soil from the catalog. Soil parameters that do not appear in the catalog ("Friction
angle struc-soil" in the picture) must be in any case assigned manually.
The specified soil is inserted into the list of soils by pressing the "Add" button.
-55-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ",dd new soils"
Classi"ication o" soils
Approximate values of soils can be obtained from the catalog of soils. The combo list serves to
select the desired soil and specify its consistency or compactness, respectively. The soil
parameters obtained from the catalog appear in the window.
-56-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window "Classification of soils"
Pressing the "O7" button shows in the "Add new soil" recommended values next to
corresponding input fields (see Fig.). Pressing the "O7*Assign" button then assigns to
individual input fields the average values of soil parameters. The "Cancel" button leaves the
window with no action.
The "/anuall%" button opens the "Manual classification of soils" dialog window that allows for
classifying the soil if its parameters are known, e.g., from laboratory measurements (grading,
moisture, compactness..).
-57-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Soil classification $ recommended range of alues
Soil and rock s%')ols
For the soil inputted either manually or inserted from the catalog it is possible to select from a
combo list a patern category (patterns of programs GEO5, full color, patterns gINT or patterns
according to the Chinese standard YS 5204 1) and color, which are displayed in the inputted
profile
A color in the combo list "Color" is the color used to plot soils (rocks) on the desktop and in
pictures that are either stored in the "Picture list" or printed with the help of "Print and export
pictures" (to visualize the same (full) colors in pictures the option ""ull color" in the
"Visualization style settings" must be set).
The pattern color to be sufficiently visible should be chosen with respect to the desktop
background or printout paper, respectively.
Dialogue window ",dd new soils" - selection of color and pattern categor#
-58-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Patterns of soils- )(*-
Patterns of soils - g+.T
Patterns of soils - /S -012 - 0111
-59-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
3iterature4
5 - /S -012-0111 - Specification for mapping s#mbol of geotechnical inestigation report
/anual classi"ication o" soils
This dialog window allows for specifying the soil parameters, which serve to add the soil into a
catalog of soils. The "O7" button switches back to the "Classi"ication o" soils" dialog window
with setting and classified soil.
Dialog window "Manual classification of soils"
Inter"aces in 2$ en&iron'ent
The left part of the desktop contains a table with the list of interfaces. Interfaces are ordered
in the table from top to bottom. For currently selected interface the program displays in the
mid section of the desktop another table listing individual interface points.
A tool bar in the top part of the desktop contains control buttons to manage interfaces.
Tool bar "+nterface"
,anges - opens the "World coordinates" dialog window that allows for setting the
world dimensions (left and right edge).
Add - turns on the regime for inputting a new interface individual interfaces
can be added in an arbitrary order. Each interface is automatically
stored in the list of interface when leaving the input mode
/odi"% - turns on the regime for editing an interface this regime is also
activated by clicking the desired interface on the desktop
-60-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
,e'o&e - upon pressing the ",e'o&e" button the program marks the selected
interface with a red color and opens the dialog window to confirm this
action
Select - select of interface with the mouse
Every change made to a given interface can be put back using the "UNDO and REDO" buttons
on the horizontal tool bar.
There is a possibility to copy and paste interfaces using GeoClipboard.
Frame "+nterface"
Adding inter"ace
The "Add" button starts the regime for inputting points of a new interface. Other buttons on
the same tool bar assumed for inputting and editing interface points become active. The "O7"
button (tinged green) closes the input regime and stores the inputted points. The "Cancel"
button (tinged red) closes the input regime without accounting for changes.
Two options are available to specify coordinates of individual interface points:
Using ta)le: interface points are introduced in the ".ew inter"ace points" table. The "Add"
button opens the ".ew point" dialog window that allows for specifying coordinates of a new
point. The "Add" button then inserts the point into the table. The "Cancel" button is serves to
close the input mode when all interface points are introduced. The "3dit" and ",e'o&e"
buttons allow for either editing or deleting the inputted points. Each change in interface
geometry immediately appears on the desktop.
Using 'ouse: individual buttons on the vertical tool drive this inputting mode. The following
-61-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
modes are available:

Add point - the point is inserted by clicking the left mouse button on the
desktop - the grid option can be exploited when inserting the
point - the inputted point is automatically rounded to two decimal
digits both mouse and keyboard input modes are therefore
identical

3dit point using
'ouse
- pressing the existing interface point using the left mouse button
allows for selecting this point and then moving it to a new position

3dit point in
dialog point
- clicking the existing interface point opens the dialog window that
allows for modifying the point coordinates

,e'o&e point - pressing the existing interface point using the left mouse button
opens the ",e'o&e point" dialog window when confirming this
action the point is deleted
When inputting points, it is possible to utilize the template obtained from import DXF.
The program allows also for introducing vertical interfaces in such a case the program
requests to insert the point either to the le"t or to the right. The buttons that serve to confirm
the action are colored the same color is also used to visualize both input variants on the
desktop.
The "O7" button (tinged green) is used to store the inputted interface when all interface points
are introduced.
The program also contains an automatic corrector of inputted interface that determines the
interface end points and then adds the interface to the list of interfaces.
Frame "+nterface"
3diting inter"ace
The "/odi"%" button turns on the regime of inputting points of a new interface. The program
also opens the currently selected interface (it is selected from the "#ist o" inter"aces" table; it
-62-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
is displayed as a solid thick line on the desktop). An interface can be selected also as an
acti&e o)8ect )% clicking a point, line or interface using the le"t 'ouse )utton.
The actual editing procedure (adding, shifting, deleting points) is the same as for adding
interface input mode.
The "O7" button closes the editing regime and stores all performed changes. The "Cancel"
button closes the regime without accounting for all previously made modifications.
After leaving the edit mode (similarly to adding interface), the program immediately runs the
corrector of the inputted interface to check for the interface shape and if necessary to modify
the interface end points.
Corrector o" inputted inter"ace
When the inputting or editing process is completed the program automatically modifies the
inputted interface to comply with the program requirements, i.e. the end points touch the
world edges or other interfaces. The automatic corrector can be further used to simplify the
input process e.g., if only one point is used to specify an interface the program automatically
creates a horizontal interface containing the inputted point.
If the interface touches another interface the corrector creates new end points of the current
interface. These points then also become the points of the interface being touched. All lines of
individual interfaces thus start and end in a point.
In case of an incorrect input (see the picture below) the interface cannot be stored. In this
case the interface must be modified or the inputting process must be stopped using the
"Cancel" button.
Here we present examples of interface corrector functions (correct and incorrect input):
-63-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Correct and incorrect interface shapes
(orld coordinates
The dialog window serves to specify world coordinates (dimensions) for a given task left and
right edges. The third data is auxiliary it determines the depth of drawing earth profiles on
the desktop it has no effect on the performed analysis.
The world coordinates can be changed at any time when increasing dimensions all inputted
interfaces are automatically prolonged, when reducing dimensions all points falling off the new
world coordinates are automatically removed.
-64-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window "%orld coordinates"
6ecommended world coordinates 7boundaries8 $ Spread Footing 7Shallow foundations8
6ecommended world coordinates 7boundaries8 $ Deep and pile foundations
-65-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
6ecommended world coordinates 7boundaries8 $ (&caations
6ecommended world coordinates 7boundaries8 $ Supporting structures and %alls
6ecommended world coordinates 7boundaries8 $ (mban9ments and Slopes
-66-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
6ecommended world coordinates 7boundaries8 $ Shallow tunnels saed
6ecommended world coordinates 7boundaries8 $ Tunnels with high oerburden
Assigning soils
Two options are available to assign soils into individual profile layers. Clicking the left mouse
button on the tool bar button above the table selects the desired soil (positioning the mouse
cursors in the bar above the soil button displays a bubble hint with the soil name). The soil is
inserted by moving the mouse cursor (the cursor mask changes into a "hand") first into a
specific layer and then by pressing the left mouse button.
The second option requires opening a combo list of a specific interface and then selecting the
desired soil to be assigned. All changes in the soil assignment are automatically displayed on
the desktop.
-67-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",ssign"
$esign coe""icients
The "Anal%sis" or "5eri"ication" (for verification methodology - classical way) frames that
display the list of computed forces allow for specifying design coefficients. A design coefficient
multiplies the corresponding force. When inputting the coefficient the results are automatically
recomputed and the desktop shows modified forces.
Design coefficients are advantageous for example for:
- Structure testing when a structure response to an increase of force specified directly in the
analysis window can be visualized.
- Excluding several forces from verification or their reduction.
- Specifying design combinations e.g., different coefficients can be assigned in the sense
of EC to main load variables and side variable loads.
The following combinations can be for example specified when performing the wall verification:
Anal%sis 1 Anal%sis 2 Anal%sis 4
- (all 5:1 5:1 5:1
- Acti&e pressure 5:1 5:1 5:1
- Surcharge 1 5:1 1:- 1:-
- Surcharge 2 1:- 5:1 1:-
- Surcharge 4 1:- 1:- 5:1
-68-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ""erification" $ application of design coefficients
,unning 'ore anal%ses 9 &eri"ications
Most frames that display the analysis results allow for defining more than one analysis to be
run. Several analyses within one construction stage are carried out for example for:
- Dimensioning structure in more locations
- Analyses of various slip surfaces
- Verification with various design coefficients
The bar in the top part of the frame serves to manage individual analyses.
Frame ",nal#sis" $ tool bar "6unning more anal#ses ; erification"

Add - adds additional analysis on the bar

,e'o&e - removes the currentl% selected analysis

Anal%sis
11214 000
- switches between individual analyses
-69-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",nal#sis" - "running more anal#ses ; erification"
Connecting progra's
In some cases it is possible to launch a new program from a currently running program. For
example, the "Cantile&er wall" program allows for running the "Slope sta)ilit%" program to
verify the external stability of a structure, or the "Spread "ooting" program to verify the
bearing capacity of a footing of a structure.
The new program loads the data of structure and then it behaves as a standalone program
closing the program, however, is different. Pressing the "O7" button (on the right below the
tool bars) closes the program and the analysis data are passed to the original program. This is
not the case if closing the program with the help of the "Cancel" button.
The program, when running it "or the "irst ti'e, creates the data of a structure and passes
on the structure dimensions, geology, loads, surcharges and other data. The program then
requires inputting so'e additional data, e.g. the analysis method, analysis setting, slip
surfaces, stages of construction, etc.
(hen running it again (always necessary if some changes were made in the original
program) the program regenerates the data to be passed on, but keeps the data alread%
inputted in this progra'. For example, when connecting the original program with the
"Spread "ooting" program the new program keeps the additionally inputted sand-gravel
cushion together with inputted soil the footing dimensions, foundation geometry, and
geological profile are, however, regenerated.
Some actions are not allowed in the new program e.g. to change the basic setting of the
project, unit, etc. The generated task, however, can be saved into new data using the "Sa&e
as" button and work with it as with any other independent task.
-70-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
6un the program "Spread footing" from program "Cantileer wall"
Selecting and storing &iews
The programs offer a number of ways of displaying results. A specific option can be selected
from the "View results" dialog window. Quite often it is necessary to go through a complex and
tedious setting of views for example, if we are interested in the distribution of internal forces
developed in beams using FEM, it is necessary to turn off the color range, draw only
undeformed structure, select a variable to be displayed, select a suitable magnification, etc.
To simplify the way of managing individual views the programs allow us, using the "Selecting
and storing &iews: )ar, to store the current &iew and also to go "ro' one &iew to the
other in a relatively simple way.
!he stored &iew keeps;
- All settings from the "View results", "FEM - results visualization settings" respectively
- Drawn variables
- Color range
- Picture zoom
The view is stored for all stages of construction if it is not possible in a certain construction
stage to perform such a setting (e.g. in the first construction stage the settlement and
depression are not defined) the programs displays the closest possible setting and the defined
view is switched to <none=.
-71-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Control units of a tool bar ""iews"
The following control units are available to 'anage &iews:

$e"ine &iew - Opens the "Results visualization settings" dialog
window, which serves to define details for
displaying the results.

Select &iew - Combo list allows for selecting an already
specified and stored view.

Store current &iew - Opens the ".ew &iew" dialog window to store
a new view.

Open &iew 'anager - Opens the window with a list of views.
,esults &isuali-ation settings
The "Settle'ent 6 results &isuali-ation settings" dialog window provides tools for a lucid
way of displaying the results both on the screen and in the printed format:
- Parameters to draw depression line and in"luence -one
- Setting surface views and color scale drawing
- Setting and drawing tilted sections
The programs based on the "inite ele'ent 'ethod further allow for setting:
- Parameters to draw the finite element 'esh
- Parameters to draw construction de"or'ed 9 unde"or'ed (note that undeformed
option must be selected when displaying beam internal forces)
- $istri)ution o" internal "orces along interfaces and on beam elements
All information specified in this window (including the setting of current magnification) can be
stored using the selecting and storing views bar.
-72-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window "Settlement $ results isuali!ation settings"
Setting color range
The color range is an important tool providing a lucid way of visualization of results. The
program offers two predefined types of color ranges "Uni"or'" and "Across -ero". Both
ranges have a moving minimum and maximum value and predefined colors. The minimum and
maximum values are auto'aticall% regenerated whenever the variable or a stage of
construction is changed. The "Uni"or'" range means that colors are uniformly spread from
the minimum to the maximum value. The "Across -ero" range draws the positive values using
warm colors (yellow, red), while cold colors (green, blue) are used to represent negative
values.
The program allows for introduction of user6de"ined ranges with both the "ied minimum
and maximum and the 'o&ing minimum and maximum. A user-defined range is specified in
the "Scale color definition" dialog window. The range is always defined for the current unit
(e.g. kPa< m) when switching the units the program always adjusts the range particular for a
given unit.
Control units of a tool bar "6anges"
-73-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The following control units are available to 'anage ranges:

Select range - a combo list allows for selecting an already
specified and stored range

$e"ine color ranges - opens the "Scale color definition" dialog
window to create a user-defined range

Store current range - opens the ".ew range" dialog window to
store a new range

Open range 'anager - opens the window with a list of automatic and
user-defined ranges
Scale color de"inition
The "Scale color de"inition" dialog window serves to create a user6de"ined color scale.
The "Floating 'ini'u' and 'ai'u'" check box determines the basic type of a scale. If
checked, the minimum and maximum values of a scale are automatically adjusted whenever
the corresponding variable or a construction stage is changed. In such a case it possible to
adjust the following:
- Scale re"ine'ent (the minimum number of levels is 4 and the maximum is 100)
- Scale color
- Uni"or' scale 9 across -ero
The nu')er o" scale le&els and scale t%pe are specified in the "Scale generation" dialog
window, which opens after pressing the "Generate &alues" button. It is possible to adjust
both &alues and colors in the table in the left part of the dialog window. The range values can
be easily changed in the table. If the box in the "Control color" column is checked, it is
possible to choose an arbitrary color from the combo box. The color on intermediate not
checked rows are automatically blended from the inputted colors in checked rows. The default
values can be recalled anytime after pressing the "Prede"ined colors" button.
An important property of the program is a definition of ranges with the "ied 'ini'u' and
'ai'u'. If the "Floating 'ini'u' and 'ai'u'" check box is not checked, the color
range is fixed and its minimum and maximum values are inputted. As oppose to the moving
range it is further possible to specify:
- ,ange end points (in the "Scale generation" dialog window)
- Colors to display &alues out o" the range
When changing a variable or a construction stage the color range re'ains still the sa'e,
keeping the same end ranges. The values found outside the range (below the minimum or
above the maximum value) are drawn using colors specified in the right part of the
window. !he 'ini'u' and 'ai'u' range &alues are inputted in the "Scale
generation" dialog window. The inputted minimum and maximum values are linked to the
sa'e unit e.g. when specifying the rage of 0 - 200 kPa, this range is kept the same for all
variables being specified in kPa when changing the currently displayed variable to the
variable settlement, the current range is switched to that corresponding to the unit of
settlement.
For both the fixed and floating scale it is possible to choose whether the colors in the ranges
are distributed uni"or'l% or across -ero. The "Uni"or'" scale means that colors are
smoothly spread from the minimum to the maximum value of the scale. The "Across -ero"
scale draws the colors above the selected value using warm colors (yellow, red), while cold
colors (green, blue) are used to represent the colors below the selected value.
-74-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window "Scale color definition"
I'port 6 eport $>F
Programs 2D (Slope stability, Settlement, FEM, Beam) allow for importing and exporting data
in DXF format.
Programs 1D (Cantilever wall, Gabion, Spread footing, Piles.) allow only for exporting data in
the *.DXF format. The program main menu (item "File") contains "I'port" - "For'at $>F
into te'plate" or "For'at $>F into inter"ace" and "3port" "For'at $>F" items.
Menu and tool bar for module "(&port-import DF="
Data import proceeds in two steps:
- Reading data into template
- Reading data into interface
- Inputting data using template
- Modifying template during data input
-75-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The data inputted in the program can be exported in DXF format anytime.
,eading data into te'plate
Choose the "I'port", "For'at $>F into te'plate" item in the program menu ("File") and
then select in a standard way the file to be imported. The loaded data are displayed in the
dialogue window, which allows selecting indi&idual la%ers to be subsequently read into the
template. All data are always loaded into the program so that the layer selection can be
modified anytime.
The same dialogue window allows also determining the unit used when creating the DXF file.
The program attempts to estimate it, but it is alwa%s necessar% to check whether the unit
is inputted correctly. The structure can also be moved. The program offers the following
options:
- do not 'o&e this option reads data in the same way as they were inputted
- auto'aticall% "ro' -ero this option moves the structure left bottom corner to the
coordinate system origin
- input this option allows for defining the shift manually
When importing data it is possible adjust the world margins based on the imported data this
is particularly useful when defining a new task.
Imported data are not transferred directly into the program. Instead, they are read into a
template, which is used to transfer data into program later on. When the data are loaded the
template is displayed on the desktop and the buttons on a horizontal tool bar, which are used
to manage the template, are made available.
6eading data into a template
-76-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Modif#ing world margins
,eading data into inter"ace
Choose the "I'port", "For'at $>F into inter"ace" item in the program menu ("File") and
then select in a standard way the file to be imported.
The loaded data are displayed in the dialog window, which allows for selecting individual layers
to be subsequently read into a interface. The same dialogue window allows also for
determining the unit used when creating the DXF file. The program attempts to estimate it, but
it is alwa%s necessar% to check whether the unit is inputted correctly. The structure can
also be moved. The program offers the following options:
- do not 'o&e this option reads data in the same way as they were inputted
- auto'aticall% "ro' -ero this option moves the structure left bottom corner to the
coordinate system origin
- input this option allows for defining the shift manually
Up on import the program automatically adjusts the world margins based on the loaded data.
Providing not all selected layers of the structure are successfully loaded, the program allows
for using the loaded DXF file as a template.
-77-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
6eading data into an interface
%arning - importing data as a template
Inputting data using te'plate
Inputting data using a template is essentially the same as a standard input of data in the
program. The main difference appears in the possibility of adding a point from a template into
the data being inputted. During input the mouse cursor appears as an axial cross when
approaching the template it turns into a small cross and long axes disappear. When a point is
now inputted (using the left mouse button) the point from the template is inserted (the
inputted point has now the same coordinates as the point in the template). To accelerate the
input of individual lines it appears useful to employ the zooming tools. After interfaces are
inputted, the procedure can be applied to input other entities. During input it is possible to
modify template anytime.
-78-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
+nputting data using a template
/odi"%ing te'plate during data input
When inputting data, the template can be modified anytime. In particular, pressing the
"/odi"%" button on the "!e'plate $>F" tool bar opens a dialog window with individual layers
of the template. For example, when inputting anchors, it is possible to turn off all layers except
for anchors inputting anchors then becomes simple and lucid.
-79-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Turning on;off la#ers in a template
Displa# after modif#ing la#ers in a template
3port $>F
To proceed, use the program menu (item "File") and choose the item "3port", "For'at
$>F". Next, select the file name intended for export. Using a dialog window the program then
provides information regarding the performed data export.
+nformation regarding the performed data e&port
The exported data can be verified by importing them back into the program.
-80-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Chec9 of e&ported data
I'port #and>/#
Programs "!erain" allow for importing data in LandXML format. Choose the "I'port",
"For'at #and>/#" item in the program menu ("File") and then select in a standard way the
file to be imported.
+mport 3and=M3
-81-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The loaded data are displayed in the dialog window, which allows for selecting individual layers
to be loaded as points and interfaces. The same dialogue window allows also for modifying the
unit used when creating the LandXML file. The structure can also be moved. The program
offers the following options:
- do not 'o&e this option reads data in the same way as they were inputted
- auto'aticall% "ro' -ero this option moves the structure left bottom corner to the
coordinate system origin
- input this option allows for defining the shift manually
Up on import the program automatically adjusts the world margins based on the loaded data.
Supported LandXML elements: Units, Alignments, CgPoints, Parcels, PlanFeatures, Roadways,
Surfaces, Survey.
Not supported LandXML elements: GradeModel, Spiral curves except clothoids.
6eading data
I'port gI.!
The program makes it possible to import data in the gINT (*.gi*) format.
The gINT (*.gi*) format is used to process and present geotechnical, geological and
hydrological data. Detail information regarding this company can be found on
www0gintso"tware0co' and www0"ine0c-9gint.
The main program menu (item "File") contains the "I'port" - "For'at GI?" items.
The program allows for loading three types of files from the gINT program:
- ?0GI1 - points of terrain for program "!errain"
-82-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- ?0GI2 - soils and geological profile for all programs
- ?0GI4 - CPT data for program "Pile CP!"
Menu "+mport g+.T"
I'port o" terrain points
The program "!errain" allows for importing the points of terrain surface. The gINT file is in
this case written as *.gi1. The main program menu (item "File") contains the "I'port" -
"For'at GI1 @gI.! inter"ace pointsA" items. Using the "Open" button in the "I'port o"
data in gI.! "or'at" dialog window makes it possible to load the gINT file import a set of
points of terrain surface. Using the "Add" button then opens the way to import in the gINT
format an arbitrary number of interfaces.
Using the "Open" button in the bottom part of the dialog window it is possible as described
above to load the "File o" points o" water"
While importing the program automatically transform the format of units of the imported data
into the one used in the program.
-83-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window "+mport of data on format g+.T"
I'port o" soils and pro"ile
Using the "Open" button in the "I'port gI.! @soils and pro"ileA" dialog window makes it
possible to load the gINT file. The gINT file is in this case written as *.gi2. The "Selected
pro"ile" combo list serves to choose the profile. The type of import (Import soils, Import
profile, Import assignment) is then determined in the "I'port para'eters" sheet.
While importing the program automatically transform the format of units of the imported data
into the one used in the program.
The program "!errain" allows for importing more profiles (boreholes) together (option "All
pro"iles" in the combo list "Selected pro"ile"). All imported profiles must have same count
of layers. If profiles contain different order of assigned soils, then assignment is made
according to the last profile.
Dialog window "+mport g+.T" 7soils and profile8
-84-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Heredit% 6 stage o" construction
For individual types of input (soil assignment, anchors, supports.) there always exists
relationship over construction stages. There are two types:
$e"ined heredit% (anchors, supports, surcharges.) these objects always remember the
stage, in which they were created. This is also the stage where these objects can be edited. In
all subsequent stages these objects can be either removed or it is possible to change some of
their properties (post-stressing anchor, changing surcharge magnitude, translating support.).
When defining a new construction stage these objects are automatically carried over to that
stage.
Auto'atic heredit% (assigning soil, terrain profile, water impact, analysis setting.) for
such types of inputs the properties from the previous stage are carried over to a new one if
created. When changing properties in the current construction stage the program proceeds as
follows:
- If the property in the next stage remains the same as in the previous stage it also receives
the tag new this change also applies to all subsequent stages.
- If the property in the next stage differs from the one in the previous stage (this means
that this property has been in the next stage already changed) then this change is not
carried over to subsequent stages.
Changes within stages of construction $ automatic heredit#
Standards and anal%sis 'ethods
Starting with the version 15, the GEO5 programs allow for a central setting of parameters of
standards and analysis methods.
In all GEO5 programs, these parameters can be specified in the "ra'e "Settings", which
enables the user to:
- select analysis parameters in the Settings list
- store and manage settings in the Settings Administrator
- create and manage new user settings
Settings Ad'inistrator
The Settings Administrator is the principal tool for managing individual "Settings". In particular,
it enables the user to:
- determine the &isi)ilit% o" Settings in the "Settings list" (it is determined by checking
the box visibility)
- &iew )asic Settings which are currently selected (available by pressing the "5iew"
-85-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
button)
- add user Settings (pressing the "Add" button opens ".ew settings" dialogue window
with a copy of the currently selected Setting)
- edit inputted user Settings (by pressing the "3dit" button)
- delete user Settings (by pressing the ",e'o&e" button).
In addition, the Settings Administrator enables exporting and importing Settings stored on the
disk.
"Settings ,dministrator" dialogue window
3port and i'port o" settings
The user settings selected in the "Settings Administrator" can be saved in to the file ("3port")
in formats ?0gBc and ?0l' and subsequently loaded ("I'port") on a different computer
having installed the GEO5 programs. It enables sharing analysis settings between several
users, e.g. in companies, which share more licenses distributed among several subdivisions.
These formats may prove particularly useful when communicating various problems with
hotline.
-86-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
(&port 7+mport8 of the selected "Settings" of anal#sis parameters
Settings list
The "Settings list" dialogue window allows the user to choose the current "Setting", which will
then drive both the calculation and verification analysis of a given task.
This list contains two types of settings:
- )asic, which accompany the distribution and can be neither edited nor deleted
- user, which is defined by the user
The list applies to all GEO5 programs, only some of the Settings can be restricted to a specific
program.
For lucidity, only Settings, which are checked in the "Settings Administrator" as visible, are
displayed. When running the program the first time, the Settings visibility is determined
according to the country of destination. Subsequently, the program remembers the changes
introduced by the user.
To work efficiently with the GEO5 programs, it is sufficient for most countries to create one or
several specific "Settings". Then, for the solution o" indi&idual tasks the user just selects
the particular Setting. The analysis methods, values of coefficients and the verification
methodology then do not need to be specified. This results in a lucid and simpler work with a
given program.
"Settings list" dialogue window
-87-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Anal%sis settings
An analysis setting is set of data, which is decisive for performing various calculations in the
program. These include, in particular:
- methods and theories of the analyses
- verification methodology; the way of proving safety of the structure (factor of safety, limit
states, EN 1997, LRFD)
- actual values of partial factors and degrees of safety for individual design situations
An analysis setting is typically the same for a large number of tasks owing to this, the
program enables creating a "Settings list". Individual settings can be edited, exported and
imported in the "Settings Administrator".
A setting can be &alid for all G3OB progra's or for one selected progra' only.
"(dit current settings" dialogue window
/aterials and standards
The tab sheet serves to input materials and analysis standards for:
- Concrete structures
- Concrete structures of bridge abutments
- EC2 coefficients are specified for the analysis of Concrete structures according to EN 1992-
1-1. Both default and user-defined values can be adopted.
- Masonry structures (defined in the "/asonr% (all" program only)
- Steel structures (defined in the "Plate" program only)
- Loads and combinations (defined in the "Plate" and "Bea'" programs only)
-88-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- AASHTO enables the reduction of friction between the soil-soil interface in the wall
anal%sis to the value of:
- SNiP enables inputting the design coefficients in the sense of Russian standards SNiP
".ew settings" dialogue window - "Materials and standards" tab sheet
(all anal%sis
The tab sheet serves to input parameters for the analysis of walls:
- Active earth pressure calculation (Caquot, Coulomb (CSN 730037), Mller-Breslau (DIN
4085), Mazindrani (Rankin), Absi).
- Passive earth pressure calculation (Caquot-Kerisel (CSN 730037), Coulomb, Mller-
Breslau, Sokolovski (DIN 4085), Mazindrani (Rankin), Absi).
- Earthquake analysis (Mononobe-Okabe, Arango).
- Shape of earth wedge (Calculate as skew, Consider always vertical).
- Base key (The base key is considered as front face resistance, The base key is considered
as inclined footing bottom).
- Internal stability - this way of calculation is adopted in "/S3 (all". Slip surface has a
different shape (straight, broken) according to the selected standard of calculation.
- Hinge Height Concept it represents the way of the analysis of precast walls according to
AASHTO, in which the favorably acting gravity force of a part of the structure is reduced.
It is adopted in ",edi ,ock (all" program. This program also allows for inputting the
"Coe""icient o" reduction o" "irst )lock6)ase".
- In the case of verification methodology according to the limit states and factor of safety, it
is possible to reduce the parameters of the foundation soil interface. The coefficient of
reduction of structure soil interface represents the amount of wall resistance against
slip resp. against translation when in contact with the soil.
- When running the verification analysis according to the theory of limit states, the program
enables the reduction of the tangent of the angle of internal friction employing the
coefficient
m
.
- Verification methodology (factor of safety, limit states, analysis according to EN 1997,
-89-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
analysis according to LRFD).
- Design situations are specified for all verification methodologies.
".ew settings" dialogue window - ",nal#sis of walls" tab sheet
3ca&ations
The tab sheet serves to input parameters for the analysis of excavations and earth pressures:
- Active earth pressure calculation (Caquot, Coulomb (CSN 730037), Mller-Breslau (DIN
4085), Mazindrani (Rankin), Absi).
- Passive earth pressure calculation (Caquot-Kerisel (CSN 730037), Coulomb, Mller-
Breslau, Sokolovski (DIN 4085), Mazindrani (Rankin), Absi).
- Earthquake analysis (Mononobe-Okabe, Arango).
- Shape of earth wedge (Calculate as skew, Consider always vertical).
- Reduce the modulus of subsoil reaction for braced sheeting this function is available in
the "Sheeting &eri"ication" program only, when during the analysis of braced sheeting
the program automatically reduces the values of the modulus of subsoil reaction.
- Verification methodology (factor of safety, limit states, analysis according to EN 1997,
analysis according to LRFD).
-90-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- Design situations are specified for all verification methodologies.
".ew settings" dialogue window - "(arth pressures" tab sheet
Sta)ilit% anal%sis
The tab sheet serves to input parameters for stability analysis:
- Verification methodology (factor of safety, limit states, analysis according to EN 1997)
- Design situations are specified for all verification methodologies.
".ew settings" dialogue window - "Stabilit# anal#ses" tab sheet
Settle'ent
The tab sheet serves to input parameters for the settlement analysis:
Analysis methods:
-91-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- CSN 73 1001 (Analysis using oedometric modulus)
- Analysis using compression coefficient
- Analysis using compression index
- NEN (Buismann, Ladde)
- Soft soil model
- Janbus theory
- Analysis using constrained modulus
Restriction of influence zone:
- based on structural strength
- by percentage of
or
(The coefficient to bound the influence zone is inputted in [%])
".ew settings" dialogue window - "Settlement" tab sheet
Spread Footing
The tab sheet serves to input parameters for the analysis of bearing capacity of foundation:
Anal%sis "or drained conditions:
- standard approach
- CSN 73 1001
- PN-81B-03020
- IS:6403-1981
- EC 7-1 (EN 1997-1:2003)
- NCMA
- GB 50007-2002
- SNiP 2.02.01-83
Anal%sis "or undrained conditions:
- standard approach
- CSN 73 1001
- IS:6403-1981
- EC 7-1 (EN 1997-1:2003)
-92-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Anal%sis o" spread "ooting on rock su)soil:
- standard approach
- CSN 73 1001
- EC 7-1 (EN 1997-1:2003)
Anal%sis o" upli"t
- standard approach
- cone method
- DL/T 5219-2005
Verification methodology (factor of safety, limit states, analysis according to EN 1997, analysis
according to LRFD).
Design situations are specified for all verification methodologies.
".ew settings" dialogue window - "Spread Footing" tab sheet
Piles
The tab sheet serves to input parameters for the analysis of piles:
Anal%sis "or drained conditions:
- CSN 73 1002
- Effective stress
- NAVFAC DM 7.2
Anal%sis "or undrained conditions:
- Tomlinson
- NAVFAC DM 7.2
-93-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
#oad settle'ent cur&e:
- nonliner (Masopust)
- linear (Poulos)
Verification methodology (factor of safety, limit states, analysis according to EN 1997).
Design situations are specified for all verification methodologies.
".ew settings" dialogue window - "Piles" tab sheet
Pile CP!
The tab sheet serves to input parameters for the analysis of piles CPT:
5eri"ication 'ethodolog% (factor of safety, limit states, NEN 6743, EN 1997-2).
Anal%sis t%pe:
- EN 1997-2
- NEN 6743
- LCPC (Bustamante)
- Schmertmann
".ew settings" dialogue window - "Piles CPT" tab sheet
-94-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
/icropiles
The tab sheet serves to input parameters for the analysis of micropiles:
Calculation o" ste' )earing capacit%:
- geometric method (Euler)
- Salas theory
- Vas-Souche theory
Calculation o" root )earing capacit%:
- Lizzi theory
- Littlejoh theory
- Bowles theory
- Zweck theory
- Vas theory
- root in the rock
- Bustamante (SPT, Pressiometer Mnard)
Verification methodology (factor of safety, limit states).
Design situations are specified for all verification methodologies.
".ew settings" dialogue window - "Micropiles" tab sheet
Pile group
The tab sheet serves to input parameters for the analysis of group of piles:
- Analysis for drained conditions: CSN 73 1002, Effective stress, NAVFAC DM 7.2
- Efficiency of pile group: UFC 3-220-01A, La Barr (CSN 73 1002), Seiler-Keeney, input
efficiency
- Verification methodology (factor of safety, limit states, analysis according to EN 1997).
- Design situations are specified for all verification methodologies.
-95-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
".ew settings" dialogue window - "Pile group" tab sheet
Adding new Setting
The program contains a relatively large number of )asic Settings applicable to individual
countries and theoretical approaches. Despite of that, it is quite probable that most users will
require to modify it and create their own user Settings.
A setting can be valid for all GEO5 programs or for the current program only (this can be
specified in the right upper corner of the window).
Pressing the "Add to the ad'inistrator" button opens the dialogue window, which displays
the current Settings of the program:
- providing the "Inputted "or the current task" is the current setting, the window is
opened in the regime pertinent to the current program
- providing the current setting is selected from the Settings list, a copy of this Setting with
the same validity is opened
After editing and specifying the name of a new Setting, this Setting is saved into the
"Settings Administrator" by pressing the "Add" button so it can be subsequently selected from
the "Settings list".
User-defined Settings is reasonable to create for example:
1A )ased on countries and standards
- settings for Boguto
- settings for Borito
- settings for pro Borito, bridge structures
2A )ased on in&estor
- settings for highways
- settings for railways
- settings for buildings
4A )ased on anal%sis 'ethods
-96-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- analysis based on Mazindrani
- analysis based on Coulomb.....
CA indi&iduall%
- my way
- Peters way
The goal is to create a "Settings list" such that the user does not need to care for the way of
inputting various types of analysis and accompanied coefficients. The created settings can be
"Exported" and made available to other users. Providing such Settings have a broader validity
the company FINE will implement them into the pre-defined Settings so that they become
available to all users of the GEO5 programs.
I'port o" older data
Older data of the GEO5 programs are, after imported into the version 15, automatically
transformed into the new format of Settings. The import is performed in the following steps:
- Old data with their program settings are loaded.
- The loaded data are compared with the Settings visible in the "Settings list". Providing the
data are compatible with one of the Setting in the list, this Setting is adopted as current
and the import is completed.
- The loaded data are compared with all Settings in the "Settings Administrator". Providing
the data are compatible with one of the Setting in the list, this Setting is adopted as
current and made visible.
- Providing the program does not find any compatible setting, the setting of loaded data is
stored as "Inputted "or current task". In such a case we recommend to create from
these data a new user-defined Setting. This ensures that the setting will be assigned to
other imported files.
In majority of cases the program loads the data such that the results are identical with the
results of the original version. Nevertheless, several exceptions exist for which the
compatibility could not be achieved.
Basic changes in settings )etween &ersion 1B and
older &ersions
Upon loading a file from an older version, the settings remain almost always the same as
specified in the previous versions. The settings are not compatible in the following cases.
1. In the analysis according to the factor of safety or the theory of limit states when
different coefficients were specified in different stages of construction. In such a case,
the program adopts settings from the first stage only and assigns them to the
permanent and transient design situations. Settings from the other stages are not
loaded and thus it is necessary to input them into corresponding design situations
manually.
2. In the program ".ailed Slopes", when performing the verification analysis according to
the theory of limit states, the coefficient reducing the self-weight of soil behind the
structure is different from one. This coefficient was in &ersion 1B re'o&ed. To
maintain the same results, it is necessary to input a modified weight of soil in the frame
"Soils".
-97-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
3. Programs "3arth Pressures", "Sheeting $esign" and "Sheeting Check", analysis
based on EN 1997, design approach 2, introduce a new factor, Partial "actor reducing
the soil resistance (
Re
), which reduces the magnitude of the passive earth pressure.
The default value of this coefficient is equal to 1,4. To maintain the same results, it is
necessary to input its value in the "Pressure analysis" window equal to 1.0.
5eri"ication 'ethodolog%
The program allows for the structure verification according to four methodologies:
- Verification according to factor of safety
- Verification according to limit states
- Verification according to EN 1997
- Verification according to LRFD
Specific calculations (e.g. pressure calculation, determination of bearing capacity of foundation
soil) are the same for all four methodologies they differ only in the way of introducing the
design coefficients, combinations and the procedure for verifying the structure safety.
Anal%sis according to the "actor o" sa"et% @AS$A
The verification methodology based on the "Factor o" sa"et%" is historically the oldest and
most widely used approach for the structure safety verification. The principal advantage is its
simplicity and lucidity.
In general, the safety is proved using the factor of safety:
where: FS - Computed factor of safety
X
pas
- A variable resisting the failure (resisting force, strength, capacity)
X
act
- A variable causing failure (sliding force, stress)
FS
re

- Required factor of safety


When performing the analysis using the "Factor o" sa"et%", neither the load nor the soil
parameters are reduced by any of a design coefficient.
Detailed description for individual programs and types of structures can be found in the
following chapters (Walls and retaining structures, Slope Stability, Spread Footing, Piles, Rock
Stability, Micropile, Pile CPT, Pile Group).
Anal%sis according to the theor% o" li'it states
@#S$A
The verification methodology based on the theory of "#i'it states" proves the safety by
comparing a resisting variable (resisting force, strength, bearing capacity) and a variable
causing failure (sliding force, stress).
-98-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: X
pas
- A variable resisting the failure (resisting force, strength, capacity)
X
act
- A variable causing failure (sliding force, stress)
X
act
is in general determined from the design parameters of soils and loading:
- soil parameters are reduced by corresponding coenfficients
- load (its action) is increased by corresponding coenfficients
X
pas
is determined based on the following assumptions:
- soil parameters are reduced by corresponding coenfficients
- the calculated structure resistance is reduced by a corresponding coenfficient
In general, it can be stated that the verification based on "#i'it states" is more modern and
apt approach in comparison to "Factor of safety". However, it is less lucid.
Modern standars used for the verification of structure safety (EN 1997, LRFD) arise from the
concept of limit states. In addition, they introduce various values for the coefficients of partial
factors for favorably and unfavorably acting loads.
Detailed description for individual programs and types of structures can be found in the
following chapters (Walls and retaining structures, Slope Stability, Spread Footing, Piles, Rock
Stability, Micropile, Pile CPT, Pile Group).
5eri"ication according to 3. 1DDE
Designing a structure according to EN 1997-1 essentially follows the analysis of limit states.
Partial factors, adjusting the characteristic values of loading, material and resistance, are
introduced into analysis in dependence on the selected "Design approach".
Partial factors are identical for all analyses in a given program. However, a "Design situation"
can be selected for individual stages.
The programs can be grouped into several categories based on the selected approach:
- Analysis of walls, supporting structures (Walls, Abutment, Nailed Slopes)
- Analysis of sheeting structures (Sheeting Design, Sheeting Check, Earth Pressure)
- Foundation analysis (Spread Footing, Pile)
- Slope stability analysis
Partial "actors
The "Settings" dialogue window serves to input, for the analysis based on EN1997, the
analysis partial factors.
The "$esign approach" combo list allows for choosing one of the three "Design approaches".
Depending on the selected design approach, the dialog window displays the partial "actors
on actions, 'aterial or resistance and coefficients of combination for variable loading
actions.
The section for inputting partial factors on actions serves also to input partial factors reducing
the action of water.
The "Settings administrator" and the "Settings list" contain a large number of pre-defined
-99-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
settings for individual countries 3U + settings 3. 1DDE according to the selected national
annexes (NA). In most countries is then specified only one Design approach depending on NAD
and the used program (type of geotechnical task) several pre-defined settings is available
only for some countries.
The program allows for inputting each set of parameters four times for individual design
situations. The program then adopts the coefficients based on the design situation set in the
frame "Stage settings".
".ew settings" dialogue window $ input of partial factors for the anal#sis based on (.5>>?
$esign Approaches
EN 1997-1 introduces three design approaches into the analysis; they differ by the
application of partial factors.
According to EN 1997-1 the partial factors are generally applied to loading actions or to their
impacts, to properties of foundation soil !, or to resistances R or both. The values of partial
factors differ not only by the assumed design approach, but also by the type of the analyzed
geotechnical task (support structures, piles, etc.). The values of partial factors are in general
specified by the Eurocode in Annees A; the national choice of values of partial factors
specifies .A. The program automatically displays the required coefficients depending on the
selected design approach or on the selection of other parameters in the setting.
Regarding the fact that individual $esign approaches introduce the partial factors into the
analysis in a different way (e.g., partial factors on actions on a structure and the resulting
structure resistance or actions and soil parameters) it is logical that the results attributed to
these design approaches may also considerably differ. If the .ational Annex does not
recommend for a given geotechnical task a $esign approach, it is up to the designer to
select it (and therefore also to evaluate whether the results correspond to the analyzed
situation).
- Design approach 1 Verification is performed for two sets of coefficients (Co')ination 1
-100-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
and Co')ination 2) used in two separate analyses. Coefficients are applied to loading
actions and to 'aterial para'eters.
- Design approach 2 Applies partial factors to loading actions and 'aterial resistance
(bearing capacity).
- Design approach 3 Applies partial factors to loading actions and at the same time to
'aterial (material parameters of soil).
".ew settings" dialogue window< anal#sis based on (.5>>? $ Selection of design approach
$esign approach 1
The verification analysis is performed for two sets of coefficients (Co')ination 1 and
Co')ination 2) used in two separate analyses. For co')ination 1 the partial factors are
applied to loading actions onl%, the remaining coefficients are set equal to 1,0. For
co')ination 2 the partial factors are applied to 'aterial para'eters @'aterial
para'eters o" soilA and to &aria)le loading actions, the remain coefficients are set equal
to 1,0.
In programs analyzing walls and performing stability analyses the analysis is carried out for
)oth co')inations auto'aticall% and the results are presented for the 'ost se&ere
situation. Detailed description of the results for both combinations is available in the output
protocol.
This approach is not applicable for the "Sheeting Check" program. The combination, for which
the analysis should be carried out, must be selected in the "Settings".
Programs "Spread Footing" and "Pile" need to specify service load even for the bearing
capacity analysis. The design load is adopted with combination 1, the ser&ice load then with
combination 2.
-101-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
+nput of partial factors for design approach 5
$esign approach 2
The design approach 2 applies the partial factors to loading actions and to 'aterial
resistance (bearing capacity).
+nput of partial factors for design approach 0
$esign approach 4
The design approach 3 applies the partial factors to loading actions and at the same type to
'aterial (material parameters of soil).
Contrary to other design approaches it distinguishes geotechnical loads + State G3O
(loading actions caused by soils e.g. earth pressures, pressures due to surcharge, water
action) and loads applied to structures + State S!, (the program considers the self weight
of a structure, inputted forces acting on a structure, anchors, geo-reinforcements, mesh
overhangs). A different set of coefficients, specified in the "Partial factors" dialog window, is
used for each type of loading. Partial factors applied to geotechnical loads are mostly smaller
than those applied to structure loads.
-102-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
+nput of partial factors for design approach 3
.ational Anne @.AA
.ational anne @.AA offers details on how to apply the Eurocode at a national level (in
individual EU countries) and it was usually issued together with ENV of a given country.
The National Annex therefore determines the choice of partial factors at a national level and
the application of design approaches for individual geotechnical tasks. Owing to the fact that
the content of NA remains open in some member countries, national annexes are not
implemented into individual programs for all member countries.
Individual national annexes can be selected from the pre-defined settings available in the
settings administrator and settings list.
New settings can be created by users from the existing ones and in that way to define own
.ational annees.
Partial "actors on water
The partial factor on water action adjusts the magnitude of force due to water action; the
magnitude of pore pressure respectively.
-103-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Partial factors applied to action of water
The partial factor on action of water can be inputted, since EN 1997 offers several ways how to
account for the influence of water. The two basic approaches are:
- 5ariant 1 the coefficient of water action is set to 1." or 1."#, respectively (some NA). In
this case the actual ground water table is considered and its influence is multiplied by the
inputted partial factor.
- 5ariant 2 the coefficient of water action is set to 1.0 or in other words, the action of
water is not considered in the analysis. In this case the maximum allowable ground water
table must be considered.
Partial factors on water
Selection of a particular option for the verification remains upon the user.
Providing the user adopts both options, we recommend introducing two settings in the
"Settings administrator", which differ by the magnitude of the coefficient
$
.
-104-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Settings list $ pre-setting for both ariants of partial factors on water action
Anal%sis o" walls @support structuresA
Analysis based on EN 1997 introduces several partial factors according to the selected Design
approach (DA).
Designing a structure according to EN 1997-1 essentially follows the analysis of limit states.
#oad reduction @$A11 $A21 $A4A:
All design approaches consider partial factors reducing load. These are used to multiply all
forces entering the analysis. For actual verification of individual modes of failure the program
determines, whether the "orce or pressure acts "a&ora)l% or un"a&ora)l%. Depending on
that these actions are then multiplied by the corresponding partial factor. Information
regarding the applied partial factors is stored in the analysis protocol.
,nal#sis protocol
The frame analysis allows for defining "Secondar% &aria)le actions" corresponding partial
factors are then multipied by combination coefficients of load.
When analyzing supporting structures, the water actions and thus also the determination of
the corresponding partial factor for water become very important.
,eduction o" 'aterial @$A11 $A4A;
Soil parameters are automatically reduced by corresponding partial factors.
,eduction o" resistance @$A2A;
Corresponding magnitudes of resistant forces, moments and bearing capacities are reduced.
When performing the analysis according to the Design approach 1, all verifications are carried
out twice for both combinations of load. For a given limit state the highest stressed design is
displayed on the desktop.
-105-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Anal%sis o" sheeting structures
Analysis based on EN 1997 introduces several partial factors according to the selected Design
approach (DP).
Designing a structure according to EN 1997-1 essentially follows the analysis of limit states.
#oad reduction @$A11 $A21 $A4A;
In programs that consider the overall earth pressure in the analysis (3arth Pressure1
Sheeting $esign1 Sheeting Check) the partial factors are used to multiply individual
components of pressure acting on a structure.
The basic assumption of the analysis is that the acti&e earth pressure acts un"a&ora)l%
whereas the passi&e earth pressure is considered as "a&ora)le. Individual pressure
diagrams are therefore multiplied by the corresponding partial factor.
,eduction o" 'aterial @$A11 $A4A;
Parameters of soils are automatically reduced by the corresponding partial factors.
,eduction o" resistance @$A2A; is considered. Partial factor on resistance reduce the
passive earth pressure in front of structure.
In simple words, DA1 Combination 2, DA2 and DA3 increase the 'agnitude o" acti&e
pressure and reduce the 'agnitude o" passi&e pressure, while DA1 combination 1 only
increases the 'agnitude o" acti&e pressure.
This approach may therefore change in so'e cases the structure )eha&ior and deliver
'isleading results. Caution must therefore be exercised when reducing input parameters.
6esponse of sheeting structure upon unloading
Anal%sis o" "oundations @spread "ooting1 pilesA
Analysis based on EN 1997 introduces several partial factors according to the selected Design
approach (DP).
Designing a structure according to EN 1997-1 essentially follows the analysis of limit states.
#oad reduction @$A11 $A21 $A4A;
Loading on foundation is taken as a result of the analysis of upper structure.
- load cases are determined according to rules provided by EN 1990:2002
- combinations of load cases are calculated according to EN 1991
-106-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The results of calculated combinations then serve as an input into programs Spread "ooting
and Pile.
Either design (bearing capacity analysis, dimensioning of footing) or ser&ice (analysis of
settlement) load is considered. In the Design approach 1, the analysis is performed for both
the inputted design load (combination 1) and inputted service load (combination 2).
Only the structure sel"6weigh or the weight o" soil a)o&e "ooting is multiplied by the
partial factors in the program. The specified design load must be determined in accord with the
3. 1DDF and 3. 1DD1 standards individual components of load must be 'ultiplied by the
corresponding partial factors the progra' does not change the inputted load an%
"urther.
,eduction o" 'aterial @$A11 $A4A;
Parameters of soils are automatically reduced by the corresponding partial factors.
,eduction o" load @$A2A1 "or piles @$A11 $A21 $A4A;
The program "Pile" assumes partial factors being dependent on the type of pile ()ored1
dri&en1 CFA). The window serves to define all partial factors. The analysis then adopts partial
factors depending on the type of pile selected in the frame "Geo'etr%". Verification of the
tensile pile always considers the pile self weight. For the co'pressi&e pile the pile self
weight can be neglected depending on the setting in the frame "#oad". The actual verification
analysis is performed according to the theory of limit states.
Vertical and horizontal bearing capacity of foundation is reduced in the "Spread Footing"
program.
Slope sta)ilit% anal%sis
Analysis based on EN 1997 introduces several partial factors according to the selected Design
approach (DP).
Designing a structure according to EN 1997-1 essentially follows the analysis of limit states.
#oad reduction @$A11 $A21 $A4A;
Loads acting on a strip are reduced in the analysis by partial factors. Depending on the
inclination of the slip surface the program evaluates whether the gra&it% "orce acting on a
given block is favorable or not. If the favorable action of force is greater than the unfavorable
one, the program adopts the favorable coefficient. Based on that the weight of block % is pre-
multiplied by the partial factor for the permanent load.
Action o" water is reduced by the partial factor, which multiplies the resulting pore pressure
and forces due to unconfined water above terrain.
-107-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Determining whether the force action is faorable or not
For inputted surcharges the program first evaluates whether these act favorably or not and
then pre-multiplies the o&erall loading by the corresponding partial factor.
,eduction o" 'aterial @$A11 $A4A;
Parameters of soils are automatically reduced by the corresponding partial factors.
,eduction o" resistance @$A2A;
Resistance on a slip surface is reduced.
(A,.I.G G
GG
Calculation o" slope sta)ilit% according to $A2 or $A1 @co')0 1A using
total para'eters gi&es &er% unrealistic results. These are caused by a
different reduction of the self-weight of massive (favorable and unfavorable). If
adopting the above mentioned approaches we reco''end to 'anuall% ad8ust
the partial "actors (i.e. increase the partial factor on resistance on the slip
surface and decrease partial factors on load actions).
#oad co')inations
Actions of loads that act simultaneously are introduced into the analysis with the help of load
combinations defined in 3. 1DDF Basis o" Structural $esign. Most of the loads are
considered as permanent. Surcharges and inputted forces can be specified as variable loading.
The program automatically determines the values of individual partial factors depending on
whether a given load acts in favor or unfavorably.
By default the variable loadings are considered as pri'ar%. Nevertheless, the "5eri"ication"
and "$i'ensions" frames allow for specifying the variable loads as secondar% such a load
is then pre-multiplied by the corresponding coefficient reducing its magnitude. Providing that
all loads are considered in the basic combination as secondary the program prompts a warning
and the verification is not accepted.
Four types of combinations can be specified in the frame "Stage settings":
Persistent and transient design situation;
where: &
k,'
-
characteristic value of '
th
permanent loading

&,'
-
partial factor of '
th
permanent loading
(
k,)
-
characteristic value of secondary )
th
variable loading
(
k,1
-characteristic value of primary variable loading

(,)
-
partial factor of )
th
variable loading
*
0
-factor for quasi-permanent value of variable loading
Accidental design situation;
where: &
k,'
-
characteristic value of '
th
permanent loading
(
k,1
- characteristic value of primary variable loading
-108-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
*
1,)
- factor for frequent value of variable loading
*
2,)
- factor for combination value of variable loading
+
,
- design value of extreme loading
Seis'ic design situation;
where: &
k,'
-
characteristic value of '
th
permanent loading
(
k,)
-
characteristic value of secondary '
th
variable loading
*
2,)
-factor for quasi-permanent value of variable loading
+
-,
-design value of seismic loading
#oad partial "actors and co')ination coe""icients are introduced in the "Partial factors"
dialog window.
+nput of secondar# loads
Anal%sis according to #,F$
When performing the analysis according to LRFD (#oad ,esistance $esign Factor) we follow
the theory of limit states.
The analysis according to LRFD introduces two types of design coefficients:
- coefficients modifying the load magnitude (#oad "actors)
- coefficients reducing the soil resistance (,esistance "actors)
The program allows for two variants of the analysis, according to LRFD 2003 or LRFD 2012.
#,F$ 2FF4 is implemented in the program to perform:
- Analysis of walls support structures
- Analysis of foundations
#,F$ 2F12 is implemented in the program to perform:
- Analysis of walls (support structures)
-109-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- Analysis of foundations
- Slope stability analysis
#,F$ 2F12 introduces new types of design situations (Strength I, Service I, Extreme I).
#,F$ 2FF4 6 Anal%sis o" walls @support structuresA
Analysis according to LRFD introduces two types of design coefficients coefficients modifying
the load magnitude (#oad "actors) and coefficients reducing the soil resistance (,esistance
"actors).
,nal#sis based on 36FD 0113 $ +nput of partial coefficients for wall anal#sis
When checking individual cases of failure the program determines, whether the "orce or
pressure act "a&ora)l% or not and then pre-multiplies the force by the corresponding partial
factor. The overall resistance of a structure against failure is in the final verification pre-
multiplied by the corresponding resistance factor.
In case of supporting structures, information about the applied design factors is listed in the
analysis protocol.
-110-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
,nal#sis protocol
#,F$ 2FF4 6 Anal%sis o" "oundations
Analysis according to LRFD introduces two types of design coefficients coefficients modifying
the load magnitude (#oad "actors) and coefficients reducing the soil resistance (,esistance
"actors).
In the program the partial factors are used to pre-multiply the "ooting sel"6weight and the
weight o" soil a)o&e the "ooting @o&er)urdenA only. Individual components of loading
must be pre6'ultiplied by the corresponding partial factors the program does not modify
the inputted load any further.
When performing the final verification the overall resistance of the structure against failure is
multiplied by the corresponding resistance factor.
,nal#sis based on 36FD 0113 $ input of partial factors for foundations
#,F$ 2F12 6 $esign situations
For the analysis of support structures (walls), foundations, and slope stability the LRFD 2012
-111-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
introduces the following design situations:
- Strength I: : the basic design situation that reduces the structure resistance and the
magnitude of load.
- Ser&ice I: this design situation assumes for most cases the partial factors (load,
resistance reduction) equal to 1,0.
- 3tre'e I: this design situation assumes for most cases the partial factors of resistance
reduction equal to 1,0.
The type of design situation is selected in the "Stage settings" frame. The values of partial
factors (load, resistance reduction) can be modified in the "Settings" frame.
36FD 0150 - Selection of design situation
,nal#sis based on 36FD 0150 $ input of partial factors
-112-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
#,F$ 2F12 6 Anal%sis o" walls @support structuresA
Analysis according to LRFD introduces two types of design coefficients coefficients modifying
the load magnitude (#oad "actors) and coefficients reducing the soil resistance (,esistance
"actors).
These coefficients enter the analysis according to the selected design situation.
When evaluating individual cases of failure, the program determines, whether the "orce or
pressure acts "a&ora)l% or un"a&ora)l%. It is then multiplied by the corresponding partial
factor.
When performing the final verification the overall resistance of the structure against failure is
multiplied by the corresponding resistance factor.
,nal#sis based on 36FD 0150 - input of partial factors for wall anal#sis
For support structures (walls) the information about the applied design factors are provided in
the analysis protocol.
-113-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
,nal#sis protocol
#,F$ 2F12 6 Anal%sis o" "oundations
Analysis according to LRFD introduces two types of design coefficients coefficients modifying
the load magnitude (#oad "actors) and coefficients reducing the soil resistance (,esistance
"actors).
These coefficients enter the analysis according to the selected design situation.
Partial factors for loading are used to multiply the "oundation sel" weight and the weight o"
soil a)o&e "oundation @o&er)urdenA only. Individual components of loading must be
'ultiplied by corresponding partial factors the inputted load is not adjusted by the program
in anyway.
When performing the final verification the overall resistance of the structure against failure is
multiplied by the corresponding resistance factor.
,nal#sis based on 36FD 0150 $ input of partial factors for foundations
-114-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
#,F$ 2F12 6 Anal%sis o" slope sta)ilit%
Analysis according to LRFD introduces two types of design coefficients coefficients modifying
the load magnitude (#oad "actors) and coefficients reducing the soil resistance (,esistance
"actors).
These coefficients enter the analysis according to the selected design situation.
The inputted loads are checked, whether they act favorably or unfavorably. The surcharge
'agnitude is then multiplied by the corresponding partial factor for loading (3S or ##,
respectively).
,esistance reduction @,esistance "actorsA;
The overall resistance on slip surface is reduced by the .
SS
partial factor. The following the
condition on the slip surface must be satisfied when evaluating the safety:
where: .
SS
- resistance factor on stability
F
pas
- resisting (passive) forces acting on slip surface
F
act
- active forces acting on slip surface
,nal#sis based on 36FD 0150 $ input of partial factors for stabilit# anal#ses
$esign situations
The programs allow for defining four design situations, which may differ by the analysis
coefficients. These are:
- Per'anent design situation most common situation and type of verification, adopted
when proving the safe design of a structure for the assumed lifetime.
- !ransient design situation can be used for temporary structures (construction
stages). Typically, lower safety is required in comparison to the permanent design
situation.
- Accidental design situation adopted for extraordinary loads (e.g. blast, vehicle
impact, flood, fire, etc.). The values of partial factors are typically equal to one.
-115-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- Seis'ic design situation applied to the analysis of earthquake. It might seem similar
to the accidental design situation, but for earthquake is sometimes required a higher
safety. In some countries the required safety is even the same as for the permanent
design situation.
Safety coefficients and partial factors are specified in the analysis settings.
The corresponding design situation for a given construction stage is selected in the frame
"Stage settings".
Selection of design situation
Input regi'es and anal%sis
This capture contains basic description of individual regimes of inputting data into the
program:
Progra' 3arth Pressure
Pro8ect
The "Pro8ect" frame is used to input the basic project data and to specify the overall setting of
the analysis run. The frame contains an input form to introduce the basic data about the
analyzed task, i.e. project information, project description, date, etc. This information is
further used in text and graphical outputs.
The frame also allows the user to switch analysis units (metric / imperial).
Frame "Pro'ect"
-116-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Settings
The frame "Settings" serves to introduce the basic "Settings" of the program such as
standards and theories of analyses, the way of proving safety of a structure and individual
coefficients of the analysis.
The programs contain not only the pre-defined )asic Settings for individual countries, but
also allow the user to create their own user6de"ined Settings, which can be subsequently
used in all GEO5 programs.
The "Select" button enables to choose an already created Setting from the "Settings list".
The "Settings Ad'inistrator" button opens the "Administrator" dialogue window, which
allows for viewing and modifying individual Setting. One may also identify the visible settings
in the Settings list. Data in the Settings administrator can be also eported and i'ported.
The "Add to the ad'inistrator" button allows for creating user-defined Settings, which are
subsequently added to the Settings administrator.
The "/odi"%" button enables a quick visualization and editing of the current Setting in the
opened program. Modifying any of the parameters changes the title to "Inputted "or the
current task". Individual analyses are then performed with this local setting. Should we
consider this setting as suitable also for other tasks, we add the setting into the "Settings
ad'inistrator" by pressing the "Add to the ad'inistrator" button.
The "Inputted "or the current task" setting is usually created when importing older data.
Settings of analysis parameters are performed in the "Materials and standards" and
"Excavations" tab sheets.
Frame "Settings"
Geo'etr%
The "Geo'etr%" frame contains table listing the points of a structure. Adding (editing) points
is performed in the "Add @editA point" dialog window.
The existing geometry points can be further edited on the desktop with the help of active
objects double clicking on a selected point opens a dialog window to edit the point.
The program makes it possible to export the geometry of a structure in the *.DXF format.
-117-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ")eometr#"
Pro"ile
The "Pro"ile" frame contains a table with a list of inputted interfaces. After specifying
interfaces it is possible to edit thicknesses of individual layers with the help of active
dimensions.
Adding (editing) layer is performed in the "Add @editA inter"ace" dialog window. The /-
coordinate measured from the top point of a structure is specified (/-axis).
The program allows for raising or lowering the top point of a structure in the "Change o"
terrain ele&ation" dialog window so that the whole interface can be translated while keeping
the thicknesses of individual layers. This function is important when copying the profile from
program "!errain".
The program makes it possible to import a profile in the gINT format.
-118-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Profile"
Soils
The "Soils" frame contains a table with a list of inputted soils. The table also provides
information about currently selected soil displayed in the right part of the frame.
Adding (editing) a soil is performed in the "Add (edit) soil" dialog window.
The soil characteristics needed in the program are further specified in the following chapters:
"Basic data", "Earth pressure at rest" and "Uplift pressure".
The program makes it possible import soils in the gINT format.
-119-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Soils"
Basic data
This part of the window serves to introduce basic parameters of soils unit weight1 angle o"
internal "riction and cohesion. The particular values are obtained from geotechnical survey
or from laboratory experiments. If these data are not available, it is possible to exploit built-in
database of soils, which contains values of selected characteristics of soils.
Either e""ecti&e or total parameters of the angle of internal friction and cohesion are specified
depending on the setting in the "Stress anal%sis" combo list. Whether to use effective or total
parameters depends primarily on the type of soil, type of loading, structure duration and water
conditions.
For effective stress further needs to specify the angle of internal friction between the soil and
structure, which depends on the structure material and the type of soil. Possible values of this
parameter are listed in the table of recommended values.
For total stress further needs to specify the adhesion of soil to the structure face a.
The associated theory is described in detail in chapter "Earth pressures".
-120-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ",dd new soils" - "@asic data"
Assign
The "Assign" frame contains a list of layers of profile and associated soils. The list of soils is
graphically represented using buttons in the bar above the table, or is accessible from a combo
list for each layer of the profile.
The procedure to assign soil into a layer is described in detail herein.
The program makes it possible to import soil assignment in the gINT format.
-121-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",ssign"
!errain
The "!errain" frame allows, by pressing the button, for specifying the terrain shape. The
selected shape with graphic hint ("Chart o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in
the left part of the frame. The terrain shape can be edited either in the frame by inserting
values into input fields, or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
The last option to choose from is a general shape of a terrain. In this case the frame contains a
table with a list of terrain points. The first point with coordinates [0,0] coincides with the top
point of a structure.
Analysis of earth pressures in case of inclined terrain is described in the theoretical part of the
help "Distribution of earth pressures for broken terrain".
-122-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Terrain"
(ater
The "(ater" frame allows, by pressing the button, for selecting the type of water. The selected
type together with a graphic hint ("Chart o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in
the left part of the frame. Water parameters (h
1
, h
2
...) can be edited either in the frame by
inserting values into input fields, or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
The last option is a manual input of pore pressure both in front and behind the structure. Two
tab sheets "In "ront o" structure" and "Behind structure" appear with tables. The table is
filled with values of pore pressure in front, or behind the structure at a depth of "/" (/-axis).
The ground water table can also be specified a)o&e the structure or earth profile,
respectively in such a case the depth of water is inputted with a negative value.
Analysis of earth pressures with influence of water is described in the theoretical part of the
hint chapter "Influence of water".
The program further allows for specifying a depth of tensile cracks filled with water.
-123-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "%ater"
Surcharge
The "Surcharge" frame contains a table with a list of inputted surcharges. Adding (editing)
surcharge is performed in the ".ew @editA surcharge" dialog window. The inputted
surcharges can be edited on the desktop with the help of active dimensions or active objects,
respectively.
The /-coordinate measured from the top point of a structure is specified (positive direction
downwards) when inputting the surcharge at a certain depth. Providing the surcharge is found
off the terrain the computer prompts an error message.
Either per'anent or &aria)le surcharge can be introduced. Selecting the particular type of
surcharge also renders the corresponding design coefficient to multiply the resulting loading
action. Favorably acting variable surcharge is not considered in the program.
Analysis of earth pressures due to surcharges is described in the theoretical part of the hint,
chapter "Influence of surcharge".
-124-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Surcharge"
3arthHuake
The "3arthHuake" frame serves to input earthquake parameters. Directions of inputted
earthquake effects are displayed on the desktop.
If not provided by measurements the coefficients k
h
and k
0
can be calculated following the
approach adopted from EN 1998-5.
Analysis of earth pressures while accounting for earthquake is described in the theoretical part
of the hint in chapter "Influence earthquake".
-125-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "(arthAua9e"
Stage settings
The frame "Stage settings" serves to input settings valid for a given construction stage.
Selected design situation determines the safety coefficients to be used in the analysis of a
given construction stage.
The frame view depends on the selected verification methodology. LRFD 2012 introduces new
types of design situations (Strength I, Ser&ice I, 3tre'e I).
Frame "Stage settings"
Anal%sis
The frame "Anal%sis" shows the analysis results. Several computations can be carried out for
a single task.
-126-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The frame appearance is adjusted based on the selected verification methodology:
- Verification according to the factor of safety, or the theory of limit states the column F in
the table allows for inputting the design coefficients, which multiply the calculated forces.
These forces are displayed on the desktop and are updated for every change of data and
setting in the frame.
- Analysis according to EN 1997 the column G in the table allows for specifying whether
the loading acting on a structure is considered as secondary one. This is explained in more
detail in section "Load combinations". Providing the analysis is carried out according to
"Design approach 1", it is necessary to enter the combination number in the right part of
the window.
- Analysis according to LRFD in the case the column F is not displayed.
The "Anal%sis" frame displays the analysis results. The frame serves to select type of
computed earth pressure (active pressure, pressure at rest, passive pressure). Two options
"Create soil wedge" and "Minimum dimensioning pressure" are available when computing the
active earth pressure.
The analysis results are displayed on the desktop and are updated immediately for an arbitrary
change in input data or setting. Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization
style settings" dialog window.
Frame ",nal#sis"
Progra' Sheeting $esign
Pro8ect
The "Pro8ect" frame is used to input the basic project data and to specify the overall setting of
-127-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
the analysis run. The frame contains an input form to introduce the basic data about the
analyzed task, i.e. project information, project description, date, etc. This information is
further used in text and graphical outputs.
The frame also allows the user to switch analysis units (metric / imperial).
Frame "Pro'ect"
Settings
The frame "Settings" serves to introduce the basic "Settings" of the program such as
standards and theories of analyses, the way of proving safety of a structure and individual
coefficients of the analysis.
The programs contain not only the pre-defined )asic Settings for individual countries, but
also allow the user to create their own user6de"ined Settings, which can be subsequently
used in all GEO5 programs.
The "Select" button enables to choose an already created Setting from the "Settings list".
The "Settings Ad'inistrator" button opens the "Administrator" dialogue window, which
allows for viewing and modifying individual Setting. One may also identify the visible settings
in the Settings list. Data in the Settings administrator can be also eported and i'ported.
The "Add to the ad'inistrator" button allows for creating user-defined Settings, which are
subsequently added to the Settings administrator.
The "/odi"%" button enables a quick visualization and editing of the current Setting in the
opened program. Modifying any of the parameters changes the title to "Inputted "or the
current task". Individual analyses are then performed with this local setting. Should we
consider this setting as suitable also for other tasks, we add the setting into the "Settings
ad'inistrator" by pressing the "Add to the ad'inistrator" button.
The "Inputted "or the current task" setting is usually created when importing older data.
Settings of analysis parameters are performed in the "Excavations" tab sheet.
-128-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Settings"
Pro"ile
The "Pro"ile" frame contains a table with a list of inputted interfaces. After specifying
interfaces it is possible to edit thicknesses of individual layers with the help of active
dimensions.
Adding (editing) layer is performed in the "Add @editA inter"ace" dialog window. The /-
coordinate measured from the top point of a structure is specified (/-axis).
The program allows for raising or lowering the top point of a structure in the "Change o"
terrain ele&ation" dialog window so that the whole interface can be translated while keeping
the thicknesses of individual layers. This function is important when copying the profile from
program "!errain".
The program makes it possible to import a profile in the gINT format.
-129-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Profile"
Soils
The "Soils" frame contains a table with a list of inputted soils. The table also provides
information about currently selected soil displayed in the right part of the frame.
Adding (editing) a soil is performed in the "Add (edit) soil" dialog window.
The soil characteristics needed in the program are further specified in the following chapters:
"Basic data" and "Uplift pressure".
The program makes it possible import soils in the gINT format.
-130-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Soils"
Basic data
This part of the window serves to introduce basic parameters of soils unit weight1 angle o"
internal "riction and cohesion. The particular values are obtained from geotechnical survey
or from laboratory experiments. If these data are not available, it is possible to exploit built-in
database of soils, which contains values of selected characteristics of soils.
Either e""ecti&e or total parameters of the angle of internal friction and cohesion are specified
depending on the setting in the "Stress anal%sis" combo list. Whether to use effective or total
parameters depends primarily on the type of soil, type of loading, structure duration and water
conditions.
For effective stress further needs to specify the angle of internal friction between the soil and
structure, which depends on the structure material and the type of soil. Possible values of this
parameter are listed in the table of recommended values.
For total stress further needs to specify the adhesion of soil to the structure face a.
The associated theory is described in detail in chapter "Earth pressures".
-131-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ",dd new soils" - "@asic data"
Assign
The "Assign" frame contains a list of layers of profile and associated soils. The list of soils is
graphically represented using buttons in the bar above the table, or is accessible from a combo
list for each layer of the profile.
The procedure to assign soil into a layer is described in detail herein.
The program makes it possible to import soil assignment in the gINT format.
-132-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",ssign"
Geo'etr%
The "Geo'etr%" frame is used to specify the depth of a construction ditch and by pressing the
button to choose the shape of a bottom. The selected shape with a graphic hint ("Para'eter
chart") appears in the left part of the frame. The dimensions of a structure can be edited
either in the frame by inserting values into input fields, or on the desktop with the help of
active dimensions.
The frame can be further used to input surcharge of a construction ditch bottom and coefficient
of reduction of earth pressure below the ditch bottom (this coefficient serves to analyze braced
sheeting).
The program makes it possible to export the geometry of a structure in the *.DXF format.
-133-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ")eometr#"
Anchors
The "Anchors" frame contains a table with a list of inputted anchors. Adding (editing) anchors
is performed in the ".ew anchor @3dit anchorA" dialog window. The inputted anchors can be
edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
-134-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",nchors"
Props
The "Props" frame contains a table with a list inputted props. Adding (editing) props is
performed in the ".ew prop @3dit propA" dialog window. The inputted props can also be
edited on the desktop with the help of active dimensions or active objects, respectively.
-135-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Props"
Supports
The "Supports" frame contains a table with a list of inputted supports. Adding (editing)
supports is performed in the ".ew support @3dit supportA" dialog window. The inputted
supports can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active dimensions or active
objects, respectively.
-136-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Supports"
Pressure deter'ination
The "Pressure speci"ication" frame allows by pressing the button "Anal%-e" ("Input",
respectively) for selecting a method for the calculation of active earth pressure. Choose option
"Anal%-e" if you wish the active earth pressure to be computed automatically based on
specified earth profile.
In some special cases (redistribution of earth pressures due to presence of anchors,
nonstandard rotation of a structure) it advisable to specify the distribution of earth pressure on
a structure manually. Selecting the option "Input" opens a table in the frame with a list of
inputted points and the corresponding pressure value. The pressure is specified up to the
depth of structure increased by the depth of zero point (the depth of zero point is introduced in
the top part of the frame). The depth of zero point equal to zero is selected if we wish to
specify the pressure values only up to the depth of construction ditch. Below the ditch the
programs computes the pressure values based on the specified geological profile. Providing the
earth pressure is specified manually the program does not account for the influence of terrain
profile, surcharge and water.
-137-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Pressure determination"
!errain
The "!errain" frame allows, by pressing the button, for specifying the terrain shape. The
selected shape with graphic hint ("Chart o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in
the left part of the frame. The terrain shape can be edited either in the frame by inserting
values into input fields, or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
The last option to choose from is a general shape of a terrain. In this case the frame contains a
table with a list of terrain points. The first point with coordinates [0,0] coincides with the top
point of a structure.
Analysis of earth pressures in case of inclined terrain is described in the theoretical part of the
hint, chapter "Distribution of earth pressures for broken terrain".
-138-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Terrain"
(ater
The "(ater" frame allows, by pressing the button, for selecting the type of water. The selected
type together with a graphic hint ("Chart o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in
the left part of the frame. Water parameters (h
1
, h
2
...) can be edited either in the frame by
inserting values into input fields, or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
The ground water table can also be specified a)o&e the structure or earth profile,
respectively in such a case the depth of water is inputted with a negative value.
Analysis of earth pressures with influence of water is described in the theoretical part of the
hint chapter "Influence of water".
The program further allows for specifying a depth of tensile cracks filled with water.
-139-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "%ater"
Surcharge
The "Surcharge" frame contains a table with a list of inputted surcharges. Adding (editing)
surcharge is performed in the ".ew @editA surcharge" dialog window. The inputted
surcharges can be edited on the desktop with the help of active dimensions or active objects,
respectively.
The /-coordinate measured from the top point of a structure is specified (positive direction
downwards) when inputting the surcharge at a certain depth. Providing the surcharge is found
off the terrain the computer prompts an error message.
Either per'anent or &aria)le surcharge can be introduced. Selecting the particular type of
surcharge also renders the corresponding design coefficient to multiply the resulting loading
action. Favorably acting variable surcharge is not considered in the program.
Analysis of earth pressures due to surcharges is described in the theoretical part of the hint,
chapter "Influence of surcharge".
-140-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Surcharge"
Applied "orces
The "Applied "orces" frame contains a table with a list of forces acting on a structure. Adding
(editing) forces is performed in the ".ew "orce @edit "orceA" dialog window. The inputted
forces can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
Applied "orces represent an additional load on the structure of the wall, sheeting or MSE wall.
We can model such as an anchoring crash barrier, crash vehicle, load from billboards and
hoardings etc. Program doesn`t adjust the applied forces in the calculation.
External load acting to the ground surface is necessary to define as surcharge.
-141-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",pplied forces"
3arthHuake
The "3arthHuake" frame serves to input earthquake parameters. Directions of inputted
earthquake effects are displayed on the desktop.
If not provided by measurements the coefficients k
h
and k
0
can be calculated following the
approach adopted from EN 1998-5.
Analysis of earth pressures while accounting for earthquake is described in the theoretical part
of the hint in chapter "Influence earthquake".
-142-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "(arthAua9e"
Stage settings
The frame "Stage settings" serves to input settings valid for a given construction stage.
Selected design situation determines the safety coefficients to be used in the analysis of a
given construction stage.
The frame view depends on the selected verification methodology. LRFD 2012 introduces new
types of design situations (Strength I, Ser&ice I, 3tre'e I).
Frame "Stage settings"
Anal%sis
The "Anal%sis" frame displays the analysis results. The analysis is carried out by pressing the
"Anal%-e" button in the right part of the frame. The frame has two variants. The first variant
-143-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
applies to a wall free of anchors (sheet pile) and the second one to an anchored (strutted)
wall.
A coefficient of reduction of passive earth pressure (or factor of safety) together with a choice
whether to consider a minimal dimensioning pressure behind the structure is specified for a
non-anchored wall.
A type of heel support (fixed, free) and analysis parameters (coefficient of reduction of passive
pressure, minimum dimensioning pressure) are specified for an anchored wall.
When performing the analysis according to EN 1997 or LRFD the design coefficients are
introduced in the "Excavations" Providing the analysis is carried out according to Design
approach 1, it is necessary to also enter the combination number.
The analysis results are displayed on the desktop. Visualization of results can be adjusted in
the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame ",nal#sis" - non-anchored wall
-144-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",nal#sis" - anchored wall
Sta)ilit%
The "Sta)ilit%" frame serves to evaluate the external stability of a structure employing the
"Slope sta)ilit%" program. This frame is used to introduce the geometry of a structure -
"$epth o" cross section" and "#ength o" the structure )elow the ditch", for anchored
walls the corresponding "Anchor "orce" should also be specified.
Pressing the "Sta)ilit%" button launches the "Slope sta)ilit%" program. This program then
allows us to check the overall stability of the analyzed structure. The button is available only if
the program "Slope sta)ilit%" is installed.
After completing all analyses press the "O7" button to leave the program all data are then
carried over to the analysis protocol of the "Sheeting design" program.
-145-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Stabilit#"
-146-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Program "Slope stabilit#"
Progra' Sheeting Check
Pro8ect
The "Pro8ect" frame is used to input the basic project data and to specify the overall setting of
the analysis run. The frame contains an input form to introduce the basic data about the
analyzed task, i.e. project information, project description, date, etc. This information is
further used in text and graphical outputs.
The frame also allows the user to switch analysis units (metric / imperial).
Frame "Pro'ect"
Settings
The frame "Settings" serves to introduce the basic "Settings" of the program such as
standards and theories of analyses, the way of proving safety of a structure and individual
coefficients of the analysis.
The programs contain not only the pre-defined )asic Settings for individual countries, but
also allow the user to create their own user6de"ined Settings, which can be subsequently
used in all GEO5 programs.
The "Select" button enables to choose an already created Setting from the "Settings list".
The "Settings Ad'inistrator" button opens the "Administrator" dialogue window, which
allows for viewing and modifying individual Setting. One may also identify the visible settings
in the Settings list. Data in the Settings administrator can be also eported and i'ported.
The "Add to the ad'inistrator" button allows for creating user-defined Settings, which are
subsequently added to the Settings administrator.
The "/odi"%" button enables a quick visualization and editing of the current Setting in the
opened program. Modifying any of the parameters changes the title to "Inputted "or the
current task". Individual analyses are then performed with this local setting. Should we
consider this setting as suitable also for other tasks, we add the setting into the "Settings
ad'inistrator" by pressing the "Add to the ad'inistrator" button.
The "Inputted "or the current task" setting is usually created when importing older data.
Settings of analysis parameters are performed in the "Materials and standards" and
"Excavations" tab sheets.
-147-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
When performing the analysis according to EN 1997 or according to the theory of limit states
the program enables to set whether to reduce the soil parameters for the calculation of limit
pressures. When modeling a real behavior of the structure we recommend not to reduce these
pressures.
The frame allows the user to specify subdivision of a wall in to finite elements (by default the
number of elements equals to 20) and the specify whether the structure is loaded by the
minimum dimensioning pressure.
Frame "Settings"
Pro"ile
The "Pro"ile" frame contains a table with a list of inputted interfaces. After specifying
interfaces it is possible to edit thicknesses of individual layers with the help of active
dimensions.
Adding (editing) layer is performed in the "Add @editA inter"ace" dialog window. The /-
coordinate measured from the top point of a structure is specified (/-axis).
The program allows for raising or lowering the top point of a structure in the "Change o"
terrain ele&ation" dialog window so that the whole interface can be translated while keeping
the thicknesses of individual layers. This function is important when copying the profile from
program "!errain".
The program makes it possible to import a profile in the gINT format.
-148-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The frame "Profile"
/odulus o" su)soil reaction
This frame serves to specify a type of analysis for computation of the modulus of subsoil
reaction, which is an important input parameter when analyzing a structure using the method
of dependent pressures.
The program makes it possible to input the distribution of the modulus of subsoil reaction
(along the length of a structure, as a soil parameter), iterate from soil material parameters, or
to compute it. The modulus of subsoil reaction can be either linear or nonlinear.
Selecting the option of modulus of subsoil reaction "anal%-e 6 /Inard" and definition of
Mnard modulus -
m
with the option "input pressio'eter test" is then specified an evaluation
of pressiometric tests in the frame "Pressio'etric tests".
Selecting the option "Input )% distri)ution" opens a table in the frame that allows for
specifying the values of the modulus of subsoil reaction both in front and behind the structure.
When selecting other options the required information needed to compute the modulus value
are inputted as soil parameters in the frame "Soils".
-149-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Modulus of subsoil reaction"
Pressio'etric tests
The frame "Pressio'etric tests" contains a table with list of inputted pressiometric tests.
Individual parameters of the test are defined in the ".ew test" ("3dit test") dialog window.
The "Add" button in this dialogue window opens another ".ew test" ("3dit test") dialogue
window, which allows for specifying the depth / measured from the terrain level, and the
Mnard modulus -
m
. These parameters are explained in more detail in the theoretical part.
User can change entered values in dialog window "3dit test". Inserting values between
already entered values is realized in dialog window "Inserted test".
The results of pressiometric tests can also be imported in the *.TXT format.
-150-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Pressiometric tests"
-151-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ".ew test"
Soils
The "Soils" frame contains a table with a list of inputted soils. The table also provides
information about currently selected soil displayed in the right part of the frame.
Adding (editing) a soil is performed in the "Add (edit) soil" dialog window.
The soil characteristics needed in the program are further specified in the following chapters:
"Basic data", "Earth pressure at rest", "Uplift pressure" and "Modulus of subsoil reaction".
The program makes it possible to import soils in the gINT format.
-152-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Soils"
Basic data
This part of the window serves to introduce basic parameters of soils unit weight1 angle o"
internal "riction and cohesion. The particular values are obtained from geotechnical survey
or from laboratory experiments. If these data are not available, it is possible to exploit built-in
database of soils, which contains values of selected characteristics of soils.
Either e""ecti&e or total parameters of the angle of internal friction and cohesion are specified
depending on the setting in the "Stress anal%sis" combo list. Whether to use effective or total
parameters depends primarily on the type of soil, type of loading, structure duration and water
conditions.
For effective stress further needs to specify the angle of internal friction between the soil and
structure, which depends on the structure material and the type of soil. Possible values of this
parameter are listed in the table of recommended values.
For total stress further needs to specify the adhesion of soil to the structure face a.
The associated theory is described in detail in chapter "Earth pressures".
-153-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ",dd new soils" - "@asic data"
Geo'etr%
The "Geo'etr%" frame contains a table with a list of inputted structural sections forming the
sheeting wall. For each section the table stores its cross-sectional characteristics (+ area, 1
Moment of inertia) and material characteristics (- Modulus of elasticity, & Shear modulus
these variables are always expressed with respect to 1m of a construction length). Adding
(editing) sections is performed in the "New section (Edit section)" dialog window.
The program allows for adding (inserting) another section in between two already existing
sections of a structure. Inserting a new section is performed in the "Insert section" dialog
window that complies with the "New section" dialog window. The inserted section is ordered
such as to precede the currently selected section of a structure.
The inputted sections can be further edited on the desktop with the help of active objects
double clicking on a structure opens a dialog window with a given section.
-154-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The program makes it possible to export the geometry of a structure in the *.DXF format.
Frame ")eometr#"
Adding and editing section
The ".ew section @3dit section1 Inserted sectionA" dialog window contains the following
items:
!%pe o" wall - combo list containing individual types of walls to create a
sheeting (pile wall, reinforced concrete rectangular wall, sheet
pile wall, steel I cross-section, or own generation of desired
cross-sectional characteristics
Section length - use input field to specify length of sheeting wall or length of a
given section of a structure, respectively
Coe""0 o" reduc0 o"
earth press0 )elow
ditch )otto'
- coefficient allowing for computation of braced sheeting (for
classical sheeting is set equal to one)
Geo'etr% - contains information about geometry for a given structural
variant (e.g., for pile wall it contains pile cross-section and
spacing of piles, for reinforced concrete wall its thickness, etc.)
Pro"ile - contains information about profile for the selected structural
variant "Steel I6section" (buttons "Catalog" and "3dit" open
the ",olled section steel pro"iles", which contains a list of
these cross-sections)
/aterial - contains information about material of a given structural variant
(e.g., for pile wall it contains a catalog of materials to select the
type of concrete, for sheet pile wall the elastic modulus, etc.)
-155-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
In"or'ation - contains overview of cross-sectional characteristics of the
inputted cross-section area and moment of inertia are always
evaluated for 1m of length in out of plane direction
The "User catalog" button in the bottom part of the window opens the "User catalog" dialog
window.
Dialog window ".ew section"
User catalog
The user catalog allows the user to define and store own cross-sections and their
characteristics that appear in the construction of a wall. At first use of the catalog (has not
been yet created) the program prompts a warning message that no catalog was found. Then,
pressing the button "O7" opens the "Sa&e as" dialog window that allows for entering the
catalog name and saving it into a specified location by pressing the "Sa&e" button (by default
a folder used for saving the project data is assumed).
The program allows the user to create more than one catalog. The next catalog is created by
pressing the ".ew" button the program asks, whether the current catalog should be
replaced (the currentl% loaded catalog is not deletedG) and saves the new catalog under a
new name. The "Open" button allows for loading an arbitrary user catalog and by pressing the
"Sa&e as" button for saving it under a different name.
-156-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
"3port !>!" button allows for exporting of currently loaded user catalog to text file.
Dialog window at first use - user catalog of cross-sections
The "User catalog" dialog window contains a table listing the user defined cross-sections. The
"Add ite' button opens the ".ew catalog ite' dialog window that allows for specifying
and subsequent saving of characteristics of a new cross-section into the catalog. Buttons "3dit
ite' and ",e'o&e ite' serve to edit individual items in the table.
The "Accept current" button accepts the current cross-sectional characteristics of a cross-
section specified in the "New section" dialog window and opens the ".ew catalog ite'"
dialog window that allows for modifying and saving the current cross-section.
Dialog windows "Bser catalog" and ".ew catalog item"
Assign
The "Assign" frame contains a list of layers of profile and associated soils. The list of soils is
graphically represented using buttons in the bar above the table, or is accessible from a combo
list for each layer of the profile.
The procedure to assign soil into a layer is described in detail herein.
The program makes it possible to import soil assignment in the gINT format.
-157-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",ssign"
3ca&ation
The "3ca&ation" frame serves to input the depth of a construction ditch and by pressing the
button to select the shape of the ditch base. The selected shape with a graphic hint "Chart o"
para'eters" appears in the left part of the frame. The dimensions of a structure can be
edited either in the frame by inserting values into input fields, or on the desktop with the help
of active dimensions.
The frame also allows for specifying surcharge acting on the ditch base or a thickness of made-
up ground of new soil below the ditch base (the soil can be selected from a combo list
containing soils inputted in the frame "Soils"). When introducing the made-up ground with
brace sheeting it is assumed that there is a sheeted structure in the location of made-up
ground, i.e., all pressures are acting on the entire width of a structure as above the
construction ditch base.
-158-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "(&caation"
!errain
The "!errain" frame allows, by pressing the button, for specifying the terrain shape. The
selected shape with graphic hint ("Chart o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in
the left part of the frame. The terrain shape can be edited either in the frame by inserting
values into input fields, or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
The last option to choose from is a general shape of a terrain. In this case the frame contains a
table with a list of terrain points. The first point with coordinates [0,0] coincides with the top
point of a structure.
Analysis of earth pressures in case of inclined terrain is described in the theoretical part of the
hint, chapter "Distribution of earth pressures for broken terrain".
-159-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Terrain"
(ater
The "(ater" frame allows, by pressing the button, for selecting the type of water. The selected
type together with a graphic hint ("Chart o" para'eters:) of inputted values is displayed in
the left part of the frame. Water parameters (h
1
, h
2
...) can be edited either in the frame by
inserting values into input fields, or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
The last option is a manual input of pore pressure both in front and behind the structure. Two
tab sheets "In "ront o" structure" and "Behind structure" appear with tables. The table is
filled with values of pore pressure in front, or behind the structure at a depth of "/" (/-axis).
The ground water table can also be specified a)o&e the structure or earth profile,
respectively in such a case the depth of water is inputted with a negative value.
Analysis of earth pressures with influence of water is described in the theoretical part of the
hint chapter "Influence of water".
The program further allows for specifying a depth of tensile cracks filled with water.
-160-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "%ater"
Surcharge
The "Surcharge" frame contains a table with a list of inputted surcharges. Adding (editing)
surcharge is performed in the ".ew @editA surcharge" dialog window. The inputted
surcharges can be edited on the desktop with the help of active dimensions or active objects,
respectively.
The /-coordinate measured from the top point of a structure is specified (positive direction
downwards) when inputting the surcharge at a certain depth. Providing the surcharge is found
off the terrain the computer prompts an error message.
Either per'anent or &aria)le surcharge can be introduced. Selecting the particular type of
surcharge also renders the corresponding design coefficient to multiply the resulting loading
action. Favorably acting variable surcharge is not considered in the program.
Analysis of earth pressures due to surcharges is described in the theoretical part of the hint,
chapter "Influence of surcharge".
-161-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Surcharge"
Applied "orces
The "Applied "orces" frame contains a table with a list of forces acting on a structure. Adding
(editing) forces is performed in the ".ew "orce @edit "orceA" dialog window. The inputted
forces can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
Applied "orces represent an additional load on the structure of the wall, sheeting or MSE wall.
We can model such as an anchoring crash barrier, crash vehicle, load from billboards and
hoardings etc. Program doesn`t adjust the applied forces in the calculation.
External load acting to the ground surface is necessary to define as surcharge.
-162-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",pplied forces"
Anchors
The "Anchors" frame contains a table with a list of inputted anchors. Adding (editing) anchors
is performed in the ".ew anchor @3dit anchorA" dialog window. The inputted anchors can be
edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
You are asked to input the anchor location, its length and inclination, pre-stress force and
parameters needed to determine the anchor stiffness (cross-sectional area, modulus of
elasticity). The anchor is introduced automatically on already deformed structure (obtained
from the previous stage of construction).
The anchor sti""ness becomes effective in subsequent stages of construction. Structuture
deformation then results in the change of anchor normal force. In subsequent stages the
anchor can no longer be edited. The only action available is the change of anchor pre-stress
force.
.ote; The program does not check the anchor bearing capacity against breakage.
-163-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",nchors"
Props
The "Props" frame contains a table with a list of inputted props. Adding (editing) props is
performed in the ".ew prop @3dit propA" dialog window. The inputted props can also be
edited on the desktop with the help of active dimensions or active objects, respectively.
You are asked to input the prop location, its length and parameters needed to determine the
prop sti""ness (cross-sectional area, modulus of elasticity).
The prop is introduced automatically on already de"or'ed structure (obtained from the
previous stage of construction). In subsequent stages the props can no longer be edited. The
only action available is the change of prop stiffness. In the analysis props are modeled in the
same way as anchors but with the initial force equal to zero.
.ote; The program does not check the prop bearing capacity neither for compression nor for
buckling.
-164-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Props"
Supports
The "Supports" frame contains a table with a list of inputted supports. Adding (editing)
supports is performed in the ".ew support @3dit supportA" dialog window. The inputted
supports can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active dimensions or active
objects, respectively.
You are asked to specify the support type (free, fixed, and spring) and its location. The support
is inputted automatically on already deformed structure (obtained from the previous stage of
construction). In subsequent stages the supports can no longer be edited. The only action
available is the introduction of prescribed (forced) displacement in a support.
-165-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Support"
3arthHuake
The "3arthHuake" frame serves to input earthquake parameters. Directions of inputted
earthquake effects are displayed on the desktop.
If not provided by measurements the coefficients k
h
and k
0
can be calculated following the
approach adopted from EN 1998-5.
Analysis of earth pressures while accounting for earthquake is described in the theoretical part
of the hint in chapter "Influence earthquake".
-166-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "(arthAua9e"
Stage settings
The frame "Stage settings" serves to input settings valid for a given construction stage.
Selected design situation determines the safety coefficients to be used in the analysis of a
given construction stage.
The frame view depends on the selected verification methodology. LRFD 2012 introduces new
types of design situations (Strength I, Ser&ice I, 3tre'e I).
Frame "Stage settings"
Anal%sis
The frame "Anal%sis" displays the analysis results. Switching to this regime automatically runs
the analysis. The frame contains three buttons to show the analysis results:
-167-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- 2
h
* pressures
Variation of the modulus of subsoil reaction is displayed in the left part of the desktop (by
default a blue color with hatching) is assumed. Referring to the method of depending pressures
some of the springs (values of modules of subsoil reaction) are removed (spring stiffness set
equal to zero) from the analysis. The analysis 'a% "ail to con&erge providing the critical
(limit) state developed both in front and behind the structure and there is not enough
constrains available (anchors, supports). The program exists without finding a solution. An
error message appears in the bottom part of the frame such a case calls for 'odi"ication in
pro)le' input e.g., add an anchor, change a depth of excavation, improve soil parameters,
etc.
Some construction stages display (by default a yellow dotted line is assumed) deformation at
the onset of mobilization of the earth pressure at rest this is a complementary information
showing plastic deformation of a structure.
Distributions of limiting pressures (by default a green dashed line is assumed) are presented in
the right part of the window (passive pressure, pressure at rest and active pressure). The
actual pressure acting on a structure is plotted in a solid blue line.
Both de"or'ed (by default a solid red color is assumed) and undeformed structure appears in
the right part of the desktop. Forces and displacements developed in anchors, supports and
props are also shown.
- Internal "orces
Plot of a structure together with forces acting in anchors, reactions and deformations of
supports and props appear in the left part of the desktop. Distributions of bending moment and
shear force are then plotted on the right.
- $e"or'ations * Stresses
Plot of a structure together with forces acting in anchors, reactions and deformations of
supports and props appear in the left part of the desktop. The deformed shape of a structure
together with overall pressure acting on a structure is then plotted on the right.
Providing the modulus of subsoil reaction is found by iteration it is necessary to check the
course of iteration in the dialog window. Details are provided in the theoretical part of the hint
"Modulus of subsoil reaction determined by iteration".
-168-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",nal#sis" - modulus of subsoil reaction< earth pressures and deformations
Frame ",nal#sis" - bending moment and shear force
-169-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",nal#sis" - deformation and pressure acting on structure
Internal sta)ilit%
This frame serves to check the internal stability of anchors the frame is therefore accessible
only in stages, in which the anchors are introduced. For each row of anchors the table shows
inputted anchor forces and the maximum allowable forces in each anchor. Overall check for the
most stressed row of anchors is displayed in the right part of the frame.
-170-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "+nternal stabilit#"
3ternal sta)ilit%
Pressing the "3ternal sta)ilit%" button launches the "Slope sta)ilit%" program. This
program then allows us to check the overall stability of the analyzed structure. The button is
available only if the program "Slope sta)ilit%" is installed.
After completing all analyses press the "O7" button to leave the program all data are then
carried over to the analysis protocol of the "Sheeting check" program.
-171-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "(&ternal stabilit#"
Hea&e "ailure
This frame "Hea&e "ailure" serves to check the failure by heave and failure by piping. The
frame is accessible only in the case, where the influence of water is considered as
"Hydrodynamic pressure" (the heel of a structure is sunk into permeable subsoil, which allows
free water flow below the structure).
-172-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Heae failure"
3n&elopes
The frame "3n&elopes" allows for displaying an envelope of internal forces and displacements
from all analyses (stages of constructions). By default the envelope is constructed from the
results from all construction stages. It can, however, be created only from the selected stages
(pressing buttons selects the constructions stages that are used to generate the current
envelope). The program makes it possible to construct more envelopes with various
combinations.
The maximum internal forces and displacements are displayed in the right part of the frame.
-173-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "(nelopes"
Progra' Slope Sta)ilit%
Pro8ect
The "Pro8ect" frame is used to input the basic project data and to specify the overall setting of
the analysis run. The frame contains an input form to introduce the basic data about the
analyzed task, i.e. project information, project description, date, etc. This information is
further used in text and graphical outputs.
The frame also allows the user to switch analysis units (metric / imperial).
Frame "Pro'ect"
-174-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Settings
The frame "Settings" serves to introduce the basic "Settings" of the program such as
standards and theories of analyses, the way of proving safety of a structure and individual
coefficients of the analysis.
The programs contain not only the pre-defined )asic Settings for individual countries, but
also allow the user to create their own user6de"ined Settings, which can be subsequently
used in all GEO5 programs.
The "Select" button enables to choose an already created Setting from the "Settings list".
The "Settings Ad'inistrator" button opens the "Administrator" dialogue window, which
allows for viewing and modifying individual Setting. One may also identify the visible settings
in the Settings list. Data in the Settings administrator can be also eported and i'ported.
The "Add to the ad'inistrator" button allows for creating user-defined Settings, which are
subsequently added to the Settings administrator.
The "/odi"%" button enables a quick visualization and editing of the current Setting in the
opened program. Modifying any of the parameters changes the title to "Inputted "or the
current task". Individual analyses are then performed with this local setting. Should we
consider this setting as suitable also for other tasks, we add the setting into the "Settings
ad'inistrator" by pressing the "Add to the ad'inistrator" button.
The "Inputted "or the current task" setting is usually created when importing older data.
Settings of analysis parameters are performed in the "Materials and standards" and "Stability
analysis" tab sheets.
Frame "Settings"
Inter"ace
The "Inter"ace" frame serves to introduce individual soil interfaces into the soil body. Detailed
description how to deal with interfaces is described herein.
The program makes it possible to import or export interfaces in the *.DXF format. They can
also be imported in the gINT format.
-175-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "+nterface"
3')ank'ent
The "3')ank'ent" frame allows for inputting interfaces to create an embankment above the
current terrain. The frame contains a table with a list of interfaces forming the embankment. A
table listing the points of currently selected interface of the embankment is displayed in the
mid section of the frame. Inputting an embankment interface follows the same steps as used
for standard interfaces.
An embankment cannot be specified in the first stage of construction. An embankment cannot
be built if there is an earth cut already specified in a given stage - in such a case either a new
stage of construction must be introduced for embankment input or the existing open cut must
be first removed.
-176-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "(mban9ment"
3arth cut
The "3arth cut" frame serves to specify the shape of an open cut. This function allows for
modifying the terrain profile within a given stage of construction. Several earth cuts can be
introduced at the same time. In such a case some of the lines in the cut appear partially above
the terrain.
A table listing individual interface points is displayed in the left part of the frame. Inputting an
earth cut interface follows the same steps as used for standard interfaces.
An open cut cannot be specified in the first stage of construction. An earth cut cannot be built
if there is an embankment already specified in a given stage - in such a case either a new
stage of construction must be introduced for earth cut input or the existing embankment must
be first removed.
-177-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "(arth cut"
Soils
The "Soils" frame contains a table with a list of inputted soils. The table also provides
information about currently selected soil displayed in the right part of the frame.
Adding (editing) a soil is performed in the "Add (edit) soil" dialog window.
The soil characteristics needed in the program are further specified in the following chapters:
"Basic data", "Uplift pressure", "Foliation" and "Parameters for rapid draw down". An input of
parameters further depends on the selected type of analysis (effective / total stress state),
which is set in the combo list.
The program makes it possible to import soils in the gINT format.
-178-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Soils"
Basic data
This part of the window serves to introduce basic parameters of soils unit weight1 angle o"
internal "riction and cohesion. The particular values are obtained from geotechnical survey
or from laboratory experiments. If these data are not available, it is possible to exploit built-in
database of soils, which contains values of selected characteristics of soils.
The analysis method of slope stability differs for:
- drained conditions; for the slope stability calculations to determine equilibrium
conditions on the slip surface (circular, polygonal) is considered effective stress according
to the equation 34t5
e6
7 c
e6
48.
- undrained conditions; in case of total stress for the calculation of passive forces on the
slip surface (circular, polygonal) is considered according to the equation c
9
48.
In some countries its customary to specify both shear strength parameters
9
, c
9
for total
stress. In this case its necessary to specify the task as an effective stress using parameters

e6
, c
e6
in program "Slope Stability".
The associated theory is described in detail in chapter "Slope stability analysis".
-179-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ",dd new soils" - "@asic data"
,igid )od%
The ",igid )odies" frame contains a table with a list of inputted rigid bodies. The rigid bodies
serve to model regions with a high stiffness e.g., sheeting structures or rock su)grade.
This table also provides information about the currently selected rigid body displayed in the
right part of the frame.
Adding (editing) rigid bodies is performed in the "Add new rigid )od%" dialog window. This
window serves to input the unit weight of the rigid body material and to select color and
pattern. The rigid bodies are in the frame "Assign" ordered after inputted soils.
,igid )odies are introduced in the program as regions with high strength so they are not
intersected )% a potential slip sur"ace. Providing we wish the slip surface to cross a rigid
body (e.g., pile wall) it is recommended to model the rigid body as a soil with a cohesion
corresponding to pile bearing capacity against slip.
-180-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "6igid bodies"
Assign
The "Assign" frame contains a list of layers of profile and associated soils. The list of soils is
graphically represented using buttons in the bar above the table, or is accessible from a combo
list for each layer of the profile.
The procedure to assign soil into a layer is described in detail herein.
The program makes it possible to import soil assignment in the gINT format.
-181-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",ssign"
Anchors
The "Anchors" frame contains a table with a list of inputted anchors. Adding (editing) anchors
is performed in the ".ew anchor @/odi"% anchor para'etersA" dialog window. The
inputted anchors can be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
You are asked to input the anchor location (starting point), its length and inclination, anchor
spacing and pre-stress force. The anchor starting point is always attached to the terrain. All
inputted parameters can be modified in the stage of construction, in which the anchor was
introduced. In subsequent stages the program allows only for modifying the anchor pre-stress
force (option "Anchor post6stressing").
Anchors can also be introduced with help of a 'ouse click. Mouse input mode is determined
by pressing buttons on the horizontal bar "Anchor". The following modes are available:
- Add clicking the left mouse button allows for specifying the starting and end
point of an anchor. The grid function can be exploited in the input mode.
The starting point is always "attached" to the terrain. The coordinates of
inputted points are automatically round up to two digits both input
modes (manual, mouse) are therefore identical
- /odi"% clicking the left mouse button on already existing anchor opens the
"/odi"% anchor propert%" dialog window, where the selected anchor can
be modified
- ,e'o&e clicking the left mouse button on an anchor opens the dialog window to
confirm the rein"orce'ent re'o&al confirming this action then
removes the anchor
Effect of anchors on the analysis is described in more detail in the theoretical part of the hint.
-182-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
.ote; The program does not check the anchor bearing capacity against breakage.
Frame ",nchors"
,ein"orce'ents
The ",ein"orce'ents" frame contains a table with a list of inputted reinforcements. Adding
(editing) reinforcement is performed in the ".ew rein"orce'ent @/odi"% inter"ace
propertiesA" dialog window. The inputted reinforcements can be edited on the desktop with
the help of active objects.
Properties like reinforcement location, anchorage length from both left and right end, tensile
strength of reinforcement R
t
and end of reinforcement (fixed or free) must be specified. All
inputted parameters can be modified only in the stage of construction, in which the
reinforcement was introduced. In subsequent stages the geo-reinforcement can only be
removed.
Reinforcements can also be introduced with help of a 'ouse click. Mouse input mode is
determined by pressing buttons on the horizontal bar ",ein"orce'ent". The following modes
are available:
- Add clicking the left mouse button allows for specifying the starting and
end point of a reinforcement. A predefined grid can be used in the
input mode. The starting point is always "attached" to the terrain. The
coordinates of inputted points are automatically round up to two digits
both input modes (manual, mouse) are therefore identical
- /odi"% clicking the left mouse button on already existing reinforcement opens
the "/odi"% rein"orce'ent propert%" dialog window, where the
selected reinforcement can be modified
- ,e'o&e clicking the left mouse button on reinforcement opens the dialog
-183-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
window to confirm the rein"orce'ent re'o&al confirming this
action then removes the reinforcement
Including reinforcements in the analysis is described in more detail in the theoretical part of
the help.
Frame "6einforcements"
Surcharge
The "Surcharge" frame contains a table with a list of inputted surcharges. Adding (editing)
surcharge is performed in the ".ew @editA surcharge" dialog window. The inputted
surcharges can be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
All inputted parameters of a surcharge can be modified in the construction stage where the
surcharge was specified. Only the surcharge magnitude can be modified in all subsequent
construction stages (option "Ad8ust surcharge").
Either per'anent or &aria)le surcharge can be introduced. Selecting the particular type of
surcharge also renders the corresponding design coefficient to multiply the resulting loading
action. Favorably acting variable surcharge is not considered in the program.
Influence of surcharge on stability analysis of slopes is described in the theoretical part of the
hint.
-184-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Surcharge"
(ater
The "(ater" frame serves to set the type of ground water table. Six options to specify the
type of water are available from the combo list.
Inputting the ground water table or isolines, respectively, is identical with the standard input of
interfaces.
A field for specifying a value of coefficient Ru or pore pressure appears next to the table if
introducing water using isolines of R
9
6inter"aces or pore pressure, respectively. Pressing the
button with a blue arrow next to the input field opens the "Coe""icient ,u" or "Pore
pressure" dialog window to enter the desired value. It is advantageous to input all values at
once using the "O7* " and "O7* ". The value of a given quantity found in a specific point
between two isolines is approximated by linear interpolation of values pertinent to given
isolines. For option "Coe""icient R
9
" the first (the most top one) is always identical with
terrain + it therefore cannot be deleted.
The ground water ta)le (resp. ta)le o" suction or original G(!) is specified as continuous
interfaces, which can be located even above the terrain.
If the inputted data in individual stages are different, the program then allows for accepting
the data from the previous stage of construction by pressing the "Accept" button.
The program further allows for specifying a depth of tensile cracks filled with water.
-185-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "%ater"
3arthHuake
The "3arthHuake" frame serves to input earthquake parameters. Directions of inputted
earthquake effects are displayed on the desktop.
If not provided by measurements the coefficients 2
h
and 2
0
can be calculated following the
approach adopted from EN 1998-5.
Slope stability analysis while accounting for earthquake is described in the theoretical part of
the hint in chapter "Influence earthquake".
-186-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "(arthAua9e"
Stage settings
The frame "Stage settings" serves to input settings valid for a given construction stage.
Selected design situation determines the safety coefficients to be used in the analysis of a
given construction stage.
The frame view depends on the selected verification methodology. LRFD 2012 introduces new
types of design situations (Ser&ice I, 3tre'e I).
Frame "Stage settings"
-187-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Anal%sis
The "Anal%sis" frame displays the analysis results. Several analyses can be performed for a
single task.
The starting point in the slope stability analysis is the selection of the type of slip surface. The
input is available from a combo list in the left top part of the frame containing two options
circular slip sur"ace and pol%gonal slip sur"ace. After introducing the slip surface the
analysis is started using the "Anal%-e" button. The analysis results appear in the right part of
the frame.
!he t%pe o" anal%sis is selected in the mid section of the frame seven methods are
available for the circular slip surface (Fellenius/Petterson, Bishop, Spencer, Janbu,
Morgenstern-Price, Shahunyants or ITF method), and six methods are available for the
polygonal slip surface (Sarma, Spencer, Janbu, Morgenstern-Price, Shahunyants or ITF
method). For both cases of the assumed slip surfaces it is possible to perform the analysis
employing all methods at once (in such a case, however, the slip surface cannot be optimized).
The actual verification of slope stability can be performed, depending on the settings in the
"Stability analysis" tab sheet:
- Verification according to EN 1997, where the loading is reduced by the analysis partial
factors and the verification is performed according to the theor% o" li'it states.
- Verification according to the factor of safety
- Verification according to the theory of limit states
The combo list (items "Standard" and "Opti'i-ation") allows for optimizing either the
circular or polygonal slip surface. Choosing the "Optimization" option activates the
"Restrictions" button pressing this button changes the frame appearance and makes it
possible to introduce restrictions on the optimization procedure.
It is also possible to specify how to deal with anchors in the analysis (box "Assu'e anchors
as in"inite").
Button Con&ert to pol%gon (circle) allows to replace slip surface with similar polygonal
(circular) one.
The slip surface, even the optimized one, must be introduced in the frame several
possibilities are available:
- Circular slip sur"ace
using 'ouse press the "Input" button to active the input regime and then by clicking
the left mouse button enter three points to define a circular slip surface (the introduced slip
surface can be further modified using the "/odi"%" button or specified again with the help
of the ",eplace" button
using the dialog window pressing the "Input" button in the "Circular slip sur"ace"
frame opens the "Circular slip sur"ace" dialog window that allows for specifying the
radius and coordinates of center
- Pol%gonal slip sur"ace
using 'ouse - press the "Input" button to active the input regime entering the surface
points proceeds in the same steps as when specifying interfaces
using ta)le pressing the button "Input" actives several buttons that allow for filling the
adjacent table with the coordinates of slip surface points (buttons "Add", "/odi"%",
",e'o&e")
-188-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The analysis results appear in the left part of the frame and the optimized slip surface on the
desktop. Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog
window.
Frame ",nal#sis" - circular slip surface
-189-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",nal#sis" - pol#gonal slip surface
,estrictions on the opti'i-ation procedure
The "Anal%sis" frame allows (after pressing the ",estrictions") for specifying restrictions on
the optimization process.
,egardless o" the assu'ed t%pe o" slip sur"ace (circular, polygonal) it is possible to
introduce into the soil body (with the help of mouse) segments, which should not be crossed
by the optimized slip surface. These segments also appear in the table in the left part of the
frame.
Pol%gonal slip sur"ace also allows for excluding some points from optimization, either
entirely or partially only in specified direction. "7eeping the point "ied" during optimization
process is achieved by checking the box in the table with corresponding point.
This input mode is quitted by pressing the red button ",eturn to analysis".
Frame ",nal#sis" - restrictions on slip surface optimi!ation b# segments
Height 'ultiplier
Providing the analyzed slope is too long or has small height the plotted slip surface might not
be sufficiently visible. This problem can be solved by selected courser scale in the vertical
direction with the help of height multiplier. The value of this multiplier is set in the
"Visualization style settings" dialog window, tab sheet "Glo)al 2$". Using standard setting
("Height 'ultiplier" equal to one) plots undistorted structure proportional to its dimensions.
Only polygonal slip surface can be inputted graphically when exploiting the height multiplier
option. The circular slip surface must be in such a case inputted manually in the "Circular slip
sur"ace" dialog window using the "Input" button.
-190-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Setting height multiplier
"isuali!ation of the resulting slip surface when using height multiplier
Progra' Cantile&er (all
Pro8ect
The "Pro8ect" frame is used to input the basic project data and to specify the overall setting of
the analysis run. The frame contains an input form to introduce the basic data about the
analyzed task, i.e. project information, project description, date, etc. This information is
further used in text and graphical outputs.
The frame also allows the user to switch analysis units (metric / imperial).
-191-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Pro'ect"
Settings
The frame "Settings" serves to introduce the basic "Settings" of the program such as
standards and theories of analyses, the way of proving safety of a structure and individual
coefficients of the analysis.
The programs contain not only the pre-defined )asic Settings for individual countries, but
also allow the user to create their own user6de"ined Settings, which can be subsequently
used in all GEO5 programs.
The "Select" button enables to choose an already created Setting from the "Settings list".
The "Settings Ad'inistrator" button opens the "Administrator" dialogue window, which
allows for viewing and modifying individual Setting. One may also identify the visible settings
in the Settings list. Data in the Settings administrator can be also eported and i'ported.
The "Add to the ad'inistrator" button allows for creating user-defined Settings, which are
subsequently added to the Settings administrator.
The "/odi"%" button enables a quick visualization and editing of the current Setting in the
opened program. Modifying any of the parameters changes the title to "Inputted "or the
current task". Individual analyses are then performed with this local setting. Should we
consider this setting as suitable also for other tasks, we add the setting into the "Settings
ad'inistrator" by pressing the "Add to the ad'inistrator" button.
The "Inputted "or the current task" setting is usually created when importing older data.
Settings of analysis parameters are performed in the "Materials and standards" and "Wall
analysis" tab sheets.
-192-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Settings"
Geo'etr%
The "Geo'etr%" frame allows by pressing the button for selecting the wall shape. The
selected shape with a graphic hint "Chart o" wall geo'etr%" appears in the left part of the
frame. The shape of a wall can be edited either in the frame by inserting values into input
fields, or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
In case the structure is composed of inclined segments it is required to enter the ratio of sides
of an inclined segment 1:;. !he straight structure is specified by entering the value zero.
The program makes it possible to export the geometry of a structure in the *.DXF format.
-193-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ")eometr#"
/aterial
The "/aterial" frame allows for the selection of material parameters for concrete and
longitudinal steel reinforcements.
Two options are available when selecting the material type:
- The "Catalog" button opens the "Catalog o" 'aterials" dialog window (for concrete or
steel reinforcements), the list of materials then serves to select the desired material.
- The "Own" button opens the "3ditor o" 'aterial 6 Concrete" dialog window (for
concrete) or the "3ditor o" 'aterial 6 ,ein"orcing steel )ars" dialog window (for
longitudinal steel reinforcements), which allows for manual specification of material
parameters
The catalogs content depends on the selection of standard for the design of concrete structures
set in the "Materials and standards" tab sheet. The input field in the upper part of the frame
serves to specify the wall unit weight.
Frame "Material"
Pro"ile
The "Pro"ile" frame contains a table with a list of inputted interfaces. After specifying
interfaces it is possible to edit thicknesses of individual layers with the help of active
dimensions.
Adding (editing) layer is performed in the "Add @editA inter"ace" dialog window. The /-
coordinate measured from the top point of a structure is specified (/-axis).
-194-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The program allows for raising or lowering the top point of a structure in the "Change o"
terrain ele&ation" dialog window so that the whole interface can be translated while keeping
the thicknesses of individual layers. This function is important when copying the profile from
program "!errain".
The program makes it possible to import a profile in the gINT format.
Frame "Profile"
Soils
The "Soils" frame contains a table with a list of inputted soils. The table also provides
information about currently selected soil displayed in the right part of the frame.
Adding (editing) a soil is performed in the "Add (edit) soil" dialog window.
The soil characteristics needed in the program are further specified in the following chapters:
"Basic data", "Earth pressure at rest" and "Uplift pressure".
The program makes it possible to import soils in the gINT format.
-195-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Soils"
Basic data
This part of the window serves to introduce basic parameters of soils unit weight1 angle o"
internal "riction and cohesion. The particular values are obtained from geotechnical survey
or from laboratory experiments. If these data are not available, it is possible to exploit built-in
database of soils, which contains values of selected characteristics of soils.
Either e""ecti&e or total parameters of the angle of internal friction and cohesion are specified
depending on the setting in the "Stress anal%sis" combo list. Whether to use effective or total
parameters depends primarily on the type of soil, type of loading, structure duration and water
conditions.
For effective stress further needs to specify the angle of internal friction between the soil and
structure, which depends on the structure material and the type of soil. Possible values of this
parameter are listed in the table of recommended values.
For total stress further needs to specify the adhesion of soil to the structure face a.
The associated theory is described in detail in chapter "Earth pressures".
-196-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ",dd new soils" - "@asic data"
Assign
The "Assign" frame contains a list of layers of profile and associated soils. The list of soils is
graphically represented using buttons in the bar above the table, or is accessible from a combo
list for each layer of the profile.
The procedure to assign soil into a layer is described in detail herein.
The program makes it possible to import soil assignment in the gINT format.
-197-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",ssign"
!errain
The "!errain" frame allows, by pressing the button, for specifying the terrain shape. The
selected shape with graphic hint ("Chart o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in
the left part of the frame. The terrain shape can be edited either in the frame by inserting
values into input fields, or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
The last option to choose from is a general shape of a terrain. In this case the frame contains a
table with a list of terrain points. The first point with coordinates [0,0] coincides with the top
point of a structure.
Analysis of earth pressures in case of inclined terrain is described in the theoretical part of the
hint, chapter "Distribution of earth pressures for broken terrain".
-198-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Terrain"
(ater
The "(ater" frame allows, by pressing the button, for selecting the type of water. The selected
type together with a graphic hint ("Chart o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in
the left part of the frame. Water parameters (h
1
, h
2
...) can be edited either in the frame by
inserting values into input fields, or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
The combo list serves to specify whether the influence of uplift pressure of water due to
different tables at the foundation joint is considered. The uplift pressure can be assumed to be
linear, parabolic or it may not be considered at all. When verifying the wall, the uplift pressure
in base of footing joint due to different water tables is introduced in terms of a special force.
The last option is a manual input of pore pressure both in front and behind the structure. Two
tab sheets "In "ront o" structure" and "Behind structure" appear with tables. The table is
filled with values of pore pressure in front, or behind the structure at a depth of "/" (/-axis).
The ground water table can also be specified a)o&e the structure or earth profile,
respectively in such a case the depth of water is inputted with a negative value.
Analysis of earth pressures with influence of water is described in the theoretical part of the
hint chapter "Influence of water".
The program further allows for specifying a depth of tensile cracks filled with water.
-199-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "%ater"
Surcharge
The "Surcharge" frame contains a table with a list of inputted surcharges. Adding (editing)
surcharge is performed in the ".ew @editA surcharge" dialog window. The inputted
surcharges can be edited on the desktop with the help of active dimensions or active objects,
respectively.
The /-coordinate measured from the top point of a structure is specified (positive direction
downwards) when inputting the surcharge at a certain depth. Providing the surcharge is found
off the terrain the computer prompts an error message.
Either per'anent or &aria)le surcharge can be introduced. Selecting the particular type of
surcharge also renders the corresponding design coefficient to multiply the resulting loading
action. Favorably acting variable surcharge is not considered in the program.
Analysis of earth pressures due to surcharges is described in the theoretical part of the hint,
chapter "Influence of surcharge".
-200-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Surcharge"
Front "ace resistance
The "Front "ace resistance" frame allows by pressing the button for specifying the terrain
shape and parameters of front face resistance. The selected shape with a graphic hint ("Chart
o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in the left part of the frame. The terrain shape
can be edited either in the frame by inserting values into input fields, or on the desktop with
the help of active dimensions.
Combo lists in the frame allows the user to select the type of resistance and a soil (the combo
list contains soils introduced in the frame "Soils"). The magnitude of terrain surcharge in front
of the wall or soil thickness above the wall lowest points can also be specified in the frame.
The resistance on a structure front face can be specified as a pressure at rest, passive
pressure or reduced passive earth pressure. The resulting force due to reduced passive
pressure is found as a resultant force caused by passive pressure multiplied by a
corresponding coefficient, which follows from the inputted type of reduced passive pressure.
-201-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Front face resistance"
Applied "orces
The "Applied "orces" frame contains a table with a list of forces acting on a structure. Adding
(editing) forces is performed in the ".ew "orce @edit "orceA" dialog window. The inputted
forces can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
Applied "orces represent an additional load on the structure of the wall, sheeting or MSE wall.
We can model such as an anchoring crash barrier, crash vehicle, load from billboards and
hoardings etc. Program doesn`t adjust the applied forces in the calculation.
External load acting to the ground surface is necessary to define as surcharge.
-202-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",pplied forces"
3arthHuake
The "3arthHuake" frame serves to input earthquake parameters. Directions of inputted
earthquake effects are displayed on the desktop.
If not provided by measurements the coefficients k
h
and k
0
can be calculated following the
approach adopted from EN 1998-5.
Analysis of earth pressures while accounting for earthquake is described in the theoretical part
of the hint in chapter "Influence earthquake".
-203-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "(arthAua9e"
Base anchorage
The frame "Base anchorage" serves to input parameters (anchorage geometry, bearing
capacity against pulling-out and pulling-apart) specifying an anchorage of the wall foundation.
Geometry of footing anchorage can be edited either in the frame by inserting values in the
inputting boxes or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions. The bearing capacity
values can be either inputted or computed by the program from the inputted parameters.
-204-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "@ase anchorage"
Stage settings
The frame "Stage settings" serves to input settings valid for a given construction stage.
Selected design situation determines the safety coefficients to be used in the analysis of a
given construction stage.
The frame view depends on the selected verification methodology. LRFD 2012 introduces new
types of design situations (Strength I, Ser&ice I, 3tre'e I).
Next, the frame serves to specify the type of pressure acting on a wall based on the allowable
wall deformation. Providing the wall is free to move, an active pressure is assumed, otherwise,
a pressure at rest is used. The third option enables to load both the wall and stem by an active
pressure.
Frame "Stage settings"
-205-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
5eri"ication
The frame "5eri"ication" shows the analysis results. Several computations can be carried out
for a single task.
The frame appearance is adjusted based on the selected verification methodology.
- Verification according to the factor of safety, or the theory of limit states the column F in
the table allows for inputting the design coefficients, which multiply the calculated forces.
These forces are displayed on the desktop and are updated for every change of data and
setting in the frame.
- Analysis according to EN 1997 the column G in the table allows for specifying whether
the loading acting on a structure is considered as secondary one. This is explained in more
detail in section "Load combinations".
- Analysis according to LRFD in the case the column F is not displayed.
The wall is loaded either by active pressure or pressure at rest depending on input in the frame
"Stage settings".
The procedure for wall verification is described in the theoretical part of this hint.
The computed forces are displayed on the desktop and are automatically updated with every
change of input data and setting. The right part of the frame shows the result of verification of
a wall against o&erturning and translation. The "In detail" button opens the dialog window,
which contains detailed listing of the results of verification analysis.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame ""erification"
-206-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Bearing capacit%
The "Bearing capacit%" frame displays the results from the analysis of foundation soil bearing
capacity. The stress in the footing bottom (assumed constant) is derived from all verifications
performed in the frame "Verification". The program "Spread "ooting" then considers all
verifications as loading cases.
Three basic analysis options are available in the frame:
- Input the "oundation soil
)earing capacit%
The input field serves to specify the foundation soil bearing
capacity. The results of verification analysis of a soil for
eccentricit% and bearing capacity are displayed in the right
part of the frame. The "In detail" button opens the dialog
window that displays detailed listing of the results of
verification analysis of foundation soil bearing capacity.
When performing the analysis according to EN 1997
Design approach 2 resp. LRFD, the assigned bearing
capacity is reduced by the corresponding design
coe""icient o" resistance.
- Co'pute the "oundation
soil )earing capacit% using
the progra' :Spread
"ooting:
Pressing the ",un Spread "ooting: button starts the
program "Spread "ooting" that allows for computing the
soil bearing capacity or settlement and rotation of a footing.
Pressing the "O7" button leaves the analysis regime the
results and all plots are copied to the program "Cantile&er
wall". The program "Spread "ooting" must be installed for
the button to be active.
- $o not co'pute @pile
"ootingA
The foundation soil bearing capacity is not computed.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
-207-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "@earing capacit#"
$i'ensioning
The "$i'ensioning" frame serves to design and verify the reinforcement of wall cross-section
the cross-section subjected to dimensioning is selected in the combo list.
- (all ste' &eri"ication
- Construction 8oint
&eri"ication
depth of construction joint from construction top edge is
specified
- (all 8u'p &eri"ication
- 5eri"ication o" heel o"
wall
The frame appearance is adjusted based on the selected verification methodology.
- Verification according to the factor of safety, or the theory of limit states the column F in
the table allows for inputting the design coefficients, which multiply the calculated forces.
These forces are displayed on the desktop and are updated for every change of data and
setting in the frame.
- Analysis according to EN 1997 the column G in the table allows for specifying whether
the loading acting on a structure is considered as secondary one. This is explained in more
detail in section "Load combinations".
- Analysis according to LRFD in the case the column F is not displayed.
Calculation of forces and their action on the analyzed cross-section is described here.
The wall stem and construction joint are always loaded by the pressure at rest. When verifying
the front wall jump the wall is loaded either by the active pressure or the pressure at rest
depending on input specified in the frame "Stage settings".
The procedure to derive distribution of internal forces in individual cross-sections is described
in the theoretical part of this documentation. In addition, force from earth pressure at rest is
taken into account when considering earthquake analysis.
Dimensioning of the reinforced concrete is performed according to the standard set in the
"Materials and standards" tab sheet.
Several computations for various cross-sections can be carried out. Various design coefficients
of individual forces can also be specified. The resulting forces are displayed on the desktop and
are updated with an arbitrary change in data or setting specified in the frame. The "In detail"
button opens the dialog window that contains detailed listing of the dimensioning results.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
-208-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Dimensioning"
Sta)ilit%
Pressing the "Sta)ilit%" button launches the "Slope sta)ilit%" program. This program then
allows us to check the overall stability of the analyzed structure. The button is available only if
the program "Slope sta)ilit%" is installed.
After completing all analyses press the "O7" button to leave the program all data are then
carried over to the analysis protocol of the "Cantile&er wall" program.
-209-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Stabilit#"
Progra' /asonr% wall
Pro8ect
The "Pro8ect" frame is used to input the basic project data and to specify the overall setting of
the analysis run. The frame contains an input form to introduce the basic data about the
analyzed task, i.e. project information, project description, date, etc. This information is
further used in text and graphical outputs.
The frame also allows the user to switch analysis units (metric / imperial).
Frame "Pro'ect"
-210-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Settings
The frame "Settings" serves to introduce the basic "Settings" of the program such as
standards and theories of analyses, the way of proving safety of a structure and individual
coefficients of the analysis.
The programs contain not only the pre-defined )asic Settings for individual countries, but
also allow the user to create their own user6de"ined Settings, which can be subsequently
used in all GEO5 programs.
The "Select" button enables to choose an already created Setting from the "Settings list".
The "Settings Ad'inistrator" button opens the "Administrator" dialogue window, which
allows for viewing and modifying individual Setting. One may also identify the visible settings
in the Settings list. Data in the Settings administrator can be also eported and i'ported.
The "Add to the ad'inistrator" button allows for creating user-defined Settings, which are
subsequently added to the Settings administrator.
The "/odi"%" button enables a quick visualization and editing of the current Setting in the
opened program. Modifying any of the parameters changes the title to "Inputted "or the
current task". Individual analyses are then performed with this local setting. Should we
consider this setting as suitable also for other tasks, we add the setting into the "Settings
ad'inistrator" by pressing the "Add to the ad'inistrator" button.
The "Inputted "or the current task" setting is usually created when importing older data.
Settings of analysis parameters are performed in the "Materials and standards" and "Wall
analysis" tab sheets.
Frame "Settings"
!%pes o" )locks
The "!%pes o" )locks" frame contains a table with a list of inputted blocks. Adding (editing)
blocks is performed in the ".ew t%pe o" )lock @3dit t%pe o" )lockA" dialog window.
This dialog window serves to define the geo'etr% o" a )lock (width and height).
The program allows for adding (inserting) another block in between two already existing blocks
of a structure. Inserting a new block is performed in the "Inserted t%pe o" )lock" dialog
window that complies with the ".ew t%pe o" )lock" dialog window. The inserted block is
ordered such to proceed the currently selected block of a structure.
-211-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "T#pes of bloc9s"
Geo'etr%
The "Geo'etr%" frame allows by pressing the button for selecting the wall shape. The
selected shape with a graphic hint "Chart o" wall geo'etr%" appears in the left part of the
frame. The shape of a wall can be edited either in the frame by inserting values into input
fields, or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
Based on the selected shape of a wall, you specify in the frame "Geo'etr% and 'asonr%
'aterial" the number and dimensions of masonry blocks in individual columns, or if applicable
also the thickness of vertical joint between blocks. In addition it is necessary to input
compressive strength of masonry, which serves as the basic input parameter for the bearing
capacity verification of reinforced masonry (according to EN 1996-1-1 or AS 3700).
The program makes it possible to export the geometry of a structure in the *.DXF format.
-212-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ")eometr#"
/aterial
The "/aterial" frame allows for the selection of material parameters for concrete and
longitudinal steel reinforcements.
Two options are available when selecting the material type:
- the "Catalog" button opens the "Catalog o" 'aterials" dialog window (for concrete or
steel reinforcements), the list of materials then serves to select the desired material
- the "Own" button opens the "3ditor o" 'aterial 6 Concrete" dialog window (for
concrete) or the "3ditor o" 'aterial 6 ,ein"orcing steel )ars" dialog window (for
longitudinal steel reinforcements), which allows for manual specification of material
parameters
The catalogs content depends on the selection of standard for the design of concrete structures
set in the "Materials and standards" tab sheet. The input field in the upper part of the frame
serves to specify the wall unit weight.
-213-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Material"
Pro"ile
The "Pro"ile" frame contains a table with a list of inputted interfaces. After specifying
interfaces it is possible to edit thicknesses of individual layers with the help of active
dimensions.
Adding (editing) layer is performed in the "Add @editA inter"ace" dialog window. The /-
coordinate measured from the top point of a structure is specified (/-axis).
The program allows for raising or lowering the top point of a structure in the "Change o"
terrain ele&ation" dialog window so that the whole interface can be translated while keeping
the thicknesses of individual layers. This function is important when copying the profile from
program "!errain".
The program makes it possible to import a profile in the gINT format.
-214-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Profile"
Soils
The "Soils" frame contains a table with a list of inputted soils. The table also provides
information about currently selected soil displayed in the right part of the frame.
Adding (editing) a soil is performed in the "Add (edit) soil" dialog window.
The soil characteristics needed in the program are further specified in the following chapters:
"Basic data", "Earth pressure at rest" and "Uplift pressure".
The program makes it possible to import soils in the gINT format.
-215-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Soils"
Basic data
This part of the window serves to introduce basic parameters of soils unit weight1 angle o"
internal "riction and cohesion. The particular values are obtained from geotechnical survey
or from laboratory experiments. If these data are not available, it is possible to exploit built-in
database of soils, which contains values of selected characteristics of soils.
Either e""ecti&e or total parameters of the angle of internal friction and cohesion are specified
depending on the setting in the "Stress anal%sis" combo list. Whether to use effective or total
parameters depends primarily on the type of soil, type of loading, structure duration and water
conditions.
For effective stress further needs to specify the angle of internal friction between the soil and
structure, which depends on the structure material and the type of soil. Possible values of this
parameter are listed in the table of recommended values.
For total stress further needs to specify the adhesion of soil to the structure face a.
The associated theory is described in detail in chapter "Earth pressures".
-216-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ",dd new soils" - "@asic data"
Assign
The "Assign" frame contains a list of layers of profile and associated soils. The list of soils is
graphically represented using buttons in the bar above the table, or is accessible from a combo
list for each layer of the profile.
The procedure to assign soil into a layer is described in detail herein.
The program makes it possible to import soil assignment in the gINT format.
-217-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",ssign"
!errain
The "!errain" frame allows, by pressing the button, for specifying the terrain shape. The
selected shape with graphic hint ("Chart o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in
the left part of the frame. The terrain shape can be edited either in the frame by inserting
values into input fields, or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
The last option to choose from is a general shape of a terrain. In this case the frame contains a
table with a list of terrain points. The first point with coordinates [0,0] coincides with the top
point of a structure.
Analysis of earth pressures in case of inclined terrain is described in the theoretical part of the
hint, chapter "Distribution of earth pressures for broken terrain".
-218-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Terrain"
(ater
The "(ater" frame allows, by pressing the button, for selecting the type of water. The selected
type together with a graphic hint ("Chart o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in
the left part of the frame. Water parameters (h
1
, h
2
...) can be edited either in the frame by
inserting values into input fields, or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
The combo list serves to specify whether the influence of uplift pressure of water due to
different tables at the foundation joint is considered. The uplift pressure can be assumed to be
linear, parabolic or it may not be considered at all. When verifying the wall, the uplift pressure
in base of footing joint due to different water tables is introduced in terms of a special force.
The last option is a manual input of pore pressure both in front and behind the structure. Two
tab sheets "In "ront o" structure" and "Behind structure" appear with tables. The table is
filled with values of pore pressure in front, or behind the structure at a depth of "/" (/-axis).
The ground water table can also be specified a)o&e the structure or earth profile,
respectively in such a case the depth of water is inputted with a negative value.
Analysis of earth pressures with influence of water is described in the theoretical part of the
hint chapter "Influence of water".
The program further allows for specifying a depth of tensile cracks filled with water.
-219-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "%ater"
Surcharge
The "Surcharge" frame contains a table with a list of inputted surcharges. Adding (editing)
surcharge is performed in the ".ew @editA surcharge" dialog window. The inputted
surcharges can be edited on the desktop with the help of active dimensions or active objects,
respectively.
The /-coordinate measured from the top point of a structure is specified (positive direction
downwards) when inputting the surcharge at a certain depth. Providing the surcharge is found
off the terrain the computer prompts an error message.
Either per'anent or &aria)le surcharge can be introduced. Selecting the particular type of
surcharge also renders the corresponding design coefficient to multiply the resulting loading
action. Favorably acting variable surcharge is not considered in the program.
Analysis of earth pressures due to surcharges is described in the theoretical part of the hint,
chapter "Influence of surcharge".
-220-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Surcharge"
Front "ace resistance
The "Front "ace resistance" frame allows by pressing the button for specifying the terrain
shape and parameters of front face resistance. The selected shape with a graphic hint ("Chart
o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in the left part of the frame. The terrain shape
can be edited either in the frame by inserting values into input fields, or on the desktop with
the help of active dimensions.
Combo lists in the frame allows the user to select the type of resistance and a soil (the combo
list contains soils introduced in the frame "Soils"). The magnitude of terrain surcharge in front
of the wall or soil thickness above the wall lowest points can also be specified in the frame.
The resistance on a structure front face can be specified as a pressure at rest, passive
pressure or reduced passive earth pressure. The resulting force due to reduced passive
pressure is found as a resultant force caused by passive pressure multiplied by a
corresponding coefficient, which follows from the inputted type of reduced passive pressure.
-221-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Front face resistance"
Applied "orces
The "Applied "orces" frame contains a table with a list of forces acting on a structure. Adding
(editing) forces is performed in the ".ew "orce @edit "orceA" dialog window. The inputted
forces can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
Applied "orces represent an additional load on the structure of the wall, sheeting or MSE wall.
We can model such as an anchoring crash barrier, crash vehicle, load from billboards and
hoardings etc. Program doesn`t adjust the applied forces in the calculation.
External load acting to the ground surface is necessary to define as surcharge.
-222-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",pplied forces"
3arthHuake
The "3arthHuake" frame serves to input earthquake parameters. Directions of inputted
earthquake effects are displayed on the desktop.
If not provided by measurements the coefficients k
h
and k
0
can be calculated following the
approach adopted from EN 1998-5.
Analysis of earth pressures while accounting for earthquake is described in the theoretical part
of the hint in chapter "Influence earthquake".
-223-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "(arthAua9e"
Base anchorage
The frame "Base anchorage" serves to input parameters (anchorage geometry, bearing
capacity against pulling-out and pulling-apart) specifying an anchorage of the wall foundation.
Geometry of footing anchorage can be edited either in the frame by inserting values in the
inputting boxes or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions. The bearing capacity
values can be either inputted or computed by the program from the inputted parameters.
-224-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "@ase anchorage"
Stage settings
The frame "Stage settings" serves to input settings valid for a given construction stage.
Selected design situation determines the safety coefficients to be used in the analysis of a
given construction stage.
The frame view depends on the selected verification methodology. LRFD 2012 introduces new
types of design situations (Strength I, Ser&ice I, 3tre'e I).
Next, the frame serves to specify the type of pressure acting on a wall based on the allowable
wall deformation. Providing the wall is free to move, an active pressure is assumed, otherwise,
a pressure at rest is used. The third option enables to load both the wall and stem by an active
pressure.
Frame "Stage settings"
-225-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
5eri"ication
The frame "5eri"ication" shows the analysis results. Several computations can be carried out
for a single task.
The frame appearance is adjusted based on the selected verification methodology.
- Verification according to the factor of safety, or the theory of limit states the column F in
the table allows for inputting the design coefficients, which multiply the calculated forces.
These forces are displayed on the desktop and are updated for every change of data and
setting in the frame.
- Analysis according to EN 1997 the column G in the table allows for specifying whether
the loading acting on a structure is considered as secondary one. This is explained in more
detail in section "Load combinations".
- Analysis according to LRFD in the case the column F is not displayed.
The wall is loaded either by active pressure or pressure at rest depending on input in the frame
"Stage settings".
The procedure for wall verification is described in the theoretical part of the hint.
The computed forces are displayed on the desktop and are automatically updated with every
change of input data and setting. The right part of the frame shows the result of verification of
a wall against o&erturning and translation. The "In detail" button opens the dialog window,
which contains detailed listing of the results of verification analysis.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame ""erification"
-226-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Bearing capacit%
The "Bearing capacit%" frame displays the results from the analysis of foundation soil bearing
capacity. The stress in the footing bottom (assumed constant) is derived from all verifications
performed in the frame "Verification". The program "Spread "ooting" then considers all
verifications as loading cases.
Three basic analysis options are available in the frame:
- Input the "oundation soil
)earing capacit%
The input field serves to specify the foundation soil bearing
capacity. The results of verification analysis of a soil for
eccentricit% and bearing capacity are displayed in the right
part of the frame. The "In detail" button opens the dialog
window that displays detailed listing of the results of
verification analysis of foundation soil bearing capacity.
- Co'pute the "oundation
soil )earing capacit% using
the progra' :Spread
"ooting:
Pressing the ",un Spread "ooting: button starts the
program "Spread "ooting" that allows for computing the
soil bearing capacity or settlement and rotation of a footing.
Pressing the "O7" button leaves the analysis regime the
results and all plots are copied to the program "/asonr%
wall". The program "Spread "ooting" must be installed for
the button to be active.
- $o not co'pute @pile
"ootingA
The foundation soil bearing capacity is not computed.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame "@earing capacit#"
-227-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
$i'ensioning
The "$i'ensioning" frame serves to design and verify the reinforcement of wall cross-section
the cross-section subjected to dimensioning is selected in the combo list.
- Construction 8oint
&eri"ication
the number of a joint between masonry blocks is inputted
- (all 8u'p &eri"ication
- 5eri"ication o" heel o"
wall
The frame appearance is adjusted based on the selected verification methodology.
- Verification according to the factor of safety, or the theory of limit states the column F in
the table allows for inputting the design coefficients, which multiply the calculated forces.
These forces are displayed on the desktop and are updated for every change of data and
setting in the frame.
- Analysis according to EN 1997 the column G in the table allows for specifying whether
the loading acting on a structure is considered as secondary one. This is explained in more
detail in section "Load combinations".
- Analysis according to LRFD in the case the column F is not displayed.
Calculation of forces and their action on the analyzed cross-section is described here.
The wall is loaded either by the active earth pressure or by the pressure at rest depending on
the setting in the frame "Stage settings". The procedure to derive distribution of internal forces
in individual cross-sections is described in the theoretical part of this documentation. In
addition, force from earth pressure at rest is taken into account when considering earthquake
analysis.
Joints between masonry blocks are verified according to AS 3700 or EN 1996-1-1 depending
on the setting in the "Materials and standards" tab sheet. The program verifies the bearing
capacity for bending, shear and combination of compression and bending. Reinforcement can
be specified on both front and back sides of a structure. An additional loading applied to a
cross-section (bending moment, compressive normal force and shear force) can also be
specified. These additional forces are added to the computed ones.
Dimensioning of reinforced concrete is performed according to the standard set in the
"Materials and standards" tab sheet.
Several computations for various cross-sections can be carried out. Various design coefficients
of individual forces can also be specified. The resulting forces are displayed on the desktop and
are updated with an arbitrary change in data or setting specified in the frame. The "In detail"
button opens the dialog window that contains detailed listing of the dimensioning results.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
-228-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Dimensioning"
Sta)ilit%
Pressing the "Sta)ilit%" button launches the "Slope sta)ilit%" program. This program then
allows us to check the overall stability of the analyzed structure. The button is available only if
the program "Slope sta)ilit%" is installed.
After completing all analyses press the "O7" button to leave the program all data are then
carried over to the analysis protocol of the "/asonr% wall" program.
-229-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Stabilit#"
Progra' Gra&it% (all
Pro8ect
The "Pro8ect" frame is used to input the basic project data and to specify the overall setting of
the analysis run. The frame contains an input form to introduce the basic data about the
analyzed task, i.e. project information, project description, date, etc. This information is
further used in text and graphical outputs.
The frame also allows the user to switch analysis units (metric / imperial).
Frame "Pro'ect"
Settings
The frame "Settings" serves to introduce the basic "Settings" of the program such as
standards and theories of analyses, the way of proving safety of a structure and individual
-230-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
coefficients of the analysis.
The programs contain not only the pre-defined )asic Settings for individual countries, but
also allow the user to create their own user6de"ined Settings, which can be subsequently
used in all GEO5 programs.
The "Select" button enables to choose an already created Setting from the "Settings list".
The "Settings Ad'inistrator" button opens the "Administrator" dialogue window, which
allows for viewing and modifying individual Setting. One may also identify the visible settings
in the Settings list. Data in the Settings administrator can be also eported and i'ported.
The "Add to the ad'inistrator" button allows for creating user-defined Settings, which are
subsequently added to the Settings administrator.
The "/odi"%" button enables a quick visualization and editing of the current Setting in the
opened program. Modifying any of the parameters changes the title to "Inputted "or the
current task". Individual analyses are then performed with this local setting. Should we
consider this setting as suitable also for other tasks, we add the setting into the "Settings
ad'inistrator" by pressing the "Add to the ad'inistrator" button.
The "Inputted "or the current task" setting is usually created when importing older data.
Settings of analysis parameters are performed in the "Materials and standards" and "Wall
analysis" tab sheets.
Frame "Settings"
Geo'etr%
The "Geo'etr%" frame allows by pressing the button for selecting the wall shape. The
selected shape with a graphic hint ("Chart o" wall geo'etr%") appears in the left part of the
frame. The shape of a wall can be edited either in the frame by inserting values into input
fields, or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
In case the structure is composed of inclined segments it is required to enter the ratio of sides
of an inclined segment 1:;. !he straight structure is specified by entering the value zero.
The program makes it possible to export the geometry of a structure in the *.DXF format.
-231-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ")eometr#"
/aterial
The "/aterial" frame allows for the selection of material parameters for concrete and
longitudinal steel reinforcements.
Two options are available when selecting the material type:
- the "Catalog" button opens the "Catalog o" 'aterials" dialog window (for concrete or
steel reinforcements), the list of materials then serves to select the desired material
- the "Own" button opens the "3ditor o" 'aterial 6 Concrete" dialog window (for
concrete) or the "3ditor o" 'aterial 6 ,ein"orcing steel )ars" dialog window (for
longitudinal steel reinforcements), which allows for manual specification of material
parameters
The catalogs content depends on the selection of standard for the design of concrete structures
set in the "Materials and standards" tab sheet. The input field in the upper part of the frame
serves to specify the wall bulk weight.
-232-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Material"
Pro"ile
The "Pro"ile" frame contains a table with a list of inputted interfaces. After specifying
interfaces it is possible to edit thicknesses of individual layers with the help of active
dimensions.
Adding (editing) layer is performed in the "Add @editA inter"ace" dialog window. The /-
coordinate measured from the top point of a structure is specified (/-axis).
The program allows for raising or lowering the top point of a structure in the "Change o"
terrain ele&ation" dialog window so that the whole interface can be translated while keeping
the thicknesses of individual layers. This function is important when copying the profile from
program "!errain".
The program makes it possible to import a profile in the gINT format.
-233-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The frame "Profile"
Soils
The "Soils" frame contains a table with a list of inputted soils. The table also provides
information about currently selected soil displayed in the right part of the frame.
Adding (editing) a soil is performed in the "Add (edit) soil" dialog window.
The soil characteristics needed in the program are further specified in the following chapters:
"Basic data", "Earth pressure at rest" and "Uplift pressure".
The program makes it possible to import soils in the gINT format.
-234-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Soils"
Basic data
This part of the window serves to introduce basic parameters of soils unit weight1 angle o"
internal "riction and cohesion. The particular values are obtained from geotechnical survey
or from laboratory experiments. If these data are not available, it is possible to exploit built-in
database of soils, which contains values of selected characteristics of soils.
Either e""ecti&e or total parameters of the angle of internal friction and cohesion are specified
depending on the setting in the "Stress anal%sis" combo list. Whether to use effective or total
parameters depends primarily on the type of soil, type of loading, structure duration and water
conditions.
For effective stress further needs to specify the angle of internal friction between the soil and
structure, which depends on the structure material and the type of soil. Possible values of this
parameter are listed in the table of recommended values.
For total stress further needs to specify the adhesion of soil to the structure face a.
The associated theory is described in detail in chapter "Earth pressures".
-235-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ",dd new soils" - "@asic data"
Assign
The "Assign" frame contains a list of layers of profile and associated soils. The list of soils is
graphically represented using buttons in the bar above the table, or is accessible from a combo
list for each layer of the profile.
The procedure to assign soil into a layer is described in detail herein.
The program makes it possible to import soil assignment in the gINT format.
-236-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",ssign"
!errain
The "!errain" frame allows, by pressing the button, for specifying the terrain shape. The
selected shape with graphic hint ("Chart o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in
the left part of the frame. The terrain shape can be edited either in the frame by inserting
values into input fields, or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
The last option to choose from is a general shape of a terrain. In this case the frame contains a
table with a list of terrain points. The first point with coordinates [0,0] coincides with the top
point of a structure.
Analysis of earth pressures in case of inclined terrain is described in the theoretical part of the
hint, chapter "Distribution of earth pressures for broken terrain".
-237-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Terrain"
(ater
The "(ater" frame allows, by pressing the button, for selecting the type of water. The selected
type together with a graphic hint ("Chart o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in
the left part of the frame. Water parameters (h
1
, h
2
...) can be edited either in the frame by
inserting values into input fields, or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
The combo list serves to specify whether the influence of uplift pressure of water due to
different tables at the foundation joint is considered. The uplift pressure can be assumed to be
linear, parabolic or it may not be considered at all. When verifying the wall, the uplift pressure
in foundation joint due to different water tables is introduced in terms of a special force.
The last option is a manual input of pore pressure both in front and behind the structure. Two
tab sheets "In "ront o" structure" and "Behind structure" appear with tables. The table is
filled with values of pore pressure in front, or behind the structure at a depth of "/" (/-axis).
The ground water table can also be specified a)o&e the structure or earth profile,
respectively in such a case the depth of water is inputted with a negative value.
Analysis of earth pressures with influence of water is described in the theoretical part of the
hint chapter "Influence of water".
The program further allows for specifying a depth of tensile cracks filled with water.
-238-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "%ater"
Surcharge
The "Surcharge" frame contains a table with a list of inputted surcharges. Adding (editing)
surcharge is performed in the ".ew @editA surcharge" dialog window. The inputted
surcharges can be edited on the desktop with the help of active dimensions or active objects,
respectively.
The /-coordinate measured from the top point of a structure is specified (positive direction
downwards) when inputting the surcharge at a certain depth. Providing the surcharge is found
off the terrain the computer prompts an error message.
Either per'anent or &aria)le surcharge can be introduced. Selecting the particular type of
surcharge also renders the corresponding design coefficient to multiply the resulting loading
action. Favorably acting variable surcharge is not considered in the program.
Analysis of earth pressures due to surcharges is described in the theoretical part of the hint,
chapter "Influence of surcharge".
-239-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Surcharge"
Front "ace resistance
The "Front "ace resistance" frame allows by pressing the button for specifying the terrain
shape and parameters of front face resistance. The selected shape with a graphic hint ("Chart
o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in the left part of the frame. The terrain shape
can be edited either in the frame by inserting values into input fields, or on the desktop with
the help of active dimensions.
Combo lists in the frame allows the user to select the type of resistance and a soil (the combo
list contains soils introduced in the frame "Soils"). The magnitude of terrain surcharge in front
of the wall or soil thickness above the wall lowest points can also be specified in the frame.
The resistance on a structure front face can be specified as a pressure at rest, passive
pressure or reduced passive earth pressure. The resulting force due to reduced passive
pressure is found as a resultant force caused by passive pressure multiplied by a
corresponding coefficient, which follows from the inputted type of reduced passive pressure.
-240-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Front face resistance"
Applied "orces
The "Applied "orces" frame contains a table with a list of forces acting on a structure. Adding
(editing) forces is performed in the ".ew "orce @edit "orceA" dialog window. The inputted
forces can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
Applied "orces represent an additional load on the structure of the wall, sheeting or MSE wall.
We can model such as an anchoring crash barrier, crash vehicle, load from billboards and
hoardings etc. Program doesn`t adjust the applied forces in the calculation.
External load acting to the ground surface is necessary to define as surcharge.
-241-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",pplied forces"
3arthHuake
The "3arthHuake" frame serves to input earthquake parameters. Directions of inputted
earthquake effects are displayed on the desktop.
If not provided by measurements the coefficients k
h
and k
0
can be calculated following the
approach adopted from EN 1998-5.
Analysis of earth pressures while accounting for earthquake is described in the theoretical part
of the hint in chapter "Influence earthquake".
-242-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "(arthAua9e"
Stage settings
The frame "Stage settings" serves to input settings valid for a given construction stage.
Selected design situation determines the safety coefficients to be used in the analysis of a
given construction stage.
The frame view depends on the selected verification methodology. LRFD 2012 introduces new
types of design situations (Strength I, Ser&ice I, 3tre'e I).
Frame "Stage settings"
5eri"ication
The frame "5eri"ication" shows the analysis results. Several computations can be carried out
for a single task.
-243-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The frame appearance is adjusted based on the selected verification methodology.
- Verification according to the factor of safety, or the theory of limit states the column F in
the table allows for inputting the design coefficients, which multiply the calculated forces.
These forces are displayed on the desktop and are updated for every change of data and
setting in the frame.
- Analysis according to EN 1997 the column G in the table allows for specifying whether
the loading acting on a structure is considered as secondary one. This is explained in more
detail in section "Load combinations".
- Analysis according to LRFD in the case the column F is not displayed.
The procedure for wall verification is described in the theoretical part of the hint.
The computed forces are displayed on the desktop and are automatically updated with every
change of input data and setting. The right part of the frame shows the result of verification of
a wall against o&erturning and translation. The "In detail" button opens the dialog window,
which contains detailed listing of the results of verification analysis.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame ""erification"
Bearing capacit%
The "Bearing capacit%" frame displays the results from the analysis of foundation soil bearing
capacity. The stress in the footing bottom (assumed constant) is derived from all verifications
performed in the frame "Verification". The program "Spread "ooting" then considers all
verifications as loading cases.
Three basic analysis options are available in the frame:
- Input the "oundation soil The input field serves to specify the foundation soil bearing
-244-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
)earing capacit% capacity. The results of verification analysis of a soil for
eccentricit% and bearing capacity are displayed in the right
part of the frame. The "In detail" button opens the dialog
window that displays detailed listing of the results of
verification analysis of foundation soil bearing capacity.
- Co'pute the "oundation
soil )earing capacit% using
the progra' :Spread
"ooting:
Pressing the ",un Spread "ooting: button starts the
program "Spread "ooting" that allows for computing the
soil bearing capacity or settlement and rotation of a footing.
Pressing the "O7" button leaves the analysis regime the
results and all plots are copied to the program "Gra&it%
wall". The program "Spread "ooting" must be installed for
the button to be active.
- $o not co'pute @pile
"ootingA
The foundation soil bearing capacity is not computed.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame "@earing capacit#"
$i'ensioning
The "$i'ensioning" frame serves to design and verify the reinforcement of wall cross-section
the cross-section subjected to dimensioning is selected in the combo list.
- (all ste' &eri"ication
- Construction 8oint
&eri"ication
depth of construction joint from construction top edge is
specified
- (all 8u'p &eri"ication
-245-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The frame appearance is adjusted based on the selected verification methodology.
- Verification according to the factor of safety, or the theory of limit states the column F in
the table allows for inputting the design coefficients, which multiply the calculated forces.
These forces are displayed on the desktop and are updated for every change of data and
setting in the frame.
- Analysis according to EN 1997 the column G in the table allows for specifying whether
the loading acting on a structure is considered as secondary one. This is explained in more
detail in section "Load combinations".
- Analysis according to LRFD in the case the column F is not displayed.
Calculation of forces and their action on the analyzed cross-section is described here. The wall
stem and construction joint are always loaded by the pressure at rest.
The procedure to derive distribution of internal forces in individual cross-sections is described
in the theoretical part of this hint.
Dimensioning of the reinforced concrete is performed according to the standard set in the
"Materials and standards" tab sheet.
Several computations for various cross-sections can be carried out. Various design coefficients
of individual forces can also be specified. The resulting forces are displayed on the desktop and
are updated with an arbitrary change in data or setting specified in the frame. The "In detail"
button opens the dialog window that contains detailed listing of the dimensioning results.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame "Dimensioning"
Sta)ilit%
Pressing the "Sta)ilit%" button launches the "Slope sta)ilit%" program. This program then
-246-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
allows us to check the overall stability of the analyzed structure. The button is available only if
the program "Slope sta)ilit%" is installed.
After completing all analyses press the "O7" button to leave the program all data are then
carried over to the analysis protocol of the "Gra&it% wall" program.
Frame "Stabilit#"
Progra' Pre"a) (all
Pro8ect
The "Pro8ect" frame is used to input the basic project data and to specify the overall setting of
the analysis run. The frame contains an input form to introduce the basic data about the
analyzed task, i.e. project information, project description, date, etc. This information is
further used in text and graphical outputs.
The frame also allows the user to switch analysis units (metric / imperial).
-247-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Pro'ect"
Settings
The frame "Settings" serves to introduce the basic "Settings" of the program such as
standards and theories of analyses, the way of proving safety of a structure and individual
coefficients of the analysis.
The programs contain not only the pre-defined )asic Settings for individual countries, but
also allow the user to create their own user6de"ined Settings, which can be subsequently
used in all GEO5 programs.
The "Select" button enables to choose an already created Setting from the "Settings list".
The "Settings Ad'inistrator" button opens the "Administrator" dialogue window, which
allows for viewing and modifying individual Setting. One may also identify the visible settings
in the Settings list. Data in the Settings administrator can be also eported and i'ported.
The "Add to the ad'inistrator" button allows for creating user-defined Settings, which are
subsequently added to the Settings administrator.
The "/odi"%" button enables a quick visualization and editing of the current Setting in the
opened program. Modifying any of the parameters changes the title to "Inputted "or the
current task". Individual analyses are then performed with this local setting. Should we
consider this setting as suitable also for other tasks, we add the setting into the "Settings
ad'inistrator" by pressing the "Add to the ad'inistrator" button.
The "Inputted "or the current task" setting is usually created when importing older data.
Settings of analysis parameters are performed in the "Materials and standards" and "Wall
analysis" tab sheets.
Frame "Settings"
Geo'etr%
The "Geo'etr%" frame contains a table with a list of inputted structural precast units (blocks)
of a wall (the lowest block is labeled as No. 1). Adding (editing) blocks is performed in the
".ew )lock @3dit )lockA" dialog window.
This dialog window serves to define the geo'etr% o" a )lock, parameters of reinforcement
(length, anchorage length, tensile strength and pull out resistance) and 'aterial
-248-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
characteristics (self weight, shear resistance between two blocks, cohesion).
The program allows for adding (inserting) another block in between two already existing blocks
of a structure. Inserting a new block is performed in the "Insert )lock" dialog window that
complies with the ".ew )lock" dialog window. The inserted block is ordered such to proceed
the currently selected block of a structure.
The inputted blocks can be further edited on the desktop with the help of active dimensions or
active objects - double clicking on a structure opens a dialog window with a given block. (hen
using the regi'e o" acti&e o)8ects the &isuali-ation o" detailed di'ensions 'ust )e
turned o"" in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window0
The program makes it possible to export the geometry of a structure in the *.DXF format.
Frame ")eometr#"
Pro"ile
The "Pro"ile" frame contains a table with a list of inputted interfaces. After specifying
interfaces it is possible to edit thicknesses of individual layers with the help of active
dimensions.
Adding (editing) layer is performed in the "Add @editA inter"ace" dialog window. The /-
coordinate measured from the top point of a structure is specified (/-axis).
The program allows for raising or lowering the top point of a structure in the "Change o"
terrain ele&ation" dialog window so that the whole interface can be translated while keeping
the thicknesses of individual layers. This function is important when copying the profile from
program "!errain".
The program makes it possible to import a profile in the gINT format.
-249-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Profile"
Soils
The "Soils" frame contains a table with a list of inputted soils. The table also provides
information about currently selected soil displayed in the right part of the frame.
Adding (editing) a soil is performed in the "Add (edit) soil" dialog window.
The soil characteristics needed in the program are further specified in the following chapters:
"Basic data", "Earth pressure at rest" and "Uplift pressure".
The program makes it possible to import soils in the gINT format.
-250-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Soils"
Basic data
This part of the window serves to introduce basic parameters of soils unit weight1 angle o"
internal "riction and cohesion. The particular values are obtained from geotechnical survey
or from laboratory experiments. If these data are not available, it is possible to exploit built-in
database of soils, which contains values of selected characteristics of soils.
Either e""ecti&e or total parameters of the angle of internal friction and cohesion are specified
depending on the setting in the "Stress anal%sis" combo list. Whether to use effective or total
parameters depends primarily on the type of soil, type of loading, structure duration and water
conditions.
For effective stress further needs to specify the angle of internal friction between the soil and
structure, which depends on the structure material and the type of soil. Possible values of this
parameter are listed in the table of recommended values.
For total stress further needs to specify the adhesion of soil to the structure face a.
The associated theory is described in detail in chapter "Earth pressures".
-251-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ",dd new soils" - "@asic data"
Assign
The "Assign" frame contains a list of layers of profile and associated soils. The list of soils is
graphically represented using buttons in the bar above the table, or is accessible from a combo
list for each layer of the profile.
The procedure to assign soil into a layer is described in detail herein.
The program makes it possible to import soil assignment in the gINT format.
-252-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",ssign"
!errain
The "!errain" frame allows, by pressing the button, for specifying the terrain shape. The
selected shape with graphic hint ("Chart o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in
the left part of the frame. The terrain shape can be edited either in the frame by inserting
values into input fields, or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
The last option to choose from is a general shape of a terrain. In this case the frame contains a
table with a list of terrain points. The first point with coordinates [0,0] coincides with the top
point of a structure.
Analysis of earth pressures in case of inclined terrain is described in the theoretical part of the
hint, chapter "Distribution of earth pressures for broken terrain".
-253-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Terrain"
(ater
The "(ater" frame allows, by pressing the button, for selecting the type of water. The selected
type together with a graphic hint ("Chart o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in
the left part of the frame. Water parameters (h
1
, h
2
...) can be edited either in the frame by
inserting values into input fields, or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
The combo list serves to specify whether the influence of uplift pressure of water due to
different tables at the foundation joint is considered. The uplift pressure can be assumed to be
linear, parabolic or it may not be considered at all. When verifying the wall, the uplift pressure
in foundation joint due to different water tables is introduced in terms of a special force.
The last option is a manual input of pore pressure both in front and behind the structure. Two
tab sheets "In "ront o" structure" and "Behind structure" appear with tables. The table is
filled with values of pore pressure in front, or behind the structure at a depth of "/" (/-axis).
The ground water table can also be specified a)o&e the structure or earth profile,
respectively in such a case the depth of water is inputted with a negative value.
Analysis of earth pressures with influence of water is described in the theoretical part of the
hint chapter "Influence of water".
The program further allows for specifying a depth of tensile cracks filled with water.
-254-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "%ater"
Surcharge
The "Surcharge" frame contains a table with a list of inputted surcharges. Adding (editing)
surcharge is performed in the ".ew @editA surcharge" dialog window. The inputted
surcharges can be edited on the desktop with the help of active dimensions or active objects,
respectively.
The /-coordinate measured from the top point of a structure is specified (positive direction
downwards) when inputting the surcharge at a certain depth. Providing the surcharge is found
off the terrain the computer prompts an error message.
Either per'anent or &aria)le surcharge can be introduced. Selecting the particular type of
surcharge also renders the corresponding design coefficient to multiply the resulting loading
action. Favorably acting variable surcharge is not considered in the program.
Analysis of earth pressures due to surcharges is described in the theoretical part of the hint,
chapter "Influence of surcharge".
-255-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Surcharge"
Front "ace resistance
The "Front "ace resistance" frame allows by pressing the button for specifying the terrain
shape and parameters of front face resistance. The selected shape with a graphic hint ("Chart
o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in the left part of the frame. The terrain shape
can be edited either in the frame by inserting values into input fields, or on the desktop with
the help of active dimensions.
Combo lists in the frame allows the user to select the type of resistance and a soil (the combo
list contains soils introduced in the frame "Soils"). The magnitude of terrain surcharge in front
of the wall or soil thickness above the wall lowest points can also be specified in the frame.
The resistance on a structure front face can be specified as a pressure at rest, passive
pressure or reduced passive earth pressure. The resulting force due to reduced passive
pressure is found as a resultant force caused by passive pressure multiplied by a
corresponding coefficient, which follows from the inputted type of reduced passive pressure.
-256-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Front face resistance"
Applied "orces
The "Applied "orces" frame contains a table with a list of forces acting on a structure. Adding
(editing) forces is performed in the ".ew "orce @edit "orceA" dialog window. The inputted
forces can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
Applied "orces represent an additional load on the structure of the wall, sheeting or MSE wall.
We can model such as an anchoring crash barrier, crash vehicle, load from billboards and
hoardings etc. Program doesn`t adjust the applied forces in the calculation.
External load acting to the ground surface is necessary to define as surcharge.
-257-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",pplied forces"
3arthHuake
The "3arthHuake" frame serves to input earthquake parameters. Directions of inputted
earthquake effects are displayed on the desktop.
If not provided by measurements the coefficients k
h
and k
0
can be calculated following the
approach adopted from EN 1998-5.
Analysis of earth pressures while accounting for earthquake is described in the theoretical part
of the hint in chapter "Influence earthquake".
-258-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "(arthAua9e"
Stage settings
The frame "Stage settings" serves to input settings valid for a given construction stage.
Selected design situation determines the safety coefficients to be used in the analysis of a
given construction stage.
The frame view depends on the selected verification methodology. LRFD 2012 introduces new
types of design situations (Strength I, Ser&ice I, 3tre'e I).
Frame "Stage settings"
5eri"ication
The frame "5eri"ication" shows the analysis results. Several computations can be carried out
for a single task.
-259-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The frame appearance is adjusted based on the selected verification methodology.
- Verification according to the factor of safety, or the theory of limit states the column F in
the table allows for inputting the design coefficients, which multiply the calculated forces.
These forces are displayed on the desktop and are updated for every change of data and
setting in the frame.
- Analysis according to EN 1997 the column G in the table allows for specifying whether
the loading acting on a structure is considered as secondary one. This is explained in more
detail in section "Load combinations".
- Analysis according to LRFD in the case the column F is not displayed.
The procedure for wall verification is described in the theoretical part of the hint.
The computed forces are displayed on the desktop and are automatically updated with every
change of input data and setting. The right part of the frame shows the result of verification of
a wall against o&erturning and translation. The "In detail" button opens the dialog window,
which contains detailed listing of the results of verification analysis.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame ""erification"
Bearing capacit%
The "Bearing capacit%" frame displays the results from the analysis of foundation soil bearing
capacity. The stress in the footing bottom (assumed constant) is derived from all verifications
performed in the frame "Verification". The program "Spread "ooting" then considers all
verifications as loading cases.
Three basic analysis options are available in the frame:
- Input the "oundation soil The input field serves to specify the foundation soil bearing
-260-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
)earing capacit% capacity. The results of verification analysis of a soil for
eccentricit% and bearing capacity are displayed in the right
part of the frame. The "In detail" button opens the dialog
window that displays detailed listing of the results of
verification analysis of foundation soil bearing capacity.
- Co'pute the "oundation
soil )earing capacit% using
the progra' :Spread
"ooting:
Pressing the ",un Spread "ooting: button starts the
program "Spread "ooting" that allows for computing the
soil bearing capacity or settlement and rotation of a footing.
Pressing the "O7" button leaves the analysis regime the
results and all plots are copied to the program "Pre"a)
wall". The program "Spread "ooting" must be installed for
the button to be active.
- $o not co'pute @pile
"ootingA
The foundation soil bearing capacity is not computed.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame "@earing capacit#"
$i'ensioning
The "$i'ensioning" frame allows for verifying joints between individual blocks of a wall. The
"Joint a)o&e )lock .o0" field serves to select the desired joint subjected to verification
analysis. The verification against o&erturning and translation is performed in the same way
as for the entire wall friction between blocks and cohesion of a block material are inputted in
the frame "Geometry".
The frame appearance is adjusted based on the selected verification methodology.
- Verification according to the factor of safety, or the theory of limit states the column F in
-261-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
the table allows for inputting the design coefficients, which multiply the calculated forces.
These forces are displayed on the desktop and are updated for every change of data and
setting in the frame.
- Analysis according to EN 1997 the column G in the table allows for specifying whether
the loading acting on a structure is considered as secondary one. This is explained in more
detail in section "Load combinations".
- Analysis according to LRFD in the case the column F is not displayed.
Several computations for various cross-sections can be carried out. Various design coefficients
of individual forces can also be specified. The resulting forces are displayed on the desktop and
are updated with an arbitrary change in data or setting specified in the frame. The "In detail"
button opens the dialog window that contains detailed listing of the dimensioning results.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame "Dimensioning"
Internal sliding
The frame serves to verify the limit state for slip along reinforcement the frame is therefore
accessible only in stages, where the reinforcements are defined.
The window requires inputting the reinforcement number the forces entering verification
analysis together with the shape of sliding block are then displayed. The calculated forces are
stored in the table.
Several calculations for various reinforcements can be carried out. Various design coefficients
of individual forces can also be specified. The resulting forces are displayed on the desktop and
are updated with an arbitrary change in data or setting specified in the frame. The "In detail"
button opens the dialog window that contains detailed listing of the dimensioning results.
The verification procedure depends on settings in the "Wall analysis" tab sheet either based
-262-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
on "actors o" sa"et% or according to the theor% o" li'it states. The solution procedure is
described herein.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame "+nternal sliding"
Sta)ilit%
Pressing the "Sta)ilit%" button launches the "Slope sta)ilit%" program. This program then
allows us to check the overall stability of the analyzed structure. The button is available only if
the program "Slope sta)ilit%" is installed.
After completing all analyses press the "O7" button to leave the program all data are then
carried over to the analysis protocol of the "Pre"a) wall" program.
-263-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Stabilit#"
Progra' Ga)ion
Pro8ect
The "Pro8ect" frame is used to input the basic project data and to specify the overall setting of
the analysis run. The frame contains an input form to introduce the basic data about the
analyzed task, i.e. project information, project description, date, etc. This information is
further used in text and graphical outputs.
The frame also allows the user to switch analysis units (metric / imperial).
Frame "Pro'ect"
-264-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Settings
The frame "Settings" serves to introduce the basic "Settings" of the program such as
standards and theories of analyses, the way of proving safety of a structure and individual
coefficients of the analysis.
The programs contain not only the pre-defined )asic Settings for individual countries, but
also allow the user to create their own user6de"ined Settings, which can be subsequently
used in all GEO5 programs.
The "Select" button enables to choose an already created Setting from the "Settings list".
The "Settings Ad'inistrator" button opens the "Administrator" dialogue window, which
allows for viewing and modifying individual Setting. One may also identify the visible settings
in the Settings list. Data in the Settings administrator can be also eported and i'ported.
The "Add to the ad'inistrator" button allows for creating user-defined Settings, which are
subsequently added to the Settings administrator.
The "/odi"%" button enables a quick visualization and editing of the current Setting in the
opened program. Modifying any of the parameters changes the title to "Inputted "or the
current task". Individual analyses are then performed with this local setting. Should we
consider this setting as suitable also for other tasks, we add the setting into the "Settings
ad'inistrator" by pressing the "Add to the ad'inistrator" button.
The "Inputted "or the current task" setting is usually created when importing older data.
Settings of analysis parameters are performed in the "Materials and standards" and "Wall
analysis" tab sheets.
Frame "Settings"
/aterial
The "/aterial" frame contains a table with a list of inputted filling (aggregates) and material
parameters of applied gabion wire netting. Adding (Editing) material and netting is performed
in the ".ew 'aterial @3dit 'aterialA" dialog window.
The material parameters of filling and netting of currently selected gabion block are displayed
in the right part of the frame.
An approximate value of the angle of internal friction of the material of gabion filler is for a well
-265-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
graded gravel in the range of "# - 40, for a quarry masonry it can be larger.
Frame "Material"
Geo'etr%
The "Geo'etr%" frame contains a table with a list of inputted blocks of a wall (the lowest
block is labeled as No. 1). Adding (editing) blocks is performed in the ".ew )lock @3dit
)lockA" dialog window.
This dialog window serves to define the geo'etr% o" a )lock, and parameters of mesh
overhang (overhang length, overhang anchorage, bearing capacity against pull out).
The program allows for adding (inserting) another block in between two already existing blocks
of a structure. Inserting a new block is performed in the "Insert )lock" dialog window that
complies with the ".ew )lock" dialog window. The inserted block is ordered such to proceed
the currently selected block of a structure.
The inputted blocks can be can be further edited on the desktop with the help of active
dimensions or active objects - double clicking on a structure opens a dialog window with a
given block. (hen using the regi'e o" acti&e o)8ects the &isuali-ation o" detailed
di'ensions 'ust )e turned o"" in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window0
The program makes it possible to export the geometry of a structure in the *.DXF format.
-266-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ")eometr#"
Pro"ile
The "Pro"ile" frame contains a table with a list of inputted interfaces. After specifying
interfaces it is possible to edit thicknesses of individual layers with the help of active
dimensions.
Adding (editing) layer is performed in the "Add @editA inter"ace" dialog window. The /-
coordinate measured from the top point of a structure is specified (/-axis).
The program allows for raising or lowering the top point of a structure in the "Change o"
terrain ele&ation" dialog window so that the whole interface can be translated while keeping
the thicknesses of individual layers. This function is important when copying the profile from
program "!errain".
The program makes it possible to import a profile in the gINT format.
-267-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Profile"
Soils
The "Soils" frame contains a table with a list of inputted soils. The table also provides
information about currently selected soil displayed in the right part of the frame.
Adding (editing) a soil is performed in the "Add (edit) soil" dialog window.
The soil characteristics needed in the program are further specified in the following chapters:
"Basic data", "Earth pressure at rest" and "Uplift pressure".
The program makes it possible to import soils in the gINT format.
-268-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Soils"
Basic data
This part of the window serves to introduce basic parameters of soils unit weight1 angle o"
internal "riction and cohesion. The particular values are obtained from geotechnical survey
or from laboratory experiments. If these data are not available, it is possible to exploit built-in
database of soils, which contains values of selected characteristics of soils.
Either e""ecti&e or total parameters of the angle of internal friction and cohesion are specified
depending on the setting in the "Stress anal%sis" combo list. Whether to use effective or total
parameters depends primarily on the type of soil, type of loading, structure duration and water
conditions.
For effective stress further needs to specify the angle of internal friction between the soil and
structure, which depends on the structure material and the type of soil. Possible values of this
parameter are listed in the table of recommended values.
For total stress further needs to specify the adhesion of soil to the structure face a.
The associated theory is described in detail in chapter "Earth pressures".
-269-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ",dd new soils" - "@asic data"
Assign
The "Assign" frame contains a list of layers of profile and associated soils. The list of soils is
graphically represented using buttons in the bar above the table, or is accessible from a combo
list for each layer of the profile.
The procedure to assign soil into a layer is described in detail herein.
The program makes it possible to import soil assignment in the gINT format.
-270-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",ssign"
!errain
The "!errain" frame allows, by pressing the button, for specifying the terrain shape. The
selected shape with graphic hint ("Chart o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in
the left part of the frame. The terrain shape can be edited either in the frame by inserting
values into input fields, or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
The last option to choose from is a general shape of a terrain. In this case the frame contains a
table with a list of terrain points. The first point with coordinates [0,0] coincides with the top
point of a structure.
Analysis of earth pressures in case of inclined terrain is described in the theoretical part of the
hint, chapter "Distribution of earth pressures for broken terrain".
-271-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Terrain"
(ater
The "(ater" frame allows, by pressing the button, for selecting the type of water. The selected
type together with a graphic hint ("Chart o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in
the left part of the frame. Water parameters (h
1
, h
2
...) can be edited either in the frame by
inserting values into input fields, or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
The combo list serves to specify whether the influence of uplift pressure of water due to
different tables at the foundation joint is considered. The uplift pressure can be assumed to be
linear, parabolic or it may not be considered at all. When verifying the wall, the uplift pressure
in foundation joint due to different water tables is introduced in terms of a special force.
The last option is a manual input of pore pressure both in front and behind the structure. Two
tab sheets "In "ront o" structure" and "Behind structure" appear with tables. The table is
filled with values of pore pressure in front, or behind the structure at a depth of "/" (/-axis).
The ground water table can also be specified a)o&e the structure or earth profile,
respectively in such a case the depth of water is inputted with a negative value.
Analysis of earth pressures with influence of water is described in the theoretical part of the
hint chapter "Influence of water".
The program further allows for specifying a depth of tensile cracks filled with water.
-272-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "%ater"
Surcharge
The "Surcharge" frame contains a table with a list of inputted surcharges. Adding (editing)
surcharge is performed in the ".ew @editA surcharge" dialog window. The inputted
surcharges can be edited on the desktop with the help of active dimensions or active objects,
respectively.
The /-coordinate measured from the top point of a structure is specified (positive direction
downwards) when inputting the surcharge at a certain depth. Providing the surcharge is found
off the terrain the computer prompts an error message.
Either per'anent or &aria)le surcharge can be introduced. Selecting the particular type of
surcharge also renders the corresponding design coefficient to multiply the resulting loading
action. Favorably acting variable surcharge is not considered in the program.
Analysis of earth pressures due to surcharges is described in the theoretical part of the hint,
chapter "Influence of surcharge".
-273-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Surcharge"
Front "ace resistance
The "Front "ace resistance" frame allows by pressing the button for specifying theterrain
shape and parameters of front face resistance. The selected shape with a graphic hint ("Chart
o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in the left part of the frame. The terrain shape
can be edited either in the frame by inserting values into input fields, or on the desktop with
the help of active dimensions.
Combo lists in the frame allows the user to select the type of resistance and a soil (the combo
list contains soils introduced in the frame "Soils"). The magnitude of terrain surcharge in front
of the wall or soil thickness above the wall lowest points can also be specified in the frame.
The resistance on a structure front face can be specified as a pressure at rest, passive
pressure or reduced passive earth pressure. The resulting force due to reduced passive
pressure is found as a resultant force caused by passive pressure multiplied by a
corresponding coefficient, which follows from the inputted type of reduced passive pressure.
-274-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Front face resistance"
Applied "orces
The "Applied "orces" frame contains a table with a list of forces acting on a structure. Adding
(editing) forces is performed in the ".ew "orce @edit "orceA" dialog window. The inputted
forces can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
Applied "orces represent an additional load on the structure of the wall, sheeting or MSE wall.
We can model such as an anchoring crash barrier, crash vehicle, load from billboards and
hoardings etc. Program doesn`t adjust the applied forces in the calculation.
External load acting to the ground surface is necessary to define as surcharge.
-275-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",pplied forces"
3arthHuake
The "3arthHuake" frame serves to input earthquake parameters. Directions of inputted
earthquake effects are displayed on the desktop.
If not provided by measurements the coefficients k
h
and k
0
can be calculated following the
approach adopted from EN 1998-5.
Analysis of earth pressures while accounting for earthquake is described in the theoretical part
of the hint in chapter "Influence earthquake".
-276-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "(arthAua9e"
Stage settings
The frame "Stage settings" serves to input settings valid for a given construction stage.
Selected design situation determines the safety coefficients to be used in the analysis of a
given construction stage.
The frame view depends on the selected verification methodology. LRFD 2012 introduces new
types of design situations (Strength I, Ser&ice I, 3tre'e I).
Frame "Stage settings"
5eri"ication
The frame "5eri"ication" shows the analysis results. Several computations can be carried out
for a single task.
-277-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The frame appearance is adjusted based on the selected verification methodology.
- Verification according to the factor of safety, or the theory of limit states the column F in
the table allows for inputting the design coefficients, which multiply the calculated forces.
These forces are displayed on the desktop and are updated for every change of data and
setting in the frame.
- Analysis according to EN 1997 the column G in the table allows for specifying whether
the loading acting on a structure is considered as secondary one. This is explained in more
detail in section "Load combinations".
- Analysis according to LRFD in the case the column F is not displayed.
The procedure for wall verification is described in the theoretical part of the hint.
The computed forces are displayed on the desktop and are automatically updated with every
change of input data and setting. The right part of the frame shows the result of verification of
a wall against o&erturning and translation. The "In detail" button opens the dialog window,
which contains detailed listing of the results of verification analysis.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame ""erification"
Bearing capacit%
The "Bearing capacit%" frame displays the results from the analysis of foundation soil bearing
capacity. The stress in the footing bottom (assumed constant) is derived from all verifications
performed in the frame "Verification". The program "Spread "ooting" then considers all
verifications as loading cases.
Three basic analysis options are available in the frame:
- Input the "oundation soil
)earing capacit%
The input field serves to specify the foundation soil bearing
capacity. The results of verification analysis of a soil for
eccentricit% and bearing capacity are displayed in the right
-278-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
part of the frame. The "In detail" button opens the dialog
window that displays detailed listing of the results of
verification analysis of foundation soil bearing capacity.
- Co'pute the "oundation
soil )earing capacit% using
the progra' :Spread
"ooting:
Pressing the ",un Spread "ooting: button starts the
program "Spread "ooting" that allows for computing the
soil bearing capacity or settlement and rotation of a footing.
Pressing the "O7" button leaves the analysis regime the
results and all plots are copied to the program "Ga)ion".
The program "Spread "ooting" must be installed for the
button to be active.
- $o not co'pute @pile
"ootingA
The foundation soil bearing capacity is not computed.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame "@earing capacit#"
$i'ensioning
The "$i'ensioning" frame allows for verifying individual joints of gabion blocks. The "Joint
a)o&e )lock .o0" field serves to select the desired joint subjected to verification analysis. The
verification against overturning, translation, for side pressure and joint between blocks is
performed.
The frame appearance is adjusted based on the selected verification methodology.
- Verification according to the factor of safety, or the theory of limit states the column F in
the table allows for inputting the design coefficients, which multiply the calculated forces.
These forces are displayed on the desktop and are updated for every change of data and
setting in the frame.
-279-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- Analysis according to EN 1997 the column G in the table allows for specifying whether
the loading acting on a structure is considered as secondary one. This is explained in more
detail in section "Load combinations".
- Analysis according to LRFD in the case the column F is not displayed.
Several computations for various cross-sections can be carried out. Various design coefficients
of individual forces can also be specified. The resulting forces are displayed on the desktop and
are updated with an arbitrary change in data or setting specified in the frame. The "In detail"
button opens the dialog window that contains detailed listing of the dimensioning results.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame "Dimensioning"
Sta)ilit%
Pressing the "Sta)ilit%" button launches the "Slope sta)ilit%" program. This program then
allows us to check the overall stability of the analyzed structure. The button is available only if
the program "Slope sta)ilit%" is installed.
After completing all analyses press the "O7" button to leave the program all data are then
carried over to the analysis protocol of the "Ga)ion" program.
-280-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Stabilit#"
Progra' Spread Footing
Pro8ect
The "Pro8ect" frame is used to input the basic project data and to specify the overall setting of
the analysis run. The frame contains an input form to introduce the basic data about the
analyzed task, i.e. project information, project description, date, etc. This information is
further used in text and graphical outputs.
The frame also allows the user to switch analysis units (metric / imperial).
Frame "Pro'ect"
-281-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Settings
The frame "Settings" serves to introduce the basic "Settings" of the program such as
standards and theories of analyses, the way of proving safety of a structure and individual
coefficients of the analysis.
The programs contain not only the pre-defined )asic Settings for individual countries, but
also allow the user to create their own user6de"ined Settings, which can be subsequently
used in all GEO5 programs.
The "Select" button enables to choose an already created Setting from the "Settings list".
The "Settings Ad'inistrator" button opens the "Administrator" dialogue window, which
allows for viewing and modifying individual Setting. One may also identify the visible settings
in the Settings list. Data in the Settings administrator can be also eported and i'ported.
The "Add to the ad'inistrator" button allows for creating user-defined Settings, which are
subsequently added to the Settings administrator.
The "/odi"%" button enables a quick visualization and editing of the current Setting in the
opened program. Modifying any of the parameters changes the title to "Inputted "or the
current task". Individual analyses are then performed with this local setting. Should we
consider this setting as suitable also for other tasks, we add the setting into the "Settings
ad'inistrator" by pressing the "Add to the ad'inistrator" button.
The "Inputted "or the current task" setting is usually created when importing older data.
Settings of analysis parameters are performed in the "Materials and standards", "Settlement"
and "Spread Footing" tab sheets.
Four options are available to calculate the vertical bearing capacity of a spread footing:
- anal%sis "or drained conditions
- anal%sis "or undrained conditions
- anal%sis o" "oundation on rock su)grade
- input &ertical )earing capacit% o" soil R
,
Frame "Settings"
Pro"ile
The "Pro"ile" frame contains a table with a list of inputted interfaces. After specifying
interfaces it is possible to edit thicknesses of individual layers with the help of active
dimensions.
Adding (editing) layer is performed in the "Add @editA inter"ace" dialog window. The /-
-282-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
coordinate measured from the top point of a structure is specified (/-axis).
The program allows for raising or lowering the top point of a structure in the "Change o"
terrain ele&ation" dialog window so that the whole interface can be translated while keeping
the thicknesses of individual layers. This function is important when copying the profile from
program "!errain".
The program makes it possible to import a profile in the gINT format.
Frame "Profile"
Soils
The "Soils" frame contains a table with a list of inputted soils. The table also provides
information about currently selected soil displayed in the right part of the frame.
Adding (editing) a soil is performed in the "Add (edit) soil" dialog window.
The soil characteristics needed in the program are further specified in the following chapters:
"Basic data", "Uplift pressure", "Foundation bearing capacity" and "Settlement".
The program makes it possible to import soils in the gINT format.
-283-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Soils"
Basic data
This part of the window serves to introduce basic parameters of soils unit weight1 angle o"
internal "riction and cohesion. The particular values are obtained from geotechnical survey
or from laboratory experiments. If these data are not available, it is possible to exploit built-in
database of soils, which contains values of selected characteristics of soils.
Soil parameters differ according to the analysis type and analysis method ("Settings" frame,
"Spread Footing" tab sheet).
The analysis type differs according:
- anal%sis "or drained conditions; e""ecti&e parameters of shear strength of soil c
e6
,
e6
are used commonly.
- anal%sis "or undrained conditions; vertical bearing capacity of foundation depends on
undrained shear strength of soil c
9
. 3""ecti&e angle of internal friction
e6
is defined only
for calculaction of earth pressure to solve horizontal bearing capacity of foundation.
- anal%sis o" "oundation on rock su)grade; for this analysis method program defines
angle of internal friction of rock , compressive strength
c
, coeficient of damage of rock
<, coefficient of structural strength m
)
and Geological Strength Index.
The associated theory is described in detail in chapter "Analysis of bearing capacity of
foundation".
-284-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ",dd new soils" - "@asic data"
Assign
The "Assign" frame contains a list of layers of profile and associated soils. The list of soils is
graphically represented using buttons in the bar above the table, or is accessible from a combo
list for each layer of the profile.
The procedure to assign soil into a layer is described in detail herein.
The program makes it possible to import soil assignment in the gINT format.
-285-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",ssign"
Foundation
The "Foundation" frame allows for selecting a type of foundation. The selected type with
graphic hint ("Geo'etr% sche'e") of inputted values is displayed in the left part of the
frame. The values can be edited either in the frame by inserting values into input fields, or on
the desktop with the help of active dimensions. The frame also serves to specify the bulk
weight of overburden.
The following types of foundations can be selected:
- Centric spread "ooting - Circular spread "ooting
- 3ccentric spread "ooting - Circular stepped spread
- Strip "ooting - Centric spread "ooting with )atter
- Stepped centric spread "ooting - 3ccentric spread "ooting with )atter
- Stepped eccentric spread "ooting
The soil profile is specified from the original ground. The foundation bearing capacity
depends mainly on the depth o" "oundation 'easured "ro' the "inished grade. When the
finished grade is found above the original ground then it is required to assign the same depth
to both, the finished grade and original ground, and introduce into subsoil a layer with a new
made-up-ground. This frame also allows for inputting the "oundation thickness.
When completed the foundation is usually filled up with a soil its bulk weight must be
specified (O&er)urden )ulk weight). Providing the analysis follows the theory of limit states
its weight is multiplied by the coefficient
m
inputted in the "Spread Footing" tab sheet.
For foundations with undrained subsoil (type of analysis is selected in the frame "Settings") it
is possible to introduce an inclination o" the "inished grade and "ooting )otto'. In all
-286-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
other cases both the ground and footing bottom are horizontal.
Frame "Foundation"
#oad
The "#oad" frame contains a table with a list of inputted loads. Adding (editing) loads is
performed in the ".ew @editA load" dialog window. Input of individual forces follows the sign
convention displayed in the right part of the dialog window.
The following types of loading can be specified:
- design load serves to verify the foundation bearing capacity
- service load serves to compute the foundation settlement and rotation
Dimensioning of reinforcements assumed for the foundation is carried out for both types of
loading.
When performing the analysis according to 3. 1DDE or #,F$ (selected in the "Spread
Footing" tab sheet) it is assumed that the design load is determined in accordance with the
corresponding standards and individual components of loading are alread% pre6'ultiplied by
corresponding partial factors - the program does not modify the inputted load an% "urther.
The foundation is loaded always at the contact point between column and foundation. The
program automatically computes the "oundation sel" weight and the weight o"
o&er)urden.
The "Ser&ice" button allows for creating the service loads from the already inputted design
loads (analysis according to the factor of safety or the theory of limit states).
The program also allows for import of loads using the "I'port" button.
-287-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "3oad"
I'port o" loads
It is possible to import values of loading into the program from text files. Import parameters
are set in the "I'port o" loads" dialog window. In the "Colu'n" input boxes you define the
column number in the text file, from which you wish to read data. The "/ultiplier" box allows
for multiplying the original value by an arbitrary number (e.g. using the number one with a
minus sign changes the load direction). The "I'port" button opens the "Open" dialog
window, which allows for loading the respective text file. The names of individual loadings if
contained by the first column of the text file can be loaded while importing the data by
checking the ".a'e in the "irst colu'n" box.
-288-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window "+mport of loads"
The program allows for importing data from an arbitrary text file @?0!>!). All rows in the text
file marked at the beginning by a semicolon are ignored by the program. The figure shows a
listing of imported data, where values of individual forces start in the fourth column.
(&ample of file "+mport of loading"
Geo'etr%
The "Geo'etr%" frame allows for specifying the foundation shape. The selected shape with
graphic hint ("Geo'etr% sche'e") of inputted values is displayed in the left part of the
-289-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
frame. The values can be edited either in the frame by inserting values into input fields, or on
the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
Foundation t%pe and its thickness are specified in the "Foundation"frame.
The program automatically computes the sel" weight o" )oth "oundation and o&er)urden
a)o&e the "oundation. The foundation self weight is specified in the "Material" frame.
Providing the analysis is carried out employing the theory of limit states the footing self weight
is multiplied by coefficients specified in the "Spread Footing" tab sheet.
The program makes it possible to export the geometry of a structure in the *.DXF format.
Frame ")eometr#"
The "$i'ensions design" button opens the "Foundation di'ensions design" that serves
with the help of the program to compute dimensions of a foundation. The dialog window
allows for inputting the bearing capacity of foundation soil R
,
or to select the option
"Anal%-e". In such a case the program determines all dimensions of a foundation based on
inputted para'eters (soils, profile, water impact, send-gravel-cushion, setting, etc.).
While leaving the dialog window by pressing the "O7" button the specified dimensions are
loaded into the "Geo'etr%" frame.
-290-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window "Foundation dimensions design"
Sand6gra&el cushion
The "Sand6gra&el cushion" frame allows for inputting parameters of the sand-gravel cushion
below foundation. The cushion thickness and overhang over foundation edge are required. The
values can be edited either in the frame by inserting values into input fields, or on the desktop
with the help of active dimensions.
The cushion filling can be selected from a combo list that contains soils specified in the frame
"Soils".
The inputted sand-gravel cushion influences the analysis of both the foundation load bearing
capacity and settlement.
-291-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Sand - grael cushion"
/aterial
The "/aterial" frame allows for the selection of material parameters for concrete and
longitudinal and transverse steel reinforcements.
Two options are available when selecting the material type:
- the "Catalog" button opens the "/aterial catalog" dialog window (for concrete or steel
reinforcements), the list of materials then serves to select the desired material
- the "Own" button opens the "Concrete" dialog window (for concrete) or the
",ein"orcing steel )ars" dialog window (for longitudinal and transverse steel
reinforcements), which allows for manual specification of material parameters
The catalogs content depends on the selection of standard for the design of concrete structures
set in the "Materials and standards" tab sheet.
The input field in the upper part of the frame serves to specify the wall )ulk weight.
-292-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Material"
Surcharge
The "Surcharge" frame contains a table with a list of inputted surcharges. Adding (editing)
surcharge is performed in the ".ew @editA surcharge" dialog window. The values are
specified according to "Geo'etr%" chart displayed in the right part of the dialog window. The
inputted surcharges can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
The z-coordinate measured from the foundation joint of a structure is specified (positive
direction downwards) when inputting the surcharge at a depth different from the depth of
foundation joint.
The surcharge is considered only when co'puting settle'ent and rotation of a foundation,
in which case it increases the stress in soil below foundation. When co'puting the
"oundation )earing capacit%, the surcharge is not considered its presence would increase
the bearing capacity.
-293-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Surcharge"
(ater1 inco'pressi)le su)soil
The "(ater * IS" frame serves to specify the depth o" ground water ta)le and level of
inco'pressi)le su)soil.
The values can be edited either in the frame by inserting values into input fields, or on the
desktop with the help of active dimensions.
The G(! changes the geostatic stress in the soil profile.
The inco'pressi)le su)soil cuts off the in"luence -one below foundation and also
influences reduction in settlement.
-294-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "%ater< incompressible subsoil"
Stage settings
The frame "Stage settings" serves to input settings valid for a given construction stage.
Selected design situation determines the safety coefficients to be used in the analysis of a
given construction stage.
The frame view depends on the selected verification methodology. LRFD 2012 introduces new
types of design situations (Strength I, Ser&ice I, 3tre'e I).
Frame "Stage settings"
Bearing capacit%
The "10 #S" frame serves to verify the &ertical and hori-ontal )earing capacit% o" a
"ooting. More computations can be performed in the frame. The verification can be performed
-295-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
either for individual loads or the program finds the 'ost critical one (can be selected from a
combo list).
The analysis follows the theory approach selected in the "Spread Footing" tab sheet. This tab
sheet serves to choose the verification methodology (according to EN 1997, LRFD, factor of
safety, limit states).
The vertical bearing capacity analysis requires selection of the type of contact pressure
(general shape, rectangle). The shape of contact pressure is plotted in the left part of the
desktop.
The horizontal bearing capacity analysis requires selection of the type of earth resistance that
can be assumed as the pressure at rest1 passi&e pressure or the reduced passi&e
pressure.
The soil para'eters (friction angle structure-soil, cohesion structure-soil) can be further
reduced when computing the horizontal bearing capacity.
When evaluating the uplift resistance the view of the "5eri"ication on upli"t" dialogue window
is adjusted according to the analysis method selected in the "Settings" frame.
Detailed listing of the results is displayed in the right part of the desktop. Visualization of
results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame "5:3S - bearing of a footing"
Settle'ent and rotation
The "20#S" frame serves to compute the foundation settlement and rotation. The frame allows
for more analyses. The verification can be performed either for individual loads or the program
finds the 'ost critical one (can be selected from combo list).
The analysis of foundation settlement and rotation is carried out according to the theory
specified in the frame "Spread Footing" tab sheet.
-296-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The stress in the footing button can be subtracted from the geostatic stress given by:
- original ground
- "inished grade
- not speci"ied
Distributions of the geostatic stress and the stress incre'ent below foundation are
displayed in the left part of the desktop. The label below footing represents the depth o"
de"or'ation -one. The stress is drawn below footing at the point with a characteristic
deformation.
The frame also allows for specifying the coefficient of reduction of computation of settlement.
The detailed listing of the verification analysis results is displayed in the right part of the
desktop. It can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame "0: 3S - settlement and rotation of a footing"
$i'ensioning
The "$i'ensioning" frame allows for designing and verifying the longitudinal reinforcement of
a foundation and also for verifying the foundation against being pushed through. The
verification can be performed either for individual loads or the program finds the 'ost critical
one (can be selected from a combo list).
The program derives the stress in the construction joint and determines the internal forces in
individual cross-sections.
Dimensioning of the reinforced concrete is performed according to the standard set in the
"Materials and standards" tab sheet.
The resulting information are displayed on the desktop and are updated with an arbitrary
change in data or setting specified in the frame. The "In detail" button opens the dialog
-297-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
window that contains detailed listing of the dimensioning results.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame "Dimensioning"
Progra' Piles
Pro8ect
The "Pro8ect" frame is used to input the basic project data and to specify the overall setting of
the analysis run. The frame contains an input form to introduce the basic data about the
analyzed task, i.e. project information, project description, date, etc. This information is
further used in text and graphical outputs.
The frame also allows the user to switch analysis units (metric / imperial).
Frame "Pro'ect"
-298-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Settings
The frame "Settings" serves to introduce the basic "Settings" of the program such as
standards and theories of analyses, the way of proving safety of a structure and individual
coefficients of the analysis.
The programs contain not only the pre-defined )asic Settings for individual countries, but
also allow the user to create their own user6de"ined Settings, which can be subsequently
used in all GEO5 programs.
The "Select" button enables to choose an already created Setting from the "Settings list".
The "Settings Ad'inistrator" button opens the "Administrator" dialogue window, which
allows for viewing and modifying individual Setting. One may also identify the visible settings
in the Settings list. Data in the Settings administrator can be also eported and i'ported.
The "Add to the ad'inistrator" button allows for creating user-defined Settings, which are
subsequently added to the Settings administrator.
The "/odi"%" button enables a quick visualization and editing of the current Setting in the
opened program. Modifying any of the parameters changes the title to "Inputted "or the
current task". Individual analyses are then performed with this local setting. Should we
consider this setting as suitable also for other tasks, we add the setting into the "Settings
ad'inistrator" by pressing the "Add to the ad'inistrator" button.
The "Inputted "or the current task" setting is usually created when importing older data.
Settings of analysis parameters are performed in the "Materials and standards" and "Piles" tab
sheets.
The pile vertical bearing capacity can be found either by using the analytical solution or the
spring method. Analytical solution is defined for:
- anal%sis "or drained conditions (CSN 73 1002, Effective stress method, NAVFAC DM
7.2)
- anal%sis "or undrained conditions (Tomlinson, NAVFAC DM 7.2)
Frame "Settings"
Pro"ile
The "Pro"ile" frame contains a table with a list of inputted interfaces. After specifying
interfaces it is possible to edit thicknesses of individual layers with the help of active
dimensions.
Adding (editing) layer is performed in the "Add @editA inter"ace" dialog window. The /-
coordinate measured from the top point of a structure is specified (/-axis).
-299-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The program allows for raising or lowering the top point of a structure in the "Change o"
terrain ele&ation" dialog window so that the whole interface can be translated while keeping
the thicknesses of individual layers. This function is important when copying the profile from
program "!errain".
The program makes it possible to import a profile in the gINT format.
Frame "Profile"
/odulus o" su)soil reaction
The combo list serves to select one of the 'ethods "or the e&aluation o" modulus of subsoil
reaction the required material parameters of soils are inputted in the frame "Soils" based on
the selected method.
Selecting the option "Input )% distri)ution" opens a table that allows for specifying the
values of the modulus of subsoil reaction along the pile.
-300-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Modulus of subsoil reaction"
Soils
The "Soils" frame contains a table with a list of inputted soils. The table also provides
information about currently selected soil displayed in the right part of the frame.
Adding (editing) a soil is performed in the "Add (edit) soil" dialog window.
The soil characteristics needed in the program are further specified in the following chapters:
"Basic data", "Uplift pressure", "Oedometric modulus", "Modulus of subsoil reaction", "Empirical
coefficient of adhesion" and "Consistency coefficient". The specified soil parameters depend on
the set up of modulus of subsoil reaction and selected theory of analysis specified in the "Piles"
tab sheet.
The program makes it possible to import soils in the gINT format.
-301-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Soils"
Basic data
This part of the window serves to introduce basic parameters of soils unit weight1 angle o"
internal "riction and cohesion. The particular values are obtained from geotechnical survey
or from laboratory experiments. If these data are not available, it is possible to exploit built-in
database of soils, which contains values of selected characteristics of soils.
Soil parameters differ according to the analysis type and analysis method ("Settings" frame,
"Piles" tab sheet).
The analysis type differs according:
- anal%sis "or drained conditions; e""ecti&e parameters of shear strength of soil c
e6
,
e6
are used commonly ("CSN 73 1002","Effective stress").
- anal%sis "or undrained conditions; in program is defined total shear strength of soil c
9
("Tomlinson").
- /ethod .A5FAC $/ E02: this method combines two types of calculation. For each layer
of soil is defined, whether the soil is calculated as drained (cohesionless) or undrained
(cohesive).
The associated theory is described in detail in chapter "Pile analysis".
-302-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ",dd new soils" - "@asic data"
Assign
The "Assign" frame contains a list of layers of profile and associated soils. The list of soils is
graphically represented using buttons in the bar above the table, or is accessible from a combo
list for each layer of the profile.
The procedure to assign soil into a layer is described in detail herein.
The program makes it possible to import soil assignment in the gINT format.
-303-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",ssign"
#oad
The "#oad" frame contains a table with a list inputted loads. Adding (editing) load is performed
in the ".ew @editA load" dialog window. The forces are inputted following the sign convention
displayed in the upper part of the dialog window.
The following types of loading can be specified:
- design load serves to verify the vertical and horizontal bearing capacity
- service load serves to compute the settlement of pile (Poulos, Masopust)
When performing the analysis according to 3. 1DDE or #,F$ (selected in the "Piles" tab
sheet) it is assumed that the design load is determined in accordance with the corresponding
standards and individual components of loading are alread% pre6'ultiplied by corresponding
partial factors - the program does not modify the inputted load an% "urther.
The "Ser&ice" button allows for creating the service loads from the already inputted design
loads (analysis according to the factor of safety or the theory of limit states).
The program also allows for import of loading using the "I'port" button.
-304-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "3oad"
Geo'etr%
The "Geo'etr%" frame allows for specifying the pile cross6section (circular, circular variable,
rectangle, I-type cross-section) based on the theor% o" anal%sis (specified in the "Piles" tab
sheet). The selected shape with graphic hint is displayed in the central section of the frame.
Input fields serve to specify dimensions of the selected cross-section.
Cross6sectional characteristics (area and moment of inertia) are computed by default, but
they can also be specified (tubes, hollow cross-sections, steel I-profiles).
The bottom part of the frame serves to specify the pile location (pile lift out and the depth of
finished grade). The pile lift out can also be negative in such a case the pile is placed "in6
ground".
For piles analyzed using the spring method method and conventional theories, it is possible to
account for the influence of pile technology by selecting the specific type of pile or directly by
inputting coefficients.
The program makes it possible to export the geometry of a structure in the *.DXF format.
-305-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ")eometr#"
/aterial
The "/aterial" frame allows for specifying the material parameters. The )ulk weight o" a
structure and material of a pile (concrete1 ti')er1 steel) are introduced in the input field in
the right part of the frame.
The elastic and shear moduli need to be specified when assuming ti')er or steel piles.
In case of a concrete pile the concrete material and parameters of transverse and
longitudinal steel reinforcements are required. Two options are available when selecting the
type of material:
- the "Catalog" button opens the "/aterial catalog" dialog window (for concrete or steel
reinforcements), the list of materials then serves to select the desired material
- the "Own" button opens the "Concrete" dialog window (for concrete) or the
",ein"orcing steel )ars" dialog window (for longitudinal steel reinforcements), which
allows for manual specification of material parameters
The catalogs content depends on the selection of standard for the design of concrete structures
set in the "Materials and standards" tab sheet.
-306-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Material"
(ater1 inco'pressi)le su)soil
The "(ater * IS" frame serves to specify the depth o" ground water ta)le and level of
inco'pressi)le su)soil.
The values can be edited either in the frame by inserting values into input fields, or on the
desktop with the help of active dimensions.
The G(! changes the geostatic stress in the soil profile.
The inco'pressi)le su)soil cuts off the in"luence -one below foundation and also
influences reduction in settlement.
-307-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "%ater< incompressible subsoil"
.egati&e skin "riction
The ".egati&e skin "riction" frame serves to specify the settlement of surrounding terrain
and the depth of influence zone. For more information on the influence of negative skin friction
the user is referred to theoretical section.
The setting option in the frame is active only when the spring 'ethod is selected for the
analysis in the frame "Settings".
-308-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ".egatie s9in friction"
Stage settings
The frame "Stage settings" serves to input settings valid for a given construction stage.
Selected design situation determines the safety coefficients to be used in the analysis of a
given construction stage.
Frame "Stage settings"
5ertical )earing capacit% + anal%tical solution
The "5ertical )earing capacit%" frame serves to verify the vertical bearing capacity of a pile.
Several analyses can be carried out in the frame. The verification can be performed for
individual loads, or the program locates the 'ost critical one (can be selected from a combo
list). The frame appearance changes depending on the analysis type setting in the frame
"Settings".
-309-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The analysis is performed based on the theory defined in the "Piles" tab sheet. This tab sheet
serves to choose the verification methodology (EN 1997-1, factor of safety, limit states).
Calculation of the pile vertical bearing capacity by using the analytical solution is performed
for:
- drained conditions (CSN 73 1002, Effective stress method, NAVFAC DM 7.2)
- undrained conditions (Tomlinson, NAVFAC DM 7.2)
The "In detail" button opens the dialog window containing detailed listing of the verification
results.
The analysis results are displayed in the right part of the desktop. Visualization of the results
can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame ""ertical bearing capacit#" - anal#sis based on classical theor#
5ertical )earing capacit% 6 Spring 'ethod
The "5ertical )earing capacit%" frame allows for verifying the pile &ertical )earing
capacit%. The analysis is performed automatically when switching to this frame. More
computations can be performed in the frame. The verification can be performed either for
individual loads or the program finds the 'ost critical one (can be selected from a combo
list).
The analysis is performed with the help of spring method. The results are automatically
updated whenever one of the analysis parameters "/ai'al de"or'ation", "Coe""icient
increasing li'it skin "riction due to technolog%" or "Procedure deter'ining in"luence
-one" is changed.
Two options are available to determine influence zone:
- By default the evaluation of the depth of influence zone below the pile base follows the
-310-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
procedure described in the theoretical part of the hint in section "Depth of influence zone".
The depth of influence zone on the pile skin is determined as a k-multiple of the pile
diameter. The value of k increases from 1 for zero loading to the value of 2,# when
exceeding the limit skin friction.
- The second option assumes the depth of influence zone below the foot and on the skin to
be set conservatively a k
th
multiple of the pile diameter, where the value of k can be
selected. During a gradual increase of pile surcharge the value of k for the depth of
influence zone on the pile skin is continuously changed from 1 at the onset of loading to
the specified value when exceeding the limit skin friction. The value of k for the influence
zone below the pile base remains constant during the analysis.
The second method, originally used in the old version GEO4, with the value of k = 2,# offers
less accurate results and usually underestimates the pile bearing capacity. Therefore a new
option that allows for specifying the depth of influence zone through analysis is offered and is
also recommended by the default setting.
Switching between results is available in the left part of the frame (limit loading curve,
distributions of internal forces, dependence of shear on displacement). The shear-displacement
relationship is derived for a given depth measured from the pile head. The results are updated
whenever the depth is changed.
The "In detail" button opens the dialog window, which contains detailed listing of the results
of verification analysis.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame ""ertical bearing capacit#" $ anal#sis using spring method
Settle'ent + linear loading cur&e @PoulosA
The "Settle'ent" frame serves to display the pile loading cur&e. More analyses can be
-311-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
performed in the frame. The combo list allows for choosing the type of pile (bored into
compressible subsoil, bearer pile).
Next, it is necessary to enter the value of limit settlement. The program constructs the
loading cur&e always such that this li'it settle'ent is not eceeded.
The analysis is carried out according to the selected theory of settlement analysis (linear). The
analysis theory is selected in the "Piles" tab sheet. The table in the bottom part of the frame
directly allows with the help of the mouse for editing the defined parameters. The "3dit -
s
"
button opens the dialog window with a help section for parameters specifying the secant
deformation modulus. Pressing the "O7" button in a particular window stores the inputted
para'eters for a given layer into the table.
The anal%sis results are displayed in the right part of the desktop. The "In detail" button
opens the dialog window containing detailed listing of the verification results.
The analysis results (loading curve) are displayed in the right part of the desktop. Visualization
of the results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame "Settlement" - linear loading cure 7Poulos8
Settle'ent + nonlinear loading cur&e @/asopustA
The "Settle'ent" frame serves to display the pile loading cur&e. More analyses can be
performed in the frame.
The combo list serves to choose the type of loading (design1 ser&ice). Next, it is possible to
enter the coefficient of influence of pile shaft. The loading curve analysis is always performed
up to the li'it settle'ent o" 2# mm.
The analysis is performed according to the selected theory of settlement analysis (nonlinear).
The analysis theory is selected in the "Piles" tab sheet. The table in the bottom part of the
frame directly allows with the help of the mouse for editing the defined parameters. Buttons
-312-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
"3dit a1 >", "3dit e1 6" and "3dit -
s
" open dialog windows with a help section for entered
parameters of regression coefficients and secant deformation modulus. Pressing the "O7"
button in a particular window stores the inputted para'eters for a given layer into the
table.
The anal%sis results are displayed in the right part of the desktop. The "In detail" button
opens the dialog window containing detailed listing of the verification results.
The analysis results (loading curve) are displayed in the right part of the desktop. Visualization
of the results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame "Settlement" - nonlinear loading cure 7Masopust8
Hori-ontal )earing capacit%
The horizontal bearing capacity of a pile is verified in the "Hori-ontal )earing capacit%"
frame. Several analyses can be carried out. The verification analysis can be carried out for
individual loads, prescribed displacements, or the program finds the 'ost critical load (can
be selected from a combo list). Assuming the prescribed displacement type of load requires
introduction of )oundar% conditions in pile head (translation and rotation).
The "ied end type of boundary condition prescribed in the pile heel can be assumed for all
types of loading.
For steel rein"orced concrete pile the programs allow for verifying the reinforcement based
on the standard selected in the frame "Materials and standards" tab sheet.
The combo list serves to specify the direction of pile verification (x,y); for a circular pile the
program allows for displaying the results in the 'ost stressed direction.
The "In detail" button opens the dialog window that contains detailed listing of the verification
results.
-313-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The analysis results are displayed on the desktop. Visualization of results can be adjusted in
the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame "Hori!ontal bearing capacit#"
Progra' Settle'ent
Pro8ect
The "Pro8ect" frame is used to input the basic project data and to specify the overall setting of
the analysis run. The frame contains an input form to introduce the basic data about the
analyzed task, i.e. project information, project description, date, etc. This information is
further used in text and graphical outputs.
The frame also allows the user to switch analysis units (metric / imperial).
-314-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Pro'ect"
Settings
The frame "Settings" serves to introduce the basic "Settings" of the program such as
standards and theories of analyses, the way of proving safety of a structure and individual
coefficients of the analysis.
The programs contain not only the pre-defined )asic Settings for individual countries, but
also allow the user to create their own user6de"ined Settings, which can be subsequently
used in all GEO5 programs.
The "Select" button enables to choose an already created Setting from the "Settings list".
The "Settings Ad'inistrator" button opens the "Administrator" dialogue window, which
allows for viewing and modifying individual Setting. One may also identify the visible settings
in the Settings list. Data in the Settings administrator can be also eported and i'ported.
The "Add to the ad'inistrator" button allows for creating user-defined Settings, which are
subsequently added to the Settings administrator.
The "/odi"%" button enables a quick visualization and editing of the current Setting in the
opened program. Modifying any of the parameters changes the title to "Inputted "or the
current task". Individual analyses are then performed with this local setting. Should we
consider this setting as suitable also for other tasks, we add the setting into the "Settings
ad'inistrator" by pressing the "Add to the ad'inistrator" button.
The "Inputted "or the current task" setting is usually created when importing older data.
Settings of analysis parameters are performed in the "Settlement" tab sheet.
The frame also serves to specify whether to perform the consolidation analysis.
Frame "Settings"
Inter"ace
The "Inter"ace" frame serves to introduce individual soil interfaces into the soil body. Detailed
description how to deal with interfaces is described herein.
The program makes it possible to import or export interfaces in the *.DXF format. They can
also be imported in the gINT format.
-315-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "+nterface"
3')ank'ent
The "3')ank'ent" frame allows for inputting interfaces to create an embankment above the
current terrain. The frame contains a table with a list of interfaces forming the embankment. A
table listing the points of currently selected interface of the embankment is displayed in the
mid section of the frame. Inputting an embankment interface follows the same steps as used
for standard interfaces.
An embankment cannot be specified in the first stage of construction. An embankment cannot
be built if there is an earth cut already specified in a given stage - in such a case either a new
stage of construction must be introduced for embankment input or the existing open cut must
be first removed.
-316-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "(mban9ment"
3arth cut
The "3arth cut" frame serves to specify the shape of an open cut. This function allows for
modifying the terrain profile within a given stage of construction. Several earth cuts can be
introduced at the same time. In such a case some of the lines in the cut appear partially above
the terrain.
A table listing individual interface points is displayed in the left part of the frame. Inputting an
earth cut interface follows the same steps as used for standard interfaces.
An open cut cannot be specified in the first stage of construction. An earth cut cannot be built
if there is an embankment already specified in a given stage - in such a case either a new
stage of construction must be introduced for earth cut input or the existing embankment must
be first removed.
-317-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "(arth cut"
Inco'pressi)le su)soil
The frame "Inco'pressi)le su)soil" serves to input a depth of inco'pressi)le su)soil0
Inputting the depth of incompressible subsoil is the same as when inputting standard
interfaces.
Inputting an incompressible subsoil is one the options how to restrict an influence zone if
inputted, then both ranges and tilted sections are drawn up to a depth of incompressible
subsoil. No ground deformation appears below the incompressible subsoil.
-318-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "+ncompressible subsoil"
Soils
The "Soils" frame contains a table with a list of inputted soils. The table also provides
information about currently selected soil displayed in the right part of the frame.
Adding (editing) a soil is performed in the "Add (edit) soil" dialog window.
The soil characteristics needed in the program are further specified in the following chapters:
"Uplift pressure" and "Settlement analysis". In consolidation analysis the coefficient of
permeability or consolidation coefficient must be entered. The input parameters of soils are
determined based on the selected theory of analysis in the "Settlement" tab sheet.
The particular values are obtained from geotechnical survey or from laboratory experiments. If
these data are not available, it is possible to exploit built-in database of soils, which contains
values of selected characteristics of soils.
The program makes it possible to import soils in the gINT format.
-319-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Soils"
Basic data
This part of the dialog window serves to specify the unit weight.
-320-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ",dd new soils" - "@asic data"
Assign
The "Assign" frame contains a list of layers of profile and associated soils. The list of soils is
graphically represented using buttons in the bar above the table, or is accessible from a combo
list for each layer of the profile.
The procedure to assign soil into a layer is described in detail herein.
The program makes it possible to import soil assignment in the gINT format.
-321-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",ssign"
Surcharge
The "Surcharge" frame contains a table with a list of inputted surcharges. Adding (editing)
surcharge is performed in the ".ew @editA surcharge" dialog window. The inputted
surcharges can be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
All inputted parameters of a surcharge can be modified in the construction stage where the
surcharge was specified. Only the surcharge magnitude can be modified in all subsequent
construction stages (option "Ad8ust surcharge").
Influence of surcharge on the change of stress in the soil body is described in the theoretical
part of the help section.
-322-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Surcharge"
(ater
The "(ater" frame serves to set the type of ground water table.
Inputting the ground water table or isolines, respectively, is identical with the standard input of
interfaces.
If the inputted data in individual stages are different, the program then allows for accepting
the data from the previous stage of construction by pressing the "Accept" button.
-323-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "%ater"
Stage settings
The frame "Stage settings" serves to input settings valid for a given construction stage.
The frame allows for specifying the position of control holes and thicknesses and locations of
layers where the stress values are calculated.
The program determines stresses at indi&idual control holes. The terrain is always
subdivided into twenty holes with even spacing. Additional holes are automatically generated
in points specifying terrain, embankment, GWT, soil layer interfaces and end points of
surcharge. The control (calculation) holes can be plotted in the frame "Analysis".
Individual holes are di&ided into la%ers according to the inputted values. The first layer
always coincides with the original ground. In addition, all points specifying interfaces, GWT
and incompressible subsoil are included. The default setting of thicknesses of layers ensures
reasona)le speed and accurac% of the analysis.
The layers are introduced up to depth of 2#0m. In actual analyses, however, the depth of
influence zone is restricted either by the inputted incompressible subsoil or by the reduction of
magnitude of stress change or by the structural strength, respectively (depending on the
setting in the "Settlement" tab sheet).
The number and location of calculation holes can be adjusted when selecting the option "User6
de"ined". In such a case it is possible to select both the location of holes and thicknesses and
location of layers. The holes are then created according to the input in addition, the program
automatically includes all important points. When selecting the option eact distri)ution,
the holes are included into all terrain points, soil layer interfaces, embankments, GWP and into
end points of surcharge. When selecting the option 'ini'al distri)ution, the holes are not
included into points of interfaces of soil and embankment layers.
-324-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
For standard analyses we reco''end keeping the default setting of the analysis.
Frame "Settings"
Anal%sis
The "Anal%sis" frame displays the analysis results. !he anal%sis is carried out based on the
calculation theory selected in the "Setttlement" tab sheet. The depth o" in"luence -one is
determined either by inputted incompressible subsoil, by the theory restriction of primary
stress or by the theory of structural strength.
Information regarding the course of analysis, maximum settlement and the depth of influence
zone are printed out in the bottom section of the frame. In consolidation analysis (set in the
frame "Settings") this section of the frame serves for entering consolidation parameters.
The results, as the main output, are displayed on the screen. To view the results, use
the hori-ontal )ar in the upper section of the screen, which allows for adjusting the way the
resulting values are plotted. !he )ar contains the "ollowing control ite's;
- the )utton to displa% the "Settlement - results visualization settings" dialog window. This
dialog window allows for specifying all drawing parameters: parameters to display depression
line and influence zone, to set color range, to draw tilted sections, isosurfaces and isolines, etc.
- option to store individual views
- selecting &alues "or &isuali-ation + either total values, or their change during the last
calculation stage or their change in co'parison with pre&ious stages can be plotted.
The setting is available only in problems where it makes sense. It is therefore possible to
display the change of stress, settlement or deformation in comparison with previous stages
however, always the current depth of influence zone is plotted.
- selecting &aria)les
SigmaZ,tot - overall vertical total stress [9Pa<9sf]
SigmaZ,eff - overall vertical effective stress [9Pa< 9sf]
Pore pressure - stress due to water [9Pa< 9sf]
Settlement - settlement of a point [mm< feet]
Deformation - relative settlement of a layer [-]C5111
- plotting option (do not plot, isosurfaces, isolines)
The color range is visible on the right part of the desktop. The buttons for setting the color
range are located below.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
-325-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",nal#sis"
Consolidation para'eters
In consolidation analysis (set in the frame "Settings") the bottom window in the frame
"Analysis" serves for entering consolidation parameters.
The first construction stage of calculation represents only geostatic stress at initial time of
construction. Top and bottom interface of consolidated soil layer and direction of water outflow
from this layer (upwards, downwards and both downwards and upwards) is entered in the first
construction stage.
-326-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",nal#sis" $ consolidation 7first construction stage8
In other construction stages time of stage duration and load action are entered. Program
allows for choosing from two options of load acting: whole loading introduced at the beginning
of stage or load linearly increases during stage duration. Calculation is then launched only in
the construction stage where "O&erall settle'ent" is checked (may be checked in whatever
stage except first one).
-327-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",nal#sis" $ consolidation 7other construction stage8
Example: determine settlement from surcharge after 5 days, 1 month, 1 year and 5 years?
Enter construction stages according to following scheme:
1. stage Only geostatic stress
2. stage Surcharge, time: 5 days
3. stage No changes, time: 25 days
4. stage No changes, time: 335 days
5. stage No changes, time: 1490 days
6. stage Check option "O&erall settle'ent" and run the calculation
Progra' A)ut'ent
Pro8ect
The "Pro8ect" frame is used to input the basic project data and to specify the overall setting of
the analysis run. The frame contains an input form to introduce the basic data about the
analyzed task, i.e. project information, project description, date, etc. This information is
further used in text and graphical outputs.
The frame also allows the user to switch analysis units (metric / imperial).
-328-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Pro'ect"
Settings
The frame "Settings" serves to introduce the basic "Settings" of the program such as
standards and theories of analyses, the way of proving safety of a structure and individual
coefficients of the analysis.
The programs contain not only the pre-defined )asic Settings for individual countries, but
also allow the user to create their own user6de"ined Settings, which can be subsequently
used in all GEO5 programs.
The "Select" button enables to choose an already created Setting from the "Settings list".
The "Settings Ad'inistrator" button opens the "Administrator" dialogue window, which
allows for viewing and modifying individual Setting. One may also identify the visible settings
in the Settings list. Data in the Settings administrator can be also eported and i'ported.
The "Add to the ad'inistrator" button allows for creating user-defined Settings, which are
subsequently added to the Settings administrator.
The "/odi"%" button enables a quick visualization and editing of the current Setting in the
opened program. Modifying any of the parameters changes the title to "Inputted "or the
current task". Individual analyses are then performed with this local setting. Should we
consider this setting as suitable also for other tasks, we add the setting into the "Settings
ad'inistrator" by pressing the "Add to the ad'inistrator" button.
The "Inputted "or the current task" setting is usually created when importing older data.
Settings of analysis parameters are performed in the "Materials and standards" and "Wall
analysis" tab sheets.
-329-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Settings"
Geo'etric section
The frame "Geo'etric section" allows for selecting the shape of bridge abutment. The
selected shape with a graphic hint "Chart o" wall geo'etr%" appears in the left part of the
frame. The shape of a wall can be edited either in the frame by inserting values into input
fields, or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
In case the structure is composed of inclined segments it is required to enter the ratio of sides
of an inclined segment 1:;. !he straight structure is specified by entering the value zero.
The frame serves to specify the final shape of abutment including the closure wall. The
abutment can be verified also for the construction state (without the closure wall) based on the
choice in the frame "Load - LC". The abutment length and the length of abutment foundation is
specified in the frame "Geometry plane view".
The program makes it possible to export the geometry of a structure in the *.DXF format.
-330-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ")eometric section"
(ings
The frame "(ings" allows for inputting the bridge wings dimensions. The wings can be either
symmetrical or unsymmetrical. Assuming unsymmetrical wings requires inputting the right and
left wing dimensions separately. The screen always displays the currently inputted wing only
the left wing is then visualized in the remaining frames.
The frame "Geometry plane view" can also be used to input or edit the wing thicknesses and
lengths.
The Wing-abutment joint cross-section can also be verified in the frame "Dimensioning". The
loading due to moment is considered. The whole wing is loaded by acti&e pressure developed
behind the wall. The "Dimensioning" dialog window serves to input the magnitude of sur"ace
surcharge to determine the wing pressure. The surcharge specified in the frame "Surcharge"
is then not taken into account and the terrain behind the wing is considered as flat. The
resulting moment applied to the joint is obtained by multiplying the overall magnitude of soil
pressure acting on the wall surface and by the difference of centroids of the pressure resultant
and the joint.
The length of cross-section used for dimensioning is considered by default as the wing height
a different length of wing-abutment joint can also be specified after selecting the option
",educe "or di'ensioning".
When using prolonged wing walls it is possible to input dimensions of the foundation below the
wall. Such foundation jumps are reflected in the analysis by computing a fictitious width of the
foundation as:
-331-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: +
tot
-overall area of foundation including all jumps
S -length of abutment foundation
,
6)ct
-fictitious width of foundation for verification analysis
The foundation is then considered as being rectangular, which is simplified but rather
conservative assumption.
Frame "%ings"
Geo'etr% plane &iew
The frame "Geo'etr% plane &iew" allows for inputting the abutment length, length of
abutment foundation and also dimensions of abutment wings.
Dimensions can be edited either in the frame by inserting values into input fields, or on the
desktop with the help of active dimensions.
For details on the e""ect o" a)ut'ent di'ensions on verification analysis we refer the
reader to section "Calculating of abutment forces".
The program makes it possible to export the geometry of a structure in the *.DXF format.
-332-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ")eometr# plane iew"
Footing steps
The frame "Footing steps" serves to input the steps of foundation below abutment. This
option thus allows for specifying additional shapes of bridge abutment.
Adding (editing) foundation step is performed in the ".ew step" dialog window. Inputted
footing steps can be edited on the desktop with the help of active dimensions or active objects,
respectively.
-333-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Footing steps"
/aterial
The "/aterial" frame allows for the selection of material parameters for concrete and
longitudinal steel reinforcements.
Two options are available when selecting the material type:
- the "Catalog" button opens the "/aterial catalog" dialog window (for concrete or steel
reinforcements), the list of materials then serves to select the desired material
- the "Own" button opens the "Concrete" dialog window (for concrete) or the
",ein"orcing steel )ars" dialog window (for longitudinal steel reinforcements), which
allows for manual specification of material parameters
The catalogs content depends on the selection of standard for the design of concrete structures
set in the "Materials and standards" tab sheet. The input field in the upper part of the frame
serves to specify the a)ut'ent unit weight.
-334-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Material"
Pro"ile
The "Pro"ile" frame contains a table with a list of inputted interfaces. After specifying
interfaces it is possible to edit thicknesses of individual layers with the help of active
dimensions.
Adding (editing) layer is performed in the "Add @editA inter"ace" dialog window. The /-
coordinate measured from the top point of a structure is specified (/-axis).
The program allows for raising or lowering the top point of a structure in the "Change o"
terrain ele&ation" dialog window so that the whole interface can be translated while keeping
the thicknesses of individual layers. This function is important when copying the profile from
program "!errain".
The program makes it possible to import a profile in the gINT format.
-335-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Profile"
Soils
The "Soils" frame contains a table with a list of inputted soils. The table also provides
information about currently selected soil displayed in the right part of the frame.
Adding (editing) a soil is performed in the "Add (edit) soil" dialog window.
The soil characteristics needed in the program are further specified in the following chapters:
"Basic data", "Earth pressure at rest" and "Uplift pressure".
The program makes it possible import soils in the gINT format.
-336-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Soils"
Basic data
This part of the window serves to introduce basic parameters of soils unit weight1 angle o"
internal "riction and cohesion. The particular values are obtained from geotechnical survey
or from laboratory experiments. If these data are not available, it is possible to exploit built-in
database of soils, which contains values of selected characteristics of soils.
Either e""ecti&e or total parameters of the angle of internal friction and cohesion are specified
depending on the setting in the "Stress anal%sis" combo list. Whether to use effective or total
parameters depends primarily on the type of soil, type of loading, structure duration and water
conditions.
For effective stress further needs to specify the angle of internal friction between the soil and
structure, which depends on the structure material and the type of soil. Possible values of this
parameter are listed in the table of recommended values.
For total stress further needs to specify the adhesion of soil to the structure face a.
The associated theory is described in detail in chapter "Earth pressures".
-337-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ",dd new soils" - "@asic data"
#oad 6 #C
The frame "#oad + #C" serves to specify individual loading cases (construction, service) and
the loading caused by the bridge and approach slab. Verification and dimensioning analyses of
the whole bridge abutment or only its part are carried out according to the specified type of
LC.
When performing the analysis according to EN1997 or LRFD, the inputted load due to )ridge
and transition plate is not I.C,3AS3$ by any partial factors. The inputted forces must be
determined in accordance with the corresponding standards (EN 1990, EN 1991).
No load specified in the case of construction state and the abutment is verified in a given
stage of construction without a closure wall and bridge wings.
In the case of ser&ice state the abutment is loaded by the )ridge and approach sla), the
whole abutment is verified.
For abutment verification it appears advantageous to exploit the stage of construction and
specify in individual stages different load cases (e.g. construction state, service state without
live load, service state with all loads). Individual stages then allow inputting different loads,
surcharges, terrain shapes, type of pressure analysis (active, at rest), design coefficients, etc.
-338-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "3oad - 3C"
Assign
The "Assign" frame contains a list of layers of profile and associated soils. The list of soils is
graphically represented using buttons in the bar above the table, or is accessible from a combo
list for each layer of the profile.
The procedure to assign soil into a layer is described in detail herein.
The program makes it possible to import soil assignment in the gINT format.
-339-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",ssign"
!errain
The "!errain" frame allows, by pressing the button, for specifying the terrain shape. The
selected shape with graphic hint ("Chart o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in
the left part of the frame. The terrain shape can be edited either in the frame by inserting
values into input fields, or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
The last option to choose from is a general shape of a terrain. In this case the frame contains a
table with a list of terrain points. The first point with coordinates [0,0] coincides with the top
point of a structure.
Analysis of earth pressures in case of inclined terrain is described in the theoretical part of the
hint, chapter "Distribution of earth pressures for broken terrain".
-340-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Terrain"
(ater
The "(ater" frame allows, by pressing the button, for selecting the type of water. The selected
type together with a graphic hint ("Chart o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in
the left part of the frame. Water parameters (h
1
< h
2
...) can be edited either in the frame by
inserting values into input fields, or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
The combo list serves to specify whether the influence of uplift pressure of water due to
different tables at the foundation joint is considered. The uplift pressure can be assumed to be
linear, parabolic or it may not be considered at all. When verifying the wall, the uplift pressure
in base of footing joint due to different water tables is introduced in terms of a special force.
The last option is a manual input of pore pressure both in front and behind the structure. Two
tab sheets "In "ront o" structure" and "Behind structure" appear with tables. The table is
filled with values of pore pressure in front, or behind the structure at a depth of "/" (/-axis).
The ground water table can also be specified a)o&e the structure or earth profile,
respectively in such a case the depth of water is inputted with a negative value.
Analysis of earth pressures with influence of water is described in the theoretical part of the
hint chapter "Influence of water".
The program further allows for specifying a depth of tensile cracks filled with water.
-341-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "%ater"
Surcharge
The "Surcharge" frame contains a table with a list of inputted surcharges. Adding (editing)
surcharge is performed in the ".ew @editA surcharge" dialog window. The inputted
surcharges can be edited on the desktop with the help of active dimensions or active objects,
respectively.
The /-coordinate measured from the top point of a structure is specified (positive direction
downwards) when inputting the surcharge at a certain depth. Providing the surcharge is found
off the terrain the computer prompts an error message.
Analysis of earth pressures due to surcharges is described in the theoretical part of the hint,
chapter "Influence of surcharge".
-342-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Surcharge"
Front "ace resistance
The "Front "ace resistance" frame allows by pressing the button for specifying the terrain
shape and parameters of front face resistance. The selected shape with a graphic hint ("Chart
o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in the left part of the frame. The terrain shape
can be edited either in the frame by inserting values into input fields, or on the desktop with
the help of active dimensions.
Combo lists in the frame allows the user to select the type of resistance and a soil (the combo
list contains soils introduced in the frame "Soils"). The magnitude of terrain surcharge in front
of the wall or soil thickness above the wall lowest points can also be specified in the frame.
The resistance on a structure front face can be specified as a pressure at rest, passive
pressure or reduced passive earth pressure. The resulting force due to reduced passive
pressure is found as a resultant force caused by passive pressure multiplied by a
corresponding coefficient, which follows from the inputted type of reduced passive pressure.
-343-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Front face resistance"
Applied "orces
The "Applied "orces" frame contains a table with a list of forces acting on a structure. Adding
(editing) forces is performed in the ".ew "orce @edit "orceA" dialog window. The inputted
forces can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
Applied "orces represent an additional load on the structure of the wall, sheeting or MSE wall.
We can model such as an anchoring crash barrier, crash vehicle, load from billboards and
hoardings etc. Program doesn`t adjust the applied forces in the calculation.
External load acting to the ground surface is necessary to define as surcharge.
-344-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",pplied forces"
3arthHuake
The "3arthHuake" frame serves to input earthquake parameters. Directions of inputted
earthquake effects are displayed on the desktop.
Analysis of earth pressures while accounting for earthquake is described in the theoretical part
of the hint in chapter "Influence earthquake".
-345-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "(arthAua9e"
Stage settings
The frame "Stage settings" serves to input settings valid for a given construction stage.
Selected design situation determines the safety coefficients to be used in the analysis of a
given construction stage.
The frame view depends on the selected verification methodology. LRFD 2012 introduces new
types of design situations (Strength I, Ser&ice I, 3tre'e I).
Next, the frame serves to specify the type of pressure acting on a wall based on the allowable
wall deformation. Providing the wall is free to move, an active pressure is assumed, otherwise,
a pressure at rest is used.
Frame "Stage settings"
-346-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
5eri"ication
The frame "5eri"ication" shows the analysis results. Several computations can be carried out
for a single task.
The frame appearance is adjusted based on the selected verification methodology.
- Verification according to the factor of safety, or the theory of limit states the column F in
the table allows for inputting the design coefficients, which multiply the calculated forces.
These forces are displayed on the desktop and are updated for every change of data and
setting in the frame.
- Analysis according to EN 1997 the column G in the table allows for specifying whether
the loading acting on a structure is considered as secondary one. This is explained in more
detail in section "Load combinations".
- Analysis according to LRFD in the case the column F is not displayed.
The wall is loaded either by active pressure or pressure at rest depending on input in the frame
"Stage settings".
The procedure for wall verification is described in the theoretical part of the hint.
The computed forces are displayed on the desktop and are automatically updated with every
change of input data and setting. The right part of the frame shows the result of verification of
a wall against o&erturning and translation. The "In detail" button opens the dialog window,
which contains detailed listing of the results of verification analysis.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame ""erification"
-347-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Bearing capacit%
The "Bearing capacit%" frame displays the results from the analysis of foundation soil bearing
capacity. The stress in the footing bottom (assumed constant) is derived from all verifications
performed in the frame "Verification". The program "Spread "ooting" then considers all
verifications as loading cases.
Three basic analysis options are available in the frame:
- Input the "oundation soil
)earing capacit%
The input field serves to specify the foundation soil bearing
capacity. The results of verification analysis of a soil for
eccentricit% and bearing capacity are displayed in the right
part of the frame. The "In detail" button opens the dialog
window that displays detailed listing of the results of
verification analysis of foundation soil bearing capacity.
- Co'pute the "oundation
soil )earing capacit% using
the progra' :Spread
"ooting:
Pressing the ",un Spread "ooting: button starts the
program "Spread "ooting" that allows for computing the
soil bearing capacity or settlement and rotation of a footing.
Pressing the "O7" button leaves the analysis regime the
results and all plots are copied to the program "A)ut'ent".
The program "Spread "ooting" must be installed for the
button to be active.
- $o not co'pute @pile
"ootingA
The foundation soil bearing capacity is not computed.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame "@earing capacit#"
-348-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
$i'ensioning
The "$i'ensioning" frame serves to design and verify the reinforcement of abutment cross-
section the cross-section subjected to dimensioning is selected in the combo list. The table
shows the abutment forces.
Offer of cross-sections that can be verified depends on the selected load case (construction,
service). The following cross-sections are available for both the construction and service state:
- (all ste' &eri"ication
- Construction 8oint &eri"ication depth of construction joint from construction top
edge is specified
- (all 8u'p &eri"ication
The service state makes also possible to verify:
- 5eri"ication o" closure wall
- 5eri"ication wing 6
a)ut'ent
the surface surcharge due to terrain is inputted, for actual
analysis we refer to section "Wings"
The frame appearance is adjusted based on the selected verification methodology.
- Verification according to the factor of safety, or the theory of limit states the column F in
the table allows for inputting the design coefficients, which multiply the calculated forces.
These forces are displayed on the desktop and are updated for every change of data and
setting in the frame.
- Analysis according to EN 1997 the column G in the table allows for specifying whether
the loading acting on a structure is considered as secondary one. This is explained in more
detail in section "Load combinations".
- Analysis according to LRFD in the case the column F is not displayed.
The abutment is loaded either by active pressure or pressure at rest depending on the input
specified in the frame "Stage settings", an active earth pressure is used when analyzing wing
walls.
The procedure to derive distribution of internal forces in individual cross-sections is described
in the theoretical part of this hint.
Dimensioning of the reinforced concrete is performed according to the standard set in the
"Materials and standards" tab sheet. Verification analysis based on the standard CSN 73
6206 "$esign o" concrete and steel rein"orced concrete )ridge structures" is
described herein.
Several computations for various cross-sections can be carried out. Various design coefficients
of individual forces can also be specified. The resulting forces are displayed on the desktop and
are updated with an arbitrary change in data or setting specified in the frame. The "In detail"
button opens the dialog window that contains detailed listing of the dimensioning results.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
-349-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Dimensioning"
Sta)ilit%
Pressing the "Sta)ilit%" button launches the "Slope sta)ilit%" program. This program then
allows us to check the overall stability of the analyzed structure. The button is available only if
the program "Slope sta)ilit%" is installed.
After completing all analyses press the "O7" button to leave the program all data are then
carried over to the analysis protocol of the "A)ut'ent" program.
-350-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Stabilit#"
Progra' .ailed slopes
Pro8ect
The "Pro8ect" frame is used to input the basic project data and to specify the overall setting of
the analysis run. The frame contains an input form to introduce the basic data about the
analyzed task, i.e. project information, project description, date, etc. This information is
further used in text and graphical outputs.
The frame also allows the user to switch analysis units (metric / imperial).
Frame "Pro'ect"
-351-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Settings
The frame "Settings" serves to introduce the basic "Settings" of the program such as
standards and theories of analyses, the way of proving safety of a structure and individual
coefficients of the analysis.
The programs contain not only the pre-defined )asic Settings for individual countries, but
also allow the user to create their own user6de"ined Settings, which can be subsequently
used in all GEO5 programs.
The "Select" button enables to choose an already created Setting from the "Settings list".
The "Settings Ad'inistrator" button opens the "Administrator" dialogue window, which
allows for viewing and modifying individual Setting. One may also identify the visible settings
in the Settings list. Data in the Settings administrator can be also eported and i'ported.
The "Add to the ad'inistrator" button allows for creating user-defined Settings, which are
subsequently added to the Settings administrator.
The "/odi"%" button enables a quick visualization and editing of the current Setting in the
opened program. Modifying any of the parameters changes the title to "Inputted "or the
current task". Individual analyses are then performed with this local setting. Should we
consider this setting as suitable also for other tasks, we add the setting into the "Settings
ad'inistrator" by pressing the "Add to the ad'inistrator" button.
The "Inputted "or the current task" setting is usually created when importing older data.
Settings of analysis parameters are performed in the "Materials and standards", "Wall analysis"
and "Stability analisis" tab sheets.
Frame "Settings"
Geo'etr%
The frame "Geo'etr%" contains a table with a list of inputted points of the structure front
face. Adding (editing) points is performed in the "Add @editA point" dialog window.
The inputted points can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects double-
clicking an already inputted point then opens a dialog window for its editing.
One needs to specify depth (/-coordinate from the top point of a structure positive direction
-352-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
is assumed downwards) and an ;-coordinate (negative direction is assumed to the left, no
overhang of a structure is allowed.
The program makes it possible to export the structure geometry in the *.DXF format.
Frame ")eometr#"
!%pes o" nails
The frame "!%pes o" nails" serves to specify a nail type in a specific table. The strength
parameters of nails can be either inputted by the user or directly determined by the
program depending on the inputted data.
The table lists the following input data; either inputted or computed nail head strength,
nail tensile strength and its pull 6 out resistance per 1 m (1 6t).
-353-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "T#pes of nails"
Geo'etr% o" nails
The frame "Geo'etr% o" nails" contains a table with a list of inputted nails. Adding (editing)
nails is performed in the ".ew nail @3dit nailA" dialog window. The inputted nails can also be
edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
The user is required to specify the nail depth, depth o" a )ench "ro' a gi&en nail (the next
nail must be introduced as deep as to be located below the bench of the upper nail), nail
length, its diameter and distance.
Inclination of nails is regarded from the horizontal line in clockwise direction and is constant for
all nails.
-354-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ")eometr# of nails"
/aterial
The "/aterial" frame allows for the selection of material parameters for concrete and
longitudinal steel reinforcements.
Two options are available when selecting the material type:
- the "Catalog" button opens the "/aterial catalog" dialog window (for concrete or steel
reinforcements), the list of materials then serves to select the desired material
- the "Own" button opens the "Concrete" dialog window (for concrete) or the
",ein"orcing steel )ars" dialog window (for longitudinal steel reinforcements), which
allows for manual specification of material parameters
The catalogs content depends on the selection of standard for the design of concrete structures
set in the "Materials and standards" tab sheet.
-355-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Material"
Pro"ile
The "Pro"ile" frame contains a table with a list of inputted interfaces. After specifying
interfaces it is possible to edit thicknesses of individual layers with the help of active
dimensions.
Adding (editing) layer is performed in the "Add @editA inter"ace" dialog window. The /-
coordinate measured from the top point of a structure is specified (/-axis).
The program allows for raising or lowering the top point of a structure in the "Change o"
terrain ele&ation" dialog window so that the whole interface can be translated while keeping
the thicknesses of individual layers. This function is important when copying the profile from
program "!errain".
The program makes it possible to import a profile in the gINT format.
-356-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Profile"
Soils
The "Soils" frame contains a table with a list of inputted soils. The table also provides
information about currently selected soil displayed in the right part of the frame.
Adding (editing) a soil is performed in the "Add (edit) soil" dialog window.
The soil characteristics needed in the program are further specified in the following chapters:
"Basic data", "Earth pressure at rest" and "Uplift pressure".
The program makes it possible import soils in the gINT format.
-357-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Soils"
Basic data
This part of the window serves to introduce basic parameters of soils unit weight1 angle o"
internal "riction and cohesion. The particular values are obtained from geotechnical survey
or from laboratory experiments. If these data are not available, it is possible to exploit built-in
database of soils, which contains values of selected characteristics of soils.
Either e""ecti&e or total parameters of the angle of internal friction and cohesion are specified
depending on the setting in the "Stress anal%sis" combo list. Whether to use effective or total
parameters depends primarily on the type of soil, type of loading, structure duration and water
conditions.
For effective stress further needs to specify the angle of internal friction between the soil and
structure, which depends on the structure material and the type of soil. Possible values of this
parameter are listed in the table of recommended values.
For total stress further needs to specify the adhesion of soil to the structure face a.
The associated theory is described in detail in chapter "Earth pressures".
-358-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ",dd new soils" - "@asic data"
Assign
The "Assign" frame contains a list of layers of profile and associated soils. The list of soils is
graphically represented using buttons in the bar above the table, or is accessible from a combo
list for each layer of the profile.
The procedure to assign soil into a layer is described in detail herein.
The program makes it possible to import soil assignment in the gINT format.
-359-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",ssign"
!errain
The "!errain" frame allows, by pressing the button, for specifying the terrain shape. The
selected shape with graphic hint ("Chart o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in
the left part of the frame. The terrain shape can be edited either in the frame by inserting
values into input fields, or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
The last option to choose from is a general shape of a terrain. In this case the frame contains a
table with a list of terrain points. The first point with coordinates [0,0] coincides with the top
point of a structure.
Analysis of earth pressures in case of inclined terrain is described in the theoretical part of the
hint, chapter "Distribution of earth pressures for broken terrain".
-360-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Terrain"
(ater
The "(ater" frame allows, by pressing the button, for selecting the type of water. The selected
type together with a graphic hint ("Chart o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in
the left part of the frame. Water parameters (h
1
< h
2
...) can be edited either in the frame by
inserting values into input fields, or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
The combo list serves to specify whether the influence of uplift pressure of water due to
different tables at the foundation joint is considered. The uplift pressure can be assumed to be
linear, parabolic or it may not be considered at all. When verifying the wall, the uplift pressure
in base of footing joint due to different water tables is introduced in terms of a special force.
The last option is a manual input of pore pressure both in front and behind the structure. Two
tab sheets "In "ront o" structure" and "Behind structure" appear with tables. The table is
filled with values of pore pressure in front, or behind the structure at a depth of "/" (/-axis).
The ground water table can also be specified a)o&e the structure or earth profile,
respectively in such a case the depth of water is inputted with a negative value.
Analysis of earth pressures with influence of water is described in the theoretical part of the
hint chapter "Influence of water".
The program further allows for specifying a depth of tensile cracks filled with water.
-361-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "%ater"
Surcharge
The "Surcharge" frame contains a table with a list of inputted surcharges. Adding (editing)
surcharge is performed in the ".ew @editA surcharge" dialog window. The inputted
surcharges can be edited on the desktop with the help of active dimensions or active objects,
respectively.
The /-coordinate measured from the top point of a structure is specified (positive direction
downwards) when inputting the surcharge at a certain depth. Providing the surcharge is found
off the terrain the computer prompts an error message.
Analysis of earth pressures due to surcharges is described in the theoretical part of the hint,
chapter "Influence of surcharge".
-362-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Surcharge"
3arthHuake
The "3arthHuake" frame serves to input earthquake parameters. Directions of inputted
earthquake effects are displayed on the desktop.
Analysis of earth pressures while accounting for earthquake is described in the theoretical part
of the hint in chapter "Influence earthquake".
-363-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "(arthAua9e"
Stage settings
The frame "Stage settings" serves to input settings valid for a given construction stage.
Selected design situation determines the safety coefficients to be used in the analysis of a
given construction stage.
The frame view depends on the selected verification methodology. LRFD 2012 introduces new
types of design situations (Strength I, Ser&ice I, 3tre'e I).
Frame "Stage settings"
Internal sta)ilit%
The frame allows for the verification of internal stability of a structure assuming
either plane or )roken slip sur"ace.
The verification of internal stability is performed:
- According to EN 1997 (the actual verification is performed according to the theory of limit
states).
- According to LRFD (the actual verification is performed according to the theory of limit
states).
- Verification according to the factor of safety, or the theory of limit states (verification is
performed depending on the setting in the "Stability analysis" tab sheet)
Individual steps of the verification procedure are described herein.
This frame also allows for the verification of nails bearing capacity.
-364-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "+nternal stabilit#"
5eri"ication
The frame "5eri"ication" shows the analysis results. Several computations can be carried out
for a single task.
The frame appearance is adjusted based on the selected verification methodology.
- Verification according to the factor of safety, or the theory of limit states the column F in
the table allows for inputting the design coefficients, which multiply the calculated forces.
These forces are displayed on the desktop and are updated for every change of data and
setting in the frame.
- Analysis according to EN 1997 the column G in the table allows for specifying whether
the loading acting on a structure is considered as secondary one. This is explained in more
detail in section "Load combinations".
- Analysis according to LRFD in the case the column F is not displayed.
To verify the external stability a "ictitious structure (wall) is created and further subjected to
the verification analysis. A fictitious wall consists of the structure front face, a line connecting
end points of individual nails, a vertical line constructed from the end point of the first nail up
to the terrain depth and from the end point of the last nail up to the structure depth (thus the
bottom edge of a fictitious structure is always horizontal). The wall points that cause a concave
curvature of the structure back face are automatically excluded by the program. The structure
is loaded by an active earth pressure.
The procedure for wall verification is described in the theoretical part of the hint.
The computed forces are displayed on the desktop and are automatically updated with every
change of input data and setting. The right part of the frame shows the result of verification of
a wall against o&erturning and translation. The "In detail" button opens the dialog window,
which contains detailed listing of the results of verification analysis.
-365-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame ""erification"
Bearing capacit%
The "Bearing capacit%" frame displays the results from the analysis of foundation soil bearing
capacity. The stress in the footing bottom (assumed constant) is derived from all verifications
performed in the frame "Verification". The program "Spread "ooting" then considers all
verifications as loading cases.
Three basic analysis options are available in the frame:
- Input the "oundation soil
)earing capacit%
The input field serves to specify the foundation soil bearing
capacity. The results of verification analysis of a soil for
eccentricit% and bearing capacity are displayed in the right
part of the frame. The "In detail" button opens the dialog
window that displays detailed listing of the results of
verification analysis of foundation soil bearing capacity.
- Co'pute the "oundation
soil )earing capacit% using
the progra' :Spread
"ooting:
Pressing the ",un Spread "ooting: button starts the
program "Spread "ooting" that allows for computing the
soil bearing capacity or settlement and rotation of a footing.
Pressing the "O7" button leaves the analysis regime the
results and all plots are copied to the program ".ailed
slopes". The program "Spread "ooting" must be installed
for the button to be active.
- $o not co'pute @pile
"ootingA
The foundation soil bearing capacity is not computed.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
-366-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "@earing capacit#"
$i'ensioning
The frame "$i'ensioning" allows for the design and verification of the reinforcement of the
structure concrete cover. The upper part of the frame serves to choose whether the &ertical or
hori-ontal rein"orce'ent and its location will be verified. The program then determines
internal forces developed on the selected section.
The table in the bottom part of the frame serves to specify locations for the verification of the
designed reinforcement depending on the inputted standard for dimensioning of reinforced
concrete (the standard is specified in the "Materials and standards" tab sheet). A cross-section
is loaded by the bending moment in a given point. An amount of the tensile
rein"orce'ent in the cross-section is inputted. If the moment is negative, the designed
reinforcement is placed at the structure front face and if it is negative, then at the structure
back face.
-367-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Dimensioning"
3ternal sta)ilit%
Pressing the "3ternal sta)ilit%" button launches the "Slope sta)ilit%" program. This
program then allows us to check the overall stability of the analyzed structure. The button is
available only if the program "Slope sta)ilit%" is installed.
After completing all analyses press the "O7" button to leave the program all data are then
carried over to the analysis protocol of the ".ailed slopes" program.
-368-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "(&ternal stabilit#"
Progra' Ground #oss
Pro8ect
The "Pro8ect" frame is used to input the basic project data and to specify the overall setting of
the analysis run. The frame contains an input form to introduce the basic data about the
analyzed task, i.e. project information, project description, date, etc. This information is
further used in text and graphical outputs.
The frame also allows the user to switch analysis units (metric / imperial).
Frame "Pro'ect"
-369-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Settings
The frame "Settings" serves to specify standards or methods that are used to perform the
analysis.
The frame "Settings" allows for selecting the method for determining subsidence trough
(Volume loss, Classical theories) and its shape (Gauss, Aversin). It also serves to input the
coefficient of calculation of inflection point, (for classical theories only), which influences the
shape of subsidence trough.
Frame ",nal#sis methods"
Buildings
The frame "Buildings" serves to input objects above excavation. An arbitrary number of
buildings can be specified both on a ground surface and at a given depth.
-370-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "@uildings"
Pro"ile
The "Pro"ile" frame contains a table with a list of inputted interfaces. After specifying
interfaces it is possible to edit thicknesses of individual layers with the help of active
dimensions.
Adding (editing) layer is performed in the "Add @editA inter"ace" dialog window. The /-
coordinate measured from the top point of a structure is specified (/-axis).
The program allows for raising or lowering the top point of a structure in the "Change o"
terrain ele&ation" dialog window so that the whole interface can be translated while keeping
the thicknesses of individual layers. This function is important when copying the profile from
program "!errain".
Inputting data in the frame is allowed providing the classical theor% o" anal%sis is selected
in the frame "Settings".
The program makes it possible to import a profile in the gINT format.
Frame "Profile"
Soils
The "Soils" frame contains a table with a list of inputted soils. The table also provides
information about currently selected soil displayed in the right part of the frame. Adding
(editing) a soil is performed in the "Add (edit) soil" dialog window.
Inputting data in the frame is allowed providing the classical theor% o" anal%sis is selected
in the frame "Settings". The particular values are obtained from geotechnical survey or from
laboratory experiments. If these data are not available, it is possible to exploit built-in
database of soils, which contains values of selected characteristics of soils.
-371-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Possible values of the angle of internal friction and cohesion are available in chapter "Rocks
parameters".
The program makes it possible import soils in the gINT format.
Frame "Soils"
Assign
The "Assign" frame contains a list of layers of profile and associated soils. The list of soils is
graphically represented using buttons in the bar above the table, or is accessible from a combo
list for each layer of the profile.
The procedure to assign soil into a layer is described in detail herein.
Inputting data in the frame is allowed providing the classical theor% o" anal%sis is selected
in the frame "Settings".
The program makes it possible to import soil assignment in the gINT format.
-372-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",ssign"
Geo'etr%
The frame "Geo'etr%" contains a table with a list of inputted excavations. The ".ew
eca&ation @3dit eca&ationA" dialog window serves to add (edit) excavations. The inputted
excavations can also be modified on the desktop with help of active objects.
Parameters of excavation differ depending on the analysis method selected in the frame
"Settings". Each excavation can be specified either by the radius or the area of excavation.
Providing a sequential excavation is being inputted it is useful to specify the excavation area
and place a fictitious center of excavation to a center of gravity of this area.
Additional input parameters are explained in more detail when describing individual analysis
methods (Volume loss, Classical theories).
The program makes it possible to export the geometry of a structure in the *.DXF format.
-373-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ".ew e&caation"
Frame ")eometr#"
/easure'ent
The frame "/easure'ent" contains a table with a list inputted measurements. The ".ew
'easure'ent @3dit 'easure'entA" dialog window serves to add (edit) measurements. The
inputted measurements can also be modified on the desktop with help of active objects.
Inputted measurements do not in"luence the actual anal%sis their introduction into the
program has resulted purely from designers needs. After excavating the first part of a
sequential tunnel it is useful to input the values measured in the construction site into the
-374-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
program and subsequently to add the excavation input parameters such that the calculated
and 'easured &alues are the sa'e. Practical experience shows that the values of input
parameters acquired from this procedure (e.g. coefficient of volume loss) are &alid also "or
su)seHuent stages.
Frame "Measurement"
Stage settings
The frame "Stage settings" serves to input settings valid for a given construction stage.
The frame allows for introducting bounds on the tensile and gradient damage. These values
serve to verify the building damage in the frame "Damages". The program offers a default pre-
setting (default setting for 'asonr% )uildings) and a user-defined setting here it is possible
to define arbitrary criteria recommended by standards or gained from practical experience for
arbitrary types of buildings.
The boundary values must be defined either in a descending or ascending order, respectively.
Providing we wish to define fewer regions than specified in the program it is possible to
characterize certain boundaries by the same value.
-375-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Settings"
Anal%sis
The frame "Anal%sis" provides the results from the analysis of subsidence trough. More than
one analysis at different depths below the terrain surface can be performed for a single task.
The computed values are displayed on a desktop and are continuously updated whenever a
certain change in the inputted data or setting in the frame is introduced.
For a quick switch between different styles of graphical presentation of results (su)sidence
trough1 distri)ution o" &alues) the user may use the buttons in section "5isuali-ation".
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame ",nal#sis" - "Settlement"
-376-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",nal#sis" - "Diagrams"
$a'ages
The frame "Failures" provides the results of failure analysis of buildings. The program offers
four types of verifications
- Verification of tensile cracks
- Verification of gradient damage
- Verification of relative deflection of buildings (Hogging, sagging)
- Verification of the inputted section of a building
The program allows the user to perform an analysis for the current and all previous stages
(en&elope "ro' all stages) or it is possible to input individual stages and evaluate their
influence. Such a procedure makes it possible to find, e.g. an optimal process of excavation of
sequential tunnels.
Several analyses can be carried out for a single task. Visualization of results can be adjusted in
the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
-377-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Damages" - isuali!ation of tensile crac9s
Frame "Damages" - isuali!ation of gradient damage
-378-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Progra' ,ock Sta)ilit%
Pro8ect
The "Pro8ect" frame is used to input the basic project data and to specify the overall setting of
the analysis run. The frame contains an input form to introduce the basic data about the
analyzed task, i.e. project information, project description, date, etc. This information is
further used in text and graphical outputs.
The frame also allows the user to switch analysis units (metric / imperial).
Frame "Pro'ect"
Settings
The frame "Settings" serves to introduce the basic "Settings" of the program such as
standards and theories of analyses, the way of proving safety of a structure and individual
coefficients of the analysis.
The programs contain not only the pre-defined )asic Settings for individual countries, but
also allow the user to create their own user6de"ined Settings, which can be subsequently
used in all GEO5 programs.
The "Select" button enables to choose an already created Setting from the "Settings list".
The "Settings Ad'inistrator" button opens the "Administrator" dialogue window, which
allows for viewing and modifying individual Setting. One may also identify the visible settings
in the Settings list. Data in the Settings administrator can be also eported and i'ported.
The "Add to the ad'inistrator" button allows for creating user-defined Settings, which are
subsequently added to the Settings administrator.
The "/odi"%" button enables a quick visualization and editing of the current Setting in the
opened program. Modifying any of the parameters changes the title to "Inputted "or the
current task". Individual analyses are then performed with this local setting. Should we
consider this setting as suitable also for other tasks, we add the setting into the "Settings
ad'inistrator" by pressing the "Add to the ad'inistrator" button.
The "Inputted "or the current task" setting is usually created when importing older data.
Settings of analysis parameters are performed in the "Stability analysis" tab sheet.
The frame serves to select the type of slip surface:
- Plane slip surface
- Polygonal slip surface
-379-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- Earth wedge
Frame "Settings"
!errain
The frame "!errain" contains a table with a list of defined sections of a rock slope.
The coordinates o" the origin the first point of terrain followed by defined sections are
entered in the upper part of the frame. In the program the slope is always oriented from the
le"t to the right.
Adding (editing) section is performed in the ".ew section @3dit sectionA" dialog window.
These sections can also be edited on desktop with the help of active objects.
Each section can be defined by its dip, by the overall length of section, by the horizontal length
and height of section of a rock slope. Only two selected &alues are used while the others are
determined by the program automatically (if more than two entry fields are checked than the
input and computation are not carried out). Both vertical and horizontal sections as well as
overhangs can be represented.
In case of a proper input the progra' auto'aticall% plots the de"ined section on desktop
using dashed line, so that before accepting the defined section by pressing the "Add" button it
is possible to check, whether the section is correctly defined.
-380-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Terrain"
,ock
The frame ",ock" allows for entering the material parameters (approximate value) of a rock
slope (depending on the type of shear strength) including the bulk weight of a rock. Three
types of shear strengths on a slip surface are available in the program:
- Mohr - Coulomb
- Barton - Bandis
- Hoek - Brown
Material parameters of rock are then entered based on the selected method.
-381-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "6oc9"
Slip sur"ace + plane
The frame "Slip sur"ace" serves to specify the shape and parameters of a plane slip surface.
The slip surface is defined by a point in the rock body and by its gradient. The program
automatically determines intersections of the slip surface with terrain.
The program also allows for defining a tension crack with an arbitrary gradient (not available
for stepped slip surface). The crack is defined by a horizontal distance from the origin and by
its gradient.
The plane slip surface can further be labeled as smooth, undulated or stepped.
The program makes it possible to export the geometry of a structure in the *.DXF format.
-382-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Slip surface - plane"
Slip sur"ace 6 pol%gonal
The frame "Slip sur"ace" contains a table with a list of defined sections of a slip surface.
Adding (editing) section is performed in the ".ew section @3dit sectionA" dialog window.
These sections can also be edited on desktop with the help of active objects.
The coordinates of the slip surface origin a point on the slip surface followed by other
sections are entered in the upper part of the frame. This point can be found even out of the
soil body the program then automatically calculates the intersection of slip surface with
terrain.
Individual sections of the slip surface can be defined by their dip, by the overall length of
section, by the horizontal length and height of section of a rock slope. Only two selected
&alues are used while the others are determined by the program automatically (if more than
two entry fields are checked than the input and computation are not carried out). Both vertical
and horizontal sections as well as overhangs can be represented.
In case of a proper input the progra' auto'aticall% plots the de"ined section on desktop
using dashed line, so that before accepting the defined section by pressing the "Add" button it
is possible to check, whether the section is correctly defined.
The program makes it possible to export the geometry of a structure in the *.DXF format.
-383-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Slip surface - pol#gonal"
Para'eters + pol%gonal slip sur"ace
The frame "Para'eters" contains a table with a list of blocks, which are created by entering a
polygonal slip surface. Parameters of individual blocks are edited in the "3dit )lock" dialog
window. Blocks can also be edited on desktop with the help of active objects.
The Mohr-Coulomb strength parameters on a slip surface and in the joints separating individual
blocks including the bulk weight of a rock are specified here.
This window also serves to introduce forces due to water in rock blocks.
-384-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Parameters" $ pol#gonal slip surface
Dialog window "(dit bloc9"
(ater + plane slip sur"ace
The "(ater" frame allows, by pressing the button, for selecting the type of water. The selected
type together with a graphic hint ("Chart o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in
the left part of the frame. Water parameters can be edited either in the frame by inserting
values into input fields, or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
-385-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Solution procedure when accounting for water is described in the theoretical part of the help
"Influence of water on slip surface"
Frame "%ater" - plane slip surface
Surcharge + plane and pol%gonal slip sur"ace
The "Surcharge" frame contains a table with a list of inputted surcharges. Adding (editing)
surcharge is performed in the ".ew @editA surcharge" dialog window. The inputted
surcharges can be edited on the desktop with the help of active dimensions or active objects,
respectively.
Introducing surcharge forces into the analysis differs for a plane and a polygonal slip surface.
-386-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Surcharge" - plane and pol#gonal slip surface
Anchors + plane and pol%gonal slip sur"ace
The "Anchors" frame contains a table with a list of inputted anchors. Adding (editing) anchors
is performed in the ".ew anchor @/odi"% anchor para'etersA" dialog window. The
inputted anchors can be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
The following is specified location (origin), depth, free length, anchor slope, spacing between
anchors and anchor force. The anchor origin can automatically be positioned on terrain (by
checking the particular entry field). All anchor parameters can be modified only in the
construction stage, where it was introduced. The subsequent stages allow only for adjusting
the anchor force (option "Post6stressing anchor").
The plane slip surface allows for defining active and passive anchors. Only active anchors are
allowed with the polygonal slip surface.
-387-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",nchors" - plane and pol#gonal slip surface
3arthHuake
The "3arthHuake" frame serves to input earthquake parameters. Directions of inputted
earthquake effects are displayed on the desktop.
Rock slope analysis while accounting for earthquake is described in the theoretical part of the
hint in chapter "Influence earthquake".
-388-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "(arthAua9e"
Stage settings
The frame "Stage settings" serves to input settings valid for a given construction stage.
Selected design situation determines the safety coefficients to be used in the analysis of a
given construction stage.
The frame view depends on the selected verification methodology. LRFD 2012 introduces new
types of design situations (Ser&ice I, 3tre'e I).
Frame "Stage settings"
Anal%sis + plane slip sur"ace
The "Anal%sis" frame displays the analysis results. Several analyses can be performed for a
single task.
-389-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Verification of the rock slope can be carried out according to the factor of safety 9 theory of
limit states based on the input in the "Stability analysis" tab sheet. The analysis results are
displayed in the frame in the bottom part of desktop.
In this frame the program makes it possible to determine the anchor "orce needed for
obtaining the required safety factor. In such a case the "Co'pute reHuired anchor "orce"
entry field must be checked and the slope of anchor force from horizontal must be entered.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame ",nal#sis" $ plane slip surface
Anal%sis + pol%gonal slip sur"ace
The "Anal%sis" frame displays the analysis results. Several analyses can be performed for a
single task.
Verification of the rock slope can be carried out according to the factor of safety 9 theory of
limit states based on the input in the frame "Stability analysis" tab sheet. The analysis results
are displayed in the frame in the bottom part of desktop.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
-390-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",nal#sis" $ pol#gonal slip surface
Geo'etr%
The frame "Geo'etr%" allows for entering the shape of a rock slope (earth wedge).
Geometry of earth wedge is defined by directions and gradients of fall lines of faces forming
the wedge. Geometry of earth wedge is displayed on desktop using a stereographic projection.
The "3D view" button opens the dialog window for viewing an earth wedge in space.
The program makes it possible to export the geometry of a structure in the *.DXF format.
-391-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ")eometr#" $ input using directions and gradients of fall lines of faces
4$ 5iew
3D view allows for graphical check o" de"ined &alues. The picture can be rotated,
translated, zoomed in and out and highlighted in a standard way. A direct print out o" the
picture is not allowed in this version.
-392-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window "3D iew"
Slip sur"ace + rock wedge
The frame "Slip surface" serves to enter the shape of a slip surface using directions and
gradients of fall lines of faces forming the wedge. A tension crack can also be defined.
Geometry of earth wedge is displayed on desktop using a stereographic projection.
The "3D view" button opens the dialog window for viewing an earth wedge in space.
-393-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Slip surface" - roc9 wedge
Para'eters + rock wedge
The frame "Para'eters" serves to enter parameters of an earth wedge. The bulk weight of a
rock and the Mohr-Coulomb strength parameters of slip surfaces must be specified.
-394-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Parameters" - roc9 wedge
Surcharge + rock wedge
The "Surcharge" frame contains a table with a list of inputted surcharges. Adding (editing)
surcharge is performed in the ".ew @editA surcharge" dialog window.
Surcharge forces are introduced into the stability analysis of earth wedge using resolution of
forces.
-395-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Surcharge" - roc9 wedge
Anchors + rock wedge
The "Anchors" frame contains a table with a list of inputted anchors. Adding (editing) anchors
is performed in the ".ew anchor @/odi"% anchor para'etersA" dialog window.
Anchor forces are introduced into the stability analysis of earth wedge using resolution acting
of forces.
-396-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",nchors" - roc9 wedge
(ater + rock wedge
The frame "(ater" allows for introducing water into analysis. If the influence of water is taken
into account then checking the respective entry field opens the field for entering the height of
GWT above the lowest point of an earth wedge.
Solution procedure when accounting for water is described in the theoretical part of the help
"Influence of ground water". The "3D view" button opens the dialog window for viewing an
earth wedge in space.
-397-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "%ater" - roc9 wedge
Anal%sis + rock wedge
The "Anal%sis" frame displays the analysis results. Several analyses can be performed for a
single task.
Verification of the rock slope can be carried out according to the factor of safety 9 theory of
limit states based on the input in the "Stability analysis" tab sheet. The analysis results are
displayed in the frame in the bottom part of desktop.
In this frame the program makes it possible to determine the anchor "orce needed for
obtaining the required safety factor. In such a case the "Co'pute reHuired anchor "orce"
entry field must be checked and the slope of anchor force from horizontal and its direction
must be entered.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
-398-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",nal#sis" - roc9 wedge
Progra' !errain
Pro8ect
The "Pro8ect" frame is used to input the basic project data and to specify the overall setting of
the analysis run. The frame contains an input form to introduce the basic data about the
analyzed task, i.e. project information, project description, date, etc. This information is
further used in text and graphical outputs.
The frame also allows the user to switch analysis units (metric / imperial).
In this input regime the assumed setting can be modified only in the first construction stage.
-399-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Pro'ect"
Basic data
The frame "Basic data" serves to input basic parameters of the task.
The frame contains a table with a list of specified layers. Layers can be added, inserted or
removed using the buttons on the right from the table. The first layer can be neither removed,
nor can another layer be inserted in front of it.
The frame section "Basic setting" serves to define world dimensions of the task. When
increasing or decreasing these dimensions the program prompts possible consequences of this
action.
The section "Inputting grid" serves to define an origin and step of the grid in the X and Y
directions. The dialog window, which allows for setting these parameters, is described in the
hint section "User6de"ined en&iron'ent", chapter "Input".
Crossing the item "Input in the glo)al coordinate s%ste'" opens the way for introducing
the data in the global coordinate system (JTSK, Gauss-Kreger).
In the "!%pe o" la%ers input" combo list it is possible to determine the way of inputting
layers. Layers can be introduced with the help of layers thicknesses or their points.
In this input regime the assumed setting can be modified only in the first construction stage.
Visualization of drawing on the desktop can be modified in any input regime based on the
setting adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window and with the help of buttons
on tool bars "3D visualization", "Scale and shift" and "Plot setting".
Frame "@asic data"
-400-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Glo)al coordinate s%ste'
The "Coordinate s%ste's" dialog window allows for defining the type of the global coordinate
system.
Essential advantage is the possibility of specifying the coordinates of points and bore holes
both in the local and global coordinate systems and switching between the two systems.
Orientation of the global coordinate system with respect to the local one is defined using two
points, where one point is always introduced in the local coordinate system and its image in
the global coordinate system.
Direction and sign convention is displayed for each type of the global coordinate system in the
legend chart.
Dialog window "Coordinate s#stem"
Soils
The "Soils" frame contains a table with a list of inputted soils. The table also provides
information about currently selected soil displayed in the right part of the frame.
Adding (editing) a soil is performed in the "Add (edit) soil" dialog window. The program Terrain
calls only for specification of the coefficient of bulkage to compute yardage of excavation pits
or embankments. The remaining data are used only for possible export into our other
programs and have no effect on actual calculations performed in program "!errain".
The program makes it possible import soils in the gINT format.
-401-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Soils"
Assign
The "Assign" frame contains a list of layers of profile and associated soils. The list of soils is
graphically represented using buttons in the bar above the table, or is accessible from a combo
list for each layer of the profile.
The procedure to assign soil into a layer is described in detail herein.
In subsequent stages of construction the program automatically adds a new layer, to which a
soil adjacent to terrain is automatically assigned. In many cases (excavation pits) this layer
may have no volume its introduction is necessary providing the new terrain is found above
the terrain of the previous stage. The soil is always assigned, since it is not possible to a prior
estimate, whether some part of the terrain in the new stage will be located above the original
one.
The program makes it possible to import soil assignment in the gINT format.
-402-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",ssign"
Points
The frame "Points" serves to define the coordinates of terrain points. There are two options
available to define coordinates of individual points:
(ith the help o" ta)le: points are defined in the table. Pressing the "Add" button opens the
".ew point" dialog window; coordinates of points are then specified and by pressing the
"Add" button added to the table. An arbitrary number of points can be defined in this way. The
"Cancel" button is used at last to close the window. These points can be further modified (in
the dialog window) using the "3dit" button or removed with the help of ",e'o&e" button
(more points can be marked in the table to remove them all at once before removing, the
selected points are displayed on the desktop in red). Each change is immediately reflected on
the desktop.
(ith the help o" the 'ouse: this inputting mode is turned on by pressing a respective
button on the horizontal bar. The following options are available:
Add - to input a point, click the left mouse button on the desktop (the mouse cursor
changes see picture) the program then opens the ".ew point" dialog window,
which allows for modifying the point coordinates, or to input its K-coordinate after
pressing the "OK" button the program adds this point into the table. Providing the
point cannot be added (e.g. duplicity of coordinates) the program prompts a
warning message
- grid functions can also be used when specifying a point
3dit - clicking an already existing point (see active object) using the left mouse button
opens the "Edit point" dialog window, which allows for editing the point coordinates -
in the dialog window the following buttons ("O7* " and "O7* ") can be used
-403-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
,e'
o&e
- clicking the point using the left mouse button opens a dialog window, which requests
to confirm deletion of the selected point
Selec
t
- actives the regime of graphical selection of points (type of selection is set in the tool
bar "Selection"
The selected points can also be imported from files in formats !>!, Atlas $/!, DXF, LandXML
and gINT.
The program allows for importing further points and edges into the processed task (e.g. in
subsequent stages).
When defining points the program in some cases automatically calculates their Z-coordinates.
Only one point can be assigned to a single coordinate X, Y.
Providing the option of inputting layres with the help of "Points o" la%ers" in the "Basic data"
frame is selected, the "Points" bar contains the "#a%res" combo list. This list serves to choose
a layer into which the points will be inputted.
Visualization of drawing on the desktop can be modified in any input regime based on the
setting adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window and with the help of buttons
on tool bars "3D visualization", "Scale and shift", "Selections" and "Plot setting".
Frame "Points"
I'port o" points
The program allows for data import in formats DXF, LandXML, ATLAS DMT and TXT. When
importing, all old data are deleted and replaced by the new ones. The world dimensions are
-404-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
automatically determined according to minimal and maximal values of coordinates ; and ? it
is therefore desirable to subsequently adjust the world dimensions in the frame "Basic data".
The program allows for importing !>! data "ro' respecti&e "iles. Each point is written on a
separate line of the file, coordinates are separated by comma. If the file contains for each point
first its name, it is necessary to check the item "Labeling of points". In the dialog window it is
then necessary to specify the order of coordinates. If the data has an opposite sign convention,
it possible to multiply the corresponding line by the value -1. The data import is performed
after pressing the "I'port" button.
The program also allows for importing terrain points in format gINT.
Dialog window "+mport" $ format "T=T"
Dialog window "+mport" $ format ",tlas"
Auto'atic calculation o" height
When defining points, bore holes and points of ground water table the program in some cases
automatically calculates the point height (/-coordinate) and eventually the layer thickness. This
function is particularly valuable when editing terrain or layers.
-405-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The possibility of height calculation depends on the status o" generated terrain:
- If no terrain is generated, the height is not calculated and the respective field remains
empty (blank).
- If terrain is generated for the current data (displayed on the desktop in a non-transparent
mode and in regimes Generation, Point constructions, #ine constructions and
#aunching also in a color mode), the required values are then automatically calculated
from the model of terrain for a point it is the /-coordinate, for a bore hole the program
further determines the layer thickness and possibly also the depth of the ground water
table when a point or a bore hole is specified the status of generated terrain is changed
and the drawing is switched to a transparent mode (the terrain is generated for the
original input, not for the current input).
- When the terrain is generated, but it is not the current one, the /-coordinates and layers
thicknesses are automatically calculated for the last generated terrain.
In"or'ation regarding the terrain status (not generated, generated, generated for the
original data) are displayed on the vertical tool bar. The frame "Generate" allows for terrain
generating or removing the generated model.
Dialog window $ add new point and calculate the D-coordinate
-406-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window $ add new bore hole and calculate the D-coordinate< thic9ness of )%T and
la#er thic9nesses
3dges
The frame "3dges" serves to input edges connecting the terrain points. Two options are
available to define edges:
(ith the help o" ta)le: edges are defined in the table. Pressing the "Add" button opens the
".ew edge" dialog window; sequence numbers of the starting and end points are then
specified and by pressing the "Add" button added to the table. An arbitrary number of edges
can be defined in this way. The "Cancel" button is used at last to close the window. These
edges can be further modified (in the dialog window) using the "3dit" button or removed with
the help of ",e'o&e" button (more edges can be marked in the table to remove them all at
once before removing, the selected edges are displayed on the desktop in red). Each change
is immediately reflected on the desktop.
(ith the help o" the 'ouse: this inputting mode is turned on by pressing a respective
button on the horizontal bar. The following options are available:
Add - to input an edge, click the starting and end points using the left mouse
button (the mouse cursor changes see picture) after clicking the end
point the program adds the corresponding edge into the table and at the
same time displays this edge on the desktop. Providing the edge cannot be
added (duplicity reason, crossing, etc.) the program prompts a warning
message
3dit - clicking an already existing edge (see active objects) using the left mouse
button opens the "3dit edge" dialog window, which allows for editing the
sequence numbers of the starting and end points of the edge - in the dialog
-407-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
window the following buttons ("O7* " and "O7* ") can be used
,e'o&e - clicking the edge using the left mouse button opens a dialog window, which
requests to confirm deletion of the selected edge
Select - activates the regime of graphical selection of edges (type of selection is set
in the bar "Selections")
Edges can intersect neither other edges nor earth grading. Only one edge can be defined
between two points.
Visualization of drawing on the desktop can be modified in any input regime based on the
setting adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window and with the help of buttons
on tool bars "3D visualization", "Scale and shift", "Selections" and "Plot setting".
Frame "(dges"
(ater
The frame "(ater" serves to specify the ground water table (GWT). A combo list "!%pe o"
water" contains the following items:
- .o water no water specified
- (ater speci"ied )% points the GWT points are defined in the table in the same way as
when defining terrain points. This approach is particularly suitable if having a horizontal
water table then it is sufficient to define only one point of a given coordinate Z and the
program automatically generates a horizontal line representing the GWT.
- (ater speci"ied in )ore holes Ground water is defined within bore holes. A particular
depth of GWT measured from terrain surface is specified. This approach is suitable when
bore holes with measured depths of GWT are available.
Visualization of drawing on the desktop can be modified in any input regime based on the
setting adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window and with the help of buttons
on tool bars "3D visualization", "Scale and shift" and "Plot setting".
-408-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "%ater"
Bore holes
The frame "Bore holes" serves to define bore holes, which allow for the modeling individual
geological la%ers (depending on the setting in the frame "Basic data") or ground water
ta)les (depending on the setting in the frame "Water").
To input points that determine the location of individual bore holes proceed in the similar way
as when defining terrain points. Apart from coordinates it is necessary to enter the bore-hole
name and thicknesses of layers. The generated geological profile can be easily modified
exploiting the option of automatic calculation of height z from the thicknesses of individual
layers.
Bore holes can be defined onl% in the first stage of construction. The program automatically
assures that a lower layer always lies below an upper layer "Crossing o" la%ers" is not
acceptable the do'inant la%er is always the upper la%er.
Visualization of drawing on the desktop can be modified in any input regime based on the
setting adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window and with the help of buttons
on tool bars "3D visualization", "Scale and shift" and "Plot setting".
The program also allows for importing bore holes in format gINT at once.
-409-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "@ore holes" $ input< edit
Frame "@ore holes" $ defined bore holes
-410-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
3arth grading
The frame "3arth grading" serves to define terrain earth grading. The earth grading cannot
be defined in the first stage of construction.
The earth grading should considerably simplify an input of excavation pits or embankments.
The essential part of earth grading is the shape o" )otto', from which the slopes of
excavations or embankments are directed towards the original terrain. The original terrain
points and edges, found in the region of earth grading, are automatically removed during
generation.
More than one earth grading can be defined within a single stage of constructions. !he% 'ust
not1 howe&er1 cross each other. If that happens, they need to be combined into a single
earth grading. No part of earth grading can also exceed the world dimensions in such a case
one should realize that faces of earth grading may exceed the world dimensions even if the
bottom is defined well inside.
The earth grading can be edited only in the stage, where it is defined. In the next stage of
construction, the earth grading is transferred in terms of terrain new points and edges.
(ith the help o" ta)le: earth grading is defined in the table. The "Add" button opens the
".ew earth grading" dialog window, which allows for specifying the name of earth grading
(by checking individual boxes it is possible to define a uniform depth of the bottom and a
uniform gradient of the slope). This dialog window contains a table to introduce points, which
define the ground plan (general polygon) of earth grading. To enter these points, proceed in
the similar way as when defining terrain points. Pressing the "Add" button closes the dialog
window and the new earth grading is inserted into the table.
The earth grading can be further modified (in the dialog window) using the "3dit" button or
removed with the help of ",e'o&e" button (more than one earth grading can be marked in
the table to remove them all at once - before removing, the selected earth grading is displayed
on the desktop in red). Each change is immediately reflected on the desktop.
(ith the help o" the 'ouse: this inputting mode is turned on by pressing a respective
button on the horizontal bar. The following options are available:
Add earth
grading
- To input an earth grading, click the left mouse button on the desktop to
successively define individual points of the polygon, which determines a
ground plan of an earth grading the polygon must be closed (the last
clicked point serves as the first point of the polygon) after closing the
polygon the program opens the ".ew earth grading" dialog window; to
continue follow the same steps as when an input using the table is assumed
- providing the earth grading cannot be defined, or it overlays an already
existing one, the program prompts a warning message
3dit earth
grading
- clicking an already existing earth grading using the left mouse button (see
active objects) opens the "3dit earth grading" dialog window, which allows
for editing the respective grading (is possible using buttons in the dialog
window "O7* " a "O7* ")
,e'o&e
earth
grading
- clicking an earth grading using the left mouse button opens a dialog window,
which requests to confirm deletion of the selected earth grading
Visualization of drawing on the desktop can be modified in any input regime based on the
setting adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window and with the help of buttons
on tool bars "3D visualization", "Scale and shift" and "Plot setting".
-411-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "(arth grading" $ input< edit
Frame "(arth grading" $ defined earth grading
-412-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Generate
The frame "Generate" serves to generate a model of the terrain.
Para'eters to generate the 'odel, which are valid for all subsequent stages, are specified
in the first stage of construction.
These are:
- 'odel s'oothing (none, medium, maximal)
- acti&e edge allows for modeling of terrain along edges
The frame further serves to define drawing para'eters (grid step, contour line step).
The actual model is generated by pressing the "Generate" button. The generated model can
be canceled by pressing the "Cancel 'odel" button this can be useful to enhance clarity of
input.
Selecting the option "Co'pute %ardage" allows for yardage calculation (in a combo list it is
possible input the construction stage number for which the calculation should be carried out).
This choice is not available in first stage of construction.
Visualization of drawing on the desktop can be modified in any input regime based on the
setting adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window and with the help of buttons
on tool bars "3D visualization", "Scale and shift" and "Plot setting".
Frame ")enerate"
/odeling terrain on edges
A special attention has to be given to )oundar% condition to correctly create a digital model
of terrain heights of points in corners and boundaries (edges) of the world (world
dimensions).
-413-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
!he corner points can be either entered or they are inserted automatically during the first
stage of construction. When automatically generated, the corner point receives the same
height as the closest point has or bore hole already defined.
When generating terrain the corner points are connected )% an edge. In some cases
(slopes) we wish the edges to model the overall shape and inclination o" terrain. In such
cases an active edge option can be used. An active edge is introduced as a percentage
"raction o" the world di'ensions. All points "ound on an acti&e edge are, during
generation, automatically projected in the normal direction on to an edge new points are
then created at the same locations (on edge) having the same /-coordinate. The new points
are stored in data associated with the next stage of construction.
Subsequent layers of the terrain model behave the same way. The thicknesses of these layers
on edges are calculated according to thicknesses of layers of the closest bore holes.
The role of an active edge is evident from the following figure.
Terrain generated without and with an actie edge
Point constructions
The frame "Point constructions" serves to introduce point constructions into the terrain.
To input points that determine the location of individual point constructions proceed in the
similar way as when defining terrain points (using either table or mouse). The ".ew point
construction" ("3dit point construction") dialog window allows also for specifying the name
of the program to analyze the corresponding construction. The frame "Launching" is then used
to run the calculation program and to transfer thicknesses of layers and assignment of soils
into the program.
Point constructions can be defined only if a correct model of the terrain is generated.
Visualization of drawing on the desktop can be modified in any input regime based on the
setting adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window and with the help of buttons
on tool bars "3D visualization", "Scale and shift" and "Plot setting".
-414-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Point constructions" $ input< edit
Frame "Point constructions" $ defined constructions
-415-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
#ine constructions
The frame "#ine constructions" serves to introduce line constructions into the terrain.
To input lines that determine the location of individual line constructions proceed in the similar
way as when defining terrain edges (using either table or mouse). The ".ew line
construction" ("3dit line construction") dialog window allows for specifying the name and
type of a construction line:
"#ongitudinal line construction" is defined by coordinates of the starting and end points
(the table is a part of the dialog window). A combo list serves to select a particular calculation
program (Settlement, Slope stability, FEM.). To run the program, use the frame "Launch".
Terrain shape and interfaces are transferred in the same way as when assigning soils to layers.
"#ine with points" is defined by coordinates of a broken line and can be used to specify new
point construction. Point constructions are defined in the table "Point constructions on line",
which is a part of the ".ew line construction" dialog window. The frame "Launching" is then
used to run the calculation program and to transfer thicknesses of layers and assignment of
soils into the program.
Line constructions can be defined only if a correct model of the terrain is generated.
Visualization of drawing on the desktop can be modified in any input regime based on the
setting adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window and with the help of buttons
on tool bars "3D visualization", "Scale and shift" "Plot setting".
Frame "3ine constructions" $ input< edit
-416-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "3ine constructions" $ defined constructions
#aunching
The frame "#aunching" contains a table with a list of defined point or line constructions.
Based on the selection in the table and after pressing the "#aunch" button the program
associated with a particular task is launched (the corresponding calculation module must be
purchased). The required data are transferred into the program. The program then allows for
performing the specific calculations and verifications. If the program is not purchased, the
launching button is not accessible.
When all calculations are completed the program is exited by pressing the "O7" button the
results and defined pictures are transferred back into a corresponding calculation protocol in
program "!errain".
-417-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "3aunching"
3aunching program "Spread footing" from program "Terrain"
-418-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Progra' /icropile
Pro8ect
The "Pro8ect" frame is used to input the basic project data and to specify the overall setting of
the analysis run. The frame contains an input form to introduce the basic data about the
analyzed task, i.e. project information, project description, date, etc. This information is
further used in text and graphical outputs.
The frame also allows the user to switch analysis units (metric / imperial).
Frame "Pro'ect"
Settings
The frame "Settings" serves to introduce the basic "Settings" of the program such as
standards and theories of analyses, the way of proving safety of a structure and individual
coefficients of the analysis.
The programs contain not only the pre-defined )asic Settings for individual countries, but
also allow the user to create their own user6de"ined Settings, which can be subsequently
used in all GEO5 programs.
The "Select" button enables to choose an already created Setting from the "Settings list".
The "Settings Ad'inistrator" button opens the "Administrator" dialogue window, which
allows for viewing and modifying individual Setting. One may also identify the visible settings
in the Settings list. Data in the Settings administrator can be also eported and i'ported.
The "Add to the ad'inistrator" button allows for creating user-defined Settings, which are
subsequently added to the Settings administrator.
The "/odi"%" button enables a quick visualization and editing of the current Setting in the
opened program. Modifying any of the parameters changes the title to "Inputted "or the
current task". Individual analyses are then performed with this local setting. Should we
consider this setting as suitable also for other tasks, we add the setting into the "Settings
ad'inistrator" by pressing the "Add to the ad'inistrator" button.
The "Inputted "or the current task" setting is usually created when importing older data.
Settings of analysis parameters are performed in the "Micropiles" tab sheet.
-419-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Settings"
Pro"ile
The "Pro"ile" frame contains a table with a list of inputted interfaces. After specifying
interfaces it is possible to edit thicknesses of individual layers with the help of active
dimensions.
Adding (editing) layer is performed in the "Add @editA inter"ace" dialog window. The /-
coordinate measured from the top point of a structure is specified (/-axis).
The program allows for raising or lowering the top point of a structure in the "Change o"
terrain ele&ation" dialog window so that the whole interface can be translated while keeping
the thicknesses of individual layers. This function is important when copying the profile from
program "!errain".
The program makes it possible to import a profile in the gINT format.
-420-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Profile"
Soils
The "Soils" frame contains a table with a list of inputted soils. The table also provides
information about currently selected soil displayed in the right part of the frame.
Adding (editing) a soil is performed in the "Add (edit) soil" dialog window.
The soil characteristics needed in the program are further specified in the following chapters:
"Basic data" "Uplift pressure". These parameters depend on the theory of analysis specified in
the "Micropiles" tab sheet.
The program makes it possible import soils in the gINT format.
-421-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Soils"
Basic data
This part of the window serves to introduce basic parameters of soils unit weight1 angle o"
internal "riction and cohesion. The particular values are obtained from geotechnical survey
or from laboratory experiments. If these data are not available, it is possible to exploit built-in
database of soils, which contains values of selected characteristics of soils.
When calculating the tube bearing capacity according to Salase, moreover, enters elastic
modulus -.
The associated theory is described in detail in chapter "Micropile".
-422-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ",dd new soils" - "@asic data"
Geo'etr%
The frame "Geo'etr%" serves to input a 'icropile cross6section (welded, rolled). The
selected shape with a graphical hint of inputted values is displayed in the left part of the frame.
The micropile cross-section is selected in dialog windows opened by pressing the "Enter
welded" "Enter rolled" buttons (the selection for rolled cross-sections is performed from a
catalog in the dialog window). An info window, displaying a detailed description of data of the
selected cross-section, can be activated in the window. The selected data can be edited after
choosing the type of micropile cross-section.
The basic geometrical data are specified in the right top part of the frame:
- free length of micropile (distance between the micropile head and the origin of micropile
base is considered)
- root length
- root diameter
- micropile inclination (range from -@0A to @0A measured from vertical, a positive value of an
inclination angle is measured counterclockwise)
- head offset (end of micropile above terrain (range from 0 to 10 m).
The program makes it possible to export the geometry of a structure in the *.DXF format.
-423-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ")eometr#"
/aterial
The frame "/aterial" serves to specify material parameters of cement mixture and steel.
Standard strength of cement mixture in compression, standard strength of steel and
'odulus o" elasticit% of the selected steel and concrete mixture are entered. These values
are required for verification of the micropile tube - coupled section bearing capacity.
-424-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Material"
Assign
The "Assign" frame contains a list of layers of profile and associated soils. The list of soils is
graphically represented using buttons in the bar above the table, or is accessible from a combo
list for each layer of the profile.
The procedure to assign soil into a layer is described in detail herein.
The program makes it possible to import soil assignment in the gINT format.
-425-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",ssign"
#oad
The "#oad" frame contains a table with a list inputted loads. Adding (editing) load is performed
in the ".ew @editA load" dialog window. Forces and moments are entered according to the
sign convention displayed in the right part of the dialog window.
-426-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "3oad"
(ater
The frame "(ater" serves to enter a depth o" ground water ta)le0
The values can be edited either in the frame by entering values into particular fields, or on the
desktop with the help of active dimensions.
-427-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "%ater"
Standard penetration tests @SP!A
The "SP!" frame contains a table with the list of inputted standard penetration tests (SPT).
The frame serves to define the test parameters (interval of the penetration depth ,, energetical
ratio of testing machine -
r
) and correlation of measured data. These are explained in more
details in the theoretical part.
The name of test is specified in the ".ew test" ("3dit test") dialogue window. The "Add"
button in this dialogue window opens another ".ew &alue o" test" ("3dit &alue o" test")
dialogue window, which allows for specifying the depth z measured from the terrain level and a
given number of blows.
The results of standard penetration tests (SPT) can also be imported in the *.TXT format.
-428-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "SPT"
-429-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ".ew test"
Pressio'etric tests
The frame "Pressio'etric tests" contains a table with list of inputted pressiometric tests.
Individual parameters of the test are defined in the ".ew test" ("3dit test") dialog window.
The "Add" button in this dialogue window opens another ".ew &alue o" test" ("3dit &alue o"
test") dialogue window, which allows for specifying the depth / measured from the terrain
level, the pressiometric pressure p
8
and the Mnard modulus -
m
. These parameters are
explained in more detail in the theoretical part.
User can change entered values in dialog window "3dit test". Inserting values between
already entered values is realized in dialog window "Inserted test".
The results of pressiometric tests can also be imported in the *.TXT format.
-430-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Pressiometric tests"
Dialog window ".ew test"
5eri"ication o" cross6section
The results of the analysis of the micropile tube bearing capacity loaded either in tension or
-431-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
compression are displayed in the frame "5eri"ication o" cross6section". More computations
can be carried out for a single task. The left part of the frame allows for inputting the modulus
of subsoil reaction and to account for the influence of corrosion on the analysis.
When calculating the tube bearing capacity (micropile cross-section) the program differentiates
between a micropile loaded in tension or in compression.
In case of tension the program determines coupled section bearing capacity (strength of
cement mixture is not considered).
In case of compression the program examines both, coupled section bearing capacity and
internal stability of section, depending on the method set in the "Micropiles" tab sheet.
The results of the verification analysis are displayed in the right part of the window. The "In
detail" button opens a dialog window listing in detailed the results of the analysis.
Frame ""erification of cross-section"
,oot &eri"ication
The analysis results are displayed in the frame ",oot &eri"ication". Several calculations can
be carried out for a single task. The limit skin friction can be specified in the left part of the
frame.
The procedure to examine the micropile root is described in detail herein.
The results of the verification analysis are displayed in the right part of the window. The "In
detail" button opens a dialog window listing in detailed the results of the analysis.
-432-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "6oot erification"
Progra' F3/
!opolog%
To input data in the FEM program slightly differs from our other programs in that it requires
defining the topology of the structure prior to any calculation. This step includes introduction of
interfaces between individual layers of soils, line constructions, parameters of soils and
interfaces and at last generation of the finite element mesh. To avoid unexpected errors when
creating a computational model the user should first become familiar with available coordinate
systems.
The topology input regime is selected by clicking the Topo button on the horizontal bar.
@ar "Stages of construction" $ switching between "Topolog#" regime and calculation stages
The actual analysis is performed in individual stages of construction (calculation stages), which
allow the user to define activity of structures, to input beams, anchors and surcharge, to
model the effect of water, etc.
-433-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Depending on the selected regime the vertical tool bar also adjusted.
Coordinate s%ste's
Glo)al coordinate s%ste'
- is right-handed
- the positive X axis is directed from the left to the right
- the positive Z axis is directed from the bottom to the top
- the positive Y axis drills in to the XZ plane
- the rotation about the Y axis is positive when measured clockwise

- The GCS is used for coordinates
- in general, the positive surcharge is assumed to act in the opposite direction to the
positive axis and the positive rotation follows the positive sense of the global rotation
- particular definitions of the positive direction must be carefully examined for all cases
Surcharge
- is always assumed to act along the horizontal line (or at a point)
- the origin (point) and the length are the required input data
- the positive surcharge at zero angle is assumed to act in the opposite direction to the
positive direction of the Z axis
- the zero angle corresponds to vertical surcharge
- the angle increases clockwise
- the angle ranges from -1B0C to 1B0C

Anchors
- an anchor can also be specified by the origin and an angle
- the zero angle corresponds to the direction of the X axis
-434-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- the angle increases clockwise

- the angle ranges from -1B0C to 1B0C
Prescri)ed displace'ents and rotation o" supports
- prescribed displacements are positive in the directions of the X, Z axes and about the Y
axis
- displacements are positive when developed in the opposite direction to the positive
directions of the coordinate axes

- the positive rotation is measured clockwise
#oad o" )ea's
- the local coordinate system is right-handed
- the positive X
D
axis of the beam is assumed in direction from the starting to the end point
- the positive Z
D
axis is perpendicular and rotated counterclockwise by E0C from the beam
axis
- loading can be applied three directions:
- global Z
- global X
- local normal (Z)
- the positive loading in the global direction acts in the opposite direction to the positive
direction of the corresponding axis
- the positive loading in the normal direction acts in the opposite direction to the positive
direction of the local Z
D
axis
- the positive loading angle d is measured clockwise
- the moment is positive when acting clockwise

-435-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- definition of loading along the X
D
axis
- coordinates, coordinates of the origin
- loading span
- types of loading (always in above mentioned directions)
- concentrated force
- concentrated moment
- distributed uniform over the whole beam
- distributed trapezoidal over the whole beam
- distributed uniform over a segment of the beam
- distributed trapezoidal over a segment of the beam
Stresses and strains
- positive normal stress S)5ma corresponds to compression, negative to tension
- positive normal strain -ps)8oF corresponds to compression, negative to tension
Internal "orces along )ea's
- positive normal force corresponds to tension, negative to compression
- positive normal strain -ps)8oF corresponds to compression, negative to tension
Pro8ect
The "Pro8ect" frame is used to input the basic project data and to specify the overall setting of
the analysis run. The frame contains an input form to introduce the basic data about the
analyzed task, i.e. project information, project description, date, etc. This information is
further used in text and graphical outputs.
The frame also allows the user to switch analysis units (metric / imperial).
Frame "Pro'ect"
Settings
The frame "Settings" serves to specify standards or methods that are used to perform the
-436-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
analysis.
The "Anal%ses" tab sheet allows the user to define the basic characteristics of the analysis to
be carried out including the type of the problem and analysis, the method of calculating the
initial stress (geostatic stress, 2
o
procedure) and available standards for concrete and steel
structures.
!he a&aila)le pro)le' @plane strain analysis, axial symmetryA and anal%sis @stress, slope
stability,water flow,tunnelsA t%pes depend on the purchased con"iguration o" the
progra'.
Pro&iding all 'odes are a&aila)le we reco''end to proceed with etre'e caution
when selecting the t%pe anal%sis + 'ore co'ple t%pes reHuire distincti&el% larger
nu')er o" input data and 'a% unnecessaril% co'plicate the use o" the progra'0
!his ta) sheet also allows "or choosing the option "Enhanced input"1 which a""ects )oth
the input para'eters o" the progra' and possi)ilities o" presenting the anal%sis
results0
This tab sheet also serves to select the method for calculating the initial stress in the first
stage of construction either standard calculation of geostatic stress or the Ko procedure.
Frame "Settings"
Sta)ilit% anal%sis
There are two options available in the FEM program to solve the slope stability problem:
1. To set the solution type to "Slope sta)ilit%" in the frame "Settings".
2. To run the module in the "Slope sta)ilit%" regime in an arbitrary stage of construction
of a standard analysis by pressing the "Sta)ilit%" button in such a case, a new
secondary task (which can be saved independently) is generated. The solution then
proceeds as in the step 1.
Creating model and inputting data in the "Slope sta)ilit%" regime is performed in the same
way as in the "Stress" regime just the "Anal%sis" button launches the slope stability
analysis of a given structure. Individual slope stability analyses in construction stages are
completely independent and have no relation to the pre&ious stages and calculations.
Plane strain anal%sis
This computational module is suitable for the analysis of longitudinal structures (tunnel,
e')ank'ent, da', etc.) characterized by a longitudinal dimensions being of the orders of
magnitude larger than transverse dimensions of the analyzed domain.
-437-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Plane strain anal#sis
In such a case the analysis can be carried per 1 m run of the structure, see Figure. This
complies with the plane strain assumption. Components of the strain vector developed on
planes normal to the longitudinal axis can be then neglected. Therefore, we assume the soil
body be loaded by the components of the strain and stress vector pertinent to the transverse
plane normal to the longitudinal axis and by the longitudinal normal stress that arises due to
Poissons effect. The corresponding non-zero components of the stress and strain vector are:
Considering beam elements the analysis corresponds to the solution of a plate strip having the
cross-section width equal to 1 m. Non-zero components of nodal generalized displacements are
evident from the following Figure for a two-node beam element compatible with a three-node
triangular plane element and a three-node beam element compatible with a six-node triangular
plane element.
Two-node and three-node beam element
The corresponding components of internal forces, see Figure, assumed with respect to 1 m of
cross-sectional width are given by:
Aial s%''etr%
This computational model is suitable for the analysis of structures of revolution. This
assumption must be satisfied from both the construction and load point of view. A typical
-438-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
example is the solution of vertically loaded isolated pile, excavation of circular ditch, or
pumping of water from a circular hole.
,&is#mmetric anal#sis
Similarly to the plane strain analysis the computational problem is three dimensional, which
can, however, be transformed into a two-dimensional problem, see Figure. The analysis is then
performed with respect to 1 m of arc length having diameter equal to ;(r). The axis of
symmetry always corresponds to the origin of the ;(r) coordinate. Shear strain components in
the direction of rotation can be neglected. We are then left with the stress and strain
components acting on the plane of symmetry cut and the normal strain and stress component
in the hoop (circumferential direction) direction. The corresponding non-zero components of
the stress and strain vector are:
It is clear that the hoop strain, and therefore also the affected normal stresses, attains an
infinite value at the axis of symmetry. Thus regarding the finite element approximation,
arriving at reliable and sufficiently accurate estimates of these values requires a relatively fine
mesh along the symmetry axis.
The application of line and surface load is also worth mentioning. Several examples of applying
the load on terrain surface are displayed in the following Figure. Clearly, their effect increases
with the distance from the axis of symmetry. Introducing such a type of loading directly on the
axis of symmetry has, therefore, no effect. In such a case it is necessary to choose the type of
load of axis of symmetry. The program allows for the application of concentrated forces only.
-439-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
(&amples of loading applied on terrain surface
Considering beam elements the analysis corresponds to the solution of a plane membrane of
revolution including bending effects. Non-zero degrees of freedom are identical adopted for
beam elements in plane strain analysis. Apart from axial (meridian) effects it is necessary to
consider also membrane and bending effects in the hoop direction, see the following Figure.
@eam element in a&ial s#mmetr#
The corresponding components of internal forces, see Figure, assumed with respect to 1 m of
cross-sectional width are given by:
In a special case of a circular plate (angle G = 0) we may refer to radial and hoop components
of internal forces, see the following Figure.
-440-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
+nternal forces acting on a circular plate
Internal forces are related to corresponding strains and curvatures as follows:
After setting r equal to infinity we arrive at plane strain conditions. It is worth noting that in
case of shear forces their magnitudes are, unlike the plane strain analysis, significantly
dependent on the refinement of the finite element mesh. This holds also for vertical reactions.
.ote to water "low
Recall that similarly to the reactions forces in the stress analysis the point fluxes at nodes with
prescribed pore pressures are evaluated with respect to 1 m of arc length having diameter
equal to ;(r). In case of plane strain analysis the corresponding values are taken per 1 m run.
The corresponding overall fluxes (inflow/outflow) can be determined from point fluxes
[m
"
H,a?Hm] as follows:
Plane strain anal%sis
Ais%''etric anal%sis
where 3 is the number of nodes along a given mesh line, in which the point fluxes (
)
[m
"
H,a?Hm] are calculated. In the case of axisymmetric analysis ;
)
represents the ;coordinate
of a given point. Therefore, the axisymmetric analysis provides total the inflow/outflow
[m
"
H,a?] through for example a cylindrical surface (vertical line) or circular surface (horizontal
line).
-441-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
!unnels
The frame "Settings" in conjunction with the "Anal%ses" tab sheet allows for selecting the
option "!unnels". (This module has to be purchased by the user otherwise this option is
not available). When selecting the "!unnels" regime it is possible to define and calculate:
- eca&ations (Modeling a 3D effect at the tunnel face assuming the New Austrian method)
- gradual degradation o" )ea's
- su)8ecting )ea's to ther'al loading
- ther'al loading applied to selected regions (Advanced input is required)
- prescri)ing swelling stress to selected regions
- 'onitoring results
The mode "!unnels" can be switched on/off at any time. The previous results will be,
however, deleted. While switching from a standard regime to the "!unnels" regime is safe,
proceeding in the opposite direction results into deleting all inputted data a warning
message, however, appears before this action is completed.
%arning message about data modification when canceling the "Tunnels" regime
Ad&anced input
The frame "Settings" in conjunction with the "Anal%ses" tab sheet allows for selecting the
option "Ad&anced input". The advanced input offers in addition:
- defining additional 'aterial para'eters of soils (e.g. the Biot parameter, bulk modulus
of water, coefficient of thermal expansion)
- three node ele'ents are available
- 'ied 'esh is available (triangular and quadrilateral elements)
- additional output para'eters are available
By default this option is turned off. On the other hand, it may become particularly useful when
doing research or during teaching. This input mode can be turned on/off at any time, but this
action will always result into deleting all previous results.
Adopting Enhanced input option in the frame "Settings" allows the user to further specify the
selected material model by choosing the type of soil and setting the Biot parameter G and the
coefficient of thermal expansion G
t
.
Default setting assumes drained (long term) boundary conditions (steady state conditions). In
such a case the deformation of soil does not change the values of the prescribed pore
pressure. Pore pressures then appear as an additional source of external load and stay
constant during the analysis (state at the end of consolidation after full dissipation of the
excess pore pressure 9
e
). This particular component of total active pore pressure 9 is denoted
as 9
s
. On the contrary, undrained boundary conditions assume that entire boundary
surrounding the particular soil is impermeable. This results in the solution of a fully coupled
problem of evolution of pore pressures in dependence on the deformation of soil assuming that
-442-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
all changes are instantaneous (short term conditions) with no influence of time (state at the
beginning of consolidation). These excess pore pressures are denoted in the program as 9
e
.
The overall active pore pressure then follows from:
The analysis requires specification of the effective bulk modulus of water 2
e
:
where: 2
e
- effective bulk modulus
2
s
- bulk modulus of grains
2
$
- bulk modulus of water
F - porosity (volume of pores / volume of skeleton)
G - Biots parameter
The actual value of this parameter does not have a major influence on the resulting pore
pressures providing it is sufficiently high. Typically it is chosen from the interval 1000 - 10000.
The Biot parameter E depends on the bulk modulus of skeleton 2
sk
and grains 2
s
of the basic
material in the form:
where: G - Biots parameter
2
sk
- bulk modulus of skeleton
2
s
- bulk modulus of grains
Default setting assumes incompressibility of grains (2
s
II 2
sk
) and therefore G = 1. The total
stress then provided by:
where: - total stress tensor
- effective stress tensor
- overall strain tensor
<
)'k8
- elastic stiffness tensor
-443-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- Kroneckers delta
9 - active pore pressure
7o procedure
2
o
0procedure is the method that allows for the calculation of geostatic stress (1
st
stage) when
particular ration between vertical and hori-ontal stress co'ponents is needed. For
example, when dealing with o&erconsolidated soils the actual horizontal stress can attain
much higher values than found in normally consolidated soils.
When adopting standard anal%sis the initial stress is determined through the application of
the finite element method. Nonlinear material models can be used to account for evolution of
possible failure surfaces already in the 1
st
calculation stage. In the case of elastic response the
ratio between vertical
/
and horizontal
;
stress components is provided by:
where:
/
- vertical normal stress

;
- horizontal normal stress
J - Poissons number
This analysis may lead to evolution of plastic strains.
The 2
o
procedure generates only elastic response. The horizontal stress in the 1
st
stage of
construction follows from:
where: 2
o
- coefficient of horizontal stress at reast defined by the user

/
- vertical normal stress

;
- horizontal normal stress
The 2
o
coefficient is assumed to be a soil parameter. If the 2
o
parameter is not assigned, it is
derived from the relation:
The resulting stresses may, however, violate the plasticity condition in the 2
F,
stage of
construction when nonlinear material models are used. Iteration of equilibrium is then carried
out even if no changes occur in the 2
F,
stage.
(ater "low
The program allows for performing either the stead% state or the transient "low anal%sis
-444-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
in a soil )od%. The transient flow analysis allows for monitoring the evolution of pore pressure
(pressure head) and the degree of saturation in time. Time after which the distribution of pores
pressure no longer changes determines the time needed to reach the steady state conditions.
This value depends both on the soil flow characteristics (coefficient of permeability) and type of
the analyzed problem (e.g. confined/unconfined flow). In case of steady state flow analysis,
the individual stages of calculation are independent from each other. In case of transient flow
analysis, the solution is performed similarly to standard stress analysis.Individual calculation
stages then depend on each other. The first stage of construction stays independent and
serves to set initial conditions, i.e. to assign initial pore pressures/pressure heads and degree
of saturation at the onset of time dependent analysis. The subsequently defined stages require
inputting the time duration of a given stage together with the loading history (time history of
hydraulic boundary conditions). The current version of the program allows us to either
introduce the entire loading at once at the beginning of the calculation stage or to assume that
it linearly increases with time during the course of stage calculation.
In both cases (steady state/transient flow) the program describes in general the flow in an
unsaturated or partially saturated medium. The flow in a fully saturated medium appears only
below the ground water table. Above the ground water table (flow in a partially saturated
medium) the flow is driven by a suitable material model. To analyze problems of unconfined
flow the program introduces three material models: the #og6linear 'odel, the Gardner
'odel and the &an Genuchten 'odel. Since the choice of the material model influences the
setting of initial conditions (initial value of degree of saturation) the program does not allow for
changing material models in subsequent calculation stages. In the same spirit changing
geometry in comparison to the initial stage is also not possible.
The first step in the analysis calls for defining the boundary conditions, either at a point or
along a boundary line. Beam and contact elements can be introduced inside the soil body. The
anal%sis results are presented in the form of pore pressure and total head distributions,
velocities and directions of flow and information about the total inflow/outflow into or out of
the soil body.
Flow anal%sis
!ransient "low
Transient flow analysis in a partially saturated medium is driven by the solution of a general
Richards equation (equation of continuity):
where: F - material porosity
- rate of change of degree of saturation
2
r
- coefficient of relative permeability
- permeability matrix od fully saturated medium
- gradient of total head
( -
source term (pump/well) [m
"
Hs]
Time discretization of Richards equation is based on a fully explicit Picards iteration scheme
[1]. This corresponds to a hybrid formulation ensuring conservation of mass. Owing to the
solution of a generally nonlienear problem, the analysis is performed incrementally. Standard
Newton-Raphson iteration scheme is used to satisfy equilibrium conditionts. The analysis also
requires setting the initial and flow boundary conditions.
Note that speed and stability of the iteration process is influenced to a large extent by the
-445-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
choice of the material model, in other words by the way of calculating the coefficient of relative
permeability and in particular by the approximation of capacity term. In general, the analysis
employing the van Genuchten model is more sensitive to the selection of material parameters,
it is computationally more demanding in comparison to other models (log-lienar, Gardner) and
less stable from the converegence point of view. On the contrary, this model allows for more
accurate representation of the real behavior of soils. Details can be found in [2].
Stead% state "low
The steady state analysis assumes no change of the degree of saturation in time. The
governing equation then reduces to:
Unlike transient flow, the analysis is therefore time independent and requires introduction of
the flow boundary conditions only. However, it is still a generally nonlinear problem (e.g.
unconfined flow analysis) calling for the application of the Newton-Raphson iteration method.
Details can be found for example in [2].
3iteratura4
F5G M: ,: Celia and (: T: @ouloutas< , general mass-conseratie numerical solutionfor the
unsaturated flow eAuation< %ater 6esources 6esearch 0H 75>>18< no: ?< 52I3$52>H:
F0G M: Je'noha< Finite element anal#sis in geotechnical design< to appear 701508
Inter"ace
The frame "Inter"ace" serves to input interfaces between individual soils. Detailed description
how to deal with interfaces is described herein.
The width of the geometrical model can be usually estimated without much of a trouble (care
must be take in the stability analysis to provide for sufficiently large space surrounding the
critical region). The depth of a mesh however is quite important. The lowest point of a mesh
can be imagined as incompressible subsoil. If there is no such layer of the soil or rock material
in the geological profile it is possible to assume that at a certain depth from the ground the
internal forces will vanish so that there will be no deformation. This will be the lowest point of
the geometrical model.
If you are not certain about the margins of the geometrical model it is useful to proceed as
follows:
- First enter larger margins, use coarser mesh and compute changes in the stress
distributions within a soil body.
- In the next step modify the initial margins (regions with no apparent deformation or
changes in stresses can be cut off), generate new and finer mesh and carry out a new and
more accurate analysis.
Interfaces can be also imported from our other programs using clipboard.
The program makes it possible to import or export interfaces in the *.DXF format. They can
also be imported in the gINT format.
-446-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "+nterface"
Soils
The frame "Soils" contains a table with the list of inputted soils. Basic information regarding
the current soil is displayed in the right part of the frame.
The soil input parameters depend on the selected material model, or material model in flow
analysis.
The basic material parameters are the Young modulus of elasticity E and the Poisson ratio
(they are needed in all models).
Most nonlinear models require defining the angle o" internal "riction and cohesion of the
soil. The program allows for modeling either drained boundary conditions (analysis is carried
out under steady state conditions after full dissipation of excess pore pressure) or undrained
boundary conditions (the state at the onset of consolidation is represented so that the pore
pressure distribution follows directly from the analysis assuming full saturation and no outflaw
of water). In both cases the analysis adopts e""ecti&e para'eters of the angle of internal
friction
e6
and cohesion c
e6
.
The required list of material parameters to input also depends on the selected input mode.
Assuming advanced input (can be selected in the frame "Settings") allows us to define
additional (advanced) material parameters (e.g. the Biot parameter, Effective bulk modulus of
water etc.). In most practical applications these material parameters are not particularly
important and mostly serve to academic purposes.
Individual material models can be combined in the analysis each soil can be assigned its own
'aterial 'odel.
Adding (editing) a soil is performed in the "Add (edit) soil" dialog window.
The program makes it possible to import soils in the gINT format.
-447-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Soils"
/aterials 'odels
Selecting the most suitable material model together with inputting the required material
parameters is one the most important but also one of the most difficult tasks when modeling
structures using the finite element method.
The material model attempts to describe the soil (or rock) behavior as close to reality as
possible. They can be divided into two basic groups linear and nonlinear models. Selecting a
proper material model is essential for the prediction of a real soil response.
Most tasks require nonlienar models (e.g., modeling of sheeting structures with linear models
yields totally wrong results). In some cases, however, using linear models may prove useful
and adequate and may considerably simplify the analysis.
-448-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ",dd new soils" $ selection of a material model
#inear 'odels
Linear models give relatively fast, but not very accurate estimate of the true material
response. These models can be used in cases, where only the stress or deformation states of a
soil mass are of interest. They provide no information about locations and possible
mechanisms of failure.
They can be used to model soil behavior in regions, where only the local failure with no effect
on the evolution of global failure occurs, but which may cause premature loss of convergence.
Providing the main interest is in a reliable description of the soil behavior it is necessary to
employ nonlinear models.
The linear models include:
- Elastic model
- Modified elastic model
-449-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
3lastic 'odel
The linear model is the basic material model that assumes a linear relationship between the
stress and strain given by the Hooke law. The following data are required:
- bulk weight of soil
J - Poisson number
- - modulus of elasticity
In a one dimensional problem the Hooke law describes the linear dependence of stress on
strain K via the Young modulus - (modulus of elasticity), see the Figure below. In this
framework the linear model provides a linear variation of displacements as a function of
applied loads.
Stress-strain relationship for 3M
/odi"ied elastic 'odel
It is clear that for soils the linear behavior is acceptable only for relatively low magnitudes of
applied loads. This becomes evident upon unloading that usually shows a rather small amount
of elastic deformation compare to the overall deformation. The modified linear model attempts
at least to some extent to take this into account by considering different modulus for loading
and unloading as plotted in the Figure.
A drop in the material stiffness along a given loading path attributed to the plastic yielding is
reflected through a deformation modulus -
,e6
, which can be imagined as a secant modulus
associated with a certain stress level.
An elastic response is assumed upon unloading. To increase the clarity of model formulation
the elastic modulus for the unloading branch is replaced by the unloading-reloading modulus
-
9r
that governs the response of a soil upon unloading and subsequent reloading up to the
level of stress found in the material point prior to the unloading.
With reference to the following Figure these moduli are given by:
where: -
,e6
-Deformation modulus [!Pa]
L
9r
-Unloading/reloading modulus [!Pa]
-450-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
7a8 6eal stress-strain diagram of soil< 7b8 Simplified stress-strain diagram for M3M
During the primary loading the response of a soil is therefore governed by the secant modulus
while upon unloading it follows the path set by the unloading-reloading modulus -
9r
. An
approximate value of this modulus is 3*secant modulus -
,e6
. In every case, both parameters
should be obtained from reliable experimental measurements.
.onlinear 'odels
The basic nonlinear models can be again divided into two groups.
The first class of models originates from the classical Mohr-Coulomb failure criterion. In
particular, the Drucker-Prager, Mohr-Coulomb and Modified Mohr-Coulomb models fall in this
category. These models can also model the hardening and softening. A common feature to
these models is the evolution of unbounded elastic strains when loaded along the geostatic
axis. This is evident from the figure below that shows projections of the yield surfaces into
deviatoric and meridian planes, respectively. An example of the effect of the selected model is
given here.
The second group of basic material models is represented by the Modified Cam-clay,
Generalized Cam clay and Hypoplastic clay models employing the concept of the critical state
of soils.
Pro'ection of #ield surfaces into 7a8 deiatoric< 7b8 meridian plane
Employing nonlinear models allows us to capture the typical nonlinear response of soils.
-451-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
These models describe the evolution of permanent (plastic) deformation of a soil material. The
onset of plastic deformation is controlled by so-called yield surface. The yield surface can be
either constant (elastic-rigid plastic material), or it can depend on the current state of stress
(material with hardening/softening).
Stress-strain diagram for nonlinear models
In addition to basic material parameters decribed in section "Elastic model" the nonlinear
models call for the introduction of certain strength characteristics of the soil needed in the
definition of a given yield surface. With reference to the first group of materials the following
parameters must be specified.
- angle of internal friction [A]
c - cohesion of soil [kPa]
* - dilation angle [A]
The angle of internal friction and cohesion determine the onset o" plastic de"or'ation. The
angle of dilation controls the evolution of plastic volumetric strain (dilation).
/ohr6Coulo') @/CA
The model requires inputting the following parameters: modulus of elasticity E, the Poisson
ratio, angle o" internal "riction and cohesion. The latter two parameters serve to define
the yield condition. The formulation of constitutive equations assumes e""ecti&e para'eters
of angle of internal friction
e66
and cohesion c
e66
. The angle of dilation must also be specified.
The Mohr-Coulomb yield surface can be defined in terms of three limit functions that plot as a
non-uniform hexagonal cone in the principal stress space. Projections of this yield surface into
deviatioric and meridian planes appear in the Figure. As evident from this Figure (part a) the
MC yield function has corners, which may cause certain complications in the implementation of
this model into the finite element method. The advantage on the other hand is the fact that
the traditional soil mechanics and partially also the rock mechanics are based on this model.
-452-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Pro'ection of #ield surfaces into4 7a8 deiatoric< 7b8 meridian plane
/ohr6Coulo') 'odel with tension cut o""
The original formulation of the Mohr-Coulomb material model is extended by introducing the
Rankine type of plasticity condition, see Figure (a), allowing for the reduction of tensile
strength of soil, which in the case of standard Mohr-Coulomb model is given by c
M
cot5, where
c is the cohesion and the angle of internal friction. This value can be reduced by specifying
the value of tensile strength
t
as evident from Figure (b). If
t
I c
M
cot5the program
automatically sets
t
= c
M
cot5. This model can be used if the advanced input option is on.
a8 Pro'ection of the 6an9ine #ield condition in the deiatoric plane< b8 Pro'ection of the
e&tended Mohr-Coulomb #ield condition into the K5 < K3 plane
/odi"ied /ohr6Coulo') @/C/A
The model requires inputting the following parameters: modulus of elasticity E, the Poisson
ratio, angle o" internal "riction and cohesion. The latter two parameters serve to define
the yield condition. The formulation of constitutive equations assumes e""ecti&e para'eters
of angle of internal friction
e66
and cohesion c
e66
. The angle of dilation must also be specified.
Similarly to the DP model the Modified Mohr-Coulomb model smoothes out the corners of the
MC yield surface. As suggested in the Figure the projection of the MCM yield surface into the
deviatoric plane passes through all corners of the Mohr-Coulomb hexagon and as the MC yield
function the MCM yield function depends on the effective mean stress
m
and the Lode angle N.
With reference to its definition a slightly stiffer response of the material can be expected with
-453-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
the MCM plasticity model when compared to the MC and DP models.
MCM and MC #ield surfaces in the deiatoric plane
$rucker6Prager
The model requires inputting the following parameters: modulus of elasticity E, the Poisson
ratio, angle o" internal "riction and cohesion. The latter two parameters serve to define
the yield condition. The formulation of constitutive equations assumes e""ecti&e para'eters
of angle of internal friction
e66
and cohesion c
e66
. The angle of dilation must also be specified.
The Drucker-Prager model (sometimes also known as the extended von Mises model) modifies
the Mohr-Coulomb yield function to avoid singularities associated with corners. Unlike the
Mohr-Coulomb model the Drucker-Prager yield surface is smooth and plots as a cylindrical
cone in the principal stress space. Similarly to the MC model the DP yield surface depends on
the effective mean stress
m
. The current version of the DP model implemented in FEM builds
upon the assumption of triaxial extension. In other words, the yield surface projection into the
deviatoric plane touches the inner corners of the Mohr-Coulomb hexagon (N = -"0
0
), where N is
the Lode angle.
DP and MC #ield surfaces in the deiatoric plane
So"tening and hardening
Standard formulation of the Drucker-Prager and Modified Mohr-Coulomb models assumes
elastic rigid-plastic behavior of the soil, when the strength parameters of soil c and L remain
constant during the analysis. The enhanced version of both models (advanced input option on)
-454-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
allows for the evolution of these parameters as a function of the equivalent deviatoric plastic
strain:
where:

- equivalent deviatoric plastic strain is given by the following expressions:
where:

- equivalent deviatoric plastic strain

- deviatoric plastic strain tensor

- plastic strain tensor

- volumetric plastic strain

- Kroneckers delta
The assumed, piecewise linear, variation of strength parameters is evident from figure.
Multi-linear hardening-softening law4 dependence of a8 cohesion and b8 angle of internal
frintion on eAuialent deiatoric plastic deformation
Dilation angle * can be assumed either constant or it may evolve as a function of the angle of
internal friction L following the Rowes dilation theory:
where
c0
is the angle of internal friction at constant volume consistent with the critical state of
soil (state at which the soil deforms at zero volumetric plastic strains). To prevent an infinite
increase of the dilation angle (increase of tensile volumetric plastic strains) it must be
bounded, e.g. in dependence on the maximum void ratio e
ma;
, acceptable for a given material.
-455-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The Rowes dilation theory requires introduction of the following parameters:

c0
- angle of internal friction at constant volume [-]
e
0
- initial void ratio
e
ma;
- maximum void ratio [-]
The current void ratio e can be expressed in terms of the current volumetric strain K
0
and the
value of initial void ratio e
0
as:
where: e - current void ratio
e
0
- initial void ratio
K
0
- overall volumetric strain
When the current void ratio e exceeds the maximum void ratio e
ma;
, the dilation angle * is set
to 0.
Angle o" dilation
The angle o" dilation controls an amount of plastic volumetric strain developed during plastic
shearing and is assumed constant during plastic yielding. The value of * = 0 corresponds to the
volume preserving deformation while in shear.
Clays (regardless of overconsolidated layers) are characterized by a very low amount of
dilation (* O 0). As for sands, the angle of dilation depends on the angle of internal friction. For
non-cohesive soils (sand, gravel) with the angle of internal friction I "0A the value of dilation
angle can be estimated as * = - "0A. A negative value of dilation angle is acceptable only for
rather loose sands. In most cases, however, the assumption of * = 0 can be adopted.
Unlike the modified linear model the nonlinear models require specifying only the elastic
modulus. A drop in the material stiffness is a result of evolution of plastic strains and
corresponding redistribution of stresses. This consequently yields an instantaneous tangent
material stiffness as a function of the current state of stress represented in the Figure below by
an instantaneous tangent modulus -
P
.
In"luence o" 'aterial 'odel
To illustrate the effect of a particular model used to predict a structural response we present an
example of a shallow foundation loaded by the distributed loading . A certain simplification of
this task is the assumption of an infinitely stiff foundation loaded by the prescribed
displacements.
The geometrical model and finite element mesh for individual tasks appear in the Figure. The
influence of soil and foundation self-weight on the resulting response is neglected. Owing to
the symmetry of the model, only one half of the structure is analyzed.
-456-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Tas9 assignment4 strip foundation
)eometrical model and the finite element mesh
,nal#sis results
The results suggest a considerably stiffer response of the soil to the external loading when
using the MCM model in comparison to the DP and MC models, which in the present example
show a similar behavior.
/odi"ied Ca'6cla% 'odel @/CCA
The MCC model was originally developed for triaxial loading conditions. Experimental
-457-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
measurements on soft clays provided the background for the development of the constitutive
model expressing the variation of void ratio e (volumetric strain K
0
) as a function of the
logarithm of the effective mean stress
m
e66
, as evident from the following Figure. Both graphs
are related as follows:
Q - slope of swelling line [-]
R - Slope of NCL (normal consolidation line) [-]
e - current void ratio [-]
Material response during isotropic consolidation 7constitutie model8
The graph consists of a normal consolidation line (NCL) and a set of swelling lines. On the first
loading the virgin soil moves down the NCL. Next, suppose that the soil was consolidated to a
certain level of stress, which is termed the preconsolidation pressure p
c
, and subsequently
unloaded up the current swelling line. Then, upon reloading the soil initially moves down the
swelling line until reaching the stress state given by the parameter p
c
, which existed prior to
the unloading. At this point the soil begins to move again down the normal consolidation line
(primary loading compression line).
Parameters Q and R can be estimated from the following expressions:
where: S
c
-one-dimensional compression index
S
s
-one-dimensional swelling index
-458-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
These parameters follow from a simple oedometric test.
The yield surface is smooth without the possibility of evolution of tensile stresses. The MCC
model allows, unlike the first group of models, a direct modeling of strain hardening or
softening for normally consolidated or overconsolidated soils, a nonlinear dependence of the
volumetric strain on the effective mean stress and limit conditions of ideal plasticity. When
using the MCC model the soil loaded in shear can be plastically deformed without collapse
(points 1,2 for hardening, point 2 for softening) until reaching the critical state (points 3 and 2
for hardening and softening, respectively). The soil deforms further in shear under the
assumption of ideal plasticity without the change of e and
m
e66
. Upon unloading, a linear
response of soil is assumed.
Pro'ection of #ield function into meridial and deiatoric planes
Evolution of the yield surface (hardening/softening) is driven by the current preconsolidation
pressure p
c
:
where:

- current preconsolidation pressure

- increment of volumetric plastic strain
Apart from parameters Q and R, the self-weight and the Poisson ratio, the MCC model requires
specifying the following three parameters:
!
cs
- slope of the critical state line [-]
TSR - overconsolidation ratio [-]
e
0
- initial void ratio [-]
Reliable initialization of the model is described in section "Numerical implementation of MCC
and GCC models".
The slope of the critical state line !
cs
can be determined from the expression:
-459-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013

, for triaxial compression

, for triaxial extension
where
c0
is the angle of internal friction for constant volume corresponding to the critical
state.
Generali-ed Ca' cla% 'odel @GCCA
This model represents a considerable improvement of the Modified Cam clay (MCC) model,
particularly when modeling soils in the supercritical domain, see Figure, where the failure
surface follows the classical models of Mohr-Coulomb, Drucker-Prager and Modified Mohr-
Coulomb models. Unlike the Modified Cam clay model (dashed line) the GCC model plots,
similarly to the MMC model, as a rounded triangle in the deviatoric plane. The MCC model
plots, similarly to the Drucker-Prager model, as a circle. In the subcritical domain both models
behave identically. Upon unloading, a linear response of soil is assumed. GCC model is
available only when advanced input is on. Reliable initialization of the model is described in
section "Numerical implementation of MCC and GCC models".
Pro'ection of #ield surface of MCC and )CC models into meridial and deiatoric planes
The material parameters required for the Generalized Cam clay model are identical to the
material data of MCC and MMC models:
Q - slope of swelling line
R - slope of normal consolidation line (NCL)
e
0
- initial void ratio
TSR - overconsoliodation ratio
c - cohesion
angle of internal friction

c0
angle of internal friction at constant volume [-]
J Poissons ratio
-460-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Parameters Q and R can be estimated from the following expressions:
where: S
c
-one-dimensional compression index
S
s
-one-dimensional swelling index
These parameters follow from a simple oedometric test.
Similarly to the MCC model the formulation of the GCC model is based on the relation between
the void ratio (volumetric strain) and the mean effective stress as shown in the following
Figure. Both graphs are linked as follows:
6esponse of material during isotropic compression 7constitutie law8
Evolution of the yield surface (hardening/softening) is driven by the current preconsolidation
pressure p
c
where:

- current preconsolidation pressure

- increment of volumetric plastic strain
-461-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
.u'erical i'ple'entation o" /CC and GCC 'odels
An important step, ensuring a reliable application of MCC and GCC models, is the
determination of the initial preconsolodation pressure p
c
)F
and the corresponding bulk modulus
2
)F
. These two parameters, however, are not directly specified by the user. Instead, they are
derived by the program based on the assumed distribution of initial geostatic stress. Recall
three basic options to derive the intial geostatic stress:
10 Using 2
o
procedure
The use of 2
o
procedure yields the following value of the initial mean stress:
where: 2
o
- coefficient of earth pressure at rest
- bulk weight of soil
h - current depth below terrain
Assuming normal consolidation, the value of p
c
)F
is determined such that the stress derived
using the 2
o
procedure fullfils the yield condition:
where: !
cs
- slope of critical state line
U - equivalent deviatoric stress

m
- mean stress
Values of U and
m
are defined by the following expressions:









where: -
,
- equivalent deviatoric stress
e
)'
- deviatoric strain tensor
K
)'
- overall strain tensor
-462-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
K
0
- volumetric strain

)'
- stress tensor
s
)'
- deviatoric stress tensor
V
)'
- Kroneckers delta
<
)'k8
- elastic stiffness tensor
& - elastic shear modulus
2 - elastic bulk modulus
- - Youngs modulus
J - Poissons number
In case of triaxial compression or extension it is possible to determine the slope of critical state
line !
cs
from the following expressions:
In case of overconsolidated soils the initial value of p
c
)F
is modified as:
The initial value of the bulk modulus follows from:
where the current void ratio e is written as:
For small stresses we get:
20 Standard @elasticA anal%sis
Recall that the program allows for replacing the material model between stages of
construction. Providing the 2
o
procedure cannot be used it is possible to carry out the analysis
assuming elastic response of the clayey soil. The resulting stresses are used to derive the
initial values of p
c
)F
and 2
)F
employing the previously defined expressions. In the next stages
of construction the original elastic material model is replaced by the required MCC or GCC
models.
40 Standard @plasticA anal%sis
-463-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
This option allows the soil to be consolidated under the assumption of nonlinear behavior when
generating the geostatic stress. This results in the evolution of plastic strains already in the
first stage of construction. As in the 2
o
procedure we consider a normally consolidated soil
which, during the course of deformation, moves down the normal consolidation line with the
initial values of p
c
)F
and 2
)F
given by:
Before the next analysis step the resulting plastic strains are set equal to zero. In some cases
such an analysis may fail to converge.
H%poplastic cla%
Hypoplastic clay is applicable for the modeling of soft fine grain soils. Similarly to all other
models it belongs to the family of standard phenomenological models. As for the description of
the soil response it falls into the group of critical state models (Cam clay, Generalized cam
clay). This model, however, accounts for the nonlinear response of soils both in loading and
unloading. In comparison to other models based on the theory of plasticity, it allows for the
calculation of total strains only. It thus makes no difference between elastic and plastic strains.
Indication of type and location of a potential failure, in other models provided by the plot of
equivalent deviatoric plastic strain, can be in the case of hypoplastic clay represented by the
distribution of the mobilized angle of internal friction.
When describing the soil response, the model allows for refecting a different stiffness in
loading and unloding, softening or hardening in dependence on the soil compaction and the
change of volume in shearing (dilation, compression). The current stiffness depends on only
the load direction, but also on the current state of soil given by its porosity. Unlike Cam clay
models, it strictly exlcudes tensile stresses in soil, see Figure 1a.
Figure 54 State boundar# of h#poplastic model $ 7a8 comparison with the #ield surface of Cam
cla# model in the meridial plane< 7b8 comparison with the #ield surface of Mohr-Coulomb
model in the deiatoric plane
In case of hypoplastic model the standard yield surface is replaced by so called Boundary state
surface. Its projection into the deviatoric plane is similar to the model, see Figure 1b. The flow
rule is nonassociated resulting into a nonsymetric stiffness matrix (compare e.g. with the
Mohr-Coulomb model when having different values for the angle of internal friction and the
dilation angle *). Details regarding the model formulation can be found in [1].
/odel para'eters
-464-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The basic variant of the model requires inputting five material parameters:
- Angle of internal friction for constant volume (critical angle of internal friction)
c0
- Slope of swelling line QM
- Slope of normal consolidation line (NCL normal consolidation line) RM
- Origin of the normal consolidation line 3
- Ratio of bulk and shear modulus r
Parameters QM, RM and 3 determine a bilinear diagram of isotropic consolidation in a log-log
scale, Figure 2a. Providing the parameters of the bilinear Cam clay model (in semi-logaritmic
scale, Figure 2b) are available, it is possible to input these values and the parameters of the
hypoplastic model are back calculated. Paremeters of the bilinear Cam clay model are:
- Slope of swelling line Q (in semi-logaritmic scale)
- Slope of normal consolidation line R (in semi-logaritmic scale)
- Void ratio e
ma;
for normal isotropic consolidation by pressure of 1kPa
Figure 04@ilinear diagram of isotropic consolidation $ 7a8 H#poplastic cla#< 7b8 Cam cla# model
Critical angle o" internal "rition
c0
- Identical for both original (undisturbed) and reconstituted subsequently consolidated
sample
- Can be determined from standard triaxial test applying different cell pressures on a
reconstituted sample
- Both drained and undrained (faster) test can be performed
- Most common values are in range of 1BA W "#A
Slope o" nor'al consolidation line RM
- It is determined graphically from the loading branche of oedometric or isotropic
consolidation test, see Figure 3
- For stiff clays it is preferable to run the test on a reconstituted sample
- Most common values are in range of 0.04 W 0.1#
-465-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Figure: 34 Simulation of oedometric test with h#poplastic model
Slope o" swelling line QM
- It can be determined similarly as parameter RM graphically or by performing a parametric
study comparing measurements and simulation along the unloading branche of
oedometric or isotropic consolidation test, see Figure 3
- Most common values Q are in range of 0.01 W 0.02
- Ratio RHQ should be large than 4.0
Origin o" nor'al consolidation line 3
- It is determined graphically from the loading branche of oedometric or isotropic
consolidation test
- The test should be performed on an undisturbed sample when surching for the
intersection lambda line with the vertical axis it is possible to determine the slope lambda
obtained from a reconstituted sample, see Figure 3
- Most common values are in range 0.B W 1.@
,atio o" )ulk and shear 'odulus r
- The physical meaning of this parameter is given by the expressio r = 2
)
H&
)
- 2
)
corresponds to the tangent bulk modulus from isotropic compression according to the
normal consolidation line
- &
)
corresponds to the tangent shear modulus for undrained shear test assuming the same
stress state
- Parameter r can be determined by a parametric study of shear triaxial test
- Most common values are in range 0.0# W 0.X
Setting initial state o" soil
-466-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
In hypoplastic clay the current state of soil is associated with the current compaction
represented by the void ratio. Model implementation allows for inputting the initial or current
void ratio either directly or it can be back calculated using the inputted preconsolidation
pressure TSR. In the first case, the inputted value e
0
corresponds to the void ratio measured
on an unloaded sample extracted from a given depth. In the second case, the inputed value of
e
c9rr
corresponds to the void ratio of a stressed soil. In the last case, the value of TSR is
specified. This parameter represents the ratio between the mean stress on NCL and the initial
mean stress, see Figure 4b.
When intializing the task using the 2
o
procedure, the initial stress state at the beginning of the
second stage is assigned the current stress state. If adopting standard analysis in the first
stage (the hypoplastic clay model is introduced already in the first calculation stage) where the
soil is loaded by its self weight, the value of initial stress p)F = 1 kPa is assumed and it holds
e
c9rr
= e
0
. Providing a different material (e.g., elastic material is considered in the first
calculation stage) is replaced by the hypoplastic clay model, the initial state of stress derived in
the previous stage is adopted. Recall that when using elastic material in the first calculation
stage the resulting stress state corresponds to the results provided by 2
o
procedure for 2
o
(J is
the Poisson ratio).
Figure 24 +niciation of oid ratio $ 7a8 with the help of initial oid ratio< 7b8 initiation b# *C6
It is clear from Figure 5 that for normally consolidated soils the state for which TSR = 1.0
corresponds to an isotropic consolidation only, thus for 2
o
= 1.0. If the soil experiences a non-
zero deviatoric stress state the corresponding TSR for a normally consolidated soil is greater
than 1.0. An exact value of depends on both the soil parameters and stress path (the value of
2
o
). Figure 5 shows the dependence of the minimum for various values of 2
o
and different
types of claye soils. Particular values are also stored in Table 1. The basic material parameters
of this set of soils are listed in Table 2.
The choice of TSR = 1.0 for normally consolidated soils with 2
o
not equal to 1.0 creates a non-
acceptable stress state which may result in the loss of convergence.
-467-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Figure -4 Dependence of *C6 on the coefficient of earth pressure at rest Mo
Table 54 *econsolidation ratio *C6 of the selected soils as function of Mo alue
-468-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Table 04 Material parameters of the selected soils
Intergranular strain
The basic version of the model is suitable in analyses with a prevailing direction of the stress
loading path. In cases with cyclic loading (loading-unloading-reloading) it is more suitable to
use an advaced formulation with the concept of intergranular strain. This allows for constraing
a unacceptable increase of perment deformation arising during small repeating changes in load
(ratcheting). Introducing intergranular strain allows for the modeling of large stiffnes, which
clays experience during small strains. This option is not part on any other models implemented
in GEO FEM. The concept of intergranular strain assumes that the total soil deformation
consists of a small deformation of an intergranular layer (integranular strain) and deformation
caused by mutual sliding of grains. Changing the load path changes first the intergranular
strain. Upon reaching the limit value of the intergranular strain, the deformation associated
with the motion of grains sets on.
Adopting the concept of intergranular strain requires five additional parameters:
- Range of elastic intergranular strain R
- Parameters m
R
and m
P
control the small strain stiffness
- Parameters Y
r
and Z control the degree of stiffness degration with increasing shear strain
These parameters are calibrated after knowing already the material data of the basic
hypoplastic model.
/argin o" elastic intergranular de"or'ation R
- It determines the range of maximal intergranular strain
- It can be determined by a parametric study of the degradation curve & = &(K
s
), Figure 5
- Alternatively it can be considered as material independent constant R = 10
-4
- Most common values are in range 2
M
10
-#
1
M
10
-4
-469-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Figure H4 Cure describing the loass of stiffness of shear modulus
Para'eter m
R

- It determines the magnitude of the shear modulus when changing the loading path in the
meridial plane (
m
- U) o 1B0A
- Linear ratio between parameter m
R
and the intial shear modulus &
0
is provided by &
0
=
p
M
(m
r
/(r
M
RM)
- The initial shear modulus can be determined from the measurement of shear wave
propagation [2]
- Most common values are in range 4.0 W 20.0
Para'eter m
P
- It determines the magnitude of the shear modulus when changing the loading path in the
meridial plane (
m
- U) o E0A
- It holds m
R
Hm
P
= &
0
H&
E0
- The ratio of initial moduli can be estimated from the ratio of these moduli for larger
strains.The value of the m
R
Hm
P
ratio is commonly in the range of 1.0 W 2.0
- Most common values of m
P
are in range 2.0 W 20.0
Para'eters Y
r
and Z
- Determine the rate of stiffness degradation with increasing shear strain
- It can be determined by a parametric study of the degradation curve & = &(K
s
)
- Most common values of parametr Y
r
are in fange 0.0# W 0.#
- Most common values of parametr Z are in range 0.# W @
3iterature4
F5G D: MaNOn< , h#poplastic constitutie model for cla#s< +nternational Pournal for .umerical
and ,nal#tical Methods in )eomechanics:< 0>4355-33H< 011-:
/aterial 'odels in "low anal%sis
The steady state flow analysis is driven by Darcys law specifying the relationship between the
flow velocity and the gradient of hydraulic head. The current version of the program assumes
constant values of coefficients of permeability independent of pore pressure.
The program also requires specifying the initial void ratio e
0
for the determination of current
-470-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
porosity F and subsequently the actual velocity of water flowing through pores only 0
s
= 0HF,
where 0 is the average flow velocity through the whole seepage area.
By introducing the relative coefficient of permeability 2
r
the program allows for tracking the
transition zone between fully saturated (S = 1< 2
r
=1) and unsaturated (2
r
=I 0) region of the
soil body. As an example we may consider the problem of unconfined flow. The process of
tracking the transition zone is governed by one of the three models of transition zone
determining the evolution of relative coefficient of permeability 2
r
as a function of pore
pressure head, see Figures.
7a8 3og-linear model F5G< 7b8 "an )enuchten model F0G
#og6linear 'odel
The Log-linear transition zone model described e.g. in [1] is defined by the following
parameters:
hp
m)F
- minimum value of pore-pressure head in fully saturated region [kPa]
h
PZ
- transition zone width [m]
R - reduction parameter, a sufficiently large number R = 100 to 1000 [-]
The relative coefficicent of permeability 2
r
is given by:
Gardner 'odel
This is an equivalent model depending on a single parameter G [1Hm] only. The relative
coefficicent of permeability Kr is in this case given by [4]:
5an Genuchten 'odel
In this case the value of relative coefficient of permeability 2
r
is given by:
-471-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where V [1Hm], F ,m = 1 - 1HF are model parameters. Their values can be obtained from
laboratory measurements of retention curves approximated by:
where: S
sat
- degree of saturation of fully saturated soil, default setting S
sat
= 1
h
PZ
- irreducible degree of saturation, default setting S
)rr
= 0
- normalized water content
Parameter is in general provided by:
where: N
r
-
rezidual water content [m
"
Hm
"
]
N
S
-
water content of fully saturated soil [m
"
Hm
"
]
The current degrese of saturation S can be expresses as a ratio of the water kontent N and
porosity F as follows:
The Log-linear and Gardner models adopt a simplified version of the van Genuchten model
according to [5]:
-472-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Table with regression coefficients for grain si!e BSD, according to "an )enuchten 75>>58
3iterature4
Details can be found in F0G:
F5G D:M: Potts< 3: Ddra9oiQ< Finite element anal#sis in geotechnical engineering $ theor#<
Thomas Telford< 3ondon< 5>>>:
F0G M: Th: "an )enuchten< , closed formulation for predicting the h#draulic conductiit# of
unsaturated soils< Pournal Soil Science Societ# of ,merica 44< 03>-0->< 5>II::
F3G M: Je'noha< Finite element anal#sis in geotechnical design< to appear 701538
F2G %: 6: )ardner< Some stead#-state solutions of the unsaturated moisture flow eAuation to
eaporation from a water table< Soil Science 85(4)< 00I$030< 5>-I:
F-G +: Fatt< %:,: Mil9off< (ffect of fractional wettabilit# on multiphase flow through porous
media< Transactions< ,+M( 216< 20H-202< 5>->:
Coe""icient o" per'ea)ilit%
Ability of porous body (soils, rocks) to transport water of given properties (e.g. ground water)
is denoted as seepage. The amount of water flowing through a certain area can be represented
by the coe""icient o" per'ea)ilit%. The coefficient of permeability represents the slope of a
linear dependence of water flow velocity on the gradient of total head (gradient of hydraulic
head) in Dracys law written as:
where: - velocity of water flowing through pores
F - porosity
2
r
- relative coefficient of permeability
- Permeability matrix storing coefficients of permeability of fully saturated
soil k
;
, k
?
, which may be different along individual coordinate axes
-473-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- gradient of total head
Hydraulic head at a given point of region of flow is defined as a sum of the pressure head and
vertical coordinate and as such it determines the height of water in piezometer at a given
point:
where:
$
- the weight of water
3a'ple &alues o" coe""icients o" per'ea)ilit% "or &arious soils 7M#sliec8
!%pe o" soil Coe""icient o"
per'ea)ilit% k
[mH,a?]
/otion o" water particle )% 1
cm for hydraulic gradient ) = 1
per time
Soft sand
10
2
- 10
@ s W 10 m)F
Clayey sand
10
-1
- 10
-2

100 m)F W 1B hrs
Loess loam
10
-2
- 10
-4

1B hrs W X0 ,a?s
Loam
10
-4
- 10
-#

X0 ,a?s W 2 ?ears
Clayey soil
10
-#
- 10
-@

2 ?ears W 20 ?ears
Clay
10
-@
- 10
-X

20 ?ears - 200 ?ears
There are several ways for determining the coefficient of permeability k. They grouped as
follows:
aA #a)orator% 'easure'ents
Several types are available for the range of k 10
4
- 10
-@
mH,a?.
)A Field 'easure'ents
Dwell or sink tests, measurement of filtration velocity of flow, for the range of k 10
@
- 1mH,a?.
cA Using e'pirical epressions
Suitable for non-cohesive soils, k 10
@
- 10mH,a?, they produce only guidance values e.g.
according Terzaghi:
where: k - coefficient of permeability [cmHs]
,
10
- diameter of effective solid particle [cm]
e - void ratio [-]
dA B% calculation "ro' ti'e dependent consolidation process
One must know the coefficient of consolidation c
0
and consolidation curve (semi-logarithmic
-474-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
dependence of deformation on time).This is only an indirect determination from the
expression:
where: e
0
- initial void ratio
c
0
- coefficient of consolidation
[
$
- bulk density of water
5 - gravitational acceleration
a
0
- coefficient of compressibility
Basic data
The following material parameters are required for all material models.
Unit weight the bulk weight of a dry soil (soil above the ground water table, GWT) is
assumed. The bulk weight of a soil below the GWT is calculated from other parameters
introduced in section "Uplift".
/odulus o" elasticit% -
The modulus of elasticity describes the material stiffness that is assumed constant over the
entire loading interval. In case of soils this assumption is, however, valid only for a very narrow
interval of recoverable deformations. Modulus of elasticity - has no significant effect on soil
behavior for nonlinear models after satisfying plasticity condition.
A straightforward answer to what definition and what value of this material parameter (initial,
tangent, secant.) one should use in a given material model is, unfortunately, not available. To
select a given type of modulus one needs know the soil )eha&ior in the analyzed geotechnical
task and to assign a particular magnitude the results from a triaial test for corresponding
stress paths are necessary. Nevertheless, certain recommendations can be provided.
The following interpretation of Youngs modulus - of elasticity is available:
-instantaneous 'odulus -
0
in case of small loads (assumption o linear dependence of strain
and stress) or when instantaneous settlement is calculated
-secant 'odulus -
#0
is determined for a reference stress equal to #0% of stress at the onset
of failure (used for example when analyzing spread foundations)
-de"or'ation 'odulus -
,e6
is determined from a loading curve derived experimentally, it is
required when using the modified elastic model (this model assumes different behavior for
loading and unloading) using this modulus when solving the problem of soil unloading (e.g.,
underground structures, heaving of bottom a foundation ditch) leads to larger deformations
than when using the elastic modulus -
9
determined from unloading branch r of the loading
curve an approximate relation is applicable:
-oedo'etric 'odulus -
oe,
which depends on the level of stress in the soil should be used
depending on the expected range of stress in the soil may experience the relation between
-
,e6
and -
oe,
is provided by:
-475-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: J - Poissons number
-
,e
6

- deformation (secant) modulus
-'odulus o" elasticit% -
9r
determined from the unloading branch is used when solving the
problem of soil unloading (excavations) must be defined when using the modified elastic
model
The values of modules of elasticity should be determined, if possible, from a triaxial
experiment. If other methods (penetration tests, piesometers, etc.) are used then it becomes
necessary to introduce some correlation coefficients described in literature.
For actual modeling we recommend to perform an elastic analysis first and check the resulting
strain field such strains according to Hookess law are linearly dependent on the applied load
and the used elastic modulus. If the resulting strains (displacements) are already too large
the user should reassess the 'agnitude o" the originall% applied elastic 'odulus.
Poisson nu')er J coefficient of transverse contraction is in the case elastic homogeneous
material loaded by normal stress in one direction given by:
where: K
?
- vertical strain
K
;
- horizontal strain
The Poisson number is relatively easy to determine. To select its value one may take
advantage of the built-in soil database. If small loads are assumed and the instantaneous
modulus -
0
is used, then also the value of the Poisson number J
0
determined for the initial
loading should be employed.
Geostatic stress1 upli"t pressure
Stress analysis is based on existence of soil layers specified by the user during input. The
program further inserts fictitious layers at the locations where the stress and lateral pressure
(GWT, points of construction, etc.) change. The normal stress in the )
th
layer is computed
according to:
where: h
)
-
thickness of the )
th
layer
-476-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013

)
- unit weight of soil
If the layer is found below the ground water ta)le, the unit weight of soil below the water
table is specified with the help of inputted parameters of the soil as follows:
- for option "Standard" from expression:
where:
sat
- saturated unit weight of soil

$
- unit weight of water
- for option "Co'pute "ro' porosit%" from expression:
where: F - porosity

s
- specific weight of soil

$
- unit weight of water
where: \ - volume of soil
\
p
- volume of voids
&
,
- weight of dry soil
Unit weight of water is assumed in the program equal to 10 k3Hm
"
or 0,00@2# ks).
Assuming inclined ground behind the structure (Y ] 0) and layered subsoil the angle Y, when
computingthe coefficient of earth pressure 2, is reduced in the )
th
layer using the following
expression:
where: - unit weight of the soil in the first layer under ground

)
-
unit weight of the soil in the )
th
layer under ground
Y - slope inclination behind the structure
,igid )odies
The frame ",igid )odies" contains a table with the list of inputted rigid bodies.
The program allows for adding the rigid bodies. Here the only required input parameter is the
bulk weight of the rigid body. The material of the rigid body is assumed an in"initel% sti"".
These bodies serve mainly to model massive concrete structures and walls in both standard
-477-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
and stability analyses.
Adding (editing) rigid bodies is performed in the dialog window "Add new rigid )od%".
Frame "6igid bodies"
Dialog window ",dd new rigid bod#"
Assign
The frame "Assign" contains a list of layers of the profile and associated soils. The list of soils
is graphically represented using buttons in the bar above the table, or is accessible from a
-478-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
combo list for each layer of the profile.
The procedure to assign a soil into a layer is described in detail herein.
Unlike other programs the soils, which become active in calculations stages, are assigned to
regions rather than to interfaces. The regions are created automatically when creating the
computational model.
When a new soil is assigned in a topology regime, it is automatically assigned to all regions in
a given geological layer.
The program makes it possible to import soil assignment in the gINT format.
Frame ",ssign"
Contact t%pes
The frame "Contact t%pes" contains a table with the list of types of contacts. Adding (editing)
contacts is performed in the ".ew t%pes o" contact" dialog window.
This dialog window serves to define new contact elements which can be subsequently
introduced into the program using the "Beams" and "Contacts" frames. The material model of
a contact element can be either linear or nonlinear.
-479-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Contact t#pes"
The contact ele'ents are used in applications that require studying an interaction of a
structure and a soil. They can be further used to model joints or interfaces of two distinct
materials (soil rock interface). A typical example of using contact elements is the 'odeling
o" sheeting structures1 retaining walls or tunnel lining. In such applications the contact
elements are used to model a relatively thin layer of a soil or rock loaded primarily in shear.
Contacts can be defined also independently along indi&idual soil inter"aces.
3ocation of contact elements when modeling a grait# wall
The contact element is an element with a zero thickness allowing for calculating an interfacial
stress as a function of a relative displacement developed along the interface.
-480-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Construction of a sheeting wall represented b# beam and contact elements
Contact ele'ents
Two options of the contact element material model are available. One may select either the
elastic 'odel with the possibility of plotting contact stresses while assuming the elastic
behavior along the interface or the plastic 'odel. The plastic model is based on the classical
Mohr-Coulomb model extended by including the tension cut-off.
This model is therefore well suited when modeling tensile separation. In certain applications
such as sheeting structures this model is vital for receiving meaningful predictions of the soil
and structure response.
The basic model parameters are the cohesion c, coefficient of friction ^ and angle of dilation *.
The parameters c and ^ can be specified also indirectly by reducing the soil strength
parameters c and taF() of adjacent to the contact. If the contact is assumed between two soils
(rocks) then the one having smaller values of c and is used in the reduction step.
The contact parameters are then defined as:
If no better information regarding the reduction of parameters is available one may use the
following values. For steel structures in sandy soils the reduction parameter equal to 2H" is
reasonable while for clays the value of 1H" can be used. These parameters usually attain higher
values when concrete structures are used. In general, the reduction parameters should be less
than 1. The dilation angle plays the same role as in the case of standard soil models. Just
recall that by setting * = 0 we prior assume elastic behavior in the tension/compression. The
plastic deformation is thus limited to shear.
Additional parameters of the contact material model are the elastic stiffnesses in the nor'al
and tangential directions k
F
and k
s
, respectively. They can be imagined as spring stiffnesses
along a given interface. A reliable selection of the values of these parameters is not an easy
task and is usually problem dependent. To shed a light on this subject one may relate these
stiffnesses to the material parameters of the soil adjacent to the contact. The following
-481-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
relations then apply:
where: t -assumed (fictitious) thickness of contact (interface) layer
& -shear modulus of elasticity
- -Youngs modulus of elasticity
In case of distinct materials (-
1
, -
2
, &
1
, &
2
) we take the lower value of k
s
and k
F.
Although in the case of a fully plastic behavior the selection of parameters k
s
and k
F
is not
essential, the values assigned to these parameters are decisive for the success of the solution
of a given nonlinear problem. Providing these values are two large (above 100000 k3Hm
"
) the
iteration process may oscillate. On the other hand, setting the values of k
s
and k
F
too low
(below 10000 k3Hm
"
) lead to nonrealistic deformations of structure.
The default setting in the program is 10000 k3Hm
"
.
"isuali!ation of elastic stiffnesses
#ining
The frame "#ining" contains a table with the list of inputted linings. This frame becomes
accessible in the program once the "!unnel" regime is activated in the frame "Settings". The
"Lining - FEM" module simplifies modeling and positioning of individual tunnel linings.
The "Lining - FEM" module is an independent program used to design linings. Free points, free
lines, line refinement, anchors, beams and beam loads created in this module are passed into
the FEM program. Although behaving in a standard way, they cannot be edited in the FEM
program. Editing is only possible in the "Lining - FEM" module.
Adding (editing) lining is performed in the "Lining - FEM" module. The following modes are
available:
- Add Pressing the "Add" button launches the "Lining - FEM" module which
-482-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
allows for creating a new lining.
- Position Pressing the "Position" button opens the "Adjust lining location" dialog
window, which allows for modifying coordinates of the lining location. To
adjust lining in the FEM program is possible even without launching the
"Lining - FEM" module.
Dialog window ",d'ust lining location"
- /odi"% Pressing the "/odi"%" button launches the "Lining - FEM" module, which
allows for editing the selected lining
- ,e'o&e Pressing the ",e'o&e" button opens the dialog window for confirming
this action upon accepting the selected lining is removed
The lining can also be modified, positioned and removed using the 'ouse. This inputing
mode is activated by clicking an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "#ining". After
choosing a particular mode the lining is selected on the desktop using the left mouse button.
To continue follow the steps already described above.
Further details are available in chapter "active objects".
Frame "3ining"
-483-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
/odule #ining 6 F3/
The "#ining + F3/" module simplifies modeling and positioning individual linings of tunnels.
The module disposes of the features of the main FEM program including the "!opolog%"
regime and stages of construction. In the "!opolog%" regime the module contains the "Free
points", "Free lines", "Line refinement" and "Settings" frames. Frames accessible from stages
of constructions are described within the stages of construction regime of the FEM program.
The "O7" button can be used to terminate the work in the module and to transmit data into
the FEM program, whereas the "Cancel" button just terminates the work without data
transmission.
The program makes it possible to import data in the *.DXF format.
The data of the lining module can be independently saved or loaded while in this dialog using
standard functions "Open" and "Sa&e". This way allows for transmitted the lining between
several analyzed tasks or within a single task.
Load a lining, having less number of stages than the current state, will add the remaining
stages. In the case of lining having more stages, the corresponding stages are first added to
the dialog and then to the main window. The data from the lining regime cannot be loaded
directly into the main window.
Module "3ining F(M"
Free points
The frame "Free points" contains a table with the list of inputted free points. Working with
free points follows the same guidelines as in the FEM program frame "Free points".
The frame differs by the functions on the horizontal tool bar, which contains the "Generator of
shape of lining" and "Generator of anchored regions" buttons. The function of the ",ange"
button is identical to that in the FEM program frame "Interface".
-484-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Free points"
Free lines
The frame "Free lines" contains a table with the list of inputted free points. Working with free
lines follows the same guidelines as in the FEM program frame "Free lines".
The frame differs by the functions on the horizontal tool bar, which contains the "Generator of
shape of lining" and "Generator of anchored regions" buttons.
-485-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Free lines"
#ine re"ine'ent
The frame "#ine re"ine'ent" contains a table with the list of inputted point refinements.
Working with free lines refinement follows the same guidelines as in the FEM program frame
"Line refinement".
-486-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "3ine refinement"
Settings
The frame "Settings" allows for redefining the location of a point to be subsequently
positioned in the main window of the FEM program. The point location can be associated with
the selected free point or determined by the coordinate system origin or by an arbitrary
coordinate. This way allows for an exact positioning of a given point of the lining structure in
the main window of the FEM program.
The use of a second tube can be activated in the right part of the frame. The second tube will
appear in the frame "Settings" as a preview, and then after transmitting it into the FEM
program. The second tube is a clone of the first one. It differs only in the positioning with
respect to the originally defined structure.
-487-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Settings"
Generator o" shape o" lining
Depending on particular parameters the generator creates corresponding elements which are
then operated on independently with no possibility for being parametrically modification. If the
parameters of generation are acceptable, the program displays during their modification the
current graphical representation of generated elements.
Six basic shapes of linings is available for generating free points and free lines in the ".ew
shape o" lining" dialog window. Each shape is defined by several parameters (radii, angles,
height, spacing, subdivision number, control points).
-488-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ".ew shape of lining" $ tab sheet "@asic shape"
The "Botto' arch" tab sheep allows us to choose, whether the lining invert will be flat of
arched, determined parametrically either by a radius or an angle.
Dialog window ".ew shape of lining" $ tab sheet "@ottom arch"
The "#ocation" tab sheet allows, using coordinates, for changing the lining location.
-489-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ".ew shape of lining" $ tab sheet "3ocation"
Generator o" anchored regions
Depending on particular parameters the generator creates corresponding elements which are
then operated on independently with no possibility for being parametrically modification. If the
parameters of generation are acceptable, the program displays during their modification the
current graphical representation of generated elements.
The ".ew anchored region" dialog window serves to generate free points and free lines
based, however, on already inputted lines. This generates a closed region, which is then
assigned in the FEM program a special soil characterizing a densely anchored region. The
dialog window requires specifying a line number and parameters based on the type anchoring
system (over entire line, angle sector, origin and length).
-490-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ".ew anchored region"
Defining anchored region
Stages o" construction
Stages of construction in the "#ining 6 F3/" module and in the FEM program correspond to
each other. They, however, may vary in several features.
Different behavior of stages in the "#ining 6 F3/" module:
- Possible to switch to stages of construction from the "!opolog%" regime without
-491-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
generating the FE mesh.
- Stages of construction added in the "#ining 6 F3/" module are, after confirming,
transferred also into the FEM program.
- Stages of construction, preceding the stage from which the "#ining 6 F3/" module was
launched, cannot be used.
- Stages of construction defined prior to launching the "#ining 6 F3/" module cannot be
deleted.
Free points
The frame "Free points" contains a table with the list of inputted free points. Adding (editing)
free points is performed in the ".ew "ree point" dialog window.
The free points can also be introduced using the mouse. This inputting mode is activated by
clicking an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "Free points". The following modes are
available:
- Add The point is introduced by clicking the left mouse button at a desired
location on the desktop.
- Ad8ust Clicking the left mouse button on already existing free point opens the
"Ad8ust "ree point properties" dialog window, which allows for
modifying its parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on already existing free point opens the
"ree point re'o&al dialog window accepting this action removes the
selected free point.
The free points can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
The program allows for inputting an arbitrary number of free nodes anywhere inside or outside
the structure. Free nodes have several main functions:
- nodes to de"ine structure (tunnel opening, lining, sheeting, beams)
- auiliar% points for the mesh refinement
- points to de"ine a )oundar% condition, to input forces, etc.
If a free node is found inside or on the boundary of a structure, it becomes auto'aticall% a
part o" the "inite ele'ent 'esh. This option allows an adjustment of the finite element
mesh or makes it possible to create own mesh.
-492-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Free points"
Mesh generated without free points
-493-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Mesh with free points
Free lines
The frame "Free lines" contains a table with the list of inputted free points. Adding (editing)
free points is performed in the ".ew "ree line" dialog window.
The lines are defined )etween indi&idual points (segments, arcs, circles) or around
individual points (circles). The lines can be introduced both between free points and between
points located on interfaces including the terrain surface.
The lines may intersect each other and 'a% ha&e an ar)itrar% nu')er o" contact
points intersections of individual lines are determined by the program when adjusting the
geometrical model. The free lines may be used to introduce )ea' ele'ents into the model.
The free points can also be introduced using the mouse. This inputting mode is activated by
clicking an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "Free points". The following modes are
available:
- Add The line is introduced by clicking the left mouse button at a desired location on
the desktop.
- #ine t%pe A combo list is used to select the desired line (segment, arc and circle).
- seg'ent Clicking individual points on the desktop with the left mouse
button creates a point to point line
- arc Use the combo list to choose a particular mode of defining an arc
segment (third point, center, radius, height). Clicking the left
mouse bottom on the desktop then selects points to define an
arc. When selecting one of the following options center, radius
or, you are further requested to select from the combo list the
orientation (positive, negative).
-494-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- circle Use the combo list to choose a particular mode of defining a circle
(center and radius, three points). Clicking the left mouse button
on the desktop then selects points to define a circle. The combo
list is also used to select the orientation (positive, negative).
- Ad8ust Clicking the left mouse button on already existing free line opens the "Ad8ust
"ree line properties" dialog window, which allows for modifying its
parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on already existing free line opens the "ree line
re'o&al dialog window accepting this action removes the selected free line.
The free lines can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
Frame "Free lines" $ different t#pes of free lines
Point re"ine'ent
The frame "Point re"ine'ent" contains a table with the list of inputted point refinements.
Adding (editing) a point refinement is performed in the ".ew point re"ine'ent" dialog
window.
,e"ining the "inite ele'ent 'esh around points is an important feature, which allows us
to create an appropriate finite element mesh. Both free points and points pertinent to
individual interfaces including terrain can be used to refine the original finite element mesh.
Refining the finite element mesh around points can also be performed using the 'ouse.
Several input modes are available depending on the selected button on the "Point
re"ine'ent" horizontal bar:
- Add Clicking the left mouse button on the desktop selects the point for refining
the mesh. The ".ew point re"ine'ent" dialog window serves to input
-495-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
the required parameters.
- Ad8ust Clicking the left mouse button on already existing (refined) point opens the
"Ad8ust point re"ine'ent properties" dialog window, which allows for
modifying individual parameters of the refinement.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on already existing (refined) point opens the
point re"ine'ent re'o&al dialog window accepting this action
removes the selected point refinement.
The point refinement can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
Frame "Point refinement"
Dialog window ".ew point refinement"
-496-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
#ine re"ine'ent
The frame "#ine re"ine'ent" contains a table with the list of inputted point refinements.
Adding (editing) a line refinement is performed in the ".ew line re"ine'ent" dialog window.
,e"ining the "inite ele'ent 'esh around lines is an important feature, which allows us to
create an appropriate finite element mesh. Both free lines and lines pertinent to individual
interfaces including terrain can be used to refine the original finite element mesh.
Refining the finite element mesh around points can also be performed using the 'ouse.
Several input modes are available depending on the selected button on the "#ine re"ine'ent"
horizontal bar:
- Add Clicking the left mouse button on the desktop selects the line for refining
the mesh. The ".ew line re"ine'ent" dialog window serves to input the
required parameters.
- Ad8ust Clicking the left mouse button on already existing (refined) line opens the
"Ad8ust line re"ine'ent properties" dialog window, which allows for
modifying individual parameters of the refinement.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on already existing (refined) line opens the
line re"ine'ent re'o&al dialog window accepting this action removes
the selected line refinement.
The line refinement can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
Frame "3ine refinement"
-497-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ".ew line refinement"
/esh generation
The frame "/esh generator" serves to define the basic setting to generate mesh (left part)
and to view information about generated mesh (right part).
A success"ull% generated 'esh completes the topology input stage the analysis then
proceeds with the calculation stages. When generating mesh the program automatically
introduces standard boundary conditions. Information about the resulting mesh including
warnings for possible weak points in the mesh is displayed in the right bottom window.
Correctly generated finite element mesh is the major step in achieving accurate and reliable
results. The program FEM has an automatic mesh generator, which may substantially simplify
this task. Nevertheless, certain rules should )e "ollowed when creating a finite element
mesh:
- The basic mesh density can be specified in the "/esh generator" dialog window. I is
generally accepted that the finer the mesh the better the results computation as well as
post-processing, however, may slow down substantially. The goal thus becomes to find an
optimum mesh density this mainly depends on the user experiences. Meshes generated
in example problems may serve as an initial hint.
-498-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Mesh generation" $ a mesh with no local refinement
- The finite element mesh should be sufficiently fine in locations in which large stress
gradients are expected (point supports, corners, openings, etc.). To that end, it is possible
to specify the mesh refinement in the neighborhood of these locations. The mesh
refinement can be specified around individual points or lines. The spread of refinement
should be at least "-# times the desired refinement in the center of the refinement. Also,
both values (density and spread of refinement) should be reasonable in view of the
prescribed mesh density that applies to the surrounding region. This assures a smooth
transition between regions with different mesh densities. Singular lines should be tackled
in the same way. For more complicated problems it is useful to first carry out the analysis
with a rather coarse mesh and then after examining the results to refine the mesh
accordingly.
Defining mesh refinement around a circular line
-499-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
.ew mesh after refining the original mesh around a circular line
By default program assumes @6node triangular ele'ents with mesh smoothing. The
accuracy of the results more or less corresponds to twice as fine mesh composed of "-node
triangular elements. The "-node elements are available only in the "Advanced input" mode
(check box "@6node ele'ents") and serve merely for research and testing purposes. The
stability analysis, however, can be performed with 6-node triangular elements only. In case of
nonlinear analysis, these elements should be used exclusively.
The "Advanced input" mode allows also for the generation of mixed mesh (triangular and
quadrilateral elements).
/esh generator warning
In the "(arning + structure critical locations" dialog window the user is prompted for
possible locations on the structure that may cause problems during automatic mesh
generation. When positioning the cursor on individual warnings the corresponding critical
region on a structure is highlighted with a red color. The following items are checked:
- whether the distance between two points is greater than one tenth of the required
element edge length,
- whether the distance between a point and a line is greater than one tenth of the element
edge length,
- whether the area of a region is greater than twice the element edge length,
- whether points and/or lines are found inside the structure (in the soil).
These warnings suggest locations, in which the mesh generator experience problems. The
following possibilities may occur:
- the mesh is not generated => this calls for a new input of geometrical data,
-500-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- the mesh is generated => in this case it is up to the user to decide whether the mesh is
reasonable in any case, the warning can be further ignored and the analysis can be
carried out.
%arning after identif#ing critical sections in F( mesh
Critical section after !ooming in $ two points are too close to each other
-501-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Ad8usting original geo'etr%
The program contains a built-in auto'atic corrector o" the speci"ied geo'etr%. This
means that prior to the mesh generation the program automatically locates all points of
intersection of lines, locates all closed regions and creates a corresponding geometrical
(calculation) model.
Such new regions can be then deactivated or they can be assigned a new soil. The main
advantage of this system becomes evident when creating a geometrical model for tunnels
(step by step excavation) or for sheeted structures. Creating even a very complicated model
thus becomes rather simple and can be performed very efficiently.
Correcting the original geometrical model may cause some points in the model to be too close
to each other or too small regions might be created. Warning message then appears in the
right bottom window identifying such week points in the model.
6egions after performing an automatic ad'ustment of the geometrical model
Standard )oundar% conditions
The program automatically generates standard boundary conditions. Therefore, in routine
pro)le's the user does not ha&e to enter the step o" speci"%ing supports0
The standard boundary conditions are:
- smooth pin along the bottom edge of the geometrical model,
- sliding pin along vertical edges of the geometrical model.
-502-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Standard boundar# conditions
Construction stages
The actual analysis is performed in individual stages of construction (calculation stages) after
the geometrical model and generating the finite element mesh (topology stage). One can move
between calculation stages and the "!opolog%" regime using the buttons on the horizontal
tool bar.
Tool bar "Construction stages" $ switching between "Topolog#" regime and other stages of
constructions
The calculation stages serve to model gradually build structures. Their correct definition and
proper sequence is very important. The analysis of each stage builds (except for the stability
analysis) upon the results deri&ed in the pre&ious stage. Information about individual
objects and their properties are carried over from one stage to the other when editing an
existing stage or creating a new stage the program applies the principle of heredity.
Some frames ("(ater", "Acti&it%", "Assign") contain at the right part of the bar the "Adopt"
button. The button becomes active once the data defined in the frame differ from those
defined in the previous stage. After pressing this button the corresponding data ("(ater",
-503-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
"Acti&it%") are adopted from the previous stage.
Changing input data $ accepting data from the preious stage of construction
The first stage of construction (calculation o" geostatic stress) represents the initial state of
the soil (rock) body before the onset of construction displacements associated with this stage
are therefore set equal to zero.
Loss of convergence may occur for a certain stage of construction. In this case (the results are
not available for non-converged structure) the subsequent stages cannot be analyzed. To avoid
modeling errors we recommend the user to follow the recommended way of the modeling and
analysis of a structure.
Acti&it%
The program allows for re'o&ing @deacti&atingA soils from individual regions. As an
example we consider an embankment analysis. In such a case, it must be accounted for
already in the topology regime when creating the overall geometrical model. In the 1
st
calculation stage, however, it can be deactivated. Similar approach applies also to underground
or open excavations (tunnels, sheeting structures). When deactivating a region below the
ground water it is necessary to correctly model the region boundary.
-504-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Modeling emban9ment $ 5st calculation stage
The embankment can be subsequently reactivated in the next calculation stage.
Modeling emban9ment $ actiit# of emban9ment bod#
Using GeoClipboard there's a possibility to copy current profile as sorted interfaces and allow
-505-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
to copy profile to another program. Copied interfaces are corrected to follow specifications to
2D profile entered from top to bottom.
Acti&it% o" regions )elow G(!
There are two cases to be considered when deactivating a region below the GWT.
1A The soil subjected to excavation is co'pletel% enclosed )% acti&e )ea' ele'ents. The
beam is then considered to be impermeable and both the soil and water are removed
(removing total stresses inacti&e region is "ree o" water). Owing to impermeability of the
beam elements, the pore pressure distribution remains unchanged, see the figure.
Pore pressure distribution after remoing soil from region enclosed b# actie beams
2A The removed soil is not enclosed )% )ea' ele'ents. In such case we assume that water
in the excavated region is still acti&e. This state is evident from the pore pressure distribution
in the figure.
Pore pressure distribution after remoing soil
Its effect can be removed by changing the ground water ta)le.
-506-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Pore pressure distribution after modif#ing the ground water table
Assign
The frame "Assign" contains a list of layers of the profile and associated soils. Its functions are
similar to the case of assigning soils in the topology regime.
In calculations stages, the active soils are assigned to regions rather than to interfaces. The
regions are created automatically when creating the computational model.
Frame ",ssign"
#ining
The frame "#ining" contains a table with the list of inputted linings. This frame becomes
accessible in the program once the "!unnel" regime is activated in the frame "Settings". Only
-507-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
editing is allowed in subsequent stages of construction.
To adjust the lining the program launches the module "Lining - FEM". Its function is described
in detail in the "!opolog%" regime. In stages of construction the "Lining - FEM" module
contains the "Beams", "Anchors" and "Beam loads" frames.
Frame "3ining"
Bea's
The frame "Bea's" contains a table with the list of inputted beams. Actions applying to beams
are identical to those used in stages of construction in the FEM program, frame "Beams".
Types of contacts to introduce contacts on beams are adopted from the FEM program.
-508-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "@eams"
Anchors
The frame "Anchors" contains a table with the list of inputted anchors. Actions applying to
beams are identical to those used in stages of construction in the FEM program, frame
"Anchors".
The frame differs by the function on the horizontal tool bar having the "Generator of anchors
on free line" button.
-509-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",nchors"
Bea' loads
The frame "Bea' loads" contains a table with the list of inputted loads. Actions applying to
beam loads are identical to those used in stages of construction in the FEM program, frame
"Beam loads".
-510-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "@eam loads"
Generator o" anchors on "ree line
Depending on particular parameters the generator creates corresponding elements which are
then operated on independently with no possibility for being parametrically modification. If the
parameters of generation are acceptable, the program displays during their modification the
current graphical representation of generated elements.
The ".ew anchors" dialog window is an extension of the standard dialog window allowing for
a uniform distribution of several identical anchors along a line. Spacing of anchors is generated
the same way as used in the generator of anchored regions (over the entire line, over a part
defined by the angle or length). There are three options to generate the number of anchors:
by the number over a length, by the angle or spacing between individual anchors.
The generated anchors are attached in the FEM program to the free line defined therein.
-511-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ".ew anchors"
Bea's
The frame "Bea's" contains a table with the list of beams. Adding (editing) beams is
performed in the ".ew Bea's" ("Ad8ust )ea' properties") dialog window.
Beams can also be introduced using the 'ouse. This inputting mode is activated by clicking
an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "Bea's". The following modes are available:
- Add The beam is introduced by clicking the left mouse button at a desired
location on the desktop.
- Ad8ust Clicking the left mouse button on already existing free point opens the
"Ad8ust )ea' properties" dialog window, which allows for modifying its
parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on already existing beam opens the )ea'
re'o&al dialog window accepting this action removes the selected
beam.
- #ocation The beam location is selected from the combo box (mesh line, terrain
-512-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
segment).
The inputted beams can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects. The
program employs the following coordinate systems.
The )ea' ele'ents serve to model )ea's1linings, sheeting walls, etc. $istri)ution
internal "orces such as moment, normal and shear forces developed along a beam axis can
are derived from the beam element end forces.
Beams are assigned to already defined lines ("ree lines1 terrain seg'ents) the
corresponding line then represents the )ea' ais. The program offers several basic types of
cross-sections. Nevertheless, the user is free to introduce the required cross-section
independently.
An important step when modeling beams is the definition of contact ele'ents characterizing
the interface behavior between the beam and the soil. Contact (interface) elements can be
assigned to )oth sides o" a )ea'. A correct definition of contacts is essential especially when
modeling sheeting walls.
Types of end points connections can be specified for each beam.
In subsequent stages the beam can be either strengthened or degraged.
The program automatically includes the )ea' sel"6weight into the analysis. This feature,
however, can be turned off when defining the beam.
Beams are modeled using the )ea' ele'ents with three degrees of freedom at each node.
The beam elements are formulated on the basis of the Mindlin theory. The theory assumes that
the plane cross-section normal to the beam axis before deformation remains plane after
deformation but not necessarily normal to the deformed beam axis. At present, the internal
forces are evaluated at the element nodes and from the beam end forces.
Dialog window ".ew beams"
-513-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "@eams"
!%pes o" cross6section
The program allows the user to either input the cross6section para'eters digitall% or to
choose from one of the predefined types of the cross-section. The type of material of the
cross-section is selected from the catalog of materials or is introduced digitally using the editor
of materials. The following types of the beam cross-section are implemented:
- rectangular concrete wall a beam wall thickness must be specified
- pile wall a pile diameter and their spacing must be specified
- steel sheet pile selected from the built-in database
- steel I cross6section a type of cross-section from the built-in database is selected, their
spacing must be specified (the type of cross-section is selected from the "Catalog of cross-
sections", or is defined in the "Editor of cross-sections", the type of material is selected
from the "Catalog of materials" or is specified digitally in the "Editor of materials")
All inputted cross-sections are auto'aticall% recalculated per 1 m @"eetA run0 !he results
o" internal "orces de&eloped along the )ea's are also presented per 1 m @"eetA run o"
a structure0 Thus if necessary, for piles or I cross-sections they must be adjusted depending
on their spacing by the user.
Providing you have your own database of sheet piles, which is not yet built-in the program,
we will be happy to implement it. You may reach us at hotline@fine.cz.
-514-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ".ew beams" $ selection of the t#pe of cross-section
Bea' end6points connection
The program allows for three types of beam end-points connection:

"ied standard type

hinge (is used to introduce an internal hinge in between beams
locations with zero bending moment)

"oot
!he "oot is a special t%pe of a beam end-point support in the soil. It is applicable for the
)ea' end6point located in the soil )od%. When the fixed type of connection is assumed the
beam and the soil element are connected at one point (a singular connection) often causing
evolution of plastic strains in the surrounding soil and loss of convergence. !he "oot allows
"or 'ore realistic redistri)ution o" contact stresses and prevents the beam from
"penetrating" into the soil, consequently stabilizing the convergence process. B% de"ault the
"oot length is assumed to be equal to the beam width it can be arbitrarily adjusted (for
example to enlarge the pile heel).
-515-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Connection 7a8 without 7b8 with a foot
$egradation and strengthening o" )ea's
In subsequent stages the inputted beams cannot be edited in a standard way. Therefore, one
of the following options must be selected to modify them:
- removing the selected beam from the analysis
- degrading the selected beam (applicable only in the "Tunnels" regime)
- strengthening the selected beam cross-section
- modifying the beam contact properties
The type of modification is selected from the "Ad8ust )ea' properties" dialog window.
A degree of )ea' degradation is specified in percentage, one hundred percent corresponds
to beam removal.
Strengthening a )ea' ele'ent with a rectangular cross-section can be achieved by
enlarging its width (e.g., increasing the shotcrete thickness). Other cross-sections are modified
by directly inputting new (larger) values of the cross-section parameters.
-516-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ",d'ust beam properties" $ beam strengthening
Catalog o" pro"iles
In the case of steel cross-sections the program allows for choosing a particular cross-section
from the catalogue of profiles. Only the type of cross-section has to be specified in the dialog
window. The type of material of the cross-section is selected similarly to other cross-sections
(rectangular wall, pile wall, sheet pile.) from the "Catalog of materials", or defined in the
"Editor of materials". The type of cross-section (beam) is selected in the "New beams" dialog
window.
Dialog window "Catalog of profiles"
-517-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Cross6section editor
In the case of steel cross-section the program allows for introducing the user defined cross-
section. Only the shape of cross-section has to be specified in the dialog window. The type of
material of the cross-section is selected similarly to other cross-sections (rectangular wall, pile
wall, sheet pile.) from the "Catalog of materials", or defined in the "Editor of materials". The
type of cross-section (beam) is selected in the "New beams" dialog window.
Dialog window "Cross-section editor $ solid welded"
Catalog o" 'aterials
The program contains a built-in catalog of materials for concrete and steel. Only the type of
material has to be specified in the dialog window. The shape of cross-section is selected from
the "Catalog of profiles", or defined in the "Cross-section editor". For other types of cross-
sections (rectangular wall, pile wall, sheet pile.) the type of cross-section is selected in the
"New beams" dialog window.
-518-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window "Catalog of materials" $ steel
Dialog window "Catalog of materials" $ concrete
3ditor o" 'aterials
Apart from using the "Catalog of materials" the program allows the user to enter the material
parameters for steel and concrete digitally. Only the type of material (material parameters) has
to be specified in the dialog window. The shape of cross-section is selected from the "Catalog
of profiles", or defined in the "Cross-section editor". For other types of cross-sections
(rectangular wall, pile wall, sheet pile.) the type of cross-section is selected in the "New
beams" dialog window.
-519-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window "(ditor of material $ Structural steel"
Dialog window "(ditor of material $ Concrete"
Contacts
The frame "Contacts" contains a table with the list of contacts. Adding (editing) contacts is
performed in the ".ew contacts" dialog window.
The contact ele'ents are used in applications that require a proper representation of
structure-soil interaction. They can be further used to model joints or interfaces of two distinct
-520-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
materials (soil rock interface). Contacts are assigned to already defined lines free lines or
mesh lines (interfaces). The contact is defined by its type.
Contacts can also be introduced using the 'ouse. This inputting mode is activated by clicking
an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "Contacts". The following modes are
available:
- Add The contact is introduced by clicking the left mouse button at a desired
location on the desktop.
- Ad8ust Clicking the left mouse button on already existing contact opens the
"Ad8ust contacts properties" dialog window, which allows for modifying
its parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on already existing contact opens the
contact re'o&al dialog window accepting this action removes the
selected contact.
- #ocation The contact location is selected from the combo box (mesh line, terrain
segment).
The inputted contacts can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
Frame "Contacts"
Contacts and )ea's @water "lowA
The frame "Contacts" ("Bea's") contains (in mode "Water flow") a table with the list of
contacts (beams). Adding (editing) contacts (beams) is performed in the ".ew contacts"
(".ew )ea's") dialog window.
The contact ele'ents are used in applications that require a proper representation of
structure-soil interaction. They can be further used to model joints or interfaces of two distinct
-521-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
materials (soil rock interface). Contacts are assigned to already defined lines free lines or
mesh lines (interfaces). The contact is defined by its type.
Contacts can also be introduced using the 'ouse. This inputting mode is activated by clicking
an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "Contacts". The following modes are
available:
- Add The contact is introduced by clicking the left mouse button at a desired
location on the desktop
- Ad8ust Clicking the left mouse button on already existing contact opens the
"Ad8ust contacts properties" dialog window, which allows for
modifying its parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on already existing contact opens the
contact re'o&al dialog window accepting this action removes the
selected contact.
The inputted contacts can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
Beam or contact element can be defined as:
- per'ea)le
- i'per'ea)le
- partiall% per'ea)le
Contact elements allow us to model a certain barrier for flow in the soil body. Consider for
example a sheeting wall represented in the stress analysis by beam elements. The sheeting
wall anchored into the inside region can be considered either as fully permeable, or fully
impermeable or partially permeable. Although the first two cases can also be treated using
contact elements placed along the corresponding line, they are handled by the program
automatically without needing these elements. The third case represents a problem of flow in a
thin zone having a given thickness ,, see figure:
Partiall# permeable contact
Corresponding fluxes in the tangent direction (s-direction)
s
and normal direction (F-direction)

F
are given by:
-522-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Defining contact elements therefore requires inputting the following parameters:
k
s
- permeability in tangent direction (permeability longitudinal), [mH,a?]
k
F
- permeability in normal direction (permeability transverse), [mH,a?]
Point supports
The frame "Point supports" contains a table with the list of point supports. Adding (editing)
point supports is performed in the ".ew point supports" dialog window.
Point supports can also be introduced using the 'ouse. This inputting mode is activated by
clicking an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "Point supports". The following
modes are available:
- Add The point support is introduced by clicking the left mouse button at a
desired location on the desktop. The required parameters are introduced in
the ".ew point supports" dialog window.
- Ad8ust Clicking the left mouse button on already existing point support opens the
"Ad8ust point supports properties" dialog window, which allows for
modifying its parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on already existing point support opens the
point support re'o&al dialog window accepting this action removes
the selected point support.
The inputted point supports can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
The program employs the following coordinate systems.
The program contains a built-in automatic generator of standard boundary conditions.
Therefore, in most problems the )oundar% @supportA conditions are not reHuired to )e
speci"ied.
!he "ollowing t%pes o" point supports are considered:
- "ree
- "ied
- spring
- prescri)ed de"or'ation
Supports are defined in the glo)al coordinate s%ste'.
-523-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Point supports"
Point "low
The frame "Point "low" contains a table with the list of point flows. Adding (editing) a point
flow is performed in the ".ew point "low" dialog window.
A point flow can also be introduced using the 'ouse. This inputting mode is activated by
clicking an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "Point "low". The following modes are
available:
- Add The point flow is introduced by clicking the left mouse button at a desired
location on the desktop. The required parameters are introduced in the
".ew point "low" dialog window.
- Ad8ust Clicking the left mouse button on already existing point flow opens the
"Ad8ust point "low properties" dialog window, which allows for
modifying its parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on already existing point support opens the
point "low re'o&al dialog window accepting this action removes the
selected point flow.
The inputted point flows can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
The following boundary conditions can be specified:
aA Pore pressure at a point
- Numerically the value of pore pressure at a given point is specified [kPa, ks6]
- By specifying the location of ground water table (total head) coordinate of GWT is
specified
-524-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
)A Point in"low9out"low
Pumping/injection rate is specified [m
"
H,a?Hm, 6t
"
H,a?H6t]
#ine Supports
The frame "#ine supports" contains a table with the list of line supports. Adding (editing) line
supports is performed in the ".ew line supports" dialog window.
Line supports can also be introduced using the 'ouse. This inputting mode is activated by
clicking an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "#ine supports". The following modes
are available:
- Add The line support is introduced by clicking the left mouse button at a
desired location on the desktop. The required parameters are introduced in
the ".ew line supports" dialog window.
- Ad8ust Clicking the left mouse button on already existing line support opens the
"Ad8ust line supports properties" dialog window, which allows for
modifying its parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on already existing line support opens the
line support re'o&al dialog window accepting this action removes the
selected line support.
- #ocation The line support location is selected from the combo box (free line, terrain
segment, mesh line).
The inputted line supports can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
The program employs the following coordinate systems.
The program contains a built-in automatic generator of standard boundary conditions.
Therefore, in most problems the )oundar% conditions are not reHuired to )e speci"ied.
When assigning supports to a line it is first necessary to select the type of line ("ree line1
inter"ace1 'esh line).
!he "ollowing t%pes o" line supports are considered:
- free
- fixed
- deformation
-525-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "3ine supports"
#ine "low
The frame "#ine "low" contains a table with the list of line flows. Adding (editing) a line flow is
performed in the ".ew line "low" dialog window.
A line flow can also be introduced using the 'ouse. This inputting mode is activated by
clicking an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "#ine "low". The following modes are
available:
- Ad8ust Clicking the left mouse button on already existing line flow opens the "Ad8ust
line "low properties" dialog window, which allows for modifying its
parameters.
The inputted line flows can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
Flow )oundar% conditions 'ust )e de"ined on all )oundar% lines. The following boundary
conditions can be specified:
aA I'per'ea)le
)A Per'ea)le Pore pressure on a given line is equal to zero
cA Pore pressure
- distribution of pore pressure p can be specified numerically
- distribution of pore pressure can be specified by inputting the location of ground water
table (by prescribing the total head h)
dA In"low9out"low on a line - it is specified in velocity units e.g. [mH,a?, 6tH,a?] - the flow
velocity into/out of the region is specified. The default setting corresponds to an impermeable
-526-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
boundary for which = 0.
eA Seepage sur"ace - this boundary condition is introduced providing the boundary cannot be
uniquely divided into the part with prescribed pore pressure and the part with prescribed
inflow/outflow (the exit point is not known). In such a case the analysis is performed in two
steps. In the first step the program locates the exit point. The actual flow analysis with known
boundary conditions is then carried in the second step. In some cases both steps must be
repeated several times. When enhanced input is considered the program requires entering a
fictitious permeability k
0
in units [mH,a?]. This is essentially a penalty term, a sufficiently large
number in general, ensuring that along an impermeable boundary the value of total h will be
equal to a ?-coordinate of a given point ( = 0). For a part of boundary with no flow condition
we have k
0
= 0. Variables and h are then related by:

if h I 0 (S = 1) inside soil body

if h _ 0 (S _ 1) inside soil body
Anchors
The frame "Anchors" contains a table with the list of anchors. Adding (editing) anchors is
performed in the ".ew anchors" dialog window ("Ad8ust anchor properties").
Anchors can also be introduced using the 'ouse. This inputting mode is activated by clicking
an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "Anchors". The following modes are
available:
- Add By clicking the left mouse button on the desktop we define the starting
and the end point of an anchor. Exploiting the function of grid may simplify
this step. The starting point is hooked to the ground and its coordinates
are rounded up to two significant digits using the mouse or keyboard is
therefore identical.
- Ad8ust Clicking the left mouse button on already existing anchor opens the
"Ad8ust anchor properties" dialog window, which allows for modifying its
parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on already existing anchor opens the
anchor re'o&al dialog window accepting this action removes the
selected anchor.
The inputted anchors can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects. The
program employs the following coordinate systems.
The anchor head (starting point) can be auto'aticall% hooked to the ground, an arbitrary
interface or opening (tunnel lining). The anchor head is then automatically positioned in to the
intersection of the anchor line determined by the inputted points and the selected line. The
anchor can also be introduced directly by specifying coordinates of the two end points.
Anchors as stabilizing or reinforcing elements are represented by elastic tensile6
co'pressi&e )ar ele'ent with constant normal stiffness. The maximum allowable tensile
force the element can sustain controls tensile failure of the anchor.The bar element is anchored
into the soil only at its staring and end points. No mutual interaction between the soil and the
anchor along the anchor length is considered.
Anchors are defined by their starting and end points and by their stiffness. The program
automatically links the anchor element degrees of freedom to the actual degrees of freedom of
-527-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
the predefined finite element mesh. Therefore, the anchor can be introduced an%where in the
structure.
The anchor sti""ness is specified in terms of the elastic modulus and its area. The program
makes it also possible to enter the anchor diameter the area is then determined
automatically. In stability analysis problems the anchor stiffness is not considered. Its action is
realized only through the prestress force introduced automatically as external compressive
force acting at the anchor head.
Other important parameters are the prestress "orce and the tensile strength (the anchor
breaks when the tensile strength is exceeded). For elements with no prestress the prestress
force is set equal to zero. Sufficiently large value of the anchor tensile strength may be
specified to avoid anchor failure.
By default the anchor does not support a co'pressi&e "orce anchor elements loaded in
compression during a certain stage of calculation are temporarily disabled. If tension occurs in
subsequent analysis run (due to change in loading, geometry or material parameters of soil),
the program automatically introduces these elements back into the analysis. The program
makes also possible to include compressive response of an anchor. However, for elements
loaded primarily in compression we recommend to define these elements as props.
The anchor deforms during analysis. Such deformation together with the deformation of the
surrounding soil may cause reduction o" the speci"ied prestress "orce in the anchor.
Providing we wish to achieve a specific prestress force in the anchor, it is necessary to either
post-stress the anchor to a given value in the next calculation stage or to use a sufficiently
large magnitude of the prestress force right from the beginning to compensate for a possible
drop (the resulting anchor force after completion of the calculation step is displayed at the
anchor head below the prescribed prestress force).
In subsequent stages the program allows only for anchor post-stressing - change of the initial
prestress force, or for removing the anchor from the analysis.
Introducing pre-stressed anchors into the soil may lead to plastic deformation of the soil in the
vicinity of the anchor head or root. Some modifications of the original input are than required
to avoid often encountered loss of converge.
-528-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
,nchor input
Anchor end points
Introducing pre-stressed anchors into the soil may lead to plastic de"or'ation of the soil in
the vicinity of the anchor head or root the analysis then often fails to converge.
In such a case we recommend the following modifications of the original input:
- to place a )ea' ele'ent under the anchor head (this results into a better transition of
load into the soil),
- to place the anchor root into a su""icientl% sti"" soil (use the elastic or modified elastic
material model for the soil layer around the anchor).
-529-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Plastic regions in the icinit# of anchor head or root
Anchors in the sta)ilit% anal%sis
When performing the sta)ilit% anal%sis the actual pre-stressed anchor is automatically
replaced by corresponding co'pressi&e point "orces acting at the anchor head.
The soil at the point of the applied force may, however, undergo plastic deformation. One
should therefore carefully assess the resulting distribution of plastic strains. Note that the
localization of equivalent plastic strain identifies the location of the potential slip surface.
Therefore, if the plastic strains at the anchor head become decisive, it is necessary to
introduce some modifications of the original input.
-530-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Modeling anchor in the slope stabilit# anal#sis
Props
The frame "Props" contains a table with the list of anchors. Adding (editing) props is
performed in the ".ew props" dialog window ("Ad8ust prop properties").
Props can also be introduced using the 'ouse. This inputting mode is activated by clicking an
appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "Props". The following modes are available:
- Add By clicking the left mouse button on the desktop we define the starting
and the end point of a prop. Exploiting the function of grid may simplify
this step.
- Ad8ust Clicking the left mouse button on already existing prop opens the "Ad8ust
prop properties" dialog window, which allows for modifying its
parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on already existing prop opens the prop
re'o&al dialog window accepting this action removes the selected prop.
The inputted props can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects. The
program employs the following coordinate systems.
The prop end points can be auto'aticall% hooked to the ground, an arbitrary interface or
opening (tunnel lining). These points are then automatically positioned in to the intersections
of the prop line determined by the inputted points and the selected lines. The prop can also be
introduced directly by specifying coordinates of the two end points.
Props are represented by elastic co'pressi&e )ar ele'ent with constant normal stiffness.
The props can sustain only compressive loading. When found in tension they are removed from
the analysis.
-531-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The prop is linked to the finite element mesh in its two end points. No interaction is considered
between the soil and the prop along its length when places into the soil.
Props are defined by their starting and end points and by their stiffness. The program
auto'aticall% links the prop ele'ent degrees of freedom to the actual degrees of freedom
of the predefined finite element mesh. Therefore, the prop can be introduced anywhere in the
structure.
The prop sti""ness is specified in terms of the elastic modulus and its area. The program
makes also possible to enter the prop diameter the area is then determined automatically.
In subsequent stages the prop cannot be edited it can be either removed or inputted again.
Prop input
-532-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Props"
,ein"orce'ents
The frame ",ein"orce'ents" contains a table with the list of reinforcements. Adding (editing)
reinforcements is performed in the ".ew rein"orce'ents" dialog window ("/odi"%
rein"orce'ent para'eters").
Reinforcements can also be introduced using 'ouse. This imputing mode is activated by
clicking an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar ",ein"orce'ents". The following
modes are available:
- Add By clicking the left mouse button on the desktop we define the starting
and the end point of a reinforcement. Exploiting the function of grid may
simplify this step.
- Ad8ust Clicking the left mouse button on already existing reinforcement opens the
"/odi"% rein"orce'ent para'eters" dialog window, which allows for
modifying its parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on already existing reinforcement opens the
rein"orce'ent re'o&al dialog window accepting this action removes
the selected reinforcement.
The inputted reinforcements can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
The program employs the following coordinate systems.
The reinforcement end points can be auto'aticall% hooked to the ground, an arbitrary
interface or opening (tunnel lining). These points are then automatically positioned in to the
intersections of the prop line determined by the inputted points and the selected lines. The
reinforcement can also be introduced directly by specifying coordinates of the two end points.
Reinforcements are tensile rein"orcing ele'ents (geotextiles, geodrids), which are defined
-533-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
by their starting and end points and their stiffness.
Unlike anchors or props, the reinforcement is linked to an underlying finite element mesh
along its entire length. However, similar to anchors the program introduces the
reinforcement end points into the finite element mesh automatically so the reinforcement can
be specified anywhere within the mesh. Similar to anchors the reinforcement is modeled by a
tensile/compressive bar element with the possibility of trans'itting onl% nor'al "orce.
Owing to its geometrical characteristics, the reinforcement calls for the input of the cross6
sectional sti""ness taken per 1' @"ootA run o" its width. The user should contact the
manufacturer for this information.
In subsequent stages the reinforcement cannot be edited it can be only removed.
6einforcement input
The program allows us to consider the reinforcement also in compression by default however,
the part o" rein"orce'ent "ound in co'pression is disa)led for the analysis. This state is
simulated in the figure showing the distribution of normal tensile forces over active parts of
individual reinforcements. The compressive part of the reinforcement is te'poraril%
ecluded from the analysis. Similar to anchors, however, it can be automatically activated
once loaded again in tension.
-534-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Tensile stress in reinforcements
Anchoring geo6rein"orce'ents
When introducing the reinforcement into the soil body it is necessary to keep in mind a
su""icient anchorage o" the rein"orce'ent since the program does not check the
rein"orce'ent against the shear "ailure. A sudden increase of the normal force as shown
in the figure suggests singularity in contact stresses and probable shear failure of the
reinforcement. From that point of view the displayed results are misleading and essentially
unrealistic.
In such a case, the reinforcement should be either removed from the analysis or ensure its
su""icient anchorage as plotted in the figure.
-535-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
+nsufficientl# anchored reinforcement
Correctl# anchored reinforcement
-536-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Aial sti""ness o" geos%nthetics
Geosynthetics are tensile reinforcing elements (geotextiles, geogrids) defined by their starting
and end points and by the axial (normal) stiffness U
/
[k3Hm].
For nonwo&en "a)rics the axial stiffness is usually not considered since these elements
typically serve as separating layers. (o&en geotetiles experience for small deformations
very low initial stiffness in the small strain region (up to #%) we encounter a considerable
increase of deformations under constant loading.
When designing geotextiles this property must be taken into account. We thus recognize both
the long6ter' tension strength in dependence on partial reduction factors (reflecting
damage of elements caused by installation, creep behavior of geosynthetics, biological and
chemical effects) and initial nor'al sti""ness in the small strain region in the interval of 0.#%
to 2%.
To determine the 'ini'u' aial sti""ness of georeinforcements it is possible to use the
following expression where for the strength corresponding to the selected strain we accept
maximally 10% deviation from a linear part of tension test:
where:
P
/
- tensile strength at x% strain [k3Hm]
K - ;% strain (relative extension) according to EN ISO 10 319 [%]
P
ma;
- maximal tensile strength according to EN ISO 10 319 [k3Hm]
K
ma;
- maximal strain (relative extension) according to EN ISO 10 319 [%]
Suppliers and producers of geotextiles typically provide the value of tensile strength at 2%
strain. The expression then becomes:
The 'ini'al (initial) aial sti""ness of geotextiles from a short-term experiment (loading
rate according to EN ISO 10 319) for ;-%-strain is given by:
where:
K - ;%-strain (relative extension) according to EN ISO 10 319 [-]
The 'ai'u' (theoretically attainable) aial sti""ness of geotextiles for a short-term axial
strength is determined as follows:
where:
K
ma;
- maximum strain (relative extension) according to EN ISO 10 319 [-]
Intervals of recommended of values of axial (normal) stiffnesses of geosynthetics U
/
[k3Hm] are
listed in the following table:
-537-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
5aria)le
description
Initial aial
sti""ness o"
geotetiles "or
K = 2%
!heoretical
@maximalA aial
sti""ness o"
geotetile
.otation @unitA U
K=;
[k3Hm] U
Kma;
[k3Hm]
Georein"orce'ent
s categor%
--- ---
Non-woven
geotextiles
- -
Woven geotextiles 250 - 500 1000
Unaxial geogrids 500 - 1000 1500
Biaxial geogrids 100 - 500
for K = 0.#%
2500
Triaxial geogrids 250 - 500
for K = 0.#%
5000
Geomats 100 - 500 1000
Drainage
geocomposites
- -
Composites 100 - 500 1500
Geomeshes - -
Geocells - -
3iterature4
)(*M,T ltd: 7www:geomat:c!84 T#pes of geote&tiles and their function in ciil engineering
structures: ,uthor4 Martin MaNpar 79asparRgeomat:c!8: +n C!ech:
H*3S< *:< M+T,< 3:4 Determination of a&ial stiffness of geos#nthetics for numerical modeling $
part 5: TB @rno 7paper in conference proceedings UCiil engineering structures in iew of
geomechanicsV8: +n C!ech:
(. +S* 51 35> 7I1 H50-84 )eote&tiles $ Tensile test on a wide strip: C!ech standard institute<
011>: +n C!ech:
Surcharge
The frame "Surcharge" contains a table with the list of surcharges. Adding (editing)
surcharges is performed in the ".ew surcharges" dialog window ("Ad8ust surcharge
properties"). The inputted surcharges can also be edited on the desktop with the help of
active objects. The program employs the following coordinate systems.
All inputted parameters of the surcharge can be modified in the stage of construction, in which
the surcharge was introduced. In subsequent stages it is only possible to modify its magnitude
-538-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
(option "Ad8ust 'agnitude").
This frame serves to introduce surcharges applied onl% to the soil )od%. The surcharge
applied to a beam element is introduced in the frame beam load.
An arbitrary number of surcharges can be specified in individual stages. The surcharge may act
either on the eisting inter"ace (including ground surface) or can be applied an%where in
the soil )od%.
In subsequent stages we are free to either remove the inputted surcharge or to 'odi"% its
'agnitude.
Note that applying the surcharge directly on the ground surface may lead to ecessi&e
plastic de"or'ations in the vicinity of the surcharge and the analysis may fail to converge.
In such a case, one may either place a )ea' ele'ent under the applied surcharge, or to
choose an elastic or modified elastic material model for the soil below the surcharge.
Frame "Surcharge"
-539-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ".ew surcharges"
Bea' loads
The frame "Bea' loads" contains a table with the list of loads. Adding (editing) beam loads is
performed in the ".ew )ea' loads" dialog window.
Beam loads can also be introduced using the 'ouse. This inputting mode is activated by
clicking an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "Bea' loads". The following modes
are available:
- Add By clicking the left mouse button on the selected beam. The load
parameters are entered in the ".ew )ea' loads" dialog window.
- Ad8ust Clicking the left mouse button on already existing beam opens the "Ad8ust
)ea' loads" dialog window, which allows for modifying its parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on already existing beam opens the )ea'
load re'o&al dialog window accepting this action removes the selected
beam load.
The inputted loads can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects. The
program employs the following coordinate systems.
All inputted parameters of the load can be modified in the stage of construction, in which the
load was introduced. In subsequent stages it is only possible to modify its magnitude (option
"Ad8ust 'agnitude").
-540-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "@eam loads"
Dialog window ".ew beam loads"
(ater
There are three options in the program to introduce ground water:
-541-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- The ground water ta)le can be specified as a continuous interface below and above the
ground surface. In such a case, the program automatically adjusts the soil self-weight
below the ground water table.
- The pore pressure values are entered via isoline. Input is the same as interface input.
The pore pressure values are inserted into the table "List of interfaces" in the left bottom
part of the screen. The values between isolines follow from linear interpolation.
- !he pore pressure coe""icient r
9
represents the ration between pore pressure and the
geostatic stress in the soil. The values of the coefficient r
9
are specified for individual
isolines. The first isoline always coincides with the ground surface. The remaining isolines
are introduced in the same way as interfaces between individual soil layers. The values are
inserted into the table "List of interfaces" in the left bottom part of the screen. The values
between isolines follow from linear interpolation.
When entering the values of pore pressure or the values coefficients r
9
the )ulk weight o"
soil is assu'ed in the whole )od% to be equal to the bulk weight regardless of the values
of pore pressures or coefficients r
9
.
The simplest way to check the input of water is to plot the distribution of pore pressure in the
output window.
"isuali!ation of pore pressure
Anal%sis
The analysis is performed for individual calculation stages in the frame :Anal%sis: after
pressing the :Anal%-e: button0
$uring anal%sis the program attempts to arrive at such a solution that satisfies for given
loading and boundary conditions the glo)al eHuili)riu'0 In most cases this step results into
an iterative process. The process of iteration and convergence of the solution is displayed on
-542-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
the screen.
The analysis can be stopped any time by pressing the :Interrupt: button. The results are
then available for the last converged load increment.
The correct results are obtained when 100% o" the applied load is reached. Due to
convergence failure the program may stop )e"ore reaching the desired load le&el - only a
fraction of the total applied load is reached. In such a case it is possible to adjust standard
parameters of the analysis setting.
When modeling more complex engineering tasks we encourage the user to follow the
recommended modeling procedure.
The transient flow analysis can be selected in the frame "Settings".
The analysis results together with information about the course of analysis appear on the
screen immediately after completing the analysis.
Detailed information about the actual modeling approach is presented in section "Setting and
analysis description". The way the results appear on the screen can be set in the "Visualization
style settings"dialog window.
In case of considering water in analysis, in most cases there's a possibility to copy analyzed
GWT to GeoClipboard and paste it into another program.
Screen after completing anal#sis
!ransient "low anal%sis
The actual analysis proceeds in two and more stages ("Water flow"), where the first stage
serves to set the initial conditions, i.e. the distribution of initial pore pressure, initial pressure
head, degree of saturation and relative permeability at the onset of transient flow analysis.
Several options are available to set the initial pore pressure:
-543-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- With the help of ground water table
- Directly with the help of pore pressure interfaces
- Running the steady state flow analysis
The first option assumes a hydrostatic (linear) distribution of pore pressure over the height.
Below GWT the program generates positive pore pressures, whereas above GWT the negative
pore pressures (suction) are generated. The second option allows for considering a dry soil by
prescribing e.g. negative pore pressures over the entire infiltrated region. The third option
requires running the steady state analysis. Based on the assigned material model the program
then determines the initial degree of saturation and relative permeability as a function of the
initial pore pressure. Figure 1 shows the distribution of initial pore pressure provided by steady
state analysis for the assumed hydraulic conditions. Clearly, only the pressures below GTW are
presented. The initial state in an unsaturated or partially saturated region can be partially
judged by plotting for example the distribution of initial degree of saturation as seen in Figure
2. When selecting the ".o water" option the initial pore pressure values are set equal to zero.
Figure 5 $ First calculation stage4 Distribution of initial pore pressure
-544-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Figure 0 $ First stage4 Distribution of initial degree of saturation
The transient flow analysis is performed from the second stage on where the next stage
follows the preceding one. Each stage requires setting the analysis time, time dependent
variation of boundary (hydraulic) conditions and the time step length. The current version of
the program allows us to either introduce the entire loading at once at the beginning of the
calculation stage or to assume that it linearly increases with time during the course of stage
calculation ("Water flow"). In the first case the initial time step is set to 1H10 of the assigned
time step. Next, the calculation continues with the assigned time step. It is reasonable to
adjust the time step during the course of analysis. A shorter time step is recommended at the
beginning of the analysis. With longer times, when the solution approaches the steady state
conditions, the time step can be increased considerably (e.g. from 1H10 of day up to several
days). Figures 3 and 4 display an intermediate state and a steady state solution, respectively,
corresponding to a sudden increase of GWT in the second calculation stage. Figures 5 and 6
show similar states associated with a subsequent rapid drawdown simulated by resetting the
original level of GWT at the seventh calculation stage.
-545-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Figure 3 $ Second calculation stage4 Distribution of pore pressure at a gien time of anal#sis
-546-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Figure 2 $ Si&th calculation stage4 Distribution of stead# state pore pressure
Figure - $ Seenth calculation stage4 Distribution of pore pressure at a gien time of anal#sis
-547-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Figure H $ (ighth calculation stage4 Distribution of stead# state pore pressure
,eco''ended 'odeling procedure
Solving geotechnical problems using the finite element method is a relatively complex task.
But yet, most users attempt to analyze the entire complex structure right from the beginning
to find the cause of possible loss of convergence may then become rather difficult. We
therefore recommend the following approach:
1A $e"ine the whole topolog% o" the structure
2A Assume elastic response of soils and contact elements (use linear models)
4A Generate coarse mesh
CA Define all calculation stages
BA Perform analysis of all calculation stages (it is sufficient to launch the analysis of the last
stage of construction analyses of all previous stages are carried out automatically).
LA Asses the course o" anal%sis
If the analysis fails, the computational model is not correctly defined e.g. beams have too
many internal hinges resulting into a kinematically undetermined structure, props are not
properly hooked to the structure, etc. The program contains a number of built-in checking
procedures to warn the user for possible drawbacks in the model definition. Some of the
errors, however, cannot be disclosed prior to running the program.
If all stages were successfully analyzed, we recommend the user to check the resulting
displacements and this way also the objectivity of the used soil parameters and structure
stiffness. Note that using nonlinear models always results into larger displacements in
-548-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
comparison to the pure elastic response should the elastic displacements be already
excessively large, we must first adjust the computational model before adopting any of the
available plasticity models.
If the analysis succeeded and the displacements are reasonable, we may proceed as follows:
EA ,eplace linear 'odels with suitable plastic models (Mohr-Coulomb, Drucker-Prager)
MA Perform analysis and evaluate the results according to step 6
DA Add nonlinear contact ele'ents
1FA Perform analysis and evaluate the results according to step 6
11A Refine and ad8ust the "inite ele'ent 'esh and perform the "inal anal%sis.
Although this approach may seem rather cumbersome and complicated, it may save a
considerable amount of time when searching for the cause of failure (loss of convergence) of
the analysis of complex problems.
#oss o" con&ergence o" nonlinear anal%sis
Loss of convergence of the solution of nonlinear analysis calls for certain 'odi"ications o" the
underl%ing co'putational 'odel the following steps can be adopted:
- Increase the stiffness of the structure
- Decrease the applied loads
- Split the soil excavation in more steps
- Improve material parameters of existing soils
- Change material model of soils in places of plasticity
- Add reinforcing members (beams, anchors)
- Add supports
- Change parameters settings affecting the iteration process (increase number of
iterations).
$istri)ution o" plastic strains may provide some explanation to why the analysis failed to
converge. Note that the distribution of equivalent plastic strain locates the regions of probable
evolution of critical failure surfaces.
-549-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
,nal#sis failed to conerge $ plot of eAuialent plastic strain
Setting and anal%sis description
The de"ault setting o" para'eters that dri&e the solution analysis is optimized to ensure
sufficient accuracy and efficiency of the analysis. Nevertheless, an experienced user may
require to change the default setting, or to examine the influence of parameters on the
accuracy and course of the analysis. The parameters setting can be adjusted in the "Anal%sis
settings" dialog window.
However, the change of standard setting deserves a word o" caution. Prior to making any
changes, the user should be well aware of possible consequences. In particular, improper
setting may substantially slow down the computation process, may cause divergence and
eventually lead to incorrect results.
- Solution method
- Change of stiffness matrix
- Initial solution step
- Maximum number of iterations
- Convergence criterion
- Newton-Raphson method setting
- Arc-length method setting
- Line search method
- Plasticity
The default setting can be always recovered by pressing the "Standard" button.
-550-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Solution 'ethod
The program FEM serves to analyze geotechnical problems characterized by nonlinear response
of the soil or rock body. A successful analysis of most of such problems calls for an iterative
solution of a given boundary value problem. Applying the finite element method (FEM) then
leads to an incremental form of the equilibrium conditions written as:
where: `
a
- instantaneous stiffness matrix
b9 - vector of nodal displacement increments
b6 - vector of out-of-balance force increments
This equation can be solved only approximately using a suitable numerical method. The goal of
the method is to arrive, during the process of iteration, at such a state of stress and strain that
satisfies the condition b6 = 0. To that end, the progra' o""ers two basic methods:
1. Newton-Raphson method NRM
2. Arc-length method ALM.
,nal#sis settings $ setting the solution method
Change o" sti""ness 'atri
The full .ewton6,aphson 'ethod assumes that the instantaneous tangent stiffness matrix
is formed at the beginning of each new iteration.
Forming a new tangent stiffness matrix only at the beginning of a new load increment leads to
so-called modified Newton-Raphson method.
-551-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
If the stiffness matrix is formed only once at the beginning of the solution analysis we obtain
so called initial stress method.
Individual methods can be selected from the "Anal%sis settings" dialog window section
"Stiffness update". The corresponding settings are:
1. 7eep elastic initial stress method,
2. 3ach iteration full Newton-Raphson method,
3. 3ach load step modified Newton-Raphson method.
The default setting assumes the full Newton-Raphson algorithm (stiffness update after each
iteration). Note that the formulation of stiffness matrix is consistent with the stress update
algorithm. Such a formulation then ensures quadratic convergence of the full Newton-Raphson
(NRM) unlike the modified NRM or the initial stress method that, in comparison with the full
NRM, require considerably more interactions to attain equilibrium.
On the other hand, it is fair to mention that the computational cost per iteration is mainly
determined by the calculation and factorization of the tangent stiffness matrix. Assuming
elastic response of a structure it is clearly meaningless to set up the structural stiffness matrix
more then once (stiffness update keep elastic). On the contrary, increasing the degree of
nonlinearity suggests more frequent stiffness reformulations (stiffness update Each
iteration).
.ewton-6aphson method $ stiffness matri& update options
Initial solution step
The actual analysis is carried out incrementally in several load steps until the overall prescribed
load is reached.
The program requires setting the initial load step only.
-552-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
This parameter represents the ratio )etween the load applied in a gi&en load step to the
o&erall prescri)ed load. Depending on the course of iteration this parameter is adaptively
adjusted.
The default setting assumes 2#% of the total prescribed load. Similarly to what we have
already mentioned it holds that increasing the solution complexity from the nonlinear response
point of view requires reduction of this parameter. However, in the case of elastic response
this parameter can be set equal to 1, which corresponds to the solution of a given problem in
one load step.
/ai'u' nu')er o" iterations
This parameter represents the 'ai'u' nu')er o" iterations allowed for a single load
step to reach the state of equilibrium.
Exceeding this value prompts the program to automatically reduce the current &alue o" the
assu'ed load step and restarts the solution from the last load level that complies with the
state of equilibrium. Similar action is taken when oscillation or divergence of the program is
imminent.
Con&ergence criterion
For the incremental solution strategy based on one of the iterative methods to be effective, it
is necessary to select suitable criteria (preset tolerances for reaching equilibrium) for the
ter'ination o" the iteration process.
Note that loose convergence criteria may result in inaccurate results while too tight
convergence tolerances may lead to unjustified increase of computational cost spent to arrive
at the results of superfluous accuracy.
In the program the convergence is checked against the change of nodal displacement
increments, the change of out-of-balanced forces and also the change of internal energy. The
last criterion gives a certain idea about how both displacements and forces approach their
equilibrium values. The corresponding settings are:
1. $isplace'ent error tolerance tolerance for the change of displacement increment
norm.
2. Out6o"6)alanced "orces tolerance tolerance for the change of out-of-balance force
norm.
3. 3nerg% error tolerance - tolerance of the change of internal energy.
The default setting is 0,01 for all con&ergence tolerances.
Setting .ewton6,aphson 'ethod
With the Newton-Raphson method the course of iteration can be driven by setting the following
parameters:
1A ,elaation "actor it represents the value of reduction of the current load step for the
restart providing the solution fails to converge. A new value of the assumed load step is found
from the expression:
new load step N old load step 9 relaation "actor0
2A /a0 .o0 o" relaations for a single load step this parameter determines how many
times it is possible to invoke the above action during the entire analysis. Exceeding this value
prompts the program to terminate the analysis. The results are then available for the last
-553-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
successfully converged load level.
4A /in0 .o0 o" iterations for a single load step this parameter allows for possible
acceleration of the analysis. In particular, providing the number of iterations to converge in the
last load step is less than the minimum one set, the load step for a new load increment is
increased as follows:
new load step N old load step * relaation "actor0
The default setting of the above parameters corresponds to values displayed in the figure:
Parameters driing the iteration process
Setting Arc6length 'ethod
The Arc-length method (ALM) is relatively robust method particularly suitable for the solution
of problems that require the search for the collapse load of a structure. Stability analysis of
earth structures (slopes, embankments) is just one particular example of such a task. Unlike
the NRM where the solution is driven purely by prescribing load increments, the ALM
introduces an additional parameter representing a certain constraint on the value of load
increment in a given load step. The value of the load step thus depends on the course of
iteration and is directly related to the selected arc length.
The basic assumption of the method is that the prescribed load varies proportionally during the
calculation. This means that a particular level of the applied load can be expressed as:
where: F - current fraction of the total applied load
R - coefficient of proportionality
-554-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
F - overall prescribed load
Note that with ALM the load vector F represents only a certain reference load that is kept
constant during the whole response calculation. The actual value of the load at the end of
calculation is equal to the R multiple of F; R _ 1 represents the state when the actual bearing
capacity of a structure is less than the prescribed reference load; if R at the end of response
calculation exceeds 1, the program automatically adjusts the arc length in order for the
solution to converge to value R = 1 within a selected tolerance equal to 0.01 (1% the maximum
applied load). This value cannot be changed.
The literature offers a number of ALM formulations. The program supports the method
suggested by Crisfield and the consistently linearized method proposed by Ramm. The latter
one is considerably simple, at least from the formulation point of view, than the Crisfield
method. On the other hand it is reportedly less robust. The default setting is the Crisfield
method.
Other important parameters of the method are "Setting arc length" and "Automatic arc length
control".
,rc-length $ setting the t#pe of ,rc-length method
Setting arc length
The arc length is the basic parameter affecting the response calculation. An indicator for the
selection of arc length can be the course of iteration in the previous solution stage. Regardless
of that the program enables the following setting:
1. $eter'ine "ro' load step the arc length is determined automatically from the
initial load step.
2. Adopt "ro' the pre&ious stage the value of arc length at the end of the previous
-555-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
calculation stage is used as a starting value for a new stage. This option becomes active
in the second stage of construction.
3. Input the value of arc length can be directly prescribed.
Providing the structure response cannot be determined prior we recommend using the first
option. Depending on the course of calculation it is possible to adjust the value of arc length
and repeat the calculation. At no event, however, is it possible to ensure convergence for an
arbitrary value of arc length selected. Similarly to NRM, if the convergence problems occur the
program allows for the reduction of the current arc length and restarts the calculation.
The next parameter driving the iteration process is the Ma&imum .o: of load steps. The
program always carries on the prescribed number of load steps providing:
- parameter R exceeds 1,
- the maximum number of relaxations of arc length is exceeded.
Providing the analysis is terminated due to exceeding the maximum number of prescribed load
steps and parameter R is less than 1, it is necessary to increase the number of steps and
restart the analysis.
,rc-length $ arc length setting
Auto'atic arc length control
Automatic arc length control strategy constitutes very important part of implementation of any
numerical method. The program makes it possible to adaptively adjust the current arc length
for a new load step depending on the course of iteration in the previous step by activating
option Opti'i-e. The program will then attempt to select a value of arc length that keeps the
desired number of iterations in each load step needed for convergence option Opti'0 .o0 o"
iter0 in a single load step.
-556-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The next parameter driving the process of iteration is the ,atio load9displace'ent. This
parameter represents a scalar factor, which adjusts the scales of load given by parameter R
and displacement vector 9. providing this parameter is sufficiently large the analysis is
essentially driven by load increment. Setting this parameter equal to 0 (default setting) we
obtain so-called cylindrical ALM and the analysis will be driven by displacement increment. This
approach is more stable and recommended by the authors. Nevertheless, the program allows
for optimization of this parameter by activating the option "Opti'i-e". In such a case the
current value of this parameter is set equal to the Bergan current stiffness parameter that
provides a scalar measure of the degree of nonlinearity. With increasing the degree of
nonlinearity this parameter is decreasing. In the vicinity of collapse load the value of this
parameter approaches zero and the solution is driven by displacement increment. This strategy
thus supports the use of cylindrical method having the ,atio load9displace'ent parameter
equal to zero. As for the default setting this option is turned off.
,rc-length $ automatic arc length control
#ine search 'ethod
The basic goal of the Line search method is to determine a scalar multiplier W that is used to
scale the current displacement increment so that the equilibrium is satisfied in a given
direction. The actual displacement vector at the end of the i-th iteration thus becomes:
Consequently, the calculation process is either accelerated, c I 1, or damped, c _ 1. Obviously,
with the Line search performed each iteration, the expense of the iteration increases. On the
other hand, this drawback is compensated by less number of iterations needed for
convergence and by the possibility of avoiding divergence or oscillation of the process of
iteration. By default the use of the Line search is enabled.
-557-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
An inexperienced user is recommended to employ the default setting evident from the figure.
3ine search method settings
Plasticit%
The Plasticit% dialog window serves to set parameters driving the stress update procedure.
The parameter ,eturn to %ield sur"ace tolerance suggests the tolerance for satisfying the
selected yield condition. Assuming nonlinear hardening/softening as in the case of modified
cam clay model the stress return mapping requires an iteration process.
The maximum number of iterations allowed is then given by the /a0 .o0 o" iterations "or a
single plastic step parameter. When employing the rigid-plastic version of the Mohr-
Coulomb, the Drucker-Prager or the modified Mohr-Coulomb model, these parameters will not
apply.
The default setting, evident in the figure, is recommended.
-558-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Parameters driing the stress return mapping
Course o" anal%sis
The course of analysis can be viewed in the bottom part of the screen.
An elastic analysis is completed in one co'putational step. A nonlinear analysis is
performed in several steps the external loading is gradually increased in several loading
@calculationA steps. The analysis is completed successfully if there is no loss of overall
convergence so that 100 percent of the required load is reached.
The de"ault setting o" para'eters that drive the solution analysis is optimized to ensure
sufficient accuracy and efficiency of the analysis. Nevertheless, an experienced user may
require to change the default setting, or to examine the influence of parameters on the
accuracy and course of the analysis. The parameters setting can be adjusted in the "Analysis
settings" dialog window:
- The Percent o" the applied load parameter gives percentage of the overall load
(excepted value) at the end of the current load step assuming successful convergence for
the current load step.
- The Step si-e parameter provides the current scaling factor for the determination of load
increment in the current load step.
- The Sa"et% "actor parameter corresponds to the expected value of the safety factor
assuming successful convergence for given parameters c, .
The course of iteration within a given load step is characterized by the change of convergence
parameters:
- c Line search method parameter
- change of the displacement increment norm
-559-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- change of the out-of-balance force norm
- change of internal energy
If all three errors are smaller than the preset error tolerance (can be edited in "Settings"
dialog window), the analysis is for the calculation step terminated.
The "Interrupt" button serves to terminate the calculation process. The results are then
available for the last load level that complies with the state of equilibrium.
Course of anal#sis
,esults
Visualization (plotting) of results is one of the most important features of the program. The
program allows us to select from several basic styles of graphical outputs, which are defined in
the "FEM results visualization settings" dialog window.
- draw de"or'ed 'esh
- surface plot of variables developed inside the soil 9 rock )od% (the total values or their
increments with respect to other calculation stage can be displayed)
- internal "orces distributed along beams, contacts
- "orces in anchors and reaction "orces
- depression cur&e
- tilted sections of variables
- &ectors and directions of variables
To display results the program employs the following coordinate systems.
The tool bar "Results" in the upper part of the screen serves to selected variables to be
displayed and the way they should appear on the screen. The color scheme is shown in the
right part of the desktop. Its particular setting can be adjusted using the "Color scheme" tool
bar.
Because properly setting outputs might be often time consuming, the program disposes of a
comfortable system of storing and managing various settings.
All outputs and selected results can be further printed out from the analysis protocol.
!ool )ar + ,esults
The tool bar contains the following operating elements:
-560-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Tool bar "Setting isuali!ation of graphical outputs"
Individual elements operate as follows:

Plotting st%le
setting
- opens the "FEM - results visualization
settings" dialog window which allows the user
to be more specific in defining the plotting
style

#ist o" plots - a combo list containing names of plots saved
by the user

Sa&e plot - saves the current plot displayed on the
desktop, the dialog window serves to enter
the name of the plot

/anager o" plots - opens the "/anager o" plots" dialog window
which serves to manage (delete, change
order, rename) already saved plots

5alues in stages o"
anal%sis
- displays calculated values (either total or
incremental values with respect to the
selected stage of construction can be seen)

5aria)le t%pe - displays the selected variable

Sur"ace plot - turns on/off plotting of isolines, isosurfaces

/esh - turns on/off the style of plotting the FE mesh
(only edges, or according to the setting in the
"FEM results visualization settings" dialog
window

$isplace'ents plot - selects the style of plotting deformed mesh
undeformed/deformed (deformed by the
magnitude, deformed by the coefficient)
The tool bar contains the 'ost o"ten used operating ele'ents needed to view the results
on the desktop. Detailed setting of the style of plotting the results is available in the "FEM
results visualization settings" dialog window.
Similar to our other programs the results can be saved and printed. The plotting style can be
adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
,esults &isuali-ation settings
The "F3/ 6 results &isuali-ation settings" dialog window serves to select the type of
variable to be displayed and the way it should appear on the screen. Individual settings can be
later saved using the "Results" tool bar.
The tab sheet "Basic" serves to set the basic parameters driving the visualization of surface
variables and FE mesh other tab sheets are used to define other types of outputs.
-561-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window "F(M $ results isuali!ation settings " $ tab sheet "@asic"
Owing to the clarity of graphical presentation it is not possible to plot some of the results at
the sa'e ti'e. It is not possible to plot a deformed mesh together with distributions of
internal forces along beams only one option must be selected. If an unacceptable
combination is selected, the displays a warning message in the bottom part of the dialog
window. The present example shows an unacceptable combination of deformed mesh;alues in
mesh grid set in the tab sheet "Basic".
%arning for conflict in plotting of results
#ist o" &aria)les
The following variables can be displayed (values in the soil/rock body):
#ist o" &aria)les displa%ed )% the progra' + )asic &aria)les
.otation $escription 5aria)l
e
Unit
Settlement
<
Z
Displacement in the Z direction ,
/
[mm]
Settlement
<
X
Displacement in the X direction ,
;
[mm]
Sigma
Z, tot.
Total normal stress in the Z direction
/,tot
[kPa]
-562-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Sigma
Z, e66.
Effective normal stress in the Z direction
/,e66
[kPa]
Pore
pressure 9
Pore pressure 9 [kPa]
Sigma
X, tot.
Total normal stress in the X direction
;,tot
[kPa]
Sigma
X, e66.
Effective normal stress in the X direction
;,e66
[kPa]
Tau
X, Y.
Shear stress d
;/
[kPa]
Epsilon
e.
Equivalent strain K
e
[-]
Epsilon
e.,
p8.
Equivalent plastic strain K
e,p8
[-]
#ist o" &aria)les displa%ed )% the progra' + &aria)les a&aila)le in the regi'e
"Extended input".
.otation $escription 5aria)l
e
Unit
Epsilon
0o8.
Volumetric strain K
0o8.
[-]
Sigma
m, tot.
Mean total normal stress
m,tot
[kPa]
Sigma
m, e66.
Mean total normal stress
m,e66
[kPa]
Sigma
e.
Equivalent deviatoric stress U [kPa]
Epsilon
0o8.,
p8.
Volumetric plastic strain K
0o8.p8
[-]
Epsilon
X
Normal strain in the X direction K
;
[-]
Epsilon
Z
Normal strain in the X direction K
/
[-]
Gama
XZ
Shear strain in the XZ plane
;/

Epsilon
1,
pr)Fc.
Maximal principal strain K
1,pr)Fc
[-]
Epsilon
2,
pr)Fc.
Intermediate principal strain K
2,pr)Fc
[-]
Epsilon
",
pr)Fc.
Minimal principal strain K
",pr)Fc
[-]
Sigma
1,
pr)Fc.
Maximal principal stress
1,pr)Fc
[kPa]
Sigma
2,
Intermediate principal stress
2,pr)Fc
[kPa]
-563-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
pr)Fc.
Sigma
",
pr)Fc.
Minimal principal stress
",pr)Fc
[kPa]
Epsilon
X, p8.
Normal plastic strain in the X direction K
;,p8
[-]
Epsilon
Z, p8
Normal plastic strain in the Z direction K
/,p8
[-]
Gama
XZ, p8.
Shear plastic strain in the XZ plane
;/,p8

/onitors
The frame "/onitors" contains a table with the list of inputted monitors. Adding (editing)
monitors is performed in the ".ew 'onitors" dialog window.
Either point or line-monitors can be introduced. The dialog window then serves to specify
coordinates of the monitor and monitor activity.
The monitors can also be introduced using the 'ouse. This inputting mode is activated by
clicking an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "Monitors". The following modes are
available:
- Add The monitor is introduced by clicking the left mouse button at a desired
location on the desktop.
- /odi"% Clicking the left mouse button on already existing monitor opens the
"Ad8ust 'onitor" dialog window, which allows for modifying its
parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on already existing monitor opens the
'onitor re'o&al dialog window accepting this action removes the
selected free point.
The monitors can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
The program allows for inputting an arbitrary number of point and line-monitors anywhere in
the structure and also out of it. Monitors have several functions:
- displaying values of variables in a given point (point-monitor),
- displaying values of the difference of distance of two points in comparison with the
previous stage ,[3] or in comparison with the input stage, where 3 is the stage number
(line-monitor).
The point monitors store also the values of variables recorded during the analysis in individual
stages. These can be written into an output protocol or used to create graphs.
The list of variables plotted for individual monitors is set in the "Monitor settings" dialog
window. To open the window use the "Settings" button in the horizontal tool bar "/onitors".
-564-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Monitors"
/onitors settings
The "/onitor settings" dialog window serves to set variables whose values will be plotted for
a given monitor (point-monitors). Setting for a given list of variables can be adopted from the
previous stage of construction using the "Adopt "ro' the pre&ious stage" button. Four
variables are displayed by default. Additional variables can be added to the list using the "Add"
button. The variable can be removed from the list using the ",e'o&e" button.
For line-monitors the dialog window serves to activate the plot of values in comparison with
the previous stage or the input stage, respectively.
For both point and line-monitors it is possible to specify the color range of plotted values.
Dialog window "Monitors settings"
-565-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Graphs
The frame "Graphs" contains a table with the list of inputted graphs. Adding (editing)
monitors is performed in the ".ew graphs" dialog window. The dialogue window serves to
enter the monitor number for which the graph will be created and the variables adopted for the
X and Y-axis respectively.
The graphs can also be introduced using the 'ouse. This inputting mode is activated by
clicking an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "Graphs". The following modes are
available:
- Add The graph location is introduced by clicking the left mouse button at a
desired monitor.
- /odi"% Clicking the left mouse button on already existing graph opens the
"Ad8ust graph" dialog window, which allows for modifying its
parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on already existing graph opens the graph
re'o&al dialog window accepting this action removes the selected
graph.
The graphs can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
The program allows for inputting an arbitrary number of graphs at points of inputted monitors.
Graphs allow for plotting a mutual dependence of individual variables stored in monitors during
the course of analysis.
Frame ")raphs"
-566-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Sta)ilit%
In stability (safety factor) analysis the program reduces the original strength para'eters -
angle of internal friction and cohesion until failure occurs. The analysis then results into a
"actor o" sa"et% that corresponds to the classical methods of limit equilibrium.
The safety factor analysis requires using six-node elements. Since plastic slip is the main
failure mechanism we also require that the Mohr-Coulomb, the modified Mohr-Coulomb or the
Drucker-Prager plasticity model be used for all soils. Default setting can be adjusted in the
"Anal%sis settings" dialog window.
In the stability analysis mode the only variables available for graphical representation are
displace'ents (in the Z and X-directions) and equivalent total and plastic strains. The
deformation of a soil body corresponds to the state of failure attained for the reduced soil
parameters - therefore, it does not correspond to real state of deformation of the soil body.
Instead, it provides a good insight about the entire slope response of earth structure in general
at the onset of failure.
A suitable way of presenting the stability analysis results are &ectors o" displace'ents
plotted together with the eHui&alent plastic strain. The localized plastic deformation
provides visible evidence about the possible location of the critical slip sur"ace.
Frame "Stabilit#"
-567-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Plot of eAuialent plastic strain $ slip surface
Setting )asic para'eters o" slope sta)ilit% anal%sis
The safety factor analysis is based on the assumption that the total load applied to the
soil/rock body is introduced in a single load step. The actual factor of safety is evaluated using
the 'ethod o" reduction o" strength para'eters c, : Regarding this the factor of safety is
defined as a scalar multiplier that reduces the original parameters c, to arrive at the state of
failure.
Mathematically, the "actor o" sa"et% is expressed as:
where:

or)5)Fa8

-the original value of the angle of internal friction

6a)89re

-the value of the angle of internal friction at failure
Searching for the critical value of the factor of safety requires a systematic modification
(reduction) of strength parameters c, leading to failure. In the framework of the NRM the
state of failure is determined as the state for which the solution fails to converge. The process
of searching for critical c, is driven by the following parameters.
1. ,eduction reduction factor (scalar multiplier) to reduce parameters c, . During the
course of analysis this parameter is progressively updated.
2. /in0 reduction "actor the limit value, below which the value of reduction factor
should not fall during the searching process. This parameter ensures that the
-568-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
computation will not continue for needless low values of the reduction factor. It is one of
the parameters to terminate the searching process.
3. ,eduction o" soil para'eters this parameter allows us to define which of the
parameters c, should be reduced. The default setting assumes that both parameters
are reduced at the same time.
@asic parameters of slope stabilit# anal#sis
Setting dri&ing para'eters o" relaation o" reduction
"actor
Similar to standard analysis the program adaptively adjusts the value of reduction factor.
Providing the solution fails to converge for a given set of parameters c, , the reduction factor
is relaxed and the analysis is restarted. This approach is driven by the parameters set in the
"Anal%sis settings" tab sheet .ewton ,aphson.
The ",elaation "actor" serves to reduce the current value of the Reduction factor of
parameters c, . The analysis is terminated once the value of reduction factor drops below the
minimum one or the maximum number of allowable reductions is exceeded. When selecting
the NRM the program allows us to determine the parameters c, which bring a soil body to a
stable state in cases, where the solution with the original parameters c, was not found. The
program then precedes in the opposite way so that parameters c, are s%ste'aticall%
increased until the sta)le solution is "ound.
-569-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Parameters driing the process of reduction of strength parameters c< L
Progra' Pile CP!
Pro8ect
The "Pro8ect" frame is used to input the basic project data and to specify the overall setting of
the analysis run. The frame contains an input form to introduce the basic data about the
analyzed task, i.e. project information, project description, date, etc. This information is
further used in text and graphical outputs.
The frame also allows the user to switch analysis units (metric / imperial).
Frame "Pro'ect"
-570-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Settings
The frame "Settings" serves to introduce the basic "Settings" of the program such as
standards and theories of analyses, the way of proving safety of a structure and individual
coefficients of the analysis.
The programs contain not only the pre-defined )asic Settings for individual countries, but
also allow the user to create their own user6de"ined Settings, which can be subsequently
used in all GEO5 programs.
The "Select" button enables to choose an already created Setting from the "Settings list".
The "Settings Ad'inistrator" button opens the "Administrator" dialogue window, which
allows for viewing and modifying individual Setting. One may also identify the visible settings
in the Settings list. Data in the Settings administrator can be also eported and i'ported.
The "Add to the ad'inistrator" button allows for creating user-defined Settings, which are
subsequently added to the Settings administrator.
The "/odi"%" button enables a quick visualization and editing of the current Setting in the
opened program. Modifying any of the parameters changes the title to "Inputted "or the
current task". Individual analyses are then performed with this local setting. Should we
consider this setting as suitable also for other tasks, we add the setting into the "Settings
ad'inistrator" by pressing the "Add to the ad'inistrator" button.
The "Inputted "or the current task" setting is usually created when importing older data.
Settings of analysis parameters are performed in the "Piles CPT" tab sheet.
This frame also allows for the introduction of negative skin friction and partial factor on model
uncertainty
ca8
into the analysis. Parameters of the negative skin friction are defined in the
frame "GWT+NSF".
Frame "Settings"
Pro"ile
The frame "Pro"ile" contains a table with the list of inputted interfaces. After specifying
interfaces it is possible to edit thicknesses of individual layers with the help of active
dimensions.
Adding (editing) layer is performed in the "Add @editA inter"ace" dialog window. The /-
coordinate measured from the top point of a structure is specified (/-axis).
-571-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The program allows for raising or lowering the top point of a structure in the "Change o"
terrain ele&ation" dialog window so that the whole interface can be translated while keeping
the thicknesses of individual layers. This function is important when copying the profile from
program "!errain".
The program makes it possible to import a profile in the gINT format.
Frame "Profile"
Soils
The frame "Soils" contains a table with the list of inputted soils. The table also provides
information about the currently selected soil displayed in the right part of the frame.
Adding (editing) a soil is performed in the "Add (edit) soil" dialog window.
The soil characteristics needed in the program are further specified in the following chapters:
"Basic data" and "Uplift pressure".
These parameters depend on the theory of analysis specified in the "Piles CPT" tab sheet.
The program makes it possible import soils in the gINT format.
-572-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Soils"
Basic data
This part of the window serves to introduce basic parameters of soils unit weight1 angle o"
internal "riction and cohesion. The particular values are obtained from geotechnical survey
or from laboratory experiments. If these data are not available, it is possible to exploit built-in
database of soils, which contains values of selected characteristics of soils.
The associated theory is described in detail in chapter "Analyses in program Pile CPT".
For calculation of shaft resistance according to the EN 1997-2, NEN 6743 and LCPC
(Bustamante) further needs to specify coefficient reducing the shaft friction G
s
. For coarse-
grained soils - sands and gra&els further needs to specify the magnitude of overconsolidation
(OCR) and type of grains.
-573-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ",dd new soils" - "@asic data"
Construction
The frame:Construction: serves to select the type of structure a single pile or a group of
piles. This frame also serves to input the values of surcharge design and standard value. The
design value is used to calculate the pile bearing capacity, while the standard value is used to
calculate the pile settlement, for both types of loading when the NEM standard is employed
(state 1B and 2).
The program makes it possible to export the geometry of a structure in the *.DXF format.
-574-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Structure" $ single pile
If the option :Consider in"luence o" negati&e skin "riction: is set in the frame "Settings",
then it is also possible to enter the sur"ace surcharge using the :G(! * .SF: frame.
Frame Structure $ single pile 7influence .SF8
-575-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Group o" piles
When defining a group of piles it is necessary to input the structure stiffness, which then the
drives the analysis and verification of the structures. The basic assumption is that for a stiff
structure all piles experience the same settlement, while for a compliant structure each pile
deforms independently. When running the analysis according to NEM6473 this frame also
serves to select the way the CPT is carried out.
For both stiff and compliant structures the program allows for defining locations of individual
piles using their coordinates. In such a case the coordinates of each pile are required (in the x,
y coordinate system) and the loading acts on each inputted pile. If the option :Consider
in"luence o" negati&e skin "riction: is set in the frame "Settings", then it is also possible to
enter the sur"ace surcharge using the :G(! * .SF: frame. Adding (editing) a new pile is
performed in the :.ew pile:dialog window.
Frame ")roup of piles" $ entering locations of piles using their coordinates
If the user does not enter the coordinates of piles locations, then their parameters are defined
directly in the frame "Construction". Selecting the stiff structure allows for specifying the
number of piles below the structure (the piles are then spread uniformly).
-576-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ")roup of piles"
Geo'etr%
The frame "Geo'etr%" serves to input the pile cross6section (circular, rectangular, circular
with enlargement, rectangular with enlargement) and a type of the pile (cast in place screw
piles, prefabricated screw pile, continuous Flight Auger (CFA)). Using input fields the cross-
section dimensions are then specified for the selected cross-section.
This frame also serves to input a 'aterial o" the pile (timber, concrete, steel) a geo'etr%
o" positioning the pile (a pile length in the soil, a pile head offset and a depth of finished
grade). The selected shape with a graphical hint of inputted values is displayed in the right
part of the frame.
The toe bearing capacity coefficientG
p
is specified in the center part of the frame. This
coefficient is by default automatically calculated based on the selected procedure while taking
into account the type of pile and the surrounding soil.
When analyzing rectangular piles the pile shape coefficients is introduced to reduce the toe
bearing capacity. When analyzing piles with enlargement the expanded pile toe coefficientYis
introduced to adjust the expanded toe bearing capacity.
The program makes it possible to export the geometry of a structure in the *.DXF format.
-577-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ")eometr#"
G(! * .SF
The frame "G(!" ("G(! * .SF") serves to specify the depth o" ground water ta)le and
the level of inco'pressi)le su)soil.
The values can be edited either in the frame by inserting values into input fields, or on the
desktop with the help of active dimensions. The G(! changes the geostatic stress in the soil
profile.
The inco'pressi)le su)soil cuts off the in"luence -one below foundation. It also influences
a reduction of the settlement.
-578-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ")%T" $ without influence of .SF
If the option :Consider in"luence o" negati&e skin "riction: is set in the frame "Settings",
then it becomes possible to enter parameters of the negative skin friction using the :G(! *
.SF: frame boundaries of the region, where the influence of negative skin friction is
considered, or sliding region and its material and cohesion.
-579-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ")%T" $ with influence of .SF
CP!s
The frame "CP!s" contains a table with list of inputted tests of static penetration (CPT).
Individual parameters of the test are defined in the ".ew CP!" ("3dit CP!") dialog window.
This window serves to enter a name of the test, a depth of the first point of the CPT from the
finished grade, location of CPT (in the ;,? coordinate system) and measured values of
penetration resistance
c
with respect to a depth / measured from the original ground (when
calculating according to Schmertmann local friction 6
s
must be specified).
The "Add" button in the dialog window opens the ".ew &alue o" skin resistance" ("3dit
skin resistance") dialog window, which serves to input the measured values of penetration
resistance.
Each inputted penetration test is automatically linked to the standard profile specified using
the "Profile" input mode. To introduce the penetration test into a specific profile check the
"Ad8ust para'eters o" standard pro"ile" input field, which is located in the bottom part of
the dialog. Individual input fields are then used to specify new parameters.
User can change entered values in dialog window "3dit CP!". Inserting values between
already entered values is realized in dialog window "Inserted CP!".
The results of CPT tests can also be imported.
-580-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ".ew test"
Editing (inserting a test in between already defined tests) is performed in the "Insert test"
dialog window.
Frame "Tests"
I'port CP!
The program "Pile CP!" allows for importing the CPT test results in the CP! format (?0cpt),
gI.! (?0gi4) a !>! (?0tt). The "I'port CP!" dialog window contains a table with the list
imported tests. The combo lists serve to select the type of file and the desired system of units.
?0CP! - a text file standard particularly for Netherlands (used e.g., in programs Geodelft M-
Serie), which serves to input elevations of individual points and values of penetration
resistance (may contain more CPTs)
?0GI4 - a text format, which transports tests data from program gINT Software this file
contains a set of units, individual test points are specified by their depth from the
origin
?0!>! - a general text format with the following definition:
1st row [test name] string
2nd row [elevation of the test origin] number (an empty row can be entered)
3rd row [point depth][penetration resistance] points separated by space
A TXT format allows for selecting a particular s%ste' o" units to store data of the test. When
importing the program automatically converts the adopted system of units to the one used in
the program.
For a correct calculation the test must be introduced into the soil body therefore the window
-581-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
requires us to input an ele&ation o" the original ground. The particular test is then inserted
into the soil body according to its specified elevation. If no elevation is given the origin of the
test is automatically placed on the original ground.
Providing you use a certain standard of a CPT text file not supported by the program, feel free
to contact us at hotline@fine.cz it will be introduced into the forthcoming version.
Dialog window "+mport CTP"
Assign
The frame "Assign" contains the list of layers of the profile and associated soils. The list of
soils is graphically represented using buttons in the bar above the table, or it is accessible from
a combo list associated with each layer of the profile.
The procedure to assign a soil to a layer is described in detail herein.
The program makes it possible to import soil assignment in the gINT format.
-582-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",ssign"
Bearing capacit%
The frame"Bearing capacit%" serves to verify the pile &ertical )earing capacit%. The
analysis results are plotted in the right bottom part of the frame. The "In details" button
opens the dialog window, which contains a detailed printout of results from the verification
analysis.
The plotting scheme can be modified in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
-583-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "@earing capacit#"
Settle'ent
The frame "Settle'ent" serves to verify the pile settlement. The analysis results are plotted
in the right bottom part of the frame. The "In details" button opens the dialog window, which
contains a detailed printout of results from the verification analysis.
When calculating settlement according to the NEN6743 standard the program plots, apart from
the limit load curve, also the loading diagram ("orce/displace'ent cur&e).
The analysis results are displayed in the top part of the frame. The plotting scheme can be
modified in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
-584-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Settlement" $ 3imit loading cure
Frame "Settlement" $ Distributions force;settlement
-585-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Progra' Bea'
Pro8ect
The "Pro8ect" frame is used to input the basic project data and to specify the overall setting of
the analysis run. The frame contains an input form to introduce the basic data about the
analyzed task, i.e. project information, project description, date, etc. This information is
further used in text and graphical outputs.
The frame also allows the user to switch analysis units (metric / imperial).
Frame "Pro'ect"
Settings
The frame "Settings" serves to introduce the basic "Settings" of the program such as
standards and theories of analyses, the way of proving safety of a structure and individual
coefficients of the analysis.
The programs contain not only the pre-defined )asic Settings for individual countries, but
also allow the user to create their own user6de"ined Settings, which can be subsequently
used in all GEO5 programs.
The "Select" button enables to choose an already created Setting from the "Settings list".
The "Settings Ad'inistrator" button opens the "Administrator" dialogue window, which
allows for viewing and modifying individual Setting. One may also identify the visible settings
in the Settings list. Data in the Settings administrator can be also eported and i'ported.
The "Add to the ad'inistrator" button allows for creating user-defined Settings, which are
subsequently added to the Settings administrator.
The "/odi"%" button enables a quick visualization and editing of the current Setting in the
opened program. Modifying any of the parameters changes the title to "Inputted "or the
current task". Individual analyses are then performed with this local setting. Should we
consider this setting as suitable also for other tasks, we add the setting into the "Settings
ad'inistrator" by pressing the "Add to the ad'inistrator" button.
The "Inputted "or the current task" setting is usually created when importing older data.
Settings of analysis parameters are performed in the "Materials and standards" tab sheet.
This frame also serves to specify su)di&ision o" the wall into "inite ele'ents (default
setting is 20 elements). Next it is possible to define whether the soil acts in tension we
always recommend calculating assu'ing tension cuto"" o" soils.
-586-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
A combo list allows for choosing one of the three ways of defining the Winkler-Pasternak
su)soil:
- Calculation of S
1
and S
2
the Winkler-Pasternak parameters of subsoil are calculated by
the program from inputted parameters of the geological profile.
- Input of S
1
and S
2
the Winkler-Pasternak parameters of subsoil are directly specified.
- Input of -
,e6
, F
?
, h
/
the Winkler-Pasternak parameters of subsoil are calculated from the
deformation modulus -
,e6
, Poisson number and depth of influence zone h
/
.
In the first case, when parameters S
1
and S
2
are calculated, the frame "Subsoil" is not
accessible. For the remaining two approaches the frames "Interface", "Location", "Soils",
"Assign", and "Water" are not accessible.
Frame "Settings"
(inkler6Pasternak para'eters C1 a C2
!he (inkler 6 Pasternak 'odel "or the solution o" an elastic la%er introduces the
balance equation in the vertical direction as:
where: c
1
, c
2
-parameters of the Winkler Pasternak model
$ -deflection in the vertical direction
6
/
-vertical load acting on a layer
The program makes it possible to calculate the parameters S
1
, S
2
from deformation
parameters of soils or from geological profile.
Calculation o" (inkler6Pasternak para'eters C1 and
C2 "ro' geological pro"ile
A characteristic combination of loading must be chosen when calculating the Winkler
Pasternak parameters (S
1
, S
2
) from the geological profile. This combination should be
considered as service and should correspond to the most frequently appearing load. Using this
combination a surcharge at the footing bottom is calculated next followed by calculation of the
influence zone.
Deformation parameters (Poissons number, deformation modulus) are determined for the
calculated influence zone as a weighted average of deformation parameters of soils. Given
these parameters the WinklerPasternak constants (S
1
, S
2
) are then calculated in the following
way.
-587-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Calculation o" (inkler6Pasternak constants "ro'
de"or'ation para'eters o" soils
The Winkler Pasternak constants S
1
and S
2
are calculated in the program from the condition
of equal compliance matrices of infinitely stiff infinite strip footing resting on the Winkler
Pasternak and elastic subsoil. This condition is represented by the following equalities:
where: [S] -matrix of constants S
1
a S
2
> -half width of foundation
S
1$
, S
2$
-Winklers constants
e depth of deformation zone
Geo'etr%
The frame "Geo'etr%" contains a table with a list of inputted beam sections. Adding (editing)
points is performed in the ".ew seg'ents @3dit seg'ent propertiesA" dialog window. The
window requires defining the section length, width and height (for rectangular cross6
section). The program allows for defining a general cross-section of a beam (cross-sectional
area and moment of inertia are specified).
/aterial o" the cross6section is specified next, either using the program catalog, or by
entering the material parameters (modulus of elasticity, shear modulus, self-weight).
-588-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ")eometr#"
Su)soil
The frame "Subsoil" contains a table with the list of values of the parameters of Winkler-
Pasternak subsoilS
1
andS
2
or de"or'ation para'eters o" soils (-
,e6
, F
?
, h
/
), respectively,
depending on the setting in the frame "Settings".
Inputting or editing parameters mode is selected from a combo list.
The table shows values of the parameter that is selected from the combo list above the table.
Adding (editing) points is performed in the ".ew su)soil para'eters" dialog window. The
window serves to specify the X coordinate and the value of the parameter.
-589-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Subsoil"
Inter"ace
The frame "Inter"ace" serves to introduce individual soil interfaces into the soil body. Detailed
description on how to deal with interfaces is described herein.
The program makes it possible to import or export interfaces in the *.DXF format. They can
also be imported in the gINT format.
-590-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "+nterface"
#ocation
The frame "#ocation" serves to specify the beam location. One needs to specify the beam
origin point having x and z coordinates.
-591-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "3ocation"
Soils
The frame "Soils" contains a table with the list of inputted soils. The table also provides
information about currently selected soil displayed in the right part of the frame.
Adding (editing) a soil is performed in the "Add (edit) soil" dialog window.
The soil characteristics needed in the program are further specified in the following chapters:
"Basic data", "Settlement oedometric modulus", "Settlement determination of the depth of
influence zone" and "Uplift pressure".
The program makes it possible to import soils in the gINT format.
-592-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Soils"
Basic data
This part of the dialog window serves to specify the unit weight.
-593-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ",dd new soils" - "@asic data"
Assign
The frame "Assign" contains a list of layers of the profile and associated soils. The list of soils
is graphically represented using buttons in the bar above the table, or it is accessible from a
combo list for each layer of the profile.
The procedure to assign soil into a layer is described in detail herein.
The program makes it possible to import soil assignment in the gINT format.
-594-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",ssign"
(ater
The frame "(ater" serves to input the ground water table. Distribution GWT is introduced the
same way as interfaces of soils.
-595-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "%ater"
Supports
The frame "Supports" contains a table with the list of inputted supports. Adding (editing)
supports is performed in the ".ew supports @3dit support propertiesA" dialog window.
Editing can be carried out with the help of "/odi"%" button or by clicking the row with the
required support in the list using the left mouse button.
The type of support is determined according to a particular boundary condition specified at a
given point (translation, rotation).
The following )oundar% condition can )e speci"ied at a point:
- free
- fixed
- deformation
- spring
-596-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Supports"
#oad cases
The frame "#oad cases" contains a table with the list of inputted load cases. Adding (editing)
load cases and their parameters is performed in the ".ew load case" dialog window. Editing
can be carried out with the help of "/odi"%" button or by clicking the row with the required
load case in the list using the left mouse button.
-597-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "3oad cases"
#oad case para'eters
The following parameters are defined in the ".ew load case" dialog window:
#oad case identi"ier
The load case identifier, which is composed of the load case number and a uniliteral prefix, is
displayed in front of the field for entering the name of the load case. The prefix is determined
by the type of load case:
G - permanent loading
O - variable loading
A - accidental loading
The load case identifier is mainly used in printouts of combinations.
#oad case code
The load case code determines, what loading can be specified for this loading. The following
options are available.
Sel"6weight -In this load case the load represents the structure self-weight and it is
generated automatically by the program. Only one load case with this code can
be considered in each task.
Force -An arbitrary type of force loading (forces, moments) can be introduced into the
load case with this code. The number of LCs is not limited.
#oad t%pe
It determines the character of load cases based on their variability in time. Selecting a
-598-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
particular type of load corresponds to classification according to EN 1990 standard, art. 4.1.1.
#oad coe""icients
It allows for specifying the load partial factor
6
. This coefficient accounts for unfavorable
deviations of values of loads from the representative ones. For permanent loading it is
necessary to introduce different values for favorable (
6, )F6
) and for unfavorable (
6, s9p
) load
action in a combination. If the load input follows EN 1990 the default values of coefficients are
taken from table A1.2(B).
Categor%
Classification of load cases into categories corresponds to the classification of load according to
table A1.1 of EN 1990 standard. Based on this the variable load cases are assigned
combination coefficients *
0
, *
1
a *
2
. The category of "User6de"ined input" allows for defining
the user self-values of these coefficients. Choosing a category is possible only for load cases
inputted according to EN 1990 (the "Materials and standards" tab sheet serves to select the
particular standard).
Co')ination coe""icients
Basic values of coefficients to create combinations arise from EN 1990 standard and depend on
the load case category. When user input is assumed, it is possible to define the user self-values
of these coefficients. The following coefficients are used to create a combination:
f - Coe""icient o" reduction o" per'anent loads in alternati&e co')ination this
coefficient is assigned to all permanent loads and is used when compiling alternative
combinations for the bearing capacity limit state (combination to relation 6.10.b, EN
1990).
*
0
- Coe""icient o" co')ination &alue coefficient for variable loads, it is used when
compiling combinations for both the bearing capacity and service limit states
*
1
- Coe""icient o" "reHuent &alue coefficient for variable loads, it is used when
compiling accidental combinations and combinations for the service limit state
*
2
Coe""icient o" Huasi6per'anent &alue 6 coefficient for variable loads, it is used
when compiling accidental combinations and combinations for the service limit state
The combination coefficients are available only for load cases inputted according to EN 1990
(the frame "Analysis methods" serves to select the particular standard).
-599-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ".ew load case"
#oad
The frame "#oad" contains a table with the list of inputted loads. Adding (editing) a load is
performed in the ".ew loads @3dit loadsA" dialog window. Editing can be carried out with the
help of "/odi"%" button or by clicking the row with the required load in the list using the left
mouse button.
Each load is assigned to a load case. The load case can be selected from the "Acti&e load
case" combo list above the table.
-600-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "3oad"
Co')ination o" U#S
The frame "Co')inations U#S" contains a table with the list of inputted combinations of the
bearing capacity limit state. Adding (editing) combinations and their parameters is performed
in the ".ew co')ination o" load cases" dialog window. Editing can be carried out with the
help of "/odi"%" button or by clicking the row with the required combination in the list using
the left mouse button.
The built-in generator of combinations of load cases can be used to create individual
combinations.
-601-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Combination of B3S"
Para'eters o" co')inations o" U#S
The following parameters are specified in the ".ew co')ination o" load cases" dialog
window:
.ew co')ination
A brief description of combination is displayed in front of the field where the combination is
defined. All considered load cases are tagged using their identifiers. The major variable loads
are moved at the beginning of the list and separated from the remaining LCs by colon.
!%pe o" co')ination @"or co')inations )ased on 3. 1DDF onl%A
The following combinations can be created for the bearing capacity limit state:
Basic -Basic combination based on expression 6.10 of EN 1990 standard
Alternati&e -Combinations based on expressions 6.10a and 1.10b of EN 1990 standard. In
this case, two variants of combination are used in the analysis, one with
reduced permanent LCs and the other with reduced major variable LC.
Accidental -Accidental combination based on 6.11 of EN 1990 standard.
Selection o" load cases
The table listing individual load cases allows for their selection to create a combination. The
load case can be introduced into a combination by checking the field in the column "Consider"
for a particular LC. Further setting in the table depends on the selection of way of inputting
loads in the "Materials and standards" tab sheet.
#oading according to 3. 1DDF;
A second field is available for each load case in the column "Consider". This field allows for
-602-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
assigning a favorable effect of action to permanent LCs (adopting coefficient
6, )F6
) or for
specifying a variable loading as the major one, respectively. The number of major variable
loads in the combination is not limited. An accidental load can be introduced into combinations
tagged as "Accidental" (only LCs tagged as "Accidental" are available for the selection). For
accidental combinations it is also necessary to choose, whether a major variable load should be
reduced by the coefficient *
1
or *
2
.
General loading
A coefficient of usability can be specified for each load case to adjust the degree of usability of
the load case in the combination.
Dialog window ".ew combination of load cases"
Generator o" co')inations
The "Generator o" co')inations + 1st order" dialog window allows for a collective
compilation of combinations of load cases based on the introduced combination rules. Referring
to standard EN 1990 the number of generated combinations can be relatively large and in
extreme cases could considerably slow down calculations. Owing to this, information about
expected number of combinations to be generated is displayed in the right bottom corner.
Therefore, before launching generation the user may check, how many combinations will be
generated and possibly adjust generator conditions. The top part of the window serves to
define conditions for generating combinations; the bottom part contains various generator
settings.
-603-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ")enerator of combinations - 5st order"
/utuall% interacting load states and groups
This part makes it possible to merge those load states that should appear in combinations
always together. Permanent and variable loads cannot be merged into one group. If the field
All per'anent loads alwa%s in co')ination is checked in the Generator parameters, the
creation of groups of permanent loads has no effect on their appearance in combinations as
each generated combination will always contain all permanent LCs. In such case, merging
permanent LCs will only influence consideration of favorable/unfavorable effects of LCs
providing the field Per'anent loads act onl% un"a&ora)l% is not checked.
Dialog window ")enerator of combinations" $ Mutuall# interacting load states
3cluded interaction o" load states
This part makes possible to define, which LCs should not appear in a combination together.
Arbitrary load cases or merged groups can be mutually excluded in dependent of the type of
load case. Two options are available to define groups to be excluded:
/utual
eclusion
-An arbitrary number of load cases can be introduced into one group. In such a
case, the program will not generate any combination that contains at least two
load cases from this group.
3clusion
)% pairs
-Providing it is necessary to create a larger number of excluding groups of two
sorts, where one LC is the same (e.g. exclusion of assembly variants of
permanent loads with all service load cases), it is possible to adopt this option.
-604-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
A load case to be excluded is first selected in the first column. The second
column is then used to select an arbitrary number of LCs, which are needed to
create excluding groups.
Dialogue window ")enerator of combinations" $ (&cluded interaction of load states
#oad cases and groups acting as the 'ain &aria)le load
This part is available only when inputting loads according to EN 1990 is considered (the
standard is selected in the "Materials and standards" tab sheet). When automatic regime is
assumed then each variable load is taken as major in created combinations. If this regime is
turned off, it is possible to manually adjust the list of major variable loads. For example, it is
possible to remove an arbitrary load case from the list so that it will not be considered as
major variable in combinations. If a new item with more load cases is add to the list then all
load cases will be considered as major variable in those combinations, where they appear
together.
Dialog window ")enerator of combinations" $ 3oad cases and groups acting as the main
ariable load
Generator para'eters (parameters that can be set in the bottom part of the dialog window).
Co')o list :Original co')inations:
,etain original
co')inations
- By pressing the "Generate" button the program will add new
combinations, created according to the specified rules, to the
original ones
,e'o&e all
co')inations
- By pressing the "Generate" button the program will delete all
original combinations and will replace them by the new ones
,e'o&e generated
co')inations
- By pressing the "Generate" button the program will delete older
combinations and will add new ones created according to the
specified rules
,e'o&e all
co')inations o" the
current t%pe
- By pressing the "Generate" button the program will delete all
combinations of a given type and will replace them by the new
ones
-605-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
,e'o&e generated
co')inations o" the
current t%pe
- By pressing the "Generate" button the program will delete older
combinations of a given type and will add new ones created
according to the specified rules
Co')o list :Generate co')inations:
The following types of generated combinations can be chosen for loads based on EN 1990:
Basic - Generates basic combinations for the bearing capacity limit state
based on expression 6.10 of EN 1990 standard
Alternati&e - Generates combinations for the bearing capacity limit state based
on expressions 6.10a and 1.10b of EN 1990 standard. This
variant generates two times more combinations but it provides
better results.
Accidental - Generates accidental combinations for the bearing capacity limit
state based on 6.11 of EN 1990 standard. An accidental load case
to appear in accidental combinations can be specified. It is also
necessary to choose, whether a major variable load will be
reduced by the coefficient *
1
or *
2
.
Per'anent loads act onl% un"a&ora)l%
If this setting is not checked, the program creates all possible combinations, where
introduction of all variants of favorable and unfavorable actions of permanent loads will be
considered.
All per'anent loads alwa%s in co')ination
If this setting is not checked, the program creates combinations in such a way that a
successive introduction of all LCs into a combination will be considered.
Co')inations S#S
The frame "Co')inations S#S" contains a table with the list of inputted combinations of the
service limit state. Adding (editing) combinations and their parameters is performed in the
".ew co')ination o" load cases" dialog window. Editing can be carried out with the help of
"/odi"%" button or by clicking the row with the required combination in the list using the left
mouse button.
The built-in generator of combinations of load cases can be used to compile individual
combinations.
-606-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Combination S3S"
Para'eters o" co')inations o" S#S
Combinations SLS serve to evaluate states that refer to the structure appearance, comfort of
people or to functioning of a structure while in ordinary use. Typically, only deformations,
vibrations, etc. are checked. The ".ew co')ination o" load cases" dialog window (similarly
to combinations for ULS) serves to define the following parameters:
!%pe o" co')ination according to 3. 1DDF
The following combinations can be created for the service limit state:
Characteristic - combination based on expression 6.14 of EN 1990 standard
FreHuent - combination based on expression 6.15 of EN 1990 standard
Ouasi6per'anent - combination based on expression 6.16 of EN 1990 standard
Selection o" load cases
The table listing individual load cases allows for their selection to create a combination. The
load case can be introduced into a combination by checking the field in the column "Consider"
for a particular LC. A coefficient of usability can be specified for generally inputted
combinations (select in the "Materials and standards" tab sheet) to adjust the degree of
usability of the load case in the combination.
-607-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ".ew combination of load cases"
Generator o" co')inations
The "Generator o" co')inations + 1st order" dialog window allows for a collective
compilation of combinations of load cases for the service limit state. Functions of generator of
combinations are explained in section devoted to the generator of combinations for the bearing
capacity limit state.
If inputting loads according to EN 1990 is set in the "Materials and standards" tab sheet, it is
possible to generate the following combinations for the service limit state:
Characteristic - combination based on expression 6.14 of EN 1990 standard
FreHuent - combination based on expression 6.15 of EN 1990 standard
Ouasi6per'anent - combination based on expression 6.16 of EN 1990 standard
Anal%sis
The frame "Anal%sis" also serves to display the analysis results. The analysis is carried using
the "inite ele'ent 'ethod incorporating the Winkler-Pasternak subsoil. Several analyses,
including presentation of results, can be carried out for one task. Information about the
performed analysis is displayed in the top right corner of the frame. Should the analysis
parameters change it is necessary to re-run the analysis by pressing the "Anal%-e" button.
If the subsoil parameters are calculated from the geological profile, it is necessary to choose
"Characteristic co')ination "or su)soil anal%sis" in the combo list.
The ",esults" combo list serves to set combinations of loading for ULS or SLS (possibly
envelopes of combinations of load cases) for which the results should be displayed on the
desktop.
The bottom part of the window serves to define, which variables are visualized (Displacements,
Shear force, Moment.) and the way of their appearance on the desktop.
-608-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",nal#sis"
Progra' Plate
Pro8ect
The "Pro8ect" frame is used to input the basic project data and to specify the overall setting of
the analysis run. The frame contains an input form to introduce the basic data about the
analyzed task, i.e. project information, project description, date, etc. This information is
further used in text and graphical outputs.
The frame also allows the user to switch analysis units (metric / imperial).
Frame "Pro'ect"
-609-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Settings
The frame "Settings" serves to introduce the basic "Settings" of the program such as
standards and theories of analyses, the way of proving safety of a structure and individual
coefficients of the analysis.
The programs contain not only the pre-defined )asic Settings for individual countries, but
also allow the user to create their own user6de"ined Settings, which can be subsequently
used in all GEO5 programs.
The "Select" button enables to choose an already created Setting from the "Settings list".
The "Settings Ad'inistrator" button opens the "Administrator" dialogue window, which
allows for viewing and modifying individual Setting. One may also identify the visible settings
in the Settings list. Data in the Settings administrator can be also eported and i'ported.
The "Add to the ad'inistrator" button allows for creating user-defined Settings, which are
subsequently added to the Settings administrator.
The "/odi"%" button enables a quick visualization and editing of the current Setting in the
opened program. Modifying any of the parameters changes the title to "Inputted "or the
current task". Individual analyses are then performed with this local setting. Should we
consider this setting as suitable also for other tasks, we add the setting into the "Settings
ad'inistrator" by pressing the "Add to the ad'inistrator" button.
The "Inputted "or the current task" setting is usually created when importing older data.
Settings of analysis parameters are performed in the "Materials and standards" tab sheet.
Frame "Settings"
Joints
The frame "Joints" contains a table with the list of inputted joints. Adding (editing) joints is
performed in the ".ew 8oints" dialog window.
Joints can also be introduced using the mouse. This inputting mode is activated by clicking an
appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "Joints". The following modes are available:
- Add Clicking the left mouse button on the desktop introduces the joint location.
- /odi"% Clicking the left mouse button on already existing joint opens the "/odi"%
properties o" 8oint" dialog window, which allows for modifying its
parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on the joint opens the re'o&e 8oint dialog
-610-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
window accepting this action removes the selected joint.
- Select Clicking the left mouse button on the joint highlights the selected joint.
The joint is simultaneously marked in the table list. The option allows for
editing several joints at once (e.g. deleting).
The inputted joints can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
Frame "Points"
#ines
The frame "#ines" contains a table with the list of inputted lines. Adding (editing) lines is
performed in the ".ew lines" dialog window.
The lines are defined )etween indi&idual points (segments, arcs, circles) or around
individual points (circles). The lines may arbitrarily cross or touch each other intersection of
inputted lines are identified by the program automatically when correcting the inputted
geometry.
Lines can also be introduced using the mouse. This inputting mode is activated by clicking an
appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "#ines". The following modes are available:
- Add Clicking the left mouse button on the desktop introduces the line location.
- #ine
t%pe
A combo list is used to select the desired type of line (segment, arc, circle).
-
seg'ent
Clicking the left mouse button on the joint introduces the line location.
-611-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- arc Use the combo list to choose a particular mode of defining an arc
segment (third point, center, radius, height). Clicking the left mouse
bottom on the desktop then selects points to define the arc. When
selecting one of the following options center, radius or included
angle, you are further requested to select the orientation (positive,
negative) from the combo list.
- circle Use the combo list to choose a particular mode of defining a circle
(center and radius, three points). Clicking the left mouse button on
the desktop then selects points to define the circle. The combo list is
also used to select the orientation (positive, negative).
- /odi"% Clicking the left mouse button on already existing points opens the "/odi"%
properties o" line" dialog window, which allows for modifying its parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on already exiting free points opens the re'o&e
line dialog window accepting this action removes the selected line.
- Select Clicking the left mouse button on the line highlights the selected line. The line is
simultaneously marked in the table list. The option allows for editing several lines
at once (e.g. deleting).
The lines can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
Frame "3ines"
/acroele'ents
The frame "/acroele'ents" contains a table with the list of inputted macroelements. Adding
(editing) macroelements is performed in the ".ew 'acroele'ents" dialog window. The
-612-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
dialog window servers to input a list of lines defining the macroelement outline, its thickness
and material. The macroelement material can be either selected from the catalog of materials
or its material parameters can be inputted manually using the "3dit 'aterial" dialog window.
Macroelements can also be introduced using mouse. This inputing mode is activated by clicking
an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "/acroele'ents". The following modes are
available:
- Add Clicking the left mouse button on the lines introduces the borders
macroelement. Adding macroelement is performed in the ".ew
'acroele'ent" dialog window.
- /odi"% Clicking the left mouse button on already existing macroelement opens the
"/odi"% properties o" 'acroele'ent" dialog window, which allows for
modifying its parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on the macroelement opens the re'o&e
'acroele'ent dialog window accepting this action removes the
selected macroelement.
- Select Clicking the left mouse button on the macroelement highlights the selected
macroelement. The macroelement is simultaneously marked in the table
list. The option allows for editing several macroelements at once (e.g.
deleting).
The inputted macroelements can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
Frame "Macroelements"
-613-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Openings
The frame "Openings" contains a table with the list of inputted openings. Adding (editing)
openings is performed in the ".ew openings" dialog window.
Openings can also be introduced using the mouse. This inputting mode is activated by clicking
an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "Openings". The following modes are
available:
- Add Clicking the left mouse button on the lines introduces the borders
openings. Adding opening is performed in the ".ew opening" dialog
window.
- /odi"% Clicking the left mouse button on already existing macroelement opens the
"/odi"% properties o" opening" dialog window, which allows for
modifying its parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on the opening opens the re'o&e opening
dialog window accepting this action removes the selected opening.
- Select Clicking the left mouse button on the opening highlights the selected
opening. The opening is simultaneously marked in the table list. The
option allows for editing several openings at once (e.g. deleting).
The inputted openings can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
Frame "*penings"
-614-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Joint re"ine'ents
The frame "Joint re"ine'ents" contains a table with the list of inputted joint refinements.
Adding (editing) joint refinements is performed in the ".ew 8oint re"ine'ents" dialog
window.
,e"ining the "inite ele'ent 'esh around 8oints is an important feature, which allows us to
create an appropriate finite element mesh.
Joint refinements can also be introduced using the mouse. This inputting mode is activated by
clicking an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "Joint re"ine'ents". The following
modes are available:
- Add Clicking the left mouse button on the desktop introduces the joint. Adding
joint refinement is performed in the ".ew 8oint re"ine'ent" dialog
window.
- /odi"% Clicking the left mouse button on already existing joint refinement opens
the "/odi"% properties o" 8oint re"ine'ent" dialog window, which
allows for modifying its parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on the opening opens the re'o&e 8oint
re"ine'ent dialog window accepting this action removes the selected
joint refinement.
- Select Clicking the left mouse button on the joint refinement highlights the
selected joint refinement. The joint refinement is simultaneously marked in
the table list. The option allows for editing several joint refinements at
once (e.g. deleting).
The inputted joint refinements can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active
objects.
-615-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Point refinements"
Dialog window ".ew 'oint refinements"
#ine re"ine'ents
The frame "#ine re"ine'ents" contains a table with the list of inputted line refinements.
Adding (editing) line refinements is performed in the ".ew line re"ine'ents" dialog window.
,e"ining the "inite ele'ent 'esh around lines is an important feature, which allows us to
create an appropriate finite element mesh.
Line refinements can also be introduced using the mouse. This inputting mode is activated by
clicking an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "#ine re"ine'ents". The following
-616-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
modes are available:
- Add Clicking the left mouse button on the desktop introduces the line. Adding
line refinement is performed in the ".ew line re"ine'ent" dialog
window.
- /odi"% Clicking the left mouse button on already existing line refinement opens
the "/odi"% properties o" line re"ine'ent" dialog window, which allows
for modifying its parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on the line refinement opens the re'o&e
line re"ine'ent dialog window accepting this action removes the
selected line refinement.
- Select Clicking the left mouse button on the line refinement highlights the
selected line refinement. The line refinement is simultaneously marked in
the table list. The option allows for editing several line refinements at once
(e.g. deleting).
The inputted line refinements can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
Frame "3ine refinements"
-617-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ".ew line refinements"
/acroele'ent re"ine'ents
The frame "/acroele'ent re"ine'ents" contains a table with the list of inputted
macroelement refinements. Adding (editing) macroelement refinements is performed in the
".ew 'acroele'ent re"ine'ents" dialog window.
,e"ining the "inite ele'ent 'esh o" 'acroele'ents is an important feature, which allows
us to create an appropriate finite element mesh.
Macroelement refinements can also be introduced using the mouse. This inputting mode is
activated by clicking an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "/acroele'ent
re"ine'ents". The following modes are available:
- Add Clicking the left mouse button on the desktop introduces the
macroelement. Adding line refinement is performed in the ".ew
'acroele'ent re"ine'ent" dialog window.
- /odi"% Clicking the left mouse button on already existing macroelement
refinement opens the "/odi"% properties o" 'acroele'ent
re"ine'ent" dialog window, which allows for modifying its parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on the macroelement refinement opens the
re'o&e 'acroele'ent re"ine'ent dialog window accepting this
action removes the selected macroelement refinement.
- Select Clicking the left mouse button on the macroelement refinement highlights
the selected macroelement refinement. The macroelement refinement is
simultaneously marked in the table list. The option allows for editing
several macroelement refinements at once (e.g. deleting).
The inputted macroelement refinements can also be edited on the desktop with the help of
active objects.
-618-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Macroelement 3ine refinements""
Dialog window ".ew macroelement refinements"
/esh generation
The frame "/esh generator" serves to define the basic setting to generate mesh (element
edge length, mesh type, mesh smoothing) and to view information about the generated mesh
(right part). The "3rror anal%sis" button allows for visualization of error listing in the right
part of the frame (list of problems the structure has).
Information about the resulting mesh including warnings for possible weak points in the mesh
is displayed in the right bottom window.
An arbitrary part of the plate specified by lines (segments, arches and circles) can be meshed.
The plate can be formed by one or more macroelements all having a constant thickness and
identical material properties and may contain an arbitrary number of openings. In addition, it
is possible to introduce internal points and lines which are then considered as mesh nodes and
-619-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
edges. The joints along lines and inside macroelements allow for mesh refinement, which is
characterized by the required length of element edges in the center of the refinement and by
the refinement radius. The user may choose either a purely triangular mesh or a hybrid mesh
consisting of both triangular and quadrilateral elements. The meshing algorithm is based on
Delaunay triangulation enhanced by several methods to modify and optimize the finite element
mesh. The mesh nodes are automatically renumbered to minimize the computational effort.
Properly generated finite element mesh is the stepping stone for obtaining accurate results.
Optimal are equilateral triangular and square quadrilateral elements. The program contains a
built-in automatic mesh generator considerably simplifying this task. The basic mesh density is
specified in the "/esh generator" window. Refining the mesh increases accuracy of the
results. However, high mesh density considerably slows down both the solution and
subsequent visualization of the results. The goal is thus to create an optimally refined mesh
this strongly depends on users experience.
Thanks to efficiency of the mesh generator there is no problem to adjust input parameters until
obtaining an optimal mesh. The mesh quality is further maintained with the help of built-in
smoothing algorithm, which can be turned off. The actual analysis step is extremely fast even
for relatively dense meshes.
!he "ollowing procedure to generate the "inite ele'ent 'esh is reco''ended;
Correctly generated finite element mesh is the major step in achieving accurate and reliable
results. The program FEM has an automatic mesh generator, which may substantially simplify
this task. Nevertheless, certain rules should )e "ollowed when creating a finite element
mesh:
- First, a uniform mesh linked to the plate thickness (1-5 multiple of its thickness) is
generated throughout the plate.
-620-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Mesh generation" $ a mesh with no local refinement
- The finite element mesh should be sufficiently fine in the locations where large stress
gradients are expected (point supports, corners, openings, etc.). The mesh refinement can
be specified around individual joints, lines and on the macroelements. Its radius should be
at least 2-3 multiple of the density assumed in the center of the refinement and both values
(density, radius) should be reasonable with respect to the refinement prescribed for the
neighboring regions. This assures a smooth transition between regions with different mesh
densities. Singular lines should be tackled in the same way.
Defining mesh refinement around a circular line
.ew mesh after refining the original mesh around a circular line
-621-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
/esh generator warning
In the "/esh generation result" dialog window the user is prompted for possible locations on
the structure that may cause problems during automatic mesh generation. When positioning
the cursor on individual warnings the corresponding critical region on a structure is highlighted
with a red color. The following items are checked:
- whether the distance between two points is greater than one tenth of the required
element edge length
- whether the distance between a point and a line is greater than one tenth of the element
edge length
- whether the area of a region is greater than twice the element edge length
- whether points and/or lines are found inside the structure (in the soil)
These warnings suggest locations, in which the mesh generator experience problems. The
following possibilities may occur:
- the mesh is not generated => this calls for a new input of geometrical data
- the mesh is generated => in this case it is up to the user to decide whether the mesh is
reasonable in any case, the warning can be further ignored and the analysis can be
carried out
%arning after identif#ing critical sections in F( mesh
-622-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Critical section after !ooming in $ two points are too close to each other
Joint supports
The frame "Joint supports" contains a table with the list of inputted joint supports. Adding
(editing) joint supports is performed in the ".ew 8oint supports" dialog window.
Joint supports can also be introduced using the mouse. This inputting mode is activated by
clicking an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "Joint supports". The following
modes are available:
- Add Clicking the left mouse button on the desktop introduces the joint location.
Adding (editing) joint support is performed in the ".ew 8oint supports"
dialog window.
- /odi"% Clicking the left mouse button on already existing joint support opens the
"/odi"% properties o" 8oint support" dialog window, which allows for
modifying its parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on the joint support opens the re'o&e
8oint support dialog window accepting this action removes the selected
joint support.
- Select Clicking the left mouse button on the joint support highlights the selected
joint support. The joint support is simultaneously marked in the table list.
The option allows for editing several joint supports at once (e.g. deleting).
The inputted joint supports can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
!he "ollowing t%pes o" 8oint supports are considered:
-623-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- free
- fixed
- spring
Frame "Point supports"
Dialog window ".ew 'oint supports"
#ine supports
The frame "#ine supports" contains a table with the list of inputted line supports. Adding
-624-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
(editing) line supports is performed in the ".ew supports o" lines" dialog window.
Line supports can also be introduced using the mouse. This inputting mode is activated by
clicking an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "#ine supports". The following modes
are available:
- Add Clicking the left mouse button on the desktop introduces the line support
location. Adding line support is performed in the ".ew supports o" lines"
dialog window.
- /odi"% Clicking the left mouse button on already existing line support opens the
"/odi"% properties o" support o" line" dialog window, which allows for
modifying its parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on the line support opens the re'o&e line
support dialog window accepting this action removes the selected line
support.
- Select Clicking the left mouse button on the line support highlights the selected
line support. The line support is simultaneously marked in the table list.
The option allows for editing several line supports at once (e.g. deleting).
The inputted line supports can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
!he "ollowing t%pes o" line supports are considered:
- free
- fixed
- spring
Frame "3ine supports"
-625-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ".ew supports of lines"
Bea's
The frame "Bea's" contains a table with the list of beams. Adding (editing) beams is
performed in the ".ew )ea's" dialog window.
The dialog widow serves to define the line number of the beam location and material and
cross-section of the beam. Choosing the type of material (concrete, steel, other) then allows
for assigning the material parameters either from the catalog of materials or manually using
editor of materials. The cross-section parameters (based on type of cross-section) can be
either calculated in the window "Calculation o" cross6sectional para'eters" or manually
inputted in the "Input o" cross6sectional para'eters" window.
Beams can also be introduced using the mouse. This inputting mode is activated by clicking an
appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "Bea's". The following modes are available:
- Add Clicking the left mouse button on the desktop introduces the beam
location. Adding beam is performed in the ".ew )ea's" dialog window.
- /odi"% Clicking the left mouse button on already existing beam opens the
"/odi"% properties o" )ea'" dialog window, which allows for modifying
its parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on the beam opens the re'o&e )ea'
dialog window accepting this action removes the selected beam.
- Select Clicking the left mouse button on the beam highlights the selected beam.
The beam is simultaneously marked in the table list. The option allows for
editing several beams at once (e.g. deleting).
The inputted beams can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
-626-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "@eams"
Dialog window ".ew beams"
Catalog o" 'aterials
The program contains a built-in catalog of materials for concrete, steel and other materials.
-627-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Only the type of material has to be specified in the dialog window. The type of cross-section is
selected from the "Calculation o" cross6sectional para'eters" dialog window or "Input o"
cross6sectional para'eters" dialog window.
Dialog window "Catalog of materials" - concrete
Dialog window "Catalog of materials" - steel
-628-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window "Catalog of materials" - other
3ditor o" 'aterials
Apart from using the "Catalog of materials" the program allows the user to enter the material
parameters for steel, concrete and other materials (dialog window "3ditor o" 'aterial 6
General") digitally. Only the type of material (material parameters) has to be specified in the
dialog window. The type of cross-section is selected from the "Calculation o" cross6sectional
para'eters" dialog window or "Input o" cross6sectional para'eters" dialog window.
Dialog window "(ditor of material - Concrete"
-629-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window "(ditor of material - Structural steel"
Dialog window "(ditor of material - )eneral"
!%pes o" cross6section
The program allows the user to either input the cross6section para'eters in "Calculation
o" cross6sectional para'eters" and "Input o" cross6sectional para'eters" dialog
windows. The cross-sectional characteristics are selected from the catalog of profiles, cross-
section editor dialog windows.
-630-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window "Calculation of cross-sectional parameters"
Dialog window "+nput of cross-sectional parameters"
Catalog o" pro"iles
In the case of steel cross-sections the program allows for choosing a particular cross-section
from the catalog of profiles. Only the type of cross-section has to be specified in the dialog
window. The type of material of the cross-section is selected from the "Catalog of materials",
or defined in the "Editor of materials".
-631-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window "Catalog of profiles"
Cross6section editor
In the case of steel and concrete cross-section the program allows for introducing the user
defined cross-section. Only the shape of cross-section has to be specified in the dialog window.
The cross-sectional characteristics are selected from the catalog of materials, editor of
materials dialog windows.
Dialog window "Cross-section editor - Structural steel< solid welded"
-632-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window "Cross-section editor - Structural steel< composite rolled"
Dialog window "Cross-section editor - Concrete< standard"
Internal hinges
The frame "Internal hinges" contains a table with the list of internal hinges. Adding (editing)
internal hinges is performed in the ".ew internal hinges" dialog window. The dialog widow
-633-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
serves to define the line number of the internal hinges location and type of internal hinge
(free, spring).
The internal hinge is a boundary condition that allows for the introduction of independent
rotation about the ; and ? axis between the two parts of the plate along a specified line while
keeping the vertical deflection along this line the same. The internal hinge can be prescribed
along an arbitrary line creating a boundary between two macroelements. The rotation can be
either free or controled by the spring torsional stiffness 2
.,P
.
Internal hinges can also be introduced using the mouse. This inputting mode is activated by
clicking an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "Internal hinges". The following
modes are available:
- Add Clicking the left mouse button on the desktop introduces the internal hinge
location. Adding internal hinge is performed in the ".ew internal hinge"
dialog window.
- /odi"% Clicking the left mouse button on already existing internal hinge opens the
"/odi"% properties o" internal hinge" dialog window, which allows for
modifying its parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on the internal hinge opens the re'o&e
internal hinges dialog window accepting this action removes the
selected internal hinge.
- Select Clicking the left mouse button on the internal hinge highlights the selected
internal hinge. The internal hinge is simultaneously marked in the table
list. The option allows for editing several internal hinges at once (e.g.
deleting).
The inputted internal hinges can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
-634-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "+nternal hinges"
Dialog window ".ew internal hinge"
/acroele'ent su)soils
The frame "/acroele'ent su)soils" contains a table with the list of inputted macroelement
subsoils. Adding (editing) line supports is performed in the ".ew 'acroele'ent su)soils"
dialog window.
The dialog window serves to define the macroelement number and parameters S
1
and S
2
. The
Winkler-Pasternak constantsS
1
and S
2
can specified either directly or calculated by the
program. The latter option further requires inputting deformation parameters of soils
(deformation modulus, Poissons number and depth of influence zone) in the "Co'pute S
1
and S
2
" dialog window. These parameters can be determined using the program "Spread
"ooting" (2. limit state) and introduced into the program.
Macroelement subsoils supports can also be introduced using the mouse. This inputting mode
is activated by clicking an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "/acroele'ent
su)soils". The following modes are available:
- Add Clicking the left mouse button on the desktop introduces the
macroelement subsoil location. Adding macroelement subsoil support is
performed in the ".ew 'acroele'ent su)soils" dialog window.
- /odi"% Clicking the left mouse button on already existing macroelement subsoil
opens the "/odi"% properties o" 'acroele'ent su)soil" dialog
window, which allows for modifying its parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on the macroelement subsoil opens the
re'o&e 'acroele'ent su)soil dialog window accepting this action
removes the selected macroelement subsoil.
- Select Clicking the left mouse button on the macroelement subsoil highlights the
selected macroelement subsoil. The macroelement subsoil is
simultaneously marked in the table list. The option allows for editing
several macroelement subsoil at once (e.g. deleting).
The inputted macroelement subsoils can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active
objects.
-635-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Macroelement subsoils"
Dialog window ".ew macroelement subsoils"
(inkler6Pasternak para'eters C1 a C2
!he (inkler 6 Pasternak 'odel "or the solution o" an elastic la%er introduces the
balance equation in the vertical direction as:
where: c
1
, c
2
-constants characterizing the Winkler Pasternak model
$ -displacement in the vertical direction
6
/
-vertical load acting on a layer
-636-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The elastic subsoil is introduced into the program using local stiffness matrices which are
added to the stiffness matrices of individual elements resting on the subsoil. The contact stress
K is provided as an output.
Calculation o" (inkler6Pasternak constants "ro'
de"or'ation para'eters o" soils
The Winkler Pasternak constants S
1
and S
2
are calculated in the program from the condition
of equal compliance matrices of infinitely stiff infinite strip footing resting on the Winkler
Pasternak and elastic subsoil. This condition is represented by the following equalities:
where: gSh -matrix of constants S
1
a S
2
> -half width of foundation
c
1$
, c
2$
-Winklers constants
e depth of deformation zone
#oad cases
The frame "#oad cases" contains a table with the list of inputted load cases. Adding (editing)
load cases and their parameters is performed in the ".ew load case" dialog window. Editing
can be carried out with the help of "/odi"%" button or by clicking the row with the required
load case in the list using the left mouse button.
-637-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "3oad cases"
Dialog window ".ew load case"
-638-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
#oad case para'eters
The following parameters are defined in the ".ew load case" dialog window:
#oad case identi"ier
The load case identifier, which is composed of the load case number and a uniliteral prefix, is
displayed in front of the field for entering the name of the load case. The prefix is determined
by the type of load case:
G - permanent loading
O - variable loading
A - accidental loading
The load case identifier is mainly used in printouts of combinations.
#oad case code
The load case code determines, what loading can be specified for this loading. The following
options are available.
Sel"6weight -In this load case the load represents the structure self-weight and it is
generated automatically by the program. Only one load case with this code can
be considered in each task.
Force -An arbitrary type of force loading (forces, moments) can be introduced into the
load case with this code. The number of LCs is not limited.
#oad t%pe
It determines the character of load cases based on their variability in time. Selecting a
particular type of load corresponds to classification according to EN 1990 standard, art. 4.1.1.
#oad coe""icients
It allows for specifying the load partial factor
6
. This coefficient accounts for unfavorable
deviations of values of loads from the representative ones. For permanent loading it is
necessary to introduce different values for favorable (
6, )F6
) and for unfavorable (
6, s9p
) load
action in a combination. If the load input follows EN 1990 the default values of coefficients are
taken from table A1.2(B).
Categor%
Classification of load cases into categories corresponds to the classification of load according to
table A1.1 of EN 1990 standard. Based on this the variable load cases are assigned
combination coefficients *
0
, *
1
a *
2
. The category of "User6de"ined input" allows for defining
the user self-values of these coefficients. Choosing a category is possible only for load cases
inputted according to EN 1990 (the "Material and standards" tab sheet serves to select the
particular standard).
Co')ination coe""icients
Basic values of coefficients to create combinations arise from EN 1990 standard and depend on
the load case category. When user input is assumed, it is possible to define the user self-values
of these coefficients. The following coefficients are used to create a combination:
f - Coe""icient o" reduction o" per'anent loads in alternati&e co')ination this
coefficient is assigned to all permanent loads and is used when compiling alternative
combinations for the bearing capacity limit state (combination to relation 6.10.b, EN
1990).
*
0
- Coe""icient o" co')ination &alue coefficient for variable loads, it is used when
-639-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
compiling combinations for both the bearing capacity and service limit states
*
1
- Coe""icient o" "reHuent &alue coefficient for variable loads, it is used when
compiling accidental combinations and combinations for the service limit state
*
2
Coe""icient o" Huasi6per'anent &alue 6 coefficient for variable loads, it is used
when compiling accidental combinations and combinations for the service limit state
The combination coefficients are available only for load cases inputted according to EN 1990
(the "Material and standards" tab sheet serves to select the particular standard).
Dialog window ".ew load case"
Joint loads
The frame "Joint loads" contains a table with the list of inputted joint loads. Each joint load is
assigned to a certain load case and inputted joint. Selection of the load is performed in the
"Acti&e load case" combo list. Adding (editing) joint loads is performed in the ".ew load o"
8oints" dialog window.
The program allows for specifying either mechanical (e.g. forces) or deformational (e.g.
prescribed displacements of supports) actions.
Joint loads can also be introduced using the mouse. This inputting mode is activated by clicking
an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "Joint loads". The following modes are
available:
- Add Clicking the left mouse button on the desktop introduces the joint location.
Adding joint load is performed in the ".ew load o" 8oints" dialog window.
- /odi"% Clicking the left mouse button on already existing joint load opens the
"/odi"% properties o" 8oint load" dialog window, which allows for
modifying its parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on the joint load opens the re'o&e 8oint
load dialog window accepting this action removes the selected joint
-640-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
load.
- Select Clicking the left mouse button on the joint load highlights the selected
joint load. The joint load is simultaneously marked in the table list. The
option allows for editing several joint loads at once (e.g. deleting).
The inputted joint loads can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
The program employs the following coordinate systems (sign convention).
Frame "Point loads"
#ine loads
The frame "#ine loads" contains a table with the list of inputted line loads. Each line load is
assigned to a certain load case and inputted lines. Selection of the load is performed in the
"Acti&e load case" combo list. Adding (editing) line loads is performed in the ".ew loads o"
lines" dialog window.
The program allows for specifying either mechanical (e.g. forces), deformational (e.g.
prescribed displacements of supports), or temperature actions.
Joint loads can also be introduced using the mouse. This inputting mode is activated by clicking
an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "#ine loads". The following modes are
available:
- Add Clicking the left mouse button on the desktop introduces the line location.
Adding line load is performed in the ".ew loads o" lines" dialog window.
- /odi"% Clicking the left mouse button on already existing line load opens the
"/odi"% properties o" load o" line" dialog window, which allows for
-641-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
modifying its parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on the line load opens the re'o&e line
load dialog window accepting this action removes the selected line load.
- Select Clicking the left mouse button on the line load highlights the selected line
load. The line load is simultaneously marked in the table list. The option
allows for editing several line loads at once (e.g. deleting).
The inputted line loads can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
The program employs the following coordinate systems (sign convention).
Frame "3ine loads"
-642-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ".ew loads of lines"
!e'perature load
Temperature load assumes a linear distribution of temperature throughout the plate thickness.
Such thermal gradient causes moments in the plate given by:
where: - - elastic modulus
J - Poissons number
h - plate thickness
G - coefficient of thermal expansion
bt - temperature difference
/acroele'ent loads
The frame "/acroele'ent loads" contains a table with the list of inputted macroelement
loads. Each macroelement load is assigned to a certain load case and inputted macroelement.
Selection of the load is performed in the "Acti&e load case" combo list. Adding (editing)
macroelement loads is performed in the ".ew 'acroele'ent loads" dialog window.
The program allows for specifying either mechanical (e.g. forces) or temperature actions.
Joint loads can also be introduced using the mouse. This inputting mode is activated by clicking
an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "/acroele'ent loads". The following modes
are available:
- Add Clicking the left mouse button on the desktop introduces the
macroelement location. Adding macroelement load is performed in the
".ew 'acroele'ent loads" dialog window.
- /odi"% Clicking the left mouse button on already existing macroelement load
-643-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
opens the "/odi"% properties o" 'acroele'ent load" dialog window,
which allows for modifying its parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on the macroelement load opens the
re'o&e 'acroele'ent load dialog window accepting this action
removes the selected macroelement load.
- Select Clicking the left mouse button on the macroelement load highlights the
selected macroelement load. The macroelement load is simultaneously
marked in the table list. The option allows for editing several
macroelement loads at once (e.g. deleting).
The inputted macroelement loads can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active
objects.
The program employs the following coordinate systems (sign convention).
Frame "Macroelement loads"
Free point loads
The frame "Free point loads" contains a table with the list of inputted free point loads. Each
free point load is assigned to a certain load case and can receive an arbitrary location on the
plate surface. Selection of the load is performed in the "Acti&e load case" combo list. Adding
(editing) free point loads is performed in the ".ew "ree point loads" dialog window.
Free point loads can also be introduced using the mouse. This inputting mode is activated by
clicking an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "Free point loads". The following
modes are available:
-644-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- Add Clicking the left mouse button on the desktop defines point specifying the
loaded. The load parameters are defined in the ".ew"ree point loads"
dialog window.
- /odi"% Clicking the left mouse button on already existing free point load opens
the "/odi"% properties o" "ree point load" dialog window, which allows
for modifying its parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on the free point load opens the re'o&e
point load dialog window accepting this action removes the selected
free point load.
- Select Clicking the left mouse button on the free point load highlights the
selected free point load. The free point load is simultaneously marked in
the table list. The option allows for editing several free point loads at once
(e.g. deleting).
The inputted free point load can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
The program employs the following coordinate systems (sign convention).
Frame "Free point loads"
Free line loads
The frame "Free line loads" contains a table with the list of inputted free line loads. Each free
line load is assigned to a certain load case and with using points it can receive an arbitrary
direction and location on the plate surface. Selection of the load is performed in the "Acti&e
load case" combo list. Adding (editing) free line loads is performed in the ".ew "ree line
loads" dialog window.
-645-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Free line loads can also be introduced using the mouse. This inputting mode is activated by
clicking an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "Free line loads". The following
modes are available:
- Add Clicking the left mouse button on the desktop defines points specifying the
loaded line. The load parameters are defined in the ".ew"ree line loads"
dialog window.
- /odi"% Clicking the left mouse button on already existing free line load opens the
"/odi"% properties o" "ree line load" dialog window, which allows for
modifying its parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on the free line load opens the re'o&e line
load dialog window accepting this action removes the selected free line
load.
- Select Clicking the left mouse button on the free line load highlights the selected
free line load. The free line load is simultaneously marked in the table list.
The option allows for editing several free line loads at once (e.g. deleting).
The inputted free line load can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
The program employs the following coordinate systems (sign convention).
Frame "Free line loads"
Free area loads
The frame "Free area loads" contains a table with the list of inputted free area loads. Each
free area load is assigned to a certain load case and with using points it can receive an
-646-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
arbitrary shape and location on the plate surface. Selection of the load is performed in the
"Acti&e load case" combo list. Adding (editing) free area loads is performed in the ".ew "ree
sur"ace loads" dialog window.
Free area load can also be introduced using the mouse. This inputting mode is activated by
clicking an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "Free sur"ace loads". The following
modes are available:
- Add Clicking the left mouse button on the desktop defines points specifying the
loaded region. The load parameters are defined in the ".ew"ree sur"ace
loads" dialog window.
- /odi"% Clicking the left mouse button on already existing free area load opens the
"/odi"% properties o" "ree sur"ace load" dialog window, which allows
for modifying its parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on the free area load opens the re'o&e
"ree area load dialog window accepting this action removes the
selected free area load.
- Select Clicking the left mouse button on the free area load highlights the selected
free area load. The free area load is simultaneously marked in the table
list. The option allows for editing several free area loads at once (e.g.
deleting).
The inputted free area load can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
The program employs the following coordinate systems (sign convention).
Frame "Free area loads"
-647-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ".ew free surface loads"
Co')ination U#S
The frame "Co')inations U#S" contains a table with the list of inputted combinations of the
bearing capacity limit state. Adding (editing) combinations and their parameters is performed
in the ".ew co')ination o" load cases" dialog window. Editing can be carried out with the
help of "/odi"%" button or by clicking the row with the required combination in the list using
the left mouse button.
The built-in generator of combinations of load cases can be used to create individual
combinations.
-648-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Combination B3S"
Para'eters o" co')inations o" U#S
The following parameters are specified in the ".ew co')ination o" load cases" dialog
window:
.ew co')ination
A brief description of combination is displayed in front of the field where the combination is
defined. All considered load cases are tagged using their identifiers. The major variable loads
are moved at the beginning of the list and separated from the remaining LCs by colon.
!%pe o" co')ination @"or co')inations )ased on 3. 1DDF onl%A
The following combinations can be created for the bearing capacity limit state:
Basic -Basic combination based on expression 6.10 of EN 1990 standard
Alternati&e -Combinations based on expressions 6.10a and 1.10b of EN 1990 standard. In
this case, two variants of combination are used in the analysis, one with
reduced permanent LCs and the other with reduced major variable LC.
Accidental -Accidental combination based on 6.11 of EN 1990 standard.
Selection o" load cases
The table listing individual load cases allows for their selection to create a combination. The
load case can be introduced into a combination by checking the field in the column "Consider"
for a particular LC. Further setting in the table depends on the selection of way of inputting
loads in the "Material and standards" tab sheet.
#oading according to 3. 1DDF
A second field is available for each load case in the column "Consider". This field allows for
assigning a favorable effect of action to permanent LCs (adopting coefficient
6, )F6
) or for
specifying a variable loading as the major one, respectively. The number of major variable
loads in the combination is not limited. An accidental load can be introduced into combinations
tagged as "Accidental" (only LCs tagged as "Accidental" are available for the selection). For
accidental combinations it is also necessary to choose, whether a major variable load should be
reduced by the coefficient *
1
or *
2
.
General loading
A coefficient of usability can be specified for each load case to adjust the degree of usability of
the load case in the combination.
-649-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ".ew combination of load cases"
Generator o" co')inations o" U#S
The "Generator o" co')inations + 1st order" dialog window allows for a collective
compilation of combinations of load cases based on the introduced combination rules. Referring
to standard EN 1990 the number of generated combinations can be relatively large and in
extreme cases could considerably slow down calculations. Owing to this, information about
expected number of combinations to be generated is displayed in the right bottom corner.
Therefore, before launching generation the user may check, how many combinations will be
generated and possibly adjust generator conditions. The top part of the window serves to
define conditions for generating combinations; the bottom part contains various generator
settings.
Dialog window ")enerator of combinations - 5st order"
/utuall% interacting load states and groups
This part makes it possible to merge those load states that should appear in combinations
-650-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
always together. Permanent and variable loads cannot be merged into one group. If the field
All per'anent loads alwa%s in co')ination is checked in the Generator parameters, the
creation of groups of permanent loads has no effect on their appearance in combinations as
each generated combination will always contain all permanent LCs. In such case, merging
permanent LCs will only influence consideration of favorable/unfavorable effects of LCs
providing the field Per'anent loads act onl% un"a&ora)l% is not checked.
Dialog window ")enerator of combinations" $ Mutuall# interacting load states
3cluded interaction o" load states
This part makes it possible to define, which LCs should not appear in a combination together.
Arbitrary load cases or merged groups can be mutually excluded in dependent of the type of
load case. Two options are available to define groups to be excluded:
/utual
eclusion
-An arbitrary number of load cases can be introduced into one group. In such a
case, the program will not generate any combination that contains at least two
load cases from this group.
3clusion)%
pairs
-Providing it is necessary to create a larger number of excluding groups of two
sorts, where one LC is the same (e.g. exclusion of assembly variants of
permanent loads with all service load cases), it is possible to adopt this option.
A load case to be excluded is first selected in the first column. The second
column is then used to select an arbitrary number of LCs, which are needed to
create excluding groups.
Dialog window ")enerator of combinations" $ (&cluded interaction of load states
#oad cases and groups acting as the 'ain &aria)le load
This part is available only when inputting loads according to EN 1990 is considered (the
standard is selected in the "Material and standards" tab sheet). When automatic regime is
assumed then each variable load is taken as major in created combinations. If this regime is
-651-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
turned off, it is possible to manually adjust the list of major variable loads. For example, it is
possible to remove an arbitrary load case from the list so that it will not be considered as
major variable in combinations. If a new item with more load cases is add to the list then all
load cases will be considered as major variable in those combinations, where they appear
together.
Dialog window ")enerator of combinations" $ 3oad cases and groups acting as the main
ariable load
Generator para'eters @para'eters that can )e set in the )otto' part o" the dialog
windowA
Co')o list "Original co')inations"
,etain original
co')inations
- By pressing the "Generate" button the program will add new
combinations, created according to the specified rules, to the
original ones
,e'o&e allco')inations - By pressing the "Generate" button the program will delete all
original combinations and will replace them by the new ones
,e'o&e generated
co')inations
- By pressing the "Generate" button the program will delete older
combinations and will add new ones created according to the
specified rules
,e'o&e all
co')inations o" the
current t%pe
- By pressing the "Generate" button the program will delete all
combinations of a given type and will replace them by the new
ones
,e'o&e generated
co')inations o" the
current t%pe
- By pressing the "Generate" button the program will delete older
combinations of a given type and will add new ones created
according to the specified rules
Co')o list "Generate co')inations"
The following types of generated combinations can be chosen for loads based on EN 1990:
Basic - Generates basic combinations for the bearing capacity limit state
based on expression 6.10 of EN 1990 standard
Alternati&e - Generates combinations for the bearing capacity limit state based
on expressions 6.10a and 1.10b of EN 1990 standard. This
variant generates two times more combinations but it provides
better results.
Accidental - Generates accidental combinations for the bearing capacity limit
state based on 6.11 of EN 1990 standard. An accidental load case
to appear in accidental combinations can be specified. It is also
-652-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
necessary to choose, whether a major variable load will be
reduced by the coefficient *
1
or *
2
.
Per'anent loads act onl% un"a&ora)l%
If this setting is not checked, the program creates all possible combinations, where
introduction of all variants of favorable and unfavorable actions of permanent loads will be
considered.
All per'anent loads alwa%s in co')ination
If this setting is not checked, the program creates combinations in such a way that a
successive introduction of all LCs into a combination will be considered.
Co')ination S#S
The frame "Co')inations S#S" contains a table with the list of inputted combinations of the
service limit state. Adding (editing) combinations and their parameters is performed in the
".ew co')ination o" load cases" dialog window. Editing can be carried out with the help of
"/odi"%" button or by clicking the row with the required combination in the list using the left
mouse button.
The built-in generator of combinations of load cases can be used to compile individual
combinations.
Frame "Combination S3S"
-653-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Para'eters o" co')inations o" S#S
Combinations SLS serve to evaluate states that refer to the structure appearance, comfort of
people or to functioning of a structure while in ordinary use. Typically, only deformations,
vibrations, etc. are checked. The ".ew co')ination o" load cases" dialog window (similarly
to combinations for ULS) serves to define the following parameters:
!%pe o" co')ination according to 3. 1DDF
The following combinations can be created for the service limit state:
Characteristic - combination based on expression 6.14 of EN 1990 standard
FreHuent - combination based on expression 6.15 of EN 1990 standard
Ouasi6per'anent - combination based on expression 6.16 of EN 1990 standard
Selection o" load cases
The table listing individual load cases allows for their selection to create a combination. The
load case can be introduced into a combination by checking the field in the column "Consider"
for a particular LC. A coefficient of usability can be specified for generally inputted
combinations (select in the "Material and standards" tab sheet) to adjust the degree of
usability of the load case in the combination.
Dialog window "Combination of load cases"
Generator o" co')inations o" S#S
The "Generator o" co')inations + 1st order" dialog window allows for a collective
compilation of combinations of load cases for the service limit state. Functions of generator of
combinations are explained in section devoted to the generator of combinations for the bearing
capacity limit state.
If inputting loads according to EN 1990 is set in the "Material and standards" tab sheet, it is
possible to generate the following combinations for the service limit state:
Characteristic - combination based on expression 6.14 of EN 1990 standard
FreHuent - combination based on expression 6.15 of EN 1990 standard
Ouasi6per'anent - combination based on expression 6.16 of EN 1990 standard
-654-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
$i'ensioning para'eters
The frame "$i'ensioning para'eters" serves to define data for dimensioning longitudinal
and shear rein"orce'ent. The co')ination nu')er (or all combinations) of a combination
to be analyzed must be specified. The material of longitudinal reinforcements is selected either
from "Catalog o" 'aterials", or can be introduced manually in the "3ditor o" 'aterials".
Shear reinforcement is specified in terms of crooks, or stirrups (crooks require to define their
angle).
When running the dimensioning analysis the program generates values of the following
quantities. The analysis is carried out according to the standard set in the "Material and
standards" tab sheet.
Frame "Dimensioning parameters"
/acroele'ent di'ensionings
The frame "/acroele'ent di'ensioning" contains a table with the inputted macroelements.
Editing reinforcement properties (rein"orce'ent direction and distance o" centroid o" top
and )otto' rein"orce'ent "ro' the plate edge can be modified) is performed in the
"/odi"% properties o" 'acroele'ent di'ensioning"dialog window.
When running the dimensioning analysis the program generates values of the following
quantities. The analysis is carried out according to the standard set in the "Material and
standards" tab sheet.
Macroelement dimensioning can also be modify using the mouse. This inputting mode is
activated by clicking an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "$i'ensioning o"
'acroele'ents". The following modes are available:
-655-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- /odi"% Clicking the left mouse button on already existing solitary point load opens
the "/odi"% properties o" di'ensioning o" 'acroele'ent" dialog
window, which allows for modifying its parameters.
- Select Clicking the left mouse button on the macroelement dimensioning
highlights the selected macroelement dimensioning. The macroelement
dimensioning is simultaneously marked in the table list. The option allows
for editing several macroelement dimensionings at once (e.g. deleting).
The macroelement dimensioning can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active
objects.
Frame "Macroelement dimensionings"
Anal%sis
The analysis results are displayed in the frame "Anal%sis". The "Anal%sis" is carried out using
the finite element method. The dimensioning analysis is performed according to the standard
set in the "Material and standards" tab sheet.
The analysis can be stopped any time by pressing the :Interrupt: button.
Upon completing the analysis the program immediately displays the results and information
about the solution process. This information (with possible listing of errors) is shown in window
in the bottom part of the frame. The principal output tool is the visualization of results on the
screen. The tool bar in the top part of the screen serves to manage the graphical
representation of output quantities.
The color rangeand the bottom for its setting are found in the top part of the desktop.
-656-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The program employs the following coordinate systems (sign convention).
The way the results appear on the screen can be set in the "Visualization style settings"dialog
window.
Frame ",nal#sis" - screen after completing anal#sis
Procedure o" anal%sis
The solution procedure is split into several steps including localization of the global stiffness
matrix while taking into account the support conditions (fixed or spring supports at joint or
along lines, elastic subsoil), setting up the load vector and analysis of the system of equations
using the Gaussian method with the Cholesky decompositions of the global stiffness matrix,
which in this case is symmetric and band. The values of primary variables $
/
,
;
a
?
calculated at mesh nodes are then used to determine the internal forces m
;
, m
?
, m
;?
, 0
;
and 0
?
together with the derived quantities m
1
, m
2
and the values of reactions developed in supports.
2D-elements
The quality of results of the plate problem derived using the finite element method is strongly
influenced by the type of plate element. The present formulation exploits a deformation variant
of the finite element method to derive triangular and quadrilateral elements denoted as DKMT
and DKMQ (Discrete Kirchhoff-Mindlin Triangle a Quadrilateral).
Formulation of the plate element implemented in the program is based on the discrete
Kirchhoff theory of bending of thin plates, which can be considered as a special case of the
Mindlin plate theory developed upon the following assumptions:
- compression of plate in the /-direction is negligible compare to the vertical displacement
%
/
-657-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- normals to the mid-plane of the plate remain straight after deformation but not
necessarily normal to the deformed mid-plane of the plate
- normal stress
/
is negligible compare to stresses
;
,
?
DKMT and DKMQ elements have 9 and 12 degrees of freedom, respectively three
independent displacements at each node:
%
/

- deflection in the direction of /-axis

;

- rotation about ;-axis

?

- rotation about ?-axis
The elements satisfy the following criteria:
- the stiffness matrix has correct rank (no zero energy states are generated)
- fulfill the patch test
- are suitable for the analysis of both this and thick plates
- they show good convergence properties
- not computationally expensive
In case of well generated mesh the quadrilateral elements are preferable as show better
behavior compare to triangular elements.
1$6ele'ents
The plate can be reinforced by beams formulated on the basis of one dimensional beam
element with embedded torsion and is compatible with plate elements (details can be found in
literature). The primary variables are %
/
,
;
and
?
and corresponding internal forces are !
1
,
!
2
and \
"
(twisting and bending moments and shear force). The beam is characterized by the
moment of inertia 1
t
a 1
2
(torsion, bending), area + and shear area +
s
. These parameters can be
calculated by the program based on the type of cross-section. The analysis constructs @;@ local
stiffness matrices subsequently localized in to the global stiffness matrix of the structure.
3iterature4
+: Matili< , new discrete Mirchhoff-Mindlin element based on Mindlin-6eissner plate theor# and
assumed shear strain fields $ part +4 ,n e&tended DMT element for thic9-plate bending
anal#sis< +nt: P: .umer: Meth: (ngng:< "ol: 3H< 5I->$5II3 75>>38
+: Matili< , new discrete Mirchhoff-Mindlin element based on Mindlin-6eissner plate theor# and
assumed shear strain fields $ part ++4 ,n e&tended DMX element for thic9-plate bending
anal#sis< +nt: P: .umer: Meth: (ngng:< "ol: 3H< 5II-$5>1I 75>>38
D: @ittnar< P: Je'noha< .umeric9Y metod# mechani9#< T"BT< Praha< 5>>0
,esults
Visualization and interpretation of results is one of the most important parts of the program.
Based on the tool bar setting the program displays variables (deflection, moments, rotation)
for an arbitrary load case or LC combination, or if needed variables for dimensioning (values of
necessary reinforcement areas calculated according to the standard selected in the "Material
and standards" tab sheet).
-658-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Calculation of values in user-defined points, or on lines, can be set in frames "Values" or
"Distributions", respectively.
The program provides several basic types of graphical output defined in the "Plate results
visualization settings" dialog window.
- plotting structure
- surface plot of quantities
- plotting finite element mesh
- plotting grid-plotting distributions (diagrams)
- plotting values on surface
- plotting directions of moments and reactions
The tool bar "Results" in the upper part of the screen serves to selected variables to be
displayed and the way they should appear on the screen. The color range is shown in the right
part of the desktop. Its particular setting can be adjusted using the "Color range" tool bar.
Because properly setting outputs might be often time consuming, the program disposes of a
comfortable system of selecting and storing view settings.
All outputs and selected results can be further printed out from the analysis protocol.
!ool )ar + ,esults
The tool bar contains the following operating elements:
Tool bar "Setting isuali!ation of graphical outputs"
Individual elements operate as follows:

Plotting st%le
setting
- opens the "Plate - results visualization
settings" dialog window which allows
the user to be more specific in defining
the plotting style

#ist o" plots - a combo list containing names of plots
saved by the user

Sa&e plot - saves the current plot displayed on the
desktop, the dialog window serves to
enter the name of the plot

/anager o"
plots
- opens the "/anager o" plots" dialog
window which serves to manage
(delete, change order, rename) already
saved plots

,esults (loads,
load cases,
combination,
dimensioning)
- displays the selected load cases,
combination (ULS, SLS), envelopes
(ULS, SLS) or dimensioning

!%pe o" &aria)le - displays the selected variable or
variable of dimensioning

Sur"ace plot - turns on/off plotting of isolines,
isosurfaces
-659-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013

/esh - turns on/off the style of plotting the FE
mesh (only edges, or according to the
setting in the "Plate results
visualization settings" dialog window

Plotting o"
topolog%
- plotting of topology of construction
The tool bar contains the 'ost o"ten used operating ele'ents needed to view the results
on the desktop. Detailed setting of the style of plotting the results is available in the "Plate
results visualization settings" dialog window.
Similar to our other programs the results can be saved and printed. The plotting style can be
adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
,esults &isuali-ation settings
The "Plate + results &isuali-ation settings " dialog window serves to specify the values to
be plotted and the way of their visualization. Individual settings can be later sa&ed using the
tool bar "Results".
The item "Basic" serves to set the basic parameters for plotting the results, quantities and
mesh information additional items can be then used to define visualization of other outputs.
Dialog window "Plate - results isuali!ation settings"
#ist o" &aria)les
#ist o" Huantities displa%ed )% the progra' "or indi&idual load cases1 co')inations o"
load cases @U#S1 S#SA or en&elopes @U#S1 S#SA
5aria)le Unit $escription
Deflection %
/
[mm] Displacement in the Z-direction
Rotation
;
[mra,] Rotation about X-axis
Rotation
?
[mra,] Rotation about Y-axis
Moment m
;
[k3mHm] Value of the moment about X-axis
Moment m
?
[k3mHm] Value of the moment about Y-axis
-660-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Moment m
;?
[k3mHm] Value of moment
Shear force \
;
[k3Hm] Value of the shear force in the X-direction
Shear force \
?
[k3Hm] Value of the shear force in the Y-direction
Moment m
1
[k3mHm] Value of the principal (extreme) moment
Moment m
2
[k3mHm] Value of the principal (extreme) moment
Shear force
\
ma;
[k3Hm] Value of the shear force (extreme)
Contact stress
[k3Hm
2
]
Value of the contact stress
#ist o" &aria)les o" di'ensioning
To perform dimensioning analysis it is first necessary to choose the option "Carr% out
di'ensioning" in the frame "Dimensioning parameters". Visualization of values for
dimensioning can be set in the tool bar "Results". Notation of variables (particularly indexes of
variables) changes according to the standards used for dimensioning of concrete and steel
structures set in the "Material and standards" tab sheet.
#ist o" Huantities displa%ed )% the progra' "or di'ensioning
5aria)le Unit $escription
Moment !
,)m1, m)F
[k3mHm] Minimal dimensioning moment in direction of reinforcement
1
Moment !
,)m1, ma;
[k3mHm] Maximal dimensioning moment in direction of reinforcement
1
Moment !
,)m2, m)F
[k3mHm] Minimal dimensioning moment in direction of reinforcement
2
Moment !
,)m2, ma;
[k3mHm] Maximal dimensioning moment in direction of reinforcement
2
Reinforcement area
+
91
[mm
2
Hm]
Area of upper reinforcement in direction 1
Reinforcement area
+
>1
[mm
2
Hm]
Area of bottom reinforcement in direction 1
Reinforcement area
+
92
[mm
2
Hm]
Area of upper reinforcement in direction 2
Reinforcement area
+
>2
[mm
2
Hm]
Area of bottom reinforcement in direction 2
Ratio of
reinforcement ^
h1
[%] Reinforcement ratio of upper reinforcement in direction 1
-661-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Ratio of
reinforcement ^
,1
[%] Reinforcement ratio of bottom reinforcement in direction 1
Ratio of
reinforcement ^
h2
[%] Reinforcement ratio of upper reinforcement in direction 2
Ratio of
reinforcement ^
,2
[%] Reinforcement ratio of bottom reinforcement in direction 2
Shear force \
-,
[k3Hm] Dimensioning shear force
Reinforcement area
+
>,F9t
[mm
2
Hm
2
]
Requested area of shear reinforcement
Shear force \
R,, c
[k3Hm] Shear strength of cross-section without shear reinforcement
Shear force \
R,, ma;
[k3Hm] Maximal allowable shear force
5alues
The frame "5alues" allows for defining points (or joints) arbitrarily placed on the plate surface.
For these points (joints) it is possible to display variables (deflections, moments, rotations) for
an arbitrary load case or LC combination, or if needed variables for dimensioning (values of
necessary reinforcement areas calculated according to the standard selected in the "Material
and standards" tab sheet).
The frame contains a table with the list of inputted points (joints). Adding (editing) is
performed in the ".ew &alues" dialog window. The window serves to specify the type of input
(point, joint), coordinates and for what load case, combination, or dimensioning the resulting
quantities should be displayed. The value in the supported joint corresponds to the reaction
force at this support.
In the dimensioning analysis some quantities can be denoted by symbol P?Q. In such a case
the necessary reinforcement area and minimal degree of reinforcement is required. If the point
is found on the boundary of two macroelements, the program displays two sets of values for
dimensioning.
Values (points) can also be introduced using the mouse. This inputting mode is activated by
clicking an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "5alues". The following modes are
available:
- Add Clicking the left mouse button on the desktop introduces the point location
(value).
- /odi"% Clicking the left mouse button on already existing point (value) opens the
"/odi"% properties o" &alue" dialog window, which allows for modifying
its parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on the point (value) opens the re'o&e
point dialog window accepting this action removes the selected point
(value).
- Select Clicking the left mouse button on the point (value) highlights the selected
point (value). The point (value) is simultaneously marked in the table list.
The option allows for editing several points (values) at once (e.g.
deleting).
-662-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The inputted points (values) can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
Frame ""alues"
$istri)utions
The frame "$istri)utions" serves to define general lines or lines located on the plate surface.
For these segments (lines) it is possible to display variables (deflections, moments, rotations,
etc.) for an arbitrary load case or LC combination, or if needed variables for dimensioning
(values of necessary reinforcement areas calculated according to the standard selected in the
"Material and standards" tab sheet).
The frame contains a table with the list of inputted segments (lines). Adding (editing) is
performed in the ".ew distri)utions" dialog window. The window serves to specify the type
of input (segment, line), coordinates of the first and the last point, load case, combination,
dimensioning and quantity.
The frame displays:
- general distri)utions general distributions (diagrams) on an arbitrary segment (line)
- distri)utions on
)ea's
if a )ea' is assigned to the line it is possible to display
distributions (diagrams) of other quantities (shear force \
"
,
bending moment !
2
, twisting moment !
1
)
- distri)utions on
supported line
if the line is supported it is possible to display distributions
(diagrams) of other quantities (vertical reaction r
/
, moment
reaction r
m, t
).
Distributions can also be introduced using the mouse. This inputting mode is activated by
clicking an appropriate button on the horizontal tool bar "$istri)utions". The following modes
-663-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
are available:
- Add Clicking the left mouse button on the joint introduces the distribution
location.
- /odi"% Clicking the left mouse button on already existing distribution opens the
"/odi"% properties o" distri)ution" dialog window, which allows for
modifying its parameters.
- ,e'o&e Clicking the left mouse button on the distribution opens the re'o&e
distri)ution dialog window accepting this action removes the selected
distribution.
- Select Clicking the left mouse button on the distribution highlights the selected
distribution. The distribution is simultaneously marked in the table list. The
option allows for editing several distributions at once (e.g. deleting).
The inputted distributions can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
Frame "Distributions"
Coordinate s%ste' @sign con&entionA
Internal "orces
Internal forces are defined as:
-664-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The positive direction of internal forces is evident from the following figure:
The principal moments and directions of principal axes are provided by:
The meaning of individual variables is the following: internal forces can be transformed from
the (;, ?) coordinate system to the (;i, ?i) coordinate system by rotating the (;, ?) plane
-665-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
through a certain angle about the /-axis. The angle G, in particular, corresponds to a rotation
angle for which the transformed m
;i?i
moment attains a zero value whereas the m
;i
and m
?i
moments attain their maximum and minimum values m
1
and m
2
, respectively.
The maximum shear force is obtained similarly:
and the angle between 0
ma;
and the ;-axis:
#oading
The sign convention of the applied force and moment loading is evident from the following
figure:
It is worth to point out a different sign convention applied to the load moment ! (at a point or
along a line) and to internal moment m. While the !
;
moment rotates about the ;-axis (as
usual for beams), the internal moment rotating about the ;-axis is denoted as m
?
.
Progra' /S3 (all
Pro8ect
The "Pro8ect" frame is used to input the basic project data and to specify the overall setting of
the analysis run. The frame contains an input form to introduce the basic data about the
analyzed task, i.e. project information, project description, date, etc. This information is
further used in text and graphical outputs.
-666-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The frame also allows the user to switch analysis units (metric / imperial).
Frame "Pro'ect"
Settings
The frame "Settings" serves to introduce the basic "Settings" of the program such as
standards and theories of analyses, the way of proving safety of a structure and individual
coefficients of the analysis.
The programs contain not only the pre-defined )asic Settings for individual countries, but
also allow the user to create their own user6de"ined Settings, which can be subsequently
used in all GEO5 programs.
The "Select" button enables to choose an already created Setting from the "Settings list".
The "Settings Ad'inistrator" button opens the "Administrator" dialogue window, which
allows for viewing and modifying individual Setting. One may also identify the visible settings
in the Settings list. Data in the Settings administrator can be also eported and i'ported.
The "Add to the ad'inistrator" button allows for creating user-defined Settings, which are
subsequently added to the Settings administrator.
The "/odi"%" button enables a quick visualization and editing of the current Setting in the
opened program. Modifying any of the parameters changes the title to "Inputted "or the
current task". Individual analyses are then performed with this local setting. Should we
consider this setting as suitable also for other tasks, we add the setting into the "Settings
ad'inistrator" by pressing the "Add to the ad'inistrator" button.
The "Inputted "or the current task" setting is usually created when importing older data.
Settings of analysis parameters are performed in the "Materials and standards", "Wall analysis"
and "Stability analysis" tab sheets.
-667-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Settings"
Geo'etr%
The "Geo'etr%" frame allows by pressing the button for selecting the wall shape.
The shape of a wall can be edited either in the frame by inserting values into input fields, or on
the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
The first type of geometry (wall) enables to define "oundation, for other types
(embankments) the program allows for inputting the co&er. The selected type of geometry
influences other frames and their inputting modes (water, surcharge, reinforcement). The
following verification options are available for individual types of geometries:
Geo'etr% t%pe 5eri"ication
1 Wall with the option to define
foundation
Verification, dimensioning, bearing capacity, internal
stability, reinforcement bearing capacity, global
stability, slope stability
2 One-sided slope Verification, bearing capacity, internal stability, global
stability, slope stability
3 Two-sided slope Global stability, slope stability
4 One-sided zoned by benches Verification, bearing capacity, internal stability, global
stability, slope stability
5 Two-sided zoned by benches Global stability, slope stability
The program makes it possible to export the geometry of a structure in the *.DXF format.
-668-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ")eometr#"
/aterial
The "/aterial" frame serves to choose parameters of the material adopted for blocks or cover.
Defining materials depends on the selected type of "Geometry". The first type of geometry
requires inputting the bulk weight of blocks, cohesion and friction.
The other types of geometry enable to consider a cover, which requires inputting the bulk
weight and shear strength.
-669-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Material"
!%pes o" rein"orce'ents
The "!%pes o" rein"orce'ents" frame contains a table with the list of inputted geo-
reinforcements and their parameters (long-term bearing capacity of reinforcements and
coefficients of interaction). Adding (editing) reinforcement is carried in the "New type of
reinforcement (Edit type of reinforcement)" dialogue window.
-670-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "T#pes of reinforcements"
Adding and editing t%pe o" rein"orce'ent
The ".ew t%pe rein"orce'ent @3dit t%pe o" rein"orce'ent1 Inserted t%pe o"
rein"orce'entA" dialogue window contains the following items:
!%pe o" rein"orce'ent - a combo list contains individual types of reinforcements from a
database, or its allows for inputting the "user6de"ined" type of
reinforcement
Short6ter'
characteristic
strength
- the strength value can be changed only for reinforcements stored
with the help of "User's catalogue"
Anal%sis o" long6ter'
strength
- a combo list enables to choose the way of analysis of long-term
strength: "input reduction "actors" (direct input of factors),
"calculate reduction "actors" (factors are determined based on
the selected lifetime of a reinforcement, soil Ph and grain size) or
"input strength" (already reduced long-term strength is
inputted)
,eduction "actors - the values of factors reducing a short-term tensile strength can
be inputted directly or calculated based on the selected options in
combo lists (lifetime, chemistry, grain size)
O&erall coe""icient o"
'odel uncertaint%
- the value of factor to reduce a short-tem strength is inputted
#ong6ter' design - calculated value of s long-term tensile strength
-671-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
strength
Slip resistance - the "Coe""icient o" direct slip along rein"orce'ent" can be
inputted directly or calculated based on the type of soil
Pull out resistance - the "Coe""icient o" interaction o" soil and geo6
rein"orce'ent" can be inputted directly or calculated based on
the type of soil
The "User's catalogue" button in the bottom part of the window opens the "User's catalogue"
dialogue window.
Dialogue window ".ew t#pe of reinforcement"
User's catalogue
The user catalogue allows the user to define and store own types of reinforcements and their
material characteristics. At first use of the catalogue (has not been yet created) the program
prompts a warning message that no catalogue was found. Then, pressing the button "O7"
opens the "Sa&e as" dialogue window that allows for entering the catalogue name and saving
it into a specified location by pressing the "Sa&e" button (by default a folder used for saving
the project data is assumed).
The program allows the user to create more than one catalogue. The next catalogue is created
-672-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
by pressing the ".ew" button the program asks, whether the current catalogue should be
replaced (the currentl% loaded catalogue is not $3#3!3$G) and saves the new catalogue
under a new name. The "Open" button allows for loading an arbitrary user catalogue and by
pressing the "Sa&e as" button for saving it under a different name.
Dialog window at first use - user catalog of t#pes of reinforcements
The "User catalogue" dialogue window contains a table listing the user defined
reinforcements. The "Add" button opens the "New type of reinforcement" dialogue window
that allows for specifying and subsequent saving of characteristics of a new reinforcement into
the catalogue. Buttons "3dit" and ",e'o&e" serve to edit individual items in the table.
The "Adopt" button accepts the current reinforcement characteristics specified in the "New
type of reinforcement" dialogue window and opens the ".ew t%pe o" rein"orce'ent"
dialogue window that allows for their modification and saving.
Dialogue window "BserZs catalogue"
,ein"orce'ent
The ",ein"orce'ent" frame contains a table with the list of inputted geo-reinforcements and
their geometries.
-673-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "6einforcement"
The "Generate" button opens the "Generate" dialogue window that enables to set automatic
parameters of generating group of reinforcements. Geo-reinforcements can be positioned only
in joints between the blocks (checking the option "Appl% rein"orce'ent"). Next step is to
define the type of reinforcement, the initial and the last block, the number of blocks to reenter
the reinforcement, reinforcement geometry (the same length of reinforcements or the same
type of reinforcement finishing). The inputted reinforcements can also be edited on the
desktop with the help active dimensions or active objects, respectively.
The "3dit" button opens the "3dit )lock" dialogue window that enables to change the type of
reinforcement, its geometry or to specify whether the reinforcement between the blocks is to
be considered. The ",e'o&e" button removes all geo-reinforcements.
-674-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialogue window ")enerate"
,ein"orce'ent
The ",ein"orce'ent" frame contains a table with the list of inputted groups of reinforcements
and their geometries.
Frame "6einforcement"
Adding (editing) groups of geo-reinforcements is performed in the ".ew @editA
-675-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
rein"orce'ent" dialogue window. The inputted reinforcements can also be edited on the
desktop with the help active dimensions or active objects, respectively. Each inputted group of
reinforcements requires inputting in the dialogue window the number of reinforcements and
type, height of the first reinforcement, reinforcement spacing and their geometry.
The program allows for inserting (insert) another group of reinforcements in between the
already inputted groups. Inserting a new group is performed in the "Inserted
rein"orce'ent" dialogue window that is identical with the ".ew rein"orce'ent" dialogue
window. The newly introduced (inserted) block is put below the currently selected block of a
structure. The ",e'o&e" button deletes a group of reinforcements.
Dialogue window "(dit reinforcement"
Pro"ile
The "Pro"ile" frame contains a table with a list of inputted interfaces. After specifying
interfaces it is possible to edit thicknesses of individual layers with the help of active
dimensions.
Adding (editing) layer is performed in the "Add @editA inter"ace" dialog window. The /-
coordinate measured from the top point of a structure is specified (/-axis).
The program allows for raising or lowering the top point of a structure in the "Change o"
terrain ele&ation" dialog window so that the whole interface can be translated while keeping
the thicknesses of individual layers. This function is important when copying the profile from
program "!errain".
The program makes it possible to import a profile in the gINT format.
-676-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Profile"
Soils
The "Soils" frame contains a table with a list of inputted soils. The table also provides
information about currently selected soil displayed in the right part of the frame.
Adding (editing) a soil is performed in the "Add (edit) soil" dialog window.
The soil characteristics needed in the program are further specified in the following chapters:
"Basic data" and "Uplift pressure".
The program makes it possible to import soils in the gINT format.
-677-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Soils"
Basic data
This part of the window serves to introduce basic parameters of soils unit weight1 angle o"
internal "riction and cohesion. The particular values are obtained from geotechnical survey
or from laboratory experiments. If these data are not available, it is possible to exploit built-in
database of soils, which contains values of selected characteristics of soils.
One further needs to specify the angle of internal friction between the soil and structure, which
depends on the structure material and the type of soil. Possible values of this parameter are
listed in the table of recommended values.
The associated theory is described in detail in chapter "Earth pressures".
-678-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialogue window ",dd new soils" - "@asic data"
Assign
The "Assign" frame contains a list of layers of profile and associated soils. The list of soils is
graphically represented using buttons in the bar above the table, or is accessible from a combo
list for each layer of the profile.
The procedure to assign soil into a layer is described in detail herein.
The program makes it possible to import soil assignment in the gINT format.
-679-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",ssign"
!errain
The "!errain" frame allows, by pressing the button, for specifying the terrain shape. The
selected shape with graphic hint ("Chart o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in
the left part of the frame. The terrain shape can be edited either in the frame by inserting
values into input fields, or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
The last option to choose from is a general shape of a terrain. In this case the frame contains a
table with a list of terrain points. The first point with coordinates [0, 0] coincides with the top
point of a structure.
Analysis of earth pressures in case of inclined terrain is described in the theoretical part of the
hint, chapter "Distribution of earth pressures for broken terrain".
-680-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Terrain"
(ater
The "(ater" frame allows, by pressing the button, for selecting the type of water. The selected
type together with a graphic hint ("Chart o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in
the left part of the frame. Water parameters (h1, h2...) can be edited either in the frame by
inserting values into input fields, or on the desktop with the help of active dimensions.
The combo list serves to specify whether the influence of uplift pressure of water due to
different tables at the foundation joint is considered. The uplift pressure can be assumed to be
linear, parabolic or it may not be considered at all. When verifying the wall, the uplift pressure
in base of footing joint due to different water tables is introduced in terms of a special force.
The last option is a manual input of pore pressure both in front and behind the structure. Two
tab sheets "In "ront o" structure" and "Behind structure" appear with tables. The table is
filled with values of pore pressure in front, or behind the structure at a depth of "/" (/-axis).
The ground water table can also be specified a)o&e the structure or earth profile,
respectively in such a case the depth of water is inputted with a negative value.
Analysis of earth pressures with influence of water is described in the theoretical part of the
hint chapter "Influence of water".
The program further allows for specifying a depth of tensile cracks filled with water.
-681-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "%ater"
(ater
The "(ater" frame allows for selecting the type of water. The ground water table can be
specified in two ways. The first option allows for specifying the height of a flat ground water
table. The second option enables to define an arbitrary shape of the ground water table with
the help of coordinates.
The water parameters (water table height, coordinates of points) can be edited either in the
frame by inserting values into the input fields or on the desktop using the active dimensions or
active blocks.
-682-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "%ater"
Surcharge
The "Surcharge" frame contains a table with a list of inputted surcharges. Adding (editing)
surcharge is performed in the ".ew @editA surcharge" dialog window. The inputted
surcharges can be edited on the desktop with the help of active dimensions or active objects,
respectively.
The /-coordinate measured from the top point of a structure is specified (positive direction
downwards) when inputting the surcharge at a certain depth. Providing the surcharge is found
off the terrain the computer prompts an error message.
Either per'anent or &aria)le surcharge can be introduced. Selecting the particular type of
surcharge also renders the corresponding design coefficient to multiply the resulting loading
action. Favorably acting variable surcharge is not considered in the program.
Analysis of earth pressures due to surcharges is described in the theoretical part of the hint,
chapter "Influence of surcharge".
-683-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Surcharge"
Front "ace resistance
The "Front "ace resistance" frame allows by pressing the button for specifying the terrain
shape and parameters of front face resistance. The selected shape with a graphic hint ("Chart
o" para'eters") of inputted values is displayed in the left part of the frame. The terrain shape
can be edited either in the frame by inserting values into input fields, or on the desktop with
the help of active dimensions.
Combo lists in the frame allows the user to select the type of resistance and a soil (the combo
list contains soils introduced in the frame "Soils"). The magnitude of terrain surcharge in front
of the wall or soil thickness above the wall lowest points can also be specified in the frame.
The resistance on a structure front face can be specified as a pressure at rest, passive
pressure or reduced passive earth pressure. The resulting force due to reduced passive
pressure is found as a resultant force caused by passive pressure multiplied by a
corresponding coefficient, which follows from the inputted type of reduced passive pressure.
-684-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Front face resistance"
Applied "orces
The "Applied "orces" frame contains a table with a list of forces acting on a structure. Adding
(editing) forces is performed in the ".ew "orce @edit "orceA" dialog window. The inputted
forces can also be edited on the desktop with the help of active objects.
Applied "orces represent an additional load on the structure of the wall, sheeting or MSE wall.
We can model such as an anchoring crash barrier, crash vehicle, load from billboards and
hoardings etc. Program doesn`t adjust the applied forces in the calculation.
External load acting to the ground surface is necessary to define as surcharge.
-685-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",pplied forces"
3arthHuake
The "3arthHuake" frame serves to input earthquake parameters. Directions of inputted
earthquake effects are displayed on the desktop.
If not provided by measurements the coefficients k
h
and k
0
can be calculated following the
approach adopted from EN 1998-5.
Analysis of earth pressures while accounting for earthquake is described in the theoretical part
of the hint in chapter "Influence earthquake".
-686-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "(arthAua9e"
Stage settings
The frame "Stage settings" serves to input settings valid for a given construction stage.
Selected design situation determines the safety coefficients to be used in the analysis of a
given construction stage.
The frame view depends on the selected verification methodology. LRFD 2012 introduces new
types of design situations (Strength I, Ser&ice I, 3tre'e I).
Frame "Stage settings"
-687-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
5eri"ication
The frame "5eri"ication" shows the analysis results.
To perform verification of external stability the program creates a "ictitious structure (wall)
which is then checked for o&erturning and slip. The fictitious wall consists of the structure
front face and a curve bounding the end points of geo-reinforcements. The fictitious structure
is loaded by an active earth pressure. The actual verification procedure is described in the
theoretical part of the hint.
The frame appearance is adjusted based on the selected verification methodology:
- Verification according to the factor of safety, or the theory of limit states the column F in
the table allows for inputting the design coefficients, which multiply the calculated forces.
These forces are displayed on the desktop and are updated for every change of data and
setting in the frame.
- Analysis according to EN 1997 the column G in the table allows for specifying whether
the loading acting on a structure is considered as secondary one. This is explained in more
detail in section "Load combinations".
- Analysis according to LRFD in the case the column F is not displayed.
Several computations can be carried out for a single task. The computed forces are displayed
on the desktop and are automatically updated with every change of input data and setting. The
right part of the frame shows the result of verification of a wall against o&erturning and slip.
The "In detail" button opens the dialog window, which contains detailed listing of the results
of verification analysis.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame ""erification"
-688-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
$i'ensioning
The "$i'ensioning" frame enables to verify individual joints between blocks for o&erturning
and slip. The option "3ntire wall" allows for verifying the overall structure above the
foundation joint as well as the foundation soil bearing capacity in the "Bearing capacit%"
frame. Checking the option "Auto'atic &eri"ication" provides verification of the most critical
joint above the block. Or it is possible to input the "Joint a)o&e )lock nu')er" to prompt
the program to perform the analysis for a given joint only.`The procedure for wall
dimensioning is described in the theoretical part of this hint.
The frame appearance is adjusted based on the selected verification methodology:
- Verification according to the factor of safety, or the theory of limit states the column F in
the table allows for inputting the design coefficients, which multiply the calculated forces.
- Analysis according to EN 1997 the column G in the table allows for specifying whether
the loading acting on a structure is considered as secondary one. This is explained in more
detail in section "Load combinations".
- Analysis according to LRFD in the case the column F is not displayed.
The frame enables to perform more analyses of individual joints of the wall blocks. Various
design coefficients of individual forces can also be specified. The resulting forces are displayed
on the desktop and are updated with an arbitrary change in data or setting specified in the
frame. The "In detail" button opens the dialog window that contains detailed listing of the
dimensioning results.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame "Dimensioning"
-689-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Bearing capacit%
The "Bearing capacit%" frame displays the results of the analysis of foundation soil bearing
capacity. Stress in the foundation joint (assumed constant) is determined from all forces
calculated in the "Verification" frame. In case of the inputted foundation, the bearing capacity
is determined from all forces calculated in the "Dimensioning" frame (the option "3ntire wall"
must be selected). The program "Spread "ooting" adopts individual verifications as loading
cases.
Three basic analysis options are available in the frame:
- Input the "oundation soil
)earing capacit%
The input field serves to specify the foundation soil bearing
capacity. The results of verification analysis of a soil for
eccentricit% and bearing capacity are displayed in the right
part of the frame. The "In detail" button opens the dialog
window that displays detailed listing of the results of
verification analysis of foundation soil bearing capacity.
When performing the analysis according to EN 1997
Design approach 2 resp. LRFD, the assigned bearing
capacity is reduced by the corresponding design
coe""icient o" resistance.
- Co'pute the "oundation
soil )earing capacit% using
the progra' :Spread
"ooting:
Pressing the ",un Spread "ooting: button starts the
program "Spread "ooting" that allows for computing the
soil bearing capacity or settlement and rotation of a footing.
Pressing the "O7" button leaves the analysis regime the
results and all plots are copied to the program "Cantile&er
wall". The program "Spread "ooting" must be installed for
the button to be active.
- $o not co'pute @pile
"ootingA
The foundation soil bearing capacity is not computed.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
-690-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "@earing capacit#"
Slip on georein"orce'ent
The "Slip on georein"orce'ent" frame enables to verify a slip of the reinforced soil block
along a geo-reinforcement checking the field ",ein"orce'ent nu')er". Selecting the option
"Auto'atic &eri"ication" provides verification of the most critical reinforcement. The
rein"orced soil )lock is bounded by the wall front face, the checked geo-reinforcement, a
vertical line passing through the geo-reinforcement end point and terrain. The reinforced soil
block is loaded by an active earth pressure and by stabilizing forces due to geo-reinforcements
exceeding the boundary of the reinforced block.
The solution procedure of slip on georeinforcement is described in the theoretical part of the
help.
The frame appearance is adjusted based on the selected verification methodology:
- Verification according to the factor of safety, or the theory of limit states the column F in
the table allows for inputting the design coefficients, which multiply the calculated forces.
- Analysis according to EN 1997 the column G in the table allows for specifying whether
the loading acting on a structure is considered as secondary one. This is explained in more
detail in section "Load combinations".
- Analysis according to LRFD in the case the column F is not displayed.
The frame enables to perform more verification analyses of individual geo-reinforcements.
Various design coefficients of individual forces can also be specified. The resulting forces are
displayed on the desktop and are updated with an arbitrary change in data or setting specified
in the frame. The "In detail" button opens the dialogue window, which contains a detailed
-691-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
listing of the results of internal stability.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
Frame "+nternal stabilit#"
Internal sta)ilit%
The "Internal sta)ilit%" frame enables to check a strength of geo-reinforcement, bearing
capacity for pull6out from the earth body and strength of connections. Checking the field
",ein"orce'ent nu')er" yields verification for individual reinforcements only. Selecting the
option "Auto'atic &eri"ication" provides verification of all reinforcements. The result for the
most critical reinforcement is displayed on the right part of the desktop. The solution
procedure of internal stability is described in the theoretical part of the hint.
The B column shows forces caused by an active earth pressure acting on the front face of the
wall in individual geo-reinforcements. The $, 3 columns store points of application of these
forces. The H, J columns represent bearing capacity of geo-reinforcements against tearing
and the resulting utilization for tearing. The J, 7 columns represent bearing capacity of geo-
reinforcements against pull6out from the earth body and the resulting utilization of geo-
reinforcement for pull-out.
The frame enables to perform more analyses of individual geo-reinforcements. The calculated
forces are displayed on the desktop are automatically updated with every change of input data.
The "In detail" button opens the dialogue window, which contains a detailed listing of the
results of reinforcement bearing capacity.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
-692-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "6einforcement bearing capacit#"
Glo)al sta)ilit%
The "Glo)al sta)ilit%" frame enables to perform the slope stability verification analysis along
a circular slip surface. It is required to input parameters of a slip surface (center and radius)
and the analysis method (Spencer, Bishop). Checking the option "Opti'i-e" allows for the
stability analysis of the most critical slip surface. The "Initial slip sur"ace" enables to
automatically input the circular slip surface. The analysis is then performed after pressing the
button "Analyze".
The actual slope stability &eri"ication anal%sis is carried out depending on the setting in the
"Stability analysis" tab sheet:
- According to EN 1997, where loading is reduced by the analysis partial factors and the
verification is performed based on the theory of limit states.
- According to LRFD, the analysis is carried out similarly to the theory of limit states
- According to the "actor o" sa"et% / the theory of li'it states depending on the setting in
"Wall analysis" tab sheet.
More analyses can be performed for a single task. The "In detail" button opens the dialogue
window, which contains a detailed listing of the results of stability analysis, i.e. parameters of
the resulting slip surface and the factor of safety, alternatively utilization (for limit states).
The results are displayed in the right part of the frame, the optimized slip surface on the
desktop.
Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style settings" dialog window.
-693-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ")lobal stabilit#"
Sta)ilit%
Pressing the "Sta)ilit%" button launches the "Slope sta)ilit%" program. This program then
allows us to check the overall stability of the analyzed structure. The button is available only if
the program "Slope sta)ilit%" is installed.
After completing all analyses press the "O7" button to leave the program all data are then
carried over to the analysis protocol of the "/S3 (all" program.
-694-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Stabilit#"
Progra' Pile Group
Pro8ect
The "Pro8ect" frame is used to input the basic project data and to specify the overall setting of
the analysis run. The frame contains an input form to introduce the basic data about the
analyzed task, i.e. project information, project description, date, etc. This information is
further used in text and graphical outputs.
The frame also allows the user to switch analysis units (metric / imperial).
-695-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Pro'ect"
Settings
The frame "Settings" serves to introduce the basic "Settings" of the program such as
standards and theories of analyses, the way of proving safety of a structure and individual
coefficients of the analysis.
The programs contain not only the pre-defined )asic Settings for individual countries, but
also allow the user to create their own user6de"ined Settings, which can be subsequently
used in all GEO5 programs.
The "Select" button enables to choose an already created Setting from the "Settings list".
The "Settings Ad'inistrator" button opens the "Administrator" dialogue window, which
allows for viewing and modifying individual Setting. One may also identify the visible settings
in the Settings list. Data in the Settings administrator can be also eported and i'ported.
The "Add to the ad'inistrator" button allows for creating user-defined Settings, which are
subsequently added to the Settings administrator.
The "/odi"%" button enables a quick visualization and editing of the current Setting in the
opened program. Modifying any of the parameters changes the title to "Inputted "or the
current task". Individual analyses are then performed with this local setting. Should we
consider this setting as suitable also for other tasks, we add the setting into the "Settings
ad'inistrator" by pressing the "Add to the ad'inistrator" button.
The "Inputted "or the current task" setting is usually created when importing older data.
Settings of analysis parameters are performed in the "Materials and standards" and "Pile
Group" tab sheets.
The right part of the frame serves to select the type of analysis - analytical solution or spring
method.
!he anal%tical solution reHuires de"ining the t%pe o" su)soil:
- cohesionless soil (analysis for drained conditions)
- cohesive soil (analysis for undrained conditions)
!he spring 'ethod reHuires inputting:
- type of pile (pile acts vertically)
- connection piles / pile cap
- modulus of subsoil reaction (pile acts horizontally)
Frame "Settings"
-696-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Structure
The frame "Structure" serves to input the width o" pile cap, nu')er and pile dia'eter
and spacing o" piles.
Individual piles in the group share the same diameter. A correct and reliable design of a pile
group requires meeting the construction rules regarding:
- the number of piles in a group (2 - 20)
- the diameter of piles (from 0,"m)
- the spacing of piles (s
;
, s
?
= 1,#, to @,) - , is the diameter of individual piles in the group
- the overhang of a pile cap from the axis of outer piles
Frame "Structure"
Geo'etr%
The frame "Geo'etr%" serves to input the depth "ro' ground sur"ace, pile head o""set,
thickness o" pile cap and length o" piles.
Individual piles in the group are of the same length.
-697-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ")eometr#"
/aterial
The "/aterial" frame allows for the selection of material parameters for concrete and
longitudinal steel reinforcements.
Two options are available when selecting the material type:
- The "Catalog" button opens the "Catalog o" 'aterials" dialog window (for concrete or
steel reinforcements), the list of materials then serves to select the desired material.
- The "Own" button opens the "3ditor o" 'aterial 6 Concrete" dialog window (for
concrete) or the "3ditor o" 'aterial 6 ,ein"orcing steel )ars" dialog window (for
longitudinal steel reinforcements), which allows for manual specification of material
parameters
The catalogs content depends on the selection of standard for the design of concrete structures
set in the "Materials and standards" tab sheet. The input field in the upper part of the frame
serves to specify the unit weight of structure.
-698-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Material"
#oad
The frame "#oad" contains the table with the list of inputted loads. Adding (editing) load is
performed in the ".ew @editA load" dialogue window. The forces are inputted according to the
sign convention displayed in the right part of the dialogue window.
The program also allows for importing a load using the "I'port" button.
The load applied to a pile group acts at the level of a pile cap upper base at its center. These
values can be easily obtained from the analysis by an arbitrary program that performs static
analysis.
The program automatically back-calculates the pile cap sel" weight to be added to the
already existing load. This program further enables to consider the sel" weight o" pile
(using the button in the left part of the desktop)
The pile cap self weight is provided by:
kde: >
;
-width of pile cap in the ; direction [m]
>
?
-width of pile cap in the ? direction [m]
t -thickness of pile cap [m]
-
unit weight of structure [k3Hm
"
]
-699-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "3oad"
#oad acting on a pile group
The pile group can be used to found both bridge abutments and arbitrary civil engineering
structures. To determine the load acting on a pile group can be rather complicated. The load
can be applied at several locations as concentrated load (column), distributed along the line
(wall) or over the area. The procedure shows a simple way of determining the load at a given
point by adopting an arbitrary static program.
1. We start from the model of a structure in the static program
2. Providing no joint is defined in the center o" the pile cap, we introduce it.
3. A "ied support in all L directions is assigned to the joint (fixed, fixed, fixed, fixed,
fixed, fixed)
4. If the joint is not found on the pile cap (beam model), we connect it with the actual
structure (The stiffness should correspond to other elements)
5. Apart from the new joint we remove all )oundar% conditions on the analyzed model
6. Perform analysis the 8oint reactions correspond to the load, which is inputted into
the "Pile group" program the function for importing the load can also be utilized
Note: internal hinges found in the structure must be changed to fixed-end supports for the
static program to find a solution.
-700-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Structure with a fi&ed support
Support reactions read# for import into the "Pile group" program
3oad imported into "Pile group" in the frame "3oad"
-701-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Pro"ile
The "Pro"ile" frame contains a table with a list of inputted interfaces. After specifying
interfaces it is possible to edit thicknesses of individual layers with the help of active
dimensions.
Adding (editing) layer is performed in the "Add @editA inter"ace" dialog window. The /-
coordinate measured from the top point of a structure is specified (/-axis).
The program allows for raising or lowering the top point of a structure in the "Change o"
terrain ele&ation" dialog window so that the whole interface can be translated while keeping
the thicknesses of individual layers. This function is important when copying the profile from
program "!errain".
The program makes it possible to import a profile in the gINT format.
Frame "Profile"
Soils
The "Soils" frame contains a table with a list of inputted soils. The table also provides
information about currently selected soil displayed in the right part of the frame.
Adding (editing) a soil is performed in the "Add (edit) soil" dialog window.
The soil characteristics needed in the program are further specified in the following chapters:
"Basic data", "Uplift pressure", "Settlement", "Modulus of subsoil reaction". These parameters
depend on the type of soil specified in the frame "Settings" and the theory of analysis specified
in the "Pile Group" tab sheet.
-702-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The program makes it possible to import soils in the gINT format.
Frame "Soil"
Basic data
This part of the window serves to introduce basic parameters of soils unit weight1 angle o"
internal "riction and cohesion. The particular values are obtained from geotechnical survey
or from laboratory experiments. If these data are not available, it is possible to exploit the
built-in database of soils, which contains values of the selected characteristics of soils.
The calculation of "Pile Group" differs according to the type of subsoil:
- cohesionless soil; e""ecti&e parameters of shear strength of soil c
e6
,
e6
are used
commonly.
- cohesi&e soil; in program is defined only the value of total shear strength of soil c
9
,
which determines vertical bearing capacity of pile group (or earth block).
Additional parameters are inputted depending on the settings in the frame "Settings" and in
the "Pile Group" tab sheet.
The associated theory is described in detail in chapter "Pile Group".
-703-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ",dd new soils" - "@asic data"
Assign
The "Assign" frame contains a list of layers of profile and associated soils. The list of soils is
graphically represented using buttons in the bar above the table, or is accessible from a combo
list for each layer of the profile.
The procedure to assign soil into a layer is described in detail herein.
The program makes it possible to import soil assignment in the gINT format.
-704-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ",ssign"
(ater
The "(ater" frame serves to specify the depth o" ground water ta)le.
The value can be edited either in the frame by inserting the value into the input field, or on the
desktop with the help of active dimensions.
The G(! changes the geostatic stress in the soil profile.
-705-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "%ater"
.egati&e skin "riction
The ".egati&e skin "riction" frame serves to specify the settlement of surrounding terrain
and the depth of influence zone. For more information on the influence of negative skin friction
the user is referred to theoretical section.
-706-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ".egatie s9in friction"
5ertical springs
The frame "5ertical springs" is active only when analyzing a "loating pile. The inputted
springs are displayed in the table.
The option "input the sti""ness o" springs" requires inputting:
- spring at the pile base [!3Hm]
- shear modulus of subsoil reaction along the pile [!3Hm
"
].
The inputted values are the same for all piles. In the analysis the vertical stiffnesses of inner
and outer piles in the group are reduced by particular coefficients.
The option "Co'pute the sti""ness o" springs "ro' soil para'eters" requires inputting
the typical load to obtain the spring stiffnesses from calculation.
-707-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame ""ertical springs"
Hori-ontal 'odulus
The frame "Hori-ontal 'odulus" serves to input the horizontal modulus of subsoil reaction
characterizing the pile response in the horizontal direction.
The inputted values of the modulus of subsoil reaction at a given depth of the profile are
displayed in the table.
-708-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Hori!ontal modulus"
Stage settings
The frame "Stage settings" serves to input settings valid for a given construction stage.
Selected design situation determines the safety coefficients to be used in the analysis of a
given construction stage.
Frame "Stage settings"
5ertical )earing capacit% + anal%tical solution
The frame "5ertical )earing capacit%" serves to verify the pile group vertical bearing
capacity. Several analyses can be carried out in the frame.
-709-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The verification analysis can be carried out for individual loads or the program identifies the
'ost critical one (can be selected from the combo list).
The analysis is performed according to the theory set in the frame "Settings" (analytical
solution):
- for cohesive soil (undrained conditions) analysis of bearing capacity of an earth block
according to FHWA
- for cohesionless soil (drained conditions) - NAVFAC DM 7.2, Effective stress, CSN 73 1002
The parameters needed for the pile group analysis are introduced for individual methods in left
part of the frame.
The verification analysis is carried out according to the methodology selected in the "Pile
Group" tab sheet (factors of safety, theory of limit states, EN 1997-1).
The "In detail" button opens the dialog window containing detailed listing of the verification
results.
The analysis results are displayed in the right part of the desktop.
Frame ""ertical bearing capacit#" $ anal#tical solution
Settle'ent + cohesi&e soil
This frame serves to calculate the pile group settle'ent for cohesive soils. The analysis of
settlement is performed according to the selected theory set in the "Pile Group" tab sheet. The
analysis results are displayed in the right part of the desktop.
The "In detail" button opens the dialogue window that contains a detailed description of the
results of the verification analysis.
-710-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Settlement" - cohesie soil
Settle'ent + cohesionless soil @loading cur&eA
The frame "Settle'ent" displays linear loading curve for the settlement of a pile group in a
cohesionless soil. Several analyses can be carried out in the frame.
The combo list enables choosing the pile type ("loating pile, end6)earing pile). The loading
curve is calculated always for the inputted li'it settle'ent.
The table in the bottom part of the frame directly allows with the help of the mouse for editing
the defined parameters. The "3dit -
s
" button opens the dialog window with a help section for
parameters specifying the secant deformation modulus. Pressing the "O7" button in a
particular window stores the inputted para'eters for a given layer into the table.
The anal%sis results are displayed in the right part of the frame. The "In detail" button
opens the dialogue window that contains a detailed description of the results of the verification
analysis.
The analysis results (loading curve) are displayed in the right part of the desktop.
-711-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame"Settlement" - cohesionless soil 7load settlement cure8
Anal%sis + spring 'ethod
This frame serves to analyze a group of piles using the spring method. The analysis is run by
pressing the "Anal%sis" button.
Upon performing the analysis, the results appear in the right part of the frame (",esults")
providing information about the 'ai'u' internal "orces, displace'ents and rotations
o" a structure. Displacements of the structure shown in the window are determined for
service loads. The "In detail" button opens the dialogue window that contains a detailed
description of the results of the verification analysis.
The left part of the frame allows for defining the way of plotting the results on the screen:
- ,esults the results can be displayed for individual loading cases or for their envelope
- Show results the results can be displayed for all piles or for individual piles only
- 5alues visualization of values of individual variable (moments, normal and shear forces,
displacements, springs....)
- Structure allows for plotting a deformed structure (only undeformed structure can be
displayed for envelopes of load cases), next it is possible to show the magnitudes of pile
cap deflections, reactions and magnitudes of springs at the pile base.
- $rawing 'ode defines the style of describing the results
The displayed results can be added to the "List of pictures" at any time and used in the
analysis protocol.
Rotation, zooming and illumination of a structure can be adjusted with the help of horizontal
-712-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
3D visualization tool bar. Visualization of results can be adjusted in the "Visualization style
settings" dialog window.
Frame ",nal#sis" - spring method
$i'ensioning
The frame "$i'ensioning" allows the programs to adopt the results obtained from the
calculations performed in the frame "Analysis". Both the envelope of loads and individual
loading cases can be selected. The reinforcement can be design for the selected pile or the
same reinforcement for all piles in the group can be assumed.
The verification analysis of a steel-reinforced concrete pile is carried out according to the
standard selected in the "Materials and standards" tab sheet.
-713-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Frame "Dimensioning" - spring method
Outputs
The program contains three basic output options:
- Print and export document
- Print and export picture
- Copy to clipboard
Adding picture
The program allows for storing the current picture irrespectively of the program regime. To
that end, press the "Add picture" button on the vertical tool bar. The button opens the ".ew
picture" dialog window and inserts the current view on the desktop view in the window.
The picture is always linked to a certain input regime or analysis. (The current regime is
displayed next to the picture name). When printing a document the picture is automatically
added to a specific regime in the tree.
The program allows for defining the picture either for a specific stage of construction (or for
the current analysis) or adjusting the setting such that the picture is added to the document in
all stages of construction (or all analyses). The latter option is assumed when selecting "all" in
the "Stages" combo list (or "Anal%sis" list).
Checkbox (hole page allows to use whole page picture in document.
(arning; All inputted pictures are auto'aticall% regenerated whene&er 'odi"%ing
-714-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
data0
The picture view can be adjusted with the help of vertical tool bar in the left part of the window
(edit size and location). See "Tool bar - scale and shift" section for more details on individual
buttons. The last button on the bar allows for adjusting the picture page ratio. The "Picture
settings" frame in bottom part of the dialog window further allows for adjusting colors and
style of line (object) drawing see "Visualization style settings".
The "O7" button stores the picture into the "Picture list". It can be then opened and modified
at any time.
The picture can be also printed out from this window pressing the "Print" button opens the
dialog window for printing and exporting pictures. If the picture is active over all stages (or all
analyses), then all possible combinations of pictures are printed all at once (each picture on a
separate page).
Dialog window ".ew picture"
#ist o" pictures
Pictures stored with the help of the "New picture" dialog window are ordered in the table in
"#ist o" pictures". The "#ist o" pictures" dialog window is opened using the button on the
vertical tool bar. The table of list of pictures contains the picture name and description, the
regime in which it was created and stage of construction or the analysis number.
Individual pictures can be edited using the "/odi"%" button, which opens the "3dit picture"
dialog window (this window corresponds to the "New picture" dialog window both in the way it
looks and in the way it functions).
These pictures can be printed out from the window by pressing the "Print" button that opens
-715-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
the dialog window for printing and exporting the picture. Providing the picture is active over all
stages of construction (over all analyses, respectively) then the program prints all possible
combinations of the picture (each picture on a separate page). Providing more pictures are
selected then all selected pictures are printed out.
Dialog window "3ist of pictures"
Print and eport docu'ent
The "Print and eport docu'ent" dialog window can be opened either from the control
menu (items "Files", "Print docu'ent") or using the "Files" button on the horizontal tool bar.
The page print preview with a generated text appears in the window.
This window generates output document including pictures stored in the "Picture list". This
window allows either for printing the created protocol or exporting it for further use. The
docu'ent is alwa%s up to date the program creates the document again based on
inputted data (even with regenerated pictures) whenever opening this window.
Only specific parts of the document including pictures can be generated by checking the
corresponding "tree" item in the left part of the window. Selecting or deselecting an arbitrary
item prompts the program to regenerate the document automatically.
The dialog window contains its own "Control menu" and "Tool bar" for finalizing the page face
(header and footer definition, page size and edges definition and definition page numbering).
A mouse ball or scroll bar can be also used to view the document.
The button part of the dialog window displays current information (defined page size, current
document page and the total number of pages).
-716-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window "Print and e&port document"
Print and eport picture
This window serves to print or export one or more pictures. Three options are available to open
this window:
- Using the control menu (items "Files", "Print &iew") or the "Files" button on the tool bar
to print data from the desktop.
- Using the "New picture" dialog window by pressing the "Print" button.
- Using the "List of pictures" dialog window by pressing the "Print" button.
The window may contain more than one picture at the same time (when printing more
construction stages or analyses) when printing more pictures from the list. Each pictured is
printed on a separate page. The picture preview can be adjusted using buttons on the tool bar
or a mouse ball.
The dialog window contains its own "Control menu" and "Tool bar" for finalizing the page face
(header and footer definition, page size and edges definition and definition page numbering).
The button part of the dialog window displays current information (defined page size, current
document page and the total number of pages).
-717-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window "Documents" $ print and e&port current picture 7iew8
Control 'enu Print and eport
The control menu of the "Print and export document" and "Print and export pictures" dialog
windows contains the following items:
$ocu'ent
Sa&e as - opens the "Save as" dialog
window that allows for saving the
file in format *.PDF, or *.RTF
Send - opens the dialog window for mail
client an adds the picture as an
attachement in format *.PDF
Open and
edit
- opens text editor (associated in
the Windows system with *.RTF
extenison) that allows for editing
the page manulally
Page
properties
- opens the "Page properties" dialog
window that allows for specifying
the page style (size, edges,
layout)
Header and - opens the "Header and footer"
-718-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
"ooter dialog window that allows for
inputting the document headers
and footers
Print - opens the system window for
"Print"
Close - closes the dialog window
3dit
Cop% - copies the selected picture (text)
to clipboard parameters are set
in the "Options" dialog window
tab sheet "Copy to clipboard"
Select all - marks all on page (on document)
into block
Cancel
selection
- cancels entire selection (picture,
text)
5iew
Full page - modifies the page size such that
the entire page in the dialog
window is visible
Page width - fits the page to a maximum width
of the document dialog window
Page (this item appers in the menu only if the document has more than one page)
First page - shows the document first page
Pre&ious page - shows the previous page
Following page - shows the following page
#ast page - shows the document last page
!ool )ar Print and eport
The tool bar of the "Print and export document" and "Print and export picture" dialog windows
contains the following buttons:
Tool bar "Print and e&port"
Individual buttons function as follows:

Sa&e as - opens the "Save as" dialog window that allows for
saving the file in format *.PDF, or *.RTF

Print - opens the system window for "Print"
-719-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013

Page
properties
- opens the "Page properties" dialog window that
allows for specifying the page style (size, edges,
orientation)

Header and
"ooter
- opens the "Header and footer" dialog window that
allows for inputting the document headers and
footers

Color st%le - determines the style of picture view (color, gray
scale, black & white)

Cop% - copies the selected picture (text) to clipboard
parameters are set in the "Options" dialog window
tab sheet "Copy to clipboard"

First page - shows the document first page

Pre&ious page - shows the previous page

.et page - shows the following page

#ast page - shows the document last page

/o&e - moves the current view in an arbitrary direction
to proceed move mouse in the desired location
while keeping the left mouse button pressed

Koo' in - scales up the desktop view while keeping location
of the point under the axis cross unchanged this
action is repeated using the left mouse button, the
right button leaves the zooming mode

Koo' out - scales down the desktop view while keeping
location of the point under the axis cross
unchanged this action is repeated using the left
mouse button, the right mouse button leaves the
zooming mode

!et selection - allows for selecting the text under the axis cross -
to proceed move mouse over the desired text while
keeping the left mouse button pressed

Full page - modifies the page size such that the entire page in
the dialog window is visible

Page width - fits the page to maximum width of the document
dialog window
Setting header and "ooter
The dialog window serves to define properties of the document header and footer. The "print
header @"ooterA" check box determines whether to print the document header (footer).
Header and footer lines may contain an arbitrary text and inserted objects implicitly defined by
the program. These objects receive program information such as:
- From the "Company data" dialog window (company name, logo, address)
- From the "Pro8ect" frame (name and task description, author)
-720-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- From the document system data (date, time, page numbering)
Objects can be introduced using the "Insert" button (the button opens a list of objects). The
button is active only if the cursor is found in one of the line that allows for inserting text
(object). Inserted objects are written in an internal format different from other text and placed
in curly brackets.
The program allows for defining various headers for the first page or odd and even pages,
respectively. Individual headers are in such a case defined in separate tab sheets.
The "use as de"ault" option sets the inputted header and footer parameters as default for the
newly created data. The assumed default setting is common for all our programs. Different
computer users may use different settings.
Writing format and the resulting view are evident from the following pictures.
Dialog window "Header and footer"
-721-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
"iew of document header and footer
Page properties
The dialog window allows for setting the page layout (paper format, print orientation and
edges).
The "use as de"ault" option sets the inputted page properties as default for the newly created
data. The assumed default setting is common for all our programs. Different computer users
may use different settings.
Dialog window "Page properties"
Page nu')ering
This dialog window allows the user to set page numbering. The combo list serves to define the
numbering style (Arabic digits, roman digits, with the help of symbols). A constant text can be
placed both in front and behind the page number. The ".u')ering "ro'" option allows for
starting the page numbering from an arbitrary number. The "use as de"ault" option sets the
inputted page numbering properties as default for the newly created data. The assumed
default setting is common for all our programs. Different computer users may use different
settings.
-722-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window "Page numbering"
A)out co'pan%
The dialog window is launched from the managing menu (items "Settings", "Co'pan%").
The "Basic data" tab sheet serves to specify the basic information about company. The
inputted data are used by the program when printing and exporting documents (pictures), in
the document header or footer.
The "Co'pan% logo" tab sheet allows the user to load the company logo. The "#oad" button
opens the dialog window which allows for opening the picture in various formats (*.JPG,
*.JPEG, *.JPE, *.BMP, *.ICO, *.EMF, *.WMF).
The "3'plo%ees" tab sheep allows for inputting the list of program users (employees). When
filling the name list it is no longer necessary fill the author's name in the frame "Project".
Dialog window ",bout compan#" $ tab sheet "@asic data"
-723-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window ",bout compan#" $ tab sheet "Compan# logo"
Dialog window ",bout compan#" $ tab sheet "(mplo#ees"
!heor%
The theoretical part of help contains all theoretical basis employed in computations with our
programs.
-724-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Stress in a soil )od%
Calculation of stress in soil in our programs is described in the following chapters:
- Geostatic stress in a soil body, computation of uplift pressure
- Effective / total stress
- Stress increment due to surcharge
- Stress increment under footing
Geostatic stress1 upli"t pressure
Stress analysis is based on existence of soil layers specified by the user during input. The
program further inserts fictitious layers at the locations where the stress and lateral pressure
(GWT, points of construction, etc.) change. The normal stress in the )
th
layer is computed
according to:
where: h
)
-
thickness of the )
th
layer

)
- unit weight of soil
If the layer is found below the ground water ta)le, the unit weight of soil below the water
table is specified with the help of inputted parameters of the soil as follows:
- for option "Standard" from expression:
where:
sat
- saturated unit weight of soil

$
- unit weight of water
- for option "Co'pute "ro' porosit%" from expression:
where: F - porosity

s
- specific weight of soil

$
- unit weight of water
where: \ - volume of soil
\
p
- volume of voids
&
,
- weight of dry soil
Unit weight of water is assumed in the program equal to 10 k3Hm
"
or 0,00@2# ks).
Assuming inclined ground behind the structure (Y ] 0) and layered subsoil the angle Y, when
computingthe coefficient of earth pressure 2, is reduced in the )
th
layer using the following
expression:
-725-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: - unit weight of the soil in the first layer under ground

)
-
unit weight of the soil in the )
th
layer under ground
Y - slope inclination behind the structure
3""ecti&e9total stress in soil
Vertical normal stress
/
is defined as:
where:
/
- vertical normal total stress

e6
- submerged unit weight of soil
/ - depth bellow the ground surface

$
- unit weight of water
This expression in its generalized form describes so called concept of effective stress:
where: - total stress (overall)

e6
- effective stress (active)
9 - neutral stress (pore water pressure)
Total< effectie and neutral stress in the soil
Effective stress concept is valid only for the normal stress

, since the shear stress d is not
transferred by the water so that it is effective. The total stress is determined using the basic
tools of theoretical mechanics, the effective stress is then determined as a difference between
the total stress and neutral (pore) pressure (i.e. always by calculation, it can never be
measured). Pore pressures are determined using laboratory or in-situ testing or by calculation.
To decide whether to use the total or effective stresses is no simple. The following table may
provide some general recommendations valid for majority of cases. We should realize that the
total stress depends on the way the soil is loaded by its self weight and external effects. As for
the pore pressure we assume that for flowing pore water the pore equals to hydrodynamic
pressure and to hydrostatic pressure otherwise. For partial saturated soils with higher degree
of it is necessary to account for the fact that the pore pressure evolves both in water and air
-726-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
bubbles.
Assu'e conditions $rained la%er Undrained la%er
short term effective stress total stress
long term effective stress effective stress
In layered subsoil with different unit weight of soils in individual horizontal layers the vertical
total stress is determined as a sum of weight of all layers above the investigated point and the
pore pressure:
where:
/
- vertical normal total stress
- unit weight of soil
- unit weight of soil in natural state for soils above the GWT and dry layers
- unit weight of soil below water in other cases
, - depth of the ground water table below the ground surface
/ - depth bellow the ground surface

$
- unit weight of water
Incre'ent o" earth pressure due to surcharge
Earth pressure increment in a soil or rock body due to surcharge is computed using the theory
of elastic subspace (Boussinesq).
Earth pressure increment in the point inside the soil or rock body due to an in"inite strip
surcharge is obtained from the following scheme:
Computation of earth pressure due to infinite strip surcharge
A trape-oidal surcharge is automatically subdivided in the program into ten segments.
-727-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Individual segments are treated as strip surcharges. The resulting earth pressure is a sum of
partial surcharges from individual segments.
Stress increment due to concentrated surcharge is computed as follows:
Surcharge related to point "*"
where:


Incre'ent o" earth pressure under "ooting
In the program "Spread "ooting" the stress distribution below foundation is determined by
combining the basic loading diagrams:
Chart of foundation loading
-728-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Chart of foundation loading
Chart of foundation loading
3arth pressure
Program system considers the following earth pressures categories:
- active earth pressure
- passive earth pressure
- earth pressure at rest
When computing earth pressures the program allows for distinguishing between the effective
and total stress state and for establishing several ways of calculation of uplift pressure. In
addition it is possible to account for the following effects having on the earth pressure
magnitude:
- influence of loading
- influence of water pressure
-729-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- influence of broken terrain
- friction between soil and back of structure
- adhesion of soil
- influence of earth wedge at cantilever jumps
- influence of earthquake
The following sign convention is used in the program, text and presented expressions.
When specifying rocks it is also necessary to input both the cohesion of rockc and the angle of
internal friction of rock . These values can be obtained either from the geological survey or
from the table of recommended values.
Sign con&ention
The following sign convention is used in the program, text and presented expressions.
Sign conention for calculation of earth pressures
- inclination of the ground surface Yis positive, when the ground rises upwards from the wall
- inclination of the back of structure G is possitive, when the toe of the wall (at the back
face) is placed in the direction of the soil body when measured from the vertical line
constructed from the upper point of the structure
- friction between the soil and back of structure V is positive, if the resultant of earth
pressure (thus also earth pressure) and normal to the back of structure form an angle
measured in the clockwise direction
Acti&e earth pressure
Active earth pressure is the smallest limiting lateral pressure developed at the onset of shear
failure by wall moving away from the soil in the direction of the acting earth pressure (minimal
wall rotation necessary for the evolution of active earth pressure is about 2 mra,, i.e.
2 mmHmofthe wall height8:
The following theories and approaches are implemented for the computation of active earth
pressure assu'ing e""ecti&e stress state:
- The Mazindrani theory
- The Coulomb theory
-730-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- The Mller-Breslau theory
- The Caquot theory
- The Absi theory
For cohesive soils the tension cutoff condition is accepted, i.e. if due to cohesion the negative
value of active earth pressure is developed or, according to more strict requirements, the value
of "Minimum dimensioning pressure" is exceeded, the value of active earth pressure drops
down to zero or set equal to the "Minimum dimensioning pressure".
The program also allows for running the analysis in total stresses.
Acti&e earth pressure + the /a-indrani theor%
Active earth pressure is given by the following formula:
where:
/
- vertical geostatic stress
2
a
- coefficient of active earth pressure due to Rankin
Y - slope inclination
- weight of soil
/ - assumed depth
- coefficient of active earth pressure due to Mazindrani
where: Y - slope inclination
- angle of internal friction of soil
c - cohesion of soil
Assuming cohesionless soils (c = 0) and horizontal ground surface (Y = 0) yields the Rankin
solution, for which the active earth pressure is provided by:
and the coefficient of active earth pressure becomes:
where: - angle of internal friction of soil
Horizontal and vertical components of the active earth pressure become:
where:
a
- active earth pressure
-731-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
V - angle of friction structure - soil
G - back face inclination of the structure
3iterature4
Ma!indrani< D:H:< and )an'ali< M:H: 5>>?: 3ateral earth pressure problem of cohesie bac9fill
with inclined surface: Pournal of )eotechnical and )eoenironmental (ngineering< ,SC(<
1237084 551$550:
Acti&e earth pressure 6 the Coulo') theor%
Active earth pressure is given by the following formula:
where:
/
- vertical geostatic stress
c
e6
- effective cohesion of soil
2
a
- coefficient of active earth pressure
2
ac
- coefficient of active earth pressure due to cohesion
The coefficient of active earth pressure 2
a
is given by:
The coefficient of active earth pressure 2
ac
is given by:
for:
for:
where: - angle of internal friction of soil
V - angle of friction structure - soil
Y - slope inclination
G - back face inclination of the structure
Horizontal and vertical components of the active earth pressure become:
where:
a
- active earth pressure
-732-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
V - angle of friction structure - soil
G - back face inclination of the structure
3iterature4
,rnold "errui't4 Soil mechanics< Delft Bniersit# of Technolog#< 0115< 011H<
"http4;;geo:errui't:net;"
Acti&e earth pressure 6 the /Rller6Breslau theor%
Active earth pressure is given by the following formula:
where:
/
- vertical geostatic stress
c
e6
- effective cohesion of soil
2
a
- coefficient of active earth pressure
2
ac
- coefficient of active earth pressure due to cohesion
The coefficient of active earth pressure 2
a
is given by:
where: - angle of internal friction of soil
V - angle of friction structure - soil
Y - slope inclination
G - back face inclination of the structure
The coefficient of active earth pressure 2
ac
is given by:
for:
for:
where: - angle of internal friction of soil
-733-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
V - angle of friction structure - soil
Y - slope inclination
G - back face inclination of the structure
Horizontal and vertical components of the active earth pressure become:
where:
a
- active earth pressure
V - angle of friction structure - soil
G - back face inclination of the structure
3iterature4
M[ller-@reslauZs (rddruc9 auf Stut!mauern<Stuttgart4 ,lfred Mroner-"erlag< 5>1H 7)erman8
Acti&e earth pressure 6 the CaHuot theor%
Active earth pressure is given by the following formula:
where:
/
- vertical geostatic stress
c
e6
- effective cohesion of soil
2
a
- coefficient of active earth pressure
2
ac
- coefficient of active earth pressure due to cohesion
The following analytical solution (Boussinesque, Caquot) is implemented to compute the
coefficient of active earth pressure 2
a
:
where: 2
a
- coefficient of active earth pressure due to Caquot
2
a
So98om>
- coefficient of active earth pressure due to Coulomb
[ - conversion coefficient see further
where: Y - slope inclination behind the structure
-734-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- angle of internal friction of soil
V - angle of friction structure - soil
The coefficient of active earth pressure 2
ac
is given by:
for:
for:
where: - angle of internal friction of soil
V - angle of friction structure - soil
Y - slope inclination behind the structure
G - back face inclination of the structure
Horizontal and vertical components of the active earth pressure become:
where:
a
- active earth pressure
V - angle of friction structure - soil
G - back face inclination of the structure
Acti&e earth pressure 6 the A)si theor%
Active earth pressure is given by the following formula:
where:
/
- vertical geostatic stress
c
e6
- effective cohesion of soil
2
a
- coefficient of active earth pressure
2
ac
- coefficient of active earth pressure due to cohesion
The program takes values of the coefficient of active earth pressure 2
a
from a database, built
upon the values published in the book: Krisel, Absi: Active and passive earth Pressure Tables,
3rd Ed. A.A. Balkema, 1990 ISBN 90 6191886 3.
The coefficient of active earth pressure 2
ac
is given by:
for:
-735-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
for:
where: - angle of internal friction of soil
V - angle of friction structure - soil
Y - slope inclination
G - back face inclination of the structure
Horizontal and vertical components of the active earth pressure become:
where:
a
- active earth pressure
V - angle of friction structure - soil
G - back face inclination of the structure
3iterature4
MYrisel< ,bsi4 ,ctie and Passie (arth Pressure Tables< 3rd ed:< @al9ema< 5>>1 +S@. >1
H5>5IIH 3
Acti&e earth pressure + total stress
When determining the active earth pressure in cohesive fully saturated soils, in which case the
consolidation is usually prevented (undrained conditions), the horizontal normal total stress
;
receives the form:
where:
;
- horizontal total stress (normal)

/
- vertical normal total stress
2
9c
- coefficient of earth pressure
c
9
- total cohesion of soil
The coefficient of earth pressure 2
9c
is given by:
where: 2
9c
- coefficient of earth pressure
c
9
- total cohesion of soil
a
9
- total adhesion of soil to the structure
-736-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Passi&e earth pressure
Passive earth pressure is the highest limiting lateral pressure developed at the onset of shear
failure by wall moving (penetrating) in the direction opposite to the direction of acting earth
pressure (minimal wall rotation necessary for the evolution of passive earth pressure is about
10 mra,, i.e. 10 mmHmofthe wall height8: In most expressions used to compute the passive earth
pressure the sign convention is assumed such that the usual values of Vcorresponding to
vertical direction of the friction resultant are negative. The program, however, assumes these
values to be positive. A seldom variant with friction acting upwards is not considered in the
program.
The following theories and approaches are implemented for the computation of passive earth
pressure assu'ing e""ecti&e stress state:
- The Rankin and Mazindrani theory
- The Coulomb theory
- The Caquot Krisel theory
- The Mller Breslau theory
- The Absi theory
- The Sokolovski theory
The program also allows for running the analysis in total stresses.
Passi&e earth pressure 6 the ,ankin and /a-indrani
theor%
Passive earth pressure follows from the following formula:
where:
/
- vertical geostatic stress
2
p
- coefficient of passive earth pressure due to Rankin
Y - slope inclination
- weight of soil
/ - assumed depth
- coefficient of passive earth pressure due to Mazindrani
The coefficient of passive earth pressure 2
p
is given by:
where: Y - slope inclination
- angle of internal friction of soil
c - cohesion of soil
-737-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
If there is no friction (V = 0) between the structure and cohesionless soils (c = 0), the ground
surface is horizontal (Y = 0) and the resulting slip surafce is also plane with the slope:
the Mazindrani theory then reduces to the Rankin theory. The coefficient of passive earth
pressure is then provided by:
where: - angle of internal friction of soil
Passive earth pressure
p
by Rankin for cohesionless soils is given:
where: - unit weight of soil
/ - assumed depth
2
p
- coefficient of passive earth pressure due to Rankin
3iterature4
,rnold "errui't4 Soil mechanics< Delft Bniersit# of Technolog#< 0115< 011H<
http4;;geo:errui't:net;
Ma!indrani< D:H:< and )an'ali< M:H: 5>>?: 3ateral earth pressure problem of cohesie bac9fill
with inclined surface: Pournal of )eotechnical and )eoenironmental (ngineering< ,SC(<
1237084 551$550:
Passi&e earth pressure 6 the Coulo') theor%
Passive earth pressure follows from the following formula:
where:
/
- effective vertical geostatic stress
2
p
- coefficient of passive earth pressure due to Coulomb
c - cohesion of soil
The coefficient of passive earth pressure 2
p
is given by:
where: - angle of internal friction of soil
V - angle of friction structure - soil
Y - slope inclination
G - back face inclination of the structure
The vertical
p0
and horizontal
ph
components of passive earth pressure are given by:
-738-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: V - angle of friction structure - soil
G - back face inclination of the structure
3iterature4
,rnold "errui't4 Soil mechanics< Delft Bniersit# of Technolog#< 0115< 011H<
http4;;geo:errui't:net;
Passi&e earth pressure 6 the CaHuot + 7Irisel theor%
Passive earth pressure follows from the following formula:
where
:
2
p
- coefficient of passive earth pressure for V = -, see the table
* - reduction coefficient * for jVj _ , see the table
c - cohesion of soil

/
- vertical geostatic stress
The vertical
p0
and horizontal
ph
components of passive earth pressureare given by:
where: V - angle of friction structure - soil
G - back face inclination of the structure
Coe""icient o" passi&e earth pressure 7p
Coefficient of passive earth pressure 2
p
for V = -
G
[A]

[A]
2
p
when YA
1 - 51 5- 01 0- 31 3- 21 2-
51 5<5
?
5<2
5
5<-
3
5- 5<3
1
5<?
1
5<>
0
0<1
I
01 5<?
5
0<1
I
0<2
0
0<?
5
0<>0
-739-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
0- 0<5
2
0<I
5
0<>
I
3<I
I
2<00 2<
23
-31 31 0<?
I
3<2
0
2<5
I
-<1
5
-<>I I<
>2
?<2
1
3- 3<?
-
2<?
3
-<I
?
?<0
5
I<?I 51
<I
1
50<
-1
53<I1
21 -<3
5
I<I
?
I<?
?
55<
11
53<?1 5?
<0
1
02<
I1
0-<21 0I<21
2- I<1
-
51<
?1
52<
01
5I<
21
03<I1 >1
<H
1
3I:
>1
2><51 H1<?1 H><
51
51 5<3
H
5<-
I
5<?
1
5- 5<H
I
5<>
?
0<0
1
0<3
I
01 0<5
3
0<-
0
0<>
0
3<0
0
3<-5
0- 0<?
I
3<3
2
3<>
>
2<I
1
-<0> -<
-?
-01 31 3<?
I
2<I
5
I<-
I
I<I
5
?<I2 ><
50
><?
?
3- -<3
I
I<I
>
I<0
I
51<
51
50<01 52
<I
1
5?<
21
5><11
21 I<1
?
51<
21
50<
11
5I<
-1
01<11 0-
<-
1
3I<
-1
3?<I1 20<01
2- 53<
0
5?<
-1
00<
>1
0><
I1
3I<31 2I
<>
1
I0<
31
?I<I1 >?<31 55
5<1
2
51 5<-
0
5<?
0
5<I
3
:
5- 5<>
-
0<0
3
0<-
?
0<I
I
01 0<-
?
0<>
I
3<2
0
3<?
-
2<1>
0- 3<- 2<5 2<> -<I I<2- I<
-740-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
1 2 1 0 I5
-51 31 2<>
I
I<1
5
?<5
>
I<-
5
51<51 55
<?
1
50<
I1
3- ?<2
?
><0
2
55<
31
53<
I1
5I<?1 01
<5
1
03<
?1
0\<11
21 50<
1
5-<
21
5><
21
02<
51
0><I1 3?
<5
1
-3<
01
--<51 H5<I1
2- 05<
0
0?<
>1
3I<
-1
2?<
01
I1<I1 ??
<3
1
>1I
<01
502<11 5-3<11 5?
I<1
1
51 5<I
2
5<I
5
5<>
3
5- 0<5
>
0<2
H
0<?
3
0<>
5
01 3<1
5
3<2
2
3<>
5
2<2
0
2<HH
0- 2<0
I
-<1
0
-<I
5
I<?
0
?<?5 I<
5H
1 31 I<2
0
?<H
>
><5
>
51<
I1
50<?1 52
<I
1
5-<
>1
3- 51<
0
50<
H1
5-<
31
5I<
I1
00<31 0I
<>
1
35<
?1
32<>1
21 5?<
-
00<
31
0I<
11
32<
I1
20<>1 -3
<3
1
?I<
21
?><51 II<?1
2- 33<
-
22<
51
-?<
21
?2<
51
>2<?1 50
1<
11
5-3
<11
5?2<11 021<11 0?
-<1
1
51 5<?
3
5<I
?
5<>
I
5- 0<2
1
0<H
-
0<>
3
3<5
0
01 3<2
-
3<>
1
2<2
1
2<>
H
-<03
-741-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
51 0- -<5
?
-<>
>
H<>
1
?<>
-
><55 ><
H?
31 I<5
?
><H
>
55<
21
53<
-1
5-<>1 5I
<-
1
5><
>1
3- 53<
I
5H<
>1
01<
-1
02<
I1
0><I1 3-
<I
1
20<
31
2H<H
1
21 0-<
-
30<
01
21<
21
2><
>1
H5<?1 ?H
<2
1
551
<11
553<
11
50?<11
2- -0<
>
H><
21
>1<
>1
55H
<11
52I<1
1
iII
<1
1
03>
<11
313<
11
3?-<11 235<11
51 5<?
I
5<I
> +
0<1
5
1# 2,#B 2,B2
1
",11 ","0
20 ",E0 4,"B 4,E2 #,#" #,B"
20 2# @,1B X,12 B,1X E,"E 10,X0 11,
40
"0 10,4 12,"
0
14,4
0
1@,E
0
20,00 2",
20
2#,0
0
"# 1B,X 22,B
0
2X,@
0
"","
0
40,00 4B,
00
#@,B
0
@2,#0
40 "X,2 4@,E
0
#B,@
0
X2,#
0
BE,"0 111
,00
1#B,
00
1@4,0
0
1B#,00
4# B4,0 110,
00
14",
00
1B4,
00
2"4,00 2E
X,0
0
"XB,
00
4XB,0
0
#E2,00 @B0,00
,eduction coe""icient o" passi&e earth pressure
Reduction coefficient * for jVj _
-742-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
[A] * for jVj _
- 5<1 1<I 1<H 1<2 1<0 1<1
51 5<11 1<>>> 1<>H0 1<>0> 1<I>I 1<IH2
5- 5<11 1<>?> 1<>32 1<II5 1<I31 1<??-
01 5<11 1<>HI 1<>15 1<I02 1<?-0 1<H?I
0- 5<11 1<>-2 1<IH1 1<?-> 1<HHH 1<-?2
31 5<11 1<>3? 1<I55 1<HIH 1<-?2 1<2H?
3- 5<11 1<>5H 1<?-0 1<H13 1<2?- 1<3H0
21 5<11 1<IIH 1<HI0 1<-50 1<3?- 1<0H0
2- 5<11 1<I2I 1<H11 1<252 1<0?H 1<5?2
Passi&e earth pressure 6 the /Rller + Breslau theor%
Passive earth pressure follows from the following formula:
where: 2
p
- coefficient of passive earth pressure
c - cohesion of soil

/
- vertical normal total stress
The coefficient of passive earth pressure 2
p
is given by:
where: - angle of internal friction of soil
V - angle of friction structure - soil
Y - slope inclination
G - back face inclination of the structure
The vertical
p0
and horizontal
ph
components of passive earth pressure are given by:
where: V - angle of friction structure - soil
G - back face inclination of the structure
-743-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
3iterature4
M[ller-@reslauZs (rddruc9 auf Stut!mauern<Stuttgart4 ,lfred Mroner-"erlag< 5>1H 7)erman8
Passi&e earth pressure 6 the A)si theor%
Passive earth pressure follows from the following formula:
where: 2
p
- coefficient of passive earth pressure
c - cohesion of soil

/
- vertical normal total stress
The program takes values of the coefficient 2
p
from a database, built upon the tabulated
values published in the book: Krisel, Absi: Active and passive earth Pressure Tables, 3rd Ed.
A.A. Balkema, 1990 ISBN 90 6191886 3.
The vertical
p0
and horizontal
ph
components of passive earth pressureare given by:
where: V - angle of friction structure - soil
G - back face inclination of the structure
3iterature4
MYrisel< ,bsi4 ,ctie and Passie (arth Pressure Tables< 3rd ed:< @al9ema< 5>>1 +S@. >1
H5>5IIH 3
Passi&e earth pressure 6 the Sokolo&ski theor%
Passive earth pressure follows from the following formula:
where: 2
p5
- passive earth pressure coefficient for cohesionless soils
2
pc
- passive earth pressure coefficient due to cohesion
2
pp
- passive earth pressure coefficient due to surcharge

/
- vertical normal total stress
Individual expressions for determining the magnitude of passive earth pressure and slip
surface are introduced in the sequel; the meaning of individual variables is evident from Fig.:
-744-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Passie eart pressure slip surface after So9olos9i
Angles describing the slip surface:
where: - angle of internal friction of soil
V
p
- angle of friction structure - soil
Y - slope inclination
Slip surface radius vector:
Provided that k _ 0 the both straight edges of the zone r
1
and r
2
numerically overlap and
resulting in the plane slip surface developed in the overlapping region. The coefficients of
-745-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
passive earth pressure 2
p5
, 2
pp
, 2
pc
then follow from:
where: - angle of internal friction of soil
V
p
- angle of friction structure - soil
G - back face inclination of the structure
Auxiliary variables: )
p5
, )
pp
, )
pc
, 5
p5
, 5
pp
, 5
pc
, t
p5
, t
pp
, t
pc
f
o
r
:
, ,

, ,

, ,




where:
For soils with zero value for the angle of internal friction the following expressions are
employed to determine the coefficients of passive earth pressure:
where:
-746-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
3iterature4
So9olos9i< ":":< 5>H1: Statics of Soil Media<@utterworth< 3ondon:
Passi&e earth pressure + total stress
When determining the passive earth pressure in cohesive fully saturated soils, in which case
the consolidation is usually prevented (undrained conditions), the horizontal normal total stress

;
receives the form:
where:
;
- horizontal total stress (normal)

/
- vertical normal total stress
2
9c
- coefficient of earth pressure
c
9
- total cohesion of soil
The coefficient of earth pressure 2
9c
is given by:
where: 2
9c
- coefficient of earth pressure
c
9
- total cohesion of soil
a
9
- total adhesion of soil to the structure
3arth pressure at rest
Earth pressure at rest rest is the horizontal pressure acting on the rigid structure. It is usually
assumed in cases, when it is necessary to minimize the lateral and horizontal deformation of
the sheeted soil (e.g. when laterally supporting a structure in the excavation pit up to depth
below the current foundation or in general when casing soil with structures sensitive to non-
uniform settlement), or when structures loaded by earth pressures are due to some
technological reasons extremely rigid and do not allow for deformation in the direction of
loading necessary to mobilize the active earth pressure.
Earth pressure at rest is given by:
For cohesi&e soils the Terzaghi formula for computing 2
r
is implemented in the program:
where: J - Poisson ratio
For cohesionless soils the Jky expression is used:
-747-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: - angle of internal friction of soil
When computing the pressure at rest for cohesive soils
r
using the Jky formula for the
determination of coefficient of earth pressure at rest 2
r
, it is recommended to use the alternate
angle of internal friction
F
.
The way of computing the earth pressure at rest can be therefore influenced by the selection
of the type of soil (cohesive, cohesionless) when inputting its parameters. Even typically
cohesionless soil (sand, gravel) must be introduced as cohesive if we wish to compute the
pressure at rest with the help of the Poisson ratio and vice versa.
For o&erconsolidated soils the expression proposed by Schmertmann to compute the
coefficient of earth pressure at rest 2
r
is used:
where: 2
r
- coefficient of earth pressure at rest
TSR - overconsolidation ratio
The value of the coefficient of earth pressure at rest can be inputted also directl%.
In"luence o" the inclined ground sur"ace at the )ack o" structure on earth pressure at
rest is described here.
3iterature4
,rnold "errui't4 Soil mechanics< Delft Bniersit# of Technolog#< 0115< 011H<
http4;;geo:errui't:net;
3arth pressure at rest "or inclined ground sur"ace at
the )ack o" structure
For inclined ground surface behind the structure (0A _ Y l ) the earth pressure at rest assumes
the form:
where: - angle of internal friction of soil
Y - slope inclination

/
- vertical geostatic stress
2
r
- coefficient of earth pressure at rest
For inclined back of wall the values of earth pressure at rest are derived from:
where: G - back face inclination of the structure

/
- vertical geostatic stress
2
r
- coefficient of earth pressure at rest
Normal and tangential components are given by:
-748-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: G - back face inclination of the structure

/
- vertical geostatic stress
2
r
- coefficient of earth pressure at rest
The deviation angle from the normal line to the wall V reads:
where: G - back face inclination of the structure
2
r
- coefficient of earth pressure at rest
Alternate angle o" internal "riction o" soil
In some cases it appears more suitable for the analysis of earth pressures to introduce for
cohesive soils an alternate angle of internal friction
F
that also accounts for the influence of
cohesive soil in conjunction with the normal stress developed in the soil. The magnitude of the
normal stress for determining the value of alternate angle of internal friction depends on the
type of geotechnical problem, foundation conditions, etc. For deep seated foundation pits or
constructions in homogeneous or relatively simple environment the normal stress is introduced
in the centroid of the loading mass. In case of shallow pits or complex environment the normal
stress is assumed in the heel of the loading diagram see figure:
Determination of normal stress for alternate angle of internal friction of soil Ln
The alternate angle of internal friction of soil is given by:
where:
/
- vertical geostatic stress
- angle of internal friction of soil
c - cohesion of soil
When computing the pressure at rest for cohesive soils
r
using the Jky formula for the
-749-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
determination of coefficient of earth pressure at rest 2
0
, it is recommended to use the
alternate angle of internal friction
F
.
Determination of alternate angle of internal friction of cohesie soil
$istri)ution o" earth pressures in case o" )roken
terrain
Figures show the procedure of earth pressure analysis in the case of sloping terrain. The
resulting shape of earth pressure distribution acting on the construction is obtained from the
sum of triangular distributions developed by individual effects acting on the construction.
Principle of the earth pressure computation in the case of bro9en terrain
-750-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Principle of the earth pressure computation in the case of bro9en terrain for ] ^ L
In"luence o" water
The influence of ground water can be reflected using one of the following variants:
Without ground water, water is not considered

Hydrostatic pressure, ground water behind structure

Hydrostatic pressure, ground water behind and in front of structure

Hydrodynamic pressure

Special distribution of water pressure

(ithout ground water1 water is not considered

(ithout ground water1 water is not considered
In this option the influence of ground water is not considered.
Complementary information:
-751-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
If there are fine soils at and below the level of GWT, one should carefully assess an influence of
full saturation in the region of capillary attraction. The capillary attraction is in the analysis
reflected only by increased degree of saturation, and therefore the value of
sat
is inserted into
parameters of soils.
To distinguish regions with different degree of saturation, one may insert several layers of the
same soil with different unit weights. Negative pore pressures are not considered. However, for
layers with different degree of saturation it is possible to use different values of shear
resistance influenced by suction (difference in pore pressure of water and gas (9
a
- 9
$
).
H%drostatic pressure1 ground water )ehind structure

H%drostatic pressure1 ground water )ehind structure
The heel of a structure is sunk into impermeable subsoil so that the water flow below the
structure is prevented. Water is found behind the back of structure only. There is no water
acting on the front face. Such a case may occur when water in front of structure flow freely
due to gravity or deep drainage is used. The back of structure is loaded by the hydrostatic
pressure:
where:
$
- unit weight of water
h
$
- water tables difference
,ction of h#drostatic pressure
-752-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
H%drostatic pressure1 ground water )ehind and in
"ront o" structure

H%drostatic pressure1 ground water )ehind and in "ront o" structure
The heel of a structure is sunk into impermeable subsoil so that the water flow below the
structure is prevented. The loading due water is assumed both in front of and behind the
structure. The water in front of structure is removed either with the help of gravity effects or is
shallowly lowered by pumping. Both the face and back of structure is loaded by hydrostatic
pressure due to difference in water tables (h
1
and h
2
). The dimension h
$
represents the
difference in water tables at the back and in front of structure - see figure:
,ction of h#drostatic pressure
H%drod%na'ic pressure

H%drod%na'ic pressure
The heel of a structure is sunk into permeable subsoil, which allows free water flow below the
structure see figure. The unit weight of soil lifted by uplift pressure
s9
is modified to account
for flow pressure. These modifications then depend on the direction of water flow.
-753-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
,ction of h#drod#namic pressure
When computing the earth pressure in the area of descending flow the program introduces the
following value of the unit weight of soil:
and in the area of ascending flow the following value:
where:
s9
- unit weight of submerged soil
b - alteration of unit weight of soil
) - an average seepage gradient

$
- unit weight of water
An average hydraulic slope is given:
where: ) - an average seepage gradient
h
$
- water tables difference
,
,
- seepage path downwards
,
9
- seepage path upwards
If the change of unit weight of soil b provided by:
where: ) - an average seepage gradient

$
- unit weight of water
Is greater than the unit weight of saturated soil
s9
, then the leaching appears in front of
-754-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
structure - as a consequence of water flow the soil behaves as weightless and thus cannot
transmit any loading. The program then prompts a warning message and further assumes the
value of = 0. The result therefore no longer corresponds to the original input is safer.
Special distri)ution o" water pressure

Special distri)ution o" water pressure
This option allows an independent (manual) input of distribution of loading due to water at the
back and in front of structure using ordinates of pore pressure at different depths. The
variation of pressure between individual values is linear. At the same time it is necessary to
input levels of tables of full saturation of a soil at the back h
1
and in front h
2
of structure
including possible decrease of unit weight V
?
in front of structure due to water flow.
3a'ple; Two separated horizon lines of ground water.
There are two permeable layers (sand or gravel) with one impermeable layer of clay in
between, which causes separation of two hydraulic horizon lines see figure:
-755-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
(&ample of pore pressure distribution
The variation of pore pressure above the clay layer is driven by free ground water table &%P
1
.
The distribution of pore pressure below the clay layer results from ratio in the lower separated
ground water table &%P
2
, where the ground water is stressed. The pore pressure distribution
in clay is approximately linear.
The capillary attraction is in the analysis reflected only by increased degree of saturation, and
therefore the value of
sat
is inserted into parameters of soils.
To distinguish regions with different degree of saturation, one may insert several layers of the
same soil with different unit weights. Negative pore pressures are not considered. However, for
layers with different degree of saturation it is possible to introduce values of shear resistance
influenced by suction.
Upli"t pressure in "ooting )otto'
The variation of uplift pressure in the footing bottom due to difference in water tables is
assumed according to expected effect linear, parabolic or is not taken into account.
Bplift pressure in footing bottom
In"luence o" tensile cracks
The program makes it possible to account for the influence of tensile surface cracks filled with
water. The analysis procedure is evident from the figure. The depth of tensile cracks is the only
input parameter.
+nfluence of tensile crac9s
/ini'u' di'ensioning pressure
When determining the magnitude and distribution of earth pressures it is very difficult to
-756-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
qualify proportions of individual effects. This situation leads to uncertainty in the determination
of earth pressure loading diagram. In reality we have to use in the design the most adverse
distribution in favor of the safety of structure. For example, in case of braced structures in
cohesive soils when using reasonable values of strength parameters of soil along the entire
structure we may encounter tensile stresses in the upper part of the structure see figure.
Such tensile stresses, however, cannot be exerted on the sheeting structure (consequence of
separation of soil due to technology of construction, isolation and drainage layer). In favor of
the safe design of sheeting structure particularly in subsurface regions, where tensile stresses
are developed during computation of the active earth pressure, the program offers the
possibility to call the option "/ini'u' di'ensioning pressure" in the analysis.
To determine the minimum dimensioning pressure the program employs for layers of cohesive
soils as the minimal value of the coefficient of active earth pressure an alternate coefficient 2
a
= 0,2. Therefore it is ensured that the value of the computed active earth pressure will not drop
below 20% of the vertical pressure (2
a
m 0,2) see figure. Application of the minimum
dimensioning pressure assumes for example the possibility of increasing the lateral pressure
due to filling of joint behind the sheeting structure with rain water. If the option of minimum
dimensioning pressure is not selected the program simply assumes tension cutoff (2
a
m 0,0).
Minimum dimensioning pressure
3arth 6 pressure wedge
Providing a structure with a cantilever jump (foundation slab of cantilever wall, modification for
reduction of earth pressures) is considered when computing earth pressures it is possible to
compute earth pressures acting either on the real back of structure with the inputted angle of
friction V l 2H" or on an alternate back of structure. The alternate back of sheeting structure
replaces the real broken one by a slip plane passing from the upper point of the back of wall
towards the outer upper point of the jump and forms an earth wedge see figure. A fully
mobilized angle of friction V = is assumed along this plane. The weight of earth wedge
created under this alternate back further contributes to loading applied to the structure. To
introduce the alternate back of structure into the analysis it is necessary to select in the
program Earth pressures the option "Consider de&eloping o" earth6pressure wedge". In
other programs the earth wedge is introduced automatically.
-757-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Calculation with and without earth$pressure wedge
Determination of earth$pressure wedge in case of actie earth pressure
The slip plane of the earthpressure wedge is inclined from the horizontal line by angle n
a
given by:
where: - angle of internal friction of soil
Y - slope inclination
V - angle of friction structure - soil
- unit weight of soil
G - back face inclination of the structure
h - height of earth wedge
-758-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The shape of the earth wedge in the layered subsoil is determined such that for individual
layers of soil above the wall foundation the program computes the angle n
a
, which then serves
to determine the angle n
as
. Next, the program determines an intersection of the line drawn
under the angle n
as
from the upper right point of the foundation block with the next layer. The
procedure continues by drawing another line starting from the previously determined
intersection and inclined by the angle n
as
. The procedure is terminated when the line intersects
the terrain or wall surface, respectively. The wedge shape is further assumed in the form of
triangle (intersection with wall) or rectangle (intersection with terrain).
Surcharge
The following types of surcharges are implemented in the program:
Acti&e earth pressure
- Surface surcharge
- Strip surcharge
- Trapezoidal surcharge
- Concentrated surcharge
- Line surcharge
3arth pressure at rest
- Surface surcharge
- Strip surcharge
- Trapezoidal surcharge
- Concentrated surcharge
Passi&e earth pressure
- Surface surcharge
Sur"ace surcharge
The increment of active earth pressure at rest due to surface surcharge is given by:
where: p - vertical uniform loading
2
a
- coefficient of active earth pressure
The vertical uniform loading p applied to the ground surface induces therefore over the entire
height of the structure a constant increment of active earth pressure see figure:
-759-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
+ncrement of actie earth pressure due to ertical uniform ground surface surcharge
Strip surcharge
For vertical strip loading 6
a
acting parallel with structure on the ground surface along an
infinitely long strip the trapezoidal increment of active earth pressure applied to the structure
over a given segment h
6
is assumed see figure.
Diagram of increment of actie earth pressure due to strip loading fa
This segment is determined by intersection of the structure and lines drawn from the edge
points of the strip loading having slopes associated with angles and o
a
. The angle o
a
corresponding to critical slip plane follows from:
The formula is described in detail in section "Acti&e earth pressure line surcharge".
Variation of pressure increment is trapezoidal; the larger intensity of b
6s
is applied at the
upper end while the smaller intensity of b
6)
at the bottom end. The two increments are given
by:
-760-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: 6
a
- magnitude of strip surcharge
> - width of the strip surcharge acting normal to the structure
h
6
- section loaded by active earth pressure increment
where: o
a
- angle of critical slip plane
- angle of internal friction of soil
V - angle of friction structure - soil
The resultant of the increment of active earth pressure due to strip loading 6
a
is provided by:
where: o
a
- angle of critical slip plane
- angle of internal friction of soil
V - angle of friction structure - soil
6
a
- magnitude of strip surcharge
> - width of the strip surcharge
For non-homogeneous soils the program proceeds as follows.
!rape-oidal surcharge
The trapezoidal surcharge is subdivided in the program in ten segments. Individual segments
are treated as strip loadings. The resulting earth pressure is a sum of partial surcharges
derived from individual segments.
Concentrated surcharge
The concentrated load (resultant F due to surface or concentrated load see figure) is
transformed into a line load with a limited length. If the width of surface loading > is smaller
than the distance a from the back of wall (see figure) the alternate line loading 6 having length
172
M
(a7>) receives the form:
where: F - resultant due to surface or concentrated load
-761-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
a - distance of loading from the back of wall
8 - length of load
> - width of surface loading
If the width > of surface loading is greater than the distance a from the back of wall (see
figure) the alternate line loading 6 having length 172.(a7>) and width (a7>) reads:
where: F - resultant due to surface or concentrated load
a - distance of loading from the back of wall
8 - length of load
> - width of surface loading
,lternate loading for calculation of increment of actie earth pressure
For non-homogeneous soils the program proceeds as follows.
#ine surcharge
Vertical infinitely long line loading 6 acting on the ground surface parallel with structure leads to
a triangular increment of active earth pressure applied to the structure over a given segment
h
6
see figure:
-762-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Diagram of increment of actie earth pressure due to ertical line loading acting on ground
surface
Action of the line surcharge is deterimened such that two lines are drawn from the point of
application following angles ando
a
(corresponding to the critical slip surface), which is provided
by:
where: - angle of internal friction of soil
K - angle derived from the following formulas
where: Y - slope inclination
- angle of internal friction of soil
V - angle of friction structure - soil
G - back face inclination of the structure
c - cohesion of soil
- unit weight of soil
h - assumed depth
For non-homogeneous soil and inclination of ground surface]smaller than the angle of internal
friction of the soil the value of the angle K is given by:
-763-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: Y - slope inclination
- angle of internal friction of soil
V - angle of friction structure - soil
G - back face inclination of the structure
The resultant of the increment of active earth pressure due to line loading 6 is provided by:
where: o
a
- angle of critical slip plane
- angle of internal friction of soil
V - angle of friction structure - soil
6 - magnitude of line surcharge
For non-homogeneous soils the program proceeds as follows.
Surcharge in non6ho'ogeneous soil
For non-homogeneous soil we proceed as follows:
- Compute the angle o
a
for a given soil layer.
- Determine the corresponding magnitude of force S
a
and size of the corresponding pressure
diagram.
- Determine the magnitude of earth pressure acting below the bottom edge of a given layer,
and its ratio with respect to the overall pressure magnitude.
- The surcharge is reduced using the above ratio, then the location of this surcharge on the
upper edge of the subsequent layer is determined.
- Compute again the angle o
a
for the next layer and repeat the previous steps until the
bottom of a structure is reached or the surcharge is completely exhausted.
Sur"ace surcharge
An increment of uniformly distributed earth pressure at rest b
r
caused by the vertical surface
loading applied on the ground surface behind the structure is computed using the following
formula:
where: 6 - magnitude of surface surcharge
2
r
- coefficient of earth pressure at rest
-764-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Diagram of increment of earth pressure at rest due to ertical uniform loading acting on
ground surface
Strip surcharge
Uniform strip loading 6
a
acting on the ground surface behind the structure parallel with vertical
structure (see figure) creates an increment of earth pressure at rest b
r
having the magnitude
given by:
where: 6
a
- vertical strip surcharge
G, G
1
, G
2
- evident from figure
+ncrement of earth pressure due to ertical strip surcharge
-765-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
!rape-oidal surcharge
The trapezoidal surcharge is subdivided in the program in five segments. Individual segments
are treated as strip loadings. The resulting earth pressure is a sum of partial surcharges
derived from individual segments.
Concentrated surcharge
Application of concentrated load yields an increment of earth pressure at rest b
r
acting on the
vertical structure and having the magnitude of:
where: F - concentrated force acting on ground surface
;, / - coordinates evident from figure
+ncrement of earth pressure at rest due to ertical concentrated force
Sur"ace surcharge
For passive earth pressure only an increment due to vertical uniform loading 6
a
is determined
using the formula:
where: 6
a
- vertical surface surcharge
2
p
- coefficient of passive earth pressure
The vertical uniform loading acting on the ground surface therefore results in a constant
increment of passive pressure applied over the whole length of wall - see figure.
-766-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
+ncrement of the passie earth pressure
In"luence o" earthHuake
Earthquake increases the effect of active pressure and reduces the effect of passive pressure.
The theories used in our programs (Mononobe-Okabe, Arrango) are derived assuming
cohesionless soils without influence of water. Therefore, all inputted soils are assumed
cohesionless when employing these theories to address the earthquake effects. Earthquake
effects due to surcharge are not considered in the program the user may introduce these
effects (depending on the type of surcharge) as "Applied "orces"
The coefficient k
h
is assumed always positive and such that its effect is always unfavorable.
The coefficient k
0
may receive both positive and negative value. If the equivalent acceleration
a
0
acts downwards (from the ground surface) the inertia forces k
0
M%
s
will be exerted on the
soil wedge in the opposite direction (lifting the wedge up). The values of equivalent
acceleration a
0
(and thus also the coefficient k
0
) and inertia forces k
0
M%
s
are assumed as
positive. It is clearly evident that the inertia forces act in the direction opposite to acceleration
(if the acceleration is assumed upwards a
0
= - k
0
M5 then the inertia force presses the soil
wedge downwards: - k
0
M%
s
. The direction with most unfavorable effects on a structure is
assumed when examining the seismic effects.
For sheeting structures it is possible to neglect the effect of vertical equivalent acceleration
k
0
M%
s
and input k
0
= 0.
-767-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Sign conention
The seismic angle of inertia is determined from the coefficients k
h
and k
0
(i.e. angle between
the resultant of inertia forces and the vertical line) using the formula:
where: k
0
- seismic coefficient of vertical acceleration
k
h
- seismic coefficient of horizontal acceleration
Pressure "ro' seis'ic e""ects
Increment of active earth pressure due to seismic effects (computed from the structure
bottom) follows from:
where:
)
-
unit weight of soil in the )
th
layer
2
ae,
)

-
coefficient of active earth pressure (static and seismic) in the )
th
layer
2
a,)
-
magnitude of earth pressure in the )
th
layer due to Coulomb
h
)
-
thickness of the )
th
layer
k
0
- seismic coefficient of vertical acceleration
Reduction of passive pressure due to seismic loading (computed from the structure bottom) is
provided by:
-768-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where:
)
-
unit weight of soil in the )
th
layer
2
pe,
)

-
coefficient of passive earth pressure (static and seismic) in the )
th
layer
2
p,)
-
magnitude of earth pressure in the )
th
layer due to Coulomb
h
)
-
thickness of the )
th
layer
k
0
- seismic coefficient of vertical acceleration
Active earth pressure coefficient2
ae,)
and passive earth pressure coefficient2
pe,)
are computed
using the Mononobe-Okabe theory or the Arrango theory. If there is ground water in the soil
body the program takes that into account.
The basic assumption in the program when computing earthquake is a flat ground surface
behind structure with inclination Y. If that is not the case the program approximates the shape
of terrain by a flat surface as evident from figure:
Terrain shape appro&imation
Point o" application o" resultant "orce
The resultant force is automatically positioned by the program into the center of the stress
diagram. Various theories recommend, however, different locations of the resultant force
owing to that it is possible to select the point of application of the resultant force in the range
of 0,"" - 0,Xe (e is the structure height). Recommended (implicit) value is 0,@@e. Having the
resultant force the program determines the trapezoidal shape of stress keeping both the
inputted point of application of the resultant force and its magnitude.
/onono)e+Oka)e theor%
The coefficient 2
ae
for active earth pressure is given by:
-769-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The coefficient 2
pe
for passive earth pressure is given by:
where: - unit weight of soil
e - height of the structure
- angle of internal friction of soil
V - angle of friction structure - soil
G - back face inclination of the structure
Y - slope inclination
k
0
- seismic coefficient of vertical acceleration
k
h
- seismic coefficient of horizontal acceleration
* - seismic inertia angle
Deviation of seismic forces *must be for active earth pressure always less or equal to the
difference of the angle of internal friction and the ground surface inclination (i.e. - Y). If the
values *of is greater the program assumes the value * = - Y. In case of passive earth
pressure the value of deviation of seismic forces *must be always less or equal to the sum of
the angle of internal friction and the ground surface inclination (i.e. 7 Y). The values of
computed and modified angle * can be visualized in the output in latter case the word
/O$IFI3$ is also displayed.
(&ample of the program output
3iterature4
Mononobe .< Matsuo H 5>0>< *n the determination of earth pressure during earthAua9es: +n
Proc: *f the %orld (ngineering Conf:< "ol: >< str: 5?H
*9abe S:< 5>0H )eneral theor# of earth pressure: Pournal of the Papanese Societ# of Ciil
(ngineers< To9#o< Papan 50 758
Arrango theor%
The program follows the Coulomb theory to compute the values of 2
a
and 2
p
while taking into
-770-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
account the dynamic values (G
M
, Y
M
).
For acti&e earth pressure;
For passi&e earth pressure;
where: Y - slope inclination
G - back face inclination of the structure
* - seismic forces inclination
The coefficients of earth pressures 2
ae
and 2
pe
are found by multiplying the coefficients F
ae
and F
pe
by the values of 2
a
and 2
p
, respectively.
where: G - back face inclination of the structure
* - seismic forces inclination
If the value of the angle Y
M
becomes larger than the program assumes the value (Y
M
= ).
The values of computed and modified angle Y
M
can be visualized in the output in latter case
the word /O$IFI3$ is also displayed. It is the user's responsibility to check in such case
whether the obtained results are realistic.
(&ample of the program output
3iterature4
Design of sheet pile walls< Pile @uc9 +nc:< "ero @each< Florida< www:pilebuc9:com
In"luence o" water
When examining the influence of ground water on the magnitudes of earth pressure the
program differentiates between confined and unconfined water. Hydrodynamic pressure acting
on the front face of the wall is calculated, if the wall is flooded at the front face side.
-771-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Con"ined water
This type is used in soils with lower permeability app. below the value of k = 1;10
-"
cmHs. In
such soils the water flow is influenced, e.g. by actual grains (by their shape and roughness) or
by resistance of fraction of adhesive water. General formulas proposed by Mononobe-Okabe or
Arrango are used to analyze seismic effects. The only difference appears in substituting the
value of the seismic angle *by *
M
:
where:
sat
- unit weight of fully saturated soil

s9
- unit weight of submerged soil
k
h
- seismic coefficient of horizontal acceleration
k
0
- seismic coefficient of vertical acceleration
Uncon"ined water
This type is used in soils with higher permeability app. above the value of k I 1;10
-1
cmHs. In
such soils it is assumed that water flow in pores is more or less independent of soil grains (e.g.
turbulent flow in coarse grain soils). General formulas proposed by Mononobe-Okabe or
Arrango are used to analyze seismic effects. The only difference appears in substituting the
value of the seismic angle *
e
by *
e
7
:
where:
,
- unit weight of dry soil

s9
- unit weight of submerged soil
k
h
- seismic coefficient of horizontal acceleration
k
0
- seismic coefficient of vertical acceleration
&
S
- specific gravity of soil particles
where: [
S
- density of the soil solids
[
$
- density of water
Apart from dynamic pressure the structure is also loaded by hydrodynamic pressure caused by
free water manifested by dynamic pressure applied to the structures. The actual parabolic
distribution is in the program approximated by the trapezoidal distribution.
The resultant of hydrodynamic pressure )ehind the structure P
$,
is distant by ?
$,
from the
heel of structure:
-772-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: e - height of the structure
and its magnitude follows from:
where:
$
- unit weight of water
k
h
- seismic coefficient of horizontal acceleration
e - height of the structure
H%drod%na'ic pressure acting on the "ront "ace o" the wall
The resultant of hydrodynamic pressure on the "ront "ace o" the wall P
$,
is distant by ?
$,
from the heel of structure:
where: e - height of the structure
and its magnitude follows from:
where:
$
- unit weight of water
k
h
- seismic coefficient of horizontal acceleration
e - height of the structure
3. 1DDM6B Seis'ic e""ects
If the coefficients k
h
and k
0
are not obtained from measurements it is necessary, providing the
analysis is carried out according to 1998-5 Eurocode 8: Design of structures for earthquake
resistance - Part 5: Foundations, retaining structures and geotechnical aspects, to input these
coefficients as follows:
where: G - ratio of the design ground acceleration on type A ground (a
5
H 5)
S - soil factor defined in EN 1998-1:2004, chapter 3.2.2.2
R - factor for the calculation of the horizontal seismic coefficient see tab.
for:


for other cases:

!%pe o" sheeting structure R
Free gravity walls that can accept a displacement up to (mm)
2
-773-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Free gravity walls that can accept a displacement up to (mm)
1,#
Flexural reinforced concrete walls, anchored or braced walls, reinforced concrete walls
founded on vertical piles, restrained basement walls and bridge abutments
1
/ore detailed description can )e "ound in 3. 1DDM6B chapter E040202 Seis'ic e""ects
Forces "ro' earth pressure at rest acting on the rigid
structure
Earth pressure at rest acts on the rigid structures (e.g. stem of the cantilever wall) in
earthquake analysis. Following resultant force of this pressure is taken into account:
where: p - height of the structure
k
h
- seismic coefficient of horizontal acceleration
- unit weight of soil
Resultant force acts in the half of the structure height.
In"luence o" "riction )etween soil and )ack o"
structure
The magnitude of active or passive earth pressure, respectively, depends not only on the
selected solution theory but also on friction between the soil and the back of wall and by the
adhesion of soil to the structure face represented by the angle V. If V = 0 then the pressure
acts in the direction normal to the back of wall and the resultant of earth pressure P is also
directed in normal to the back of wall see figure:
Distribution of earth pressure along structure for _ ` 1
Providing the friction between the soil and the back of wall is considered in the analysis of
earth pressures, the earth pressure and also its resultant P are inclined from the back of wall
by the angle V. Orientation of friction angles Vfrom normal to the back of wall must be
introduced in accord with the mutual movement of structure and soil. With increasing value of
Vthe value of active earth pressure decreases, i.e. the resultant force of active earth pressure
deviates from the normal direction see figure:
-774-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Distribution of earth pressure along structure for _ a 1
The magnitude _ can be usually found in the range of V l 1H" to V = 2H". The values of
orientation of the friction angle V between the soil and the structure are stored in table of
values of Vfor various interfaces and in table of recommended values for jVj H . The value of V
l 1H"can be used if assuming smooth treatment of the back of sheeting structure (foil and
coating against ground water). For untreated face it is not reasonable to exceed the value of
V = 2H". When selecting the value of Vit is necessary to reflect also other conditions,
particularly the force equation of equilibrium in the vertical direction. One should decide
whether the structure is capable of transmitting the vertical surcharge due to friction on its
back without excessive vertical deformation. Otherwise it is necessary to reduce the value of V,
since only partial mobilization of friction on the back of wall may occur. In case of uncertainty it
is always safer to assume smaller vale of V.
!a)le o" ulti'ate "riction "actors "or dissi'ilar
'aterials
5alues o" the angle V "or di""erent inter"aces (after NAVFAC)
Inter"ace 'aterial Friction
"actor t5(V)
Friction
angle VA
/ass concrete on the "ollowing "oundation
'aterials;
Clean sound rock 1<?1 3-
Clean gravel, gravel-sand mixtures, coarse sand 1<-- - 1<H 0> - 35
Clean fine to medium sand, silty medium to coarse sand,
silty or clayey gravel
1<2- - 1<--
Clean fine sand, silty or clayey fine to medium sand 1<3- - 1<2- 5> - 02
Fine sandy silt, nonplastic silt 1<31 - 1<31 5? - 5>
Very stiff and hard residual or preconsolidated clay 1<21 - 1<-1 00 - 0H
Medium stiff and stiff clay and silty clay 1<31 - 1<3- 5? - 5>
-775-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Steel sheet piles against the "ollowing soils;
Clean gravel, gravel-sand mixtures, well-graded rock fill
with spalls
1<21 00
Clean sand, silty sand-gravel mixture, single size hard
rock fill
1<31 5?
Silty sand, gravel or sand mixed with silt or clay 1<0- 52
Fine sandy silt, nonplastic silt 1<01 55
For'ed concrete or concrete sheet piling against
the "ollowing soils;
Clean gravel, gravel-sand mixture, well-graded rock fill
with spalls
1<21 - 1<-1 00 - 0H
Clean sand, silty sand-gravel mixture, single size hard
rock fill
1<31 - 1<21 5? - 00
Silty sand, gravel or sand mixed with silt or clay 1<31 5?
Fine sandy silt, nonplastic silt 1<0- 52
5arious structural 'aterials;
Dressed soft rock on dressed soft rock 1<?1 3-
Dressed hard rock on dressed soft rock 1<H- 33
Dressed hard rock on dressed hard rock 1<-- 0>
Masonry on wood (Gross grain) 1<-1 0H
Steel on steel at sheet pile interlocks 1<31 5?
Adhesion o" soil
When performing the analysis in the total stress state it is necessary not only to use the total
shear strength parameters of soil
9
, c
9
but also to know the adhesion a of soil to the structure
face. The value of adhesion a is usually considered as a fraction of the soil cohesion c. The
typical values of a for a given range of the cohesion c are listed in the following table.
Co''on &alues o" the adhesion o" soil a
-776-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Soil Cohesion c [kPa] Adhesion a [kPa]
Soft and very soft cohesive
soil
1 - 50 1 $ 50
Cohesive soil with medium
consistency
50 - 02 50 $ 02
Stiff cohesive soil 02 - 2I 02 - 3H
Hard cohesive soil 2I - >H 3H $ 2H
Para'eters o" rocks
Rock parameters of orientation with respect to strength of rock in pure compression
Co'pressi&
e strength
o" rock

c)
[!Pa]
Strength para'eter o"
rock a"ter Hoek
m
)
[-]
GSI
[-]
Cohesion o"
rock
c [kPa]
Angle o" internal
"riction o" rock
[A]
5-1 0- ?- ?111 - 53111 2H - HI
I1 50 -1 3111 - 2111 31 - H-
-1 5H ?- 0111 - 2111 21 - H1
31 5- H- 5111 - 0111 21 - H1
01 I 31 211 - H11 01 - 22
5- 51 02 311 - -11 02 - 3I
- 51 01 >1 - 511 03 - 0I
Unlike soils (both cohesive and cohesionless) the magnitude of the angle of internal friction
(sometimes refer to as the angle of shear strength) varies and depends on the current state of
stress in the rock body. Graphically it is represented by the angle of the tangent to the
envelope of Mohr circles constructed for the ultimate stress state. The value of gradually
decreases with the increasing value of stress . If the elastic regime is exceeded (onset of
plastic deformation) we set = 0. As a representative value of the angle of internal friction we
denote the value
0
associated with the stress = 0. In practical applications the part of the
Mohr envelope between tensile R
t
and compressive R
,
circles is usually replaced by the tangent
to both circles (see Fig.) The magnitude of the angle of internal friction then follows from:
-777-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Determination L1 from Mohr circle
The angle of internal friction can be estimated by measuring angles of slip planes on remaining
parts of tested specimens together with the following formula:
So'e &alues o" orientation;
weathered sand conglomerate, lowly cracked 3- $ 22b
unweathered clay slate, medium cracked 31 - 21b
unweathered tuff, medium cracked 33 $ 20b
unweathered diabase 3> $ -1b
unweathered phantanite, lowly cracked 2- $ -0b
.ailed slopes
The program ".ailed Slopes" allows for the following verifications:
- Verification of structure internal stability (plane or broken slip surface, bearing capacity of
nails)
- Verification of fictitious wall - the same as gravity wall
- Verification of structure concrete cover (dimensioning)
- Verification of overall stability using the program "Slope Sta)ilit%"
Anal%sis o" internal sta)ilit%
An internal stability of a structure is checked assuming two types of a slip surface:
- Plane slip sur"ace
-778-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Plane slip surface
- Broken slip sur"ace
@ro9en slip surface
In both cases a specific slip surface is examined for a variation of angle o.
When running an opti'i-ation analysis the calculation is carried out for all benches with a
variation of the angle of slip surface c changing from 1 up to BE degrees with a one degree
step.
A verification analysis of internal stability can be performed using either the factor of safety or
the theory of limit states depending on the setting in the "Wall analysis" tab sheet.
The analysis checks whether a ratio of resisting and shear (driving) forces acting on a slip
surface is greater than the inputted factor of safety. The following forces are employed:
Shear "orces;
- component of gravity force parallel to slip surface
- in case of broken slip surface component of active earth pressure acting on vertical part
of structure and parallel to slip surface (pressure is determined without reduction of input
parameters)
- horizontal forces due to earthquake
,esisting "orces;
- soil friction and cohesion along slip surface
- sum of forces transmitted by nails
Anal%sis o" nails )earing capacit%
For each nail the following bearing capacities are either computed or inputted:
R
6
nail head strength
R
t
nail strength against breaking
P
p
pull-out nail bearing capacity
Strength characteristics o" a nail represent the basic parameters to compute the total
bearing capacity of a nail.
!he nail strength against )reaking follows from:
-779-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: R
t
- strength against breaking
,
s
- nail diameter
6
?
- strength of nail material
Sq
P
- factor of safety against breaking
!he pull6out nail )earing capacit% is calculated by one of the following ways:
1. calculate from ultimate bond strength:
where: P
p
- pull-out nail bearing capacity [k3Hm]
, - hole diameter
5
s
- ultimate bond strength
Sq
e
- factor of safety against pull-out
2. calculate from effective stress
where:
where: P
p
- pull-out nail bearing capacity [k3Hm]
, - hole diameter

/
- vertical geostatic stress
- effective angle of internal friction of soil
c - effective cohesion of soil
Sq
e
- factor of safety against pull-out
. calculate according to !" 68#$4
where: P
p
- pull-out nail bearing capacity [k3Hm]
, - hole diameter

F
- average radial effective stress
- effective angle of internal friction of soil
-780-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
c - effective cohesion of soil
Sq
e
- factor of safety against pull-out
Average radial effective stress
F
is calculated by following formula:
where:
/
- vertical geostatic stress
where:
.ail head strength is evaluated by formula:
where: 8 - nail length
S
ma;
- maximum spacing of nails in a structure
R
t
- nail strength against breaking
P
p
- pull-out nail bearing capacity
Sq
6
- factor of safety of nail head strength
If the nail is not anchored to the structure cover, it is possible to set the nail head strength to
zero.
3sti'ated )ond strength
3sti'ated )ond strength o" soil nails in soil and rock (source: Elias a Juran, 1991)
/aterial Construction
'ethod
Soil 9 rock t%pe Ulti'ate )ond
strength
s
[kPa]
,ock ,otar% drilled Marl / limestone 311 - 211
Phyllite 511 - 311
Chalk -11 - H11
Soft dolomite 211 - H11
Fissured dolomite H11 - 5111
Weathered
sandstone
011 - 311
-781-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Weathered shale 511 - 5-1
Weathered schist 511 - 5?-
Basalt -11 - H11
Slate / hard shale 311 - 211
Cohesionless
soils
,otar% drilled Sand / gravel 511 - 5I1
Silty sand 511 - 5-1
Silt 21 - 501
Piedmont residual 21 - 501
Fine colluvium ?- - 5-1
$ri&en casing Sand / gravel
- low overburden
- high overburden
5>1 - 021
0I1 - 231
Dense moraine 3I1 - 2I1
Colluvium 511 - 5I1
Augered Silty sand fill 01 - 21
Silty fine sand -- - >1
Silty clayey sand H1 - 521
Jet grouted Sand 3I1
Sand gravel ?11
Fine 6 grained
soils
,otar% drilled Silty clay 3- - -1
$ri&en casing Clayey silt >1 - 521
Augered Loess 0- - ?-
Soft clay 01 - 31
Stiff clay 21 - H1
Stiff clayey silt 21 - 511
Calcareous sandy
clay
>1 - 521
.ote: Convert values in kPa to ps6 by multiplying by 20.9, Convert values in kPa to ps) by
multiplying by 0.145
-782-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
!otal )earing capacit% o" nail
Bearing capacity of nail is determined based on the location of its intersection with a slip
surface. If a nail is found completely in front of the slip surface, then it does not enter the
calculation. If a nail crosses the slip surface, then its bearing capacity is determined as:
where: ; - nail length behind slip surface in direction of soil body
? - nail length in front of slip surface
R
6
- nail cap bearing capacity
R
t
- nail strength against breaking
P
p
- pull-out nail bearing capacity
Distribution of tensile force along nail
5eri"ication + "actor o" sa"et%
The analysis checks whether a ratio of resisting and shear (driving) forces acting on a slip
surface is greater than the inputted factor of safety.
A factor of safety on the inputted slips forces is thus provided by:
where: & - gravity force
-783-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
S
a,s0
- vertical component of active pressure
S
a,0o,
- horizontal component of active pressure
,
)
-
length of i
th
section slip surface
, - length of slip surface
F
h,F
-
bearing capacity of n
th
nail behind slip surface per 1 running meter
c
)
-
cohesion of i
th
soil layer

)
-
angle o internal friction of i
th
layer
n - inclination of slip surface
G - inclination of nails from horizontal direction
5eri"ication + theor% o" li'it states
The analysis checks whether the passi&e (resisting) "orces F
p
acting on a slip surface are
greater than the acti&e (shear) "orces F
a
:
where: & - gravity force
S
a,s0
- vertical component of active pressure
S
a,0o,
- horizontal component of active pressure
,
)
-
length of )
th
section slip surface
, - length of slip surface
F
h,F
-
bearing capacity of F
th
nail behind slip surface per 1 running meter
c
)
-
cohesion of )
th
soil layer

)
-
angle of internal friction of )
th
layer
n - inclination of slip surface
G - inclination of nails from horizontal direction
.ail "orce
The magnitude of acti&e earth pressure is reduced using a coefficient k
F
, which can also be
introduced in the frame "Settings". The recommended (experimentally determined) value
-784-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
is k
F
= 0,B#.
Forces transmitted by individual nails are determined such that a particular portion of the
calculated earth pressure is assigned to a gi&en )ench. Each nail is then loaded by the
corresponding portion of the active earth pressure.
Forces transmitted b# indiidual nails
The nail "orce is provided by:
where: > - nail spacing
G - nail inclination
k
F
- reduction coefficient
P
a,0o,
- active earth pressure acting on a given bench
$i'ensioning o" concrete co&er
!he concrete co&er o" a nailed slope is designed to sustain an active earth pressure. So,
the structure is assumed to be subdivided into individual intermediate design strips.
In the &ertical direction the nail cap is modeled as a support and joint between benches as
an internal hinge.
In the hori-ontal direction the program generates (by default) a structure with five supports
uniformly loaded by the magnitude of active pressure up to a depth of the nail cap.
The program further allows for the verification of concrete cover reinfocement of a structure
loaded by the bending moment.
Constructing scheme of the 'odel design including loading is evident from the figure:
-785-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dimensioning of concrete coer
/S3 (all
The program performs the following verifications:
5eri"ication
The analysis performs verification of the external stability of so called "ictitious structure
consisting of the structure front face and a curve bounding the geo-reinforcements end points.
The fictitious structure is loaded by calculated forces acting on the structure and checked for
o&erturning and slip similarly to the verification of a gravity wall.
$i'ensioning
From the calculated forces acting on a structure the program determines the forces in the
checker cross-section. Only the forces above the checked joint (see figure) are taken into
account. Reinforcements introduce stabilizing forces which equal to the lower value of the two
bearing capacities (against tearing and pull-out). The actual verification for o&erturning and
slip follows next. The program also allows for an automatic verification of the most critical
cross-section.
Bearing capacit%
The bearing capacity of foundation soil below a "ictitious structure is checked. The constant
stress in the foundation joint is determined from all forces acting on a structure and calculated
in the "Verification" frame. In case of the inputted foundation the bearing capacity is
determined from all forces calculated in the "Dimensioning" frame (the option "3ntire wall"
-786-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
must be selected).
Slip on georein"orce'ent
The slip of a rein"orced soil )lock along a geo-reinforcement is checked. The reinforced block
is bounded the wall front face, the checked geo-reinforcement, a vertical line passing through
the geo-reinforcement end point and terrain. The block is loaded by an active earth pressure
and by stabilizing forces due to geo-reinforcements exceeding the boundary of the reinforced
block and by other forces. The program also allows for an automatic verification for sliding
along individual reinforcements and for finding the most critical result.
Internal sta)ilit%
Individual geo-reinforcements are checked for tearing and pull6out from an earth body. The
program also allows for an automatic verification of the most critical reinforcement.
Glo)al sta)ilit%
The program enables to check the overall slope stability along a circular slip surface. The slip
surface can be automatically optimized, i.e. the program automatically selects the verification
along the most critical surface. The actual slope stability analysis can be carried out with the
help of two slice methods: Spencer (rigorous, more accurate method) and Bishop (more
conservative, simpler, more easily finds the solution satisfying equilibrium conditions).
Slope sta)ilit%
Verification of overall (global) stability by the "Slope sta)ilit%" program.
Internal sta)ilit%
Geo6rein"orce'ent "orce
Determination of forces in geo-reinforcements is performed by splitting and assigning the
calculated earth pressure to individual layers. Each reinforcement accommodates part of the
active pressure, which acts in the corresponding la%er, i.e. force developed in the
reinforcement F
;
= rP
a,hor
. The calculation is always performed for flat terrain. Influence of
broken terrain is considered as an additional surcharge (increase of geostatic stress
/
). Earth
pressure is considered as an active for extensible reinforcements (Standard - straight slip
surface, AASHTO - Extensible, FHWA NHI-10-024), or as a combination of pressures for
inextensible reinforcements (AASHTO - Inextensible, JTGD30 - 2004 Highway China Code, TB
10025 Railway China Code, BS 8006 - Coherent Gravity Method). Slip surface has a different
shape (straight, broken) according to the selected standard of calculation.
Forces transmitted b# indiidual reinforcements
-787-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
,ein"orce'ent strength check
Long-term design strength of geo-reinforcement R
t
is calculated from the inputted parameters
of the geo-reinforcement:
where: R
t
- long-term design strength of reinforcement
P
98t
- short-term characteristic strength of geo-reinforcement
RF
S
R
- reduction coefficient of long-term deformation of reinforcement (determined
based on geo-reinforcement lifetime)
RF
<
- reduction coefficient of durability of reinforcement (determined based on soil
pH)
RF
1
<
- reduction coefficient of failure of reinforcement when inserting into the soil
(determined based on the grain sizes of soil)
FS
s
3S
- overall coefficient of model uncertainty
,ein"orce'ent )earing capacit% against pull6out
Strength of reinforcement against pull-out from the earth body is calculated from the inputted
parameters of the geo-reinforcement and the normal force acting in the direction normal to its
area:
where: P
p
- bearing capacity against tearing
D - reinforcement length (from front face to its end)
S
)
- coefficient of interaction between soil and geo-reinforcement

/
- vertical geostatic stress
- angle of internal friction of soil
5eri"ication of bearing capacity of reinforcement against pull-out can be carried out according
to the factor of safety or the theory of limit states.
5eri"ication + "actor o" sa"et%
The main advantage of this verification is lucidity and uniqueness, since neither soil
parameters nor acting forces are reduced.
Check "or tearing;
where: F
;
- force developed in reinforcement
-788-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
R
t
- long-term design strength of reinforcement
SF
st
- safety factor for geo-reinforcement strength (inputted in the "Wall analysis"
tab sheet)
Check "or pull6out;
where: F
;
- force developed in reinforcement
P
p
- bearing capacity of reinforcement against pull-out
SF
po
- safety factor for pull out resistance of geo-reinforcement (inputted in the
frame "Wall analysis" tab sheet)
5eri"ication + li'it states
The soil parameters are reduced depending on the setting in the "Wall analysis" tab sheet.
The result is the reinforcement utilization compared with 100 %.
Check "or tearing;
where: F
;
- force developed in reinforcement
R
t
- long-term design strength of reinforcement against tearing
Check "or pull6out;
where: F
;
- force developed in reinforcement
P
p
- bearing capacity of reinforcement against pull-out
Shapes o" slip sur"aces
Slip surface has a different shape according to the selected standard of calculation:
- Straight slip sur"ace - Standard, AASHTO - Extensible, FHWA NHI-10-024
- Broken slip sur"ace - AASHTO - Inextensible, JTGD30 - 2004 Highway China Code, TB
10025 Railway China Code, BS 8006 - Coherent Gravity Method.
-789-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Shapes of slip surfaces according to the indiidual standards of calculation
3tensi)le rein"orce'ents 6 acti&e earth pressure
For extensible reinforcements (Standard - straight slip surface, AASHTO - Extensible, FHWA
NHI-10-024) is considered active earth pressure in the calculation of internal stability. The
program allows to multiply the calculated earth pressure by coefficient k
r
/k
a
(according to the
AASHTO standards). Recommended values are shown in the following picture.
-790-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
"ariation of the coefficient of hori!ontal stress ratio 9r;9a with depth for e&tensible
reinforcements
3iterature4
,,SHT* 36FD @ridge Design Specifications 0112 7S+8:
Inetensi)le rein"orce'ents 6 co')ination o" earth
pressures
For inextensible reinforcements (AASHTO - Inextensible, JTGD30 - 2004 Highway China Code,
TB 10025 Railway China Code, BS 8006 - Coherent Gravity Method) is considered a
combination of active earth pressure and earth pressure at rest in the calculation of internal
stability.
-791-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Determination of failure plane location and ariation of earth pressure coefficients Ma< Mo with
depth for ine&tensible reinforcements
3iterature4
,,SHT* Highwa# @ridges:
(all anal%sis
Verification analysis of walls can be performed with the help of:
- theory of limit state (when performing the analysis according to 3. 1DDE or #,F$ the
structure is verified in this particular way)
- factor of safety
In addition, the bearing capacity of foundation soil is examined for both cases.
Following forces are used in the verification:
- weight o" wall depends on the shape and unit weight of wall (for input use the
"/aterial" dialog window) uplift pressure is introduced for walls found below the
groundwater table
- resistance on "ront "ace when inputting the resistance on front face the corresponding
force acts as the pressure at rest, or passive pressure or reduced passive pressure
- gravity forces of earth wedges an arbitrary number of these forces may occur depending
on the shape of structure
- active earth pressure or pressure at rest acting on the structure the basic loading of
structure due earth pressures - depending on the selected option in the frame "Settings"
the pressure is computed either with or without reduction of input soil parameters
-792-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- forces due to water effects or pore pressure, respectively
- forces due to surcharge a single force corresponds to each inputted surcharge. If the
magnitude of force due to surcharge is equal to zero (the surcharge has no effect on a
structure) then it does not appear in the picture but only in the table listing
- inputted "orces forces entering the analysis are displayed
- "orces due to earthHuake several forces enter the analysis due to earthquake
increase of earth pressure acting on a structure, reduction of passive pressure on the front
face of a structure, or force due to free water behind structure
- mesh step joints and reinforcements are displayed and included providing they appear in
the analysis
- base anchorage of wall
3&aluation o" "orces in the "ooting )otto'
After computing forces acting on the structure the program determines the overall vertical F
0
and horizontal F
h
forces, computes the forces acting in the footing bottom (normal force 3 and
shear force e):
Forces acting in the footing bottom
5eri"ication + li'it states
Program evaluates normal and shear force in the footing bottom and then verifies the wall
against overturning and sliding. For walls with a flat footing bottom and specified jump it is
possible to account for the wall jump either in the form of pressure acting on the front face or
by considering a wall with an inclined footing bottom.
Check "or o&erturning sta)ilit%;
where: !
o0r
- overturning moment

o
- reduction coefficient of overturning
!
res
- resisting moment
-793-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Check "or slip;
kde: 3 - normal force acting in the footing bottom

,
- design angle of friction structure-soil
c
,
- design cohesion structure-soil
, - width of wall heel
e - eccentricity

s
- reduction coefficient of sliding resistance
e - shear force acting in the footing bottom
F
res
- resisting force (from georeinforcement and mesh overlap)
- reduction coefficient of contact base - soil
where eccentricity e:
where: !
o0r
- overturning moment
!
res
- resisting moment
3 - normal force acting in the footing bottom
, - width of wall heel
Horizontal components of forces are included in the shear force and overturning moment,
vertical components of forces are included in the normal force and resisting moment. The
resisting forces and moments also include horizontal forces from georeinforcements and
overlapping meshes.
5eri"ication 6 sa"et% "actor
Program evaluates normal and shear force in the footing bottom and then verifies the wall
against overturning and sliding. For walls with a flat footing bottom and specified jump it is
possible to account for the wall jump either in the form of pressure acting on the front face or
by considering a wall with an inclined footing bottom.
Check "or o&erturning sta)ilit%;
where: !
o0r
- overturning moment
!
res
- resisting moment
SF
o
- safety factor for overturning
Check "or slip;
-794-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
s
kde: 3 - normal force acting in the footing bottom

,
- design angle of friction structure-soil
c - cohesion structure-soil
, - width of wall heel
e - eccentricity
e - shear force acting in the footing bottom
F
res
- resisting force (from georeinforcement and mesh overlap)
SF
s
- safety factor foe sliding resistance
- reduction coefficient of contact base - soil
where eccentricity e:
where: !
o0r
- overturning moment
!
res
- resisting moment
3 - normal force acting in the footing bottom
, - width of wall heel
Horizontal components of forces are included in the shear force and overturning moment,
vertical components of forces are included in the normal force and resisting moment. The
resisting forces and moments also include horizontal forces from georeinforcements and
overlapping meshes.
Internal sliding
This limit state evaluates the possibility of structure to slide along the reinforcement. For the
selected reinforcement the program searches for a critical slip surface in the range of 4# - E0
o
from the end of given reinforcement.
For each slip surfaces the program calculates the shear and resisting forces and performs
verification.
!he shear "orces include;
- active pressure on a fictitious wall
- forces due to surcharge behind the wall
!he resisting "orces include;
- resistance of the wall structure against slip (it is calculated as for the wall dimensioning)
- friction between reinforcement and the sliding block
-795-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- forces due to other reinforcements
The resisting force due to friction between reinforcement and the sliding block is given by:
where: 3 - normal force acting on reinforcement (due to self weight of soil and
surcharge behind the fictitious wall)
- angle of internal friction of soil surrounding the reinforcement
S
,s
- coefficient of reduction of friction on reinforcement
The actual verification is then performed based on the input specified in the "Wall analysis" tab
sheet, according to the theory of limit states and factor of safety. It has to hold:

resp.
where: F
res
- resisting force
F
act
- active force
SF
sr
- safety factor for sliding along geo-reinforcement
,ein"orce'ents
Reinforcements or overhangs of mesh behind the wall, respectively, may considerably increase
the wall stability. The basic parameter of reinforcement is the tensile strength R
t
. A design
value of this parameter is used in all programs (except for the RediRock wall program), i.e. the
tensile strength of reinforcement reduced by coefficients taking into account the effect of
durability, creep, environment chemistry and installation damage. The force transmitted by
reinforcement can ne&er eceed the assigned tensile strength R
t
(a default value of 40
k3Hm is used for gabions).
The second characteristic is the pull6out strength P
p
. This parameter determines the
anchoring length, i.e. the required length of reinforcement in the soil, for which the
reinforcement is fully stressed attaining the value R
t
. Since the realistic values of the pull-out
strength are difficult to determine, the program offers three options for their calculation,
respectively for the calculation of the force F transmitted by the reinforcement.
3ength of mesh step 'oint or reinforcement behind bloc9s< respectiel#
-796-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Calculate pull6out "orce
The pull-out force F is given by:
where: - normal stress due to self weight at the intersection of mesh and slip surface
- angle of internal friction of soil
S - coefficient of interaction (0,8 by default)
8 - length of mesh step joint behind the slip surface into the soil body
Computation of the angle n
a
is described in chapter earth wedge.
Input rein"orce'ent anchor length 8
k

An anchoring length 8
k
is specified. This parameter is determined by the shear strength
developed between the mesh and the soil gradually increasing from zero to its limit value
(measured from the end of reinforcement fixed in soil).
where: 8 - length of mesh step joint behind the slip surface into the soil body
8
k
- anchoring length of reinforcement
R
t
- tensile strength
Input 'esh pull6out resistance P
p

The pull-out force F is given by:
where: 8 - length of mesh step joint behind the slip surface into the soil body
P
p
- pull-out resistance of mesh
Base anchorage
An anchorage of wall footing can be specified in program "Cantile&er (all". It is necessary to
specify an anchor location, dimensions of a drill hole, and spacing of anchors.
Two limit states of bearing capacity are defined for an anchor:
- )earing capacit% against pulling6out R
e
(k3Hm)
- strength o" anchor R
t
(k3).
-797-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
@ase anchorage
Bearing capacities can be either input or computed from the input values using the following
expressions:
where: P
p
- pull-out resistance
, - drill hole diameter
a - ultimate bond
FS
p
- safety factor against pulling-out
where: R
P
- strength of anchor
,
s
- anchor diameter
6
?
- yield strength of anchor
FS
P
- safety factor against pulling-apart
Approi'ate &alues o" )earing capacit% against pulling6out
-798-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
/aterial Ulti'ate
)ond
[3Hmm
2
]
Ulti'ate strength "or speci"ied hole dia'eter [k3Hm]
H- mm ?- mm >1 mm 511 mm 5-1 mm
Soft shale 1<05 -
1<I3
20 - 5H> 2> - 5>- -> - 032 H- - 0H1 >I - 3>5
Sandstone 1<I3 -
5<?3
5H> - 3-1 5>- - 21? 032 - 2IH 0H1 - -23 3>5 - -H0
Slate, Hard
Shale
1<IH -
5<3I
5?- - 0I5 010 - 30- 023 - 3>1 0?1 - 233 21- - -H0
Soft Limestone 5<11 -
5<-0
012 - 351 03- - 3-I 0I0 - 20> 352 - 2?? 2?5 - -H0
Granite, Basalt 5<?0 -
3<51
3-5 - -H0 21- - -H0 2IH - -H0 -21 - -H0 -H0 - -H0
Concrete 5<3I -
0<?H
0I5 - -H0 30- - -H0 3>1 - -H0 233 - -H0 -H0 - -H0
Accounting "or wall 8u'p
Two options are available to account for the foundation wall jump in the analysis as shown in
the figure (programs "Cantile&er (all" and "/asonr% (all").
*ptions to account for wall 'ump
If the jump is assumed as an inclined "ooting )otto', then a new shape of the footing
bottom is considered and the structure front face resistance is included only up to a depth of
the wall front face.
If the jump influence is considered as a "ront "ace resistance the analysis assumes a flat
footing bottom (as if there was no jump), but the structure front face resistance included up to
a depth of jump. In such a case computation of the structure front face resistance must also
be inputted otherwise the jump influence is neglected.
The jump introduced below the wall foundation is always considered as a structure front face
-799-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
resistance.
,ssuming wall 'ump in the middle
$i'ensioning o" 'asonr% wall according to AS 4EFF
Reinforced masonry is verified for loading due to bending moment, shear force and
combination of compressive normal force and bending moment. When loading due normal
force is considered, it is necessary to specify also the slenderness ratio S
r
.
$esign "or 'e')ers in co'pression and )ending
where: F
,
- the design compression force acting on the cross-section
. - the capacity reduction factor - 0,X#
k
s
- a reduction factor taken as 1,1B - 0,0"S
r
but not greater than 1,0
6i
9c
- the characteristic uncofined compressive strength of masonry
6i
m
- the characteristic compressive strength of masonry
+
>
- the bedded area of the masonry cross-section
6
s?
- the design yield strength of reinforcement
+
s
- the total cross-sectional area of main reinforcement
$esign "or 'e')ers in )ending
-800-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: !
,
- the design bending moment acting on the cross-section of member
. - the capacity reduction factor - 1<?-
6
s?
- the design yield strength of reinforcement
+
s,
- the portion of the cross-sectional area of the main tensile reinforcement
used for design purposes in a reinforced masonry member
the lesser of and +
st
6i
m
- the characteristic compressive strength of masonry
, - the effective depth of the reinforced masonry member
6
9c
- the characteristic uncofined compressive strength of masonry
Out6o"6plane shear in wall
A reinforced wall subject to out-of-plane shear shall be such that:
but not more than:
where: \
,
- the design shear force acting on the cross-section of the masonry wall
. - the capacity reduction factor - 0,X#
6i
0m
- the characteristic shear strength of reinforced masonry - 0,"# !pa
, - the effective depth of the reinforced masonry wall
6
0s
- the design shear strength of main reinforcement - 1X,# !pa
6
s?
- the design yield strength of reinforcement
+
st
- the cross-sectional area of fully anchored longitudinal reinforcement in
the tension zone of the cross-section
$i'ensioning o" 'asonr% wall according to 3.
1DDL6161
The reinforced masonry is verified for the loading caused by the combination of the
compressive normal force and the bending moment and for the loading due to the shear force.
5eri"ication "or pressure and )ending
Analysis assumptions:
- plane cross-sections remain plane
- the strain of steel is the same as the strain of the attached masonry
- the tensile strength of masonry is assumed equal to zero
- the limit strain of masonry in compression is 0,00"#
- the limit strain of steel in tension is 0,01
- variation of stress as a function of strain of masonry is assumed parabolic-rectangular
-801-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- variation of stress as a function of strain of steel is assumed bounded by a horizontal
upper branch
- the properties of filling concrete are considered the same as the properties of masonry (it
is necessary to use the worse of the two materials)
- design strength of masonry (concrete) is provided by:
where: 6
k
- characteristic strength of masonry (concrete) - shear force

!
- 1,B
- If the slenderness ratio given by the ratio of the height and the width of the wall is greater
than 12, the effect of the II-nd order theory is considered by including an additional design
bending moment given by:
where: 3
-,
- design value of the normal force
h
e6
- buckling height of wall
t - wall thickness
- If the slenderness ratio is greater than 2X, then it is not possible to perform the analysis
and it is necessary by changing geometry to obtain more favorable slenderness ratio.
5eri"ication "or shear
where: \
-,
- design value of the shear force
6
0,
- design value of the shear strength of masonry (concrete)
t - wall thickness
8 - wall length 1 running meter
Bearing capacit% o" "oundation soil
Verification analysis of the bearing capacity of foundation soil takes into account forces
obtained from all already performed verifications of the overall stability of structure (the theory
of limit states, factor of safety). To that end, the following relationships are used:
where: 3 - normal force acting in the footing bottom
, - width of wall heel
R
,
- bearing capacity of foundation soil
-802-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
e - eccentricity
e
a8$
- allowable eccentricity
(all di'ensioning
After computing forces acting on the structure the program determines all internal forces in the
verified cross-section (normal force 3, shear force ( and moment !) and then verifies the
cross-section bearing capacity employing one of the setting selected in the "Wall analysis" tab
sheet.
Only the forces found above the verified joint (see figure) are assumed for dimensioning.
These forces are not multiplied by any design coefficients.
Forces entering the anal#sis
!he "ront 8u'p o" wall as well as the back jump of wall is verified against the loading caused
by the bending moment and shear force. Stress in the footing bottom can be assumed either
constant (CSN) or linear (EC).
Assuming linear &ariation o" stress in the footing bottom the distribution of stress is
provided by:
or when excluding tension:
where: e - eccentricity of normal force 3
, - width of wall foundation
3 - normal force acting in the footing bottom (see verification according to
limit states or factor of safety, respectively)
Bending moment and shear force are determined as reaction developed on the cantilever beam
as shown in figure:
-803-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
+nternal forces acting on wall 'ump
5eri"ication o" the )ack 8u'p of wall (top tensile reinforcement in the wall jump,
respectively) is performed only in some countries and usually is not required. The programs
"Cantile&er wall" and ",ein"orced wall" allow in version 5.5 for designing the reinforcement
in the back jump of wall. The cross-section is then assumed to be loaded by the self weight of
structure, earth wedge, surcharge, anchorage force and the force associated with contact
pressure in the soil. Forces due to pressure are accounted for only if having a negative impact.
Forces introduced by the user are not reflected at all.
The cross-section is checked against the loading caused by the bending moment and shear
force.
Internal sta)ilit% o" ga)ion
The internal stability of gabion wall can be examined with the help of:
- the theory of limit states
- factor of safety
Verification of joints between individual blocks is performed in the "$i'ensioning" frame. The
structure above the block is loaded by active pressure and corresponding forces are
determined in the same way as for the verification of the entire wall. A loose filling is used in
the analysis not hand-placed rockfill but its effect can be simulated using a very high angle
of internal friction. It can be assumed that after some time due to action of filling aggregate
the stress in meshes will drop down. Individual sections of the gabion wall are checked for the
maximum normal and shear stress. With the help of these variables it is possible to modify the
slope of structure face by creating terraces or by increasing the slope of face of wall G.
Assu'ing loading applied to the )otto' )lock is schematically represented as:
-804-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
3oading on the bottom bloc9
Normal stress in the center of the bottom block is given by:
where: 3 - normal force acting on the bottom block
q - width of upper block
e - eccentricity
! - moment acting on the bottom block
h - height of bottom block
- unit weight of the bottom block material
G - gabion slope
Pressure acting on the wall o" the )otto' )lock is determined as an increased active
pressure:
where:
,
- design angle of internal friction of the bottom block material
c
,
- design cohesion of the bottom block material
- unit weight of material of the bottom block
h - height of bottom block
q - width of upper block
G - gabion slope
P - average value of pressure acting on face of the bottom block
- maximal normal stress acting on the bottom block
(idths o" 'eshes o" the )otto' )lock per one running meter of the gabion wall are:
where: <
9pp
- width of upper mesh between blocks loaded in tension
<
tota8
- overall width of meshes loaded in compression P
-805-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
0 - spacing of vertical meshes
h - height of bottom block
The program allows for analysis of gabions with both simple and double mesh placed between
blocks. For double meshes the inputted tensile strength of mesh (frame "Material" - the "3dit
'aterial" dialog window) should be twice as large as the value assumed for simple meshes.
)eometr# of gabions
Internal sta)ilit% o" ga)ion wall + "actor o" sa"et%
The following cases are assumed when examining the internal stability of the gabion wall using
the concept of factor of safety:
1A Check "or o&erturning sta)ilit%;
where: !
o0r
- overturning moment
!
res
- resisting moment
SF
o
- safety factor for overturning
2A Check "or slip;
where: 3 - normal force acting on the upper joint of the bottom block
-806-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013

,
- design angle of internal friction of the bottom block material
q - width of upper block
c - cohesion of the bottom block material
( - shear force
SF
s
- safety factor for sliding resistance
4A Check "or )earing capacit% with respect to the lateral pressure;
where: P - average value of pressure acting on face of the bottom block
S - force per one running meter of the joint
S
9
- joint bearing capacity (for input use the frame "Material")
SF
F
- safety factor mesh strength (for input use the "Wall analysis" tab
sheet default value is 1,#)
> - width = 1m
h height of the block
<
tota8
overall width of meshes loaded in compression P
CA Check "or )earing capacit% o" 8oint )etween )locks;
where: 3
,
- tensile force per one running meter of the upper joint
3
9
- strength of mesh (for input use the frame "Material")
SF
F
- safety factor mesh strength (for input use the "Wall analysis" tab sheet
default value is 1,#)
(
tr
- shear force transmitted by friction and cohesion between blocks

t
- reduction coefficient of friction between blocks (for input use the "Wall
analysis" tab sheet)
h - height of the block
<
tota8
- overall width of meshes loaded in compression P
<
9pp
- width of upper mesh between blocks loaded in tension
-807-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Internal sta)ilit% o" ga)ion wall + li'it states
Reduced parameters of the gabion material, which depend on the coefficients set in the "Wall
analysis" tab sheet, are used in the verification analysis.
1A Check "or o&erturning sta)ilit%;
where: !
o0r
- overturning moment
!
res
- resisting moment
2A Check "or slip;
where: 3 - normal force acting on the upper joint of the bottom block

,
- design angle of internal friction of the bottom block material
q - width of upper block
c
,
- design cohesion of the bottom block material
( - shear force
4A Check "or )earing capacit% with respect to the lateral pressure;
where: P - average value of pressure acting on the face of bottom block
S - force per one running meter of the joint
S
9
- joint bearing capacity (for input use the "Material" frame)
> - width = 1m
h - height of the block
<
tota
8

- overall width of meshes loaded in compression P
CA Check "or )earing capacit% o" 8oint )etween )locks;
where: 3
,
- tensile force per one running meter of the upper joint of the bottom block
3
9
- strength of mesh (for input use the frame "Material")
(
tr
- shear force transmitted by friction and cohesion between blocks

t
- reduction coefficient of friction between blocks (for input use the "Wall
analysis")
-808-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
h height of the block
<
tota
8

overall width of meshes loaded in compression P
<
9pp
width of upper mesh between blocks loaded in tension
Calculating a)ut'ent "orces
An abutment is analyzed per 1m 716t8. All forces entering the analysis are therefore adjusted in
the program as follows:
- the a)ut'ent sel" weight, assumed per 1m 716t8, is calculated from the inputted
transverse cross-section
- reactions inserted )% the )ridge and the approach sla) are inputted in k3 7kp)8 using
the values for the whole abutment, these values are in the analysis divided by
the a)ut'ent length
- soil pressure is determined per 1m 716t8 and then multiplied by the ratio length o" load
due to soil 9 a)ut'ent length,
- weight o" soil wedges is determined per 1m (16t) and then multiplied by the ratio length
o" load due to soil 9 a)ut'ent length,
- surcharge is determined per 1m 716t8 and then multiplied by the ratio length o" load due
to soil 9 a)ut'ent length,
- inputted "orces and "ront "ace resistance are assumed per 1m without reduction
- wing walls the wing walls self-weight is computed from their geometry; before
introduced in the stem design and foundation verification it is divided by the a)ut'ent
length (it is the user responsibility to either include or exclude the effect of wing walls in
from the analysis).
Computation of individual abutment forces is described in more detail in chapter "Wall
analyses".
All forces acting in the foundation joint that are introduced in the verification analysis (except
for the front face resistance) are multiplied by the ratio a)ut'ent length 9 "oundation
length0
-809-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
)eometr# of bridge abutment
,educed passi&e earth pressure
Evolution of passive earth pressure
p
corresponds to the maximal displacement of a structure
pushed into the soil. Such a displacement might not, however, occur (e.g. in the case of fixed
sheeting structures) and the structure is loaded by the reduced passive earth pressure
ps
. The
value of reduced passive earth pressure
ps
can range from the value of earth pressure at rest

r
(in the case of zero deformation) up to the value of passive earth pressure
p
. Figure shows
the dependence of values of earth pressure of a cohesionless soil (soil resistance) on the actual
displacement , to maximal displacement ,
ma;
ratio (when activating passing earth pressure

p
).
Dependence of earth pressure alues on the ratio of actual structure deformation
-810-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Sheeting design
Analyses in the program "Sheeting design" can be divided into three groups:
- Analysis of anchor free walls (e.g. sheet pile wall)
- Analysis of anchored walls fixed at heel
- Analysis of anchored walls simply supported at heel
Analysis of braced sheeting is also available in the program.
Anal%sis o" sheet pile wall
A sheet pile wall is analyzed using a standard approach that account for the effect of earth
pressures. In general, the active earth pressure develops behind the structure while the
passive earth pressure appears in front of the structure.
Based on the theor% o" li'it states the program searches in an iterative way a point on the
wall to satisfy the moment equation of equilibrium in the form:
Once this is accomplished, the program continues by determining the wall heel location for
which the equilibrium of shear forces is fulfilled (computation of depth of fixed end). The
overall length of the analyzed structure is found this way.
When applying approach based on the "actor o" sa"et% the program searches, in an iterative
way, a point to get:
It is obvious that the distribution of internal forces resulting from this approach is not very
realistic. In some countries, however, this approach is required.
The computation can be driven either by choosing a minimal dimensioning pressure or by
reduction of passi&e pressure. Assuming the actual magnitude of the passive earth pressure
provides deformations of the analyzed structure, which cannot usually occur. The actual
passive pressure can attain for walls free of deformation the value of pressure at rest as well
as all intermediate values up to the value of passive pressure for fully deformed wall (rotation
app. 10 mRa, i.e. deformation 10 mm per 1m of structure height). Therefore it is reasonable to
consider reduced values of the passive earth pressure by setting the value of the "Coe""icient
o" reduction o" passi&e pressure" to less than or equal to one. The following values are
recommended:
- 0,@X reduces deformations app. by one half
- 0,#0 approximately corresponds to deformation of structure loaded by increased active
earth pressure
- 0,"" approximately corresponds to deformation of structure loaded by the pressure at rest,
structure reaches app. 20 percent of its original deformations
Anal%sis o" anchored wall "ied in heel
Anchored wall fixed in heel is analyzed as a continuous beam using the deformation variant of
the finite element method in order to comply with the assumption of heel fixed in the soil. The
actual analysis is preceded by the determination of load due to earth pressure applied to the
-811-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
structure. The pressure acting on the back of a structure is assumed to be the active pressure,
while the front face is loaded by the passive pressure.
The passive pressure can be reduced with the help ofthe coe""icient o" reduction o" passi&e
pressure. Assuming the actual magnitude of the passive earth pressure provides deformations
of the analyzed structure, which cannot usually occur. The actual passive pressure can attain
for walls free of deformation the value of pressure at rest as well as all intermediate values up
to the value of passive pressure for fully deformed wall (rotation app. 10 mRa, i.e.
deformation 10 mm per 1m of structure height). Therefore it is reasonable to consider reduced
values of the passive earth pressure setting the value of the "Coe""icient o" reduction o"
passi&e pressure" to less than or equal to one. The following values are recommended:
- 0,@X reduces deformations app. by one half
- 0,"" deformations attain approximately twenty percent of their original values
The program offers two options to deter'ine acti&e pressure:
- calculation from inputted soil parameters, water, surcharge, terrain including introduction
of the minimum dimensioning pressure
- inputting an arbitrary distribution of earth pressure up to the depth of zero point (this way
it is possible to introduce an arbitrary redistribution of earth pressure)
Zero-value point, i.e. the point at which the overall pressure equals zero is determined by the
following expression:
where: 9 - depth of zero-value point

a
- magnitude of active pressure behind structure at the ditch bottom
2 - coefficient of overall pressure
- unit weight of soil below the ditch bottom
The analysis of structure fixed at heel assumes that the point of zero loading 3 (at depth 9) is
identical with the point of zero moment. For the actual analysis the structure is divided into
two parts an upper part (upper beam) up to zero-value point and a lower beam:
,nal#sis of anchored wall fi&ed in heel
The upper beam is analyzed first together with evaluation of anchor forces F and the reaction
force R at the zero-value point. Then, the lower beam length ; is determined such that the
moment equilibrium condition with respect to the heel is satisfied (the beam is loaded by the
reaction R and by the difference of earth pressures). To satisfy the shear force equilibrium the
-812-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
computed length of fixed end is extended by the value b; as shown in figure:
Determination of the e&tension of the length of wall b# d&
Anal%sis o" anchored wall si'pl% supported at heel
Anchored wall simply supported at heel is analyzed as a continuous beam using the
deformation variant of the finite element method in order to comply with the assumption of
simply supported structure at heel. The actual analysis is preceded by the determination of
load due to earth pressure applied to the structure. The pressure acting on the back of a
structure is assumed as active presure, while the front face is loaded by passive pressure.
The passive pressure can be reduced with the help ofthe coe""icient o" reduction o" passi&e
pressure. Assuming the actual magnitude of the passive earth pressure provides deformations
of the analyzed structure, which cannot usually occur. The actual passive pressure can attain
for walls free of deformation the value of pressure at rest as well as all intermediate values up
to the value of passive pressure for fully deformed wall (rotation app. 10 mRa, i.e.
deformation 10 mm per 1m of structure height). Therefore it is reasonable to consider reduced
values of the passive earth pressure setting the value of the "Coe""icient o" reduction o"
passi&e pressure" to less than or equal to one. The following values are recommended:
- 0,@X reduces deformations app. by one half
- 0,"" deformations attain approximately twenty percent of their original values
The program offers two options to deter'ine acti&e pressure:
- calculation from inputted soil parameters, water, surcharge, terrain including introduction
of the minimum dimensioning pressure
- inputting an arbitrary distribution of earth pressure up to the depth of zero point (this way
it is possible to introduce an arbitrary redistribution of earth pressure).
Zero-value point, i.e. the point at which the overall pressure equals zero is determined by the
following expression:
where: 9 - depth of zero-value point

a
- magnitude of active pressure behind structure at the ditch bottom
2 - coefficient of overall pressure
- unit weight of soil below the ditch bottom
-813-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
For simply supported structures it is assumed that the moment and shear force are zero at the
heel. The program first places the end of a structure into the zero-value point, and then it
looks for the end beam location ;, where the above condition is fulfilled (see Fig.). Solution
procedure for multiplied anchored walls is identical.
,nal#sis of anchored wall simpl# supported at heel
Sheeting check
The program evaluates the inputted structure using the method of dependent pressures. The
loading applied to the structure is derived from its deformation, which allows for realistic
modeling of its behavior and provides cost effective designs. The analysis correctly accounts
for the construction process such as individual stages of progressive construction of the wall
(stages o" constructions) including gradual evolution of deformations and post-stressing of
anchors, and makes it possible to model braced sheeting.
The use of the method of dependent pressures requires determination of the modulus of
subsoil reaction, which is assumed either linear or nonlinear.
The program also allows the user to check internal stability of the anchorage system.
The actual anal%sis is carried out using the deformation variant of the finite element method.
Displacements, internal forces and the modulus of subsoil reaction are evaluated at individual
nodes.
The following procedure for dividing the structure into finite elements is assumed:
- first, the nodes are inserted into all topological points of a structure (starting and end
points, points of location of anchors, points of soil removal, points of changes of cross-
sectional parameters),
- based on selected subdivision the program computes the remaining nodes such that all
elements attain approximately the same size.
A value of the modulus of subsoil reaction is assigned to each element it is considered as the
Winkler spring of the elastic subsoil. Supports are placed onto already de"or'ed structure
each support then represents a forced displacement applied to the structure.
Anchors, in the load case at which they were introduced or post-stressed, are considered as
forces (variant I in Fig). In other load cases, the anchors are modeled as forces and springs of
stiffness k (variant II. in Fig):
-814-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
@raced sheeting
The change of anchor force due to deformation is provided by:
where: 0 - horizontal distance between anchors
b $ - deformation increment the point of anchor application
- - anchor Youngs modulus
+ - anchor cross-sectional area
8 - anchor length
k - anchor stiffness
G - anchor inclination
/ethod o" dependent pressures
The basic assumption of the method is that the soil or rock in the vicinity of wall behaves as
ideally elastic-plastic Winkler material. This material is determined by the modulus of subsoil
reaction k
h
, which characterizes the deformation in the elastic region and by additional limiting
deformations. When exceeding these deformations the material behaves as ideally plastic.
The following assumptions are used:
- The pressure acting on a wall may attain an arbitrary value between active and passive
pressure but it cannot fall outside of these boundaries.
- The pressure at rest acts on an undeformed structure ($ = 0).
The pressure acting on a deformed structure is given by:
for:
for:
where:
r
- pressure at rest
-815-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
k
h
- modulus of subsoil reaction
$ - deformation of structure

a
- active earth pressure

p
- passive earth pressure
The computational procedure is as follows:
- The modulus of subsoil reaction k
h
is assigned to all elements and the structure is loaded
by the pressure at rest see figure:
Scheme of structure before first iteration
- The analysis is carried out and the condition for allowable magnitudes of pressures acting
on the wall is checked. In locations at which these conditions are violated the program
assigns the value of k
h
=0 and the wall is loaded by active or passive pressure, respectively
see figure:
Scheme of structure during the iteration process
The above iteration procedure continues until all required conditions are satisfied.
In analyses of subsequent stages of construction the program accounts for plastic deformation
of the wall. This is also the reason for specifying individual stages o" construction that
comply with the actual construction process.
-816-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
/odulus o" su)soil reaction
The following options are available in the program to introduce the modulus of subsoil
reactions:
- In the "or' o" distri)ution (the assumed distribution of the modulus of subsoil reaction
in front and behind the structure is inputted)
- As a soil para'eter with a respecti&e &alue (either linear or nonlinear)
- According to Schmitt
- According to CUR166
- According to Mnard
- According to Chadeisson
- Iterate using deformation characteristics of soils
The modulus of horizontal reaction of a soil body generally corresponds to spring stiffness in
the Winkler model describing the relation between load applied to a rigid plate and the
resulting soil deformation in the form:
where: p - load acting along plate-soil interface
k - stiffness of Winkler spring
? - translation of plate into subsoil
Definition of the modulus of subsoil reaction
/odulus o" su)soil reaction according to CU, 1LL
The following table stores the values of the modulus of subsoil reaction derived from
experimental measurements carried out in Netherlands (described in CUR 166). The table
offers secant modules, which are in the program directly transformed into secant modules of
subsoil reaction see nonlinear modulus of subsoil reaction.
-817-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
k
h,1
tk3Hm
"
u
p
0
_ p
h
_ 0,# p
pas

k
h,2
tk3Hm
"
u
0,# p
pas
l p
h
l0,B
p
pas

k
h,"
tk3Hm
"
u
0,B p
pas
l p
h
l
1,0p
pas

Sand
loose
medium dense
dense
50111 - 0?111
01111 - 2-111
21111 - >1111
H111 - 53-11
51111 - 00-11
01111 - 2-111
3111 - H?-1
-111 - 550-1
51111 - 00-11
Cla%
soft
stiff
very stiff
0111 - 2-11
2111 - >111
H111 - 53-11
I11 - 5I11
0111 - 2-11
2111 - >111
-11 - 550-
I11 - 5I11
0111 - 2-11
Peat
soft
stiff
5111 - 00-1
0111 - 2-11
-11 - 550-
I11 - 5I11
0-1 - -H1
-11 - 550-
where: p
0
-
value of pressure at rest in k3Hm
2
p
pas
-
passive pressure in k3Hm
2
p
h
-
horizontal pressure in k3Hm
2
corresponding to a given shift of a structure
Diagram of determination of the modulus of subsoil reaction
3iterature4
CB6 5HH Damwandconstructies< aailable at Ciieltechnisch Centrum Bitoering 6esearch en
6egelgeing4 P:*:@o& 201< 0I11 ,M )ouda 7.38
/odulus o" su)soil reaction according to Sch'itt
This analysis builds on the relation between oedometric modulus and stiffness of the structure
introduced by Schmitt in Revue Francaise de Gotechnique n
o
71 and 74:
-818-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: -
M
1 - structure stiffness
-
oe,
- oedometric modulus
3iterature4
Schmitt: P:75>>-8: "(stimating the coefficient of subgrade reaction for diaphragm wall and
sheet pile wall design"< in French: 6eue Franeaise de )YotechniAue< .: ?5< 0b trimestre 5>>-<
3-51
/odulus o" su)soil reaction according to /Inard
Based on the results from experimental measurements (pressiometer) of soil response loaded
by rigid plate Mnard derived the following expression:
where: -
!
- pressiometric modulus, if necessary it can be substituted by oedometric
modulus of soil
a - characteristic length depending on a depth of fixed-end structure, according
to Mnard assumed at a depth of 2/3 of length of fixed-end structure below
final depth of sheeted ditch
G - rheological coefficient of soil
5alues o" rheological coe""icient o" soilG:
Cla% Silt Sand Gra&el
Overconsolidated 5 0;3 5;0 5;3
Normally
consolidated
0;3 5;0 5;3 5;2
Non-consolidated 5;0 5;0 5;3 5;2
3iterature4
Menard 3:< 5>?-< "The Menard Pressuremeter4 +nterpretation and ,pplication of the
Pressuremeter Test 6esults to Foundations Design"< Sols-Soils< .o: 0H< Paris< France:
/odulus o" su)soil reaction according to Chadeisson
Based on the measurements on sheeting structures in different soils and computation of a shift
of structure needed to mobilize the limit value of passive pressure R. Chadeisson derived
expression for the determination of the modulus of subsoil reaction in the form:
-819-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: -
M
1 - structure stiffness
- unit weight of soil
2
p
- coefficient of passive pressure
2
0
- coefficient of soil pressure at rest
ci - effective cohesion
+
p
- coefficient of influence of cohesion (1 - 15)
3iterature4
Chadeisson< 6: 5>H5 Parois continues moulYes dans le sols: Proceedings of the -
th
(uropean
Conf: on Soil Mechanics and Foundation (ngineering<"ol: 0: Dunod< Paris< -H3--HI"
/odulus o" su)soil reaction deri&ed "ro' iterations
The program allows for automatic calculation of the modulus of subsoil reaction from
deformational characteristics of soil from iteration process. The procedure builds on the
assumption that deformation of the elastic subspace characterized by the deformation
modulus-,e6F!PaG when changing the stress state associated with the change of earth
pressures is the same as deformation of the underground wall.
The goal therefore is to find such values of k
h
[!3Hm
"
] so that the continuity of deformations of
wall and adjacent soil is maintained. Plastic de"or'ation o" structure is not considered
when performing analysis with k
h
iteration. This approach is schematically cleared by
computing the modulus of subsoil reaction of the )
th
segment of wall free of anchor, see figure:
-820-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Determination of modulus of subsoil reaction of ith segment
For change of stress
r
- the program determines uniform loading
o8
[!Pa] of individual
segments of a structure. Next, the overall change of stress passing the )
th
segment (
[!Pa
M
m]) is computed. This change is caused by additional loading of the soil body due to
segments 1 to F (
o8,1
-
o8,F
). The overall change of stress b
)
is reduced by structural strength
m
)M

or,)
[!Pa]. The new value of the spring stiffness then follows from:
where: -,e6 - deformation modulus of elastic subspace

o8
- uniform load applied to segments of structure

-
overall change of stress behind )
th
segment of structure
The change of stress inside the soil body is determined according to Boussinesque. Inserting
the new value of k directly into the next calculation would cause instable iteration therefore
the value of k that is introduced into the next analysis of the wall is determined from the
original value of k
p
and the new value of k
F
of the modulus of subsoil reaction.
where: k
p
- original value of modulus of subsoil reaction
k
F
- new value of modulus of subsoil reaction
Maximum modulus of the subsoil reaction of the )
th
layer is limited by the value:
where: -
,e6,)
-
deformation modulus of )
th
layer
The iterative procedure used when computing the modulus of subsoil reaction is as follows:
1. Determine the matrix of influence values for deriving change of stress in a depth of the
soil body passing the )
th
segment of a structure due to surcharge caused by the change
of stress in other segments.
2. The first approximation of the modulus k
h
in front of the wall is introduced a
triangular distribution of values at the wall heel k
h
= 10 !3Hm
"
is assumed.
3. Perform analysis of the wall.
4. Compute new values of k
h
and determine new values for the next analysis.
5. The dialog window to check the iteration appears and the program waits till the next
command. If the next F iterations are selected, the steps 3 and 4 are repeated Ftimes
to arrive again at the step No. 5. The analysis is terminated in this dialog window by
pressing the "Stop" button.
This iterative process is controlled by the user he or she has to decide whether the results
make sense.
-821-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Internal sta)ilit% o" anchors
The internal stability of an anchorage system of sheeting is determined for each layer
independently. The verification analysis determines an anchor force, which equilibrates the
system of forces acting on a block of soil. The block is outlined by sheeting, terrain, line
connecting the heel of sheeting with anchor root and by a vertical line passing through the
center of anchor root and terrain. The theoretical footing of sheeting construction is the point
where the sum of horizontal forces under the bottom of the construction pit is equal to zero. If
this point lies under the footing of the sheeting wall, the theoretical point is the footing of this
wall. The analysis is performed per one running meter of a sheeting structure. Anchor forces
are therefore computed with respect to their spacing in individual layers.
,nal#sis of internal stabilit#
Scheme for verification of the )
th
layer of anchors is shown in the figure. The force equilibrium
for the block +qS< is being determined. The following forces enter the analysis:
-
+

-resultant of active earth pressure acting on sheeting (on line +<)
-
+
)

-resultant of active earth pressure above the root of verified anchor (on line qS)
&
)

-
weight of the )
th
the soil block +qS<; in addition, this value incorporates the surcharge p
applied on the ground surface providing the slope of slip surface +q is greater than an
average value of the angle of internal friction on this surface; in case of a smaller slope of slip
-822-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
surface +q the ground surchage is not considered
S
)

-resultant of soil cohesion on slip surface +q
F
'
,

F
k
,
.
-forces developed in other anchors, but some of them are not taken into account; only
"shorter" anchors (comparing with the )
th
anchor) will contribute in the equilibrium analysis of
the )
th
block; following principle is used to decide whether the given anchor (the m
th
) is
included or excluded from equilibrium of the )
th
block:
at first the lower anchor is selected (the m
th
or the )
th
); then a plane slip surface is placed from
the root center of the selected lower anchor; this plane is inclined 4#
o
-
F
H2 from vertical line
(line a> or qc in the figure);
F
is an average value of the angle of internal friction above the
root of the lower anchor; if the )
th
root is found above the m
th
one and the higher located root
(the )
th
) is outside the area cut by the plane slip surface, then the m
th
anchor is included into
analysis; the same example of including the m
th
anchor is when the )
th
root lies under the m
th
one and the m
th
root is located inside the area cut by the slip surface; two opposite cases
determine excluded anchors from analysis; first is the )
th
root above the m
th
one and the )
th
inside the area, second is when the )
th
root lies under the m
th
one and the m
th
is outside the
area; from above definition resulting that "shorter" anchor F
k
is included into analysis and
"longer" anchor F
'
is excluded from analysis (see figure)
(
)

-reaction on slip surface +q
F
)

force in the analyzed anchor, the maximum allowable magnitude of this force is the result of
the equilibrium analysis carried out for the )
th
block
Solution of the equilibrium problem for a given block requires writing down vertical and
horizontal force equations of equilibrium. These represent a system of two equations to be
solved for the unknown subsoil reaction (
)
and the maximum allowable magnitude of the
anchor force F
)
.
As a result the program provides the maximum allowable anchor forces for each row of
anchors. These are them compared with those actually prescribed in anchors.
Braced sheeting
When analyzing braced sheeting the following approach is adopted to determine the earth
pressures:
Up to the depth of ditch the pressures are determined with respect to one running meter of the
structure width. Below the ditch bottom the earth pressures are multiplied by the coefficient of
reduction k (the "Coe""0 o" reduction o" pressures )elow ditch )otto'" can be inputted
in the frame "Geometry" as a parameter of the section of a structure) the pressures are
determined with respect to a reduced structure width k
M
>. In case of continuous wall the
coefficient is set to one and no reduction of pressures is assumed. If "#anding o" soil" above
the ditch ("Excavation" dialog window) is inputted, then the pressures within this section are
computed with respect to the whole width of wall (k = 1).
-823-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The coefficient k can be approximately determined (for very conservative design) according to:
where: m - longitudinal spacing of soldier beams
t - width of soldier beam
Actual &alue of the coefficient also depends on the soil type and space effect of earth
pressure. Real values of coefficients (based on experiments) are two6 or three6ti'es higher
than values calculated with the help of the previous formula.
@raced sheeting
.onlinear 'odulus o" su)soil reaction
Nonlinear model describes dependence of the modulus of subsoil reaction k
h
i.e. change of k
h
in between the threshold values corresponding to failure due to passive earth pressure P
p
and
active earth pressure P
a
see figure (the modulus of subsoil reaction is given by the slope of
the curve; for pore pressure at rest acting on a structure it is possible to consider the value of
k
h1
). This model also accounts for spring supports and forced deflections of the structure,
various boundary conditions, application of struts and anchors, etc.
-824-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
+nteraction model to determine 9h
The values of the modulus of subsoil reaction can be derived subsequently from the values of
secant modules of subsoil reaction (CUR 166) see figure:
+nteraction model to determine 9h - CB6 5HH
Failure )% hea&e
Failure )% hea&e
The stability of soil against heave due to flow of water in the subsoil (HYD) is checked
according to the limit states by equation:
where: 9
,st
- unfavourable water pressure

st>
- favourable weight of soil

h
- reduction coefficient of failure by heave
The stability of soil against heave due to flow of water in the subsoil (HYD) is checked
according to the factor of safety by equation:
-825-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: 9
,st
- unfavourable water pressure

st>
- favourable weight of soil
SF
h
- safety factor for failure by heave
Failure b# heae $ scheme of sheeting structure
Failure )% piping
Failure by piping is checked according to the limit states by equation:
where: ) - hydraulic gradient
)
c
- critical hydraulic gradient, where )
c
=
s9
/
$

p
- reduction coefficient of internal erosion of soil
Failure by piping is checked according to the factor of safety by equation:
where: ) - hydraulic gradient
)
c
- critical hydraulic gradient, where )
c
=
s9
/
$
SF
p
- safety factor for internal erosion of soil
3iterature4
(urocode ?4 )eotechnical design $ Part 54)eneral rules:
-826-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Slope sta)ilit%
The slope stability problem is solved in a two dimensional environment. The soil in a slope
body can be found below the ground water table, water can also exceed the slope ground,
which can be either partially or completely flooded. The slope can be loaded by a surcharge of
a general shape either on the ground or inside the soil body. The analysis allows for including
the effect of anchors expected to support the slope or for introduction of horizontal reinforcing
elements reinforcements. An earthquake can also be accounted for in the analysis.
Two types of approaches to the stability analysis are implemented in the program classical
analysis according to the factor of safety and the analysis following the theory of limit states.
The slip surface can be modeled in two different ways. Either as a circular one, then the user
may choose either from the Fellenius/Petterson, Bishop, Spencer, Janbu or Morgenstern-Price,
Shahunyants, ITF method, or as a polygonal one, in which case the program exploits the
Sarma, Spencer, Janbu or Morgenstern-Price, Shahunyants, ITF method.
Soil )od%
The soil body is formed by a la%ered pro"ile. An arbitrary number of layers can be used. Each
layer is defined by its geometry and material. The material of a layer is usually represented by
a soil with specified properties. The geostatic stress in a soil body is determined during the
analysis.
A layer can be specified also as a rigid body. Such layer then represents bedrock or a sheeting
wall. The slip surface can never pass through the rigid body.
In"luence o" water
Ground water can be assigned to the slope plane section using one of the five options:
1A Ground water ta)le
The ground water table is specified as a polygon. It can be arbitrarily curved, placed totally
within the soil body or introduced partially a)o&e the ground sur"ace.
Presence of water influences value of pore pressure acting within a soil and reducing its shear
bearing capacity. The pore pressure is considered as the hydrostatic pressure, i.e. unit weight
of water is multiplied by reduced height of the water table:
where:
$
- unit weight of water
h
r
- reduced height of water table
where:
where: h - vertical distance of point, where pore pressure is calculated and point on
the water table
G - inclination of the water table
Resultant force of pore pressure at certain section of the block is used in the calculation:
where: 9 - pore pressure in the point
-827-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
8 - length of section
Below the ground water table the analysis proceeds using the unit weight of saturated soil
sat
and uplift pressure; above the ground water table the analysis assumes the inputted unit
weight of soil .
The shear forces along the slip surface are provided by:
where: P - shear force along slip surface segment
3 - normal force along slip surface segment
s - pore pressure resultant along slip surface segment
- angle of internal friction
c - cohesion
, - length of slip surface segment
In case of total stress (entered in the "Soil" dialog window) total parameters are used and pore
pressure is considered zero.
2A Ground water ta)le including suction
Suction ta)le can be introduced above the inputted ground water table. A negative value of
pore pressure 9 is then assumed with the region separated by the two tables. Suction
increases as negative hydrostatic pressure from the ground water table towards the suction
table.
4A ,apid draw down
Original ta)le can be introduced above the inputted ground water table. Original water table
simulates state before rapid draw down.
6apid draw down anal#sis
First of all, the initial pore pressure 9
0
is evaluated:
where: h
0
- height from original table to the point of evaluation P
-828-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013

$
- unit weight of water
Height h
0
is generally the distance from point of pore pressure evaluation (P) to original water
table this is valid for the case when original water table is under terrain surface. In case of
original water table above terrain there is used the height h
0
from point P to the level of terrain
surface (profile 1 in the figure). Another case is when original water table as well as ground
water table are both above terrain then height h
0
is the distance from ground water table to
point P (profile 2 in the figure).
Second step is to calculate change of pore pressure in the area between original and ground
water table:
where: h
,
- height from original to ground water table

$
- unit weight of water
As in previous calculation of pressure, there are three possibilities how to get height h
,
. When
both water tables are under terrain, h
,
is the distance between original and ground water table.
In case of original water table above terrain, then h
,
is measured from ground water table to
the level of terrain (profile 1 in the figure). Last case is when both water tables are above
terrain then height h
,
is zero (profile 2 in the figure).
Third step is calculation of final value of pore pressure 9. Change of pore pressure b9 is
multiplied by coefficient of reduction of initial pore pressure X, which is required for all soils
(dialog window "Soils"). X coefficient of the soil in the area of point P is used (NOT soil in the
area between original and ground water table). In case of permeable soil X = 1, in other case X
= 0. Final pore pressure is evaluated as:
where: 9
0
- initial pore pressure
X - coefficient of reduction of initial pore pressure
b9 - change of pore pressure
CA Coe""icient o" pore pressure Ru
The coefficient of pore pressure R
9
represents the ratio between the pore pressure and
geostatic pressure in a soil body. In the area, where R
9
is positive, entered unit weight of
saturated soil
sat
is considered; in other case unit weight of soil is used.
The values of R
9
are introduced with the help of isolines connecting points with the same value
of R
9
. Linear interpolation is assumed to obtain intermediate values. Pore pressure is
established as geostatic stress reduced by coefficient R
9
:
where: R
9
- coefficient of pore pressure
h
)
-
height of )
th
soil layer

)
-
unit weight of )
th
soil layer
BA Pore pressure &alues
-829-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Ground water can be introduced directly through the pore pressure values 9 within the plane
section of a soil body.
In the area, where 9 is positive, entered unit weight of saturated soil
sat
is considered; in
other case unit weight of soil is used.
The pore pressure values are introduced with the help of isolines connecting points with the
same value of pore pressure. Linear interpolation is assumed to obtain intermediate values.
Pore pressure values are then derived from the values of pore pressure obtained in specific
points within the slope plane section.
Surcharge
The slope stability analysis takes into account even the surcharge caused by neighboring
structures. The surcharge can be introduced either as a concentrated force or distributed load
acting either on the ground surface or inside the soil body.
Since it is usually assumed that the surcharge is caused by the weight of objects found on the
slope body, the vertical component of surcharge having the direction of weight (material
component) is added to the weight of blocks. It means that if the earthquake effects are
included this component is also multiplied by the factor of horizontal acceleration or vertical
earthquake. Material surcharge component also influences the position of block centroid. The
components that do not act in the direction of weight are assumed in equations of equilibrium
written for a given block as weightless thus neither contribute to inertia effects of the
earthquake nor position of block centroid.
The surcharge is always considered in the analysis with respect to one running meter.
Providing the surcharge, essentially acting over the area >
M
8, is introduced as a concentrated
force it is transformed before running the analysis into a surface loading spread up to a depth
of slip surface along the slope 2:1 as displayed in figure.
Scheme of spreading the concentrated load on the slip surface
The analysis then proceeds with the resultant of surface load p having the value:
Anchors
Anchor is specified by two points and a force. The first point is always located on the ground
surface; the force always acts in the direction of a soil body. The anchor force when computing
equilibrium on a given block (slice) is added to the weightless surcharge of the slope.
-830-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Two options are available to account for anchors:
1. Co'pute anchor lengths analysis assumes infinite lengths of anchors (anchors are
always included in the analysis) and computes the required lengths of links anchors
(distance between the anchor head and intersection of anchor with the slip surface)
subsequently. The anchor root is then placed behind the slip surface. This approach is
used whenever we wish the anchor to be always active and thus contribute to increase
the slope stability and we need to know its minimum distance.
2. Anal%sis with speci"ied lengths o" anchors the analysis takes into account only
those anchors that have their end points (center of roots) behind the slip surface. This
approach is used always whenever we wish to evaluate the current state of slope with
already existing anchors, since it may happen that some of the anchors may prove to
be short to intersect the critical slip surface so that they do not contribute to increase
the slope stability.
,ein"orce'ents
Reinforcements are horizontal reinforcing elements, which are placed into the soil to increase
the slope stability utilizing their tensile strength. If the reinforcement intersects the slip
surface, the force developed in the reinforcement enters the force equation of equilibrium of a
given block. In the contrary case, the slope stability is not influenced.
The basic parameter of reinforcement is the tensile strength R
t
. A design value of this
parameter is used - i.e. the strength of reinforcement reduced by coefficients taking into
account the effect of durability, creep and installation damage. The force transmitted by
reinforcement can ne&er eceed the assigned tensile strength R
t.
Scheme of accounting for reinforcement
The second characteristic is the pull6out strength P
p
. This parameter determines the
anchoring length, i.e. the required length of reinforcement in the soil, for which the
reinforcement is fully stressed attaining the value R
t
. Since the realistic values of the pull-out
strength are difficult to determine, the program offers three options for their calculation,
respectively for the calculation of the force F transmitted by the reinforcement.
1A Calculate rein"orce'ent )earing capacit%
The pull-out force F is given by:
where: - normal stress due to self weight at the intersection of reinforcement and
slip surface see Fig.
-831-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- angle of internal friction of soil
S - coefficient of interaction (0,8 by default)
8 - length of reinforcement step joint behind the slip surface into the soil body
2A Input rein"orce'ent anchor length l
k
An anchoring length 8
k
is specified. This parameter is determined by the shear strength
developed between the reinforcement and the soil gradually increasing from zero to its limit
value (measured from the end of reinforcement fixed in soil).
where: 8 - length of reinforcement behind the slip surface into the soil body
8
k
- anchoring length of reinforcement
R
t
- tensile strength
4A Input rein"orce'ent pull6out resistance T
p
The pull-out force F is given by:
where: 8 - length of reinforcement behind the slip surface into the soil body
P
p
- pull-out resistance of reinforcement
Forces in reinforcements determined on the basis of reinforcement strength may attain
relatively large values. Introducing these forces in the analysis yields a higher factor of safety
of a given slip surface. In case of rigorous methods (Spencer, Janbu, Morgenstern-Price) the
introduction of such forces in the reinforcements may cause the loss of convergence. This
appears mainly in cases when these forces are so high that it is not possible to achieve
equilibrium of forces acting on blocks while maintaining the principal assumptions of individual
methods, e.g. the assumption of zero moment at the end of slip surface. In such a case the
forces in reinforcements are reduced as least as possible (to the highest acceptable values) so
the method converges and attains acceptable results. The reduced values of forces are then
written out as part of the stability analysis results. However, in case of no reduction these
forces are not included in the final set of results.
3nd o" rein"orce'ents
The reinforcement mounting is assumed in the program either as "ied or "ree.
Should the slope with reinforcement fail the one of the following reinforcement failure shown in
the following figures may appear.
If the reinforcement at its starting point in front of the slip surface is fixed (for example fixed
into the structure cladding) the 3rd type of failure is prevented pullout of the reinforcement
in front of the slip surface. The failure type 1 and 2 is always checked in the analysis, type of
failure 3 is checked only for reinforcements having free end points that allow for such a type of
failure.
-832-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
".ew reinforcement" dialogue window - input of end of reinforcement
@rea9ing of reinforcement $ t#pe of failure 5
Pullout of the reinforcement behind the slip surface $ t#pe of failure 0
-833-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Pullout of the reinforcement in front of the slip surface $ t#pe of failure 3
3arthHuake e""ect
The program allows for computing the earthquake effects with the help of two variables
factor of horizontal acceleration 2
h
or the coefficient of vertical earthquake 2
0
.
- Coe""icient o" &ertical earthHuake 2
0

The coefficient of vertical earthquake either decreases (2
0
I 0) or increases (2
0
_ 0) the unit
weight of a soil, water in a soil and material surcharge by multiplying the respective values by
1 - 2
0
. It is worth to note that the coefficient 2
0
may receive both positive and negative value
and in case of sufficiently large coefficient of horizontal acceleration the slope relieve (2
0
I 0)
is more unfavorable than the surcharge.
- Factor o" hori-ontal acceleration 2
h

In a general case the computation is carried out assuming a zero value of the factor 2
h
. This
constant, however, can be exploited to simulate the effect of earthquake by setting a non-zero
value. This value represents a ratio between horizontal and gravity accelerations. Increasing
the factor 2
h
results in a corresponding decrease of the factor of safety FS.
The coefficient of horizontal acceleration introduces into the analysis an additional horizontal
force acting in the center of gravity of a respective block with the magnitude 2
hM
%
)
, where %
)
is the block overall weight including the material component of the slope surcharge.
The following table lists the values of the factor 2
h
that correspond to different degrees of
earthquake based on M-C-S scale.
/6C6S degree Hori-ontal
acceleration
Factor o" hori-ontal
acceleration
(!S2-@4)
[mmHs
2
]
2
h

5 1<1 -

0<- 1<1 -

1:1110-
0 0<- -

-<1 1<1110- -

1:111-
3 -<1 -

51<1 1<111- -

1:115
2 51<1 - 0-<1 1<115 - 1:110-
-834-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013

- 0-<1 -

-1<1 1<110- -

1:11-
H -1<1 -

511<1 1<11- -

1:15
? 511<1 -

0-1<1 1<15 -

1:10-
I 0-1<1 -

-11<1 1<10- -

1:1-
> -11<1 -

5111<
1
1<1- -

1:5
51 5111<1 -

0-11<
1
1<5 -

1:0-
55 0-11<1 -

-111<
1
1<0- -

1:-
50 ^

-111<
1
^

1:-
5eri"ication according to 3. 1DDE
When running the verification analysis according to EN 1997 the choice of the Design approach
and Partial factors is important. Forces and loads are reduced in all design approaches.
When performing the verification analysis according to EN 1997 in combination with the design
approach 2 the program reduces the resisting moment (by reciprocal value of
Rs
). The value
of capacity utilization \
9
is calculated and then it is compared to 100%. The value of capacity
utilization is given by:
where: !
o0r
- overturning moment

Rs
- resistance on slip surface reduction factor
!
res
- resisting moment
In the case of design approache 1 and design approache 3 the program reduces the strength
parameters of soil (angle of internal friction and cohesion). The value of capacity utilization is
then given by:
where: !
o0r
- overturning moment
!
res
- resisting moment
-835-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Anal%sis according to the theor% o" li'it states 9
"actor o" sa"et%
The verification parameters are inputted in the "Stability analysis" tab sheet. The structure can
be verified according to the factor of safety or the theory of limit states.
Verification according to the theor% o" li'it states:
Soil parameteres (angle of internal friction, cohesion) are in this case reduced using the
design coe""icients introduced in the "Stability analysis" tab sheet.
The value of utilization \
9
is calculated and then compared with the value of 100%. The value of
utilization is given by:
where: !
o0r
- overturning moment

s
- coefficient of overall stability of structure
!
res
- resisting moment
Verification according to the "actor o" sa"et%:
where: !
o0r
- overturning moment
!
res
- resisting moment
SF
s
- factor of safety
Pol%gonal slip sur"ace
Solution of the slope stability problem adopting the polygonal slip surface is based on the
determination of the limit state of forces acting on the soil body above the slip surface. To
introduce these forces the slip surface above is subdivided into blocks by dividing planes.
Typically, these planes are assumed vertical, but this is not a required condition, e.g. the
Sarma method considers generally inclined planes.
-836-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Static scheme of bloc9
The figure shows forces acting on individual blocks of soil. If the region above the slip surface
is divided in blocks, then for the evaluation of unknowns we have: F normal forces 3
)
acting on
individual segments and corresponding F shear forces P
)
; F-1 normal forces between blocks -
)
and corresponding F-1 shear forces X
)
; F-1 values of /
)
representing the points of application of
forces -
)
, F values of 8
)
representing the points of application of forces 3
)
and one value of the
factor of safety FS. Forces X
)
can be in some methods replaced by the values of inclination of
forces -
)
.
To following set of equations is available to solve the problem of equilibrium: F horizontal and F
vertical equations of equilibrium written for individual blocks, F moment equations of
equilibrium for individual blocks and F relations between 3
)
and P
)
forces developed on blocks
according to the Mohr-Coulomb theory. In total there are 4F equations for @F-2 unknowns. This
suggests that 2F-2 unknowns must be chosen a prior. Individual methods differ from each
other in the way these values are selected.
Most often points of application of individual forces acting between blocks or their inclinations
are selected. Solving the problem of equilibrium it proceeds in an iterative manner, where the
selected values must allow for satisfying both the equilibrium and kinematical admissibility of
the obtained solution.
The program allows for adopting one of the following methods:
- Sarma
- Spencer
- Janbu
- Morgenstern-Price
- Shahunyants
- ITF Method
Optimization of polygonal slip surface searches the most critical surface (the lowest factor of
safety).
-837-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Sar'a
The Sarma method falls within a category of general sliced methods of limit states. It is based
on fulfilling the force and moment equilibrium conditions on individual blocks. The blocks are
created by dividing the soil region above the potential slip surface by planes, which may have
in general experience a different inclination. Forces acting on individual blocks are displayed in
the following figure.
Static scheme $ Sarma method
Here, -
)
,X
)
represent the normal and shear forces between blocks. 3
)
,P
)
are normal and shear
forces on segments of a slip surface. %
)
is the block weight and 2
hM
%
)
is the horizontal force
that is used to achieve in the Sarma method the limit state. Generally inclined surcharge can
be introduced in each block. This surcharge is included in the analysis together with the
surcharge due to water having the free water table above the terrain, and with forces in
anchors. All these forces are projected along the horizontal and vertical directions, which are
then summed up into components F;
)
and F?
)
.
2
h
is a constant named the factor of horizontal acceleration and it is introduced into the
analysis in order to satisfy the equilibrium on individual blocks. There is a relationship between
2
h
and the factor of slope stability FS allowing for the safety factor computation. In ordinary
cases the analysis proceeds with the value of 2
h
equal to zero. A non-zero value of 2
h
is used
to simulate the horizontal surcharge, e.g. due to earthquake (see below).
Anal%sis process
Co'putation o" li'it eHuili)riu'
The computation of limit equilibrium requires the solution of @F-1unknowns, where F stands for
the number of blocks dividing the soil region above the potential slip surface. These are:
-
)
- forces developed between blocks
3
)
- normal forces acting on slip surface
P
)
- shear forces acting on a slip surface
X
)
- shear forces developed between blocks
/
)
- locations of points of applications of forces
-838-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
8
)
- locations of points of applications of forces
2
h
- factor of horizontal acceleration
#F-1 equations are available for the required unknowns. In particular, we have:
aAhori-ontal "orce eHuations o" eHuili)riu' on )locks;
)A&ertical "orce eHuations o" eHuili)riu' on )locks;
cA 'o'ent eHuations o" eHuili)riu' on )locks;
where r;
)
and r?
)
are arms of forces F;
)
and F?
)
dA relationship )etween the nor'al and shear "orces according to the /ohr6Coulo')
theor%;
where: P
M
%
)

- resultant force of pore pressure on dividing planes

- average value of internal friction angle on dividing plane

- average value of cohesion on dividing plane
It is evident that F-1 must be selected (estimated) a priory. Relatively small error is received
when estimating the points of application of forces -
)
. The problem then becomes statically
determined. Solving the resulting system of equations finally provides the values of all
remaining unknowns. The principal result of this analysis is the determination of the factor of
horizontal acceleration 2
h
.
Co'putation o" "actor o" slope sta)ilit% FS
The factor of slope stability FS is introduced in the analysis such as to reduce the soil strength
parameters c and t5. Equilibrium analysis is then performed for the reduced parameters to
arrive at the factor of horizontal acceleration 2
h
pertinent to a given factor of slope stability FS.
This iteration is repeated until the factor 2
h
reaches either zero or a specified value.
In"luence o" eternal loading
The analyzed slope can be loaded on its ground by inclined loading having generally
trapezoidal shape. This loading enters the analysis such that its vertical material component (if
having the direction of weight) is added to the weight of a corresponding block. This results in
change of both the slice weight and its center of gravity. Providing the vertical component acts
against the direction of gravity it is added to force F?
)
. The horizontal component is added to
force F;
)
.
3iterature4
-839-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Sarma< S: M:4 Stabilit# anal#sis of emban9ments and slopes<)YotechniAue 03< 203$233< 5>?3:
Spencer
The Spencer method is a general method of slices developed on the basis of limit equilibrium.
It requires satisfying equilibrium of forces and moments acting on individual blocks. The blocks
are created by dividing the soil above the slip surface by dividing planes. Forces acting on
individual blocks are displayed in the following figure.
Static scheme $ Spencer method
Each block is assumed to contribute due to the following forces:
%
)
- block weight, including material surcharge having the character of weight including
the influence of the coefficient of vertical earthquake2
0
2
hM
%
)
- horizontal inertia force representing the effect of earthquake, 2
h
is the factor of
horizontal acceleration during earthquake
3
)
- normal force on the slip surface
P
)
- shear force on the slip surface
-
)
,-
)71
- forces exerted by neighboring blocks, they are inclined from horizontal plane by
angle V
F;
)
,F?
)
- other horizontal and vertical forces acting on block
!1
)
-
moment of forces F;
)
, F?
)
rotating about point !, which is the center of the )
th
segment of slip surface
s
)
- pore pressure resultant on the )th segment of slip surface
The following assumptions are introduced in the Spencer method to calculate the limit
equilibrium of forces and moment on individual blocks:
- dividing planes between blocks are always vertical
- the line of action of weight of block %
)
passes through the center of the )
th
segment of slip
surface represented by point /
- the normal force 3
)
is acting in the center of the )
th
segment of slip surface, at point /
-840-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- inclination of forces -
)
acting between blocks is constant for all blocks and equals to V,
only at slip surface end points is V = 0
The solution adopts the following expressions:

(1)

(2)


(3)


(4)

(5)
Equation (1) represents the relationship between effective and total value of the normal force
acting on the slip surface. Equation (2) corresponds to the Mohr-Coulomb condition
representing the relation between the normal and shear forces on a given segment of the slip
surface. Equation (3) represents the force equation of equilibrium in the direction normal to
the )
th
segment of the slip surface, whereas Equation (4) represents equilibrium along the )
th
segment of the slip surface. FS is the factor of safety, which is used to reduce the soil
parameters. Equation (5) corresponds to the moment equation of equilibrium about point /,
where ?
5)
is the vertical coordinate of the point of application of the weight of block and ?
!
is
the vertical coordinate of point /. Modifying equations (3) and (4) provides the following
recursive formula:
-841-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
This formula allows to calculate all forces -
)
acting between blocks for given values of V
)
and
FS. This solution assumes that at the slip surface origin the value of - is known and equal to
-
1
= 0.
Additional recursive formula follows from the moment equation of equilibrium (5) as:
This formula allows us calculating for a given value of V all arms / of forces acting between
blocks, knowing the value on the left at the slip surface origin, where /
1
= 0.
The factor of safety FS is determined by employing the following iteration process:
1. The initial value of V is set to zero V = 0.
2. The factor of safety FS for a given value of V follows from equation (6), while assuming
the value of -
F71
= 0 at the end of the slip surface.
3. The value of V is provided by equation (7) using the values of - determined in the
previous step with the requirement of having the moment on the last block equal to
zero. Equation (7) does not provide the value of /
F71
as it is equal to zero. For this
value the moment equation of equilibrium (5) must be satisfied.
4. Steps 2 and 3 are then repeated until the value of V does not change.
For the process of iteration to be stable it is necessary to avoid unstable solutions. Such
instabilities occur at points where division by zero in expressions (6) and (7) takes place. In
equation (7), division by zero is encountered for V = vH2 or V = -vH2. Therefore, the value of
angle V must be found in the interval (-vH2 ; vH2).
Division by zero in expression (6) appears when:
Another check preventing numerical unstability is verification of parameter m
G
- following
condition must be satisfied:
Therefore before iteration run it is required to find the highest of critical values FS
m)F
satisfying
above mentioned conditions. Values below this critical value FS
m)F
are in area of unstable
solution, therefore iteration begins by setting FS to a value "just" above FS
m)F
and all result
values of FS from iteration runs are higher than FS
m)F
.
Generally rigorous methods converge worse than the simpler methods (Bishop, Fellenius).
Examples with convergence problems include too steep sections of slip surface, complex
geometry, a significant jump in surcharge etc. If no result is obtained, we recommend slight
change of inputted data, e.g. less steep slip surface, input more points into the slip surface
etc. or using of some of the simpler methods.
3iterature4
-842-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Spencer< (: 5>H?: , method of anal#sis of the stabilit# of emban9ments assuming parallel
interslice forces: )YotechniAue< 5?7584 55$0H:
Jan)u
Janbu is a general method of slices developed on the basis of limit equilibrium. It requires
satisfying equilibrium of forces and moments acting on individual blocks (only moment
equilibrium at last uppermost block is not satisfied). The blocks are created by dividing the soil
above the slip surface by dividing planes. Forces acting on individual blocks are displayed in
the following figure:
Static scheme $ Panbu method
Each block is assumed to contribute due to the following forces:
%
)
- block weight, including material surcharge having the character of weight including
the influence of the coefficient of vertical earthquake2
0
2
hM
%
)
- horizontal inertia force representing the effect of earthquake, 2
h
is the factor of
horizontal acceleration during earthquake
3
)
- normal force on the slip surface
P
)
- shear force on the slip surface
-
)
,-
)71
- forces exerted by neighboring blocks, they are inclined from horizontal plane by
angle V
)
resp. V
)71
and lie at the height /
)
resp. /
)71
above slip surface
F;
)
,F?
)
- other horizontal and vertical forces acting on block
!1
)
-
moment from forces F;
)
, F?
)
rotating about point /, which is the center of the )
th
segment of slip surface
s
)
-
pore pressure resultant on the )
th
segment of slip surface
The following assumptions are introduced in the Janbu method to calculate the limit
equilibrium of forces and moment on individual blocks:
- dividing planes between blocks are always vertical
- the line of action of weight of block %
)
passes through the center of the )
th
segment of slip
surface represented by point /
-843-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- the normal force 3
)
is acting in the center of the )
th
segment of slip surface, at point /
- position /
)
of forces -
)
acting between blocks is assumed, at slip surface end points is / = 0
Choice of position /
)
can have significant infuence on convergency of method. If we make a bad
assumption of position /
)
for a given slope, it can become impossible to satisfy equilibrium
conditions (algorithm does not converge). Heights /
)
above slip surface are set approximately
to one third of height of interface between the blocks. In case of unsatisfying equilibrium
conditions algorithm changes heights to a different position, e.g. slightly higher within passive
zone, near the toe, and lower within active zone, near the crest of slope.
The solution adopts the following expressions:

(1)

(2)


(3)


(4)

(5)
Equation (1) represents the relationship between effective and total value of the normal force
acting on the slip surface. Equation (2) corresponds to the Mohr-Coulomb condition
representing the relation between the normal and shear forces on a given segment of the slip
surface. Equation (3) represents the force equation of equilibrium in the direction normal to
the )
th
segment of the slip surface, whereas Equation (4) represents equilibrium along the )
th
segment of the slip surface. FS is the factor of safety, which is used to reduce the soil
parameters. Equation (5) corresponds to the moment equation of equilibrium about point /,
where ?
5)
is the vertical coordinate of the point of application of the weight of block and ?
!
is
the vertical coordinate of point /.
Modifying equations (3) and (4) provides the following recursive formula (6):
-844-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013


(
6
)
This formula allows calculating all forces -
)
acting between blocks for given values of V
)
and FS.
This solution assumes that at the slip surface origin the value of - is known and equal to -
1
=0.
Formula for calculating angles V
)
(7) follows from the moment equation of equilibrium (5) as:

(
7
)
This formula allows us calculating for a given value of V all arms /
)
of forces acting between
blocks, knowing the value on the left at the slip surface origin, where /
1
= 0.
The factor of safety FS is determined by employing the following iteration process:
1. The initial value of angles are set to zero V
)
= 0 and positions /
)
to approximately one
third of interface height.
2. The factor of safety FS for a given value of V
)
follows from equation (6), while assuming
the value of -
F71
= 0 at the end of the slip surface.
3. The value of V
)
is provided by equation (7) using the values of -
)
determined in the
previous step.
4. Steps 2 and 3 are then repeated until the value of FS does not change.
It is necessary to avoid unstable solutions for successful iteration process. Such instabilities
occur at points where division by zero in expression (6) takes place, i.e.:
Another check preventing numerical unstability is verification of parameter m
G
- following
condition must be satisfied:
Therefore before iteration run it is required to find the highest of critical values FS
m)F
satisfying
above mentioned conditions. Values below this critical value FS
m)F
are in area of unstable
solution, therefore iteration begins by setting FS to a value "just" above FS
m)F
and all result
values of FS from iteration runs are higher than FS
m)F
.
Generally rigorous methods converge worse than the simpler methods (Bishop, Fellenius).
-845-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Examples with convergence problems include too steep sections of slip surface, complex
geometry, a significant jump in surcharge etc. If no result is obtained, we recommend slight
change of inputted data, e.g. less steep slip surface, input more points into the slip surface
etc. or using of some of the simpler methods.
3iterature4
Panbu< .: 5>-2: ,pplication of Composite Slip Surface for Stabilit# ,nal#sis: (uropean
Conference on Stabilit# ,nal#sis< Stoc9holm< Sweden:
Panbu< .: 5>?3: Slope Stabilit# Computations: (mban9ment Dam (ngineering - Casagrande
"olume< 6:C: Hirschfeld and S:P: Poulos< eds:< Pohn %ile# and Sons< .ew /or9< pp 2?-IH:
/orgenstern6Price
Morgenstern-Price is a general method of slices developed on the basis of limit equilibrium. It
requires satisfying equilibrium of forces and moments acting on individual blocks. The blocks
are created by dividing the soil above the slip surface by dividing planes. Forces acting on
individual blocks are displayed in the following figure:
Static scheme $ Morgenstern-Price method
Each block is assumed to contribute due to the same forces as in Spencer method. The
following assumptions are introduced in the Morgenstern-Price method to calculate the limit
equilibrium of forces and moment on individual blocks:
- dividing planes between blocks are always vertical
- the line of action of weight of block %
)
passes through the center of the )
th
segment of slip
surface represented by point /
- the normal force 3
)
is acting in the center of the )
th
segment of slip surface, at point /
- inclination of forces -
)
acting between blocks is different on each block (V
)
) at slip surface
end points is V = 0
The only difference between Spencer and Morgenstern-Price method is shown in the above list
of assumptions. Choice of inclination angles V
)
of forces -
)
acting between the blocks is realized
with the help of Half-sine function one of the functions in the following figure is automatically
chosen. This choice of the shape of function has a minor influence on final results, but suitable
choice can improve the convergency of method. Functional value of Half-sine function 6(;
)
) at
-846-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
boundary point ;
)
multiplied by parameter R results the value of inclination angle V
)
:
Half-sine function
The solution adopts the expressions (1) (5), shown in Spencer method, i.e.:

(1)

(2)


(3)


(4)

(5)
- (1) relationship between effective and total value of the normal force acting on the slip
surface
- (2) Mohr-Coulomb condition representing the relation between the normal and shear
forces on a given segment of the slip surface (3
)
a P
)
)
- (3) force equation of equilibrium in the direction normal to the )
th
segment of the slip
surface
-847-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- (4) force equation of equilibrium along the )
th
segment of the slip surface
- (5) moment equation of equilibrium about point /
Modifying force equations (3) and (4) provides the following recursive formula (6):


(
6
)
This formula allows calculating all forces -
)
acting between blocks for given values of V
)
and FS.
This solution assumes that at the slip surface origin the value of - is known and equal to -
1
=
0.
Additional recursive formula (7) follows from the moment equation of equilibrium (5) as:

(
7
)
This formula allows to calculate all arms /
)
of forces acting between blocks for a given values of
V
)
, knowing the value on the left at the slip surface origin, where /
1
= 0.
The factor of safety FS is determined by employing the following iteration process:
1. The initial value of angles V
)
is set according to Half-sine function (V
)
= R
M
6(;
)
)).
2. The factor of safety FS for a given value of V
)
follows from equation (6), while assuming
the value of -
F71
= 0 at the end of the slip surface.
3. The value of V
)
is provided by equation (7) using the values of -
)
determined in the
previous step with the requirement of having the moment on the last block equal to
zero. Functional values 6(;
)
) are same all the time during the iteration, only parameter R
is iterated. Equation (7) does not provide the value of /
F71
as it is equal to zero. For
this value the moment equation of equilibrium (5) must be satisfied.
4. Steps 2 and 3 are then repeated until the value of V
)
(resp. parameter R) does not
change.
It is necessary to avoid unstable solutions for successful iteration process. Such instabilities
occur at points where division by zero in expressions (6) and (7) takes place. In equation (7),
division by zero is encountered for V
)
= vH2 or V
)
= -vH2. Therefore, the value of angle V
)
must be
found in the interval (-vH2 ; vH2).
Division by zero in expression (6) appears when:
Another check preventing numerical unstability is verification of parameter m
G
- following
condition must be satisfied:
-848-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Therefore before iteration run it is required to find the highest of critical values FS
m)F
satisfying
above mentioned conditions. Values below this critical value FS
m)F
are in area of unstable
solution, therefore iteration begins by setting FS to a value "just" above FS
m)F
and all result
values of FS from iteration runs are higher than FS
m)F
.
Generally rigorous methods converge worse than the simpler methods (Bishop, Fellenius).
Examples with convergence problems include too steep sections of slip surface, complex
geometry, a significant jump in surcharge etc. If no result is obtained, we recommend slight
change of inputted data, e.g. less steep slip surface, input more points into the slip surface
etc. or using of some of the simpler methods.
3iterature4
Morgenstern< .:6:< and Price< ":(: 5>H-: The anal#sis of the stabilit# of general slip surfaces:
)YotechniAue< 5-7584 ?>$>3:
Morgenstern< .:6:< and Price< ":(: 5>H?: , numerical method for soling the eAuations of
stabilit# of general slip surfaces: Computer Pournal< >4 3II$3>3:
Dhu< D:/:< 3ee< C:F:< Xian< X:H:< and Chen< ):6: 011-: , concise algorithm for computing the
factor of safet# using the Morgenstern$Price method: Canadian )eotechnical Pournal< 207584
0?0$0?I:
Shahun%ants
The Shahunyants method is a general method of slices developed on the basis of limit
equilibrium. It requires satisfying equilibrium of forces and moments acting on individual
blocks. The blocks are created by dividing the soil above the slip surface by dividing planes.
Forces acting on individual blocks are displayed in the following figure:
Static scheme $ Shahun#ants method
Each block assumes action of the following forces:
where: P
?)
- resultant of vertical forces acting on a given block (block weight, block
-849-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
surcharge, earthquake, anchor forces, .)
P
;)
- resultant of horizontal forces on a given block (block surcharge,
earthquake, anchor forces, geo-reinforcements, .)
-
)71
, -
)
- forces developed between blocks
3
)
- reaction below the block normal to the slip surface segment
P
)
- friction force on the slip surface segment
G
)
- inclination of the slip surface segment
8
)
- length of the slip surface segment
The following assumptions are adopted in the Shahunyants method to calculate the limit state
on a given block:
- dividing planes between blocks are always vertical
- slope of forces -
)
acting between blocks is zero, forces act horizontally
Solution procedure;
Forces P
?)
and P
;)
are first transformed with the help of expressions (1) and (2) into directions
of forces P
)
and 3
)
. For a positive angle G
)
(the same way as in the schema) the force P
3)
acts
in the direction opposite to 3
)
, the force P
()
acts in the direction opposite to P
)
.
758
708
The forces acting along the slip surface segment are related by:
738
where: s
)
- pore pressure on the slip surface segment
!he "orce eHuations o" eHuili)riu' are "ul"illed on the )lock;
The equilibrium condition in the direction normal to the slip surface segment:
728
The equilibrium condition in the direction parallel to the slip surface segment:
7-8
Introducing Eq. (3) into Eq. (5) gives:
7H8
Next, substituting Eq. (4) into Eq. (6) gives:
-850-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
7?8
After some algebra:
7I8
Exploiting the following mathematical expression:
7>8
yields Eq. (8) in the form:
7518
This can be modified as:
7558
to provide the recurrent expression for -
)
forces acting between blocks as:
7508
At this stage the analysis enters the factor of safety 2
9
. The factor of safety is the value which
bring the forces acting on individual blocks of soil into the state of limit states. This is achieved
by multiplying active forces, i.e. forces contributing to sliding of the soil mass above the slip
surface, by the factor of safety. Active forces are in Eq. (12) contained within the term P
()
.
This term contains on the one hand active forces that contribute to sliding and on the other
hand forces that resist to sliding. The contributing forces will be denoted as P
(),s,
whereas the
resisting forces as P
(),9,
. Eq. (12) then becomes:
7538
Providing the value of P
()
is positive then it contributes to sliding and will be assumed as
active force P
(),s,
. Providing the value of P
()
is negative then it resists to sliding and will be
assumed as force P
(),9,
. Therefore subtracting the value P
(),9,
, which is negative, in Eq. (13)
means essentially adding the positive value, so we can formally write:
-851-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
7528
At the slip surface origin the value of -
0
= 0. The value of -
1
is then given by:
75-8
The value of -
2
is then given by:
75H8
Similarly we may determine the values of all forces acting between blocks. It further holds at
the end point of the slip surface we have -
F
= 0. Exploiting the previous expressions this can
be written as:
75?8
This equation directly provides the factor of safety 2
9
in the form:
75I8
I!F /ethod @I')alance !hrust Force /ethodA
The ITF method is a limit state method. It builds up on the equation of equilibrium of forces
acting on individual blocks and does not consider the moment equation of equilibrium. The
bases of the method and adopted assumptions are evident from following figure.
-852-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Forces acting on a bloc9
Consider the following assumptions to concerning the forces acting on the block:
where: %
)
-
weight of the )
th
block, the weight of a part of the block below the
ground water is determined from the bulk weight of soil below water

S9
, it holds that
S9
=
sat
-
$

F
?)
- represents the remaining vertical loading acting on the block
F
;)
- represents the remaining horizontal loading acting on the block
<
)
- seepage force of the ground water <
)
=
$
\
)
Y
)
, wheree Y
)
is the
inclination of ground water acting on a given block
F
)
, F
)71
- forces acting between blocks along directions given by angles G
)
and
G
)71
The force equation of equilibrium in the direction normal to the segment of the slip surface
provides:
The forces on the segment of a slip surface are related by
where:
)
- angle of internal friction of soil
c
)
- soil cohesion
8
)
-
length of the slip surface segment associated with the )
th
block
The force equation of equilibrium in the direction of the )
th
segment of the slip surface (given
by angle G
)
) yields the force F
)
acting between blocks in the form:
Introducing Eqs.(1) and (2) into Eq. (3) provides:
-853-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
and after some formal algebra we arrive at the resulting form of the equation of equilibrium
as:
The equilibrium condition will be fulfilled by introducing the factor of safety FS into the analysis
such that the strength parameters of a given soil c and taF are divided by this value. Eq. (4)
then becomes
Eq. (5) then gives the searched factor of safety FS through the process of iteration. This
process proceeds such that the force F
F
equal to 0 k3 is applied at the highest (end) point of
the slip surface. The forces F
)
acting in between blocks are determined for a given value of the
factor of safety FS from Eq. (5). This step is repeated for various values of FS until we find
such FS for which the force F
0
at the slope base becomes equal to 0 k3. No tension is assumed
along the slip surface. If the equilibrium condition requires the value of normal force 3
)
being
negative, which means that the soil is loaded in tension, then the value of this force is set
equal to zero in the next iteration step and the shear force P
)
acting on a given segment is
determined based on the soil cohesion only.
The ITF method is quite sensitive with respect to the shape of the slip surface. In case the slip
surface contains sharp segment discontinuities the resulting factor of safety is generally larger
as compare to reality. It is recommended that the slope difference between adjacent segments
of the slip surface be less than 10w. This is checked automatically by the program and if the
slope difference is found greater the programs prompts a warning that the results might be
overestimated. This is usually not the problem of a circular slip surface but should be kept in
mind in case of polygonal slip surfaces.
I!F /ethod + eplicit solution
The explicit solution of the ITF method assumes a different way of introducing the factor of
safety into the analysis. The mathematical solution then does not require iterations and the
resulting factor of safety is calculated directly in one step. With this approach the resulting
factor of safety is typically higher which may the solution totally devalued, particularly in cases
concerning polygonal slip surfaces with large slope differences of adjacent segments.
The solution exploits Eq. (4) to which the factor of safety FS is introduced such that it
multiplies the active components of forces, i.e. the components acting in the sliding direction.
The equilibrium condition then becomes :
-854-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
For lucidity we introduce the component of active forces as:
and next the component of passive forces as:
and an auxiliary function:
Eq. (6) can be then written in more compact form as:
The next step assumes the known force F
F
=0 to provide expressions of forces between blocks
F in the form:
Etc..
And since the force on the bottom origin of the slip surface should be equal to 0 k3, we get the
final form of the factor of safety FS as:
Opti'i-ation o" pol%gonal slip sur"ace
The slip surface optimization proceeds such that the program changes subsequently locations
of individual points of this surface and checks, which change of location of a given point results
in the maximal reduction of the factor of slope stability FS. The end points of the optimized slip
surface are moved on the ground surface, internal points are moved in the vertical and
horizontal directions. The step size is initially selected as one tenth of the smallest distance of
neighboring points along the slip surface. With every new run the step size is reduced by one
half. Location of points of slip surface is optimized subsequently from the left to the right and it
-855-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
is completed when there was no point moved in the last run.
When optimizing the polygonal slip surface the iteration process may suffer from falling into
the local 'ini'u' (with respect to gradual evolution of locations of nodal points) so not
always the process is terminated by locating the critical slip surface. Especially in case of
complex slope profile it is therefore advantageous to introduce several locations of the initial
slip surface. Combination with the approach used for circular slip surfaces is also
recommended. Therefore, the critical slip surface assuming circular shape is found first and the
result is then used to define the initial polygonal slip surface.
The optimization process can be restricted by various constraints. This becomes advantageous
especially if we wish the searched slip to pass through a certain region or to bypass this
region. The restriction on the optimization process can be performed in two different ways:
1. Optimization restrictions are specified as a set of segments in a soil body. The optimized
slip surface is then forced to bypass these segments during optimization.
2. Another way of restricting the optimization process is to fix location of selected points
along the optimized slip surface or allow for moving these points only in one of two
directions, either vertically or horizontally.
Changing inclination o" di&iding planes
It is evident from figure that the planes dividing individual blocks do not have to be vertical
and not even mutually parallel. In the first stage of analysis when the optimization procedure
moves points along the slip surface it assumes vertical alignment of dividing planes. To arrive
at even smaller value of the slope stability it is possible to change the mutual alignment of
dividing planes. This process is again performed in several runs with limited value of rotation
step and this step is again reduced in the course of optimization. This stage of optimization is
terminated once the rotation step drops below the value of 1
o
and no change of rotation
occurred during the last optimization run.
Static scheme $ Sarma method
Circular slip sur"ace
All methods of limit equilibrium assume that the soil body above the slip surface is subdivided
-856-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
into blocks (dividing planes between blocks are always vertical). Forces acting on individual
blocks are displayed in figure.
Static scheme of slice
Here, X
)
and -
)
are the shear and normal forces acting between individual blocks, P
)
and 3
)
are
the shear and normal forces on individual segments of the slip surface, %
)
are weights of
individual blocks.
Individual methods of slices differ in their assumptions of satisfying the force equations of
equilibrium and the moment equation of equilibrium with respect to the center O.
The program allows for adopting one of the following methods:
- Fellenius / Petterson
- Bishop
- Spencer
- Janbu
- Morgenstern-Price
- Shahunyants
- ITF Method
Ground water specified within the slope body (using one of the five options) influences the
analysis in two different ways. First when computing the weight of a soil block and second
when determining the shear forces. Note that the effective soil parameters are used to relate
the normal and shear forces.
Introducing anchor "orces and water a)o&e the ground sur"ace into the anal%sis
Anchor forces are considered as external loading applied to the slope. They are taken with
respect to one running meter F9.;mG and introduced into the moment equation of equilibrium.
These forces should contribute to additional stability, if that cannot be achieved in a different
way. There is no limitation to the magnitudes of anchor forces and therefore it is necessary to
work with realistic values.
Influence of water above the ground surface is considered as set forces acting perpendicular on
the ground surface together with pore pressure along the slip surface, which is derived
depending on the depth of slip surface measured from the ground water table. The forces
acting on the ground surface enter the moment equation of equilibrium as forces acting on
respective arms measured towards the center of the slip surface.
-857-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Optimization of circular slip surface searches the most critical surface (the lowest FS).
Fellenius 9 Petterson
The simplest method of slices assumes only the overall moment equation of equilibrium written
with respect to the center of the slip surface. The shear and normal forces between blocks X
)
and -
)
are neglected. The factor of safety FS follows directly from the following expression:
where: 9
)
- pore pressure within block
c
)
,
)
- effective values of soil parameters
%
)
- block weight
3
)
- normal force on the segment of the slip surface
G
)
- inclination of the segment of the slip surface
8
)
- length of the segment of the slip surface
3iterature4
Petterson M( 75>--8 The earl# histor# of circular sliding surfaces: )eotechniAue -40?-$0>H
Bishop
The simplified Bishop method assumes zero X
)
forces between blocks. The method is based on
satisfying the moment equation of equilibrium and the vertical force equation of equilibrium.
The factor of safety FS is found through a successive iteration of the following expression:
where: 9
)
- pore pressure within block
c
)
,
)
- effective values of soil parameters
%
)
- block weight
G
)
- inclination of the segment of the slip surface
>
)
- horizontal width of the block
3iterature4
@ishop< ,:%: 75>--8 "The Bse of the Slip Circle in the Stabilit# ,nal#sis of Slopes"<
)eotechniAue< )reat @ritain< "ol: -< .o: 5< Mar:< pp: ?-5?
Spencer
This method assumes non-zero forces between blocks. The resultants of shear and normal
forces acting between blocks have constant inclinations. The Spencer method is a rigorous
-858-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
method in a sense that it satisfies all three equations of equilibrium the force equations of
equilibrium in the horizontal and vertical directions and the moment equation of equilibrium.
The factor of safety FS is found through the iteration of inclination of forces acting between
blocks and the factor of safety FS. Further details can be found in section describing the
analysis of polygonal slip surface.
Jan)u
Janbu method assumes non-zero forces between blocks. Method satisfies the force equations
of equilibrium in the horizontal and vertical directions for all blocks and the moment equation
of equilibrium for all but the last (uppermost) slice. Assumption of this method is choice of
position of forces acting between the blocks. The factor of safety FS is found through the
iteration of forces acting between blocks and then inclinations of these forces are calculated.
Further details can be found in section describing the analysis of polygonal slip surface.
/orgenstern6Price
This method assumes non-zero forces between blocks. The resultants of shear and normal
forces acting between blocks have different inclinations at each block (shape of Half-sine
function). Morgenstern-Price is a rigorous method in a sense that it satisfies all three equations
of equilibrium the force equations of equilibrium in the horizontal and vertical directions and
the moment equation of equilibrium. The factor of safety FS is found through the iteration of
inclination of forces acting between blocks and the factor of safety FS. Further details can be
found in section describing the analysis of polygonal slip surface.
Shahun%ants
Further details can be found in section describing the analysis of polygonal slip surface.
I!F /ethod @I')alance !hrust Force /ethodA
Further details can be found in section describing the analysis of polygonal slip surface.
Opti'i-ation o" circular slip sur"ace
The goal of the optimization process is to locate a slip surface with the smallest factor of slope
stability FS. The circular slip surface is specified in terms of 3 points: two points on the ground
surface and one inside the soil body. Each point on the surface has one degree of freedom
while the internal point has two degrees of freedom. The slip surface is defined in terms of four
independent parameters. Searching for such a set of parameters that yields the most critical
results requires sensitivity analysis resulting in a matrix of changes of parameters that allows
for fast and reliable optimization procedure. The slip surface that gives the smallest factor of
slope stability is taken as the critical one. Parameters of individual slip surfaces and results
from optimization runs can be displayed in output document.
This approach usually succeeds in finding the critical slip surface without encountering the
problem of falling into a local minimum during iteration. It therefore appears as a suitable
starting point when optimizing general slip surfaces such as the polygonal slip surface.
The optimization process can be restricted by various constraints. This becomes advantageous
especially if we wish the searched slip surface to pass through a certain region or to bypass
this region. Optimization restrictions are specified as a set of segments in a soil body. The
optimized slip surface is then forced to bypass these segments during optimization.
-859-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Foliation
Soils can be introduced with foliation. It means that along an angle specified in terms of a
certain interval, which in turn is introduced as one of the soil parameters <Starting Slope; End
Slope> the soil experiences significantly different (usually worse) parameters (c a ).
If the slope of a slip surface segment or the slope of interface between blocks is assumed
within the interval <Starting Slope; End Slope>, the analysis proceeds with the modified
parameters of c and .
In"luence o" tensile cracks
The program makes it possible to account for the influence of tensile cracks that appear on
terrain surface and are filled with water h. The only input parameter is the depth of tensile
cracks. The effect of cracks is incorporated when calculating normal and shear forces in
sections of a slip surface containing cracks in a section with tensile cracks the shear strength
parameters are set to zero (c = 0, = 0). Next, a horizontal force F due to presence water in a
tensile crack is introduced in the analysis (see figure):
+nfluence of tensile crac9s
Anal%sis o" )earing capacit% o" "oundation
The vertical bearing capacity of the foundation soil is verified according to the theory of limit
states using the following inequality:
or based on the factor of safety as:
where: - extreme design contact stress at the footing bottom
R
,
- design bearing capacity of foundation soil

R\
- coefficient of vertical bearing capacity of foundation (for input use the
"Spread Footing" tab sheet)
SF
0
- safety factor for vertical bearing capacity
Extreme design contact stress at the footing bottom is assumed the form:
-860-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: \ - extreme design vertical force
+
e6
- effective area of foundation
The vertical bearing capacity of the foundation soil R
,
is determined for three basic types of
foundation conditions:
- Drained subsoil
- Undrained subsoil
- Bedrock
The above computations are applicable only for the homogeneous soil. If there is a non6
ho'ogeneous soil under the footing bottom (or there is ground water present), then the
inserted profile is transformed into a homogeneous one.
Bearing capacit% on drained su)soil
One of the following approaches is available to assess the bearing capacity of a foundation if
drained conditions are assumed:
- standard analysis
- according to CSN 731001 "Zkladov pda pod plosnmi zklady" approved 8.6. 1987
- according to Polish standard PN-81 B - 03020 "Grunty budowiane, Posudowienie
bezposrednie budowli, Obliczenia statyczne i projekktowanie" from year 1982
- according to Indian standard IS:6403-1981 "Code of Practice for Determination of Bearing
Capacity of Shallow Foundations" from year 1981
- according to EC 7-1 (EN 1997-1:2003) "Design of geotechnical structures Part 1:
General rules"
- according to NCMA Segmental retaining walls manual, second edition.
All approaches incorporate coefficients due to Brinch Hansen (see standard analysis) to
account for inclined ground surface and inclined footing bottom.
Assuming drained conditions during construction the soil below spread footing deforms
including both shear and volumetric deformations. In such a case the strength of soil is
assumed in terms of effective values of the angle of internal friction
e6
and the effective
cohesion c
e6
. It is also assumed that there is an effective stress in the soil equal to the total
stress (consolidated state). Effective parameters
e6
, c
e6
represent the peak strength
parameters.
Owing to the fact that the choice of drained conditions depends on a number of factors (rate of
loading, soil permeability, degree of saturations and degree of overconsolidation) it is the
designer's responsibility to decide, depending on the actual problem being solved, if the
effective parameters should be used.
Standard anal%sis
By default the solution proposed by J. Brinch Hansena is used, where the bearing capacity of
foundation soil follows from:
-861-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where:

coe""icients o" )earing capacit%;
for:
for:





coe""icients o" in"luence o" depth o"
"oundation;




coe""icients o" slope o" "ooting )otto';



coe""icients o" in"luence o" slope o" terrain;


-862-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
d
.otation o" angles and coe""icients >,5
where: c - cohesion of soil

0
- equivalent uniform loading accounting for the influence of
foundation depth
, - depth of footing bottom
- unit weight of soil above the footing bottom
> - width of foundation
- unit weight of soil
3
c
,3
,
,3
>
- coefficient of bearing capacity
s
c
,s
,
,s
>
- coefficients of shape of foundation
,
c
,,
,
,,
>
- coefficients of influence of foundation depth
)
c
,)
,
,)
>
- coefficients of influence of slope of loading
5
c
,5
,
,5
>
- coefficients of influence of slope of terrain
- angle of internal friction of soil
8 - length of foundation
V - angle of deviation of the resultant force from the vertical direction
Y - slope of terrain
G - slope of footing bottom
3iterature4
@rinch Hansen< P: 75>?18< , reised and e&tended formula for bearing capacit#< Danish
)eotechnical +nstitute< @ulletin 0I<--55
Bearing capacit% on undrained su)soil
One of the following approaches is available to assess the bearing capacity of a foundation if
undrained conditions are assumed:
- standard analysis
- according to CSN 731001 "Zkladov pda pod plosnmi zklady" approved 8.6. 1987
- according to Indian standard IS:6403-1981 "Code of Practice for Determination of Bearing
Capacity of Shallow Foundations" from year 1981
- according to EC 7-1 (EN 1997-1:2003) "Design of geotechnical structures Part 1:
General rules"
In addition the coefficients due to Brinch Hansen are used to account for inclined footing
bottom (see standard analysis).
In case of undrained conditions it is assumed that during construction the spread footing
undergoes an instantaneous settlement accompanied by shear deformations of soil in absence
of volumetric changes. When the structure is completed the soil experiences both primary and
secondary consolidation accompanied by volumetric changes. The influence of neutral stress
appears in the reduction of soil strength. The strength of soil is then presented in terms of
-863-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
total values of the angle of internal friction
9
and the total cohesion c
9
(these parameters can
be considered as the minimal ones). Depending on the degree of consolidation the value of the
total angle of internal friction
9
ranges from 0 to
e6
, the total cohesion c
9
is greater than c
e6
.
Owing to the fact that the choice of undrained conditions depends on a number of factors (rate
of loading, soil permeability, degree of saturations and degree of overconsolidation) it is the
designer's responsibility to decide, depending on the actual problem being solved, if the
effective parameters should be used. Nevertheless, the total parameters are generally used for
fine-grained soil.
Standard anal%sis
The following formula is used by default:
with dimensionless coefficients:
where: c
9
- total cohesion of soil
> - width of foundation
8 - length of foundation
, - depth of foundation
V - angle of deviation of the resultant force from the vertical direction
G - slope of footing bottom from horizontal direction
- overburden pressure at the level of foundation base
Bearing capacit% o" "oundation on )edrock
The following methods can be used to compute the design bearing capacity R
,
of the
foundation with a horizontal footing bottom supported by the rock mass composed of rocks or
weak rocks:
- Standard approach
- Solution according to CSN 73 1001
- Solution according to EC7
Standard anal%sis
The bearing capacity of foundation soil composed of rocks or weak rocks is found from the
-864-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
expression proposed by Xiao-Li Yang and Jian-Hua Yin
1
:
where:
where: s - nonlinear parameter depending on rock properties (according to Hoek
and Brown)
&S1 - Geological Strength Index
< - coefficient reflecting damage of a rock mass
3
s
,3

,3

- coefficients of bearing capacity depending on the angle of internal
friction
3
s
- coefficient of strength of a rock depending on GSI and strength
parameterm
)
- angle of internal friction of rock

c
- uniaxial compressive strength of rock > 1<- MPa

0
- equivalent uniform loading accounting for the influence of foundation
depth

2
- unit weight of soil above the footing bottom
> - width of foundation
1
Xiao-Li Yang, Jian-Hua Yin: Upper bound solution for ultimate bearing capacity with a
modified HoekBrown failure criterion, International Journal of Rock Mechanics & Mining
Sciences 42 (2005),str. 550560
Solution according to CS. E4 1FF1
The bearing capacity of foundation soil composed of rocks or weak rocks follows from articles
97 99 of standard CSN 73 1001 "Foundation soil )elow spread "ooting" approved 8.6.
1987.
As input parameters the analysis requires the unit weight of soil, uniaxial compression
strength
c
, Poisson's ratioJ and deformation modulus -
,e6
.
Anal%sis according to 3C E61 @3. 1DDE61;2FF4A
The bearing capacity of the foundation R
,
with a horizontal footing bottom is determined
-865-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
according to a design method for the derivation of expected bearing capacity of spread
footings resting on a bedrock outlined in a supplement G (informative) EC 7-1 (EN 1997-
1:2003) "Design of geotechnical structures Part 1: General rules". For low strength or
damaged rocks with closed discontinuities including chalks with low porosity less than 3-f the
derivation of expected bearing capacity follows from classification of rocks into groups of rocks
stored in the table below. The analysis further requires an input of discontinuity spacing S
,
,
unit weight of rock, Poisson's ratioJand uniaxial compressive strength
c
. It is assumed that
the structure is able to transmit a settlement equal to 1<- f of the foundation width. The
expected values of bearing capacity for other settlements can be estimated using direct
proportion. For weak and broken rocks with opened or filled discontinuities it is recommended
to use lower values than the expected ones.
,ock groups
Group !%pe o" rock
1 Pure limestones and dolomites
Carbonate sandstones of low porosity
2 Igneous
Oolitic and marly limestones
Well cemented sandstones
Indurated carbonate mudstones
Metamorphic rocks, including slates and schist (flat
cleavage / foliation)
3 Very marly limestones
Poorly cemented sandstones
Slates and schist (steep cleavage / foliation)
4 Uncemented mudstones and shales
3iterature4
(urocode ?4)eotechnical design $ Part 54)eneral rules
Para'eters to co'pute "oundation )earing capacit%
Para'eters to co'pute &ertical )earing capacit% o" a "oundation resting on )edrock
The following parameters are used in the program to compute the foundation vertical bearing
capacity:
- values of coefficient < reflecting a state of damage of a rock mass
- values of strength parameter m
)
- strength of rocks in simple compression
c
- Poisson's ratio of rocks J
- bulk weight of rocks
3sti'ating distur)ance coe""icient <
-866-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
$escription o" rock 'ass Suggested &alue o" <
Rock mass, intact strong rock, excavation by
blasting or by open TBM
0
Rock mass, poor quality rock, mechanical
excavation with minimal disturbance
0
Rock mass, poor rock, mechanical excavation,
significant floor heave, temporary invert or
horizontal geometry of excavation sequence
0,5
Rock mass,very poor rock often very altered,
local damage of surrounding rock (app. 3
m )
0,8
Rock slope or rock outcrop, modification with
controlled blasting
0,7
Rock slope or rock outcrop, modification with
blasting results to the some disturbance
1,0
Open pit mines, excavation with blasting 1,0
Open pit mines, mechanical excavation 0,7
5alues o" strength para'eter m
)

!%pe o" rock ,epresentati&e rocks m
)
[-]
Carbonate rocks with well
developed cleavage
Dolomite, limestone and
marble
= 7
Lithified argillaceous rocks Mudstone, siltsone shale,
slate
= 10
Arenaceous rock with
strong crystal and poorly
developed crystal
cleavage
Sandstone and qurtzite = 15
Fine grained polyminerallic
igneous crystalline rocks
Andesite, dolerite,
diabase, ryolite
= 17
Coarse grained
polyminerallic igneous and
metamorphic rocks
Amphibolite, gabbro,
gneiss, granite and quartz
diorite
= 25
Uniaxial compressive strength K
c,
Poisson's ratio c and Unit weight of rock g
-867-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Strength
o" rocks
!%pes o" rock
@ea'plesA
Uniaia
l
co'pr0
strengt
h

c
[!Pa]
Poisson
nu')er
J
Unit weight o" rock
[k3Hm
"
]
Extremely
hard rock
Very hard, intact
rock strong and
solid quartzite,
basalt and other
extremely hard
rock
>150 0,1 28,00 - 30,00
Very hard
rock
Very hard granite,
quartz porphyry,
quartz slate, very
hard sandstones
and limestones
100 -
150
0,15 26,00 - 27,00
Hard rock Solid and compact
granite, very hard
sandstone and
limestone, silicious
iron veis, hard
pudding stones,
very hard iron ores
hard calcite, not
very hard granite,
hard sandstone,
marble, dolomite,
pyrite
80 - 100 0,20 25,00 - 26,00
Fairly
hard rock
Normal sandstone,
medium hard iron
ore, sandy shale,
flagstone
50 - 80 0,25 24,00
Medium
hard rock
Hard mudstones,
not very hard
sandstones and
calcite, soft
flagstone, not very
hard shales, dense
marl
20 - 50 0,25
0,30
23 - 24,00
Fairly
weak rock
Soft schist, soft
limestones, chalk,
rock salt, frost
soils, anthracite,
normal marl,
disturbed
sandstones, soft
flagstones and
5 - 20 0,3
0,35
22,00 26,00
-868-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
soils with
aggregates
Weak
rock
Compact clay, hard
soil (eluvium with
soil texture)
0,5 - 5 0,35
0,40
22,00 - 18,0
Hori-ontal )earing capacit% o" "oundation
The foundation horizontal bearing capacity is verified according to the theory of limit states
using the following inequality:
or based on the factor of safety as:
where:
where: *
,
- angle of internal friction between foundation and soil
a
,
- cohesion between foundation and soil
+
e6
- effective area of foundation
S
p,
- earth resistance
e
;
,e
?
- components of horizontal force
( - extreme design vertical force

Re
- coefficient of horizontal bearing capacity of foundation (for input use
the "Spread Footing" tab sheet)
FS - factor of safety
When adopting the analysis methodology according to EN 1997 the term with cohesion (a
,M
+
e6
) is excluded for drained conditions whereas the term with friction between foundation and
soil ((
M
taF*
,
) is excluded for undrained conditions.
The analysis depends on the design angle of internal friction below the footing bottom
,
, the
design value of cohesion below the footing bottom c
,
and the design value of earth resistance
S
p,
. If the soil-footing frictional angle and the soil-footing cohesion are less than the values of
soil below the footing bottom, then it is necessary to use those values.
The earth resistance is assumed as displayed in figure:
-869-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
(arth resistance
The earth resistance S
p,
is found with the help of the reduction of passive earth pressure or
pressure at rest employing influence coefficients:
where: S
p
- passive earth pressure, pressure at rest or reduced passive pressure

mR
- coefficient of reduction of earth resistance (for input used the frame
"Settings") - for the analysis according to CSN it assumes the value
mR
=
1,# for passive pressure,
mR
= 1," for pressure at rest
Coe""icients o" earth pressures are clear from the following formulas:
for passive pressure:
for pressure at rest in drained soils:
for pressure at rest in other soils:
When determining the reduced passi&e pressure1 the resultant force includes contributions
due to the passive pressure and pressure at rest.
The passive pressure can be considered, if the deformation needed for its activation does not
cause unallowable stresses or deformations in upper structure.
Ho'ogeni-ation o" la%ered su)soil
If the soil below the footing bottom is inhomogeneous (or if there is ground water present)
then the inputted profile is transformed into a homogeneous soil based on the Prandtl slip
surface (see Fig.), which represents the type and location of failure of the foundation.
-870-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The Prandtl slip surface
Determination of equivalent values of (angle of internal friction), c (cohesion of soil) (unit
weight of soil below footing bottom) is evident from the following formulas. The unit weight of
soil above foundation is derived in the same way.
Procedure for computation of au&iliar# alues
-871-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
3""ecti&e area
When solving the problem of eccentrically loaded foundations the program offers two options
to deal with an effective dimension of the foundation area:
- a rectangular shape of effective area is assumed
- general shape of effective area is assumed
,ectangular shape
A simplified solution is used in such cases. In case of axial eccentricity (bending moment acts
in one plane only) the analysis assumes a uniform distribution of contact stress K applied only
over a portion of the foundation 8
1
, which is less by twice the eccentricity e compared to the
total length 8.
Determination of effectie area in case of a&ial eccentricit#
An effective area (>
M
8
1
) is assumed to compute the contact stress, so that we have:
In case of a general eccentric loading (foundation is loaded by the vertical force \ and by
bending moments !
1
and !
2
the loading is replaced by a single force with given eccentricities:
The size of effective area follows from the condition that the force \ must act eccentrically:
General shape o" contact stress
In case of an eccentric loading the effective area is determined from the assumption that the
resultant force \ must act in the center of gravity of the compressive area. The theoretically
correct solution appears in Fig.
-872-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Determination of contact stress for general eccentricit# $ general shape
Owing to a considerable complexity in determining the exact location of the neutral axis, which
in turn is decisive when computing the effective area, the program follows the solution
proposed by Highter a Anders
1u
, where the effective areas are derived with help of graphs.
1u
Highter, W.H. Anders,J.C.: Dimensioning Footings Subjected to Eccentric Loads Journal of
Geotechnical Engineering. ASCE, Vol. 111, No GT5, pp 659 - 665
$eter'ination o" cross6sectional internal "orces
#ongitudinal rein"orce'ent o" a "oundation is checked for the loading due to bending
moment and shear force. The stress in the footing bottom is assumed as linear. Stresses in
individual directions ;, ? are determined independently.
When the linear distri)ution o" stress in the footing bottom is considered the distribution of
stress over the cross-section is provided by:
or when excluding tension:
where: e - eccentricity of normal force 3
, - width of foundation
3 - normal force acting at the footing bottom
Bending moment and shear force are determined as reaction developed on the cantilever beam
as shown in figure:
-873-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
+nternal forces acting on wall 'ump
Internal forces in the cross-section corresponding to constant distri)ution o" stress are
provided by:
where: - maximal stress in the footing bottom
,
0
- length of jump
e - eccentricity of normal force 3
, - width of wall foundation
3 - normal force acting at the footing bottom
Anal%sis o" upli"t
The analysis of a spread footing in tension is performed when the load due to a negative
normal force 3 (the force acts upwards) is assumed. The verification of such a footing is
carried out according to the corresponding verification methodology. During the analysis the
program compares the maximum tensile force 3
t,ma;
with the uplift resistance R
t
. The program
considers the following three methods of the calculation of bearing capacity (uplift resistance
R
t
) of footing:
- standard approach
- cone method
- DL/T 5219-2005
Standard approach
The uplift resistance R
t
combines the self weight of the soil overburden and friction along the
footing walls + fictitious (substitute) block of soil above the footing. The "Bearing cap0" frame
in the "5eri"ication on upli"t" dialogue window serves to input the design angle of friction of
overburden
,
and the design cohesion of overburden c
,
.
-874-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialogue window ""erification on uplift" $ standard approach
The vertical bearing capacity check - spread footing in tension (uplift resistance) follows from:
where:
;
- earth pressure at rest due to overburden

,
- design angle of internal friction of overburden
c
,
- design cohesion of overburden
, - depth of footing bottom
p - footing perimeter
"erification on uplift $ standard approach
Cone 'ethod
The uplift resistance R
t
combines the footing self weight and the self weight of the soil
overburden in the shape of cone as evident from the following figure.
-875-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
@asis of the cone method
The "Bearing cap0" frame in the "5eri"ication on upli"t" dialogue window serves to input the
cone angle G. When calculating the uplift resistance R
t
it is also possible to account for the
influence of a neighbour foundation either in one or both directions that reduces the volume of
the soil cone.
Dialogue window ""erification on uplift" $ cone method
+nfluence of a neighbour foundation
-876-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
$#9! B21D 6 2FFB
This type of verification originates from the Chinese standard $#9! B21D 6 2FFB. Unlike the
cone method and the standard approach it introduces a critical depth h
c
, which depends on the
type of soil and the shape of foundation. The "5eri"ication on upli"t" dialogue window allows
for either inputting the critical depth h
c
directly or it can be determined by the program
depending on the inputted type of soil and the shape of foundation according to table L040161
+ Critical depth h
c
.
!a)le L040161 with the &alues o" a critical depth )ased on the Chinese standard $#9!
B21D62FFB
Type of soil Natural state of soil Critical depth h
c
for tensile foundation
Circular foundation Square foundation
Sand or Silt Dense ~ Slightly dense 2,#< ",0q
Clay Hard ~ Stiff 2,0< 2,#q
Plastic 1,#< 2,0q
Soft - plastic 1,2< 1,#q
Note 1: For rectangular foundation, if the ration between length Di and width q is smaller
than ", claculate h
c
as circular foundation and <=0,@Mtq7Diu.
Note 2: The soil must be in a natural state.
The "Bearing cap0" frame in the "5eri"ication on upli"t" dialogue window serves to specify
as another input parameter the cone angle G. The influence of a neighbour foundation is
described in the cone method. The inclination of column N has no influence on the calculation
of bearing capacity of a footing in tension (the uplift resistance).
Dialogue window "erification on uplift" $ D3;T -05>-011-
-877-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
"erification of footing in pension according to D3;T -05>-011-
Pile anal%sis
Analyses available in the program "Piles" can be divided into three main groups:
- Analysis of vertical bearing capacity
- Pile settlement
- Analysis of horizontal bearing capacity
5ertical )earing capacit%
Analysis of pile vertical resistance can be carried out using:
- Analytical solution
- Spring method
Anal%tical solution
The analytical solution assumes that the pile total compressive resistance R
c
is derived as a
sum of the pile base resistance R
>
and the pile shaft resistance R
s
(developed due to friction of
the surrounding soil along the shaft). The following generally accepted methods are
implemented into the program:
- NAVFAC DM 7.2
- Tomlinson
- Effective stress method
- CSN 73 1002
For the above specified methods it is possible to choose one of the following verification
methodologies:
- Classical way
- EN 1997-1
When running the co'pression pile analysis, the pile self-weight is introduced depending on
-878-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
the setting in the frame "Load". As for the tensile pile, the pile self-weight is always taken
into account automatically. Based on the inputted load the program itself performs the
verification analysis for either co'pression or tensile pile.
.A5FAC $/ E02
Calculation of vertical pile resistance is performed according to the publication: NAVFAC DM
7.2, Foundation and Earth Structures, U.S. Department of the Navy 1984, where all
approaches are described in detail. The analysis provides the pile base resistanceR
>
and the
pile shaft resistanceR
s
.
For non-cohesive, the program takes into account the critical depth.
Pile )ase resistance
Pile base resistance for non6cohesi&e soils is given by:
where:
e6>
- effective stress on the pile base
3

- bearing capacity factor


+
>
- area of pile base
The bearing capacity factor3

is back calculated by the program; however, its values can be


manually modified.
For cohesi&e soils the following expression holds:
where: c
9
- undrained shear strength at the base
+
>
- area of pile base
Pile sha"t resistance
Pile shaft resistance for non6cohesi&e soils is given by:
where: 2
'
- coefficient of lateral earth pressure in the '-th layer

e6, '
- effective strength of soil in the '-th layer
V
'
- pile skin friction angle (between pile material and surrounding soil in the '-
th layer)
+
s'
- area of pile shaft in the '-th layer
The lateral earth pressure coefficient2 is back calculated by the program; however, its values
can be manually modified in the "Add new soils" dialog window.
For cohesi&e soils the following expression holds:
-879-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: G
'
- skin friction coefficient in the '-th layer
c
9, '
- undrained cohesion in th '-th layer
+
s'
- area of pile shaft in the '-th layer
Bearing capacit% "actor .H
Reference values of the bearing capacity factor 3

are listed in the table. If jet grouting is used


when constructing the pile, then the maximum angle of internal friction is equal to 2B
A
.
Bearing capacit% "actor 3

Angle of internal friction
[A]
2@ 2B "0 "1 "2 "" "4 "# "@ "X "B "E 40
Bearing capacity factor 3

for driven piles
10 1# 21 24 2E "# 42 #0 @2 XX B@ 12
0
14
#
Bearing capacity factor
3

for bored piles
# B 10 12 14 1X 21 2# "0 "B 4" @0 X2
3iterature4
NAVFAC DM 7.2, Foundation and Earth Structures, U.S. Department of the Navy, 1984.
Coe""icient o" lateral earth pressure 7
The soil around a driven pile is compressed during construction and the lateral earth pressure
of this soil acting on the pile skin is greater than the earth pressure at rest (given by
coefficient 2
0
) and smaller than the maximum earth pressure (passive earth pressure given
by coefficient 2
p
):
Reference values of the coefficient of lateral earth pressure 2 are listed later in the table. The
coefficient of lateral earth pressure 2 is approximated as follows:
where: 2
0
- coefficient of earth pressure at rest

- angle of soil shear resistance
2
p
- coefficient of passive earth pressure

-880-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
2
a
- coeffiecient of active earth pressure

Pressure on the pile
,e"erence &alues o" the lateral earth pressure coe""icient 2
!%pe o" pile 2 "or co'pression
piles
2 "or tensile +
upli"ted piles
Driven H-piles 0,# W 1,0 0," W 0,#
Driven displacement piles
(round and square)
1,0 W 1,# 0,@ W 1,0
Driven displacement
tapered piles
1,# W 2,0 1,0 W 1,"
Driven jetted piles 0,4 - 0,E 0," - 0,@
Bored piles (less than
70cm)
0,X 0,4
3iterature4
NAVFAC DM 7.2, Foundation and Earth Structures, U.S. Department of the Navy, 1984.
Friction angle on pile skin
Reference values of friction angle between the pile skin material and the surrounding non-
cohesive soil are listed in the following table:
Friction angle on pile V [w]
Pile 'aterial V [w]
Steel piles 20
Timber piles 0,X#
Steel reinforced concrete
piles
0,X#
where: - angle of internal friction of soil
3iterature4
-881-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
.,"F,C DM ?:0< Foundation and (arth Structures< B:S: Department of the .a#< 5>I2:
Adhesion coe""icient
Reference values of the adhesion coefficient Gare listed in the following table:
3'pirical adhesion coe""icient G
Pile 'aterial Soil consistenc% Cohesion range
c
9
gk3Hm
2
h
Adhesion
coe""icient G [-]
!i')er and concrete
piles
Very soft 0 - 12 0,00 - 1,00
Soft 12 - 24 1,00 - 0,E@
Medium stiff 24 - 4B 0,E@ - 0,X#
Stiff 4B - E@ 0,X# - 0,4B
Very stiff E@ - 1E2 0,4B - 0,""
Steel piles Very soft 0 - 12 0,00 - 1,00
Soft 12 - 24 1,00 - 0,E2
Medium stiff 24 - 4B 0,E2 - 0,X0
Stiff 4B - E@ 0,X0 - 0,"@
Very stiff E@ - 1E2 0,"@ - 0,1E
3iterature4
.,"F,C DM ?:0< Foundation and (arth Structures< B:S: Department of the .a#< 5>I2:
Critical depth
For non6cohesi&e soils the skin friction does not increases infinitely with depth as e.g.
effective stress, but from a certain so called critical depth it acquires a constant value see
the following figure, where ,
c
is the critical depth, S
c
is the skin friction at critical depth and ,
is the pile diameter. Similar rule holds also for the pile base resistance in non-cohesive soils,
where the same values of the critical depth ,
c
are considered for simplicity.
-882-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Crtitical depth
The reference value of the critical depth for soft sand is 10, (, is the pile diameter or its
width), for medium compact sand and compact sand the values are 1#, and 20,, respectively.
!he coe""icient o" critical depth k
,c
can be specified in the "Ver. capacity". The critical depth
follows from:
where: k
,c
- critical depth coefficient
, - pile diameter
!o'linson
This widely used method adopts undrained shear strength parameters to calculate the pile
bearing capacity. It further assumes that the pile shaft resistance depends on the pressure due
to overburden surcharge.
The pile sha"t resistance is given by:
where: c
a, '
- adhesion in the j-th layer (shear stress between the pile skin and the
surrounding soil)
+
s, '
- area of pile shaft in the j-th layer
G
'
- empirical adhesion coefficient (depends on the type of soil, type of pile, etc.)
in the j-th layer
c
9, '
- undrained cohesion in the j-th layer (undrained shear strength)
The empirical adhesion coefficientG is back calculated by the program. Its values, however, can
be manually adjusted in the "Add new soil" dialog window.
The pile )ase resistance is given by:
where:
>
- unit pile base resistance
+
>
- pile base area
c
9
- undrained shear strength
-883-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Adhesion coe""icient
The empirical adhesion coefficient G takes into account the behavior of soil around the pile skin
and depends on the pile material, quality of the pile skin surface and the type of surrounding
soil. Values of this coefficient are introduced into the program employing the following graph
taken from M.J. Tomlinson: Pile Design and Construction Practice.
)raph to determine adhesion coefficient
3""ecti&e length
The effective length < determines the pile length, which effectively transfers the load from the
pile into the soil. If the whole pile is placed into the resistant soil, in which the load is
transferred by skin friction, then the effective length corresponds to the pile length below
terrain see Fig. A. In case of layered medium, highly compressible layers (in which the load
is not transferred into the soil by skin friction) and the layers above are not counted into the
effective length < see Fig. B. Introduction of effective length into the analysis and its
magnitude are set in the frame "Vertical capacity".
Fig: , (ffectie length in resistant soils
-884-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Fig: @ (ffectie length in la#ered medium
3""ecti&e stress 'ethod
The effective stress method allows for calculating the vertical bearing capacity of an isolated
pile in both cohesive and non-cohesive soils. This method is suitable for drained conditions
i.e. conditions that prevail after sufficient time passed the construction.
The pile sha"t resistance is given by:
where:
s, '
- shaft resistance in the j-th layer
Y
p,'
- coefficients according to Bjerrum and Burland in the j-th layer

0, '
- average effective stress due to overburden acting along the pile in the j-th
layer
+
s'
- pile shaft area in the j-th layer
The pile )ase resistance is given by:
where:
p
- unit pile base resistance
+
>
- pile base area
3
p
- pile base resistance coefficient (according Fellenius)

p
- effective stress due to overburden acting at pile base
Coe""icients o" pile )earing capacit%
Recommended ranges of values of coefficients of pile base resistance 3
p
and coefficient Yare
listed in the following table. The coefficient Yis usually found in the given range, it seldom
exceeds the value 1,0.
,ange o" coe""icients 3
p
and Y (Fellenius, 1991)
-885-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
!%pe o" soil
e6
3
p
Y
Clay 25 50 3 30 0,23 - 0,40
Silt 28 34 20 40 0,27 - 0,50
Sand 32 40 30 150 0,30 - 0,60
Gravel 35 - 45 60 - 300 0,35 - 0,80
3iterature4
Felenius< @:H:4 Foundation (ngineering Handboo9< (ditor H:S: Fang< "an .ostrand 6einhold
Publisher< .ew /or9< 5>>5< -55 - -3H
CS. E4 1FF2
There are two methods implemented in the program to compute the pile vertical bearing
capacity following the Commentary to the CS. E4 1FF2 standard "Pile "oundation":
- Anal%sis according to the theor% o" the 1st group o" li'it states
The solution procedure is described in the Commentary to the CSN 73 1002 standard "Pile
foundation" in Chapter 3 "Design" part B general solution according to the theory of the 1st
group of limit states (pp. 15). All computational approaches are based on formulas presented
therein. The original geostatic stress
or
is assumed from the finished grade. The coefficient of
conditions of the behavior of foundation soil is considered for the depth / (measured from the
finished grade).
The effective pile length used for the computation of skin bearing capacity is reduced by a
segment:
where: , - pile diameter
- Anal%sis o" pile resting on inco'pressi)le su)soil
Analysis of a pile resting on incompressible subsoil (rocks class R1, R2) is based on part G -
Analysis of vertical bearing capacity R
c
according to CSN 73 1004 - Commentary to CSN 73
1002 "Pilotov zklady". The description begins in page 27 titled "Piles resting on
incompressible subsoil". The solution procedures used in the program are identical. The
influence coefficient of settlement 1
$p
is interpolated from Table 16, which is also built-in the
program.
If checking the option "anal%sis according to CS. E4 1FF2" in the "Piles" tab sheet the
verification analysis is carried out exclusively according to CSN 73 10002 and other coefficients
ate not used. Providing this option is not checked the verification is performed based on the
selected methodology adopting particular coefficients.
-886-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
3iterature4
Tes9osloens9h sthtnO norma TS. ?3 5110 PilotoY !h9lad#< .ormali!aQnO institut< Praha< 5>I?
Tes9osloens9h sthtnO norma TS. ?3 5112 "el9oprimjroY pilot#< .ormali!aQnO institut<
Praha< 5>I5
5eri"ication
Verification of pile )earing capacit% depends on the verification methodology selected in the
"Piles" tab sheet:
- verification according to the factor of safety
- verification according to the theory of limit states
- verification according to EN 1997
Actual analyses (e.g. assessment of the pile base resistance) are the same for both options
they differ only by incorporation of design coefficients, combinations and in the way of
demonstrating the structure safety. Design coefficients (verification parameters) are specified
in the "Piles" tab sheet.
If the verification analysis according to CS. E4 1FF2 is selected, the verification is carried
out exclusively according to the Commentary to CSN 73 10002.
5eri"ication according to the theor% o" li'it states
When running the verification analysis according to the theory of limit states, it is possible to
introduce the required values of design coefficients in the "Piles" tab sheet.
The program performs verification of the co'pression pile as:
where: R
c
- pile compressive resistance
R
>
- pile base resistance
R
s
- pile shaft resistance

>
- partial factor on pile base resistance

s
- partial factor on pile shaft resistance
\
,
- extreme vertical load acting on a pile
%
p
- pile self-weight
For tension pile the following verification applies:
where: R
s,t
- pile tensile resistance
R
s
- pile shaft resistance

st
- partial factor on tensile pile shaft resistance
-887-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
\
,
- extreme vertical load acting on a pile
%
p
- pile self-weight
$esign coe""icients
The "Piles" tab sheet serves to specify two groups of design (partial) coefficients:
Partial "actors on soil para'eters

m
- reduction coefficient of internal friction

mc
- reduction coefficient of cohesion

m
- coefficient of unit weight
It is also possible to choose reduction of t5:
Partial "actors on pile resistance

>
- reduction coefficient of base resistance

s
- reduction coefficient of shaft resistance

t
- reduction coefficient of total resistance

st
- reduction coefficient of resistance in tension
The values of individual coefficients are listed in corresponding standards.
5eri"ication according to "actors o" sa"et%
When running the verification analysis according to the factor of safety, it is possible to
introduce the required value of factor safety SF for the vertical bearing capacity in the "Piles"
tab sheet.
The program performs verification of vertical bearing capacity of co'pression pile as:
where: \
,
- extreme vertical load acting on a pile
R
c
- pile compressive resistance
%
p
- pile self-weight (introduction into the analysis based on the setting
in the frame "Load")
and for tension pile:
where: \
,
- extreme vertical load acting on a pile
R
st
- pile tensile resistance
-888-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
%
p
- pile self-weight
5ertical )earing capacit% 6 Spring 'ethod
The program module "Pile + spring 'ethod" is part of the "Pile" program. It serves to
calculate the pile vertical bearing capacity in general layered subsoil. This analysis provides the
limit loading curve and distributions of forces and displacements developed along the pile.
The main advantage of this module is availability of the required input parameters of soils
around the pile the user is asked to specify the angle o" internal "riction1 cohesion1 unit
weight and de"or'ation 'odulus of a given soil.
The solution procedure in the module "Pile + spring 'ethod" is based on a semi-analytical
approach. The response of soil surrounding the pile follows from the well known solution of
layered subsoil as a generalization of the Winkler-Pasternak model. The elastic rigid plastic
response in shear is assumed along the pile-soil interface in view of the Mohr-Coulomb failure
criterion. The normal stress acting on the pile is determined from the geostatic stress and soil
(concrete mixture) pressure at rest.
The in"luence o" water in the vicinity of pile is not only introduced into the shear bearing
capacity of the pile skin, but also affects the depth of influence zone below the pile heel.
Providing the pile reaches incompressible subsoil the spring method cannot be used.
The pile settlement can also be influenced by the settlement of the surrounding terrain. In
particular, settlement of soil may reduce the pile bearing capacity. The pile settlement
increases without increasing load. This phenomenon is modeled in the program as so called
negative skin friction.
The analysis may also account for the influence of technological process of pile construction on
the stiffness of pile foundation.
The solution procedure consists of several steps:
1) In analysis the pile subdivided into a number of segments. Subdivision into individual
segments complies with the condition that the ratio between the pile segment and its
diameter should be approximately equal to 2,#. The minimum number of segments is 10.
2) Each segment is in the analysis characterized by a spring. The spring stiffness serves to
model both the shear resistance of skin and at the pile heel the stiffness of soil below the
pile heel.
3) For each segment the limit value of shear forceP
8)m
transmitted by the skin is determined.
4) The pile is loaded at its top end by increments of the vertical load. For each load increment
the magnitude of spring force for each segment is determined. However, it cannot exceed
the limit value of skin friction P
8)m
. It is clear that for a certain load level all springs will no
longer be able to increase their force and with additional load increase the pile becomes
supported by the base spring only. This spring has no restriction on the transmitted force.
5) As a result the analysis provides the limit loading curve, forces developed in the pile and a
graph showing variation of shear as a function of deformation at a given location.
#i'it loading cur&e
The limit loading curve describes the variation of vertical load ( as a function of the pile
settlement.
By default the program offers the construction of this curve for the maximal value of
-889-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
settlement equal to 2# mm. This magnitude, however, can be adjusted up to the value of
100 mm before running the calculation. An example showing a typical shape of the limit loading
curve appears in the figure.
3imit loading cure
Shear strength o" skin
For each segment of the analyzed pile the program determines the limiting value of the force
that can be transmitted by the pile skin at the location of a given segment. Its value depends
on the geostatic stress
/
found at a depth of a given segment.
where: - unit weight of soil
h - depth below the ground surface
Summation sign denotes that
/
is summed over individual layers of the soil.
The allowable shear stress is then given by:
where: c - cohesion of soil at the location of beam
- angle of internal friction of soil at the location of beam
k - coefficient of increase of allowable skin friction due to technology
If the beam is found below the ground water table, the allowable skin friction is then reduced
to receive the form:
where: 9 - pore pressure below the ground water table
-890-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The allowable shear force then follows from:
where: T - length of perimeter of pile skin
8 - length of pile beam
Coe""icient o" increase o" li'it skin "riction
A specific input parameter is the coefficient of increase of limit skin friction k due to applied
technology of construction. By default the value of this coefficient is set equal to one. There is
no recommendation by standard for its specific value its adjustment depends solely on the
practical experiences of the designer. It has been found from the in situ measurements on real
piles that the value of k is usually greater than 5 and may reach the value of 1,#. Theoretically,
however, it may attain values even less than 1:
$epth o" de"or'ation -one
The assumed depth of influence is a variable, which considerably influences the stiffness of soil
below the pile heel. It is one of the input parameters for the determination of parameters S
1
and S
2
of the Winkler-Pasternak model. The deeper the influence zone the smaller the stiffness
of subsoil. When the depth of influence zone approaches in the limit zero the stiffness of
subsoil tends to infinity.
The depth of influence zone depends both on subsoil parameters and magnitude of the applied
surcharge, thus on stress below the pile heel. The program assumes that the depth of
influence zone is found in the location, where the stress below the heel equals the geostatic
stress. Such an idea is depicted in the following figure:
Determination of the depth of influence !one below the pile heel
For digital determination of the depth of influence zone e serves the function F(Y). Its
distribution appears in figure. This function was derived using the above assumptions and in
the program appears in the form of table. Its application is evident from the following steps.
-891-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The values of F(Y) are determined for the current value of stress 6
/
below the pile heel and for
the original geostatic stress
h
. For this value of F(Y) we determine the parameter Y. This value
serves to determine for the actual value Poisson's number Jand pile diameter r the
corresponding depth of influence zone e.
"ariation of function F7]8
The depth of influence zone can be affected by the presence of ground water. In such s case its
determination is outlined in following figure:
Determination of the depth of influence !one below the pile heel including water
-892-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
For digital determination of the depth of influence zone e is then used the function &(Y). Its
distribution appears in figure. In the analysis this function is exploited in the similar way as
function F(Y). The only difference when determining the values of &(Y) appears in the use of
hydrostatic pressure
$M
h
$
.
"ariation of function )7]8
Inco'pressi)le su)soil
At a certain depth below the ground surface it is possible to specify incompressible subsoil. If
the pile exceeds this specified depth the spring method cannot be used, because the pile is
assumed rigid and therefore no deformation can developed in its surrounding. If there is
incompressible subsoil below the pile heel but not deeper than the depth of influence zone
below the heel, the depth of influence zone for the stiffness computation is reduced such that
the influence zone reaches the incompressible subsoil. This way also the incompressible subsoil
below the base increases its stiffness and consequently also the bearing capacity of the pile
base. If the incompressible subsoil is found below the depth of influence zone, it does not
influence the analyzed pile.
.egati&e skin "riction
A negative skin friction is a phenomenon that arises from a settlement of soil in the vicinity of
a pile. The soil deforming around the pile tends to pull the pile downwards thus reducing its
bearing capacity for a given pile settlement.
-893-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The input parameters for assessing the influence of negative skin friction is the settlement of
ground surface $ and a depth of influence zone of this deformation h. For a uniformly
distributed load around the pile the value of $ should be measured in the distance equal to
three times the pile diameter from its outer face. The value then represents the depth
influenced by the ground surface settlement and below which the soil is assumed
incompressible with no deformation.
Computation of negative skin friction is carried out first while determining the limit shear
forces transmitted by the pile skin P
8)m
. The solution procedure assumes that the soil
settlement decreases linearly with depth from the value of $ on the ground surface up to 0 at a
depth of h. The specific value of the soil settlement is therefore assumed for each level below
the ground surface till the depth of h. The forces developed in springs of pile segments due to
their deformation are determined and then subtracted from P
8)m
to reduce the bearing capacity
of the pile skin.
From the presented theory it is evident that for large settlement $ or large depth h the values
of P
8)m
may drop down to zero. In extreme cases the negative skin friction may completely
eliminate the skin bearing capacity so that the pile is then supported only by the elastic subsoil
below the pile heel.
In"luence o" technolog%
The pile bearing capacity is considerably influenced by technological processes applied during
construction. The module "Pile 6 Spring 'ethod" allows for specifying the technology of pile
construction. The mobilized skin friction and the resistance at the pile heel are then reduced
with the help of reduction coefficients depending on the selected technology. The values of
these coefficients follow from the Dutch standard NEN 6743 Pile foundation.
Apart from technologies offered by the program and corresponding coefficients the users are
free to assign to these coefficients their own values. This way the users may introduce their
own practical experiences or information provided by other sources into the analysis.
Shear resistance on skin
The shear resistance on pile skin is in the analysis represented by the stiffness of springs
supporting individual pile segments. This stiffness is associated with material parameters of
the Winkler-Pasternak model S
1
and S
2
. The values of S
1
and S
2
are determined from
parameter -
,e6
. They depend on the depth of influence zone, which varies with the pile
deformation (settlement). The variability of influence zone is in the analysis determined such
that for zero deformation it receives the value of 1 the pile diameter and for deformation at
the onset of skin failure equals k the pile diameter, where k is the specified value, resp. 2,#.
The decisive parameter for the determination of magnitudes of S
1
and S
2
is the deformation
modulus. Caution must be taken when estimating the value of -
,e6
from deformational
characteristics of soil using standards. In particular, in case of long piles we are essentially
dealing with deep seated foundations and the soil at the pile heel will certainly experiences
higher stiffness than that proposed by the standard for spread footings. This holds particularly
for cohesive soils. The most reliable estimates are of course those obtained directly from
experimental measurements.
Formulas given below serve to determine the stiffness of springs representing the shear
resistance of pile skin as a function of computed parameters of the elastic subsoil. They
depend on the shape of cross-section and for the implemented cross-sections they receive the
following forms:
Circle;
-894-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: r - radius of pile cross-section
S
1
, S
2
- subsoil parameters
2
1
(G
r
), 2
2
(G
r
) - values of the modified Bessel functions
Parameter E attains the value:
,ectangle;
where a,> are lengths of rectangle edges and S
1
,S
2
are subsoil parameters and k
re,
is the
reduction coefficient, which reduces the stiffness with respect to slenderness of the rectangle.
It receives the following values
where ais the length of a shorter edge of the rectangle and eis the depth of influence zone.
Croos1 :I6section:;
For these cross-sections the stiffness is derived from the stiffness of rectangular cross-section
reduced by subtracting the stiffness corresponding to four "removed" parts of the cross-
section.
a
1
, >
1
- evident from the following figure
-895-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Sti""ness o" su)soil )elow the pile heel
The soil stiffness below the pile heel follows from the value of stiffness of the Winkler model
S
1
. The value of S
1
is determined for soil parameters -
,e6
and J at the location of pile heel.
The value of S
1
further depends on the depth of influence zone beneath the heel.
The spring stiffness introduced at the pile base is then provided by:
where: + - cross-sectional area at the pile heel
$istri)utions o" "orces acting on pile
Apart from the limit loading curve it is also possible to keep track of the distribution of normal
force in the pile and the distribution of shear force developed along the pile skin. The normal
forces decreases from the top to the bottom as the load is gradually taken by the shear force
developed along the pile skin. Unlike the normal force the shear force thus increases from the
top to the bottom. Both forces are evaluated in relative values related to the magnitude of
vertical load.
$ependence o" shear on de"or'ation
At an arbitrary (selected) depth it is possible to view the distribution of skin friction as a
function of deformation (settlement) of a given point of the pile. This graph shows the process
of gradual reduction of shear stiffness of pile skin until zero with increasing deformation. This
dependency is initially linear, particularly in stage, where the spring force does not exceed the
value P
8)m
. When this value is exceeded the spring stiffness starts to gradually decrease
manifested by the flattening of the curve.
Pile settle'ent
Two options are available to perform the pile settlement analysis:
- Nonlinear theory (Masopust)
- Linear theory (Poulos)
.onlinear theor% @/asopustA
The nonlinear theory constructs the loading curve (3oad $ settlement cure8 assuming that
evolution of settlement as a function of resistance up to full mobilization of skin friction can be
represented by parabola. After that the relationship is linear as displayed in Figure. This
method was derived from equations of regression curves constructed on the basis of statistical
analysis of the results of static loading tests of piles and for the determination of vertical
bearing capacity it employs regression coefficients. Further details are provided herein.
-896-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
3oading cure
3iterature4
Masopust Pan4 "rtanY pilot#< Praha< Cenk9 a Pele9< 5>>2
Approach according to /asopust
The loading curve is constructed in the following way:
1A !he ulti'ate skin "riction
s
is deter'ined as "ollows;
where: a,> - regression coefficient of the specific skin friction
0
)
- depth from terrain up to the middle of the i-the layer
,
)
- pile diameter in the i-the layer
and pile skin bearing capacity is the provided by:
where: m
1
- load type coefficient
m
2
- shaft protection coefficient
,
)
- pile diameter in the i-the layer
h
)
- thickness of the i-the layer

s)
ultimate skin friction in the i-th layer
2A !he pile )ase )earing capacit%
>
"ollows "ro';
where: e, 6 - regression coefficients below pile base
-897-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
< - pile length inside soils
,
>
- pile tip diameter
4A !he load trans"erred to pile )ase coe""icient Y is written as;
where:
>
- pile base bearing capacity

- weighted average of ultimate skin friction
< - pile length inside soils
,
>
pile tip diameter
The load to mobilize skin friction R
s?
is then given by:
where: R
s
-pile skin bearing capacity
Y -load transferred to pile base coefficient
CA !he #oad at the sha"t resistance acti&ation R
s?
reads;
where: 1
s
- settlement coefficient
R
s?
- load at the mobilization of skin friction
, - pile diameter
-
s
- secant deformation modulus of the surrounding soil
BA !he load at the pile )ase "or the prescri)ed settle'ent @"or li'iting settle'ent o"
2# mm A "ollows "ro';
where: Y - load transferred to pile base coefficient
R
s?
- load at the mobilization of skin friction
s
8)m
- limiting settlement (described), usually 2# mm
s
?
settlement at shaft resistance activation
aThe pile resistance attributed to a given settlement S
8)m
is then provided by:
where: R
>8)m
- load on pile base for prescribed settlement
-898-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
R
s
- pile shaft resistance
,pproach according to Masopust
,egression coe""icients
The specific skin friction depends on regression coefficients a, >. The pile base resistance (at
the full mobilization of skin friction) depends on the regression coefficients e, 6. The values of
these regression coefficients were derived from equations of regression curves constructed on
the basis of statistical analysis of the results of approximately "#0 static loading tests of piles.
The dialog window for entering regression coefficients can be displayed in the frame
"Settlement" using the "3dit a, >", "3dit e, 6" buttons. When editing the dialog window displays
the recommended values of regression coefficients for various types of soils and rocks.
-899-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dialog window "+nput for loading cure" $ input of regression coefficients a< b 7e< f8
Coe""icients '11 '2
#oad t%pe coe""icient m
1
;
- for service loading 0,X
- for extreme loading 1,0
Sha"t protection coe""icient m
2
;
- for concreting in dry shaft or under water 1,0
- for concreting with bentonite slurry 0,E
- for PVC sheet pile protection (thickness over 0,X mm) 0,X
- for sheet pile protection and B system mesh 0,#
- for steel casing tube protection 0,1#
Secant de"or'ation 'odulus 3s
The values of secant modulus -
s
should be determined experimentally by in-situ
-900-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
measurements (presiometric tests). The dialog window for entering the secant modulus can be
displayed in the frame "Settlement" using the "3dit -
s
" button. When editing the window
displays the recommended values of the secant modulus.
Dialog window "+nput for loading cure" $ secant deformation modulus (s
Settle'ent coe""icient Is
The settlement coefficient depends on the depth of pile below the surface of a resistant layer <
and the pile diameter ,. The settlement coefficient 1
s
is given by:
where: 1
0
- base settlement influence coefficient
R
k
- corrective factor for pile compressibility
R
h
- corrective factor for finite depth of layer on a rigid base
#inear theor% @PoulosA
Construction of the limit loading curve is based on the solution described in the book by H.G.
Poulos a E.H. Davis - Pile Foundations Analysis and Design and is based on the theory of
elasticity and modifications attributed to in-situ measurements. Foundation soil is therefore
characterized by the modulus of elasticity - and by the Poisson number J. This method allows
-901-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
for constructing the limit loading curve for:
- Piles resting on stiff subsoil
- Piles floating in compressible subsoil
The basic input parameters of the analysis are R
>
and R
s
. These values are obtained by the
program from the analysis of bearing capacity based on the selected method. All partial factors
of the analysis are assumed equal to one so that the resulting resistance is greater than the
one obtained from actual bearing capacity analysis.
3oading cure
3iterature4
H:): Poulos a (:H: Dais - Pile Foundations ,nal#sis and Design
Piles resting on sti"" su)soil
The basic assumption of the analysis is the determination of the load at the shaft resistance
activation R
s?
. At this point the shaft resistance no longer increases. Further loading is taken by
the pile base only:
where: R
s
-pile shaft resistance
Y -load transferred to pile base coefficient
The load trans"erred to the pile coe""icient ] is provided by:
where: Y
0
- tip load proportion for incompressible pile
S
k
- corrective coefficient for pile compressibility
S
J
- corrective coefficient for influence of Poissons number of soil
-902-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
S
>
- corrective coefficient for stiffness soil stratum
The corresponding settle'ent at sha"t resistance acti&ation s
?
is given by:
where: 1 - settlement influence coefficient
-
s
- deformation modulus of soil or secant deformation modulus of soil along
pile shaft
, - pile diameter
R
s?
- load at the shaft resistance activation
The settle'ent in"luence coe""icient 1 is written as:
where: 1
0
- base settlement influence coefficient
R
k
- corrective factor for pile compressibility
R
>
- corrective factor for stiffness soil layer
R
0
- corrective factor for Poissons number of soil
The total li'it settle'ent follows from:
where: 1 - settlement influence coefficient
R
>9
- pile base bearing capacity
Y - load transferred to pile base coefficient
, - pile diameter
-
s
deformation modulus of soil or secant deformation modulus of soil along
pile shaft
Piles "loating in co'pressi)le su)soil
The maximum settlement s
8)m
is derived from:
where: 1
s
- settlement influence coefficient
-
s
- deformation modulus of soil or secant deformation modulus of soil along
pile shaft
, - pile diameter
R
s?
- load at the shaft resistance activation
The settle'ent in"luence coe""icient 1
s
is written as:
-903-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: 1
0
- basic settlement influence coefficient
R
k
- corrective factor for pile compressibility
R
h
- corrective factor for finite depth of layer on a rigid base
R
0
- corrective factor for Poissons number of soil
Correcti&e "actor "or PoissonSs nu')er ,&
The corrective factor for the influence of Poissons number R
J
accounts for the influence of
reduction of Poissons number of soils surrounding the pile on the values of pile settlement for
constant modulus of these soils. These values are generally presented as a function of
Poissons number of the surrounding soil J
s
for various pile stiffness factors2. The graphs are
implemented in the program in a digital format.
Correctie factor for influence of Poissonms number 6c
Correcti&e "actor "or sti""ness soil la%er ,)
The values of the corrective factor R
>
are generally presented as a function of the ratio of
moduli of elasticity of the soil at the pile base and the surrounding soil (-
>
;-) for various pile
stiffness factors2 and various pile length to pile diameter ratios (8;,8. The graphs are
implemented in the program in a digital format.
-904-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Correctie factor for stiffness soil la#er 6b
Correctie factor for stiffness soil la#er 6b
!ip load proportion "or inco'pressi)le pile B3!Ao
The tip load proportion for incompressible pile Y
0
represents the influence of compression of
elastic half-space, which adopts the load transferred by the pile from incompressible soil. The
values of this coefficient are generally presented as a function of the pile length to pile
diameter ratio (8H,) for various pile base diameter to pile diameter ratios (,
>
H,). The graphs are
implemented in the program in a digital format.
-905-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Tip load proportion for incompressible pile ]1
Correcti&e coe""icient "or pile co'pressi)ilit% Ck
The values of the coefficient S
k
are generally presented as a function of the pile stiffness
factor2 for various pile length to pile diameter ratios (8H,). The graphs are implemented in the
program in a digital format.
Correctie coefficient for pile compressibilit# C9
-906-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Correcti&e coe""icient "or in"luence o" PoissonTs nu')er
o" soil C&
The values of the coefficient S
J
are generally presented as a function of Poissons number of the
surrounding soil J
s
for various pile stiffness factors2. The graphs are implemented in the
program in a digital format.
Correctie coefficient for influence of Poissonns number of soil Cc
Correcti&e coe""icient "or sti""ness soil stratu' C)
The values of the coefficient S
>
are generally presented as a function of the ratio of moduli of
elasticity of the soil at the pile base and the surrounding soil (-
>
;-) for various pile stiffness
factors2 and various pile length to pile diameter ratios (8;,8. The graphs are implemented in
the program in a digital format.
-907-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Correctie coefficient for stiffness soil stratum Cb 7 3;d`51 8
Correctie coefficient for stiffness soil stratum Cb 7 3;d`- 8
Pile sti""ness "actor 7
The pile stiffness factor is defined as:
where: -
p
- elastic modulus of pile material
-
s
- elastic modulus of surrounding soil or more precisely an average secant
-908-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
deformation modulus of soils along the pile shaft
R
a
- ratio of area of pile section to area bounded by pile outer-circumference
where: +
1
- average area of pile
+
2
- area of pile shaft
(for stiff piles R
a
= 1)
Basic settle'ent in"luence coe""icient Io
The basic settlement influence coefficient 1
o
depends on the pile length 8 and diameter , and
the values of this coefficient are generally provided by the following graph also showing their
ranges:
@asic settlement influence coefficient +o
These graphs are implemented in the program in a digital format.
Correcti&e "actor "or pile co'pressi)ilit% ,k
The corrective factor R
k
represents the pile stiffness in dependence on the pile stiffness factor2
for various ratios of the pile length to pile diameter (8;,). Its values are provided by the
following graph are implemented in the program in a digital format.
-909-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Correctie factor for pile compressibilit# 69
Correcti&e "actor "or "inite depth o" la%er on a rigid
)ase ,h
The corrective factor R
h
represents the influence of incompressible layer below the pile base.
Its values are again presented in the literature graphically for various pile length to pile
diameter ratios (8;,) and ratios of pile length to thickness of compressible layer above the
incompressible layer (8;hor h;8). The graphs are implemented in the program in a digital
format.
Correctie factor for finite depth of la#er on a rigid base 6h
-910-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Hori-ontal )earing capacit%
Hori-ontal )earing capacit% o" a pile1 di'ensioning
The horizontally loaded pile is analyzed using the finite element method as a beam on elastic
Winkler foundation. The soil parameters along the pile are represented by the modulus of
subsoil reaction. By default the pile is subdivided into 30 segments. For each segment the
program determines the values of the modulus of subsoil reaction, internal forces and
deformations. The program also allows for dimensioning of the steel-reinforced concrete pile
based on the method specified in the frame "Settings" and on the parameters inputted in the
"Piles" tab sheet.
The program also enables to analyze a pile loaded by the prescri)ed displace'ents
(translation or rotation of the pile head). In such a case the analysis is carried out only with
the prescribed displacement. The inputted mechanical loading is excluded.
The following options for inputting the 'odulus o" su)soil reaction are available in the
program:
- )% distri)ution (distribution of the modulus of subsoil reaction along the pile is specified)
- constant distribution
- linear distribution (Bowles)
- according to CSN 73 1004
- according to Matlock and Rees
- according to Vesic
In general, the modulus of subsoil reaction corresponds to the spring stiffness in the Winkler
model. This model describes settlement of a rigid plate as a function of the applied load. The
corresponding relationship is represented by the following formula:
where: p - load acting along plate-soil interface
k - stiffness of Winkler spring
? - translation of plate into subsoil
Definition of the modulus of subsoil reaction
Constant distri)ution o" 'odulus o" su)soil reaction
The modulus of subsoil reaction of the )
th
layer is provided by:
where:
-911-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
-
,e6
- deformation modulus of soil
r - reduced width of pile given by:
where:
, - pile diameter
Y - angle of dispersion is inputted with respect to the angle of internal friction in the
range of H4-
#inear 'odulus o" su)soil reaction
The modulus of subsoil reaction at a depth ! follows from the formula:
where: , - pile diameter
8 - length of pile
k - soil parameter after Bowles
r - reduced width of pile
where: , - pile diameter
Y - angle of dispersion introduced by the user is inputted with respect to the
angle of internal friction in the range of L;2-L
Possi)le &alues o" 'odulus k a"ter Bowles [!3Hm
"
]
dense sandy gravel 011 - 211
medium dense gravel 5-1 - 311
medium-graded sand 511 - 0-1
fine sand I1 - 011
stiff clay H1 - 5I1
saturated stiff clay 31 - 511
plastic clay 31 - 511
saturated plastic clay 51 - I1
soft clay 0 - 31
3iterature4
"esic< ,:S:< Design of Pile Foundations< .ational Cooperatie Highwa# 6esearch Program
S#nthesis 20< Transportation 6esearch @oard< 5>??
-912-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
/odulus o" su)soil reaction according to CS. E4 1FFC
The modulus of subsoil reaction for cohesi&e soil assumes the form:
where: -
,e6
- deformation modulus of soil
, - pile diameter
For cohesionless soils it is provided by:
where: F
h
- modulus of horizontal compressibility
, - pile diameter
/ depth of a given section from finished grade
Possi)le &alues o" 'odulus F
h
"or cohesionless soils
Soil
F
h
g!3Hm
"
h
Relative density 1
<
0,33 0,50 0,90
Dry sand and gravel
Wet sand and gravel
1,5
2,5
7,0
4,5
18,0
11,0
/odulus o" su)soil reaction a"ter /atlock and ,ees
This method is applicable for cohesionless soils. The modulus of subsoil reaction then follows
from the expression:
where: F
h
- modulus of horizontal compressibility
/ depth of a given section from finished grade
Possi)le &alues o" 'odulus F
h
"or cohesionless soils
-913-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Soil
F
h
[!3Hm
"
]
Dry sand and gravel
- loose
- medium dense
- dense
1,B W 2,2
#,# W X,0
1#,0 - 1B,0
Wet sand and gravel
- loose
- medium dense
- dense
1,0 W 1,4
",# W 4,#
E,0 - 12,0
/odulus o" su)soil reaction a"ter 5esic
The modulus of subsoil reaction is provided by:
where: -
p
- modulus of elasticity of pile
1
p
- moment of inertia of pile
-
s
- modulus of elasticity of soil
, - pile diameter
J - Poisson's ratio
3iterature4
"esic< ,:S:< Design of Pile Foundations< .ational Cooperatie Highwa# 6esearch Program
S#nthesis 20< Transportation 6esearch @oard< 5>??
Pile Group
Analyses performed in the "Pile group" program can be divided into two groups:
- Analytical solution - calculation of the vertical bearing capacity of a pile group for cohesive
and cohesionless soils and the determination of settlement
- Analysis of a pile group using the spring method together with the determination of
reinforcement of piles
Anal%tical solution
Analysis of the vertical bearing capacity of a pile group can be performed for:
- cohesionless soil (analysis for drained conditions)
- cohesive soil (analysis for undrained conditions)
The actual verification analysis is carried out according to the factors of safety or the theory of
-914-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
limit states.
The verification is performed for the &ertical load only. Loading due to moments and shear
forces is not considered. To account for horizontal actions of the pile group calls for choosing
the spring method in the frame "Settings".
The analytical methods also allow for calculating the pile group settlement.
Cohesionless soil @anal%sis "or drained conditionsA
The same methods as for the analysis of an isolated pile are used to calculate the vertical
bearing capacity of a pile group:
- NAVFAC DM 7.2
- Effective stress
- CSN 73 1002
The pile group vertical bearing capacity is provided by:
where: F - number of piles in a group
R
c
- vertical bearing capacity of an isolated pile
c
5
- pile group efficiency
The actual verification analysis is carried out according to the factors of safety or the theory of
limit states.
3""icienc% o" a pile group
UFC 4622F6F1A
- for axial spacing of piles in the group: ",
- for axial spacing of piles in the group: @,
#a BarrI @CS. E4 1FF2A
where: F
;
-number of piles in the ; direction
F
?
-number of piles in the ? direction
* -
angle having tangent , expressed in degrees
s -axial spacing of piles
, -diameter of piles
Seiler67eene% "or'ula
-915-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: F
;
- number of piles in the ; direction
F
?
- number of piles in the ? direction
s - axial spacing of piles
Input e""icientc%
User-defined input of the degree of efficiency in the range of 0,# - 1,0.
Cohesi&e soil @anal%sis "or undrained conditionsA
The bearing capacity of an earth block is provided by:
where: 8 -length of piles
>
;
,>
?
-plane dimensions of the base of an earth body in the form of a block
c
9s
-
average undrained shear strength along the piles ( )
c
9>
-undrained shear strength at the base of piles
3
c5
-cohesion group bearing capacity factor
w
h
e
r
e
:
for condition:
for condition:
Note: The earth body is represented by a block with its base given by a plane containing feet
of individual piles and having vertical walls found in the distance of one pile diameter from the
axes of outer piles. This earth block subjected to overall load caused by the pile group resists
by shear along the walls skin "riction and by bearing capacity at its base.
The actual verification analysis is carried out according to the factors of safety or the theory of
limit states.
Anal%sis according to "actor o" sa"et%
When performing the analysis according to the factor of safety the program carries out the
verification analysis for a pile group in co'pression:
where: R
5
-vertical bearing capacity of a pile group
-916-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
\
,
-maximum vertical force (including the pile cap self weight)
%
p
-self weight of piles (only when the option "Consider the sel" weight o"
pile" is checked)
SF
cp
-factor of safety for a pile group in compression
Anal%sis according to the theor% o" li'it states
When performing the analysis according to the theory of limit states the program carries out
the verification analysis for a pile group in a cohesionless soil:
where: R
5
-vertical bearing capacity of a pile group
F -number of piles in the group
R
c
-vertical bearing capacity of an isolated pile (R
>
+ R
s
)

t
reduction coefficient of total resistance
c
5
-pile group efficiency
\
,
-maximum vertical force (including the pile cap self weight)
%
p
-self weight of piles (only when the option "Consider the sel" weight o"
pile" is checked)
When performing the analysis according to the theory of limit states the program carries out
the verification analysis for a pile group in a cohesi&e soil:
where: R
5
-vertical bearing capacity of a pile group
\
,
-maximum vertical force (including the pile cap self weight)
%
p
-self weight of piles (only when the option "Consider the sel" weight o"
pile" is checked)

t
-reduction coefficient of total resistance
When performing the verification analysis according to EN 1997-1 the pile group vertical
bearing capacity in a cohesive soil is reduced by the coefficient of base resistance (
t
=
>
).
Pile group settle'ent
Cohesionless soil
The analysis of a pile group in a cohesionless soil is developed based on the linear theory of
settlement (Poulos). The limit loading curve for a pile group and the value of the total
settlement s
5
is increased by so-called group settle'ent "actor 5
6
.
An immediate settlement of the pile group increased by the group settlement factor is provided
by:
-917-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: s
5
-pile group settlement
5
6
-group settlement factor for a cohesionless soil (according to Pile Buck Inc.
1992)
s
0
-settlement of an isolated pile (determined, e.g. from the limit loading
curve)
, -pile diameter
>
;
-minimum width of pile group
Cohesi&e soil
The pile group settlement in a cohesive soil is determined as the settlement of a substitute
foundation at a depth of 0,@X
M
D, having a width q and a length qi.
Analyses to calculate settlement are described in details in "Settlement analysis".
Scheme of substitute foundation $ settlement of pile group in cohesie soil
-918-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Spring 'ethod
The pile group is analyzed using the Finite Element Method. The pile cap is considered as
infinitely stiff. A general load is applied in the center of the cap and can be imported from an
arbitrary program that performs static analysis.
The piles analyzed according to figure:
Modeling piles
Four options to model piles are available in the frame "Settings":
1. Floating piles compute the stiffness of springs from soil parameters
2. Floating piles input the stiffness of springs
3. Piles resting on the rock subgrade
4. Piles fixed into the rock subgrade
All options require inputting the "Horizontal modulus of subsoil reaction" characterizing the pile
behavior in the transverse direction. Floating piles further require determining the stiffness of
vertical springs. The program allows for back calculation of this stiffness from the available soil
parameters and the typical load. They can be also inputted directly in the frame "Vertical
springs".
Either hinge or fixed-type connection of a pile to the pile cap can be considered.
-919-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Connecting pile to the pile-cap 7selected in the frame "Settings"8
The actual analysis is performed using the finite element method. Each pile is divided into ten
elements. For each element the program defines the magnitude of horizontal and vertical
springs. In comparison to an isolated pile, the stiffness of horizontal and vertical springs are
further reduced for both the inner and outer piles the horizontal stiffness is reduced by the
coefficients equal to 0,# and 0,2# for the outer and inner piles, respectively; the shear stiffness
is reduced by the coefficients equal to 0,# and 0,1 for the outer and inner piles, respectively;
These reductions well represent the real behavior of a pile group. The springs at the pile-base
are not reduced.
Calculation o" sti""nesses o" &ertical springs
When back calculating the stiffnesses of vertical springs it is necessary to input a t%pical load
in the frame "5ertical springs" that will serve to the determine the spring stiffnesses. This
load should be selected such as to characterize the structure behavior as close as possible.
The stiffnesses are determined as follows:
1. Typical load is applied to individual piles
2. The stiffness of shear vertical springs distributed along the pile is calculated depending
on the soil parameters.
3. The stiffness of vertical spring at the pile-base is calculated depending on the stiffness
of the subsoil below the pile-base and the depth of influence zone. For tensile piles this
stiffness is equal to zero.
These stiffnesses are further adjusted according to their location in the pile group the shear
stiffness is reduced by the coefficients equal to 0,# and 0,1 for the outer and inner piles,
respectively.
Settle'ent anal%sis
One of the following methods is available to compute settlement:
- With the help of oedometric modulus
- With the help of compression constant
-920-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- With the help of compression index
- According to NEN (Buismann, Ladde)
- With the help of Soft soil model
- According to Janbu theory
- With the help of DMT (constrained modulus)
The program offers two options to constrain the depth of influence zone:
- Exploiting the theory of structural strength
- Using the percentage of the magnitude of geostatic stress
The theory of elasticity (Boussinesq theory) is employed to determine stress in a soil state in
all methods available for the settlement analysis.
General theories of settlement serve as bases in all the above methods.
When computing settlement below the footing bottom the programs first calculates the stress
in the footing bottom and then determines the overall settlement and rotation of foundation.
The general approach in all theories draws on subdividing the subsoil into layers of a different
thickness based on the depth below the footing bottom or ground surface. Vertical deformation
of each layer is then computed the overall settlement is then defined as a sum of partial
settlements of individual layers within the influence zone (deformations below the influence
zone are either zero or neglected):
where: s - settlement
s
)
-
settlement of the )
th
layer
Stress in the "ooting )otto'
The stress in the footing bottom can be assumed as:
- rectangular (uniform in the footing bottom)
- general (trapezoidal) with different edge values
General distribution of stress follows from figure:
-921-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Stress in the footing bottom
where:




where: ( - vertical loading of footing
8,> - footing width and length
e
>
- loading eccentricity
! - moment acting on the footing
e - horizontal force
3 - normal force at eccentric footing
p - column axis offset from the footing center
If in some points the stress becomes negative, the program continues with adjusted
dimensions >
M
8 while excluding tension from the analysis. Before computing the stress
distribution due to surcharge the stress in the footing bottom is reduced by the geostatic stress
in the following way:
There are three options in the program to specify the geostatic stress in the footing bottom:
- Fro' the original ground It is therefore considered, whether the footing bottom in the
open pit measured from the original ground is free of stress for the time less than needed
for soil bulkage and subsequent loss of stress in the subsoil.
- Fro' the "inished grade The same assumptions as above apply.
- .ot considered at all
O&erall settle'ent and rotation o" "oundation
The foundation settlement is substantially influenced by the overall stiffness of the system
represented by foundation structure and foundation soil given by:
where: -
>as)c
-modulus of elasticity of footing
t -foundation thickness
-
,e6, a0
-weighted average of the deformation modulus up to depth of influence
zone
8 -footing dimension in the direction of searched stiffness
For k I 1 the foundation is assumed to be rigid and as a representative point for the
determination of its settlement is assumed the characteristic point (distant by 0,"X times the
-922-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
foundation dimension from its axis).
For k _ 1 the foundation structure is assumed to be compliant and as a representative point for
the determination of foundation settlement is assumed the "oundation center point.
The "oundation rotation is determined from the difference of settlements of center and of
individual edges.
6otation of spread footing $ principle calculation
In"luence o" "oundation depth and inco'pressi)le
su)soil
When computing settlement it is possible to account for the in"luence o" "oundation depth
by introducing the reduction coefficient Q
1
:
for strip footing:
for spread footing:
where: , - depth of footing bottom
/ - depth under footing bottom
In"luence o" inco'pressi)le la%er is introduced into the analysis by the reduction
coefficient Q
2
:
where: /
)c
- depth of rigid base under footing bottom
-923-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
/ - depth under footing bottom
Incorporating the above coefficients allows trans"or'ation of the vertical component of
stress K
/
such that the actual depth is replaced by a su)stitute &alue /
r
given by:
where: Q
1
- coefficient of footing bottom depth
Q
2
- coefficient of rigid base
/ - depth under footing bottom
In"luence o" sand6gra&el cushion
If the sand-gravel cushion is specified below the spread footing, the material parameters X in
individual layers are computed in the following way:
For layer h
a,)
:
where: X
)
-
material parameters at )
th
layer
X
c
- material parameters of sand-gravel cushion
For layer h
>,)
:
where: +
c
- area of sand-gravel cushion
X
c
- material parameters of sand-gravel cushion
X
>,)
- material parameters of >,) layer
>
)
-
cushion widths in the )
th
layer
8
)
-
cushion length in the )
th
layer
-924-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
,nal#sis =i in the sand-grael cushion
Anal%sis using the oedo'etric 'odulus
Equation to compute compression of an )
th
soil layer below foundation having a thickness h
arises from the definition of oedometric modulus-
oe,
:
where:
/,)
-
vertical component of incremetal stress in the middle of )
th
layer
h
)
-
thickness of the )
th
layer
-
oe,,)
-
oedometric modulus of the )
th
layer
The oedometric modulus -
oe,
can be specified for each soil either as constant or with the help
of an oedometric curve (
e6
/K relation). When using the oedometric curve the program assumes
for each layer the value of -
oe,
corresponding to a given range of original and final stress. If
the value of oedometric modulus -
oe,
is not available, it is possible to input the deformation
modulus -
,e6
and the program carries out the respective transformation.
where:
where: J - Poisson's ratio
-
,e6
- deformation modulus
-925-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Anal%sis using the co'pression constant
Equation to compute compression of an )
th
soil layer below foundation having a thickness h
arises from the definition of compression constantS:
where:
or,)
-
vertical component of original geostatic stress in the middle of )
th
layer

/,)
- vertical component of incremental stress (e.g. stress due to structure
surcharge) inducing layer compression
h
)
-
thickness of the )
th
layer
S
)
-
compression constant in the )
th
layer
The program allows for inputting either the compression constant S
)
or the compression
constantS
10
(the program itself carries out the transformation).
3iterature4
,rnold "errui't4 Soil mechanics< Delft Bniersit# of Technolog#< 0115< 011H<
http4;;geo:errui't:net;
Anal%sis using the co'pression inde
Equation for settlement when employing the compression indexS
c
of the )
th
layer arises from
the formula:
where:
or,)
-
vertical component of geostatic stress in the middle of i
th
layer

/,)
- vertical component of incremental stress (e.g. stress due to structure
surcharge) inducing layer compression
e
o
- initial void ratio
h
)
-
thickness of the i
th
layer
S
c,)
-
compression index in the i
th
layer
3iterature4
,rnold "errui't4 Soil mechanics< Delft Bniersit# of Technolog#< 0115< 011H<
http4;;geo:errui't:net;
Anal%sis according to .3. @Buis'ann1 #addA
This method computes both the primary and secondary settlement. When computing the
method accounts for overconsolidated soils and differentiates between two possible cases:
- Sum of the current vertical effective stress in the soil and stress due to external surcharge
is less than the preconsolidation pressure so that only additional surcharge is considered.
-926-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- Sum of the current vertical effective stress in the soil and stress due to external surcharge
is greater than the preconsolidation pressure so that the primary consolidation is set on
again. The primary settlement is then larger when compared to the first case.
Primary settlement
Primary settlement of the )
th
layer of overconsolidated soil (OCRI 1) is provided by:
for:
or
7
/
l
p
(sum of the current vertical stress and its increment is less than the
preconsolidation pressure):
for:
or
7
/
I
p
(sum of the current vertical stress and its increment is greater than the
preconsolidation pressure):
where:
or,)
-
vertical component of geostatic stress in the middle of i
th
layer

/,)
- vertical component of incremental stress (e.g. stress due to structure
surcharge) inducing layer compression

p,)
-
preconsolidation pressure in the )
th
layer
e
o
- initial void ratio
h
)
-
thickness of the )
th
layer
S
c,)
-
compression index in the )
th
layer
S
r,)
-
recompression index in the )
th
layer
Primary settlement of the )
th
layer of normally consolidated soil (OCR= 1) reads:
where:
or,)
-
vertical component of geostatic stress in the middle of )
th
layer

/,)
- vertical component of incremental stress (e.g. stress due to structure
surcharge) inducing layer compression
e
o
- initial void ratio
h
)
-
thickness of the )
th
layer
S
c,)
-
compression index the )
th
layer
Secondary settlement
Secondary settlement of the )
th
layer assumes the form:
for:
or
7
/
l
p
(sum of the current vertical stress and its increment is less than the
preconsolidation pressure):
-927-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
for:
or
7
/
I
p
(sum of the current vertical stress and its increment is greater than the
preconsolidation pressure):
where: h
)
-
thickness of the )
th
layer
S
Gr,)
-
secondary compression index below preconsolidation pressure in the )
th
layer
S
G
-
index of secondary compression in the )
th
layer
t
p
- time to terminate primary consolidation
t
s
- time required for secondary settlement
If we specify the value of preconsolidation index of secondary compression the same as for the
index of secondary compression, the program does not take into account in the computation of
secondary settlement the effect of preconsolidation pressure.
3iterature4
.etherlandish standard .(.H?21< 5>>5< )eotechnie9 T)@5>>1 @asisen en belastingen<
.ederlands normalisatie-+nstitut
Anal%sis using the So"t soil 'odel
The analysis employs the modified compression indexRand is based on the Soft soil elastic-
plastic model developed in university of Cambridge. The soil deformation assumes the
volumetric strain to be linearly dependent on the change of effective mean stress K plotted in
natural logarithmic scale. The settlement of the )
th
layer is then provided by:
kde:
or,)
-
vertical component of geostatic stress in the middle of i
th
layer

/,)
- vertical component of incremental stress (e.g. stress due to structure
surcharge) inducing layer compression
h
)
-
thickness of the i
th
layer
R -
modified compression index in the i
th
layer
The analysis requires inputting the modified compression index Rusually obtained from triaxial
laboratory measurements.
If the modified compression index Ris not known, it is possible to specify the compression
indexS
S
together with an average value of the void ratioe (if that is also not know it is
sufficient to provide the initial void ratio e
o
) and the program then performs an approximate
computation of the modified compression index R using the available information.
-928-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
3iterature4
@urland P:@: The #ielding and dilatation of cla# 7correspondence8< )YotechniAue< 5- 708<5>H-<
str: 055-052
Anal%sis according to the Jan)u theor%
It is based on principles of nonlinear elastic deformation, where the stress-strain relationship is
described by a function of two dimensionless parameters unique for a given soil. The
parameters are the exponent ' and the Janbu modulusm. Equations describing the settlement
are obtained by specifying Kfrom the definition of deformation modulus -
t
and by subsequent
integration. The program allows the user to compute settlement for the following types of soil:
- Cohesionless soils
- Coarse - grained soil
- Sands and silts
- Overconsolidated sands and silts
- Cohesive soils
- Overconsolidated cohesive soils
3iterature4
Method of settlement computation for arious t#pes of soils< Soil Mechanics and foundation
engineering< Springer< ? 738< 5>?1< str< 015-01H
Anal%sis "or cohesionless soils a"ter Jan)u
For cohesionless soils the stress exponent is not equal to zero. For layered subsoil the resulting
settlement equals to the sum of partial settlements of individual layers:
where:
or,)
-
vertical component of geostatic stress in the middle of )
th
layer

/,)
- vertical component of incremental stress (e.g. stress due to structure
surcharge) inducing layer compression
'
)
-
stress exponent in the )
th
layer
m
)
-
Janbu modulus in the )
th
layer
h
)
-
thickness of the )
th
layer
Anal%sis "or coarse6grained soils a"ter Jan)u
For dense coarse-grained soils (e.g. ice soil) the stress-deformation (settlement) relationship is
usually assumed as "elastic", i.e. the stress exponent ' is equal to one. Thus for ' = 1and the
reference stress
r
= 100 kPa the resulting settlement equals to the sum of partial settlements
of individual layers:
-929-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where:
/,)
- vertical component of incremental stress (e.g. stress due to structure
surcharge) inducing layer compression - i.e. change of effective stress
m
)
-
Janbu modulus in the )
th
layer
h
)
-
thickness of the )
th
layer
Anal%sis "or sands and silts a"ter Jan)u
For sands and silts the stress exponent' receives the value around 0,#, for the reference stress

r
= 100 kPa the resulting settlement equals to the sum of partial settlements of individual
layers. It can be derived from the following formula:
where:
or,)

vertical component of geostatic stress in the middle of )
th
layer

/,)
vertical component of incremental stress (e.g. stress due to structure
surcharge) inducing layer compression
m
)

Janbu modulus in the )
th
layer
h
)

thickness of the )
th
layer
Anal%sis "or o&erconsolidated sands and silts a"ter
Jan)u
Providing the final stress in soil exceeds the preconsolidation pressure (
or
7
/
I
p
), the
settlement of layered subsoil is found from the following equation:
where:
or,)
-
vertical component of geostatic stress in the middle of )
th
layer

p,)
-
preconsolidation pressure in the )
th
layer

/,)
- vertical component of incremental stress (e.g. stress due to structure
surcharge) inducing layer compression
m
)
-
Janbu modulus in the )
th
layer
m
r,)
-
Janbu modulus of recompression in the )
th
layer
h
)
-
thickness of the )
th
layer
If the stress due to surcharge does not cause the final stress to exceed the preconsolidation
pressure (
or
7
/
l
p
), it is possible to assume the following forms of equations for the
computation of settlement of layered sand or silt subsoil:
-930-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where:
or,)
-
vertical component of geostatic stress in the middle of )
th
layer

p,)
-
preconsolidation pressure in the )
th
layer

/,)
- vertical component of incremental stress (e.g. stress due to structure
surcharge) inducing layer compression
m
r,)
-
Janbu modulus of recompression in the )
th
layer
h
)
-
thickness of the )
th
layer
Anal%sis "or cohesi&e soils a"ter Jan)u
In case of cohesive soils the stress exponent is equal to zero. For normally consolidated soils
we obtain from the definition of the tangent modulus of deformation (by modification and
subsequent integration) -
t
equation for the settlement of layered subsoil formed by cohesive
soils in the form:
where:
or,)
-
vertical component of geostatic stress in the middle of )
th
layer

/,)
- vertical component of incremental stress (e.g. stress due to structure
surcharge) inducing layer compression
m
)
-
Janbu modulus in the )
th
layer
h
)
-
thickness of the )
th
layer
Anal%sis "or o&erconsolidated cohesi&e soils a"ter
Jan)u
Most cohesive soils in the original order except very young or organic clays are
overconsolidated. If the final stress in the soil exceeds overconsolidation stress (
or
7
/
I
p
)
than the settlement of the layered subsoil composites from cohesive soils is computed from
following relation:
for:
or
7
/
I
p
for:
or
7
/
l
p
where:
or,)
-
vertical component of geostatic stress in the middle of )
th
layer
-931-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013

p,)
-
preconsolidation pressure in the )
th
layer

/,)
- vertical component of incremental stress (e.g. stress due to structure
surcharge) inducing layer compression
m
)
-
Janbu modulus in the )
th
layer
m
r,)
-
Janbu modulus of recompression in the )
th
layer
h
)
-
thickness of the )
th
layer
Settle'ent anal%sis using $/! @constrained
'odulusA
Constrained modulus !
<!P
[!Pa] is defined as the vertical drained confined tangent modulus
at
0o
. !
<!P
is obtained from dilatometer test.
If the value of the constrained modulus !
<!P
is not available, it is possible to input the
coefficient of volume compressibility m
\
[m
2
H!3] (determined from the oedometer test) and
the program carries out the respective transformation:
where: !
<!P
- constrained modulus
m
\
- coefficient of volume compressibility
The analysis employs the constrained modulus !
<!P
or coefficient of volume
compressibility m
\
and is based on Marchetti method. This approach being based on linear
elasticity, provides a settlement proportional to the load and is unable to provide non linear
predictions.
The settlement of the )
th
layer is then provided by:
where:
/,)
-
vertical component of incremental stress in the middle of )
th
layer
h
)
-
thickness of the )
th
layer
!
<!P
- constrained modulus
3iterature4
Marchetti S: 75>>>8 " The Flat Dilatometer and its applications to )eotechnical Design "<
3ecture notes 7>1 pp8 +ntnl Seminar on DMT held at the Papanese )eot: Societ#< To9#o< 50
Feb 5>>>
!heor% o" settle'ent
If the stress change in the soil or in the currently build earth structure, caused by ground
surface surcharge, is known, it is possible to determine the soil deformation. The soil
-932-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
deformation is generally inclined and its vertical component is termed the settlement. In
general, the settlement is non-stationary dependent on time, which means that it does not
occur immediately after introducing the surcharge, but it rather depends on consolidation
characteristics of a soil. Permeable, less compressible soils (sand, gravel) deform fast, while
saturated, low permeability clayey soils experience gradual deformation called consolidation.
Time dependent settlement of soils
Applied load yields settlement, which can be subdivided based on time dependent response
into three separate components:
- Instantaneous settlement (initial)
- Primary settlement (consolidation)
- Secondary settlement (creep)
Instantaneous settle'ent
During instantaneous settlement the soil experiences only shear deformation resulting into
change in shape without volumetric deformation. The loss of pore pressure in the soil is zero.
Pri'ar% settle'ent
This stage of soil deformation is characterized by skeleton deformation due to motion and
compression of grains manifested by volume changes. If the pores are filled with water
(particularly in case of low permeability soils), the water will be carried away from squeezed
pores into locations with lower pressure (the soil will undergo consolidation). The consolidation
primary settlement is therefore time dependent and is terminated by reaching zero pore
pressure.
Secondar% settle'ent
When the primary consolidation is over the skeleton deformation will no longer cause the
change in pore pressure (theoretically at infinite time). With increasing pressure the grains
may become so closely packed that they will start to deform themselves and the volumetric
changes will continue this is referred to as creep deformation of skeleton or secondary
consolidation (settlement). Unlike the primary consolidation the secondary consolidation
proceeds under constant effective stress. Particularly in case of soft plastic or squash soils the
secondary consolidation should not be neglected in case of overconsolidated soils it may
represent app. 10% of the overall settlement, for normally consolidated soils even app. 20%.
-933-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Pri'ar% settle'ent
The final primary settlement s is often is often substituted by the term settlement. Most of the
computational approaches can be attached to one of the two groups:
- #inear elastic de"or'ation
- .onlinear elastic de"or'ation
#inear elastic de"or'ation
The linear stress-strain relationship follows the Hook law:
where: K - induced deformation of the soil layer
b
e6
- induced change of effective stress in the soil layer
- - Young's modulus in the soil layer
J - Poisson's ratio
The applicability of Young's modulus - of elasticity is substantiated only in cases, in which the
stressed soil is allowed to stretch in the horizontal direction. This, however, is acceptable only
for small spread foundations. When applying the load over a larger area, the stressed soil
cannot, except for its edges, to deform sideways and experiences therefore only a vertical
(one-dimensional) strain related to the oedometric modulus -
oe,
, that is larger than the elastic
modulus -:
The settlement of a soil layer s is determined by multiplying the deformation of a soil layer o
by the layer thickness (height) e
o
:
where: K - deformation of the soil layer
e
o
- thickness of the soil layer
In case of layered subsoil we get the total settlement by summing up settlements of individual
layers:
where: s - settlement of the layered subsoil
K
)
-
deformation of the )
th
soil layer
e
o)
-
thickness of the )
th
soil layer
.onlinear elastic de"or'ation
For most soils the stress-strain relationship is nonlinear and often influenced by the loading
history. This nonlinearity cannot be neglected, particularly when computing the settlement of
fine-grained soils (silts, clays). Clearly, the procedure based on application of Young's modulus
of elasticity is not generally applicable. Even if employing the stress dependent oedometric
modulus of deformation, it will not be possible to receive reasonable estimates of the behavior
of certain overconsolidated soils. Nonlinear elastic deformation is generally modeled using the
void ratio and deformation characteristics derived from one-dimensional deformation of a soil
sample (e.g. compression constant, compression index, etc.).
-934-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The procedure for the computation of settlement of a compressible saturated soil layer using
the void e is described on the following soil element having the height e
o
and the width q = 1
m:
,nal#sis of settlement from phase diagram
Owing to the fact that the soil is a three phase medium (it contains solid particles and pore
filled with fluid and gas) it is possible to describe the solid particles (rock particles and mineral
grains) by their volume \
s
(and assumed to be equal to unity), while the porous phase can be
described using the void ratioe:
The soil element is subjected on its upper surface to a uniform loading causing the change in
stress inside the sample and also the vertical displacement be, which in turn leads to the
reduction of pores \
p
and therefore also to the reduction of void ratio (from its original value
e
o
to a new value e). The vertical strain Kof a soil sample is given by the ratio of be to the
original sample height e
o
, and can be expressed using the void ratio e:
where: K - vertical relative compression
be - vertical deformation
e
o
- origin height of the element
s - settlement
e - void ratio
b e - change of void ratio
By modifying this equation we arrive at the formula describing the sample settlement with the
-935-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
help of void ratio:
where: K - vertical relative compression
e
o
- origin height of the element
s - settlement
e - void ratio
b e - change of void ratio
Secondar% settle'ent
To describe a gradual creep of soil during secondary settlement the program employs the
Buissman method (it incorporates the index of secondary compressionS
G
derived by Lade).
From observations suggesting that the soil deformation follows a linear path when plotted in
semi-logarithmic scale against time Buissman proposed the variation of Kdue to long-term
stress in the form:
where: K - total deformation
K
p
- deformation associated with primary consolidation
K
s
- deformation associated with secondary consolidation
t - time of consolidation
t
0
- refereference time
Time dependent ariation of strain 7primar# and secondar# consolidation8
-936-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Consolidation anal%sis
Program allows analysis of consolidation when set in the frame "Settings". Consolidated layer,
formed by impermeable, resp. lower permeable soil, subsequently settles with increasing time.
Consolidation affects values of pore pressure. Soil parameters influencing consolidation
analysis are entered in the frame "Soils", other consolidation parameters are set in the frame
"Analysis" in individual construction stages.
Consolidation coefficient, depended on the soil properties, is calculated:
where: -
oe,
- oedometric modulus of deformation
k - coefficient of permeability

$
- unit weight of water
When the consolidated layer is composed from non-homogeneous soil, coefficient c
0
is
evaluated as average of soil coefficients.
Consolidation analysis is also influenced by time factors, which are depended on the path of
water outflow. This path is equal to the thickness of the consolidated layer in case of only one
direction outflow (upwards or downwards) or half of the thickness in case of both directions
outflow (upwards and downwards). Real time factor is evaluated according to the following
formula:
where: c
0
- consolidation coefficient
t - real time
e - drainage path
Time factor of build duration is influenced by duration of load action. When the whole loading
is introduced at the beginning of stage, build time is equal to zero. When load linearly
increases during stage duration, then build time is equal to the time of stage duration. Time
factor of build duration is calculated by formula:
where: c
0
- consolidation coefficient
t
c
- build time
e - drainage path
Degree of consolidation is evaluated by following formulas:
fo
r:
-937-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
fo
r:
w
he
re
:
where: P
0
- real time factor
P
c
- time factor of build duration
Original value of deformation in consolidated layer in certain construction stage is multiplied by
corresponding degree of consolidation s
a0
to obtain result value of deformation:
where: K
6)F
- result value of deformation
K - original value of deformation
s
a0
- degree of consolidation
Consolidation analysis also influences pore pressure values in consolidated layer. In the time of
introducing the load action, pore pressure values are the highest. When time increases to
theoretical infinity, pore pressure decreases to zero.
Pore pressure:
fo
r:
fo
r:
w
he
re
:
where: P
0
- real time factor
P
c
- time factor of build duration
e - drainage path
/ - depth, where value of pore pressure is evaluated
9
0
- change of effective stress compared to previous stage (loading)
3iterature4
@ra'a M: Das: ,danced Soil Mechanicsp Ta#lor q Francis4 3ondon< 011I:pp0?I - 35H"errui't
,: Soil Mechanics< Delft Bniersit# of Technolog#< 0151< pp>?-503
http4;;geo:errui't:net;software;SoilMech@oo9:pd
-938-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
$eter'ination o" the depth o" in"luence -one
From the theoretical point of view when applying a load on the ground surface we may expect
the change of stress in subsoil into an infinite depth. The soil, however, deforms only up to a
certain depth within so called influenced zone.
The program offers two options to specify the influence zone:
- Using the theory of structural strength
- By specifying a certain percentage of the primary geostatic stress
!heor% o" structural strength
The structural strength represents the resistance of soil against deformation for a loading at
the onset of failure of its internal structure. With decreasing coefficient m the soil responds
tends to be linear.
If the structural strength is accounted for during settlement analysis, then:
aA the influence zone is characterized by the depth below the footing bottom at which the
increment of vertical stress
/
becomes equal to the structural strength of soil (determined by
multiplying the original geostatic stress
or
by the coefficientm):
where: m - coefficient of structural strength

or
- original geostatic stress
)A when computing the settlement of a layer, the increment of vertical stress
/
due to
surcharge and reduced by the structural strength of soil is provided by:
where: m - coefficient of structural strength

or
- original geostatic stress

/
- incremetal stress in the middle layer
and the settlement s then follows from the stress denoted in figure by hatching and is given
by:
where: m - coefficient of structural strength

or
- original geostatic stress

/
- incremetal stress in the middle layer
-939-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Depth of influnece !one based on theor# of structural strength 7area of effectie surcharge is
hatched8
/ethod o" restriction o" the 'agnitude o" pri'ar%
stress
If we assume in the settlement analysis the constrains in terms of the percentage of primary
geostatic stress, then:
aA the influence zone is represented by a depth below the footing bottom where the
incremental stress
/
reaches a certain percentage of the original geostatic stress:
where:
;%
- considered magnitude of the geostatic stress

or
- geostatic stress
)A the settlement s is derived from stress value denoted in figure by hatching and it receives
the form:
where:
/
- incremetal stress

or
- geostatic stress
-940-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Depth of influence !one gien b# constraining the magnitude of primar# stress
Characteristics o" settle'ent anal%ses
Depending on the selected solution method the program employs for the computation of
settlement the following characteristics that may differ by the type of experiment needed for
their determination or in the way of representation of measured variables:
- Compression index S
c

- Oedometric modulus -
oe,

- Compression constant S
- Compression constant S
10

- Void ratio e
- Recompression index S
r

- Janbu characteristics
- Correcting coefficient m
- Modified compression index R
- Index of secondary compression S
G

- Overconsolidation index of secondary compression S
Gr

Co'pression inde
It describes variation of the void ratio e as a function of the change of effective stress
e6
plotted in the logarithmic scale:
-941-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
"oid ratio e ersus effectie stress Kef
It therefore represents a deformation characteristic of overconsolidated soil:
where: be - variation of void ratio
b8o5
e6
- variation of effective stress
,ange o" co'pression inde S
c
(Naval Facilities Engineering Command Soil
MechanicsDESIGN MANUAL 7.01)
A typical range of the compression index is from 0,1 to 10. Approximate values for
homogeneous sand for the loading range from E# kPa to "E2@ kPa attain the values from 0,0# to
0,0@ for loose state and 0,02 to 0,0" for dense state. For silts this value is 0,20.
For lightl% o&erconsolidated cla%s and silts tested in USA #ouisiana 7au"'ann and
Sher'ann @1DLCA present the "ollowing &alues:
Soil 3""ecti&e
consolidation
stress
ce6
[kPa]
Final
e""ecti&e
stress in the
soil
e6
[kPa]
Co'pression
inde S
c
[-]
CL soft clay 5H1 011 1<32
CL hard clay 5?1 0-1 1<22
ML silt of low plasticity 031 3-1 1<5H
CH clay of high plasticity 0I1 3-1 1<I2
CH soft clay with silt
layers
321 0>1 1<-0
-942-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Pro"0 Juan /0Pestana6.asci'ento @Uni&ersit% o" Cali"ornia1 Berkele%A o""ers the
"ollowing t%pical &alues o" the co'pression inde S
c
:
Soil Co'pression inde S
c
[-]
Normal consolidated clays 1<01 $ 1<-1
Chicago clay with silt (CL) 1<5- - 1<31
Boston blue clay (CL) 1<31 - 1<-1
Vickburgs clay - dray falls into lumps (CH) 1<3 $ 1<H
Swedish clay (CL CH) 5 $ 3
Canada clay from Leda (CL CH) 5 $ 2
Mexico City clay (MH) ? $ 51
Organic clays (OH) 2 and more
Peats (Pt) 51 $ 5-
Organic silts and claye silts (ML MH) 5<- $ 2<1
San Francisco sediments (CL) 1<2 $ 5<0
Clay in the old San Francisco Bay 1<? $ 1<>
Bangkok clay (CH) 1<2
In addition1 there are e'pirical epressions a&aila)le to deter'ine approi'ate
&alues o" S
c
"or silts1 cla%s and organic soilsU their applica)ilit%1 howe&er1 is 'ore or
less local:
-943-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Soil 3Huations ,e"erence
Transformed clays

Skempton 1944
Clays

Nishida 1956
Brazilian clays
Sao Paulo clays


Cozzolino 1961
New York clays

Terzaghi a Peck 1948
Clays of low plasticity

Sowers 1970
Taipei clays and silts


Moh a kol. 1989
Clays


Pestana 1994
Oedo'etric 'odulus
If the results from oedometric test are represented in terms of oedometric curve (bK = 6(b
e6
)),
it becomes evident that for each point on the curve we receive a different ratio
e6
/K:
Determination of oedometric modulus (oed
If the stress-strain curve is replaced for a certain interval of two neighboring stresses
1e6
-
2e6
-944-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
by a secant line, it is acceptable to assume a linear behavior of soil within this interval and
represent the soil compressibility by as b
e6
/bK called the oedometric modulus of
deformation. The oedometric modulus of deformation is therefore a secant modulus linked to a
certain stress interval
1e6
-
2e6
selected on the stress-strain diagram bK = (b
e6
):
In general, the oedometric modulus of deformation -
oe,
tends to decrease its value with the
increasing stress interval. Therefore we should consider for each layer a specific value of -
oe,
pertinent to a given stress interval (from original to final stress state). This is reflected in the
program by the way of inputting -
oe,
, where it is possible to specify for each soil the respective
oedometric curve (
e6
/Kdiagram).
Practical experience, however, suggests (e.g. for clays) a several orders of magnitude
difference between the value of -
oe,
derived from the deformation modulus -
,e6
and that
provided by the in situ measured loading curve.
Approi'ate range o" &alues o" oedo'etric 'odulus o" de"or'ation -
oe,
for individual
soils and typical stress range (Vanek: Mechanika zemin (soil mechanics)):
Soil Oedo'etric 'odulus -
oe,
[!Pa]
gravels H1 $ H11
medium dense sands to dense
sands
? $ 531
cohesive 0 $ 31
Co'pression constant
When plotting the effective vertical stress against the vertical strain in the semi-logarithmic
scale we often arrive at a linear dependency.
-945-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Detemination of compression constant C
Slope of this curve is one of the soil parameters particularly in case of one-dimensional
deformation and is referred to as the compression constant S:
where:
1e6
- initial effective stress of soil in oedometer

2e6
- final effective stress of soil in oedometer
/argins o" co'pression constant S 7P:Jime94 Mechani9a !emin8
Soil Co'pression constant S
[-]
Loess silt 5- $ 2-
Clay 31 $ 501
Silts H1 $ 5-1
Medium dense and dense sands 5-1 $ 011
Sand with gravel > 0-1
Co'pression constant 1F
In engineering practice the natural logarithm with base is sometimes replaced by logarithm
with base 10 when plotting the stress
e6
. In this case it is common to denote the compression
constant with subscript 10: S
10
. Since it holds:
it is possible to derive a relationship between compression constant S and S
10
:
Arnold 5errui8t @Soil /echanicsA offers the following values of compression constant:
Soil S S
10

Sand -1 $ -11 01 $ 011
Silt 0- $ 50- 51 $ -1
Clay 51 $ 511 2 $ 21
Peat 0 - 0- 5 - 51
-946-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
5oid ratio
The void ratio e describes porosity of a soil and is provided by:
where: \
p
- volume of voids
\
s
- volume of solid grains
,anges o" &oid ratio e 7@ra'a M: D,S4 Principles of Foundation (ngineering8
Soil 5oid ratio e [-]
Poorly graded sand with loose density 1<I
Well graded dense sand 1<2-
Loose density sand with angular particles 1<H-
Dense density sand with angular particles 1<2
Stiff clay 1<H
Soft clay 1<> $ 5<2
Loess 1<>
Soft organic clay 0<- $ 3<0
Glacial till 1<3
,eco'pression inde
The recompression index S
r
is determined from the graph representing the variation of void
ratioe as a function of the effective stress
e6
plotted in the logarithmic scale for unloading
reloading sequence:
-947-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Determination of recompression inde& Cr
where: be - change of void ratio for the unloading-reloading curve
b8o5
e6
- change of effective stress for the unloading-reloading curve
If no results from either laboratory or in situ measurements are available, the recompression
index S
r
can be approximately derived from:
where: S
c
- compression constant
Jan)u characteristics
5alues o" the Jan)u 'odulus m and o" stress eponent ' (according Canadian Foundation
Engineering Manual 1992)
Soil Jan)u 'odulus m Stress inde
'
Very dense to dense till, glacial
till
5111 $ 311 5
Gravel 211 $ 21 1<-
Dense sand 211 $ 0-1 1<-
Medium condition sand 0-1 $ 5-1 1<-
Loose sand 5-1 $ 511 1<-
-948-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dense silt 011 $ I1 1<-
Medium condition silt I1 H1 1<-
Loose silt H1 $ 21 1<-
Hard to very stiff clay H1 $ 01 1
Medium to stiff clay 01 $ 51 1
Soft claye silt 51 $ - 1
Soft marine clays 01 $ - 1
Organic clays 01 $ - 1
Peats - $ 5 1
In"luence o" loading histor%
The loading history has a substantial influence on the distribution of deformation curve and
therefore also on the values of deformation characteristics. The following figure displays the
deformation curve (Ae = 6(AK
e6
) diagram) derived from oedometric loading test corresponding,
e.g. to natural dense sandy soil.
3oad histor# a8 Deformation cure for cla#e# soils from oedometric test b8 Simplified
interpretation of deformation cure
The soil sample was gradually loaded to reach the stress level
>e6
, the stress-strain
relationship (
>e6
- K8 within the section a-> is linear and is denoted as primary or virgin (i.e.,
relative compression is encountered). Upon exceeding the stress level
>e6
the sample was
elastically unloaded and the soil moved up the >-c section of the deformation curve. Upon
reloading the soil moved down the >-c section till reaching the original stress
>e6
prior to
unloading. When loading beyond
>e6
the deformation curve aproaches asymptotically within
the ,-e section the primary line accompanied by inelastic deformation of a soil sample. Such a
complex stress-strain curve is often simplified by the idealized deformation curve (fig. b). Such
a curve characterizes so called overconsolidated soils, which were in the past subjected large
stresses and subsequently unloded. The overconsolidation ratio (OC,) then represents the
ratio between the maximum preconsolidation stress the soil has ever experienced and the
current vertical stress. Overconsolidated soils typicaly follow the deformation curve given by
points c-,-e. The change in slope along this line (given app. by point ,) corresponds either to
the vertical geostatic stress
o
(normally consolidated soils) or to preconsolidation pressure
c
(overconsolidated soils). This point influences the soil deformation, which is smaller within the
-949-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
c-, section when compared to the ,-e section (where for the large degree of overconsolidation
the soil deformation increases). Additional deformation characteristics such as deformation
modulus upon unloading -
e
, one-dimensional swelling index S
e
, recompression index S
r
, etc.
were introduced to describe such a complex soil behavior. Currently the most often used
parameter is the recompression index S
r
suitable for the computation of settlement of
overconsolidated soils.
Coe""icient '
Correction coefficient of surcharge due to structural strength m determines the structural
strength of soil.
5alues o" the correction coe""icient o" surcharge m
!%pe o" "unda'ental soil m
Very compressible fine soils class F1 -F8
- with deformation modulus -
,e6
< 2 MPa
- nonoverconsoludated
- soft to hard consistency
(all 3 attributes must be fullfiled),
filling, made ground
secondary and tertiary sedimets
rocks class R1, R2
0,1
fine soils class F1-F8, not belonging to coefficient
m = 0,1 nor 0,4 nor 0,6
sands and gravels class S1, S2, G1, G2 under GWT
rock class R3, R4
0,2
Sands and gravels class S1, S2, G1, G2
above GWT
sands and gravels with clay, silt or fine soil admixture
soils class S3, S4, S5, G3, G4, G5
rocks class R5, R6
0,3
eluvium of igneous and metanorphic rocks 0,4
/odi"ied co'pression inde
The analysis employing the Soft soil model builds on the elastic-plastic model developed in the
university in Cambridge. Here, the vertical deformation of soil K assumes linear dependence on
the logarithmic variation of effective stress in a soil. Application of this model requires an
introduction of the modified compression index R usually obtained from triaxial tests.
If the modified compression index R is not available from laboratory measurements, it can be
approximately found from the compression index S
S
:
-950-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: S
S
- compression index
e - average void ratio (if this value is not available, it can be approximately
substituted by the initial void ratio e
o
)
Inde o" secondar% co'pression
The index of secondary compression is proportional to the logarithm of time and the slope of
primary consolidation (it is strongly dependent on the final effective stress in soil):
where: S
G
- index of secondary compression
G - deformation of a soil layer
t
1
- initial time of a period of monitoring (measured from the start of
consolidation)
t
2
- final time of a period of monitoring
Determining the value of index of secondary compression S
G
requires either laboratory (e.g.
one-dimensional consolidation in oedometer) or in-situ measurements:
Determination of inde& of secondar# compression CE
,anges o" &alues o" inde o" secondar% co'pression S
G
sand 1<11113 $ 1<1111H
silty loess 1<1112
clay 1<15
The ratio between the index of secondary compression S
G
and the compression index S
c
is
approximately constant for most of the normally consolidated clays for loading typical in
engineering practice. Its average value is 0,0#.
Variation of natural moisture of soil as a function of the index of secondary compression S
G
derived by Mesri appears in figure:
-951-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
"ariation of natural moisture of soil as a function of the inde& of secondar# compression CE
after Mesri
1 Whangamarino clay
2 Mexico City clay
3 Calcareous organic silt
4 Leda clay
5 Norwegian plastic clay
6 Amorphous and fibous peat
7 Canadian muskeg
8 Organic marine deposits
9 Boston blue clay
10 Chicago blue clay
11 Organic silty clay
O&erconsolidation inde o" secondar% co'pression
The overconsolidation index of secondary compression depends on laboratory measurements
-952-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
(e.g. one-dimensional consolidation) and is proportional to the logarithm of time and slope of
virgin consolidation line providing the preconsolidation pressure was not exceeded:
where: S
Gr
- overconsolidation index of secondary compression
K - deformation of a soil layer
t
1
- initial time of a period of monitoring (measured from the onset of
consolidation)
t
2
- final time of a period of monitoring
Anal%ses in progra' Ground #oss
Analyses performed in the program "Ground #oss" can be divided into the following groups:
- Analysis of the shape of subsidence trough above excavations
- Analysis of failure of buildings
The failure analysis of building is based on the shape of subsidence trough.
Anal%sis o" su)sidence trough
The analysis of subsidence trough consists of several sequential steps:
- Determination of the 'ai'u' settle'ent and di'ensions o" su)sidence trough for
individual excavations
- Analysis of the shape of subsidence trough
- Back calculation of the shape and dimensions of subsidence trough providing it is
calculated at a given depth below the terrain surface
- Determination of the overall shape of subsidence trough for more excavations
- Post-processing of other variables (horizontal deformation, slope)
The analysis of maximum settlement and dimensions of subsidence trough can be carried out
using either the theory of volume loss or the classical theories (Peck, Fazekas, Limanov).
5olu'e loss
The volume loss method is a semi-empirical method based partially on theoretical grounds.
The method introduces, although indirectly, the basic parameters of excavation into the
analysis (these include mechanical parameters of a medium, technological effects of
excavation, excavation lining etc) using 2 comprehensive parameters (coe""icient k "or
deter'ination o" in"lection point and a percentage o" &olu'e loss \D). These
parameters uniquely define the shape of subsidence trough and are determined empirically
from years of experience.
-953-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Settlement e&pressed in terms olumes
The maximum settlement S
ma;
, and location of inflection point D
)F6
are provided by the
following expressions:
where: + - excavation area
Z - depth of center point of excavation
k - coefficient to calculate inflection point (material constant)
\D - percentage of volume loss
The roof deformation 9
a
follows from:
where: r

- excavation radius
\
D

- percentage of volume loss
3iterature4
http4;;www:groundloss:com;
,eco''ended &alues o" para'eters "or &olu'e loss
anal%sis
Data needed for the determination of subsidence trough using the volume loss method:
Coe""icient to calculate in"lection point k
-954-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Soil or rock k
cohesionless soil 1<3
normaly consolidated clay 1<-
overconsolidated clay 1<H - 1<?
clay slate 1<H - 1<I
quartzite 1<I - 1<>
Percentage o" &olu'e loss \D
!echnolog% \D
TBM 1<- - 5
Sequential excavation method 1<I - 5<-
Several relationships were also derived to determine the value of lost volume \D based on
stability ratio 3 defined by Broms and Bennermarkem:
where:
0

- overall stress along excavation axis

t

- excavation lining resistance (if lining is installed)
S
9

- undrained stiffness of clay
For 3 _ 2 the soil/rock in the vicinity of excavation is assumed elastic and stable. For
local plastic zones begin to develop in the vicinity of excavation, for a large plastic
zone develops around excavation and for 3 = @ the loss of stability of tunnel face occurs.
Figure shows the dependence of stability ration and lost volume \D.
-955-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
3iterature4
Broms, B.B., Bennemark, H., 1967. Stability of clay at vertical openings. ASCE, Journal of Soil
Mechanics and Foundation Engineering Division, SMI 93, 7194.
Classical theor%
Convergence analysis of an excavation and calculation of the maximum settlement in a
ho'ogeneous )od% are the same for all classical theories. The subsidence trough analyses
then differ depending on the assumed theory (Peck, Fazekas, Limanov).
When calculating settlement the program first determines the radial loading of a circular
excavation as:
where:
/

- geostatic stress in center of excavation
2
r

- coefficient of pressure at rest of cohesive soil
The roof 9
a
and the bottom 9
>
deformations of excavation follow from:
where: Z

- depth of center point of excavation
r- excavation radius
-956-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013

-

- modulus of elasticity of rock/soil in vicinity of excavation
J

- Poisson's number of rock/soil in vicinity of excavation
The maximum terrain settlement and the length of subsidence trough are determined as
follows:
where: Z

- depth of center point of excavation
r

- excavation radius
-

- modulus of elasticity of rock/soil in vicinity of excavation
J

- Poisson's number of rock/soil in vicinity of excavation
When the tunnel roo" displace'ent is prescri)ed the maximum settlement is provided by
the following expression:
where: Z

- depth of center point of excavation
r

- excavation radius
9
a

- tunnel roof displacement
J

- Poisson's number of rock/soil in vicinity of excavation
Anal%sis "or la%ered su)soil
When determining a settlement of layered subsoil the program first calculates the settlement
at the interface between the first layer above excavation and other layers of overburden S
)Ft
and determines the length of subsidence trough along layers interfaces. In this case the
approach complies with the one used for a homogeneous soil.
Next (as shown in Figure) the program determines the length of subsidence trough D at the
terrain surface.
-957-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
,nal#sis of settlement for la#ered subsoil
The next computation differs depending on the selected analysis theory:
Solution a"ter #i'ano&
Limanov described the horizontal displacement above excavation with the help of lost area F:
where: D - length of subsidence trough
F - volume loss of soil per 1m run determined from:
where: D
)Ft
- length of subsidence trough along interfaces above excavation
S
)Ft
- settlement of respective interface
Solution a"ter Fa-ekas
Fazekas described the horizontal displacement above excavation using the following
expression:
where: D - length of subsidence trough
D
)Ft
- length of subsidence trough along interfaces above excavation
S
)Ft
- settlement of respective interface
Solution a"ter Peck
Peck described the horizontal displacement above excavation using the following expression:
-958-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: D
)Ft
- length of subsidence trough along interfaces above excavation
S
)Ft
- settlement of respective interface
D
)F6
- distance of inflection point of subsidence trough from excavation axis at
terrain surface
3iterature4
S!Ych#< Mhrol#< The art of tunelling< @udapest 4 ,9adYmiai Miad\< 5>HH
Shape o" su)sidence trough
The program offers two particular shapes of subsidence troughs according to Gauss or
Aversin.
Cur&e )ased on Gauss
A number of studies carried out both in the USA and Great Britain proved that the transverse
shape of subsidence trough can be well approximated using the Gauss function. This
assumption then allows us to determine the horizontal displacement at a distance ; from the
vertical axis of symmetry as:
where: S
)
- settlement at point with coordinate ;
)
S
ma;
- maximum terrain settlement
D
)F6
- distance of inflection point
Cur&e )ased on A&ersin
Aversin derived, based on visual inspection and measurements of underground structures in
Russia, the following expression for the shape of subsidence trough:
kde: S
)
- settlement at point with coordinate ;
)
S
ma;
- maximum terrain settlement
D - reach of subsidence trough
3iterature4
S!Ych#< Mhrol#< The art of tunelling<@udapest 4 ,9adYmiai Miad\< 5>HH
Coe""icient o" calculation o" in"lection point
When the classical methods are used the inputted coefficient k
)F6
allows the determination of
-959-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
the inflection point location based on D
)F6
= D/k
)F6
. In this case the coefficient k
)F6
represents a
very important input parameter strongly influencing the shape and slope of subsidence trough.
Its value depends on the average soil or rock, respectively, in overburden literature offers
the values of k
)F6
in the range 2,1 - 4,0.
Based on a series of FEM calculations the following values are recommended:
- gravel soil G1-G3 k
)F6
= ",#
- sand and gravel soil S1-S5,G4,G5, rocks R5-R6 k
)F6
= ",0
- fine-grained soil F1-F4 k
)F6
= 2,#
- fine-grained soil F5-F8 k
)F6
= 2,1
The coefficient for calculation of inflection point is inputted in the frame "Settings".
Su)sidence trough with se&eral eca&ations
The principal of superposition is used when calculating the settlement caused by structured or
multiple excavations. Based on input parameters the program first determines subsidence
troughs and horizontal displacements for individual excavations. The overall subsidence trough
is determined subsequently.
Other variables, horizontal strain and gradient of subsidence trough, are post-processed from
the overall subsidence trough.
Anal%sis o" su)sidence trough at a depth
A linear interpolation between the maximal value of the settlement S
ma;
at a terrain surface
and the displacement of roof excavation 9
a
is used to calculate the maximum settlement S at a
depth h below the terrain surface in a homogeneous body.
,nal#sis of subsidence trough at a depth
The width of subsidence trough at an overburden 8 is provided by:
-960-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: D - length of subsidence trough at terrain surface
r - excavation radius
Z - depth of center point
/ - analysis depth
The values 8 and S are then used to determine the shape of subsidence trough in overburden
above an excavation.
Calculation o" other &aria)les
A vertical settlement is accompanied by the evolution of horizontal displacements which may
cause damage to nearby buildings. The horizontal displacement can be derived from the
vertical settlement providing the resulting displacement vectors are directed into the center of
excavation. In such a case the horizontal displacement of the soil is provided by the following
equation:
where: ; - distance of point ; from axis of excavation
s(;) - settlement at point ;
Z - depth of center point of excavation
r - excavation radius
The horizontal displacements are determined in a differential way along the ; axis and in the
transverse direction they can be expressed using the following equation:
where: ; - distance of point ; from axis of excavation
s(;) - settlement at point ;
Z - depth of center point of excavation
D
)F6
- distance of inflection point
r - excavation radius
Anal%sis o" "ailure o" )uildings
The program first determines the shape and dimensions of subsidence trough and then
performs analysis of their influence on buildings.
The program offers four types of analysis:
- Determination of tensile cracks
- Determination of gradient damage
- Determination of a relative deflection of buildings (hogging, sagging)
- Analysis of the inputted section of a building
-961-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
!ensile cracks
One of the causes responsible for the damage of buildings is the horizontal tensile strain. The
program highlights individual parts of a building with a color pattern that corresponds to a
given class of damage. The maximum value of tensile strain is provided in the text output.
The program offers predefined zones of damage for masonry buildings. These values can be
modified in the frame "Stage settings". Considerable experience with a number of tunnels
excavated below build-up areas allowed for elaborating the relationship between the shape of
subsidence trough and damage of buildings to such precision that based on this it is now
possible to estimate an extent of compensations for possible damage caused by excavation
with accuracy acceptable for both preparation of contractual documents and for contractors
preparing proposals for excavation of tunnels.
Recommended values for masonry buildings from one to six floors are given in the following
table.
Horizontal strains (per mille)
Proportional h0s0 @per
'illeA
$a'age $escription
1<0 $ 1<- Microcracks Microcracks
1<- - 1<?- Little damage - superficial Cracks in plaster
1<?- $ 5<1 Little damage Small cracks in walls
5<1 $ 5<I Medium damage, functional Cracks in walls, problems
with windows and doors
5<I $ Large damage Wide open cracks in bearing
walls and beams
Gradient da'age
One of the causes leading to the damage of buildings is the slope subsidence trough. The
program highlights individual parts of a building with a color pattern that corresponds to a
given class of damage. The maximum value of tensile strain is provided in the text output.
The program offers predefined zones of damage for masonry buildings. These values can be
modified in the frame "Stage settings". Considerable experience with a number of tunnels
excavated below build-up areas allowed for elaborating the relationship between the shape of
subsidence trough and damage of buildings to such precision that based on this it is now
possible to estimate an extent of compensations for possible damage caused by excavation
with accuracy acceptable for both preparation of contractual documents and for contractors
preparing proposals for excavation of tunnels.
Recommended values for masonry buildings from one to six floors are given in the following
table.
Gradient
-962-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Gradient $a'age $escription
545011 - I11 Microcracks Microcracks
54I11 - -11 Little damage - superficial Cracks in plaster
54-11 - 311 Little damage Small cracks in walls
54311 - 5-1 Medium damage, functional Cracks in walls, problems
with windows and doors
545-1 - 1 Large damage Wide open cracks in bearing
walls and beams
,elati&e de"lection
Definition of the term relative deflection is evident from the figure. The program searches
regions on buildings with the maximum relative deflection both upwards and downwards.
Clearly, from the damage of building point of view the most critical is the relative deflection
upwards leading to "tensile opening" of building.
6elatie deflection
Verification of the maximum relative deflection is left to the user the following tables list the
ultimate values recommended by literature.
!%pe o" structure !%pe o" da'age Ulti'ate relati&e de"lectionV H8
Burland and Wroth Meyerhof Polshin a
Tokar
SN
73
1001
Unreinforced
bearing walls
Cracks in walls For L/H = 1 -
0.0004
For L/H = 5 -
0.0008
0,0004 0,0004 0,0015
Cracks in bearing
structures
For L/H = 1 -
0.0002
For L/H = 5 -
0.0004
- - -
-963-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Failure o" a section o" )uilding
In a given section the program determines the following variables:
- maximum tensile strain
- maximum gradient
- maximum relative deflection
- relative gradient between inputted points of a building
Evaluation of the analyzed section is left to the user the following tables list the
recommended ultimate values of relative rotation and deflection.
!%pe o"
structure
!%pe o"
da'age
Ulti'ate relati&e gradient
Skempton Meyerhof Polshin a
Tokar
Bjerrum SN
73 1001
Frame
structures
and
reinforced
bearing
walls
Structural 1/150 1/250 1/200 1/150
Cracks in
walls
1/300 1/500 1/500 1/500 1/500
!%pe o" structure !%pe o" da'age Ulti'ate relati&e de"lectionV H8
Burland and Wroth Meyerho
f
Polshin a
Tokar
SN
73
1001
Unreinforced
bearing walls
Cracks in walls For L/H = 1 -
0.0004
For L/H = 5 -
0.0008
0,0004 0,0004 0,0015
Cracks in bearing
structures.
For L/H = 1 -
0.0002
For L/H = 5 -
0.0004
- - -
,ock slope
Program for stability analysis of rock slope treats the following types of failure of rock faces:
- Sliding on the plane slip surface
- Translation on the polygonal slip surface
- Fall of the rock wedge
-964-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Failure of a roc9 face due to sliding on the plane slip surface
Translation on the pol#gonal slip surface
Fall of the roc9 wedge
Plane slip sur"ace
Failure on the plane slip surface is manifested by a rock block sliding down along this surface.
The solution procedure requires determination of the nor'al "orce 3 acting on the slip
surface, the shear "orce P
act
@acti&eA and the resisting shear "orce P
res
@passi&eA.
-965-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Forces on the slip surface
The shear strength parameters and the normal force 3 acting on the slip surface are the main
input data for the determination of the resisting shear forces P
res
. Calculation of the active
shear force P
act
and the normal force 3 is further influenced by the weight of block (depends
on the geometry and bulk weight of rock), anchorage, surcharge, influence of water and
seismic effects. The active force and the normal force are determined as a sum of all forces
entering the analysis.
The program offers several types of plane slip surfaces:
- Smooth
- Undulating
- Stepped
The slip surface can be specified with a tension crack.
The resulting verification can be carried out either according to the theory of limit states or
factors of safety.
3iterature4
Charles ,: Mliche46oc9 slope stabilit#< SM(< BS,< 5>>><+S@. 1-I?33--5?5-5
Stepped slip sur"ace
If the rock body contains a system of parallel discontinuous cracks inclined to the top face of a
rock and the second system is indistinctive, then it is possible to consider a formation of a
stepped (jagged) slip surface in the rock body. This surface can be introduced into the
program using the Calla and Nicholas theory, which increases resistance on the slip surface by
bd.
where:
F
- normal stress acting in the direction normal to the slip surface
J - waviness angle
P - effective tensile strength of steps in the intact rock
k - part of the height h
t
associated with steps in the intact rock (not
created by a secondary system of planes)
h
t
- normal height of stepped wedge resting on an inclined plane of
-966-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
principal system of discontinuity planes
P
0
- tensile strength of intact rock
Stepped slip surface
3iterature4
Characteri!ing roc9 'oint geometr# with 'oint s#stem models Pournal 6oc9 Mechanics and 6oc9
(ngineering< Springer %ien +SS. 1?03-0H30 < +ssue "olume 05< .umber 5 ; Panuar#< 5>II
Pages 05--5
!ensile strength o" rock
Tensile strength P
e
is 20 to "0 smaller than the strength of rock in simple compression
c.
Strength in simple tension P
o
for selected intact rocks [!Pa]
Basalt 3 - 5I
Gneiss ? - 5H
Granite 55 - 05
Limestone 3 - -
Marble ? - 50
Quarzite 2 - 03
Sandstone - - 55
Schist - - 50
Slate 0 - 5?
Tuff 0 - 2
-967-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Undulating slip sur"ace
If undulating surface is considered (on scale 1 to 10 m) it is possible to account for waviness
by angle J:
where: G - slip surface gradient
G
)
- gradient of the i-th fault of slip surface
Thewaviness increases the tensile strengthdon slip surface by bd:
where:
F
- normal stress acting in the direction normal to the slip surface
J - waviness angle
Bndulating slip surface
Anchorage o" rock slope
Two types of anchors can be defined when running the slope stability analysis on a plane slip
surface:
Acti&e
An active anchor is represented by a pre-stressed anchor, for which the anchor forces are
activated before the sliding of a rock block takes place. The normal force increases the normal
stress on a slip surface and as such also the resisting forces; the tangent component of the
normal force is either added to or subtracted from the shear (active) forces.
Passi&e
A passive anchor is activated by sliding of a rock block (i.e. not pre-stressed anchors). The
normal force increases the normal stress on a slip surface and as such also the resisting
forces; the tangent component of the normal force is added to the resisting forces.
-968-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
6esolution of anchor force
Surcharge o" rock slope
The surcharge resultant is determined first. The normal component of the resultant force
increases the normal stress on a slip surface and as such also the resisting forces P
res
, the
tangent component is either added to or subtracted from the shear (active) forces P
act
0
6esolution of surcharge
In"luence o" water acting on slip sur"ace
The following options to account for water effects are available in the program:
-969-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Without ground water, water is not considered

Hydrostatic pressure, GWT above toe of slope

Hydrostatic pressure, GWT on tension crack

Hydrostatic pressure, GWT on tension crack, max

Hydrostatic pressure, water acting on tension crack only

Own water force acting on slip surface only

Own water force behavior

G(! a)o&e toe o" slope

H%drostatic pressure1 G(! a)o&e toe o" slope
The slip surface is either entirely or partially below the ground water table, the maximal water
pressure is at the toe of face.
H#drostatic pressure on slip surface
The value of water pressure 9 at the heel of slope is given by:
-970-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where:
$
- bulk weight of water
h
t
- height of GWT above toe of slope
The resulting compressive water force acting in the direction normal to the slip surface is given
by:
where:
$
- bulk weight of water
h
t
- height of GWT above toe of slope
G - deflection of slip surface from horizontal
G(! on tension crack

G!( on tension crack
The slip surface is entirely below the ground water table; the GWT either intersects the tension
crack or is aligned with terrain, the maximal value of uplift pressure is at the toe of face.
H#drostatic pressure on slip surface and on tension crac9< ma&: alue at the toe of slope
The value of uplift pressure 9 at the intersection of slip surface and tension crack is given by:
where:
$
- bulk weight of water
h
t
- height of GWT above the line of intersection of slip surface and tension
crack
The resulting compressive water force \ acting in the direction normal to the tension crack is
given by:
-971-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where:
$
- bulk weight of water
h
t
- height of GWT above the line of intersection of slip surface and tension
crack
- deflection of tension crack from vertical
The value of pressure 9
1
at the toe of slope is given by:
where:
$
- bulk weight of water
e
$
- height of GWT above toe of slope
The resulting compressive water force s acting in the direction normal to the tension crack is
given:
where: 9 - water pressure acting on the line of intersection of slip surface and tension
crack
9
1
- water pressure at toe of slope
h
t
- height of GWT above the line of intersection of slip surface and tension
crack
G - deflection of slip surface from horizontal
e
$
- height of GWT above toe of slope
G(! on tension crack1 'a

G(! on tension crack
The slip surface is entirely below the ground water table, the GWT either intersects the tension
crack or is aligned with terrain, the maximal value of uplift pressure is at the intersection of
tension crack and slip surface.
-972-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
H#drostatic pressure on slip surface and on tension crac9
The value of uplift pressure 9 at the intersection of slip surface and tension crack is given by:
where:
$
- bulk weight of water
h
t
- height of GWT above the line of intersection of slip surface and tension
crack
The resulting compressive water force \ acting in the direction normal to the tension crack is
given by:
where:
$
- bulk weight of water
h
t
- height of GWT above the line of intersection of slip surface and tension
crack
- deflection of tension crack from vertical
The resulting value of pressure 9
1
at the toe of slope is equal to zero.
The resulting compressive water force s acting in the direction normal to the tension crack is
given:
where: 9 - water pressure acting on the line of intersection of slip surface and tension
crack
h
t
- height of GWT above the line of intersection of slip surface and tension
crack
G - deflection of slip surface from horizontal
e
$
- height of GWT above toe of slope
-973-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
(ater acting on tension crack onl%

(ater acting on tension crack onl%
The slip surface is fully dry; the GWT either intersects the tension crack or is aligned with
terrain, the maximal value of uplift pressure is at the intersection of slip surface and tension
crack.
%ater acting on tension crac9 onl#
The value of uplift pressure 9 at the intersection of slip surface and tension crack is given by:
where:
$
- bulk weight of water
h
t
- height of GWT above the line of intersection of slip surface and tension
crack
The resulting compressive water force \ acting in the direction normal to the tension crack is
given by:
where:
$
- bulk weight of water
h
t
- height of GWT above the line of intersection of slip surface and tension
crack
- deflection of tension crack from vertical
The value of water pressure acting on slip surface is equal to zero.
Own water "orce acting on slip sur"ace onl%

Own water "orce acting on slip sur"ace onl%
The program allows for a manual input of the value of water pressure p
s
in [kPa] acting on a
-974-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
slip surface, providing the pressure distribution is constant.
*wn alue of water pressure acting on slip surface
Own water "orce )eha&ior

Own water "orce )eha&ior
The program allows for a manual input of the value of water pressure p
t
in [kPa] acting on a
tension crack, providing the pressure distributions are constant.
*wn alues of water pressure on slip surface and on tension crac9
Pol%gonal slip sur"ace
The program performs stability analysis of rock blocks moving along the polygonal slip surface.
Owing to the complexity of the general solution the program admits the following assumptions:
- Motion of rock blocks is only translational
- Blocks translate along the polygonal slip surface formed either by planar planes or planes
with moderate waviness
-975-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- Rock blocks are divided by joints with known directions
- Actual deformation of rock mass inside the blocks is negligible
- Failure on the polygonal slip surface and along joints is driven by the Mohr-coulomb failure
criterion
- The same factor of safety is assumed for all joints and along the entire polygonal slip
surface
- All rock blocks are in contact (opening of joints is not allowed)
- The shear forces on the polygonal slip surface have the same sign
The Mohr-Coulomb shear strength parameters on the slip surface and on joints separating
individual block are the main input data for the determination of stability of rock blocks. The
solution is further influenced by the weight of block (depends on the geometry and bulk weight
of rock), anchorage, surcharge, influence of water and seismic effects.
The basic theoretical grounds of the solution are described here.
Pol#gonal slip surface
3iterature4
6oc9 mechanics I< Stabilitrtsberechnung ebener und rrumlicher Felsbsschungen<5>?H< pp: ?3
$ 553
Geo'etr% o" rock )lock
The block geometry is determined by the gradient G, by the length of a given slip surface 8 and
by the gradient of a dividing joint separating the subsequent block as well as by the gradient
G and the length 8 of the top face of external surface of a rock slope (natural profile). Lengths
of planes can be defined either by the total length or by the lengths of their horizontal and
vertical projections. It is necessary to ensure the condition that all rock blocks are in contact
(the opening between joints is not allowed).
-976-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
)eometr# of the i-th element
Anchor "orces1 surcharge
It is possible to introduce anchor forces and surcharges of rock blocks. The resultant of forces
acting on the )
th
block in k3Hm is then determined. All forces acting on the block excluding the
water pressure on the slip surface and the joints are taken into account.
Surcharge acting on the )lock
It is possible to input surface, strip and trapezoidal surcharge of terrain. The program then
determines their effect on individual rock blocks.
Anchor "orces
The applied anchor force is adjusted per 1m run based on the specified horizontal spacing of
anchors.
(&ternal forces on the i-th element
In"luence o" water
The water pressure along the joints and on the slip surface can be taken into account. It is
introduced as external loading:
-977-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
(ater pressure on 8oints @water )etween )locksA F
v
It must be introduced into the analysis whenever the presence of water in the joints between
blocks is expected. It is applied as a resultant force F
0
in k3 (the pressure acting on the
immerse part of the joint per 1m run is considered).
(ater pressure on the eternal slip sur"ace @upli"t pressureA U
It is defined as hydrostatic pressure on each slip surface of the polygon (external slip surface)
separately and introduced as an external loading (uplift pressure) s in k3, which can be
reduced depending on the slip surface permeability (the pressure acting on the immerse part
of the slip surface per 1m run is considered).
%ater forces acting on a roc9 bloc9
Solution procedure
For each rock block resting on the polygonal slip surface the program applies the basic
equation of the stability of rock slope sliding along the plane slip surface as:
where: R - resultant of all active forces
k
1
,k
2
- coefficients depending on slope gradient, inclination of anchor force,
angle of internal friction and factor of safety
c - cohesion on slip surface
& - weight of a rock body in danger of sliding
such that the resultant of all active forces is assumed as an unknown interaction force 2
)
between rock blocks (see figure). If, apart from interaction force, the )
th
rock block is further
loaded by other external forces, it is possible to write the interaction force of the )
th
block in
the form:
where: c
)
-
cohesion on slip surface of )
th
block
-978-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
&
)
-
weight of )
th
rock block
P
)
&

-
overall external force acting on )
th
block in vertical direction
P
)
2

-
overall external force acting on )
th
block in the direction of interaction
force
2
)
&

-
magnitude of interaction force on )
th
block in vertical direction
2
)
2

-
magnitude of interaction force on)
th
in the direction of 2
k
1)
- coefficient depending on gradient of slip surface G, gradient of external
loading Y
)
, stability of rock slope and angle of internal friction
)
k
2)
- coefficient depending on gradient of slip surface G, gradient of external
loading Y
)
, stability of rock slope and angle of internal friction
)
By combining the above forces it is possible to implicitly express the gradient of interaction
force 2
)
of the i-th block as:
where: V
)
- gradient of interaction force Ki of i-th block
c
)
- cohesion on slip surface of i-th block
+
)
- slip surface of i-th rock block
R
)
- interaction force on i-th block
F - ratio of maximal shear resistance and acting shear force

)
- angle of internal friction on slip surface of i-th block
Forces acting on slip surfaces between bloc9s 7internal slip surfaces8
-979-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
,ock wedge
The program performs stability analysis of a rock wedge that is wedged in between two
surfaces (planes) and slides in the direction of the line of interaction (tray) of these planes.
Gradient of this intersection must be considerably larger than the angle of internal friction
along dividing planes, whereas the falling line of both dividing planes must be directed towards
the line of intersection. It is further assumed that the tray is located in a stable rock body.
The solution requires determination of the nor'al "orce., the shear "orce P
act
(active) and
the resisting @passi&eA shear "orce P
res
acting on slip surfaces +
1
and +
2
. The active force
P
act
and the normal force 3 are obtained as a summation all forces entering the analysis after
performing the space resolution of these forces.
The Mohr-Coulomb shear strength parameters and the nor'al "orce 3 acting on the slip
surface are the main input data for the determination of the resisting shear "orces P
res
.
Calculation of the active shear force P
act
and the normal force 3 is further influenced by the
weight of block (depends on the geometry and bulk weight of rock), anchorage, surcharge,
influence of water and seismic effects.
The slip surface can be specified with a tension crack. The resulting verification can be carried
out either according to the theory of limit states or factors of safety.
Components acting on a roc9 wedge
3iterature4
Charles ,: Mliche4 6oc9 slope stabilit#< SM(< BS,< 5>>><+S@. 1-I?33--5?5-5
Geo'etr% o" rock wedge
Entering geometry of a rock wedge using either gradient or falling line gradient direction
requires definition of space orientation of the rock face, terrain (top face), slip surfaces 3
1
and
-980-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
3
2
and/or tension crack, such that:
- Gradient (gradient angle) is an inclination angle Grepresenting inclination of surface from
horizontal (it may receive values from 0A to E0A)
- Gradient direction (falling line) is an angle between horizontal projection of the line
normal to the strike direction measured as an azimuth angle (from the north in the
clockwise direction) (the falling line corresponds to inclination of the plane), it may receive
values from 0A to "@0A
The program when defining space orientation of planes displays these planes using a
stereographic projection.
Description of orientation of surfaces 7ertical cut through a roc9 mass and plane pro'ection8
Stereographic pro8ection
When defining geometry of the wedge and slip surfaces using space projection, the program
displays individual surfaces with the help of great circles of Lambert's hemispherical projection.
Hemispherical pro'ection of the inclined plane
In"luence o" ground water
By default the program performs the stability analysis of a rock wedge without considering
-981-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
ground water. If interested on the influence of ground water on a rock wedge it is necessary to
introduce the height of GWT from the line of intersection of slip surfaces and rock face (the
GWT takes an arbitrary position over the entire height of a rock wedge). The program assumes
that water can flow freely discontinuities located below the GWT (no restrictions, e.g. due to
ice blocks, are considered).
The water pressure acts in the direction normal to the slip surfaces against normal components
of the passive forces. If the height ?
$
above the point of maximal pressure P
ma;
is equal or
larger than ZH2 and it is fully contained by the rock wedge, then its value is assumed to be
equal to ZH2 (case A). If the height ?
$
above the point of maximal pressure P
ma;
is less than
ZH2 (case B), then its value reduced as:
where: DM - length of the line of intersection of slip surfaces +
1
, +
2
G
1
- gradient of rock face
V - gradient of the of line of intersection of slip surfaces
The resulting water pressure on slip surfaces 1 and 2 is given by:
where: Z - height of GWT above the line of intersection of slip surfaces and rock face
P
ma
;

- maximal water pressure on the line of intersection of slip surfaces

$
- bulk weight of water
+
1
$

- are of the wetted part of the slip surface 1
+
2
$

- area of the wetted part of the slip surface 2
Distribution of water pressure on the line of intersection of slip surfaces
If a tension crack is found either entirely or partially below the GWT, then the influence of
water pressure is reflected both on slip surfaces 1 and 2 through forces P
1
and P
2
acting on
intersection of these surfaces and on tension crack through force P
"
acting in the direction
normal to the tension crack.
-982-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Distribution of water pressure when considering )%T in tension crac9
,esolution o" acting "orces
Forces acting on a rock wedge (weight of rock wedge, external loading, anchor force) are
resolved into directions normal to planes +
1
and +
2
(the block is wedged in between these
surfaces) and into the direction of their intersection. The resolution of forces results into the
normal forces 3
1
< 3
2
acting on planes +
1
and +
2
, resisting (passive) forces P
res1
, P
res2
acting
along planes +
1
and +
2
.
This step further generates the shear @acti&eA "orce P
act
acting in the direction of the line of
intersection of slip surfaces. The resulting shear @acti&eA "orceP
act
is obtained as a sum of
individual shear forces P
act,)
.
!he resisting @passi&eA "orce P
res
is found by summing up the components P
res1
, P
res2
(e.g.
due to external loading) and friction forces on planes +1 and +2 due to normal forces:
where: c
1
-cohesion on slip surface +
1
c
2
-cohesion on slip surface +
2

1
-angle of internal friction on slip surface +
1

2
-angle of internal friction on slip surface +
2
P
0/,1
-resisting forces on slip surface +
1
P
0/,2
-resisting forces on slip surface +
2
-983-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Space resolution of self weight of earth wedge %
5eri"ication
Verification can be carried out either according to the theory of limit states or factor of safety.
5eri"ication according to the "actor o" sa"et%
When performing verification according to the factor of safety the program directly determines
the value of the factor of safety SF. Verification condition has the form:
where: P
act
-shear forces along the slip surface
P
act
-passive forces along the slip surface
SF -safety factor
SF
s
-safety factor (input in the "Stability analisis" tab sheet)
Typical values for most cases when studying stability of rock slopes are, e.g. for walls of
foundation pits F =1,1 to 1,2#, for rock cuts of highways F =1,2 to 1,#, etc.
5eri"ication according to the theor% o" li'it states
When performing verification according to the theory of limit states the program reduces
material parameters of rocks (angle of internal friction or tangent of the angle of internal
friction, cohesion) using partial coefficients entered in the "Stability analysis" tab sheet.
Verification condition has the form:
where: P
act
-shear forces along the slip surface
-984-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
P
res
-passive forces along the slip surface

s
-reduction coefficient of overall stability of construction (input in the
"Stability analisis")
When analyzing the pol%gonal slip sur"ace the program compares the calculated value with
the value corresponding to the fully stressed design (state of equilibrium with zero
reserve). Verification condition has the form:
where: SF - factor of safety calculated with the reduced material parameters
SF
s
- coefficient of the overall stability of the structure
,ock 6 shear resistance criteria
The shear strength is the basic criterion to determine resisting passive forces. The resisting
force is given by the following expression:
where: d - shear strength on the slip surface
8 - length of the slip surface
The shear strength for the planar slip surface can be written as:
- Mohr - Coulomb
- Hoek - Brown
- Barton - Bandis
/ohr 6 Coulo')
The shear strength according to the Mohr-Coulomb is given by:
where: 3 - normal force acting on the slip surface
8 - length of the slip surface
c - cohesion of soil / rock
- angle of internal friction of soil
Approximate ranges of parameters of the Mohr-Coulomb failure criterion for selected soils are
given here.
3iterature4
Charles ,: Mliche4 6oc9 slope stabilit#< SM(< BS,< 5>>><+S@. 1-I?33--5?5-5
Para'eters /ohr + Coulo')
If possible the strength parameters should be determined in-situ measurements. The results of
in-situ and laboratory experiments show that the angle of internal friction is found for majority
of discontinuities in the rock mass in the range of 2XA to 4XA. Approximate values of the angle
-985-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
of internal friction and cohesion c for rocks based on the RMR classification are stored in the
following table:
,ock class I II III I5 5
RMR 511 - I5 I1 - H5 H1 - 25 21 - 05 t 01
,ngle of internal
friction F A]
^ 2- 3- - 2- 0- - 2- 5- - 0- t 5-
Cohesionc [kPa] ^ 211 311 - 211 011 - 311 511 - 011 t 511
Hoek 6 Brown
The modified Hoek-Brown failure criterion describes the failure of a rock mass (based on the
performed analyses of hundreds of underground structures and rock slopes) as:
where:
1e6
- major principal stress during rock failure

"e6
- minor principal stress during rock failure

c
- strength of the intact rock in simple compression
m
>
,s - nonlinear material constant depending on the rock quality
a - coefficient depending on the rock breaking
Basic parameters of the modified Hoek-Brown model should be determined from in-situ and
laboratory measurements. To become more acquainted with this model, a brief list of ranges of
individual parameters is provided. If rock 'ass classi"ication using GSI is known then it is
possible to let the program to determine the H-B parameters by itself.
For actual analysis the H-B parameters are transformed into the M-C parameters. The solution
procedure then becomes identical to that of the Mohr-Coulomb criterion.
This transformation employs the solution derived by Hoek and Brown in 1990 for known value
of the effective normal stress
F
, which is typical for the solution of slope stability problem.
where:
c
- strength of the intact rock in simple compression
-986-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
m - nonlinear material constant depending on the rock quality
a - coefficient depending on the rock breaking
3iterature4
Stabilit# anal#sis of roc9 slopes with a modified Hoe9-@rown failure criterion< ,.) =iao-3i p
3+,.) 3+ p /+. Pian-Hua +nternational 'ournal for numerical and anal#tical methods in
geomechanics +SS. 13H3->1H5< 0112< ol: 0I< no0< pp: 5I5-5>1
Para'eters Hoek + Brown
Para'eter o" rock )reaking a
Parameter a is an exponent receiving values from 0,# to 0,@# (for the original Hoek-Brown
condition it is equal to 0,#) and depends on the degree of rock breaking.
.onlinear para'eters m
>
= m 1 s "or a = 0,#
(index r denotes residual values)
-987-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Car)onate
rocks with
well
de&eloped
clea&age 6
dolo'ite1
li'estone1
'ar)le
Argillaceou
s rocks 6
'udstone1
siltstone1
shale1 slate
Arenaceous
rocks 6
sandstone1
Huart-ite
Fine
grained
igneous
cr%stalline
rocks 6
andesite1
dolerite1
)asalt1
rh%olite
Coarse
'eta'orphi
c and
igneous
rocks 6
ga))ro1
gneiss1
granite
Intact rock
material,
Laboratory
specimens have
no
discontinuities,
R!R = 100,
( = #00
m = X.00
s = 1.00
mr = X.00
sr = 1,00
m = 10.00
s = 1.00
mr = 10.00
sr = 1.00
m = 1#.00
s = 1.00
mr = 1#.00
s = 1.00
m = 1X.00
s = 1.00
mr = 1X.00
s = 1.00
m = 2#.00
s = 1.00
mr = 2#.00
s = 1.00
Very good
quality rock
mass,
Rocks without
isolated blocks
with non-
weathered
discontinuities,
R!R = B#,
( = 100
m = 2.40
s = 0.0B2
mr = 4.10
sr = 0.1BE
m = ".4"
s = 0.0B2
mr = #.B#
sr = 0.1BE
m = #.14
s = 0.0B2
mr = B.XB
sr = 0.1BE
m = #.B2
s = 0.0B2
mr = E.E#
sr = 0.1BE
m = B.#@
s = 0.0B2
mr = 14.@"
sr = 0.1BE
Good quality
rock mass,
Slightly damaged
rocks with non-
weathered
discontinuities
spaced from 1 to
" m,
R!R = @#,
( = 10
m = 0.#X#
s = 0.002E"
mr = 2.00@
sr = 0.020#
m = 0.B21
s = 0.002E"
mr = 2.B@#
sr = 0.020#
m = 1.2"1
s = 0.002E"
mr = 4.2EB
sr = 0.020#
m = 1."E#
s = 0.002E"
mr = 4.BX1
sr = 0.020#
m = 2.0#2
s = 0.002E"
mr = X.1@"
sr = 0.020#
Fair quality rock
mass,
Partially
weathered
discontinuities
spaced from 0,"
to 1 m,
m = 0.12B
s = 0.0000E
mr = 0.E4X
m = 0.1B"
s = 0.0000E
mr = 1."#"
m = 0.2X#
s = 0.0000E
mr = 2.0"0
m = 0."11
s = 0.0000E
mr = 2."01
m = 0.4#B
s = 0.0000E
mr = "."B"
-988-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
R!R = 44,
( = 1 sr = 0.001EB sr = 0.001EB sr = 0.001EB sr = 0.001EB sr = 0.001EB
Poor quality rock
mass,
Numerous
weathered
discontinuities
spaced from "0
to #00 mm,
R!R = 2",
( = 0,1
m = 0.02E
s = 0.00000"
mr = 0.44X
sr = 0.0001E
m = 0.041
s = 0.00000"
mr = 0.@"E
sr = 0.0001E
m = 0.0@1
s = 0.00000"
mr = 0.E#E
sr = 0.0001E
m = 0.0@E
s = 0.00000"
mr = 1.0BX
sr = 0.0001E
m = 0.102
s = 0.00000"
mr = 1.#EB
sr = 0.0001E
Very poor quality
rock mass,
Numerous
extremely
weathered
discontinuities
with filling
spaced by less
than #0 mm, fine
grained waste
rock,
R!R = ",
( = 0,01
m = 0.00X
s =
0.0000001
mr = 0.21E
sr = 0.00002
m = 0.010
s =0.0000001
mr = 0."1"
sr = 0.00002
m = 0.01#
s = 0.0000001
mr = 0.4@E
sr = 0.00002
m = 0.01X
s =
0.0000001
mr = 0.#"2
sr = 0.00002
m = 0.02#
s = 0.0000001
mr = 0.XB2
sr = 0.00002
Strength o" rocks in si'ple co'pression
c,
Poisson's nu')erJand )ulk weight o"
rock
-989-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
,ock
strengt
h
!%pes o" rock @ea'plesA Strengt
h

c

[!Pa]
Poisson's
nu')er
J
Bulk weight
o" rock
[k3Hm
"
]
Solid
rock
most hard solid rock, intact,
compact and dense quartz
rock and basalt, other
extraordinary hard rocks
I1#0 0,1 2B,00 - "0,00
Highly
hard
rock
very hard granit rock, quartz
porphyry, very hard granite,
hard flinty shale, quartzite,
very hard sand rock and very
hard cacite
100 - 1#0 0,1# 2@,00 - 2X,00
Hard
rock
granite, very hard sandstone
and calcite, quarzite lode, hard
conglomerate, very hard ore,
hard limestone, marble,
dolomite, pyrite
B0 - 100 0,20 2#,00 - 2@,00
Rock sandstone, ore, medium sandy
shale, flagstone
#0 - B0 0,2# 24,00
Medium
rock
hard mudstone, softer sand
rock and calcite, chalky clay
20 - #0 0,2# W 0,"0 2" - 24,00
Soft rock shale, soft limestone, calk, salt
rock, frozen ground, anthracite,
marl, remoulded sandstone,
soft conglomerate, ground with
fels
# - 20 0," W 0,"# 22,00 W 2@,00
Weak
soil
compact clay, soil eluvium,
black coal
0,# - # 0,"# W 0,40 20,00 - 22,0
1B,00 - 20,00
Calculation o" Hoek6Brown para'eters
If rock mass classification using GSI(Geological Structure Index) is known then it is possible to
let the program to determine the H-B parameters as follows:
where: &S1 - Geological Structure Index
-990-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
< - damage coefficient of rock mass
m
)
- strength material constant of the intact rock for peak conditions
5alues o" da'age coe""icient < "or rock slope
$escription o" rock 'ass Suggested
&alue o"
coe""icient <
Small scale blasting in engineering slopes
results in modest rock mass damage,
particularly if controlled blasting is used.
However, stress relief results in some
disturbance.
(Good blasting).
1<?
Small scale blasting in engineering slopes
results in modest rock mass damage,
particularly if controlled blasting is used.
However, stress relief results in some
disturbance.
(Poor blasting).
5
Very large open pit mine slopes significant
disturbance due to heavy production
blasting and due to stress relief from
overburden removal.
(Production blasting).
5
In some softer rocks excavation can be
carried out by ripping and dozing and the
degree of damage to the slope is less.
(Mechanical excavation).
1<?
Approi'ate &laues o" strength 'aterial constant o" the intact rock m
)
(after Hoek)
-991-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
!%pe o" rock ,epresentati&e rocks m
)
[-]
Limestone rocks with well
developed crystalline
cleavage
Dolomite, calcite, marble = ?
Consolidated clayey rocks Mudstone, siltstone, silty
shale, slate
= 51
Sandy rocks with solid
crystals and poorly
developed crystalline
cleavage
Sandstone, quarzite = 5-
Fine grained igneous
crystalline rocks
Andesite, dolerite,
diabase, rhyolite
= 5?
Coarse grained and
metamorphic rocks
Amphibolite, gabbro,
gneiss, granite, diorite
= 0-
Barton 6 Bandis
The Barton-Bandis shear strength failure criterion for the rock mass takes the following form:
where: URS - joint roughness coefficient

F
- normal stress acting on the surface of the rock joint
USS - joint compressive strength

>
- basic angle of internal friction of the slip surface
If possible the shear strength parameters should be determined from in-situ measurements.
Approximate ranges of parameters of the Barton-Bandis failure criterion are given here.
3iterature4
@romhead< (M 75>>08: VThe Stabilit# of Slopes 70nd (dition8u< @lac9ie ,cademic q
Professional4 3ondon
Barton + Bandis para'eters
Joint roughness coe""icient J,C
If the value of JRC cannot be determined by direct measurements on the joint surface, it is
possible to obtain this value from the Barton graph (see figure) showing the variation of the
coefficient JRC as a function of length of profile and roughness depth.
-992-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Diagram to determine P6C 7after @arton8
Rock joint roughness profiles showing the typical range of JRC are plotted next.
-993-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
6oc9 'oint roughness profiles showing the t#pical range of P6C 7@arton q Chube# 5>??8
Co'pressi&e strength o" discontinuit% JCS
Methods allowing us to determine the compressive strength of discontinuity (slip surface) JCS
are generally recommended by ISRM. The value of JCS can be obtained from the Deer-Miller
graph showing its dependence on the rock strength found from the Schmidt hammer
measurements, see figure below.
-994-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Basic angle o" internal "riction on slip sur"ace
>

The basic value of the angle of internal friction on the surface is approximately equal to the
residual value
r
. Nevertheless, it can be generally measured in laboratories using shear
measurement devices (typical area of the specimen is #0 ; #0 mm). Typical ranges of the basic
angle of internal friction for weathered rock surfaces are 2#A to "#A.
Bulk weight o" rocks
Bulk weight or rock
-995-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
,ock
strengt
h
,ock categor% @ea'plesA Bulk weight
o" rock
[k3Hm
"
]
Solid
rock
most hard solid rock, intact,
compact and dense quartz
rock and basalt, other
extraordinary hard rocks
0I<11 -
31<11
Highly
hard
rock
very hard granit rock, quartz
porphyry, very hard granite,
hard flinty shale, quartzite,
very hard sand rock and very
hard cacite
0H<11 -
0?<11
Hard
rock
granite, very hard sandstone
and calcite, quarzite lode, hard
conglomerate, very hard ore,
hard limestone, marble,
dolomite, pyrite
0-<11 -
0H<11
Rock sandstone, ore, medium sandy
shale, flagstone
02<11
Medium
rock
hard mudstone, softer sand
rock and calcite, chalky clay
03 - 02<11
Soft rock shale, soft limestone, calk, salt
rock, frozen ground, anthracite,
marl, remoulded sandstone,
soft conglomerate, ground with
fels
00<11 $
0H<11
Weak
soil
compact clay, soil eluvium,
black coal
01<11 - 00<1
5I<11 -
01<11
In"luence o" seis'ic e""ects
The programs allows for taking into account the earthquake effects using two variables
coefficient of horizontal acceleration 2
h
and coefficient of vertical acceleration 2
0
.
The coefficient of acceleration is a dimensionless number, which represents the seismic
acceleration as a fraction of the gravity acceleration. Earthquake effects are introduced through
the seismic force S, which is determined by multiplying the weight of the rock subjected to
earthquake (i.e. rock block) by the coefficient of acceleration. When assuming seismic waves
only in the horizontal direction the seismic force is given by:
-996-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: 2
h
- coefficient of horizontal acceleration
% - weight of the rock body
The seismic force always acts in the center of gravity of the rock body. Usually, only seismic
effects in the horizontal direction are considered. Nevertheless, the program also allows for
treating the vertical direction (with the help of vertical coefficient of acceleration 2
0
). Effects in
both directions are then combined.
/WCWS grade Hori-ontal acceleration Coe""icient o" hori-ontal
acceleration
(!S2-@4)
[mmHs
2
]
2
h

5 1<1 - 0<- 1<1 - 1:1110-
0 0<- - -<1 1<1110- - 1:111-
3 -<1 - 51<1 1<111- - 1:115
2 51<1 - 0-<1 1<115 - 1:110-
- 0-<1 - -1<1 1<110- - 1:11-
H -1<1 - 511<1 1<11- - 1:15
? 511<1 - 0-1<1 1<15 - 1:10-
I 0-1<1 - -11<1 1<10- - 1:1-
> -11<1 - 5111<
1
1<1- - 1:5
51 5111<1 - 0-11<
1
1<5 - 1:0-
55 0-11<1 - -111<
1
1<0- - 1:-
50 ^ -111<
1
^ 1:-
!he &alues o" "actor 2
h
correspond to indi&idual degrees o" earthHuake according to
/6C6S scale
3iterature4
Charles ,: Mliche46oc9 slope stabilit#< SM(< BS,< 5>>><+S@. 1-I?33--5?5-5
/icropile
The program performs verification analysis of micropiles (reinforced by steel tube)
- based on limit states
- based on factor of safety
-997-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Both the root section and micropile tube (micropile cross-section) are examined for both
cases. When examining the micropile tube the analysis may include excpected lifetime of the
micropile.
5eri"ication )ased on "actor o" sa"et%
The program performs verification analysis of the micropile tube and root:
5eri"ication o" the cross6section @tu)eA
Both, internal stability of section and coupled section bearing capacity, are verified.
10 Internal sta)ilit% o" section
where: 3
cr
-standard critical normal force, calculated in dependence on the method
set in the "Micropiles" tab sheet
3
ma;
-maximal normal force, entered in the frame "Load"
SF
6
-critical force safety factor, entered in the "Micropiles" tab sheet
20 Coupled section )earing capacit%
where: R
s
-standard strength of steel, entered in the frame "Material"

s
-stress in steel, calculated according to the way of loading (section loaded
only by normal force or by combination of bending moment and normal
force)
SF
s
-safety factor of section resistance, entered in the "Micropiles" tab sheet
5eri"ication o" the root
where: ( -standard root bearing capacity, calculated in dependence on used method
(see "Bearing capacity of the micropile root section")
3
ma;
-maximal normal force, entered in the frame "Load"
FS -root resistance safety factor, entered in the "Micropiles" tab sheet
5eri"ication )ased on li'it states
The program performs verification analysis of the micropile tube and root:
5eri"ication o" the cross6section @tu)eA
-998-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Both, internal stability of section and coupled section bearing capacity, are verified.
10 Internal sta)ilit% o" section
where: 3
ma;
-maximal normal force, entered in the frame "Load"
3
cr,
-design critical normal force
where: 3
cr
-standard critical normal force, calculated in dependence on the method
set in the "Micropiles" tab sheet.

m6
-reduction coefficient of critical force, entered in the "Micropiles" tab sheet
(limit states)
20 Coupled section )earing capacit%
where:
s
-stress in steel, calculated according to the way of loading (section loaded
only by normal force or by combination of bending moment and normal
force)
R
s,
-design strength of steel
where: R
s
-standard strength of steel, entered in the frame "Material"

ss
-reliability coefficient of steel, entered in the "Micropiles" tab sheet (limit
states)
5eri"ication o" the root
where: 3
ma;
-maximal normal force, entered in the frame "Load"
(
r,
-design root bearing capacity
where: ( -standard root bearing capacity, calculated in dependence on used method
(see "Bearing capacity of the micropile root section")

mr
-reduction coefficient of root resistance, entered in the "Micropiles" tab
sheet (limit states)
5eri"ication o" the 'icropile tu)e
When calculating the tube bearing capacity (micropile cross-section) the program differentiates
-999-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
between a micropile loaded in tension or in compression.
In case of tension the program determines coupled section bearing capacity (strength of
cement mixture is not considered).
In case of compression the program examines both, coupled section bearing capacity and
internal stability of section, depending on the method set in the "Micropiles" tab sheet.
Coupled section )earing capacit%
In the case of coupled section bearing capacity, the micropile tube is examined against the
failure due to loading caused by normal force or by combination of bending moment and
normal force.
When determining the coupled section bearing capacity it is possible to involve influence of the
expected life time of the micropile.
/icropile li"e ti'e
The micropile life time is introduced by reducing the area of the reinforcing tube using the
reduction coefficient of the influence of corrosion of steel tube r
e
and coefficientF
9t
taking into
account connection of the micropile and the surrounding soil.
where: < -external diameter of reinforcing tube
t -wall thickness of reinforcing tube
F
9t
-coefficient taking into account connection of micropile and surrounding soil
r
e
-coefficient of influence of corrosion of steel tube
3iterature4
@S (. 525>>4011- (&ecution of special geotechnical wor9s: Micropiles @ritish-,dopted
(uropean Standard ; 31-Mar-011- ; -0 pages +S@.4 1-I12-?02>
Coe""icient Fut
Coe""icient F
9t
taking into account connection o" 'icropile and surrounding soil
!%pe F
9t
[-]
Using sleeve of external double spiral
without reduction in cross-section
5<1
Spiral with increasing cross-section 5<1
Other types of connection 5<1
Other cases 5<1
-1000-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Coe""icient o" in"luence o" corrosion
Coe""icient o" in"luence o" corrosion o" steel tu)e r
e
P mm Q @)ased on 3. 1C1DDA
!%pe o" soil ,eHuired li"e ti'e o" 'icropile [?ears]
- 0- -1 ?- 511
Soils in natural deposition 1<1 1<31 1<H1 1<>1 5<01
Soils in natural deposition
contaminated
1<5- 1<?- 5<-1 0<0- 3<11
Organic soils 1<01 5<11 5<?- 0<-1 3<0-
Loose soils 1<5I 1<?1 5:01 5<?1 0<01
Special soils (containing
soluble salts)
1<-1 0<11 3:0- 2<-1 -<?-
.ote; Values of the coefficient of influence of corrosion of steel tube r
e
are for intermediate
values.
Bearing capacit% o" cross6section loaded )% nor'al "orce
!ension nor'al "orce
In case of tension force, the stress in steel part of cross section is calculated using following
formula:
where:
s
- stress in steel
3 - normal force acting in section
+
s
- area of the steel part of the micropile cross-section
Co'pressi&e nor'al "orce
Bearing capacity of the cross-section in compression, reduced by buckling coefficient, is
determined as:
where: Z - buckling coefficient
+
s
- area of the steel part of the micropile cross-section
+
c
- area of the cement mixture part of the micropile cross-section
R
s
,

- design strength of steel
R
c
,

- design strength of cement mixture in compression
-1001-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Design strengths are equal to standard values in the verification based on the factor of safety.
Design strengths of steel and cement mixture are calculated in the verification based on the
theory of limit states as follows:
where: R
s
- standard strength of steel, entered in the frame "Material"

ss
- reduction coefficient of steel strength, entered in the "Micropiles" tab sheet
R
c
- standard strength of cement mixture in compression, entered in the frame
"Material"

sc
- reduction coefficient for cement mixture, entered in the "Micropiles" tab
sheet
The stress in the steel part of the cross-section is determined as:
where: 3 - normal force acting in section
3
c,9
- bearing capacity of the cross-section in compression, reduced by
influence of buckling
R
s,
- design strength of steel
Bearing capacit% o" cross6section loaded )% co')ination
o" )ending 'o'ent and nor'al "orce
A cross-section loaded by combination of bending moment and normal force requires the
determination of neutral axis, dividing the cross-section into tensile and co'pressed part.
When searching the position of neutral axis, influence of buckling is included, i.e. normal force
is increased by dividing it by coefficient of bucklingv. The neutral axis is searched following the
procedure known from the dimensioning of concrete cross-sections, reinforced by steel, as a
limit equilibrium method. Compression is transmitted by a part of a steel tube and cement
mixture filling. Tension is taken by the remaining part of the steel tube, cement mixture in
tension is not considered.
The bearing capacity in bending is determined by the following formula:
where: R
s
,
- design strength of steel
+
s,
t
- area of the tensile part of the steel micropile cross-section
-1002-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
+
s,
c
- area of the compressed part of the steel micropile cross-section
+
c,
c
- area of the compressed part of the cement mixture cross-section
t
s,t
- location of the center of tensile steel part
t
s,c
- location of the center of compressed steel part
t
c,c
- location of the center of compressed cement mixture part
R
c
,
- design strength of cement mixture in compression
Design strengths are equal to standard values in the verification based on the factor of safety.
Design strengths of steel and cement mixture are calculated in the verification based on the
theory of limit states as follows:
where: R
s
- standard strength of steel, entered in the frame "Material"

ss
- reliability coefficient of steel, entered in the "Micropiles" tab sheet
R
c
- standard strength of cement mixture in compression, entered in the frame
"Material"

sc
- reliability coefficient of cement mixture, entered in the "Micropiles" tab sheet
The stress in the steel part of the cross-section is determined as:
where: ! - bending moment acting in section
!
9
- bearing capacity in bending
R
s,
- design strength of steel
In"luence o" )uckling
The analysis is preceded by the determination of characteristics of an ideal cross-section, in
which the effect of cement mixture cross-section is transformed into steel. Slenderness of
element is determined as:
where: 8
cr
- element buckling length
) - radius of gyration of the ideal cross-section
-1003-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: - - modulus of elasticity of the ideal cross-section
1 - moment of inertia of the ideal cross-section
3
cr
- standard critical normal force, calculated in dependence on the method
set in the "Micropiles" tab sheet
Recounted slenderness R
p
is determined next:
where: R
s,
- design strength of steel (in calculation based on factor of safety design
strength is equal to standard strength)
where: R
s
- standard strength of steel, entered in the frame "Material"

ms
- reliability coefficient of steel, entered in the "Micropiles" tab sheet (limit
states)
Buckling coefficient Z is determined according to slenderness R
p
with the help of following
formulas:




Internal sta)ilit% o" section
Internal stability of section examines the failure of a micropile due to buckling into the
surrounding soil. The crucial step for the determination of internal stability of section is the
calculation of the normal force 3
cr
that depends on the micropile length, the surrounding soil
and other effects. User can choose one of the following solution methods in the "Micropiles" tab
sheet for calculating critical normal force 3
cr
:
- Geometric method (Euler)
- Salas theory
- Vas-Souche theory
-1004-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Geo'etric 'ethod @3ulerA
The soil surrounding the micropile is represented in the program by the modulus of subsoil
reaction-
p
(Winkler constant k) defined by the user in the frame "Verification of cross-section".
A model of a structure is displayed in the figure.
Model of structure
For a micropile in compression it is expected that a varying number of half waves occurs
depending on the geometry and stiffness of the structure and surrounding soil, respectively.
The solution of this case arises from the equation of bending of a straight beam.
After some manipulations the bending equation can be expressed as:

where:



-1005-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013

Integration constants are found from four boundary conditions depending on the assumed end
point supports.
Assu'ing hinges on )oth ends the following equation can be derived:

providing the number of half waves in the form:

where: -
)
- modulus of elasticity of ideal cross-section
1
)
- moment of inertia of ideal cross-section
8
p
- micropile length
-
p
- modulus of subsoil reaction
F - number of half waves
Assu'ing hinge on the one side and "ied end on the other side the following equation
holds:

providing the number of half waves in the form:

where: -
)
- modulus of elasticity of ideal cross-section
1
)
- moment of inertia of ideal cross-section
8
p
- micropile length
-
p
- modulus of subsoil reaction
F - number of half waves
Force 3
cr
is determined from the following equation by iterations:
-1006-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: -
)
- modulus of elasticity of ideal cross-section
1
)
- moment of inertia of ideal cross-section
3
cr
- critical normal force
8
cr
- buckling length of micropile cross-section in compression
Salas theor%
The critical force 3
cr
for basic support conditions in the micropile head (determining micropile
deflection) follows from:
where: -
aM
1
a
-bending stiffness of micropile reinforcing tube
8 -free length of micropile length
8
e6
-length of fictitious fixed end
+ -constat reflecting the type of support in micropile head
where: 6 -coefficient depending on the ratio of modulus of elasticity of soil in
micropile head and base
8
e
-elastic length of micropile given by:
where: -
aM
1
a
-bending stiffness of micropile reinforcing tube
-
8
-modulus of elasticiy of soil in the micropile base
3iterature4
PimYne! Salas P:,: a 9ol4)eotecnica # Cimientos +++< Capitulo 3< 6ueda< Madrid 7Spanish8
Constant A re"lecting the t%pe o" support in the 'icropile
head
Constant + re"lecting the t%pe o" support in the 'icropile head
-1007-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
!%pe o" support in the 'icropile head + [-]
Hinged 0:12-
Free 1<0-
Fixed 2<1
Horizontally movable 5<1
Coe""icient "
Coe""icient 6
-
o
H -
8
1u
[-]
6 [-]
1 5<?1
1<- 5<0-
5 5<11
1u
-
o
- the modulus of elasticity of soil below terrain surface (at the micropile head)
-
8
- the modulus of elasticity of soil at the micropile root
5Ias6Souche theor%
Calculation of the force 3
c
follows from graphs published by Vas and Souche (see literature).
The graphs for the determination of the critical normal force 3
cr
are constructed for
dimesionless quatitites k,m:
where: 8
P
-micropile length
-
aM
1
a
-bending stiffness of micropile reinforcing tube
k -ratio of free length of micropile (from beginning of base) and its length in
soil
-
r,
-design value of modulus of horizontal reaction
where: -
r
-reaction of soil in horizontal direction
F
$
-coefficient reducing the value of -
r
tF
$
= 1,2#u
-1008-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
3iterature4
"Yase< Souche4 wtude du fla<berment de pieu& partiellernent immergYs dans offrant
latYralement une rYaction YlastiAue pure< ,nnales de +m+T@TP< .o: 203< Sene Soils et
Foundations< 5I?< mars $ aril 5>I2< str: 3I $ H1 7French8
/odulus o" hori-ontal reaction o" su)soil
The soil surrounding the micropile can be represented using horizontal springs along micropile
characterized by the Winkler constant k. For buckling of micropile into the soil in the direction
of the ; axis it is possible to write:
where: p
h
-reaction of soil caused by the shift of micropile in direction of ; axis (soil in
compression)
k
h
-stiffness of Winkler spring (modulus of subsoil reaction-
p
u
; -shift of micropile in direction of ; axis
Providing we consider the reaction of soil to pressing of micropile per one meter run of the
micropile we arrive at:
where: -
r
-reaction of soil in horizontal direction
P
h
-reaction of soil caused by shift of micropile in direction of ; axis per one
meter run of micropile
; shift of micropile in direction of & axis
The above equations identify the relation between the modulus of subsoil reaction-
p
[k3Hm
"
]
and the reaction of soil in the horizontal direction -
r
[k3Hm
2
] (assuming constant -
r
in the soil):
where: < -diameter of micropile
k
h
-stiffness of Winkler spring (modulus of subsoil reaction-
p
)
Reaction of soil in the horizontal direction -
r
can be post calculated based on the knowledge of
the modulus -
m
.
Calculation o" the 'odulus o" hori-ontal reaction o" su)soil 3r
The modulus of horizontal reaction of subsoil can be determined when knowing the
pressuremeter modulus -
m
and coefficient G
p
as:
kde: -
m
- pressuremeter modulus
-1009-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
G
p
- coefficient of type of soil (see the table below)
,e"erence &alues -
m
and P
8)m

Soils -
m
[!pa] P
8)m
[!Pa]
non-cohesive loose 1 $ 3<- 1 $ 1<-
medium dense 3<- $ 50 1<- $ 5<-
dense 50 $ 00<- 5<- $ 0<-
very dense ^ 00<- ^0<-
cohesive slush 1 $ 0<- 1 - 1<0
soft 0<- $ - 1<0 $ 1<2
stiff - $ 50 1<2 $ 1<I
solid 50 $ 0- 1<I $ 5<H
hard ^0- ^5H
5alues o" coe""icient o" t%pe o" soil G
p

!%pe o" soil Peat Cla%1 silt Sedi'ent Sand Sand and
gra&el
G
p
G
p

-
m
HP
8)m

G
p

-
m
HP
8)m

G
p

-
m
HP
8)m

G
p

-
m
H P
8)m

overconsolidate
d
- 5 ^5H 0;3 ^52 5;0 ^50 5;3 ^51
normally
consolidated
5 0;3 >-5H 5;0 I-52 5;3 ?-50 5;2 H-51
methamorfous - 5;0 ?-> 5;0 --I 5-3 --? 5x2 -
5alues o" the 'odulus o" su)soil reaction 3p
5alues o" the 'odulus o" su)soil reaction -
p
[!3Hm"]
Soil
-p !)FH!a; [!3Hm
"
] A&erage &alue k
h
[!3Hm
"
]
soft clay 0:1 - -:1 3:-
stiff clay 3:1 - I:1 -:-
solid clay H:1 - 5H:1 55:1
-1010-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
sand naturally wet loose H:1 - 53:1 >:-
sand naturally wet medium
dense
01:1 - 21:1 31:1
sand naturally wet dense 2-:1 - >1:1 H?:-
sand aquiferous loose 2:1 - I:1 H:1
sand aquiferous medium
dense
51:1 - 01:1 5-:1
sand aquiferous dense 31:1 - H1:1 2-:1
sandy clay soft 3:1 - H:1 2:-
sand clay stiff -:1 - >:1 ?:1
sandy clay solid I:1 - 5?:1 50:-
clayey sand wet loose 2:1 - >:1 H:-
clayey sand wet medium
dense
50:1 - 30:1 00:1
clayey sand wet dense 02:1 - 22:1 32:1
clayey sand aquiferous loose 3:- - H:- -:1
clayey sand aquiferous
medium dense
?:1 - 55:1 >:1
clayey sand aquiferous
dense
55:- - 53:- 50:-
Bearing capacit% o" the 'icropile root section
The micropile bearing capacity can be determined computationally using one of the approaches
available in the literature and standards. The program "/icropile" provides a set of methods
representing the basic approaches to the solution of bearing capacity of the micropile root. The
analysis is accrued out according to setting in the "Micropiles" tab sheet employing one of the
following procedures:
Lizzi theory - average limit friction on root skin is specified
Littlejohn theory - grouting pressure is specified
Zweck theory - method depends on geostatic stress and soil parameters of surrounding
soil
Bowles theory method depends on geostatic stress and soil parameters of surrounding
soil
Vas theory - the way the micropile is built and soil parameters of surrounding soil are
specified
root in rock - rock parameters of surrounding soil are specified
-1011-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Bustamante - method depends on parameters of SPT tests and pressiometric tests
#i--i theor%
The Lizzi method is currently the most popular method used. The root bearing capacity is
provided by:
where: , -root diameter
8 -root length
d
m
-average limit skin friction
U -coefficient reflecting influence of bore hole
Coefficient U reflects the influence of the bore hole diameter it ranges from 1,0 for hole up to
100mm and 0,B for hole from 200mm.
Average limit skin friction of the micropile root can be found in the literature. The program
contains three tables with reference values of limit skin friction. The first one is created by the
program authors using various literature sources, the second one contains values of y
m
according to DIN 4128, and the third one includes values published in by Klein and Misov
(Inzenrsk stavby, 1984). Third table contains measured values of skin friction of anchor
roots for various soils, root diameters, number if groutings, etc. - using this table yields rather
realistic results.
3iterature4
3i!!i< F: 75>I08: "The pali radice 7root piles8": S#mposium on soil and roc9improement
techniAues including geote&tiles< reinforced earth and modern pilingmethods< @ang9o9< D-3:
Skin "riction o" the 'icropile root
,e"erence &alues o" li'it skin "riction @reco''end )% the authorsA
Soil Skin "rition [kPa]
soft clay 21 $ H1
stiff clay H- - I-
solid clay 531 $ 5?1
sand naturally wet, loose 551 $ 5-1
sand naturally wet, medium dense 521 $ 5I1
sand maturally wet, dense 5?1 $ 031
aquiferous sand, loose I1 $ 531
aquiferous sand, medium dense 501 $ 5H1
aquiferous sand, dense 5H1 $ 011
-1012-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
sandy clay, soft -1 $ ?1
sandy clay, stiff ?- $ >-
sandy clay, solid 50- $ 5H-
clayey sand, wet, loose >1 $ 53-
clayey sand, wet, medium dense 53- $ 5H-
clayey sand, wet, dense 5-1 $ 5?1
clayey sand, aquiferous, loose I1 $ 51-
clayey sand, aquiferous, medium dense >1 $ 531
clayey sand, aquiferous, dense 55- $ 5--
5alues o" li'it skin "riction according to $I. C12M
Soil A&erage li'it skin "riction
piles in
co'pression [kPa]
piles in tension
[kPa]
medium to coarse-grain
sand
011 511
sand and gravel sand 5-1 I1
cohesive soils 511 -1
,eco''ended para'eters o" anchor roots (Misove, Klein, Inzenrsk stavby 5/1986)
-1013-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
!%pe o" support o"
'icropile in head
Final
grouting
press0
[!Pa]
.u')er
o"
grouting
s
,oot
dia'eter
[mm]
,oot
length
[m]
Skin
"riction
[kPa]
bedrock - 1 501 --3 5111-
5H11
semirock 1<--3<1 1-5 501-001 ?-3 311-5111
gravel, injectable soils 5<1 5-0 0-1-211 ?-- 0-1-301
gravel, non-injectable
soils
0<1-2<1 5-0 0I1-3-1 ?-- 031
medium and fine-grain
sand
5<--2<1 0-3 001-3-1 50-? 5-1-5I1
cohesive stiff and solid
soils
5<--3<1 5-3 011-0I1 5?-I 531-5>1
cohesive solid to rigid
plastic soils
5<1-0<- 0-3 5-1-211 01-> 511-531
cohesive soft plastic soils 1<--0<1 3-2 311-2-1 0?-53<- -1-?1
#ittle8ohn theor%
When using the Littlejohn method the root bearing capacity is provided by:
where: , -root diameter
8 -root length
p
)
-magnitude of grouting pressure
It follows from experimental measurements of micropiles that their bearing capacity also
depends on the course of grouting and on the grouting pressure (grouting course often
governs the micropile bearing capacity). The bearing capacity considerably increases with
repeated grouting. Grouting pressures range from 0,1 to " !pa, in some case they may reach
up to B !pa. The Littlejohn method gives the bearing capacity directly proportional to the
grouting pressure.
3iterature4
3+TT3(P*H.< ): S: # @6BC(< D: ,: 75>?-8:4 "6oc9 ,nchors - State of the ,rt: Part 5: Design":
(n )round (ngineering< "ol: I< .b 2:
Kweck theor%
The Zweck and Bowles methods were developed for the analysis of anchor roots they depend
mainly on the geostatic stress in the location of the micropile root. These methods arise from
-1014-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
the same priciples the pressure magnitude is however reduced using the coefficient of
pressure at rest 2
o
.
where: , -root diameter
8 -root length
2
o
-magnitude of pressure at rest

/
-average geostatic stress at the micropile root
-average value of friction angle at the micropile root
Bowles theor%
The Bowles solution allows for incorporating the influence of the cohesion on the root bearing
capacity therefore it is more suitable for cohesive soils.
where: , -root diameter
8 -root length
2
o
-coefficient of pressure at rest

/
-average geostatic stress at the micropile root
-average magnitude of angle of internal friction at the micropile root
3iterature4
P:(: @owles - Foundation ,nal#sis and Design< Mc)raw Hill boo9 Compan#
5Ias theor%
This solution takes into account the effect of geostatic stress at the micropile root and course
of grouting.
Bearing capacit% o" the 'icropile root is pro&ided )%;
where: R
>k
-bearing capacity of the micropile root
R
sk
-skin bearing capacity of the micropile root
/icropile skin )earing capacit%;
-1015-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: F -number of layers passed by the micropile root
+
s)
-area of wall of the micropile base in the )-th layer

s)
-skin friction in the )-th layer
Bearing capacit% o" the 'icropile root is pro&ided )%;
Skin friction
s
at a depth of ! below the terrain surface:
where: / -depth / bellow the terrain surface, where the magnitude of skin friction is
determined
c -effective cohesion of soil at a depth of /
V -friction angle along the interfave of the micropile root and the soil at a depth of /:

i -effective angle of internal friction of soil at a depth of /

h
t/
u
-horizontal component of geostatic stress at a depth of /:
-for grouting course of type IR and IRS (with monitoring of grouting pressure) and
depth ! l 5 m:

-other cases:

2
o
-coefficient of earth pressure at rest
-for normally consolidated soils:

-for overconsolidated soils:

0
t/
u
-vertical component of geostatic stress at a depth of /
-1016-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
p
)
-grouting pressure for grouting course of type IR and IRS and depth
/ m # m, in other cases p
)
= 0
F
c
,
F

-coefficients of type of application of micropile


3iterature4
"Yase< Souche4 wtude du fla<berment de pieu& partiellernent immergYs dans offrant
latYralement une rYaction YlastiAue pure< ,nnales de +m+T@TP< .o: 203< Sene Soils et
Foundations< 5I?< mars $ aril 5>I2< str: 3I $ H1 7French8
Coe""icients o" t%pe o" application o" 'icropile
Coe""icients o" t%pe o" application o" 'icropile
!%pe o" application o"
'icropile
F
c
[-] F

[-]
Newly constructed
foundations
5<-1 5<-1
Existing foundations 5<01 5<01
Bearing capacit% o" the root in rock
This solution is suitable for the mircopile root reaching into rocks with index R(< I @0 or
having the strength in simple compression
c
I 20 !Pa (ISRM < III). The root bearing capacity
is given by:
where: +
s
-area of wall of micropile root

sr
-skin friction in rock
+
>
-area of the micropile root

>r
-bearing capacity of the microple root in rock
3iterature4
)uOa para el pro#ecto # la e'ecuci\n de micropilotes en obras de carretera< Ministerio de
fomento< 011- 7Spanish8
Skin "riction and )earing capacit% o" the 'icropile root in
rock
Skin "riction in rock
sr
and )earing capacit% o" the 'icropile root in rock
>r

-1017-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
!%pe o" rock
sr
[!Pa]

>r
[!Pa]
1u1
Sediments 1<5- $ 1<21 1<1?
c

Slates and fylits 1<01 $ 1<31 1<1?
c

Sandstones 1<31 $ 1<2- 1<1?
c

Lime stones and dolomites 1<21 $ 1<-1 1<51
c

granites, basalts 1<21 $ 1<H1 1<51
c

1u

c
- strength in simple tension v !Pa
Busta'ante @SP!1 Pressio'eter /InardA
The analysis of bearing capacity of the micropile root section is based on the results of SPT
tests or pressiometric tests.
The magnitude of skin "riction o" the 'icropile root
s
[!Pa] is available from the
Bustamant graphs, which depend on the type of soil and the injection technology.
Sha"t resistance o" the 'icropile root R
s
follows from:
where: ,
r
-diameter of the micropile root
8
r
-length of the micropile root

s
-skin friction of the micropile root (value determined from the graph)
Base resistance o" the 'icropile root R
>
may not be considered in the analysis or is taken
as:
where: R
s
-Shaft resistance of the micropile root
Base resistance of the micropile root R
>
is assumed in the program in the form:
where: +
p
-croos-section area of the base of the micropile root
k
p
-soil factor in the vicinity of the base of the micropile root
p
8
-pressiometric pressure according to Mnard
Skin "riction o" the 'icropile root 6 graphs
The analysis of shaft resistance of the micropile root R
s
depends considerably on the t%pe o"
in8ection of micropile root. The following options of injection are considered in the program:
- I,S: repeated selective injection of the micropile root over sleeves performed locally
-1018-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
(!u)e6X6/anchette),
- IGU: unified global pressure injection (#ooped !u)e S%ste's).
The following graphs for the analysis of skin "riction o" the 'icropile root
s
[!Pa] are built
in the program:
-1019-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The displayed graphs consider on the horizontal axis the pressiometric pressure p
8
determined
from the pressiometric tests. In case of SPT tests the same graphs are used, but the
pressiometric pressure p
8
[!Pa] is then determined as the F6'ultiple of the number of blows
3 for the interval of penetration depth , = 0," m, i.e. SPP [3H0," m]. For individual types of soils
the values of pressiometric pressure p
8
according to Mnard are as follows:
- sand1 gra&el1 silt and weak rock; p
8
= SPP H 20.
- cla%s: p
8
= SPP H 1#.
For example, for the sandy soil and the value of the multiple of number of blows SPP = 120 the
pressiometric pressure is given by p
8
= SPP H 20 = 120 H 20 = @,0 !Pa.
Next, for example, for the clayey soil and the value of the multiple of number of blows SPP =
"0 the pressiometric pressure is provided by p
8
= SPP H 1# = "0 H 1# = 2,0 !Pa.
The vertical axis provides the value of skin friction of the micropile root
s
depending on the
value of pressiometric pressure p
8
and the applied type of injection (I,S or IGU, respectively).
Anal%ses in progra' Pile CP!
The program Pile CPT serves to verify the bearing capacity and settlement of a single pile or a
group of piles based on the results of penetration tests.
The main objective is to determine the toe and shaft bearing capacities. This analysis can be
carried according to the following standards and approaches:
- EN 1997-2
- NEN 6743
- LCPC (Bustamante)
- Schmertmann
For all methods the essential input parameters are dimensionless coefficients adjusting the
magnitude of bearing capacity and shaft friction, respectively. Different notation of these
parameters can be encountered in various publications. The following notation is used in
program Pile CPT:
-1020-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
G
p
-pile toe coefficient
G
s
-shaft friction coefficient
These coefficients are automatically calculated based on the type pile and the surrounding soil
these parameters can be, however, also specified manually (G
p
can be entered in the
"Geometry" input mode, G
s
as a soil parameter).
When analyzing rectangular piles the pile shape coefficients is introduced to reduce the toe
bearing capacity. When analyzing piles with enlargement the expanded pile toe coefficientY is
introduced to adjust the expanded toe bearing capacity. When calculating the toe bearing
capacity the program automatically accounts for the influence of the change of terrain
elevation.
The program allows for the calculation of limit load curve and pile settlement for a given load.
This analysis adopts the values of calculated toe and shaft bearing capacities and follows the
NEN 6743 standard. A negative skin friction can also be taken into account when calculating
pile settlement.
Verification of pile bearing capacity depends on the verification methodology selected in the
"Pile CPT" tab sheet.
Bearing capacit%
The maximum bearing capacity of a single pile based on the values of tip resistance
c
of the i-
th static penetration test is given by:
where: F
ma;,)
-
maximum bearing capacity of the pile from )
th
CPT test
F
ma;,toe,)
-
maximum toe resistance from )
th
CPT test
F
ma;,sha6t,)
-
maximum shaft resistance from )
th
CPT test
Providing there is F CPT tests then the bearing capacity of a single pile is obtained as an
arithmetic average of F calculated bearing capacities:
If performing the analysis according to the NEN 6743 standard then the approach for more CPT
tests is different and follows directly the NEN 6743 standard (article 5.3.2.2).
!he 'ai'u' pile toe resistance F
ma;,toe
is provided by:
where: +
toe
-pile toe cross-sectional area
p
ma;, toe
-maximum pressure at pile toe from CPT results
!he 'ai'u' sha"t resistance F
ma;,sha6t
is provided by:
-1021-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: T
p
-pile periphery in bearing soil
p
ma;, sha6t
-maximum force on shaft (friction) from CPT results
bD -pile length, either length of actived shaft friction or length of expanded
toe
/ -vertical dimension alog pile axis
Actual calculation of the maximum pressure at pile toe p
ma;,toe
and the maximum force
developed along the shaft p
ma;,sha6t
(determined according to the selected type of analysis
selected in the "Pile CPT" tab sheet).
3. 1DDE62
The 3. 1DDE62 standard determines the maximum pressure at pile toe (maximum
resistance) p
ma;,toe
from the corresponding i-th penetration test as follows:
where:
c,1,m
-mean from values
c,1
(see Addenum D.7 in EN 1997-2)

c,11,m
-mean of the minimum cone tip resistances
c,11
(see Addenum B4 in
EN 1997-3)

c,111,m
-mean of the cone tip resistance
c,111
(see Addenum B4 in EN 1997-3)
G
p
-pile toe coefficient (pile class factor)
s -pile shape coefficient
Y -expaned pile toe coefficient
The 'ai'u' &alue o" penetration pressure
c
is limited by the value of 1# !Pa. In
cohesionless soils the analysis takes into account the influence of overconsolidation (OCR).
The 'ai'u' sha"t "riction (shaft resistance) p
ma;,sha6t
is given by:
where: G
s
-shaft friction coefficient

c,/,a
-tip resistance at depth h
3iterature4
(. 5>>?-0 )eotechnical design: )round inestigation and testing
.3. LEC4
The NEN 6743 "Piled Foundations" standard determines the 'ai'u' pressure at pile toe
p
ma;,toe
from the corresponding )
th
penetration test as follows:
kde:
c,1,m
-mean of the cone tip resistance
c,1
(see article 5.3.3.3 in NEN 6743
-1022-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
standard)

c,11,m
-mean of the minimum cone tip resistance
c,11
(see article 5.3.3.3 in
NEN 6743 standard)

c,111,m
-mean of the cone tip resistance
c,111
(see article 5.3.3.3 in NEN 6743
standard)
G
p
-pile toe coefficient
s -pile shape coefficient
Y -expanded pile toe coefficient
The 'ai'u' pressure at pile toe p
ma;,toe
is limited by the value of 1# !Pa. In cohesionless
soils the analysis takes into account the influence of overconsolidation (OCR).
The 'ai'u' sha"t "riction p
ma;,sha6t
is given by:
where: G
s
-shaft friction coefficient

c,/,a
-tip resistance at depth h
3iterature4
.(. H?2345>>5;,545>>?< )eotechnie9 - @ere9eningsmethode oor funderingen op palen -
Dru9palen
#CPC @Busta'anteA
The LCPC - Laboratoire Central des Ponts et Chausees method (also known as Bustamante
method based on the works of Bustamante and Gianeselli) determines the 'ai'u'
pressure at pile toe p
ma;,toe
as follows:
where: G
p
-pile toe coefficient

c,e
-equivalent average cone tip resistence
The 'ai'u' sha"t "riction p
ma;,sha6t
is given by:
where: G
s
-shaft friction coefficient

c,/,a
-tip resistence
$eter'ination o" eHui&alent a&erage cone tip resistance
An equivalent average cone tip resistance is obtained in the following way:
1) calculate the average tip resistance
c,m
at the tip of the pile by averaging
c
values over a
zone ranging from 1,#, below the pile tip to 1,#, above the pile tip (dis the pile diameter)
2) eliminate
c
values in the zone which are higher than 1," multiple of the mean of the cone
tip resistance
c,m
and those are lower than 0,X multiple of the mean of the cone tip
resistance
c,m
as shown in figure
-1023-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
3) calculate the equivalent average cone tip resistance
c,e
by averaging the remaining cone
tip resistance (
c
) values over the same zone that were not eliminated (i.e. from values in
the range 0,X to 1," multiple of the cone tip resistance
c,m
)
Determination of eAuialent aerage cone tip resistance Ac< eA
3iterature4
Tom 3unne< Peter M: 6obertson< Pohn P:M: Powell4 Cone Penetration Testing in )eotechnical
Practice< Spon Press< 5>>?< 3ondon
Sch'ert'ann
The Schmertmann method determines the maximum pressure at pile toe p
ma;,toe
as follows:
where: G
p
-pile toe coefficient

9pr
-modified equivalent average cone tip resistance
where:
c1
,
c2
-minimum value of mean of the cone tip resistance
In cohesionless soils the analysis takes into account the influence of overconsolidation (OCR).
The 'ai'u' sha"t "riction p
ma;,sha6t
is given by following formulas:
- "or cohesionless soils;
-1024-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: 2 -correlation coefficient

-mean value of penetrometer sleeve local friction 6
s
in the interval
given by bracket subscript
+
s
-area of the pile shaft surface in given interval
, -diameter of pile
< -embedded pile length
- "or cohesi&e soils;
where: G
s,)
-
shaft friction coefficient according Tomlinson in the )
th
layer

-
mean value of penetrometer sleeve local friction 6
s
in the )
th
layer
+
s,)
-
area of the pile shaft surface in the )
th
layer
3iterature4
Schmertmann P:H:4 )uidelines for Cone Penetration Test< Performance and deign< B:S:
Departments of Transportation< report .o: FH%,-TS-?I-01>< %ashington<D:C:< 5>?I
$eter'ination o" a&erage cone tip resistance
The minimum mean value of the cone tip resistance
c
s determined by the minimum value of
the mean of the cone tip resistance
c
over the influenced zone ranging from 0,X, to 4, below
the pile toe (, is the pile diameter). The minimum mean value of the cone tip resistance
c2
is
determined over the influence zone extending from B, above the pile toe (, is the pile
diameter). The procedure for obtaining the mean value of the cone tip resistance
c1
,
c2
is as
follows (see figure):
1) determine two averages of the cone stress within the zone below the pile toe, one for a
zone depth of 0,X, and one for 0,4, along the path "a" through "b". The smaller of the two is
retained. (The zone height 0,X, applies to where the cone stress increases with depth below
the pile toe).
2) determine the smallest cone stress within the zone used for the Step 1
3) determine the average of the two values per Steps 1 and 2. Step 4 is determining the
average cone stress in the zone
4) determine the average cone stress in the zone B, above the pile toe that gives the value
c
.
Finally, the average of the Step 3 and Step 4 values is determined.
-1025-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Determination of aerage cone tip resistance Ac5< Ac0
Correlation coe""icient 7
Correlation coefficient of skin friction 2 is entered in the "Pile CPT" tab sheet. Value of this
coefficient is equal to ratio of unit pile shaft resistance and unit penetrometer sleeve local
friction. Correlation coefficient 2 can be expressed for example by function of embedded pile
length see following graphs.
-1026-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Function of embedded pile length 7D - embedded pile length< b - pile width or diameter8
3iterature4
FH%, H+ >?-1534 Design and Construction of Drien Pile Foundations< %or9shop manual $
"olume 5< .ational Highwa# institute
.egati&e skin "riction
A negative skin friction is an effect that arises as a result of the settlement of soil around the
pile. A soil deforming around the pile tends to pull the pile down thus reducing its bearing
capacity. In extreme cases this effect may completely eliminate the influence of shaft friction.
The pile is then supported only by elastic subsoil below the pile toe.
The negati&e skin "riction F
s,Fk,rep
is given by:
where: T
p
-pile periphery
F -number of layers in the negative friction zone
h
)
-
depth of )
th
layer
2
0,),rep
-representative value of the coefficient of earth pressure at rest
V
),rep
-
friction between soil and pile at )
th
layer

),rep
-
representative value of the angle of internal friction at )
th
layer
-1027-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013

0,)-1,rep
-horizontal stress in soil at )-1 layer

0,1,rep
-
horizontal stress in soil at )
th
layer
p
),a,rep
-surcharge at )-th layer
b
),0,$,rep
-
change of vertical stress
0
at)
th
layer
the following
relation holds:

If a slip surface is defined then the value of negative skin friction F
s,Fk,rep
is provide by:
where: T
p
-pile periphery
h
)
-
depth of )
th
layer
c
),rep
-representative cohesion of slip surface
- for bitumen 10.10
"
3Hm
2
- for bentonite 20.10
"
3Hm
2
- for synthetic material #0.10
"
3Hm
2
The value of representative cohesion along a slip surface can also be introduced directly by the
user.
Sha"t "riction coe""icient A#FA s
The coefficient reducing the shaft friction G
s
differs based on the applied method and the type
of soil. The following values are built into the program:
- according to 3. 1DDE62 and .3. LEC4
The values "or sands and sands with gra&el are listed in the following table:
Piles d
s
g-h
prefabricated driven piles or steel piles 0,010
Franki pile 0,014
driving wooden pile 0,012
vibrating 0,012
cast in place screw piles 0,00E
prefabricated screw pile 0,00E
cast in place screw piles with additional grouting 0,00@
-1028-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
prefabricated screw pile with additional grouting 0,00@
steel tubular piles 0,00X
#
continuous Flight Auger (CFA) 0,00@
bored piles or piles sheeted by bentonite suspense 0,00@
bored piles with steel casing 0,00#
For &er% coarse6grained sands and gra&els the above values are reduced in both methods
by a reduction coefficient (coarse-grained 0,X#, gravel 0,#).
For pit the value of E
s
= 0 is considered.
For cla% and silt the values of E
s
are taken from 3. 1DDE620
If the #CPC @Busta'anteA method is used the shaft friction coefficient E
s
is used depending
on the tip resistance
c
(orientation values are available in the following table).
Orientation &alues o" the sha"t "riction coe""icient d
s
)ased on the cone tip resistance

c

LCPC
(Bustamante)
Soil type
Cone stress (tip
resistance)

c
g!Pah
E
s

for bored piles
E
s

for driven piles
Maximum
shaft
resistance
gkPah
Clay _ 1 0,011 0,033 15
1 _
c
_ # 0,025 0,011 35
# _
c
0,017 0,008 35
Sand
c
_ # 0,017 0,008 35
# _
c
_ 12 0,010 0,005 80
12 _
c
0,007 0,005 120
When using Sch'ert'ann method, coefficient E
s
reducing shaft friction according to
Tomlinson is considered. Values used in program are derived from following graph mentioned
in publication M.J. Tomlinson: Pile Design and Construction Practice.
-1029-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
3iterature4
Tomlinson T:P:4 Pile Design and Construction Practice< Ta#lor and Franci< 5>>2< +S@. 514
125>5I2-13
In"luence o" o&erconsolidation @OC,A
For sand and gravel the maximum pressure at pile toe p
ma;,toe
(determined according to the
selected type of analysis selected in the "Pile CPT" tab sheet) is reduced depending on the
value of overconsolidation OCR (defined as a soil parameter in the frame "Soils") as follows:
Anal%sis accroding to 3C E641 .3. LEC4;
- for all cohesionless soils the maximum pressure at pile toe p
ma;,toe
is 1# !Pa
- for TSR l 2 no reduction is performed
- for 2 _ TSR l 4 the maximum pressure at pile toe p
ma;,toe
is multiplied by 0,@X
- for TSR I 4 the maximum pressure at pile toe p
ma;,toe
is multiplied by 0,50
(hen using the Sch'ert'ann 'ethod the reduction is performed according to the
following graph:
-1030-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
6eduction of eAuialent mean cone tip resistance according to *C6 7Schmertman8
Pile shape coe""icient s
This coefficient represents the influence of a rectangular pile, the >Ha ratio in particular. Its
values are evident from the following graph (function of >Ha):
)raph to determine pile shape coefficient s 7a $ length of the smallest side< b $ the largest
side8
3panded pile toe coe""icient B3!A
This coefficient denoted as Y represents the influence of an expanded pile shank (toe), its
values are evident from the following figure:
-1031-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
(as a function of ):
)raph to determine the coefficient ]
where: e -pile length
<
e
-equivalent pile diameter
,
e
-equivalent pile shank diameter
Pile toe coe""icient A#FA p
The pile toe coefficient of capacity reduction G
p
identifies the type of pile. Its values are
determined from one of the available calculation methods or they can be entered manually by
the user.
For .3. LEC4 a 3C 1DDE62 methods the following built-in values of the coefficient G
p
are
available:
Piles G
p
[-]
prefabricated driven piles or steel piles 5<1
Franki pile 5<1
driving wooden pile 5<1
Vibrating 5<1
cast in place screw piles 1<>
-1032-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
prefabricated screw pile 1<I
cast in place screw piles with additional grouting 1<>
prefabricated screw pile with additional grouting 1<I
steel tubular piles 5<1
continuous Flight Auger (CFA) 1<I
bored piles or piles sheeted by bentonite suspense 1<-
bored piles with steel casing 1<-
For #CPC and Sch'ert'ann the coefficient is back-calculated based on the value of
penetration resistance
c
(the values are stored in the following table):
Orientation &alues o" the pile toe coe""icient G
s
)ased on the cone tip resistance
c

LCPC
(Bustamante)
Soil type
Cone stress (tip
resistance)

c
[!Pa]
G
p

"or )ored
piles
G
p

"or dri&en
piles
Clay t 5 1<12 1<-1
5 t
c
t - 1<3- 1<2-
- t
c
1<2- 1<--
Sand
c
t 50 1<21 1<-1
53 t
c
1<31 1<21
Pile group
Analysis of a group of piles depends on the structure sti""ness. The basic assumption is that
for a stiff structure all piles experience the same settlement, while for a compliant structure
each pile deforms independently no interaction is assumed.
The 'ai'u' )earing capacit% o" a rigid pile "oundation is given by:
where: ! -number of piles in the pile foundation
F
r,ma;,rep
-single pile bearing capacity in the pile foundation
If adopting the NEN6743 standard then a coefficient of capacity reduction f is introduced into
the analysis depending on the number piles ! and the number of CPT tests (article 5.3.2.1).
The maximum )earing capacit% o" a co'pliant pile "oundation is determined according to
the bearing capacity of the most stressed pile in the group as:
-1033-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: F
r,)
-bearing capacity of fully stressed pile in the group
Calculation o" pile toe settle'ent l
The magnitude of pile head settlement $
1,,
is determined as follows:
where: $
toe,,
-pile toe settlement due to acting force

$
toe,,,1
-pile toe settlement due to force acting at toe
$
toe,,,2
-pile toe settlement due to force acting on the shaft
$
e8,,
-pile settlement due to elastic compression
The magnitudes of settlements $
toe,,,1
and $
toe,,21
are determined from built-in graphs
according to the NEN6743 standard. The value $
e8,,
is given by:
where: D -pile length
F
meaF,,
-mean of force acting on the pile
+
p8ast
-pile shank cross-sectional area
-
p,mat,,
-modulus of elasticity of pile material
Graphs to calculate settle'ent
Graphs to calculate settlement are taken from the NEN6743 standard (article 6.2.1), which
allow us to determine:
- Pile settlement due to toe vertical force (pile settlement in percentage of the equivalent
pile diameter plotted as a function of the toe vertical force given in percentage of the
maximum toe resistance F
ma;,toe
).
- Pile settlement due to shaft force (pile settlement in mm plotted as a function of the shaft
force given in percentage of the maximum shaft resistance F
ma;,sha6t
).
-1034-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
)raph to determine wtoe<d<5 75 $ drien piles< 0 $ continuous auger< 3 $ bored piles8
)raph to determine wtoe<d<0 75 $ drien piles< 0 $ continuous auger< 3 $ bored piles8
Calculation o" li'it load cur&e
One of the program outputs is a loading diagram of vertically loaded pile li'it load cur&e,
-1035-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
which plots the pile vertical settlement as a function of the applied load.
The limit load curve is determined as a sum of the settlements due to forces at the pile toe and
on the shaft derived from graphs used to calculate the pile settlement. A typical example of the
limit load curve appears in the following figure.
3imit load cure
5eri"ication
Verification of pile (or group of piles) )earing capacit% depends on the verification
methodology selected in the "Pile CPT" tab sheet:
- verification according to the EN 1997-2
- verification according to the factor of safety or the theory of limit states
- verification according to the NEN 6743
In settle'ent calculation it is possible to use either a limit load curve or a load-displacement
curve when adopting the NEN 6743 standard.
5eri"ication according to 3. 1DDE62
When verification according to EN 1997-2 is set, required coefficients are specified in the "Pile
CPT" tab sheet.
Program determines the toe and shaft bearing capacities. Result is 3 values of total bearing
capacities for 3 CPT experiments:
kde: R
c,)
-
total bearing capacity from )
th
CPT experiment
R
>,)
-
toe bearing capacity from )
th
CPT experiment
-1036-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
R
s,)
-
shaft bearing capacity from )
th
CPT experiment
Each value of bearing capacity is reduced by model coefficient
ca8
:
Model coefficient
ca8
is established according to design values and in-situ pile experiments
(statistical evaluation). Coefficient can be set in the "Pile CPT" tab sheet.
Program evaluates automatically standard values of pile resistance in compression:
- "ro' 'ini'al &alue
where:
- "ro' 'ean &alue
where:
Correlation coefficients f
"
and f
4
for evaluating standard values of bearing capacity are set
automatically according to number of CPT experiments. Constructions with sufficient stiffness
and resistance can be modelled by reducing of the correlation coefficients by value 1,1 (result
cannot be less than 1,0 after dividing). Reduction of coefficients f
"
and f
4
is set in the frame
"Settings".
Result standard value is minimal value from both values (minimal and mean bearing capacity):
Design values of bearing capacities are calculated from standard values:
- "ro' 'ini'al &alue
-1037-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- "ro' 'ean &alue
Bearing capacity is reduced by coefficients
>
and
s
(toe and shaft). Default values are set to
1,0. Values of coefficients can differ depending on various methodologies and countries user
should specify them in the "Pile CPT" tab sheet.
Result value of design bearing capacity is minimal value from both values (minimal and mean
bearing capacity):
Verification of pile for bearing capacity is given by following formula:
where: F
s,,
-design load
R
c,,
-design pile bearing capacity
Correlation coe""icients "or e&aluating standard &alues o"
)earing capacit%
Correlation coe""icients f "or e&aluating standard &alues o" )earing capacit% "ro'
results o" soil eperi'ents @ F + nu')er o" CP! test pro"ilesA
f forF= 1 2 " 4 # X 10
f
"
1,40 1,"# 1,"" 1,"1 1,2E 1,2X 1,2#
f
4
1,40 1,2X 1,2" 1,20 1,1# 1,12 1,0B
5eri"ication according to "actor o" sa"et%
The verification analysis according to factor of safety is selected in the "Pile CPT" tab sheet.
This frame also serves to define the required factor of safety for bearing capacity. Pile
verification then assumes the form:
where: F
s,,
-pile loading
SF
>
-safety factor for bearing capacity
-1038-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
F
r,,
-pile bearing capacity
5eri"ication according to li'it states
The verification according to limit states is selected in the "Pile CPT" tab sheet, including
setting of pile bearing capacity reduction coefficient. When using the NEN 6743 standard the
program automatically performs the verification analysis as specified by this standard and
therefore the frame "Settings" is not accessible. Pile verification for the "irst li'it state
assumes the formula:
where: F
s,,
-design pile loading

t
-reduction coefficient of bearing capacity
F
r,,
-design pile bearing capacity
Field testing
Some of the GEO5 programs exploit as input parameters for the analysis several types of field
tests (in situ). In particular, the following tests are considered:
- CP! tests - program Pile CPT,
- SP! tests - program Micropile (Bustamante method),
- pressio'etric tests - program Sheeting Check (modulus of subsoil reaction according to
Mnard), program Micropile (Bustamante method).
Cone penetration tests @CP!A
The static penetration test @CP!A is based on pushing a penetration cone with the help of
system of penetration rods with constant velocity of (20 - 2# mmHs) into the soil. During the
penetration test the values of the cone resistance
c
and the local skin "riction 6
s
,
respectively, are recorded. The cone resistance thus represents in general the resistance
against penetration of a cone spike into the soil (subsoil). The diameter of the tip of cone spike
is typically in the range of 2# - #0 mm.
The cone resistance
c
[!Pa] represents the ratio of the measured force on the cone tip (
c
and the area of normal projection of the cone tip +
c
.
The local skin "riction 6
s
[kPa] represents the ratio of the measured force on the friction of
sleeve F
s
and the area of its skin +
s
.
The result of static penetration test is its distribution plotted as a graph. The evaluation of CPT
tests serve as an input parameter for the analyses in the "Pile CP!" program.
I'port o" CP! tests
The results of static penetration tests can be imported into the program in the ?0!>! format.
The first line contains an arbitrary name of the CPT test. The remaining lines list individual
-1039-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
values (depth /, measured values of cone resistance
c
, measured values of local skin friction
6
s
) always separated by space (number of spaces is arbitrary).
Te&t file format to import results of cone penetration test 7CPT8
3iterature4
(. +S* 002?H-54 )eotechnical inestigation and testing - Field testing: Part 54 (lectrical cone
and pie!ocone penetration test< 0153:
(. +S* 002?H-504 )eotechnical inestigation and testing - Field testing: Part 504 Mechanical
cone penetration test 7CPTM8< 011>:
Standard penetration tests @SP!A
The standard penetration test @SP!A serves primarily to the determination of strength and
deformation parameters of soils. The standard penetration test is based on driving a sampling
device being punched by a ram weight m [k5] that is being dropped down from a height h [m]
on to a anvil or a punching head. The number of blows 3, needed to penetrate a sampling
device by a co called interval of penetration depth, is called the penetration resistance.
The results of standard penetration test are presented as a number of blows 3 over a certain
distance, to which the device (ram with a head or anvil) punched into the soil or rock,
respectively. This distance is called the inter&al o" penetration depth , [m]. The value of this
parameter is commonly assumed being equal to 0," m. For some types of tasks this value can
be changed.
3nergetic ratio o" testes de&ice -
r
[%] represents the ratio of real energy -
meas
and the
calculated energy -
theor
of the ram.
Other important parameters to evaluate standard penetration test are so called correlations
or correction factors (e.g. loss of energy due to length of the system of rods, influence of
overburden in sands, etc.). The current design methods based on the principle of SPT tests
have an empirical character and therefore it is necessary to use the corresponding parameters
correctly modified. The program assumes the following two ways of adopting the correction
factors:
- correlation S
3
"or &ertical stress i
\
represents the influence of weight of overburden
in sands. The values of the correction factor S
3
greater than 1,# must not be used
-1040-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
(according to EN ISO 22476-3 recommendations).
- userSs correlation R [-] represents the loss of energy due to the length of the system
of rods for sandy soils. This correction factor can be specified in the programs in the range
of (0,# - 1,0).
%able of built in t&'es of correlations
!%pe Type of
consolidation
,elati&e co'pactness 8
p
P%Q
Correlation "actor S
3
Type 1 - EN
ISO 22476-3
(Tab. A2)
Normally
consolidated
40 - @0
Type 2 - EN
ISO 22476-3
(Tab. A2)
@0 - B0
Type 3 - EN
ISO 22476-3
(Tab. A2)
Over-
consolidated
-
Type 4 - EN
ISO 22476-3
Normally
consolidated
sands
-
Type 5 - FHWA
(1998), Peck
(1974)
- -
where: i
\
- Effective vertical stress
The result of standard penetration test is its distribution plotted as a graph. The evaluation of
SPT tests serve as an input parameter for the analyses in the "/icropile" program
Bustamante method).
I'port o" SP! tests
The results of SPT tests can be imported into the program in the ?0!>! format. The first line
contains an arbitrary name of the SPT test. The remaining lines list individual values (depth /
and number of blows 3) always separated by space (number of spaces is arbitrary).
-1041-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Te&t file format to import results of standard penetration test 7SPT8
3iterature4
CS. (. +S* 002?H-34 )eotechnical inestigation and testing - Field testing: Part 34 Standard
penetration test< 011-:
Pressio'etric tests
The pressio'etric test consists of pressiometric probe placed in the tested soil and gradually
filled with water. The subsequent swelling of soil or rock around the hole is determined as a
dependence of the measured volume of water on the pressure increment that is gradually
increased in a priory defined time intervals.
The pressiometric test provides the following parameters as a function of depth / [m]:
- /Inard 'odulus -
m
[!Pa] is obtained from the pressiometric test and depends on the
type of sheath o" pro)e (rubber sleeve, perforated casing).
- pressio'etric pressure p
8
[!Pa] represents an increment of water pressure in the
testing probe depending on the volume change of soil or rock, respectively.
The result of pressiometric test is its distribution plotted as a graph. The evaluation of
pressiometric tests serve as an input parameter for the analyses in the "/icropile"
Bustamante method) and "Sheeting &eri"ication" (modulus of subsoil reaction due to
Mnard) programs.
I'port o" pressio'etric tests
The results of pressiometric tests can be imported into the program in the ?0!>! format. The
first line contains an arbitrary name of the pressiometric test. The remaining lines list
individual values (depth /, measured values of pressiometric pressure p
8
, measured values of
Menrd modulus -
m
) always separated by space (number of spaces is arbitrary).
-1042-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Te&t file format to import results of pressiometric tests
3iterature4
(. +S* 002?H-24 )eotechnical inestigation and testing - Field testing: Part 24 MYnard
pressuremeter test< 011-:
$i'ensioning o" concrete structures
Concrete structures can by analyze by folowing standards:
- EN 1992-1-1 (EC2) or EN 1992-2
- CSN 73 1201R
- CSN 73 6206 (only for Abutment)
- PN-B-03264:2002
- BS 8110:1997
- IS 456
- ACI 318-11
- AS 3600-2001
- SNiP 52-101-2003
- GB 50010-2002
- NZS 3101-2006
3. 1DD26161 @3C2A or 3. 1DD262
This help contains the following computationals methods:
- Materials, coefficients, notation
- Standard values of coefficiens
- Verification of rectangular cross-section made from plain concrete
- Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under M, V
-1043-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under N, M, V
- Verification of circular RC cross-section
- Verification of spread footing for punching shear
- Design of longitudinal reinforcement for plates
- Design of shear reinforcement for plates
/aterials1 coe""icients1 notation
The following notation for material parameters is used:
6
ck
- characteristic value of cylindrical strength of concrete in compression
6
c,
- design strength of concrete in compression
6
cm
- average value of tensile strength of concrete
6
ctk0,0#
- lower value of the characteristic tensile strength of concrete
6
ct,
- design strength of concrete in tension
6
?k
- characteristic strength of steel
6
?,
- design strength of steel in tension
The characteristic compressive strength of concrete is the basic input parameter given by the
class of concrete it serves to derive the remaining coefficients of reliability.



pro:

pro :




Standard values of coefficients G
cc
,
c
, G
ct
,
s
are built-in the program these values can also
be inputted by the user depending on the selected .ational anne.
The most common notation for geometrical parameters:
-1044-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
> - cross-section width
h - cross-section depth
, - effective depth of cross-section
/ - lever arm (arm of internal forces)
Standard &alues o" coe""icients
The standard contains a number of coefficients, which can be adjusted in .ational annees.
The table provides description of individual coefficients, their values and corresponding artical
of the standard. In some cases the formula contains a variable, which has no symbol in the
standard - in such a case the variable in the epression is denoted )% X.
Coe""icient 5alue Annotations Article

c
5<- 2.4.2.4

s
5<5- 2.4.2.4
G
cc
5 3.1.6
G
ct
5 3.1.6
G
cc,p8
1<I 12.3.1
G
ct,p8
1<I 12.3.1
k 5<- 12.6.3
[
m)F
1<1153 9.2.1.1
X 1<0H 9.2.1.1
[
ma;
1<12 9.2.1.1
[
m)F
1<110 9.5.2
X 1<5 9.5.2
[
ma;
1<12 9.5.2
X 1<5I 6.2.2
J
m)F
- 6.2.2
X 1<- 6.2.2
-1045-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
J - 6.2.2
cot5 N
m)F
1 6.2.3
cot5 N
ma;
0<- 6.2.3
.ational Anne C-ech ,epu)lic @CS. 3. 1DD26161 6 2F1FA
Coe""icient 5alue Annotations Article
G
ct,p8
1<? 12.3.1
other values are standard
.ational Anne Slo&akia @S!. 3. 1DD26161 6 2FFMA
all values are standard
.ational Anne Poland @P. 3. 1DD26161 6 2FFMA
Coe""icient 5alue Annotations Article

c
5<2 2.4.2.4
cot5 N
ma;
0<1 6.2.3
other values are standard
3. 1DD262 6 2FFE
Coe""icient 5alue Annotations Article
G
cc
1<I- 3.1.6
other values are standard
5eri"ication o" rectangular cross6section 'ade "ro'
plain concrete
The cross-section is rectangular, loaded by the bending moment !
-,
, normal force 3
-,
(applied in the cross-section centroid) and by the shear force \
-,
:The shear strength is
provided by:
where: +
cc
- compressed area of concrete
-1046-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Standard value of the coefficient k is built-in the program (Art. 12.6.3) this value can also be
adjusted in the program based on the selected .ational anne.
Strength of concrete cross-section subject to the combination of bending moment and normal
force is derived from the following expressions depending on the normal force eccentricity e:
As the greater of:
Standard values of coefficients G
cc,p8
, G
ct,p8
,
c
are built-in the program these values can also
be inputted by the user depending on the selected .ational anne.
5eri"ication o" rectangular ,C cross6section under /1 5
The cross-section is rectangular, reinforced on one side and loaded by the bending moment
!
-,
.
The permissible moment for a given area of reinforcements +
s
reads:
-1047-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:

Standard values of coefficients [
m)F
, [
ma;
are built-in the program these values can also be
inputted by the user depending on the selected .ational anne.
Shear
First, the program computes the ultimate shear strength of concrete \
R,,c
.
where:
If the ultimate shear strength of concrete is exceeded, the maximum ultimate shear strength
\
R,,ma;
is checked.
Next, the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
Standard values of coefficients J, J
ma;
are built-in the program these values can also be
inputted by the user depending on the selected .ational anne.
5eri"ication o" rectangular ,C cross6section under .1
/1 5
The cross-section is rectangular, unilaterally reinforced and loaded by the bending moment and
normal compression force. The program verifies a reinforced concrete section using the
method of limit deformation. The maximum allowable strain of concrete in compression is 0,002
to 0,00"#. Compression reinforcement is not taken into account. Minimum eccentricity is
applied:
-1048-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013

The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:

Standard values of coefficients [
m)F
, [
ma;
are built-in the program these values can also be
inputted by the user depending on the selected .ational anne.
Shear
First, the program computes the ultimate shear strength of concrete \
R,,c
.
where:
If the ultimate shear strength of concrete is exceeded, the ultimate shear strength \
R,,ma;
is
checked.
Next, the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
Standard values of coefficients J, J
ma;
are built-in the program these values can also be
inputted by the user depending on the selected .ational anne.
5eri"ication o" circular ,C cross6section
The program verifies a reinforced concrete pile using the method of limit deformation. The
maximum allowable strain of concrete in compression is 0,002 - 0,00"#. Concrete strength
c
M
6
c,
is reduced by ten percent due to shape of cross-section (Art. 3.1.7).
The degree of reinforcement is checked using the formula:
-1049-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- Pile
+
c
_ 0,#m
2

[
m)F
= 0,00#
+
c
I 1m
2

[
m)F
= 0,002#
where: +
c
- cross-section area of pile
intermediate values are interpolated

- Colu'n - check for dominant compression

- Bea' - check for dominant bending

where: , - pile diameter
+
s
- cross sectional area of reinforcement
Standard values of coefficients [
m)F
, [
ma;
are built-in the program these values can also be
inputted by the user depending on the selected .ational anne.
5eri"ication o" spread "ooting "or punching shear
It is loaded by the prescribed moments !
-;
, !
-?
and by the shear force \
-
provided by:
where: + - area of footing
-1050-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
\ - assigned vertical force developed in column
+
t
- hatched area in fig0
Dimensioning of shear reinforcement area ,t
The program constructs control sections at distances from 0,#, to 2, in case of "ooting
without shear rein"orce'ent. In case of rein"orced "ooting, the distances are from 0,#, to
4,, where , is the e""ecti&e depth o" "ooting. The shear reinforcement is considered in
control sections, which are in the distance of less than 2, from the column. The control
sections are considered in intervals of 0,2#,.
The load stress \
-,
in each control section is found using 6.4.3 (3), the punching shear
resistance of footing without shear reinforcement \
R,,c
follows from 6.4.4 (2) and if necessary
the punching shear resistance of reinforced footing \
R,,cs
is given by 6.4.5 (1).
Furthermore, the co'pression chord resistance at the column perimeter \
R,,ma;
is
calculated according to 6.4.5 (3). \
R,,ma;
depends on column dimensions and the footing
thickness.
!he control section with the worst ratio of loading and resistance is considered as critical and
marked in the program.
Literature:
EN 1992-1-1 Eurocode 2: Design of concrete structures Part 1-1: General rules and rules for
buildings
$esign o" longitudinal rein"orce'ent "or plates
The design of reinforcement is performed for loading caused by the bending moment !
-,
. The
program provides the required area of tensile and compressive (if needed) reinforcement. It
takes into account conditions for the minimum and maximum degree of reinforcement in a
given cross-section. First, the program determines the location of neutral axis as:
-1051-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Providing the location of neutral axis is less than the allowable one (; _ ;
ma;
), the program
determines the area of tensile reinforcement +
st
from the expression:
Providing the location of neutral axis is greater than the allowable one (; I ;
ma;
), the program
determines the areas of both compressive +
sc
and tensile +
st
reinforcement from the
expressions:
The limit location of neutral axis is found from:

for concrete C40/45 and lower

for concrete C45/50 and higher
The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:

Standard values of coefficients [
m)F
, [
ma;
are built-in the program these values can also be
inputted by the user depending on the selected .ational anne.
If the maximum degree of total reinforcement [
ma;
is exceeded, the program informs the user
that the longitudinal reinforcement cannot be designed for a given cross-section.
$esign o" shear rein"orce'ent "or plates
The program allows determination of the required amount of shear reinforcement form by
stirrups and hooks, respectively.
First, the program computes the ultimate shear strength in a given section the shear force
transmitted by concrete \
R,,c
and the maximum allowable shear force \
R,,ma;
.
-1052-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where:
As for stirrups the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
As for hooks the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
Standard values of coefficients J, J
m)F
are built-in the program these values can also be
inputted by the user depending on the selected .ational anne.
CS. E4 12F1 ,
This help contains the following computationals methods:
- Materials, coefficients, notation
- Verification of rectangular cross-section made from plain concrete
- Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under M, V
- Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under N, M, V
- Verification of circular RC cross-section
- Verification of spread footing for punching shear
- Design of longitudinal reinforcement for plates
- Design of shear reinforcement for plates
/aterials1 coe""icients1 notation
The following notation for material parameters is used:
R
>,
- design strength of concrete in compression
R
>t,
- design strength of concrete in tension

9
- coefficient of the shape of cross-section
/ - lever arm (arm of internal forces)
Coefficient
9
is given by equation:
-1053-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The most common notation for geometrical parameters:
> - cross-section width
h - cross-section depth
h
e
- effective depth of cross-section
/ - lever arm (arm of internal forces)
5eri"ication o" rectangular cross6section 'ade "ro'
plain concrete
The cross-section is rectangular, loaded by the bending moment !, normal force 3 (applied in
the cross-section centroid) and by the shear force X: The cross-section bearing capacity
subjected to bending moment is given by:
The shear strength is provided by:
Strength of concrete cross-section subject to the combination of bending moment and normal
force is derived from the following expressions depending on the normal force eccentricity e:
for:
The ultimate bearing capacity is checket using the following formula:
-1054-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
5eri"ication o" rectangular ,C cross6section under /1 5
The cross-section is rectangular, reinforced on one side and loaded by the bending moment
!
,
.
The ultimate moment is provided by:
The program further checks whether the location of neutral axis ; is less than the limit location
of neutral axis ;
8)m
given by:
The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:

Shear
First, the program computes the ultimate shear strength of concrete (
>9
.
where: for:

is: Q

= 1,2#
for:

je Q

= 1,#0
for:

je Q

= 1,@0
If the ultimate shear strength of concrete is exceeded, the ultimate shear strength (
ma;
is
checked.
Next, the necessary reinforcement area is given by:

-1055-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where:
The magnitude of c is bounded by the following expression:

5eri"ication o" rectangular ,C cross6section under .1
/1 5
The cross-section is rectangular, unilaterally reinforced and loaded by the bending moment and
normal compression force. The program verifies a reinforced concrete section using the
method of limit deformation. The maximum allowable strain of concrete in compression is 0,002
- 0,00"#. Compression reinforcement is not taken into account.
The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:

Shear
First, the program computes the ultimate shear strength of concrete (
>9
.
where: for:

is: Q

= 1,2#
for:

je Q

= 1,#0
for:

je Q

= 1,@0
If the ultimate shear strength of concrete is exceeded, the ultimate shear strength (
ma;
is
checked.
Next, the necessary reinforcement area is given by:

-1056-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where:
The magnitude of c is bounded by the following expression:

5eri"ication o" circular ,C cross6section
The program verifies a reinforced concrete pile using the method of limit deformation. The
maximum allowable strain of concrete in compression is 0,002#. The degree of reinforcement is
checked using the formula:
- Colu'n - check for dominant compression
- Bea' - check for dominant bending
where: , - pile diameter
+
s
- reinforcement area
5eri"ication o" spread "ooting "or punching shear
The program allows for the verification of spread footing for punching shear or for the design
of shear reinforcement. The critical section loaded in shear s
cr
is distant from the column edge
by one half of the footing thickness. It is loaded by the prescribed moments !
;
, !
?
and by the
shear force (
r
provided by:
where: + - area of footing
( - assigned vertical force developed in column
+
t
- hatched area in fig0
-1057-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dimensioning of shear reinforcement area ,t
The program computes the maximal shear force (
,ma;
developed in the critical section, the
shear force transmitted by concrete with no shear reinforcement (
>9
, and the maximal
allowable force (
ma;
:
where for: is: or else:
For (
,ma;
_ (
>9
no shear reinforcement is needed.
For (
,ma;
I (
>9
and (
,ma;
_ (
ma;
the shear reinforcement must be introduced. The ultimate
shear force is given by:
where: s
cr
- critical cross-section span
G - is angle of crooks
+
s
- overall area of crooks in footing
For (
,ma;
I (
ma;
the shear reinforcement cannot be designed. It is therefore necessary to
increase the cross-section height.
$esign o" longitudinal rein"orce'ent "or plates
The design of reinforcement is performed for loading caused by the bending moment !. The
program provides the required area of tensile and compressive (if needed) reinforcement. It
takes into account conditions for the minimum and maximum degree of reinforcement in a
given cross-section. First, the program determines the location of neutral axis as:
-1058-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Providing the location of neutral axis is less than the allowable one (; _ ;
8)m
), the program
determines the area of tensile reinforcement +
st
from the expression:
Providing the location of neutral axis is greater than the allowable one (; I ;
8)m
), the program
determines the areas of both compressive +
sc
and tensile +
st
reinforcement from the
expressions:
The limit location of neutral axis is found from:
The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:

If the maximum degree of tensile reinforcement (^
st,ma;
= 0,0") or total reinforcement (^
ma;
=
0,04), respectively, is exceeded, the program informs the user that the longitudinal
reinforcement cannot be designed for a given cross-section.
$esign o" shear rein"orce'ent "or plates
The program allows determination of the required amount of shear reinforcement form by
stirrups and hooks, respectively.
First, the program computes the ultimate shear strength in a given section the shear force
transmitted by concrete (
>9
and the maximum allowable shear force (
ma;
.
-1059-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: for:

is: Q

= 1,2#
for:

je Q

= 1,#0
for:

je Q

= 1,@0
As for stirrups the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
As for hooks the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
where:
The magnitude of c is bounded by the following expression:

CS. E4 L2FL
When selecting "CS. E4 L2FL", frame :Anal%sis 'ethods:, the verification analysis of
decisive joints is performed according to the standard CSN 73 6206 "Design of concrete and
steel reinforced concrete bridge structures", including changes a-10/1989 a Z2/1994. The
program allows for verification of cross-sections from plain concrete or single-ended steel
reinforced concrete. All calculations related to concrete are carried out using the theor% o"
allowa)le stresses.
The main difference when compared to other standards appears in the dimensioning of
concrete joints where the earth pressure is computed alwa%s without reduction o" input
para'eters independently of the input in the frame "Settings".
When performing the verification analysis of cross-sections made either from plain or steel
reinforced concrete it is possible input the coe""icient o" allowa)le stress according to art.
47 CS. E4 L2FL to increase the material allowable stress.
The following joints can be verified by the program:
A)ut'ent ste' + "oundation1 construction 8oint 6 the cross-section can be made either
from plain or steel reinforced concrete. The joint is verified for the load due to normal force
and bending moment. The allowable stresses of concrete, steel and concrete in concentric
pressure are checked. In case of reinforced concrete the program also checks the degree of
reinforcement, cross-sections from plain concrete are then checked for overturning (hH2e _
1,"#) and translation (3
M
6_1,#); friction concrete-concrete is assumed as 6 = 0,#).
-1060-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Closure wall 6 )earing )lock - the cross-section is verified for the load due to normal force
and bending moment. The steel reinforced concrete cross-section is always assumed. The
allowable stresses of concrete and steel and the degree of reinforcement are checked.
(ing wall + a)ut'ent the joint can be made either from concrete or steel reinforced
concrete. The allowable stresses of concrete, steel and concrete in concentric pressure are
checked. In case of reinforced concrete the program also checks the degree of reinforcement.
Front 8u'p o" a)ut'ent "oundation the front jump of abutment is verified according to
its projection. In case of jump projection 0 _ 0,#h
/
(h
/
is the height of foundation jump) the
program checks the magnitude of stress in principal tension due to forces developed in the
above-foundation joint. The stress is determined as:
where: , - width of above-foundation joint
!,3 - moment and normal force in above-foundation joint
In case of jump projection 0 I 0.# h
/
the jump is analyzed as cantilever bended by the reaction
(stress) of foundation soil. The joint can be made either from concrete or steel reinforced
concrete. The allowable stresses of concrete, steel and concrete in concentric pressure are
checked. In case of reinforced concrete the program also checks the degree of reinforcement.
P.6B6F42LC;2FF2
This help contains the following computationals methods:
- Materials, coefficients, notation
- Verification of rectangular cross-section made from plain concrete
- Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under M, V
- Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under N, M, V
- Verification of circular RC cross-section
- Verification of spread footing for punching shear
- Design of longitudinal reinforcement for plates
- Design of shear reinforcement for plates
/aterials1 coe""icients1 notation
The following notation for material parameters is used:
6
ck
- characteristic strength of concrete in compression
6
c,
- design strength of concrete in compression
6
ctk
- characteristic strength of concrete in tension
6
ct,
- design strength of concrete in tension
6
?k
- characteristic strength of steel
6
?,
- design strength of steel
6
ctm
- design strength of steel in tension
-1061-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: G
cc
= 1
G
ct
= 1

c
= 1,# -for reinforced concrete structures

c
= 1,B -for concrete strustures
The most common notation for geometrical parameters:
> - cross-section width
h - cross-section depth
, - effective depth of cross-section
/ - lever arm (arm of internal forces)
5eri"ication o" rectangular cross6section 'ade "ro'
plain concrete
The cross-section is rectangular, loaded by the bending moment !
S,
, normal force 3
S,
(applied
in the cross-section centroid) and by the shear force \
S,
: The cross-section bearing capacity
subjected to bending moment is given by:
The shear strength is provided by:
where:
Strength of concrete cross-section subject to the combination of bending moment and normal
force is derived from the following expressions depending on the normal force eccentricity e:
As the greater of:
-1062-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where:
5eri"ication o" rectangular ,C cross6section under /1 5
The cross-section is rectangular, reinforced on one side and loaded by the bending moment
!
S,
.
The permissible moment for a given area of reinforcements +
s
reads:
The program further checks whether the location of neutral axis ; is less than the limit location
of neutral axis ;
8)m
given by:
where:
The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:
where:


Shear
-1063-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
First, the program computes the ultimate shear strength of concrete \
R,1
.
where:
If the ultimate shear strength of concrete is exceeded, the ultimate shear strength \
R,2
is
checked.
where:
Next, the necessary reinforcement area is given by:

5eri"ication o" rectangular ,C cross6section under .1
/1 5
The cross-section is rectangular, unilaterally reinforced and loaded by the bending moment and
normal compression force. The program verifies a reinforced concrete section using the
method of limit deformation. The maximum allowable strain of concrete in compression is 0,002
- 0,00"#. Compression reinforcement is not taken into account.
The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:
where:


Shear
First, the program computes the ultimate shear strength of concrete \
R,1
.
-1064-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where:
If the ultimate shear strength of concrete is exceeded, the ultimate shear strength \
R,2
is
checked.
where:
Next, the necessary reinforcement area is given by:

5eri"ication o" circular ,C cross6section
The program verifies a reinforced concrete pile using the method of limit deformation. The
maximum allowable strain of concrete in compression is 0,002 - 0,00"#. The degree of
reinforcement is checked using the formula:
- Colu'n - check for dominant compression
- Bea' - check for dominant bending
where: , - pile diameter
+
s
- reinforcement area
-1065-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
5eri"ication o" spread "ooting "or punching shear
The critical section loaded in shear 9 is distant from the column edge by one half of the footing
thickness. It is loaded by the prescribed moments !
;
, !
?
and by the shear force 3
S,
provided
by:
where: + - area of footing
\ - assigned vertical force developed in column
+
t
- hatched area in fig0
Dimensioning of shear reinforcement area ,t
The program computes the maximal shear force 3
S,
developed in the critical section, the shear
force transmitted by concrete with no shear reinforcement 3
R,1
and the maximal allowable
force 3
R,,ma;
:
For 3
S,
_ 3
R,
no shear reinforcement is needed.
For 3
S,
I3
R,
and 3
S,
_ 3
R,,ma;
the shear reinforcement must be introduced. The ultimate
shear force is given by:
where: 9 - critical cross-section span
G - is angle of crooks
+
s$
- overall area of crooks in footing
For 3
S,
I3
R,,ma;
the shear reinforcement cannot be designed. It is therefore necessary to
increase the cross-section height.
-1066-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
$esign o" longitudinal rein"orce'ent "or plates
The design of reinforcement is performed for loading caused by the bending moment !
S,
. The
program provides the required area of tensile and compressive (if needed) reinforcement. It
takes into account conditions for the minimum and maximum degree of reinforcement in a
given cross-section. First, the program determines the location of neutral axis as:
Providing the location of neutral axis is less than the allowable one (; _ ;
ma;
), the program
determines the area of tensile reinforcement +
st
from the expression:
Providing the location of neutral axis is greater than the allowable one (; I ;
ma;
), the program
determines the areas of both compressive +
sc
and tensile +
st
reinforcement from the
expressions:
The limit location of neutral axis is found from:
where:
The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:
where:

-1067-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013

If the maximum degree of total reinforcement [
ma;
is exceeded, the program informs the user
that the longitudinal reinforcement cannot be designed for a given cross-section.
$esign o" shear rein"orce'ent "or plates
The program allows determination of the required amount of shear reinforcement form by
stirrups and hooks, respectively.
First, the program computes the ultimate shear strength in a given section the shear force
transmitted by concrete \
R,1
and the maximum allowable shear force \
R,2
.
where:
where:
As for stirrups the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
As for hooks the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
BS M11F;1DDE
This help contains the following computationals methods:
- Materials, coefficients, notation
- Verification of rectangular cross-sections made from plain concrete
- Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under M, V
- Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under N, M, V
- Verification of circular RC cross-section
- Verification of spread footing for punching shear
- Design of longitudinal reinforcement for plates
- Design of shear reinforcement for plates
-1068-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
/aterials1 coe""icients1 notation
The following notation for material parameters is used:
6
c9
- characteristic cube compressive strength of concrete
6
?
- characteristic strength of reinforcement
6
?,
- design strength of steel in tension
The characteristic compressive strength of concrete is the basic input parameter given by the
class of concrete.
The most common notation for geometrical parameters:
> - cross-section width
h - cross-section depth
, - effective depth of cross-section
/ - lever arm (arm of internal forces)
All computations are carried out according to the theory of limit states.
5eri"ication o" rectangular cross6sections 'ade "ro'
plain concrete
The cross-section is rectangular, loaded by the bending moment !, normal force 3 (applied in
the cross-section centroid) and by the shear force \.
Strength of concrete cross-section subject to the combination of bending moment and normal
force with eccentricity e is derived from the following expressions:
The shear strength is provided by:
where: J
c
- is the design value of shear stress in concrete for degree of longitudinal
reinforcement [ = 0 (see Verification of spread footing for punching shear)
5eri"ication o" rectangular ,C cross6section under /1 5
The cross-section is rectangular, reinforced on one side and loaded by the bending moment
!
9
.
The permissible moment for a given area of reinforcements +
s
reads:
-1069-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The program further checks whether the location of neutral axis ; is less than the limit location
of neutral axis ;
ma;
given by:
The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:
where:

- for 6
?
= 4@0 3Hmm
2
- for 6
?
= 2#0 3Hmm
2
Shear
First, the program computes the ultimate shear strength of concrete \
c
.
where:
The J
c
values are for 6
c9
above 2# 3Hmm
2
multiplied by t6
c9
H 2#u
1H"
If the ultimate shear strength of concrete is exceeded, the ultimate shear strength \
ma;
is
checked.
Next, the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
where:

-1070-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
5eri"ication o" rectangular ,C cross6section under .1
/1 5
The cross-section is rectangular, unilaterally reinforced and loaded by the bending moment and
normal compression force. The program verifies a reinforced concrete section using the
method of limit deformation. The maximum allowable strain of concrete in compression is 0,002
- 0,00"#. Compression reinforcement is not taken into account. Minimum eccentricity is applied:

The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:
where:
- for 6
?
= 4@0 3Hmm
2
- for 6
?
= 2#0 3Hmm
2
Shear
First, the program computes the ultimate shear strength of concrete \
c
.
where:
The J
c
values are for 6
c9
above 2# 3Hmm
2
multiplied by t6
c9
H 2#u
1H"
If the ultimate shear strength of concrete is exceeded, the ultimate shear strength \
ma;
is
checked.
Next, the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
where:

-1071-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
5eri"ication o" circular ,C cross6section
The program verifies a reinforced concrete pile using the method of limit deformation. The
maximum allowable strain of concrete in compression is 0,002 - 0,00"#.
The degree of reinforcement is checked using the formula:
- Colu'n - check for dominant compression

[
ma;
= 0,04
[
m)F
= 0,001"
- for 6
?
= 4@0 3Hmm
2
[
m)F
= 0,0024
- for 6
?
= 2#0 3Hmm
2
- Bea' - check for dominant bending

[
ma;
= 0,0@
[
m)F
= 0,004
where: , - pile diameter
+
s
- reinforcement area
5eri"ication o" spread "ooting "or punching shear
The critical section loaded in shear s
cr
is distant from the column edge by one half of the
footing thickness. It is loaded by the prescribed moments !
;
, !
?
and by the shear force \
provided by:
where: + - area of footing
( - assigned vertical force developed in column
+
t
- hatched area in fig0
-1072-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dimensioning of shear reinforcement area ,t
The program computes the maximum shear force \ developed in the critical section, the shear
force transmitted by concrete with no shear reinforcement \
c
, and the maximal allowable force
\
9
:
where:
The J
c
values are for 6
c9
above 2# 3Hmm
2
multiplied by t6
c9
H 2#u
1H"
or # 3Hm
2
J
9
-is ultimate shear stress
For \ _ \
c
no shear reinforcement is needed.
For \ I \
c
and \
c
_ \
9
it is necessary to design shear reinforcement. The permissable shear
force is given by:
where: 9 -critical cross-section span
G -angle of crooks
+
9s
-overall area of crooks in footing
For \I \
9
the shear reinforcement cannot be designed. It is therefore necessary to increase
the cross-section depth.
-1073-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
$esign o" longitudinal rein"orce'ent "or plates
The design of reinforcement is performed for loading caused by the bending moment !
,
. The
program provides the required area of tensile and compressive (if needed) reinforcement. It
takes into account conditions for the minimum and maximum degree of reinforcement in a
given cross-section. First, the program determines the location of neutral axis as:
Providing the location of neutral axis is less than the allowable one (; _ ;
ma;
), the program
determines the area of tensile reinforcement +
st
from the expression:
Providing the location of neutral axis is greater than the allowable one (; I ;
ma;
), the program
determines the areas of both compressive +
sc
and tensile +
st
reinforcement from the
expressions:
The limit location of neutral axis is found from:
The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:
where:
- for 6
?
= 4@0 3Hmm
2
- for 6
?
= 2#0 3Hmm
2
If the maximum degree of reinforcement [
ma;
is exceeded, the program informs the user that
the longitudinal reinforcement cannot be designed for a given cross-section.
$esign o" shear rein"orce'ent "or plates
The program allows determination of the required amount of shear reinforcement form by
-1074-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
stirrups and hooks, respectively.
First, the program computes the ultimate shear strength in a given section the shear force
transmitted by concrete \
c
and the maximum allowable shear force \
ma;
.
where:
The J
c
values are for 6
c9
above 2# 3Hmm
2
multiplied by t6
c9
H 2#u
1H"
As for stirrups the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
As for hooks the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
where:
IS CBL
This help contains the following computationals methods:
- Materials, coefficients, notation
- Verification of rectangular cross-sections made from plain concrete
- Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under M, V
- Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under N, M, V
- Verification of circular RC cross-section
- Verification of spread footing for punching shear
- Design of longitudinal reinforcement for plates
- Design of shear reinforcement for plates
/aterials1 coe""icients1 notation
The following notation for material parameters is used:
6
ck
- characteristic cube compressive strength of concrete
6
c,
- design strength of concrete in compression
6
ctk
- characteristic strength of concrete in tension
-1075-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
6
ct,
- design strength of concrete in tension
6
?
- characteristic strength of steel
6
?,
- design strength of steel in tension
The characteristic compressive strength of concrete is the basic input parameter given by the
class of concrete it serves to derive the remaining coefficients of reliability.
The most common notation for geometrical parameters:
> - cross-section width
h - cross-section depth
, - effective depth of cross-section
/ - lever arm (arm of internal forces)
All computations are carried out according to the theory of limit states.
5eri"ication o" rectangular cross6sections 'ade "ro'
plain concrete
The cross-section is rectangular, loaded by the bending moment !, normal force 3 (applied in
the cross-section centroid) and by the shear force \:
The shear strength is provided by:
where: d
c
- is the design value of stress in concrete obtained from table 19 of the IS456
standard for degree of longitudinal reinforcement [ = 0.
Strength of concrete cross-section subject to the combination of bending moment and normal
force with eccentricity e is derived from the following expressions:
-1076-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where:
5eri"ication o" rectangular ,C cross6section under /1 5
The cross-section is rectangular, reinforced on one side and loaded by the bending moment M.
The permissible moment for a given area of reinforcements +
s
reads:
The program further checks whether the location of neutral axis ; is less than the limit location
of neutral axis ;
ma;
given by:
- for steel Fe 250
- for steel Fe 400
- for steel Fe 500
The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:
Shear
First, the program computes the ultimate shear strength of concrete \
9c
.
where: d
c
is determined according to table 19 standard IS 456 : 2000.
If the ultimate shear strength of concrete is exceeded, the ultimate shear strength \
9c,ma;
is
checked.
-1077-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: d
c,ma;
is determined according to table 20 standard IS 456 : 2000.
Next, the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
where:

5eri"ication o" rectangular ,C cross6section under .1
/1 5
The cross-section is rectangular, unilaterally reinforced and loaded by the bending moment and
normal compression force. The program verifies a reinforced concrete section using the
method of limit deformation. The maximum allowable strain of concrete in compression is 0,002
- 0,00"#. Compression reinforcement is not taken into account. Minimum eccentricity is applied:
The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:
Shear
First, the program computes the ultimate shear strength of concrete \
9c
.
where: d
c
is determined according to table 19 standard IS 456 : 2000.
If the ultimate shear strength of concrete is exceeded, the ultimate shear strength \
9c,ma;
is
checked.
where: d
c,ma;
is determined according to table 20 standard IS 456 : 2000.
Next, the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
where:
-1078-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013

5eri"ication o" circular ,C cross6section
The program verifies a reinforced concrete pile using the method of limit deformation. The
maximum allowable strain of concrete in compression is 0,002 - 0,00"#.
The degree of reinforcement is checked using the formula:
- Colu'n - check for dominant compression
- Bea' - check for dominant bending
where: , - pile diameter
+
s
- reinforcement area
5eri"ication o" spread "ooting "or punching shear
The critical section loaded in shear s
cr
is distant from the column edge by one half of the
footing thickness. It is loaded by the prescribed moments !
;
, !
?
and by the shear force \
r
provided by:
where: + - area of footing
( - assigned vertical force developed in column
+
t
- hatched area in fig0
-1079-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dimensioning of shear reinforcement area ,t
The program computes the maximum shear force \ developed in the critical section, the shear
force transmitted by concrete with no shear reinforcement \
c
, and the maximal allowable force
\
ma;
:
where:
where: c
;
, c
?
- are dimensions of footing column
For \ _ \
c
no shear reinforcement is needed.
For \ I \
c
and \_ \
ma;
it is necessary to design shear reinforcement. The permissable shear
force is given by:
where: 9 -critical cross-section span
G -is angle of crooks
+
9s
-overall area of crooks in footing
For \I \
ma;
the shear reinforcement cannot be designed. It is therefore necessary to increase
the cross-section depth.
-1080-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
$esign o" longitudinal rein"orce'ent "or plates
The design of reinforcement is performed for loading caused by the bending moment !
r,
. The
program provides the required area of tensile and compressive (if needed) reinforcement. It
takes into account conditions for the minimum and maximum degree of reinforcement in a
given cross-section. First, the program determines the location of neutral axis as:
Providing the location of neutral axis is less than the allowable one (; _ ;
ma;
), the program
determines the area of tensile reinforcement +
st
from the expression:
Providing the location of neutral axis is greater than the allowable one (; I ;
ma;
), the program
determines the areas of both compressive +
sc
and tensile +
st
reinforcement from the
expressions:
The limit location of neutral axis is found from:

for steel Fe 250

for steel Fe 400

for steel Fe 500
The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:
If the maximum degree of tensile reinforcement ([
t,ma;
= 0,04) or total reinforcement ([
ma;
=
0,0B), respectively, is exceeded, the program informs the user that the longitudinal
reinforcement cannot be designed for a given cross-section.
$esign o" shear rein"orce'ent "or plates
The program allows determination of the required amount of shear reinforcement form by
stirrups and hooks, respectively.
-1081-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
First, the program computes the ultimate shear strength in a given section the shear force
transmitted by concrete \
c9
and the maximum allowable shear force \
9c,ma;
.
where: d
c
is determined according to table 19 standard IS 456 : 2000.
where: d
c,ma;
is determined according to table 20 standard IS 456 : 2000.
As for stirrups the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
As for hooks the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
where:
IS ,oad Bridges
ACI 41M611
This help contains the following computationals methods:
- Materials, coefficients, notation
- Verification of rectangular cross-section made from plain concrete
- Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under M, V
- Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under N, M, V
- Verification of circular RC cross-section
- Verification of spread footing for punching shear
- Design of longitudinal reinforcement for plates
- Design of shear reinforcement for plates
/aterials1 coe""icients1 notation
The following notation for material parameters is used:
6i
c
- design strength of concrete in compression
-
c
- modulus of elasticity
The modulus of elasticity is provided by:
The most common notation for geometrical parameters:
-1082-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
> - cross-section width
h - cross-section depth
, - effective depth of cross-section
5eri"ication o" rectangular cross6section 'ade "ro'
plain concrete
The cross-section is rectangular, loaded by the bending moment !, normal force P (applied in
the cross-section centroid) and by the shear force \
F
:
The shear strength is provided by:
Strength of concrete cross-section subject to the combination of bending moment and normal
force is derived from the following expressions:
for compression side:
where:
for tension side:
where:
5eri"ication o" rectangular ,C cross6section under /1 5
The cross-section is rectangular, reinforced on one side and loaded by the bending moment
!
9
.
The ultimate moment is provided by:
-1083-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:
The program further checks whether the location of neutral axis c is less than the limit location
of neutral axis c
ma;
given by:

Shear
First, the program computes the ultimate shear strength of concrete \
c
.
If the ultimate shear strength of concrete is exceeded, the ultimate shear strength \
ma;
is
checked.
Next, the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
where:

-1084-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
5eri"ication o" rectangular ,C cross6section under .1
/1 5
The cross-section is rectangular, unilaterally reinforced and loaded by the bending moment and
normal compression force. The program verifies a reinforced concrete section using the
method of limit deformation. The maximum allowable strain of concrete in compression is 0,002
- 0,00"#. Compression reinforcement is not taken into account.
The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:
Shear
First, the program computes the ultimate shear strength of concrete \
c
.
If the ultimate shear strength of concrete is exceeded, the ultimate shear strength \
ma;
is
checked.
Next, the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
where:

5eri"ication o" circular ,C cross6section
The program verifies a reinforced concrete pile using the method of limit deformation. The
maximum allowable strain of concrete in compression is 0,002 - 0,00"#. The degree of
reinforcement is checked using the formula:
- Colu'n - check for dominant compression
-1085-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- Bea' - check for dominant bending

where: , - pile diameter
+
s
- reinforcement area
5eri"ication o" spread "ooting "or punching shear
The program allows for the verification of spread footing for punching shear or for the design
of shear reinforcement. The critical section loaded in shear s
cr
is distant from the column edge
by one half of the footing thickness. It is loaded by the prescribed moments !
;
, !
?
and by the
shear force \
9
provided by:
where: + - area of footing
\ - assigned vertical force developed in column
+
t
- hatched area in fig0
Dimensioning of shear reinforcement area ,t
The program computes the maximal shear force \
9
developed in the critical section, the shear
force transmitted by concrete with no shear reinforcement \
c
, and the maximal allowable force
\
ma;
:
-1086-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
For \
9
_ .
M
\
c
no shear reinforcement is needed.
For \
9
I .
M
\
c
and \
9
_ .
M
\
ma;
the shear reinforcement must be introduced. The ultimate shear
force is given by:
where: s
cr
- critical cross-section span
G - is angle of crooks
+
s
- overall area of crooks in footing
For \
c
I \
ma;
the shear reinforcement cannot be designed. It is therefore necessary to increase
the cross-section height.
$esign o" longitudinal rein"orce'ent "or plates
The design of reinforcement is performed for loading caused by the bending moment !. The
program provides the required area of tensile and compressive (if needed) reinforcement. It
takes into account conditions for the minimum and maximum degree of reinforcement in a
given cross-section. First, the program determines the location of neutral axis as:
Providing the location of neutral axis is less than the allowable one (; _ ;
8)m
), the program
determines the area of tensile reinforcement +
st
from the expression:
Providing the location of neutral axis is greater than the allowable one (; I ;
8)m
), the program
determines the areas of both compressive +
sc
and tensile +
st
reinforcement from the
expressions:
where:
The limit location of neutral axis is found from:
-1087-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:
If the maximum degree of total reinforcement [
ma;
is exceeded, the program informs the user
that the longitudinal reinforcement cannot be designed for a given cross-section.
$esign o" shear rein"orce'ent "or plates
The program allows determination of the required amount of shear reinforcement form by
stirrups and hooks, respectively.
First, the program computes the ultimate shear strength in a given section the shear force
transmitted by concrete \
c
and the maximum allowable shear force \
ma;
.
As for stirrups the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
As for hooks the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
where:
AS 4LFF62FF1
This help contains the following computationals methods:
- Materials, coefficients, notation
- Verification of rectangular cross-sections made from plain concrete
- Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under M, V
- Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under N, M, V
- Verification of circular RC cross-section
-1088-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- Verification of spread footing for punching shear
- Design of longitudinal reinforcement for plates
- Design of shear reinforcement for plates
/aterials1 coe""icients1 notation
The following notation for material parameters is used:
6 x
c
- characteristic compressive cylinder strength of concrete at 28 days
-
c
- mean value of the modulus of elasticity of concrete at 28 days
6 x
c6
- characteristic flexural tensile strength of concrete
6 x
ct
- characteristic principal tensile strength of concrete
6
s?
- yield strength of reinforcing steel
The characteristic compressive strength of concrete is the basic input parameter given by the
class of concrete.
The most common notation for geometrical parameters:
> - cross-section width
< - cross-section depth
, - effective depth of cross-section
/ - lever arm (arm of internal forces)
All computations are carried out according to the theory of limit states.
5eri"ication o" rectangular cross6sections 'ade "ro'
plain concrete
The cross-section is rectangular, loaded by the bending moment !, normal force 3 (applied in
the cross-section centroid) and by the shear force \.
The shear strength is provided by:
Strength of concrete cross-section subject to the combination of bending moment and normal
force is derived from the following expressions:
-1089-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where:
where: +
5
- loaded area
5eri"ication o" rectangular ,C cross6section under /1 5
The cross-section is rectangular, reinforced on one side and loaded by the bending moment M.
The permissible moment for a given area of reinforcements +
s
reads:
The program further checks whether the location of neutral axis parameter k
9
is less than the
limit value:
where: ; - depth of neutral axis
The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:
where:
The program further checks ultimate shear strength:
-1090-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where:

5eri"ication o" rectangular ,C cross6section under .1
/1 5
The cross-section is rectangular, unilaterally reinforced and loaded by the bending moment and
normal compression force. The program verifies a reinforced concrete section using the
method of limit deformation. The maximum allowable strain of concrete in compression is 0,002
- 0,00"#. Compression reinforcement is not taken into account.
The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:
where:
The program further checks ultimate shear strength:
where:

5eri"ication o" circular ,C cross6section
The program verifies a reinforced concrete pile using the method of limit deformation. The
maximum allowable strain of concrete in compression is 0,002 - 0,00"#. The degree of
-1091-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
reinforcement is checked using the formula:
- Colu'n - check for dominant compression

- Bea' - check for dominant bending

where: < - pile diameter
+
s
- reinforcement area
5eri"ication o" spread "ooting "or punching shear
The program allows for the verification of spread footing for punching shear. The critical section
loaded in shear s
cr
is distant from the column edge by one half of the footing thickness. It is
loaded by the prescribed moments !
;
, !
?
and by the shear force \
M
provided by:
where: + - area of footing
\ - assigned vertical force developed in column
+
t
- hatched area in fig0
-1092-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dimensioning of shear reinforcement area ,t
The program checks, whether the cross-section bursting strength is sufficient according to the
relation:
where:
where: Y
h
- the ratio of the longest overall dimension of the effective loaded area, Y, to
the overall dimension, X, measured perpendicular to Y
a - the dimension of the critical shear perimeter measured parallel to the
direction of !
M
0
!
M
0

- the bending moment transferred from the slab to a support in the direction
being considered
The analysis is carried out independently in directions ; and ?, as the decisive one the lower
value of \
9
is accepted.
$esign o" longitudinal rein"orce'ent "or plates
The design of reinforcement is performed for loading caused by the bending moment !. The
program provides the required area of tensile and compressive (if needed) reinforcement. It
takes into account conditions for the minimum and maximum degree of reinforcement in a
given cross-section. First, the program determines the location of neutral axis as:
-1093-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Providing the location of neutral axis is less than the allowable one (; _ k
9M
,), the program
determines the area of tensile reinforcement +
st
from the expression:
Providing the location of neutral axis is greater than the allowable one (; I k
9M
,), the program
determines the areas of both compressive (+
sc
) and tensile (+
st
8 reinforcement from the
expressions:
where:
The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:
where:
$esign o" shear rein"orce'ent "or plates
The program allows determination of the required amount of shear reinforcement form by
stirrups and hooks, respectively.
First, the program computes the ultimate shear strength in a given section the shear force
transmitted by concrete \
9c
and the maximum allowable shear force \
9,ma;
.
where:
-1094-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
As for stirrups the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
As for hooks the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
where:
S.iP B261F162FF4
This help contains the following computationals methods:
- Materials, coefficients, notation
- Verification of rectangular cross-sections made from plain concrete
- Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under M, V
- Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under N, M, V
- Verification of circular RC cross-section
- Verification of spread footing for punching shear
- Design of longitudinal reinforcement for plates
- Design of shear reinforcement for plates
/aterials1 coe""icients1 notation
The following notation for material parameters is used:
R
>,
- design strength of concrete in compression
R
>t,
- design strength of concrete in tension
R
sc
- design strength of steel in compresion
Rs - design strength of steel in tension
The most common notation for geometrical parameters:
> - cross-section width
h - cross-section depth
h
e
- effective depth of cross-section
/ - lever arm (arm of internal forces)
-1095-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
5eri"ication o" rectangular cross6sections 'ade "ro'
plain concrete
The cross-section is rectangular, loaded by the bending moment !, normal force 3 (applied in
the cross-section centroid) and by the shear force (: The cross-section bearing capacity
subjected to bending moment is given by:
The shear strength is provided by:
Strength of concrete cross-section subject to the combination of bending moment and normal
force is derived from the following expressions depending on the normal force eccentricity e:
for:
5eri"ication o" rectangular ,C cross6section under /1 5
The cross-section is rectangular, reinforced on one side and loaded by the bending moment !.
The ultimate moment is provided by:
The program further checks whether the location of neutral axis ; is less than the limit location
of neutral axis ;
R
given by:
The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:
-1096-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013

Shear
First, the program computes the ultimate shear strength of concrete (
>
.
If the ultimate shear strength of concrete is exceeded, the ultimate shear strength (
ma;
is
checked.
Next, the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
where:

5eri"ication o" rectangular ,C cross6section under .1
/1 5
The cross-section is rectangular, unilaterally reinforced and loaded by the bending moment and
normal compression force. The program verifies a reinforced concrete section using the
method of limit deformation. The maximum allowable strain of concrete in compression is 0,002
to 0,00"#. Compression reinforcement is not taken into account.
The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:

Shear
First, the program computes the ultimate shear strength of concrete (
>
.
If the ultimate shear strength of concrete is exceeded, the ultimate shear strength (
ma;
is
checked.
Next, the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
-1097-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where:

5eri"ication o" circular ,C cross6section
The program verifies a reinforced concrete pile using the method of limit deformation. The
maximum allowable strain of concrete in compression is 0,002 - 0,00"#. The degree of
reinforcement is checked using the formula:
- Colu'n - check for dominant compression
- Bea' - check for dominant bending
where: , - pile diameter
+
s
- reinforcement area
5eri"ication o" spread "ooting "or punching shear
The program allows for the verification of spread footing for punching shear or for the design
of shear reinforcement. The critical section loaded in shear s
cr
is distant from the column edge
by one half of the footing thickness. It is loaded by the prescribed moments !
;
, !
?
and by the
shear force F provided by:
where: + - area of footing
( - assigned vertical force developed in column
+
t
- hatched area in fig0
-1098-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Dimensioning of shear reinforcement area ,t
The program computes the maximal shear force F developed in the critical section, the shear
force transmitted by concrete with no shear reinforcement F
>,98t
, and the maximal allowable
force F
98t,ma;
:
For F_ F
>,98t
no shear reinforcement is needed.
For F I F
>,98t
and F _ F
98t,ma;
the shear reinforcement must be introduced. The ultimate shear
force is given by:
where: \
cr
- critical cross-section span
G - is angle of crooks
+
s
- overall area of crooks in footing
For FI F
98t,ma;
the shear reinforcement cannot be designed. It is therefore necessary to
increase the cross-section height.
$esign o" longitudinal rein"orce'ent "or plates
The design of reinforcement is performed for loading caused by the bending moment !. The
program provides the required area of tensile and compressive (if needed) reinforcement. It
takes into account conditions for the minimum and maximum degree of reinforcement in a
given cross-section. First, the program determines the location of neutral axis as:
Providing the location of neutral axis is less than the allowable one (; _ ;
ma;
), the program
determines the area of tensile reinforcement +
st
from the expression:
-1099-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Providing the location of neutral axis is greater than the allowable one (; I ;
ma;
), the program
determines the areas of both compressive +
sc
and tensile +
st
reinforcement from the
expressions:
The limit location of neutral axis is found from:
The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:

$esign o" shear rein"orce'ent "or plates
The program allows determination of the required amount of shear reinforcement form by
stirrups and hooks, respectively.
First, the program computes the ultimate shear strength in a given section the shear force
transmitted by concrete (
>
and the maximum allowable shear force (
ma;
.
As for stirrups the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
As for hooks the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
where:
GB BFF1F62F1F
This help contains the following computationals methods:
-1100-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
- Materials, coefficients, notation
- Verification of rectangular cross-sections made from plain concrete
- Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under M, V
- Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under N, M, V
- Verification of circular RC cross-section
- Verification of spread footing for punching shear
- Design of longitudinal reinforcement for plates
- Design of shear reinforcement for plates
/aterials1 coe""icients1 notation
The following notation for material parameters is used:
6
c
- design strength of concrete in compression
6
t
- design strength of concrete in tension
6 x
?
- design strength of steel in compresion
6x
?
- design strength of steel in tension
The most common notation for geometrical parameters:
> - cross-section width
h - cross-section depth
, - effective depth of cross-section
/ - lever arm (arm of internal forces)
5eri"ication o" rectangular cross6sections 'ade "ro'
plain concrete
The cross-section is rectangular, loaded by the bending moment !, normal force 3 (applied in
the cross-section centroid) and by the shear force \: The cross-section bearing capacity
subjected to bending moment is given by:
where:
The shear strength is provided by:
where:
-1101-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Strength of concrete cross-section subject to the combination of bending moment and normal
force is derived from the following expressions depending on the normal force eccentricity e:
for:
where:
5eri"ication o" rectangular ,C cross6section under /1 5
The cross-section is rectangular, reinforced on one side and loaded by the bending moment !.
The ultimate moment is provided by:
for:
for: , intermediate values are obtained using linear interpolation method.
The program further checks whether the location of neutral axis ; is less than the limit location
of neutral axis ;
>
given by:
for:
for:
-1102-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:

Shear
First, the program computes the ultimate shear strength of concrete \
c
.
where:
If the ultimate shear strength of concrete is exceeded, the ultimate shear strength \
ma;
is
checked.
for:
for: , intermediate values are obtained using linear interpolation method.
Next, the necessary reinforcement area is given by:

5eri"ication o" rectangular ,C cross6section under .1
/1 5
The cross-section is rectangular, unilaterally reinforced and loaded by the bending moment and
normal compression force. The program verifies a reinforced concrete section using the
method of limit deformation. The maximum allowable strain of concrete in compression is 0,002
to 0,00"#. Compression reinforcement is not taken into account.
The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:

-1103-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Shear
First, the program computes the ultimate shear strength of concrete \
c
.
where:
If the ultimate shear strength of concrete is exceeded, the ultimate shear strength \
ma;
is
checked.
for:
for: , intermediate values are obtained using linear interpolation method.
Next, the necessary reinforcement area is given by:

5eri"ication o" circular ,C cross6section
The program verifies a reinforced concrete pile using the method of limit deformation. The
maximum allowable strain of concrete in compression is 0,002 - 0,00"#. The degree of
reinforcement is checked using the formula:
- Colu'n - check for dominant compression
- Bea' - check for dominant bending
where: , - pile diameter
+
s
- reinforcement area
5eri"ication o" spread "ooting "or punching shear
The program allows for the verification of spread footing for punching shear or for the design
-1104-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
of shear reinforcement. The critical section loaded in shear s
cr
is distant from the column edge
by one half of the footing thickness. It is loaded by the prescribed moments !
;
, !
?
and by the
shear force F
8
provided by:
where: + - area of footing
( - assigned vertical force developed in column
+
t
- hatched area in fig0
Dimensioning of shear reinforcement area ,t
The program computes the maximal shear force F
8
developed in the critical section, the shear
force transmitted by concrete with no shear reinforcement F
c
, and the maximal allowable force
F
ma;
:
where formula elements are determined according to 7.7.1 of standard GB 50010-2010.
For F
8
_ F
c
no shear reinforcement is needed.
For F
8
I F
c
and F
8
_ F
ma;
the shear reinforcement must be introduced. The ultimate shear force
is given by:
where: 9
m
- critical cross-section span
G - is angle of crooks
+
s>
9

- overall area of crooks in footing
For F
8
I F
ma;
the shear reinforcement cannot be designed. It is therefore necessary to increase
the cross-section height.
$esign o" longitudinal rein"orce'ent "or plates
The design of reinforcement is performed for loading caused by the bending moment !. The
-1105-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
program provides the required area of tensile and compressive (if needed) reinforcement. It
takes into account conditions for the minimum and maximum degree of reinforcement in a
given cross-section. First, the program determines the location of neutral axis as:
Providing the location of neutral axis is less than the allowable one (; _ ;
8)m
), the program
determines the area of tensile reinforcement +
st
from the expression:
Providing the location of neutral axis is greater than the allowable one (; I ;
8)m
), the program
determines the areas of both compressive +
sc
and tensile +
st
reinforcement from the
expressions:
The limit location of neutral axis is found from:
The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:

If the maximum degree of total reinforcement [
ma;
is exceeded, the program informs the user
that the longitudinal reinforcement cannot be designed for a given cross-section.
$esign o" shear rein"orce'ent "or plates
The program allows determination of the required amount of shear reinforcement form by
stirrups and hooks, respectively.
First, the program computes the ultimate shear strength in a given section the shear force
transmitted by concrete \
c
and the maximum allowable shear force \
ma;
.
-1106-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where:
for:
for: , intermediate values are obtained using linear interpolation method.
As for stirrups the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
As for hooks the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
.KS 41F162FFL
This help contains the following computationals methods:
- Materials, coefficients, notation
- Verification of rectangular cross-sections made from plain concrete
- Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under M, V
- Verification of rectangular RC cross-section under N, M ,V
- Verification of circular RC cross-section
- Verification of spread footing for punching shear
- Design of longitudinal reinforcement for plates
- Design of shear reinforcement for plates
/aterials1 coe""icients1 notation
The following notation for material parameters is used:
6 x
c
- specified compressive strength of concrete
-
c
- modulus of elasticity of concrete at 28 days
6 x
?
- lower characteristic yield strength of reinforcing steel
The characteristic compressive strength of concrete is the basic input parameter given by the
class of concrete.
The most common notation for geometrical parameters:
> - cross-section width
-1107-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
h - cross-section depth
, - effective depth of cross-section
/ - lever arm (arm of internal forces)
All computations are carried out according to the theory of limit states.
5eri"ication o" rectangular cross6sections 'ade "ro'
plain concrete
The cross-section is rectangular, loaded by the bending moment !
M
, normal force 3
M
(applied
in the cross-section centroid) and by the shear force \
M
. The shear strength is provided by:
where:
for cross-sections with height smaller than 200mm
for cross-sections with height greater than 400mm, intermediate values are
obtained using linear interpolation method.
6
c
x
is limited to value #0!Pa.
Strength of concrete cross-section subject to the combination of bending moment and normal
force is derived from the following expressions depending on the normal force eccentricity e:
Where 3
F
is determined as the greater of:
for 6
c
x
_ ##!Pa is G
1
= 0.B#
for concrete with greater strength is

-1108-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
5eri"ication o" rectangular ,C cross6section under /1 5
The cross-section is rectangular, reinforced on one side and loaded by the bending moment
!
M
.
The ultimate moment is provided by:
for 6
c
x
_ ##!Pa is G
1
= 0.B#
for concrete with greater strength is
for 6
c
x
_ "0!Pa is Y
1
= 0.B#
for concrete with greater strength is
The program further checks whether the location of neutral axis c is less than the limit location
of neutral axis 0.X#c
>
given by:
The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:
Shear
where:
First, the program computes the ultimate shear strength of concrete \
c
.
for cross-sections with height smaller than 200mm
0
c
is computed acording to following formulas for cross-sections with height greater than
400mm, intermediate values are obtained using linear interpolation method.
-1109-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where [
$
is degree of reinforcement and 6
c
x
is limited to value #0!Pa.
If the ultimate shear strength of concrete is exceeded, the ultimate shear strength \
ma;
is
checked.
Next, the necessary reinforcement area is given by:

5eri"ication o" rectangular ,C cross6section under .1
/1 5
The cross-section is rectangular, unilaterally reinforced and loaded by the bending moment and
normal compression force. The program verifies a reinforced concrete section using the
method of limit deformation. The maximum allowable strain of concrete in compression is
0,00". Compression reinforcement is not taken into account.
The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:
Shear
where:
First, the program computes the ultimate shear strength of concrete \
c
.
for cross-sections with height smaller than 200mm
0
c
je spocten podle nsledujcch vztahu pro prurezy s vskou vts nez 400mm, mezilehl
hodnoty jsou interpolovny.
0
c
is computed acording to following formulas for cross-sections with height greater than
400mm, intermediate values are obtained using linear interpolation method.
-1110-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where [
$
is degree of reinforcement and 6
c
x
is limited to value #0!Pa.
If the ultimate shear strength of concrete is exceeded, the ultimate shear strength \
ma;
is
checked.
Next, the necessary reinforcement area is given by:

5eri"ication o" circular ,C cross6section
The program verifies a reinforced concrete pile using the method of limit deformation. The
maximum allowable strain of concrete in compression is 0,00".
The degree of reinforcement is checked using the formula:
- Pile
+
5
_ 0,#m
2

[
m)F
= 2,4 H 6
?

+
5
I 2m
2

[
m)F
= 1,2 H 6
?

where: +
5
- cross-section area of pile
intermediate values are calculated according to:
- Colu'n - check for dominant compression
- Bea' - check for dominant bending
-1111-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where: , - pile diameter
+
s
- cross sectional area of reinforcement
5eri"ication o" spread "ooting "or punching shear
The program allows for the verification of spread footing for punching shear or for the design
of shear reinforcement. The critical section loaded in shear s
cr
is distant from the column edge
by one half of the footing thickness. It is loaded by the prescribed moments !
M
;
, !
M
?
and by
the shear force \
M
provided by:
where: + - area of footing
\ - assigned vertical force developed in column
+
t
- hatched area in fig0
Dimensioning of shear reinforcement area ,t
Program vypocte maximln smykovou slu \
M
v kritickm prurezu, dle pak posouvajc slu
prensenou betonem bez smykov vztuze \
c
a maximln dovolenou slu \
ma;
.
The program computes the maximal shear force \
M
developed in the critical section, the shear
force transmitted by concrete with no shear reinforcement \
c
, and the maximal allowable force
\
ma;
:
wher:
-1112-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
where G
s
: 20 - for interior column
15 - for edge column
10 - for corner column
Y
c
c is the ratio of the long side to the short side of the critical section
For \
M
_ .\
c
no shear reinforcement is needed.
For \
M

I .\
c
and \
M
_ .\
ma;
the shear reinforcement must be introduced. The ultimate shear
force is given by:
kde: >
o
- dlka kritickho prurezu
G - sklon ohybu
+
0
- celkov plocha ohybu v patce
where: >
o
- critical cross-section span
G - is angle of crooks
+
0
- overall area of crooks in footing
For \
M
I .\
ma;
the shear reinforcement cannot be designed. It is therefore necessary to
increase the cross-section height.
$esign o" longitudinal rein"orce'ent "or plates
The design of reinforcement is performed for loading caused by the bending moment !
M
. The
program provides the required area of tensile and compressive (if needed) reinforcement. It
takes into account conditions for the minimum and maximum degree of reinforcement in a
given cross-section. First, the program determines the location of neutral axis as:
Providing the location of neutral axis is less than the allowable one (c _ 0.X#c
>
), the program
determines the area of tensile reinforcement +
st
from the expression:
Providing the location of neutral axis is greater than the allowable one (c I 0.X#c
>
), the
program determines the areas of both compressive +
sc
and tensile +
st
reinforcement from the
-1113-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
expressions:
The limit location of neutral axis is found from:
The computed degree of reinforcement is checked using the following expressions:
If the maximum degree of total reinforcement [
ma;
is exceeded, the program informs the user
that the longitudinal reinforcement cannot be designed for a given cross-section.
$esign o" shear rein"orce'ent "or plates
The program allows determination of the required amount of shear reinforcement form by
stirrups and hooks, respectively.
First, the program computes the ultimate shear strength in a given section the shear force
transmitted by concrete \
c
and the maximum allowable shear force \
ma;
.
where:
for cross-sections with height smaller than 200mm
0
c
is computed acording to following formulas for cross-sections with height greater than
400mm, intermediate values are obtained using linear interpolation method.
where [
$
is degree of reinforcement and 6
c
x
is limited to value #0!Pa.
If the ultimate shear strength of concrete is exceeded, the ultimate shear strength \
ma;
is
checked.
As for stirrups the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
-1114-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
As for hooks the necessary reinforcement area is given by:
-1115-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Inde
ACI 318-11..............................................................................................................1043
Active earth pressure...........................................................89, 90, 730-735, 759, 760, 769
Activity.........................................................................................................51, 503, 504
Adhesion coefficient....................................................................................................882
Administrator.......85-88, 96, 97, 117, 128, 147, 175, 192, 211, 231, 248, 265, 282, 299, 315,
329, 352, 379, 419, 571, 586, 610, 667, 696
Advanced input...................................................................................................442, 500
Analyses in program Pile CPT.......................................................................................573
Analysis.......51, 68, 69, 91-95, 99, 105-107, 109-111, 113-115, 122-127, 138-140, 142, 143,
159-161, 166, 167, 188, 190, 198-200, 203, 206, 208, 218-220, 223, 226, 228, 237-239,
242, 244, 246, 253-255, 258, 260, 262, 271-273, 276, 278, 280, 284, 324-326, 340-342,
345, 347, 349, 360-363, 365, 376, 389, 390, 398, 437, 542, 550, 552, 559, 567, 569, 599,
608, 656, 671, 680, 681, 683, 686, 688, 689, 691, 712-714, 801, 811, 831, 838, 846, 858,
878, 886, 901, 902, 914, 937, 953, 961, 1015, 1030, 1033, 1060
Analytical solution........................................................................................299, 878, 914
Anchors..........................................134, 163, 182, 387, 396, 434, 508, 509, 527, 814, 1014
Applied forces...........................................141, 162, 202, 222, 241, 257, 275, 344, 685, 767
Arrango theory...........................................................................................................769
AS 3600-2001..........................................................................................................1043
Assign. . .57, 121, 132, 157, 180, 181, 197, 217, 236, 252, 270, 285, 303, 321, 339, 359, 372,
402, 425, 478, 503, 507, 582, 587, 594, 679, 704
Automatic arc length control.................................................................................555, 556
Barton - Bandis...................................................................................................381, 985
Base anchorage...................................................................................................204, 224
Basic data. . .119, 130, 152, 178, 195, 215, 234, 250, 268, 283, 301, 336, 357, 400, 404, 405,
409, 421, 572, 592, 677, 702, 723
Beam loads.................................................................................................508, 510, 540
Beams..................................................................................479, 508, 512, 513, 521, 626
Bearing capacity. .207, 227, 244, 260, 278, 348, 366, 583, 689, 690, 783, 786, 880, 998, 999,
1001, 1015, 1016, 1038
Bishop............................................................188, 693, 787, 827, 842, 845, 849, 857, 858
Blocks................................................................................................................384, 975
Bore holes.................................................................................................................409
Bowles theory.....................................................................................................95, 1011
BS 8110:1997..........................................................................................................1043
Buildings...................................................................................................................370
Catalog of materials...................................194, 213, 232, 514, 517-519, 629, 631, 655, 698
Catalog of profiles...............................................................................................518, 519
-1116-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Change of stiffness matrix...........................................................................................550
Circular slip surface.............................................................................................188, 190
Classification of soils...............................................................................................55, 60
Coefficient of influence of corrosion.............................................................................1001
Coefficient of permeability...........................................................................................474
Coefficients of type of application of micropile..............................................................1017
Combinations SLS.................................................................................606, 607, 653, 654
Compression constant..........................................................................................941, 946
Compression index...............................................................................................941-943
Concentrated surcharge...............................................................................................759
Consolidation analysis..........................................................................................937, 938
Construction.....39, 40, 208, 228, 245, 349, 574, 576, 781, 884, 901, 1027, 1029, 1030, 1037
Contact elements........................................................................................................522
Contact types.............................................................................................................479
Contacts...............................................................................................479, 480, 520-522
Control menu......................................................................................................716, 717
Convergence criterion.................................................................................................550
Coordinate systems....................................................................................................401
Copy to clipboard....................................................................................52, 714, 719, 720
Coupled section bearing capacity...........................................................................998, 999
CPTs..................................................................................................................580, 581
Critical depth.............................................................................................................877
Cross-section editor.............................................................................................518, 519
CSN 73 1002................................................93, 95, 299, 302, 310, 710, 878, 886, 887, 915
CSN 73 6206...........................................................................................349, 1043, 1060
Damages...................................................................................................................375
Design approach 1.........................................................................100, 105, 107, 127, 144
Design approach 2.......................................................................................101, 207, 690
Design approach 3......................................................................................................101
Design coefficients................................................................................................68, 887
Design of longitudinal reinforcement for plates......1044, 1053, 1061, 1068, 1075, 1082, 1089,
1095, 1101, 1107
Design of shear reinforcement for plates.....1044, 1053, 1061, 1068, 1075, 1082, 1089, 1095,
1101, 1107
Design situations..........................................................................................90, 91, 93-95
Dimensioning.69, 208, 228, 245, 246, 261, 279, 287, 297, 331, 349, 367, 655, 661, 662, 689,
690, 713, 786, 804, 873
Distributions.........................................................................................168, 297, 659, 663
-1117-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
DL/T 5219 - 2005.......................................................................................................877
Drucker-Prager......................................................................451, 454, 460, 549, 558, 567
Earth cut.......................................................................................................50, 177, 317
Earth grading.............................................................................................................411
Earth pressure.....119, 120, 131, 152, 153, 195, 196, 215, 216, 234, 235, 250, 251, 268, 269,
336, 337, 357, 358, 678, 727, 747, 757, 759, 774, 787
Earthquake.....89, 90, 125, 142, 166, 186, 203, 223, 242, 258, 276, 345, 363, 388, 686, 767,
996
Edges................................................................................................................407, 408
Editor of materials.........................................................................514, 517, 518, 631, 655
Effective stress method.................................................................................299, 310, 878
Elastic model......................................................................................................449, 452
Embankment..........................................................................................50, 176, 316, 846
EN 1997-2..............................................................94, 573, 1020, 1022, 1028, 1029, 1036
Envelopes..................................................................................................................173
Estimated bond strength..............................................................................................781
Excavation.............................................................................117, 128, 144, 147, 158, 823
External stability.................................................................................................171, 368
Failure by heave.........................................................................................................825
Fellenius / Petterson....................................................................................................857
Field testing...........................................................................................1040, 1042, 1043
Foliation....................................................................................................................178
Footing...........................98, 99, 101, 107, 282, 284, 286, 287, 290, 296, 333, 860, 869, 873
Foundation.....99, 283, 286, 290, 773, 819, 820, 861, 863, 865, 879-882, 886, 901, 902, 912,
914, 947, 948, 956, 1009, 1015, 1017, 1022, 1027
Frames................................................................................................................44, 484
Free area loads...........................................................................................................646
Free line loads.....................................................................................................645, 646
Free lines....................................................................................................484, 485, 494
Free point loads..........................................................................................................644
Free points...........................................................................................482, 484, 492, 494
Front face resistance.......................................................201, 221, 240, 256, 274, 343, 684
Generate..................................................................74, 406, 413, 548, 605, 606, 652, 674
Generator of anchored regions..............................................................................484, 485
Generator of anchors on free line..................................................................................509
Generator of combinations.....................................................................603, 608, 650, 654
Generator of shape of lining..................................................................................484, 485
GeoClipboard......................................................................................50, 51, 61, 505, 543
-1118-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Geometric method (Euler)..........................................................................................1004
Geometric section.......................................................................................................330
Geometry....107, 117, 133, 154, 155, 193, 204, 212, 224, 231, 248, 261, 266, 286, 289, 290,
293, 305, 330-332, 352, 354, 373, 391, 393, 423, 577, 588, 668, 669, 697, 823, 1021
Global coordinate system.............................................................................................434
Global stability.............................................................................................668, 693, 787
Graphs.............................................................................................................566, 1034
GWT + NSF..........................................................................................575, 576, 578, 579
GWT above toe of slope........................................................................................970-973
GWT on tension crack..........................................................................................970, 972
Heave failure..............................................................................................................172
Height multiplier.........................................................................................................190
Hoek - Brown......................................................................................................381, 985
Horizontal bearing capacity...................................................................................313, 911
Horizontal modulus..............................................................................................708, 919
Hydrodynamic pressure..................................................................172, 751, 753, 771, 773
Hydrostatic pressure, ground water behind and in front of structure..................................753
Hydrostatic pressure, ground water behind structure...............................................751, 752
Hypoplastic clay..................................................................................................451, 464
Import CPT................................................................................................................581
Import gINT.................................................................................................................84
Import of loads...........................................................................................................288
Incompressible subsoil................................................................................................318
Index of secondary compression...................................................................................941
Influence of ground water............................................................................................397
Influence of water...............123, 139, 160, 199, 219, 238, 254, 272, 341, 361, 386, 681, 857
Initial solution step.....................................................................................................550
Inputting data using template........................................................................................75
Interface.............................................................50, 60, 175, 315, 446, 484, 587, 590, 775
Internal hinges....................................................................................................633, 634
Internal stability.....................................................................89, 692, 787, 998, 999, 1004
IS 456..........................................................................................1043, 1077, 1078, 1082
Janbu............................92, 188, 827, 832, 837, 843, 846, 857, 859, 921, 929-932, 941, 948
Joint loads...................................................................................................640, 641, 643
Joint refinements........................................................................................................615
Joint supports............................................................................................................623
Joints.................................................................................................................228, 610
Ko procedure..............................................................................................................437
-1119-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Launching............................................................................................406, 414, 416, 417
LCPC (Bustamante)....................................................................94, 573, 1020, 1029, 1033
Line constructions................................................................................................406, 416
Line flow....................................................................................................................526
Line loads..................................................................................................................641
Line refinement....................................................................................484, 486, 497, 616
Line search method......................................................................................550, 557, 559
Line supports...............................................................................................525, 624, 625
Line surcharge............................................................................................................759
Linear models.............................................................................................................449
Linear theory (Poulos).................................................................................................896
Lines.........................................................................................................................611
Lining....................................................................................482-484, 491, 492, 507, 508
List of pictures.............................................................................................712, 715, 717
List of variables...................................................................................................562, 563
Littlejohn theory.......................................................................................................1011
Lizzi theory.........................................................................................................95, 1011
Load. .88, 94, 105-107, 109-111, 113-115, 127, 206, 208, 226, 228, 244, 246, 260, 262, 278,
280, 287, 304, 330, 338, 347, 349, 365, 426, 435, 484, 597-600, 602, 605, 637, 639, 649,
651, 666, 688, 689, 691, 699, 723, 873, 879, 888, 896, 898, 900, 915, 998, 999
Location...................................................................36, 489, 512, 521, 525, 587, 591, 855
Macroelement loads....................................................................................................643
Macroelement refinements...........................................................................................618
Macroelement subsoils................................................................................................635
Macroelements....................................................................................................612, 613
Manual classification of soils...........................................................................................57
Material. 49, 117, 147, 155, 175, 192, 194, 208, 211, 213, 228, 231, 232, 246, 248, 265, 282,
290, 292, 297, 299, 306, 313, 329, 334, 349, 352, 355, 367, 381, 424, 586, 588, 599, 602,
605, 607, 608, 610, 639, 640, 649, 651, 654-656, 658, 661-663, 667, 669, 696, 698, 713,
781, 792, 799, 806-808, 830, 998, 999, 1002-1004, 1043, 1053, 1061, 1068, 1075, 1082,
1088, 1095, 1101, 1107
Maximum number of iterations.....................................................................................550
Measurement.............................................................................................................374
Mesh generation.........................................................................................................622
Micropile.....98, 99, 419, 421, 422, 432, 998-1000, 1002-1004, 1011, 1015, 1039, 1041, 1042
Minimum dimensioning pressure...................................................................................127
Modified compression index.........................................................................................941
Modified elastic model.................................................................................................449
Modifying template during data input..............................................................................75
-1120-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Modulus of subsoil reaction....................................................................152, 168, 301, 702
Mohr - Coulomb..................................................................................................381, 985
Monitors....................................................................................................................564
Morgenstern-Price...........................................................188, 827, 832, 837, 846, 857, 859
MSE Wall..............................................................................................................89, 694
Nailed slopes......................................................................................................366, 368
NAVFAC DM 7.2....................................................93, 95, 299, 302, 310, 710, 878-882, 915
Negative skin friction...........................................................................................308, 706
NEN 6743.......................................94, 573, 894, 1020-1023, 1028, 1030, 1032, 1036, 1039
Nonlinear theory (Masopust)........................................................................................896
Numerical implementation of MCC and GCC models.................................................459, 460
NZS 3101-2006........................................................................................................1043
Oedometric modulus.....................................................................................301, 941, 945
Openings...................................................................................................................614
Options...................................................................................34, 37, 38, 50-54, 719, 720
Overconsolidation index of secondary compression.........................................................941
Own water force acting on slip surface only............................................................970, 974
Own water force behavior.....................................................................................970, 975
Page properties...................................................................................................718, 720
Partial factors..........................................................................99, 102, 109, 114, 835, 888
Passive earth pressure.........................................................89, 90, 737-739, 743, 744, 759
Pile analysis...............................................................................................................302
Pile base resistance.....................................................................................................879
Pile CPT........................................83, 98, 99, 573, 581, 1020-1022, 1026, 1030, 1036-1039
Pile group...................................................................98, 99, 696, 700, 702, 703, 710, 914
Pile settlement..................................................................................................878, 1034
Pile shaft resistance....................................................................................................879
Piles...75, 98, 99, 299, 301, 302, 304, 305, 310, 312, 571, 572, 878, 886-888, 902, 911, 919,
1028, 1032
Plane slip surface................................................................................................379, 778
Plane strain analysis....................................................................................................441
Plasticity............................................................................................................550, 558
PN-B-03264:2002.....................................................................................................1043
Point constructions.......................................................................................406, 414, 416
Point flow..................................................................................................................524
Point refinement.........................................................................................................495
Point supports............................................................................................................523
Points...........................................................................................................82, 403, 404
-1121-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Polygonal slip surface...................................................................................188, 190, 379
Pressiometric tests.......................................................................................149, 150, 430
Primary settlement..............................................................................................927, 933
Print and export document..........................................................38, 43, 714, 716, 718, 719
Print and export picture..........................................................38, 43, 53, 58, 714, 718, 719
Profile..118, 129, 148, 155, 194, 214, 233, 249, 267, 282, 299, 335, 356, 371, 420, 571, 580,
676, 702
Project.116, 127, 147, 174, 191, 210, 230, 247, 264, 281, 298, 314, 328, 351, 369, 379, 399,
419, 436, 452, 570, 586, 609, 666, 695, 720, 723
Props..................................................................................................135, 164, 531, 532
Reading data into interface............................................................................................75
Reading data into template............................................................................................75
Recompression index...................................................................................................941
Reinforcement....................183, 228, 533, 661, 662, 673, 675, 691, 692, 786, 788, 796, 831
Results......................................................................72, 560, 561, 608, 659-661, 712, 819
Rigid bodies........................................................................................................180, 477
Rock...89, 98, 99, 372, 381, 388, 777, 781, 796, 865-867, 966, 967, 976, 980, 985, 986, 988,
990, 993, 996, 997, 1014
Root verification.........................................................................................................432
Salas theory.......................................................................................................95, 1004
Sand-gravel cushion....................................................................................................291
Sarma...........................................................................................188, 827, 836-838, 840
Scale color definition...............................................................................................73, 74
Schmertmann.........................................94, 580, 748, 1020, 1024, 1025, 1029, 1030, 1033
Secondary settlement..........................................................................................927, 933
Selecting and storing views............................................................................................71
Setting and analysis description....................................................................................543
Setting arc length.......................................................................................................555
Settings...47, 85-88, 96, 97, 99, 101, 104, 112, 117, 128, 147, 175, 192, 211, 230, 231, 248,
265, 282, 284, 286, 296, 299, 302, 308, 309, 315, 325, 326, 329, 352, 370-373, 379, 419,
436, 437, 442, 447, 482, 484, 487, 507, 543, 560, 564, 571, 575, 576, 579, 586, 589, 610,
667, 696, 702, 703, 710, 723, 784, 792, 870, 911, 915, 919, 937, 960, 1037, 1039, 1060
Settlement. .40, 54, 72, 75, 282, 283, 311, 312, 315, 319, 324, 325, 416, 562, 584, 592, 702,
711, 899, 901, 918
Shahunyants..........................................................................188, 827, 837, 849, 850, 857
Sheeting check.....................................................................................................40, 171
Sheeting design..................................................................................................145, 811
Slip on georeinforcement......................................................................................691, 787
Slope stability.....54, 70, 75, 99, 110, 145, 171, 179, 186, 209, 229, 246, 247, 263, 280, 350,
368, 416, 437, 694, 787
-1122-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
SNiP 52-101-2003....................................................................................................1043
Soils......97, 119, 130, 149, 152, 158, 178, 195, 201, 215, 221, 234, 240, 250, 256, 268, 274,
283, 291, 300, 301, 319, 336, 343, 357, 371, 401, 421, 447, 572, 587, 592, 677, 684, 702,
819, 829, 860, 937, 1001, 1009, 1010, 1017, 1030
Solution according to CSN 73 1001...............................................................................864
Solution method.........................................................................................................550
Solution procedure................................................................................386, 397, 814, 850
Special distribution of water pressure.....................................................................751, 755
Spencer.....................................188, 693, 787, 827, 832, 837, 840, 843, 846, 847, 857, 858
Spring method....................................................................................................878, 894
Stability...98, 99, 145, 175, 179, 188, 209, 229, 246, 263, 280, 350, 352, 364, 379, 390, 398,
437, 554, 667, 693, 694, 778, 836, 840, 846, 858, 956, 984, 985, 987, 992
Stage settings.....100, 108, 112, 116, 126, 143, 167, 187, 205, 206, 208, 225, 226, 228, 243,
259, 277, 295, 309, 324, 346, 347, 349, 364, 375, 389, 687, 709, 962
Stages of construction..........................................................................................491, 492
Standard approach.....................................................................................................864
Standard values of coefficients................................................1044, 1047-1050, 1052, 1053
Stress in the footing bottom.........................................................................................803
Strip surcharge...........................................................................................................759
Structure.................................................................................68, 697, 712, 879-882, 990
Style manager.............................................................................................................42
Subsoil.........................................................................................................50, 587, 589
Supports......................................................................................136, 165, 523, 596, 814
Surcharge.....68, 108, 124, 140, 161, 184, 200, 220, 239, 255, 273, 293, 322, 328, 331, 342,
362, 386, 395, 434, 538, 683, 977
Surface surcharge.......................................................................................................759
Tables...................................................................................................42, 735, 736, 744
Temperature load........................................................................................................643
Terrain.....82-84, 118, 122, 129, 138, 148, 159, 195, 198, 214, 218, 233, 237, 249, 253, 267,
271, 283, 300, 335, 340, 356, 360, 371, 380, 401, 416, 417, 420, 572, 676, 680, 702
Tomlinson....................................................93, 299, 302, 310, 878, 884, 1025, 1029, 1030
Topology..............................................................................................484, 491, 503, 508
Transient flow analysis.................................................................................................445
Trapezoidal surcharge..................................................................................................759
Tunnels..............................................................................................................442, 516
Types of blocks...........................................................................................................211
Types of nails.............................................................................................................353
Types of reinforcements...............................................................................................670
User catalog................................................................................................156, 157, 673
-1123-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Values.......462, 561, 659, 662, 712, 775, 819, 842, 845, 849, 867, 884, 948, 950, 991, 1001,
1010, 1013, 1029, 1038
Verification...68, 69, 89-91, 93-95, 98, 100, 107, 108, 127, 188, 206-208, 226-228, 243, 244,
246, 259-261, 277-279, 296, 338, 347-349, 364-366, 377, 390, 398, 432, 668, 688-691, 778,
786-788, 792, 801, 802, 804, 836, 874, 876, 877, 887, 963, 984, 985, 998, 999, 1005, 1021,
1036, 1038, 1043, 1044, 1053, 1061, 1068, 1069, 1075, 1082, 1088, 1089, 1095, 1101, 1107
Vertical bearing capacity...............................................................................309, 310, 709
Vertical springs............................................................................................707, 919, 920
Visualization style settings.....39, 42, 43, 58, 127, 144, 189, 190, 206-208, 226-228, 244-246,
249, 260-263, 266, 278-280, 296-298, 310-314, 325, 347-349, 366, 376, 377, 390, 398, 400,
404, 408, 409, 411, 413, 414, 416, 543, 561, 583, 584, 657, 660, 688-690, 692, 693, 713,
715
Void ratio....................................................................................................465, 941, 947
Volume loss........................................................................................................370, 373
Wall analysis. 192, 211, 231, 248, 262, 265, 329, 352, 667, 693, 779, 789, 796, 803, 807, 808
Water 42, 45, 50, 123, 139, 160, 185, 199, 219, 238, 254, 272, 294, 307, 323, 341, 361, 385,
397, 408, 409, 427, 446, 503, 521, 543, 545, 587, 595, 681, 682, 705, 752, 974, 978
Wings................................................................................................................331, 349
Without ground water, water is not considered........................................................751, 970
World coordinates.........................................................................................................60
Zweck theory......................................................................................................95, 1011

-1124-
GEO5 User's Guide Fine Ltd. 2013
Fine Ltd. 2013
www.finesoftware.eu
-1125-

Вам также может понравиться